* gdb.texinfo (Fortran Operators): Describe '%' operator.
[deliverable/binutils-gdb.git] / gdb / doc / gdb.texinfo
1 \input texinfo @c -*-texinfo-*-
2 @c Copyright (C) 1988, 1989, 1990, 1991, 1992, 1993, 1994, 1995, 1996, 1998,
3 @c 1999, 2000, 2001, 2002, 2003, 2004, 2005, 2006
4 @c Free Software Foundation, Inc.
5 @c
6 @c %**start of header
7 @c makeinfo ignores cmds prev to setfilename, so its arg cannot make use
8 @c of @set vars. However, you can override filename with makeinfo -o.
9 @setfilename gdb.info
10 @c
11 @include gdb-cfg.texi
12 @c
13 @settitle Debugging with @value{GDBN}
14 @setchapternewpage odd
15 @c %**end of header
16
17 @iftex
18 @c @smallbook
19 @c @cropmarks
20 @end iftex
21
22 @finalout
23 @syncodeindex ky cp
24
25 @c readline appendices use @vindex, @findex and @ftable,
26 @c annotate.texi and gdbmi use @findex.
27 @syncodeindex vr cp
28 @syncodeindex fn cp
29
30 @c !!set GDB manual's edition---not the same as GDB version!
31 @c This is updated by GNU Press.
32 @set EDITION Ninth
33
34 @c !!set GDB edit command default editor
35 @set EDITOR /bin/ex
36
37 @c THIS MANUAL REQUIRES TEXINFO 4.0 OR LATER.
38
39 @c This is a dir.info fragment to support semi-automated addition of
40 @c manuals to an info tree.
41 @dircategory Software development
42 @direntry
43 * Gdb: (gdb). The GNU debugger.
44 @end direntry
45
46 @ifinfo
47 This file documents the @sc{gnu} debugger @value{GDBN}.
48
49
50 This is the @value{EDITION} Edition, of @cite{Debugging with
51 @value{GDBN}: the @sc{gnu} Source-Level Debugger} for @value{GDBN}
52 Version @value{GDBVN}.
53
54 Copyright (C) 1988, 1989, 1990, 1991, 1992, 1993, 1994, 1995, 1996, 1998,@*
55 1999, 2000, 2001, 2002, 2003, 2004, 2005, 2006@*
56 Free Software Foundation, Inc.
57
58 Permission is granted to copy, distribute and/or modify this document
59 under the terms of the GNU Free Documentation License, Version 1.1 or
60 any later version published by the Free Software Foundation; with the
61 Invariant Sections being ``Free Software'' and ``Free Software Needs
62 Free Documentation'', with the Front-Cover Texts being ``A GNU Manual,''
63 and with the Back-Cover Texts as in (a) below.
64
65 (a) The FSF's Back-Cover Text is: ``You are free to copy and modify
66 this GNU Manual. Buying copies from GNU Press supports the FSF in
67 developing GNU and promoting software freedom.''
68 @end ifinfo
69
70 @titlepage
71 @title Debugging with @value{GDBN}
72 @subtitle The @sc{gnu} Source-Level Debugger
73 @sp 1
74 @subtitle @value{EDITION} Edition, for @value{GDBN} version @value{GDBVN}
75 @author Richard Stallman, Roland Pesch, Stan Shebs, et al.
76 @page
77 @tex
78 {\parskip=0pt
79 \hfill (Send bugs and comments on @value{GDBN} to bug-gdb\@gnu.org.)\par
80 \hfill {\it Debugging with @value{GDBN}}\par
81 \hfill \TeX{}info \texinfoversion\par
82 }
83 @end tex
84
85 @vskip 0pt plus 1filll
86 Copyright @copyright{} 1988, 1989, 1990, 1991, 1992, 1993, 1994, 1995,
87 1996, 1998, 1999, 2000, 2001, 2002, 2003, 2004, 2006
88 Free Software Foundation, Inc.
89 @sp 2
90 Published by the Free Software Foundation @*
91 51 Franklin Street, Fifth Floor,
92 Boston, MA 02110-1301, USA@*
93 ISBN 1-882114-77-9 @*
94
95 Permission is granted to copy, distribute and/or modify this document
96 under the terms of the GNU Free Documentation License, Version 1.1 or
97 any later version published by the Free Software Foundation; with the
98 Invariant Sections being ``Free Software'' and ``Free Software Needs
99 Free Documentation'', with the Front-Cover Texts being ``A GNU Manual,''
100 and with the Back-Cover Texts as in (a) below.
101
102 (a) The FSF's Back-Cover Text is: ``You are free to copy and modify
103 this GNU Manual. Buying copies from GNU Press supports the FSF in
104 developing GNU and promoting software freedom.''
105 @page
106 This edition of the GDB manual is dedicated to the memory of Fred
107 Fish. Fred was a long-standing contributor to GDB and to Free
108 software in general. We will miss him.
109 @end titlepage
110 @page
111
112 @ifnottex
113 @node Top, Summary, (dir), (dir)
114
115 @top Debugging with @value{GDBN}
116
117 This file describes @value{GDBN}, the @sc{gnu} symbolic debugger.
118
119 This is the @value{EDITION} Edition, for @value{GDBN} Version
120 @value{GDBVN}.
121
122 Copyright (C) 1988-2006 Free Software Foundation, Inc.
123
124 This edition of the GDB manual is dedicated to the memory of Fred
125 Fish. Fred was a long-standing contributor to GDB and to Free
126 software in general. We will miss him.
127
128 @menu
129 * Summary:: Summary of @value{GDBN}
130 * Sample Session:: A sample @value{GDBN} session
131
132 * Invocation:: Getting in and out of @value{GDBN}
133 * Commands:: @value{GDBN} commands
134 * Running:: Running programs under @value{GDBN}
135 * Stopping:: Stopping and continuing
136 * Stack:: Examining the stack
137 * Source:: Examining source files
138 * Data:: Examining data
139 * Macros:: Preprocessor Macros
140 * Tracepoints:: Debugging remote targets non-intrusively
141 * Overlays:: Debugging programs that use overlays
142
143 * Languages:: Using @value{GDBN} with different languages
144
145 * Symbols:: Examining the symbol table
146 * Altering:: Altering execution
147 * GDB Files:: @value{GDBN} files
148 * Targets:: Specifying a debugging target
149 * Remote Debugging:: Debugging remote programs
150 * Configurations:: Configuration-specific information
151 * Controlling GDB:: Controlling @value{GDBN}
152 * Sequences:: Canned sequences of commands
153 * Interpreters:: Command Interpreters
154 * TUI:: @value{GDBN} Text User Interface
155 * Emacs:: Using @value{GDBN} under @sc{gnu} Emacs
156 * GDB/MI:: @value{GDBN}'s Machine Interface.
157 * Annotations:: @value{GDBN}'s annotation interface.
158
159 * GDB Bugs:: Reporting bugs in @value{GDBN}
160
161 * Command Line Editing:: Command Line Editing
162 * Using History Interactively:: Using History Interactively
163 * Formatting Documentation:: How to format and print @value{GDBN} documentation
164 * Installing GDB:: Installing GDB
165 * Maintenance Commands:: Maintenance Commands
166 * Remote Protocol:: GDB Remote Serial Protocol
167 * Agent Expressions:: The GDB Agent Expression Mechanism
168 * Target Descriptions:: How targets can describe themselves to
169 @value{GDBN}
170 * Copying:: GNU General Public License says
171 how you can copy and share GDB
172 * GNU Free Documentation License:: The license for this documentation
173 * Index:: Index
174 @end menu
175
176 @end ifnottex
177
178 @contents
179
180 @node Summary
181 @unnumbered Summary of @value{GDBN}
182
183 The purpose of a debugger such as @value{GDBN} is to allow you to see what is
184 going on ``inside'' another program while it executes---or what another
185 program was doing at the moment it crashed.
186
187 @value{GDBN} can do four main kinds of things (plus other things in support of
188 these) to help you catch bugs in the act:
189
190 @itemize @bullet
191 @item
192 Start your program, specifying anything that might affect its behavior.
193
194 @item
195 Make your program stop on specified conditions.
196
197 @item
198 Examine what has happened, when your program has stopped.
199
200 @item
201 Change things in your program, so you can experiment with correcting the
202 effects of one bug and go on to learn about another.
203 @end itemize
204
205 You can use @value{GDBN} to debug programs written in C and C@t{++}.
206 For more information, see @ref{Supported Languages,,Supported Languages}.
207 For more information, see @ref{C,,C and C++}.
208
209 @cindex Modula-2
210 Support for Modula-2 is partial. For information on Modula-2, see
211 @ref{Modula-2,,Modula-2}.
212
213 @cindex Pascal
214 Debugging Pascal programs which use sets, subranges, file variables, or
215 nested functions does not currently work. @value{GDBN} does not support
216 entering expressions, printing values, or similar features using Pascal
217 syntax.
218
219 @cindex Fortran
220 @value{GDBN} can be used to debug programs written in Fortran, although
221 it may be necessary to refer to some variables with a trailing
222 underscore.
223
224 @value{GDBN} can be used to debug programs written in Objective-C,
225 using either the Apple/NeXT or the GNU Objective-C runtime.
226
227 @menu
228 * Free Software:: Freely redistributable software
229 * Contributors:: Contributors to GDB
230 @end menu
231
232 @node Free Software
233 @unnumberedsec Free Software
234
235 @value{GDBN} is @dfn{free software}, protected by the @sc{gnu}
236 General Public License
237 (GPL). The GPL gives you the freedom to copy or adapt a licensed
238 program---but every person getting a copy also gets with it the
239 freedom to modify that copy (which means that they must get access to
240 the source code), and the freedom to distribute further copies.
241 Typical software companies use copyrights to limit your freedoms; the
242 Free Software Foundation uses the GPL to preserve these freedoms.
243
244 Fundamentally, the General Public License is a license which says that
245 you have these freedoms and that you cannot take these freedoms away
246 from anyone else.
247
248 @unnumberedsec Free Software Needs Free Documentation
249
250 The biggest deficiency in the free software community today is not in
251 the software---it is the lack of good free documentation that we can
252 include with the free software. Many of our most important
253 programs do not come with free reference manuals and free introductory
254 texts. Documentation is an essential part of any software package;
255 when an important free software package does not come with a free
256 manual and a free tutorial, that is a major gap. We have many such
257 gaps today.
258
259 Consider Perl, for instance. The tutorial manuals that people
260 normally use are non-free. How did this come about? Because the
261 authors of those manuals published them with restrictive terms---no
262 copying, no modification, source files not available---which exclude
263 them from the free software world.
264
265 That wasn't the first time this sort of thing happened, and it was far
266 from the last. Many times we have heard a GNU user eagerly describe a
267 manual that he is writing, his intended contribution to the community,
268 only to learn that he had ruined everything by signing a publication
269 contract to make it non-free.
270
271 Free documentation, like free software, is a matter of freedom, not
272 price. The problem with the non-free manual is not that publishers
273 charge a price for printed copies---that in itself is fine. (The Free
274 Software Foundation sells printed copies of manuals, too.) The
275 problem is the restrictions on the use of the manual. Free manuals
276 are available in source code form, and give you permission to copy and
277 modify. Non-free manuals do not allow this.
278
279 The criteria of freedom for a free manual are roughly the same as for
280 free software. Redistribution (including the normal kinds of
281 commercial redistribution) must be permitted, so that the manual can
282 accompany every copy of the program, both on-line and on paper.
283
284 Permission for modification of the technical content is crucial too.
285 When people modify the software, adding or changing features, if they
286 are conscientious they will change the manual too---so they can
287 provide accurate and clear documentation for the modified program. A
288 manual that leaves you no choice but to write a new manual to document
289 a changed version of the program is not really available to our
290 community.
291
292 Some kinds of limits on the way modification is handled are
293 acceptable. For example, requirements to preserve the original
294 author's copyright notice, the distribution terms, or the list of
295 authors, are ok. It is also no problem to require modified versions
296 to include notice that they were modified. Even entire sections that
297 may not be deleted or changed are acceptable, as long as they deal
298 with nontechnical topics (like this one). These kinds of restrictions
299 are acceptable because they don't obstruct the community's normal use
300 of the manual.
301
302 However, it must be possible to modify all the @emph{technical}
303 content of the manual, and then distribute the result in all the usual
304 media, through all the usual channels. Otherwise, the restrictions
305 obstruct the use of the manual, it is not free, and we need another
306 manual to replace it.
307
308 Please spread the word about this issue. Our community continues to
309 lose manuals to proprietary publishing. If we spread the word that
310 free software needs free reference manuals and free tutorials, perhaps
311 the next person who wants to contribute by writing documentation will
312 realize, before it is too late, that only free manuals contribute to
313 the free software community.
314
315 If you are writing documentation, please insist on publishing it under
316 the GNU Free Documentation License or another free documentation
317 license. Remember that this decision requires your approval---you
318 don't have to let the publisher decide. Some commercial publishers
319 will use a free license if you insist, but they will not propose the
320 option; it is up to you to raise the issue and say firmly that this is
321 what you want. If the publisher you are dealing with refuses, please
322 try other publishers. If you're not sure whether a proposed license
323 is free, write to @email{licensing@@gnu.org}.
324
325 You can encourage commercial publishers to sell more free, copylefted
326 manuals and tutorials by buying them, and particularly by buying
327 copies from the publishers that paid for their writing or for major
328 improvements. Meanwhile, try to avoid buying non-free documentation
329 at all. Check the distribution terms of a manual before you buy it,
330 and insist that whoever seeks your business must respect your freedom.
331 Check the history of the book, and try to reward the publishers that
332 have paid or pay the authors to work on it.
333
334 The Free Software Foundation maintains a list of free documentation
335 published by other publishers, at
336 @url{http://www.fsf.org/doc/other-free-books.html}.
337
338 @node Contributors
339 @unnumberedsec Contributors to @value{GDBN}
340
341 Richard Stallman was the original author of @value{GDBN}, and of many
342 other @sc{gnu} programs. Many others have contributed to its
343 development. This section attempts to credit major contributors. One
344 of the virtues of free software is that everyone is free to contribute
345 to it; with regret, we cannot actually acknowledge everyone here. The
346 file @file{ChangeLog} in the @value{GDBN} distribution approximates a
347 blow-by-blow account.
348
349 Changes much prior to version 2.0 are lost in the mists of time.
350
351 @quotation
352 @emph{Plea:} Additions to this section are particularly welcome. If you
353 or your friends (or enemies, to be evenhanded) have been unfairly
354 omitted from this list, we would like to add your names!
355 @end quotation
356
357 So that they may not regard their many labors as thankless, we
358 particularly thank those who shepherded @value{GDBN} through major
359 releases:
360 Andrew Cagney (releases 6.3, 6.2, 6.1, 6.0, 5.3, 5.2, 5.1 and 5.0);
361 Jim Blandy (release 4.18);
362 Jason Molenda (release 4.17);
363 Stan Shebs (release 4.14);
364 Fred Fish (releases 4.16, 4.15, 4.13, 4.12, 4.11, 4.10, and 4.9);
365 Stu Grossman and John Gilmore (releases 4.8, 4.7, 4.6, 4.5, and 4.4);
366 John Gilmore (releases 4.3, 4.2, 4.1, 4.0, and 3.9);
367 Jim Kingdon (releases 3.5, 3.4, and 3.3);
368 and Randy Smith (releases 3.2, 3.1, and 3.0).
369
370 Richard Stallman, assisted at various times by Peter TerMaat, Chris
371 Hanson, and Richard Mlynarik, handled releases through 2.8.
372
373 Michael Tiemann is the author of most of the @sc{gnu} C@t{++} support
374 in @value{GDBN}, with significant additional contributions from Per
375 Bothner and Daniel Berlin. James Clark wrote the @sc{gnu} C@t{++}
376 demangler. Early work on C@t{++} was by Peter TerMaat (who also did
377 much general update work leading to release 3.0).
378
379 @value{GDBN} uses the BFD subroutine library to examine multiple
380 object-file formats; BFD was a joint project of David V.
381 Henkel-Wallace, Rich Pixley, Steve Chamberlain, and John Gilmore.
382
383 David Johnson wrote the original COFF support; Pace Willison did
384 the original support for encapsulated COFF.
385
386 Brent Benson of Harris Computer Systems contributed DWARF 2 support.
387
388 Adam de Boor and Bradley Davis contributed the ISI Optimum V support.
389 Per Bothner, Noboyuki Hikichi, and Alessandro Forin contributed MIPS
390 support.
391 Jean-Daniel Fekete contributed Sun 386i support.
392 Chris Hanson improved the HP9000 support.
393 Noboyuki Hikichi and Tomoyuki Hasei contributed Sony/News OS 3 support.
394 David Johnson contributed Encore Umax support.
395 Jyrki Kuoppala contributed Altos 3068 support.
396 Jeff Law contributed HP PA and SOM support.
397 Keith Packard contributed NS32K support.
398 Doug Rabson contributed Acorn Risc Machine support.
399 Bob Rusk contributed Harris Nighthawk CX-UX support.
400 Chris Smith contributed Convex support (and Fortran debugging).
401 Jonathan Stone contributed Pyramid support.
402 Michael Tiemann contributed SPARC support.
403 Tim Tucker contributed support for the Gould NP1 and Gould Powernode.
404 Pace Willison contributed Intel 386 support.
405 Jay Vosburgh contributed Symmetry support.
406 Marko Mlinar contributed OpenRISC 1000 support.
407
408 Andreas Schwab contributed M68K @sc{gnu}/Linux support.
409
410 Rich Schaefer and Peter Schauer helped with support of SunOS shared
411 libraries.
412
413 Jay Fenlason and Roland McGrath ensured that @value{GDBN} and GAS agree
414 about several machine instruction sets.
415
416 Patrick Duval, Ted Goldstein, Vikram Koka and Glenn Engel helped develop
417 remote debugging. Intel Corporation, Wind River Systems, AMD, and ARM
418 contributed remote debugging modules for the i960, VxWorks, A29K UDI,
419 and RDI targets, respectively.
420
421 Brian Fox is the author of the readline libraries providing
422 command-line editing and command history.
423
424 Andrew Beers of SUNY Buffalo wrote the language-switching code, the
425 Modula-2 support, and contributed the Languages chapter of this manual.
426
427 Fred Fish wrote most of the support for Unix System Vr4.
428 He also enhanced the command-completion support to cover C@t{++} overloaded
429 symbols.
430
431 Hitachi America (now Renesas America), Ltd. sponsored the support for
432 H8/300, H8/500, and Super-H processors.
433
434 NEC sponsored the support for the v850, Vr4xxx, and Vr5xxx processors.
435
436 Mitsubishi (now Renesas) sponsored the support for D10V, D30V, and M32R/D
437 processors.
438
439 Toshiba sponsored the support for the TX39 Mips processor.
440
441 Matsushita sponsored the support for the MN10200 and MN10300 processors.
442
443 Fujitsu sponsored the support for SPARClite and FR30 processors.
444
445 Kung Hsu, Jeff Law, and Rick Sladkey added support for hardware
446 watchpoints.
447
448 Michael Snyder added support for tracepoints.
449
450 Stu Grossman wrote gdbserver.
451
452 Jim Kingdon, Peter Schauer, Ian Taylor, and Stu Grossman made
453 nearly innumerable bug fixes and cleanups throughout @value{GDBN}.
454
455 The following people at the Hewlett-Packard Company contributed
456 support for the PA-RISC 2.0 architecture, HP-UX 10.20, 10.30, and 11.0
457 (narrow mode), HP's implementation of kernel threads, HP's aC@t{++}
458 compiler, and the Text User Interface (nee Terminal User Interface):
459 Ben Krepp, Richard Title, John Bishop, Susan Macchia, Kathy Mann,
460 Satish Pai, India Paul, Steve Rehrauer, and Elena Zannoni. Kim Haase
461 provided HP-specific information in this manual.
462
463 DJ Delorie ported @value{GDBN} to MS-DOS, for the DJGPP project.
464 Robert Hoehne made significant contributions to the DJGPP port.
465
466 Cygnus Solutions has sponsored @value{GDBN} maintenance and much of its
467 development since 1991. Cygnus engineers who have worked on @value{GDBN}
468 fulltime include Mark Alexander, Jim Blandy, Per Bothner, Kevin
469 Buettner, Edith Epstein, Chris Faylor, Fred Fish, Martin Hunt, Jim
470 Ingham, John Gilmore, Stu Grossman, Kung Hsu, Jim Kingdon, John Metzler,
471 Fernando Nasser, Geoffrey Noer, Dawn Perchik, Rich Pixley, Zdenek
472 Radouch, Keith Seitz, Stan Shebs, David Taylor, and Elena Zannoni. In
473 addition, Dave Brolley, Ian Carmichael, Steve Chamberlain, Nick Clifton,
474 JT Conklin, Stan Cox, DJ Delorie, Ulrich Drepper, Frank Eigler, Doug
475 Evans, Sean Fagan, David Henkel-Wallace, Richard Henderson, Jeff
476 Holcomb, Jeff Law, Jim Lemke, Tom Lord, Bob Manson, Michael Meissner,
477 Jason Merrill, Catherine Moore, Drew Moseley, Ken Raeburn, Gavin
478 Romig-Koch, Rob Savoye, Jamie Smith, Mike Stump, Ian Taylor, Angela
479 Thomas, Michael Tiemann, Tom Tromey, Ron Unrau, Jim Wilson, and David
480 Zuhn have made contributions both large and small.
481
482 Andrew Cagney, Fernando Nasser, and Elena Zannoni, while working for
483 Cygnus Solutions, implemented the original @sc{gdb/mi} interface.
484
485 Jim Blandy added support for preprocessor macros, while working for Red
486 Hat.
487
488 Andrew Cagney designed @value{GDBN}'s architecture vector. Many
489 people including Andrew Cagney, Stephane Carrez, Randolph Chung, Nick
490 Duffek, Richard Henderson, Mark Kettenis, Grace Sainsbury, Kei
491 Sakamoto, Yoshinori Sato, Michael Snyder, Andreas Schwab, Jason
492 Thorpe, Corinna Vinschen, Ulrich Weigand, and Elena Zannoni, helped
493 with the migration of old architectures to this new framework.
494
495 Andrew Cagney completely re-designed and re-implemented @value{GDBN}'s
496 unwinder framework, this consisting of a fresh new design featuring
497 frame IDs, independent frame sniffers, and the sentinel frame. Mark
498 Kettenis implemented the @sc{dwarf 2} unwinder, Jeff Johnston the
499 libunwind unwinder, and Andrew Cagney the dummy, sentinel, tramp, and
500 trad unwinders. The architecture-specific changes, each involving a
501 complete rewrite of the architecture's frame code, were carried out by
502 Jim Blandy, Joel Brobecker, Kevin Buettner, Andrew Cagney, Stephane
503 Carrez, Randolph Chung, Orjan Friberg, Richard Henderson, Daniel
504 Jacobowitz, Jeff Johnston, Mark Kettenis, Theodore A. Roth, Kei
505 Sakamoto, Yoshinori Sato, Michael Snyder, Corinna Vinschen, and Ulrich
506 Weigand.
507
508 Christian Zankel, Ross Morley, Bob Wilson, and Maxim Grigoriev from
509 Tensilica, Inc.@: contributed support for Xtensa processors. Others
510 who have worked on the Xtensa port of @value{GDBN} in the past include
511 Steve Tjiang, John Newlin, and Scott Foehner.
512
513 @node Sample Session
514 @chapter A Sample @value{GDBN} Session
515
516 You can use this manual at your leisure to read all about @value{GDBN}.
517 However, a handful of commands are enough to get started using the
518 debugger. This chapter illustrates those commands.
519
520 @iftex
521 In this sample session, we emphasize user input like this: @b{input},
522 to make it easier to pick out from the surrounding output.
523 @end iftex
524
525 @c FIXME: this example may not be appropriate for some configs, where
526 @c FIXME...primary interest is in remote use.
527
528 One of the preliminary versions of @sc{gnu} @code{m4} (a generic macro
529 processor) exhibits the following bug: sometimes, when we change its
530 quote strings from the default, the commands used to capture one macro
531 definition within another stop working. In the following short @code{m4}
532 session, we define a macro @code{foo} which expands to @code{0000}; we
533 then use the @code{m4} built-in @code{defn} to define @code{bar} as the
534 same thing. However, when we change the open quote string to
535 @code{<QUOTE>} and the close quote string to @code{<UNQUOTE>}, the same
536 procedure fails to define a new synonym @code{baz}:
537
538 @smallexample
539 $ @b{cd gnu/m4}
540 $ @b{./m4}
541 @b{define(foo,0000)}
542
543 @b{foo}
544 0000
545 @b{define(bar,defn(`foo'))}
546
547 @b{bar}
548 0000
549 @b{changequote(<QUOTE>,<UNQUOTE>)}
550
551 @b{define(baz,defn(<QUOTE>foo<UNQUOTE>))}
552 @b{baz}
553 @b{Ctrl-d}
554 m4: End of input: 0: fatal error: EOF in string
555 @end smallexample
556
557 @noindent
558 Let us use @value{GDBN} to try to see what is going on.
559
560 @smallexample
561 $ @b{@value{GDBP} m4}
562 @c FIXME: this falsifies the exact text played out, to permit smallbook
563 @c FIXME... format to come out better.
564 @value{GDBN} is free software and you are welcome to distribute copies
565 of it under certain conditions; type "show copying" to see
566 the conditions.
567 There is absolutely no warranty for @value{GDBN}; type "show warranty"
568 for details.
569
570 @value{GDBN} @value{GDBVN}, Copyright 1999 Free Software Foundation, Inc...
571 (@value{GDBP})
572 @end smallexample
573
574 @noindent
575 @value{GDBN} reads only enough symbol data to know where to find the
576 rest when needed; as a result, the first prompt comes up very quickly.
577 We now tell @value{GDBN} to use a narrower display width than usual, so
578 that examples fit in this manual.
579
580 @smallexample
581 (@value{GDBP}) @b{set width 70}
582 @end smallexample
583
584 @noindent
585 We need to see how the @code{m4} built-in @code{changequote} works.
586 Having looked at the source, we know the relevant subroutine is
587 @code{m4_changequote}, so we set a breakpoint there with the @value{GDBN}
588 @code{break} command.
589
590 @smallexample
591 (@value{GDBP}) @b{break m4_changequote}
592 Breakpoint 1 at 0x62f4: file builtin.c, line 879.
593 @end smallexample
594
595 @noindent
596 Using the @code{run} command, we start @code{m4} running under @value{GDBN}
597 control; as long as control does not reach the @code{m4_changequote}
598 subroutine, the program runs as usual:
599
600 @smallexample
601 (@value{GDBP}) @b{run}
602 Starting program: /work/Editorial/gdb/gnu/m4/m4
603 @b{define(foo,0000)}
604
605 @b{foo}
606 0000
607 @end smallexample
608
609 @noindent
610 To trigger the breakpoint, we call @code{changequote}. @value{GDBN}
611 suspends execution of @code{m4}, displaying information about the
612 context where it stops.
613
614 @smallexample
615 @b{changequote(<QUOTE>,<UNQUOTE>)}
616
617 Breakpoint 1, m4_changequote (argc=3, argv=0x33c70)
618 at builtin.c:879
619 879 if (bad_argc(TOKEN_DATA_TEXT(argv[0]),argc,1,3))
620 @end smallexample
621
622 @noindent
623 Now we use the command @code{n} (@code{next}) to advance execution to
624 the next line of the current function.
625
626 @smallexample
627 (@value{GDBP}) @b{n}
628 882 set_quotes((argc >= 2) ? TOKEN_DATA_TEXT(argv[1])\
629 : nil,
630 @end smallexample
631
632 @noindent
633 @code{set_quotes} looks like a promising subroutine. We can go into it
634 by using the command @code{s} (@code{step}) instead of @code{next}.
635 @code{step} goes to the next line to be executed in @emph{any}
636 subroutine, so it steps into @code{set_quotes}.
637
638 @smallexample
639 (@value{GDBP}) @b{s}
640 set_quotes (lq=0x34c78 "<QUOTE>", rq=0x34c88 "<UNQUOTE>")
641 at input.c:530
642 530 if (lquote != def_lquote)
643 @end smallexample
644
645 @noindent
646 The display that shows the subroutine where @code{m4} is now
647 suspended (and its arguments) is called a stack frame display. It
648 shows a summary of the stack. We can use the @code{backtrace}
649 command (which can also be spelled @code{bt}), to see where we are
650 in the stack as a whole: the @code{backtrace} command displays a
651 stack frame for each active subroutine.
652
653 @smallexample
654 (@value{GDBP}) @b{bt}
655 #0 set_quotes (lq=0x34c78 "<QUOTE>", rq=0x34c88 "<UNQUOTE>")
656 at input.c:530
657 #1 0x6344 in m4_changequote (argc=3, argv=0x33c70)
658 at builtin.c:882
659 #2 0x8174 in expand_macro (sym=0x33320) at macro.c:242
660 #3 0x7a88 in expand_token (obs=0x0, t=209696, td=0xf7fffa30)
661 at macro.c:71
662 #4 0x79dc in expand_input () at macro.c:40
663 #5 0x2930 in main (argc=0, argv=0xf7fffb20) at m4.c:195
664 @end smallexample
665
666 @noindent
667 We step through a few more lines to see what happens. The first two
668 times, we can use @samp{s}; the next two times we use @code{n} to avoid
669 falling into the @code{xstrdup} subroutine.
670
671 @smallexample
672 (@value{GDBP}) @b{s}
673 0x3b5c 532 if (rquote != def_rquote)
674 (@value{GDBP}) @b{s}
675 0x3b80 535 lquote = (lq == nil || *lq == '\0') ? \
676 def_lquote : xstrdup(lq);
677 (@value{GDBP}) @b{n}
678 536 rquote = (rq == nil || *rq == '\0') ? def_rquote\
679 : xstrdup(rq);
680 (@value{GDBP}) @b{n}
681 538 len_lquote = strlen(rquote);
682 @end smallexample
683
684 @noindent
685 The last line displayed looks a little odd; we can examine the variables
686 @code{lquote} and @code{rquote} to see if they are in fact the new left
687 and right quotes we specified. We use the command @code{p}
688 (@code{print}) to see their values.
689
690 @smallexample
691 (@value{GDBP}) @b{p lquote}
692 $1 = 0x35d40 "<QUOTE>"
693 (@value{GDBP}) @b{p rquote}
694 $2 = 0x35d50 "<UNQUOTE>"
695 @end smallexample
696
697 @noindent
698 @code{lquote} and @code{rquote} are indeed the new left and right quotes.
699 To look at some context, we can display ten lines of source
700 surrounding the current line with the @code{l} (@code{list}) command.
701
702 @smallexample
703 (@value{GDBP}) @b{l}
704 533 xfree(rquote);
705 534
706 535 lquote = (lq == nil || *lq == '\0') ? def_lquote\
707 : xstrdup (lq);
708 536 rquote = (rq == nil || *rq == '\0') ? def_rquote\
709 : xstrdup (rq);
710 537
711 538 len_lquote = strlen(rquote);
712 539 len_rquote = strlen(lquote);
713 540 @}
714 541
715 542 void
716 @end smallexample
717
718 @noindent
719 Let us step past the two lines that set @code{len_lquote} and
720 @code{len_rquote}, and then examine the values of those variables.
721
722 @smallexample
723 (@value{GDBP}) @b{n}
724 539 len_rquote = strlen(lquote);
725 (@value{GDBP}) @b{n}
726 540 @}
727 (@value{GDBP}) @b{p len_lquote}
728 $3 = 9
729 (@value{GDBP}) @b{p len_rquote}
730 $4 = 7
731 @end smallexample
732
733 @noindent
734 That certainly looks wrong, assuming @code{len_lquote} and
735 @code{len_rquote} are meant to be the lengths of @code{lquote} and
736 @code{rquote} respectively. We can set them to better values using
737 the @code{p} command, since it can print the value of
738 any expression---and that expression can include subroutine calls and
739 assignments.
740
741 @smallexample
742 (@value{GDBP}) @b{p len_lquote=strlen(lquote)}
743 $5 = 7
744 (@value{GDBP}) @b{p len_rquote=strlen(rquote)}
745 $6 = 9
746 @end smallexample
747
748 @noindent
749 Is that enough to fix the problem of using the new quotes with the
750 @code{m4} built-in @code{defn}? We can allow @code{m4} to continue
751 executing with the @code{c} (@code{continue}) command, and then try the
752 example that caused trouble initially:
753
754 @smallexample
755 (@value{GDBP}) @b{c}
756 Continuing.
757
758 @b{define(baz,defn(<QUOTE>foo<UNQUOTE>))}
759
760 baz
761 0000
762 @end smallexample
763
764 @noindent
765 Success! The new quotes now work just as well as the default ones. The
766 problem seems to have been just the two typos defining the wrong
767 lengths. We allow @code{m4} exit by giving it an EOF as input:
768
769 @smallexample
770 @b{Ctrl-d}
771 Program exited normally.
772 @end smallexample
773
774 @noindent
775 The message @samp{Program exited normally.} is from @value{GDBN}; it
776 indicates @code{m4} has finished executing. We can end our @value{GDBN}
777 session with the @value{GDBN} @code{quit} command.
778
779 @smallexample
780 (@value{GDBP}) @b{quit}
781 @end smallexample
782
783 @node Invocation
784 @chapter Getting In and Out of @value{GDBN}
785
786 This chapter discusses how to start @value{GDBN}, and how to get out of it.
787 The essentials are:
788 @itemize @bullet
789 @item
790 type @samp{@value{GDBP}} to start @value{GDBN}.
791 @item
792 type @kbd{quit} or @kbd{Ctrl-d} to exit.
793 @end itemize
794
795 @menu
796 * Invoking GDB:: How to start @value{GDBN}
797 * Quitting GDB:: How to quit @value{GDBN}
798 * Shell Commands:: How to use shell commands inside @value{GDBN}
799 * Logging Output:: How to log @value{GDBN}'s output to a file
800 @end menu
801
802 @node Invoking GDB
803 @section Invoking @value{GDBN}
804
805 Invoke @value{GDBN} by running the program @code{@value{GDBP}}. Once started,
806 @value{GDBN} reads commands from the terminal until you tell it to exit.
807
808 You can also run @code{@value{GDBP}} with a variety of arguments and options,
809 to specify more of your debugging environment at the outset.
810
811 The command-line options described here are designed
812 to cover a variety of situations; in some environments, some of these
813 options may effectively be unavailable.
814
815 The most usual way to start @value{GDBN} is with one argument,
816 specifying an executable program:
817
818 @smallexample
819 @value{GDBP} @var{program}
820 @end smallexample
821
822 @noindent
823 You can also start with both an executable program and a core file
824 specified:
825
826 @smallexample
827 @value{GDBP} @var{program} @var{core}
828 @end smallexample
829
830 You can, instead, specify a process ID as a second argument, if you want
831 to debug a running process:
832
833 @smallexample
834 @value{GDBP} @var{program} 1234
835 @end smallexample
836
837 @noindent
838 would attach @value{GDBN} to process @code{1234} (unless you also have a file
839 named @file{1234}; @value{GDBN} does check for a core file first).
840
841 Taking advantage of the second command-line argument requires a fairly
842 complete operating system; when you use @value{GDBN} as a remote
843 debugger attached to a bare board, there may not be any notion of
844 ``process'', and there is often no way to get a core dump. @value{GDBN}
845 will warn you if it is unable to attach or to read core dumps.
846
847 You can optionally have @code{@value{GDBP}} pass any arguments after the
848 executable file to the inferior using @code{--args}. This option stops
849 option processing.
850 @smallexample
851 @value{GDBP} --args gcc -O2 -c foo.c
852 @end smallexample
853 This will cause @code{@value{GDBP}} to debug @code{gcc}, and to set
854 @code{gcc}'s command-line arguments (@pxref{Arguments}) to @samp{-O2 -c foo.c}.
855
856 You can run @code{@value{GDBP}} without printing the front material, which describes
857 @value{GDBN}'s non-warranty, by specifying @code{-silent}:
858
859 @smallexample
860 @value{GDBP} -silent
861 @end smallexample
862
863 @noindent
864 You can further control how @value{GDBN} starts up by using command-line
865 options. @value{GDBN} itself can remind you of the options available.
866
867 @noindent
868 Type
869
870 @smallexample
871 @value{GDBP} -help
872 @end smallexample
873
874 @noindent
875 to display all available options and briefly describe their use
876 (@samp{@value{GDBP} -h} is a shorter equivalent).
877
878 All options and command line arguments you give are processed
879 in sequential order. The order makes a difference when the
880 @samp{-x} option is used.
881
882
883 @menu
884 * File Options:: Choosing files
885 * Mode Options:: Choosing modes
886 * Startup:: What @value{GDBN} does during startup
887 @end menu
888
889 @node File Options
890 @subsection Choosing Files
891
892 When @value{GDBN} starts, it reads any arguments other than options as
893 specifying an executable file and core file (or process ID). This is
894 the same as if the arguments were specified by the @samp{-se} and
895 @samp{-c} (or @samp{-p}) options respectively. (@value{GDBN} reads the
896 first argument that does not have an associated option flag as
897 equivalent to the @samp{-se} option followed by that argument; and the
898 second argument that does not have an associated option flag, if any, as
899 equivalent to the @samp{-c}/@samp{-p} option followed by that argument.)
900 If the second argument begins with a decimal digit, @value{GDBN} will
901 first attempt to attach to it as a process, and if that fails, attempt
902 to open it as a corefile. If you have a corefile whose name begins with
903 a digit, you can prevent @value{GDBN} from treating it as a pid by
904 prefixing it with @file{./}, e.g.@: @file{./12345}.
905
906 If @value{GDBN} has not been configured to included core file support,
907 such as for most embedded targets, then it will complain about a second
908 argument and ignore it.
909
910 Many options have both long and short forms; both are shown in the
911 following list. @value{GDBN} also recognizes the long forms if you truncate
912 them, so long as enough of the option is present to be unambiguous.
913 (If you prefer, you can flag option arguments with @samp{--} rather
914 than @samp{-}, though we illustrate the more usual convention.)
915
916 @c NOTE: the @cindex entries here use double dashes ON PURPOSE. This
917 @c way, both those who look for -foo and --foo in the index, will find
918 @c it.
919
920 @table @code
921 @item -symbols @var{file}
922 @itemx -s @var{file}
923 @cindex @code{--symbols}
924 @cindex @code{-s}
925 Read symbol table from file @var{file}.
926
927 @item -exec @var{file}
928 @itemx -e @var{file}
929 @cindex @code{--exec}
930 @cindex @code{-e}
931 Use file @var{file} as the executable file to execute when appropriate,
932 and for examining pure data in conjunction with a core dump.
933
934 @item -se @var{file}
935 @cindex @code{--se}
936 Read symbol table from file @var{file} and use it as the executable
937 file.
938
939 @item -core @var{file}
940 @itemx -c @var{file}
941 @cindex @code{--core}
942 @cindex @code{-c}
943 Use file @var{file} as a core dump to examine.
944
945 @item -pid @var{number}
946 @itemx -p @var{number}
947 @cindex @code{--pid}
948 @cindex @code{-p}
949 Connect to process ID @var{number}, as with the @code{attach} command.
950
951 @item -command @var{file}
952 @itemx -x @var{file}
953 @cindex @code{--command}
954 @cindex @code{-x}
955 Execute @value{GDBN} commands from file @var{file}. @xref{Command
956 Files,, Command files}.
957
958 @item -eval-command @var{command}
959 @itemx -ex @var{command}
960 @cindex @code{--eval-command}
961 @cindex @code{-ex}
962 Execute a single @value{GDBN} command.
963
964 This option may be used multiple times to call multiple commands. It may
965 also be interleaved with @samp{-command} as required.
966
967 @smallexample
968 @value{GDBP} -ex 'target sim' -ex 'load' \
969 -x setbreakpoints -ex 'run' a.out
970 @end smallexample
971
972 @item -directory @var{directory}
973 @itemx -d @var{directory}
974 @cindex @code{--directory}
975 @cindex @code{-d}
976 Add @var{directory} to the path to search for source and script files.
977
978 @item -r
979 @itemx -readnow
980 @cindex @code{--readnow}
981 @cindex @code{-r}
982 Read each symbol file's entire symbol table immediately, rather than
983 the default, which is to read it incrementally as it is needed.
984 This makes startup slower, but makes future operations faster.
985
986 @end table
987
988 @node Mode Options
989 @subsection Choosing Modes
990
991 You can run @value{GDBN} in various alternative modes---for example, in
992 batch mode or quiet mode.
993
994 @table @code
995 @item -nx
996 @itemx -n
997 @cindex @code{--nx}
998 @cindex @code{-n}
999 Do not execute commands found in any initialization files. Normally,
1000 @value{GDBN} executes the commands in these files after all the command
1001 options and arguments have been processed. @xref{Command Files,,Command
1002 Files}.
1003
1004 @item -quiet
1005 @itemx -silent
1006 @itemx -q
1007 @cindex @code{--quiet}
1008 @cindex @code{--silent}
1009 @cindex @code{-q}
1010 ``Quiet''. Do not print the introductory and copyright messages. These
1011 messages are also suppressed in batch mode.
1012
1013 @item -batch
1014 @cindex @code{--batch}
1015 Run in batch mode. Exit with status @code{0} after processing all the
1016 command files specified with @samp{-x} (and all commands from
1017 initialization files, if not inhibited with @samp{-n}). Exit with
1018 nonzero status if an error occurs in executing the @value{GDBN} commands
1019 in the command files.
1020
1021 Batch mode may be useful for running @value{GDBN} as a filter, for
1022 example to download and run a program on another computer; in order to
1023 make this more useful, the message
1024
1025 @smallexample
1026 Program exited normally.
1027 @end smallexample
1028
1029 @noindent
1030 (which is ordinarily issued whenever a program running under
1031 @value{GDBN} control terminates) is not issued when running in batch
1032 mode.
1033
1034 @item -batch-silent
1035 @cindex @code{--batch-silent}
1036 Run in batch mode exactly like @samp{-batch}, but totally silently. All
1037 @value{GDBN} output to @code{stdout} is prevented (@code{stderr} is
1038 unaffected). This is much quieter than @samp{-silent} and would be useless
1039 for an interactive session.
1040
1041 This is particularly useful when using targets that give @samp{Loading section}
1042 messages, for example.
1043
1044 Note that targets that give their output via @value{GDBN}, as opposed to
1045 writing directly to @code{stdout}, will also be made silent.
1046
1047 @item -return-child-result
1048 @cindex @code{--return-child-result}
1049 The return code from @value{GDBN} will be the return code from the child
1050 process (the process being debugged), with the following exceptions:
1051
1052 @itemize @bullet
1053 @item
1054 @value{GDBN} exits abnormally. E.g., due to an incorrect argument or an
1055 internal error. In this case the exit code is the same as it would have been
1056 without @samp{-return-child-result}.
1057 @item
1058 The user quits with an explicit value. E.g., @samp{quit 1}.
1059 @item
1060 The child process never runs, or is not allowed to terminate, in which case
1061 the exit code will be -1.
1062 @end itemize
1063
1064 This option is useful in conjunction with @samp{-batch} or @samp{-batch-silent},
1065 when @value{GDBN} is being used as a remote program loader or simulator
1066 interface.
1067
1068 @item -nowindows
1069 @itemx -nw
1070 @cindex @code{--nowindows}
1071 @cindex @code{-nw}
1072 ``No windows''. If @value{GDBN} comes with a graphical user interface
1073 (GUI) built in, then this option tells @value{GDBN} to only use the command-line
1074 interface. If no GUI is available, this option has no effect.
1075
1076 @item -windows
1077 @itemx -w
1078 @cindex @code{--windows}
1079 @cindex @code{-w}
1080 If @value{GDBN} includes a GUI, then this option requires it to be
1081 used if possible.
1082
1083 @item -cd @var{directory}
1084 @cindex @code{--cd}
1085 Run @value{GDBN} using @var{directory} as its working directory,
1086 instead of the current directory.
1087
1088 @item -fullname
1089 @itemx -f
1090 @cindex @code{--fullname}
1091 @cindex @code{-f}
1092 @sc{gnu} Emacs sets this option when it runs @value{GDBN} as a
1093 subprocess. It tells @value{GDBN} to output the full file name and line
1094 number in a standard, recognizable fashion each time a stack frame is
1095 displayed (which includes each time your program stops). This
1096 recognizable format looks like two @samp{\032} characters, followed by
1097 the file name, line number and character position separated by colons,
1098 and a newline. The Emacs-to-@value{GDBN} interface program uses the two
1099 @samp{\032} characters as a signal to display the source code for the
1100 frame.
1101
1102 @item -epoch
1103 @cindex @code{--epoch}
1104 The Epoch Emacs-@value{GDBN} interface sets this option when it runs
1105 @value{GDBN} as a subprocess. It tells @value{GDBN} to modify its print
1106 routines so as to allow Epoch to display values of expressions in a
1107 separate window.
1108
1109 @item -annotate @var{level}
1110 @cindex @code{--annotate}
1111 This option sets the @dfn{annotation level} inside @value{GDBN}. Its
1112 effect is identical to using @samp{set annotate @var{level}}
1113 (@pxref{Annotations}). The annotation @var{level} controls how much
1114 information @value{GDBN} prints together with its prompt, values of
1115 expressions, source lines, and other types of output. Level 0 is the
1116 normal, level 1 is for use when @value{GDBN} is run as a subprocess of
1117 @sc{gnu} Emacs, level 3 is the maximum annotation suitable for programs
1118 that control @value{GDBN}, and level 2 has been deprecated.
1119
1120 The annotation mechanism has largely been superseded by @sc{gdb/mi}
1121 (@pxref{GDB/MI}).
1122
1123 @item --args
1124 @cindex @code{--args}
1125 Change interpretation of command line so that arguments following the
1126 executable file are passed as command line arguments to the inferior.
1127 This option stops option processing.
1128
1129 @item -baud @var{bps}
1130 @itemx -b @var{bps}
1131 @cindex @code{--baud}
1132 @cindex @code{-b}
1133 Set the line speed (baud rate or bits per second) of any serial
1134 interface used by @value{GDBN} for remote debugging.
1135
1136 @item -l @var{timeout}
1137 @cindex @code{-l}
1138 Set the timeout (in seconds) of any communication used by @value{GDBN}
1139 for remote debugging.
1140
1141 @item -tty @var{device}
1142 @itemx -t @var{device}
1143 @cindex @code{--tty}
1144 @cindex @code{-t}
1145 Run using @var{device} for your program's standard input and output.
1146 @c FIXME: kingdon thinks there is more to -tty. Investigate.
1147
1148 @c resolve the situation of these eventually
1149 @item -tui
1150 @cindex @code{--tui}
1151 Activate the @dfn{Text User Interface} when starting. The Text User
1152 Interface manages several text windows on the terminal, showing
1153 source, assembly, registers and @value{GDBN} command outputs
1154 (@pxref{TUI, ,@value{GDBN} Text User Interface}). Alternatively, the
1155 Text User Interface can be enabled by invoking the program
1156 @samp{@value{GDBTUI}}. Do not use this option if you run @value{GDBN} from
1157 Emacs (@pxref{Emacs, ,Using @value{GDBN} under @sc{gnu} Emacs}).
1158
1159 @c @item -xdb
1160 @c @cindex @code{--xdb}
1161 @c Run in XDB compatibility mode, allowing the use of certain XDB commands.
1162 @c For information, see the file @file{xdb_trans.html}, which is usually
1163 @c installed in the directory @code{/opt/langtools/wdb/doc} on HP-UX
1164 @c systems.
1165
1166 @item -interpreter @var{interp}
1167 @cindex @code{--interpreter}
1168 Use the interpreter @var{interp} for interface with the controlling
1169 program or device. This option is meant to be set by programs which
1170 communicate with @value{GDBN} using it as a back end.
1171 @xref{Interpreters, , Command Interpreters}.
1172
1173 @samp{--interpreter=mi} (or @samp{--interpreter=mi2}) causes
1174 @value{GDBN} to use the @dfn{@sc{gdb/mi} interface} (@pxref{GDB/MI, ,
1175 The @sc{gdb/mi} Interface}) included since @value{GDBN} version 6.0. The
1176 previous @sc{gdb/mi} interface, included in @value{GDBN} version 5.3 and
1177 selected with @samp{--interpreter=mi1}, is deprecated. Earlier
1178 @sc{gdb/mi} interfaces are no longer supported.
1179
1180 @item -write
1181 @cindex @code{--write}
1182 Open the executable and core files for both reading and writing. This
1183 is equivalent to the @samp{set write on} command inside @value{GDBN}
1184 (@pxref{Patching}).
1185
1186 @item -statistics
1187 @cindex @code{--statistics}
1188 This option causes @value{GDBN} to print statistics about time and
1189 memory usage after it completes each command and returns to the prompt.
1190
1191 @item -version
1192 @cindex @code{--version}
1193 This option causes @value{GDBN} to print its version number and
1194 no-warranty blurb, and exit.
1195
1196 @end table
1197
1198 @node Startup
1199 @subsection What @value{GDBN} Does During Startup
1200 @cindex @value{GDBN} startup
1201
1202 Here's the description of what @value{GDBN} does during session startup:
1203
1204 @enumerate
1205 @item
1206 Sets up the command interpreter as specified by the command line
1207 (@pxref{Mode Options, interpreter}).
1208
1209 @item
1210 @cindex init file
1211 Reads the @dfn{init file} (if any) in your home directory@footnote{On
1212 DOS/Windows systems, the home directory is the one pointed to by the
1213 @code{HOME} environment variable.} and executes all the commands in
1214 that file.
1215
1216 @item
1217 Processes command line options and operands.
1218
1219 @item
1220 Reads and executes the commands from init file (if any) in the current
1221 working directory. This is only done if the current directory is
1222 different from your home directory. Thus, you can have more than one
1223 init file, one generic in your home directory, and another, specific
1224 to the program you are debugging, in the directory where you invoke
1225 @value{GDBN}.
1226
1227 @item
1228 Reads command files specified by the @samp{-x} option. @xref{Command
1229 Files}, for more details about @value{GDBN} command files.
1230
1231 @item
1232 Reads the command history recorded in the @dfn{history file}.
1233 @xref{Command History}, for more details about the command history and the
1234 files where @value{GDBN} records it.
1235 @end enumerate
1236
1237 Init files use the same syntax as @dfn{command files} (@pxref{Command
1238 Files}) and are processed by @value{GDBN} in the same way. The init
1239 file in your home directory can set options (such as @samp{set
1240 complaints}) that affect subsequent processing of command line options
1241 and operands. Init files are not executed if you use the @samp{-nx}
1242 option (@pxref{Mode Options, ,Choosing Modes}).
1243
1244 @cindex init file name
1245 @cindex @file{.gdbinit}
1246 @cindex @file{gdb.ini}
1247 The @value{GDBN} init files are normally called @file{.gdbinit}.
1248 The DJGPP port of @value{GDBN} uses the name @file{gdb.ini}, due to
1249 the limitations of file names imposed by DOS filesystems. The Windows
1250 ports of @value{GDBN} use the standard name, but if they find a
1251 @file{gdb.ini} file, they warn you about that and suggest to rename
1252 the file to the standard name.
1253
1254
1255 @node Quitting GDB
1256 @section Quitting @value{GDBN}
1257 @cindex exiting @value{GDBN}
1258 @cindex leaving @value{GDBN}
1259
1260 @table @code
1261 @kindex quit @r{[}@var{expression}@r{]}
1262 @kindex q @r{(@code{quit})}
1263 @item quit @r{[}@var{expression}@r{]}
1264 @itemx q
1265 To exit @value{GDBN}, use the @code{quit} command (abbreviated
1266 @code{q}), or type an end-of-file character (usually @kbd{Ctrl-d}). If you
1267 do not supply @var{expression}, @value{GDBN} will terminate normally;
1268 otherwise it will terminate using the result of @var{expression} as the
1269 error code.
1270 @end table
1271
1272 @cindex interrupt
1273 An interrupt (often @kbd{Ctrl-c}) does not exit from @value{GDBN}, but rather
1274 terminates the action of any @value{GDBN} command that is in progress and
1275 returns to @value{GDBN} command level. It is safe to type the interrupt
1276 character at any time because @value{GDBN} does not allow it to take effect
1277 until a time when it is safe.
1278
1279 If you have been using @value{GDBN} to control an attached process or
1280 device, you can release it with the @code{detach} command
1281 (@pxref{Attach, ,Debugging an Already-running Process}).
1282
1283 @node Shell Commands
1284 @section Shell Commands
1285
1286 If you need to execute occasional shell commands during your
1287 debugging session, there is no need to leave or suspend @value{GDBN}; you can
1288 just use the @code{shell} command.
1289
1290 @table @code
1291 @kindex shell
1292 @cindex shell escape
1293 @item shell @var{command string}
1294 Invoke a standard shell to execute @var{command string}.
1295 If it exists, the environment variable @code{SHELL} determines which
1296 shell to run. Otherwise @value{GDBN} uses the default shell
1297 (@file{/bin/sh} on Unix systems, @file{COMMAND.COM} on MS-DOS, etc.).
1298 @end table
1299
1300 The utility @code{make} is often needed in development environments.
1301 You do not have to use the @code{shell} command for this purpose in
1302 @value{GDBN}:
1303
1304 @table @code
1305 @kindex make
1306 @cindex calling make
1307 @item make @var{make-args}
1308 Execute the @code{make} program with the specified
1309 arguments. This is equivalent to @samp{shell make @var{make-args}}.
1310 @end table
1311
1312 @node Logging Output
1313 @section Logging Output
1314 @cindex logging @value{GDBN} output
1315 @cindex save @value{GDBN} output to a file
1316
1317 You may want to save the output of @value{GDBN} commands to a file.
1318 There are several commands to control @value{GDBN}'s logging.
1319
1320 @table @code
1321 @kindex set logging
1322 @item set logging on
1323 Enable logging.
1324 @item set logging off
1325 Disable logging.
1326 @cindex logging file name
1327 @item set logging file @var{file}
1328 Change the name of the current logfile. The default logfile is @file{gdb.txt}.
1329 @item set logging overwrite [on|off]
1330 By default, @value{GDBN} will append to the logfile. Set @code{overwrite} if
1331 you want @code{set logging on} to overwrite the logfile instead.
1332 @item set logging redirect [on|off]
1333 By default, @value{GDBN} output will go to both the terminal and the logfile.
1334 Set @code{redirect} if you want output to go only to the log file.
1335 @kindex show logging
1336 @item show logging
1337 Show the current values of the logging settings.
1338 @end table
1339
1340 @node Commands
1341 @chapter @value{GDBN} Commands
1342
1343 You can abbreviate a @value{GDBN} command to the first few letters of the command
1344 name, if that abbreviation is unambiguous; and you can repeat certain
1345 @value{GDBN} commands by typing just @key{RET}. You can also use the @key{TAB}
1346 key to get @value{GDBN} to fill out the rest of a word in a command (or to
1347 show you the alternatives available, if there is more than one possibility).
1348
1349 @menu
1350 * Command Syntax:: How to give commands to @value{GDBN}
1351 * Completion:: Command completion
1352 * Help:: How to ask @value{GDBN} for help
1353 @end menu
1354
1355 @node Command Syntax
1356 @section Command Syntax
1357
1358 A @value{GDBN} command is a single line of input. There is no limit on
1359 how long it can be. It starts with a command name, which is followed by
1360 arguments whose meaning depends on the command name. For example, the
1361 command @code{step} accepts an argument which is the number of times to
1362 step, as in @samp{step 5}. You can also use the @code{step} command
1363 with no arguments. Some commands do not allow any arguments.
1364
1365 @cindex abbreviation
1366 @value{GDBN} command names may always be truncated if that abbreviation is
1367 unambiguous. Other possible command abbreviations are listed in the
1368 documentation for individual commands. In some cases, even ambiguous
1369 abbreviations are allowed; for example, @code{s} is specially defined as
1370 equivalent to @code{step} even though there are other commands whose
1371 names start with @code{s}. You can test abbreviations by using them as
1372 arguments to the @code{help} command.
1373
1374 @cindex repeating commands
1375 @kindex RET @r{(repeat last command)}
1376 A blank line as input to @value{GDBN} (typing just @key{RET}) means to
1377 repeat the previous command. Certain commands (for example, @code{run})
1378 will not repeat this way; these are commands whose unintentional
1379 repetition might cause trouble and which you are unlikely to want to
1380 repeat. User-defined commands can disable this feature; see
1381 @ref{Define, dont-repeat}.
1382
1383 The @code{list} and @code{x} commands, when you repeat them with
1384 @key{RET}, construct new arguments rather than repeating
1385 exactly as typed. This permits easy scanning of source or memory.
1386
1387 @value{GDBN} can also use @key{RET} in another way: to partition lengthy
1388 output, in a way similar to the common utility @code{more}
1389 (@pxref{Screen Size,,Screen Size}). Since it is easy to press one
1390 @key{RET} too many in this situation, @value{GDBN} disables command
1391 repetition after any command that generates this sort of display.
1392
1393 @kindex # @r{(a comment)}
1394 @cindex comment
1395 Any text from a @kbd{#} to the end of the line is a comment; it does
1396 nothing. This is useful mainly in command files (@pxref{Command
1397 Files,,Command Files}).
1398
1399 @cindex repeating command sequences
1400 @kindex Ctrl-o @r{(operate-and-get-next)}
1401 The @kbd{Ctrl-o} binding is useful for repeating a complex sequence of
1402 commands. This command accepts the current line, like @key{RET}, and
1403 then fetches the next line relative to the current line from the history
1404 for editing.
1405
1406 @node Completion
1407 @section Command Completion
1408
1409 @cindex completion
1410 @cindex word completion
1411 @value{GDBN} can fill in the rest of a word in a command for you, if there is
1412 only one possibility; it can also show you what the valid possibilities
1413 are for the next word in a command, at any time. This works for @value{GDBN}
1414 commands, @value{GDBN} subcommands, and the names of symbols in your program.
1415
1416 Press the @key{TAB} key whenever you want @value{GDBN} to fill out the rest
1417 of a word. If there is only one possibility, @value{GDBN} fills in the
1418 word, and waits for you to finish the command (or press @key{RET} to
1419 enter it). For example, if you type
1420
1421 @c FIXME "@key" does not distinguish its argument sufficiently to permit
1422 @c complete accuracy in these examples; space introduced for clarity.
1423 @c If texinfo enhancements make it unnecessary, it would be nice to
1424 @c replace " @key" by "@key" in the following...
1425 @smallexample
1426 (@value{GDBP}) info bre @key{TAB}
1427 @end smallexample
1428
1429 @noindent
1430 @value{GDBN} fills in the rest of the word @samp{breakpoints}, since that is
1431 the only @code{info} subcommand beginning with @samp{bre}:
1432
1433 @smallexample
1434 (@value{GDBP}) info breakpoints
1435 @end smallexample
1436
1437 @noindent
1438 You can either press @key{RET} at this point, to run the @code{info
1439 breakpoints} command, or backspace and enter something else, if
1440 @samp{breakpoints} does not look like the command you expected. (If you
1441 were sure you wanted @code{info breakpoints} in the first place, you
1442 might as well just type @key{RET} immediately after @samp{info bre},
1443 to exploit command abbreviations rather than command completion).
1444
1445 If there is more than one possibility for the next word when you press
1446 @key{TAB}, @value{GDBN} sounds a bell. You can either supply more
1447 characters and try again, or just press @key{TAB} a second time;
1448 @value{GDBN} displays all the possible completions for that word. For
1449 example, you might want to set a breakpoint on a subroutine whose name
1450 begins with @samp{make_}, but when you type @kbd{b make_@key{TAB}} @value{GDBN}
1451 just sounds the bell. Typing @key{TAB} again displays all the
1452 function names in your program that begin with those characters, for
1453 example:
1454
1455 @smallexample
1456 (@value{GDBP}) b make_ @key{TAB}
1457 @exdent @value{GDBN} sounds bell; press @key{TAB} again, to see:
1458 make_a_section_from_file make_environ
1459 make_abs_section make_function_type
1460 make_blockvector make_pointer_type
1461 make_cleanup make_reference_type
1462 make_command make_symbol_completion_list
1463 (@value{GDBP}) b make_
1464 @end smallexample
1465
1466 @noindent
1467 After displaying the available possibilities, @value{GDBN} copies your
1468 partial input (@samp{b make_} in the example) so you can finish the
1469 command.
1470
1471 If you just want to see the list of alternatives in the first place, you
1472 can press @kbd{M-?} rather than pressing @key{TAB} twice. @kbd{M-?}
1473 means @kbd{@key{META} ?}. You can type this either by holding down a
1474 key designated as the @key{META} shift on your keyboard (if there is
1475 one) while typing @kbd{?}, or as @key{ESC} followed by @kbd{?}.
1476
1477 @cindex quotes in commands
1478 @cindex completion of quoted strings
1479 Sometimes the string you need, while logically a ``word'', may contain
1480 parentheses or other characters that @value{GDBN} normally excludes from
1481 its notion of a word. To permit word completion to work in this
1482 situation, you may enclose words in @code{'} (single quote marks) in
1483 @value{GDBN} commands.
1484
1485 The most likely situation where you might need this is in typing the
1486 name of a C@t{++} function. This is because C@t{++} allows function
1487 overloading (multiple definitions of the same function, distinguished
1488 by argument type). For example, when you want to set a breakpoint you
1489 may need to distinguish whether you mean the version of @code{name}
1490 that takes an @code{int} parameter, @code{name(int)}, or the version
1491 that takes a @code{float} parameter, @code{name(float)}. To use the
1492 word-completion facilities in this situation, type a single quote
1493 @code{'} at the beginning of the function name. This alerts
1494 @value{GDBN} that it may need to consider more information than usual
1495 when you press @key{TAB} or @kbd{M-?} to request word completion:
1496
1497 @smallexample
1498 (@value{GDBP}) b 'bubble( @kbd{M-?}
1499 bubble(double,double) bubble(int,int)
1500 (@value{GDBP}) b 'bubble(
1501 @end smallexample
1502
1503 In some cases, @value{GDBN} can tell that completing a name requires using
1504 quotes. When this happens, @value{GDBN} inserts the quote for you (while
1505 completing as much as it can) if you do not type the quote in the first
1506 place:
1507
1508 @smallexample
1509 (@value{GDBP}) b bub @key{TAB}
1510 @exdent @value{GDBN} alters your input line to the following, and rings a bell:
1511 (@value{GDBP}) b 'bubble(
1512 @end smallexample
1513
1514 @noindent
1515 In general, @value{GDBN} can tell that a quote is needed (and inserts it) if
1516 you have not yet started typing the argument list when you ask for
1517 completion on an overloaded symbol.
1518
1519 For more information about overloaded functions, see @ref{C Plus Plus
1520 Expressions, ,C@t{++} Expressions}. You can use the command @code{set
1521 overload-resolution off} to disable overload resolution;
1522 see @ref{Debugging C Plus Plus, ,@value{GDBN} Features for C@t{++}}.
1523
1524
1525 @node Help
1526 @section Getting Help
1527 @cindex online documentation
1528 @kindex help
1529
1530 You can always ask @value{GDBN} itself for information on its commands,
1531 using the command @code{help}.
1532
1533 @table @code
1534 @kindex h @r{(@code{help})}
1535 @item help
1536 @itemx h
1537 You can use @code{help} (abbreviated @code{h}) with no arguments to
1538 display a short list of named classes of commands:
1539
1540 @smallexample
1541 (@value{GDBP}) help
1542 List of classes of commands:
1543
1544 aliases -- Aliases of other commands
1545 breakpoints -- Making program stop at certain points
1546 data -- Examining data
1547 files -- Specifying and examining files
1548 internals -- Maintenance commands
1549 obscure -- Obscure features
1550 running -- Running the program
1551 stack -- Examining the stack
1552 status -- Status inquiries
1553 support -- Support facilities
1554 tracepoints -- Tracing of program execution without
1555 stopping the program
1556 user-defined -- User-defined commands
1557
1558 Type "help" followed by a class name for a list of
1559 commands in that class.
1560 Type "help" followed by command name for full
1561 documentation.
1562 Command name abbreviations are allowed if unambiguous.
1563 (@value{GDBP})
1564 @end smallexample
1565 @c the above line break eliminates huge line overfull...
1566
1567 @item help @var{class}
1568 Using one of the general help classes as an argument, you can get a
1569 list of the individual commands in that class. For example, here is the
1570 help display for the class @code{status}:
1571
1572 @smallexample
1573 (@value{GDBP}) help status
1574 Status inquiries.
1575
1576 List of commands:
1577
1578 @c Line break in "show" line falsifies real output, but needed
1579 @c to fit in smallbook page size.
1580 info -- Generic command for showing things
1581 about the program being debugged
1582 show -- Generic command for showing things
1583 about the debugger
1584
1585 Type "help" followed by command name for full
1586 documentation.
1587 Command name abbreviations are allowed if unambiguous.
1588 (@value{GDBP})
1589 @end smallexample
1590
1591 @item help @var{command}
1592 With a command name as @code{help} argument, @value{GDBN} displays a
1593 short paragraph on how to use that command.
1594
1595 @kindex apropos
1596 @item apropos @var{args}
1597 The @code{apropos} command searches through all of the @value{GDBN}
1598 commands, and their documentation, for the regular expression specified in
1599 @var{args}. It prints out all matches found. For example:
1600
1601 @smallexample
1602 apropos reload
1603 @end smallexample
1604
1605 @noindent
1606 results in:
1607
1608 @smallexample
1609 @c @group
1610 set symbol-reloading -- Set dynamic symbol table reloading
1611 multiple times in one run
1612 show symbol-reloading -- Show dynamic symbol table reloading
1613 multiple times in one run
1614 @c @end group
1615 @end smallexample
1616
1617 @kindex complete
1618 @item complete @var{args}
1619 The @code{complete @var{args}} command lists all the possible completions
1620 for the beginning of a command. Use @var{args} to specify the beginning of the
1621 command you want completed. For example:
1622
1623 @smallexample
1624 complete i
1625 @end smallexample
1626
1627 @noindent results in:
1628
1629 @smallexample
1630 @group
1631 if
1632 ignore
1633 info
1634 inspect
1635 @end group
1636 @end smallexample
1637
1638 @noindent This is intended for use by @sc{gnu} Emacs.
1639 @end table
1640
1641 In addition to @code{help}, you can use the @value{GDBN} commands @code{info}
1642 and @code{show} to inquire about the state of your program, or the state
1643 of @value{GDBN} itself. Each command supports many topics of inquiry; this
1644 manual introduces each of them in the appropriate context. The listings
1645 under @code{info} and under @code{show} in the Index point to
1646 all the sub-commands. @xref{Index}.
1647
1648 @c @group
1649 @table @code
1650 @kindex info
1651 @kindex i @r{(@code{info})}
1652 @item info
1653 This command (abbreviated @code{i}) is for describing the state of your
1654 program. For example, you can show the arguments passed to a function
1655 with @code{info args}, list the registers currently in use with @code{info
1656 registers}, or list the breakpoints you have set with @code{info breakpoints}.
1657 You can get a complete list of the @code{info} sub-commands with
1658 @w{@code{help info}}.
1659
1660 @kindex set
1661 @item set
1662 You can assign the result of an expression to an environment variable with
1663 @code{set}. For example, you can set the @value{GDBN} prompt to a $-sign with
1664 @code{set prompt $}.
1665
1666 @kindex show
1667 @item show
1668 In contrast to @code{info}, @code{show} is for describing the state of
1669 @value{GDBN} itself.
1670 You can change most of the things you can @code{show}, by using the
1671 related command @code{set}; for example, you can control what number
1672 system is used for displays with @code{set radix}, or simply inquire
1673 which is currently in use with @code{show radix}.
1674
1675 @kindex info set
1676 To display all the settable parameters and their current
1677 values, you can use @code{show} with no arguments; you may also use
1678 @code{info set}. Both commands produce the same display.
1679 @c FIXME: "info set" violates the rule that "info" is for state of
1680 @c FIXME...program. Ck w/ GNU: "info set" to be called something else,
1681 @c FIXME...or change desc of rule---eg "state of prog and debugging session"?
1682 @end table
1683 @c @end group
1684
1685 Here are three miscellaneous @code{show} subcommands, all of which are
1686 exceptional in lacking corresponding @code{set} commands:
1687
1688 @table @code
1689 @kindex show version
1690 @cindex @value{GDBN} version number
1691 @item show version
1692 Show what version of @value{GDBN} is running. You should include this
1693 information in @value{GDBN} bug-reports. If multiple versions of
1694 @value{GDBN} are in use at your site, you may need to determine which
1695 version of @value{GDBN} you are running; as @value{GDBN} evolves, new
1696 commands are introduced, and old ones may wither away. Also, many
1697 system vendors ship variant versions of @value{GDBN}, and there are
1698 variant versions of @value{GDBN} in @sc{gnu}/Linux distributions as well.
1699 The version number is the same as the one announced when you start
1700 @value{GDBN}.
1701
1702 @kindex show copying
1703 @kindex info copying
1704 @cindex display @value{GDBN} copyright
1705 @item show copying
1706 @itemx info copying
1707 Display information about permission for copying @value{GDBN}.
1708
1709 @kindex show warranty
1710 @kindex info warranty
1711 @item show warranty
1712 @itemx info warranty
1713 Display the @sc{gnu} ``NO WARRANTY'' statement, or a warranty,
1714 if your version of @value{GDBN} comes with one.
1715
1716 @end table
1717
1718 @node Running
1719 @chapter Running Programs Under @value{GDBN}
1720
1721 When you run a program under @value{GDBN}, you must first generate
1722 debugging information when you compile it.
1723
1724 You may start @value{GDBN} with its arguments, if any, in an environment
1725 of your choice. If you are doing native debugging, you may redirect
1726 your program's input and output, debug an already running process, or
1727 kill a child process.
1728
1729 @menu
1730 * Compilation:: Compiling for debugging
1731 * Starting:: Starting your program
1732 * Arguments:: Your program's arguments
1733 * Environment:: Your program's environment
1734
1735 * Working Directory:: Your program's working directory
1736 * Input/Output:: Your program's input and output
1737 * Attach:: Debugging an already-running process
1738 * Kill Process:: Killing the child process
1739
1740 * Threads:: Debugging programs with multiple threads
1741 * Processes:: Debugging programs with multiple processes
1742 * Checkpoint/Restart:: Setting a @emph{bookmark} to return to later
1743 @end menu
1744
1745 @node Compilation
1746 @section Compiling for Debugging
1747
1748 In order to debug a program effectively, you need to generate
1749 debugging information when you compile it. This debugging information
1750 is stored in the object file; it describes the data type of each
1751 variable or function and the correspondence between source line numbers
1752 and addresses in the executable code.
1753
1754 To request debugging information, specify the @samp{-g} option when you run
1755 the compiler.
1756
1757 Programs that are to be shipped to your customers are compiled with
1758 optimizations, using the @samp{-O} compiler option. However, many
1759 compilers are unable to handle the @samp{-g} and @samp{-O} options
1760 together. Using those compilers, you cannot generate optimized
1761 executables containing debugging information.
1762
1763 @value{NGCC}, the @sc{gnu} C/C@t{++} compiler, supports @samp{-g} with or
1764 without @samp{-O}, making it possible to debug optimized code. We
1765 recommend that you @emph{always} use @samp{-g} whenever you compile a
1766 program. You may think your program is correct, but there is no sense
1767 in pushing your luck.
1768
1769 @cindex optimized code, debugging
1770 @cindex debugging optimized code
1771 When you debug a program compiled with @samp{-g -O}, remember that the
1772 optimizer is rearranging your code; the debugger shows you what is
1773 really there. Do not be too surprised when the execution path does not
1774 exactly match your source file! An extreme example: if you define a
1775 variable, but never use it, @value{GDBN} never sees that
1776 variable---because the compiler optimizes it out of existence.
1777
1778 Some things do not work as well with @samp{-g -O} as with just
1779 @samp{-g}, particularly on machines with instruction scheduling. If in
1780 doubt, recompile with @samp{-g} alone, and if this fixes the problem,
1781 please report it to us as a bug (including a test case!).
1782 @xref{Variables}, for more information about debugging optimized code.
1783
1784 Older versions of the @sc{gnu} C compiler permitted a variant option
1785 @w{@samp{-gg}} for debugging information. @value{GDBN} no longer supports this
1786 format; if your @sc{gnu} C compiler has this option, do not use it.
1787
1788 @value{GDBN} knows about preprocessor macros and can show you their
1789 expansion (@pxref{Macros}). Most compilers do not include information
1790 about preprocessor macros in the debugging information if you specify
1791 the @option{-g} flag alone, because this information is rather large.
1792 Version 3.1 and later of @value{NGCC}, the @sc{gnu} C compiler,
1793 provides macro information if you specify the options
1794 @option{-gdwarf-2} and @option{-g3}; the former option requests
1795 debugging information in the Dwarf 2 format, and the latter requests
1796 ``extra information''. In the future, we hope to find more compact
1797 ways to represent macro information, so that it can be included with
1798 @option{-g} alone.
1799
1800 @need 2000
1801 @node Starting
1802 @section Starting your Program
1803 @cindex starting
1804 @cindex running
1805
1806 @table @code
1807 @kindex run
1808 @kindex r @r{(@code{run})}
1809 @item run
1810 @itemx r
1811 Use the @code{run} command to start your program under @value{GDBN}.
1812 You must first specify the program name (except on VxWorks) with an
1813 argument to @value{GDBN} (@pxref{Invocation, ,Getting In and Out of
1814 @value{GDBN}}), or by using the @code{file} or @code{exec-file} command
1815 (@pxref{Files, ,Commands to Specify Files}).
1816
1817 @end table
1818
1819 If you are running your program in an execution environment that
1820 supports processes, @code{run} creates an inferior process and makes
1821 that process run your program. In some environments without processes,
1822 @code{run} jumps to the start of your program. Other targets,
1823 like @samp{remote}, are always running. If you get an error
1824 message like this one:
1825
1826 @smallexample
1827 The "remote" target does not support "run".
1828 Try "help target" or "continue".
1829 @end smallexample
1830
1831 @noindent
1832 then use @code{continue} to run your program. You may need @code{load}
1833 first (@pxref{load}).
1834
1835 The execution of a program is affected by certain information it
1836 receives from its superior. @value{GDBN} provides ways to specify this
1837 information, which you must do @emph{before} starting your program. (You
1838 can change it after starting your program, but such changes only affect
1839 your program the next time you start it.) This information may be
1840 divided into four categories:
1841
1842 @table @asis
1843 @item The @emph{arguments.}
1844 Specify the arguments to give your program as the arguments of the
1845 @code{run} command. If a shell is available on your target, the shell
1846 is used to pass the arguments, so that you may use normal conventions
1847 (such as wildcard expansion or variable substitution) in describing
1848 the arguments.
1849 In Unix systems, you can control which shell is used with the
1850 @code{SHELL} environment variable.
1851 @xref{Arguments, ,Your Program's Arguments}.
1852
1853 @item The @emph{environment.}
1854 Your program normally inherits its environment from @value{GDBN}, but you can
1855 use the @value{GDBN} commands @code{set environment} and @code{unset
1856 environment} to change parts of the environment that affect
1857 your program. @xref{Environment, ,Your Program's Environment}.
1858
1859 @item The @emph{working directory.}
1860 Your program inherits its working directory from @value{GDBN}. You can set
1861 the @value{GDBN} working directory with the @code{cd} command in @value{GDBN}.
1862 @xref{Working Directory, ,Your Program's Working Directory}.
1863
1864 @item The @emph{standard input and output.}
1865 Your program normally uses the same device for standard input and
1866 standard output as @value{GDBN} is using. You can redirect input and output
1867 in the @code{run} command line, or you can use the @code{tty} command to
1868 set a different device for your program.
1869 @xref{Input/Output, ,Your Program's Input and Output}.
1870
1871 @cindex pipes
1872 @emph{Warning:} While input and output redirection work, you cannot use
1873 pipes to pass the output of the program you are debugging to another
1874 program; if you attempt this, @value{GDBN} is likely to wind up debugging the
1875 wrong program.
1876 @end table
1877
1878 When you issue the @code{run} command, your program begins to execute
1879 immediately. @xref{Stopping, ,Stopping and Continuing}, for discussion
1880 of how to arrange for your program to stop. Once your program has
1881 stopped, you may call functions in your program, using the @code{print}
1882 or @code{call} commands. @xref{Data, ,Examining Data}.
1883
1884 If the modification time of your symbol file has changed since the last
1885 time @value{GDBN} read its symbols, @value{GDBN} discards its symbol
1886 table, and reads it again. When it does this, @value{GDBN} tries to retain
1887 your current breakpoints.
1888
1889 @table @code
1890 @kindex start
1891 @item start
1892 @cindex run to main procedure
1893 The name of the main procedure can vary from language to language.
1894 With C or C@t{++}, the main procedure name is always @code{main}, but
1895 other languages such as Ada do not require a specific name for their
1896 main procedure. The debugger provides a convenient way to start the
1897 execution of the program and to stop at the beginning of the main
1898 procedure, depending on the language used.
1899
1900 The @samp{start} command does the equivalent of setting a temporary
1901 breakpoint at the beginning of the main procedure and then invoking
1902 the @samp{run} command.
1903
1904 @cindex elaboration phase
1905 Some programs contain an @dfn{elaboration} phase where some startup code is
1906 executed before the main procedure is called. This depends on the
1907 languages used to write your program. In C@t{++}, for instance,
1908 constructors for static and global objects are executed before
1909 @code{main} is called. It is therefore possible that the debugger stops
1910 before reaching the main procedure. However, the temporary breakpoint
1911 will remain to halt execution.
1912
1913 Specify the arguments to give to your program as arguments to the
1914 @samp{start} command. These arguments will be given verbatim to the
1915 underlying @samp{run} command. Note that the same arguments will be
1916 reused if no argument is provided during subsequent calls to
1917 @samp{start} or @samp{run}.
1918
1919 It is sometimes necessary to debug the program during elaboration. In
1920 these cases, using the @code{start} command would stop the execution of
1921 your program too late, as the program would have already completed the
1922 elaboration phase. Under these circumstances, insert breakpoints in your
1923 elaboration code before running your program.
1924
1925 @kindex set exec-wrapper
1926 @item set exec-wrapper @var{wrapper}
1927 @itemx show exec-wrapper
1928 @itemx unset exec-wrapper
1929 When @samp{exec-wrapper} is set, the specified wrapper is used to
1930 launch programs for debugging. @value{GDBN} starts your program
1931 with a shell command of the form @kbd{exec @var{wrapper}
1932 @var{program}}. Quoting is added to @var{program} and its
1933 arguments, but not to @var{wrapper}, so you should add quotes if
1934 appropriate for your shell. The wrapper runs until it executes
1935 your program, and then @value{GDBN} takes control.
1936
1937 You can use any program that eventually calls @code{execve} with
1938 its arguments as a wrapper. Several standard Unix utilities do
1939 this, e.g.@: @code{env} and @code{nohup}. Any Unix shell script ending
1940 with @code{exec "$@@"} will also work.
1941
1942 For example, you can use @code{env} to pass an environment variable to
1943 the debugged program, without setting the variable in your shell's
1944 environment:
1945
1946 @smallexample
1947 (@value{GDBP}) set exec-wrapper env 'LD_PRELOAD=libtest.so'
1948 (@value{GDBP}) run
1949 @end smallexample
1950
1951 This command is available when debugging locally on most targets, excluding
1952 @sc{djgpp}, Cygwin, MS Windows, and QNX Neutrino.
1953
1954 @end table
1955
1956 @node Arguments
1957 @section Your Program's Arguments
1958
1959 @cindex arguments (to your program)
1960 The arguments to your program can be specified by the arguments of the
1961 @code{run} command.
1962 They are passed to a shell, which expands wildcard characters and
1963 performs redirection of I/O, and thence to your program. Your
1964 @code{SHELL} environment variable (if it exists) specifies what shell
1965 @value{GDBN} uses. If you do not define @code{SHELL}, @value{GDBN} uses
1966 the default shell (@file{/bin/sh} on Unix).
1967
1968 On non-Unix systems, the program is usually invoked directly by
1969 @value{GDBN}, which emulates I/O redirection via the appropriate system
1970 calls, and the wildcard characters are expanded by the startup code of
1971 the program, not by the shell.
1972
1973 @code{run} with no arguments uses the same arguments used by the previous
1974 @code{run}, or those set by the @code{set args} command.
1975
1976 @table @code
1977 @kindex set args
1978 @item set args
1979 Specify the arguments to be used the next time your program is run. If
1980 @code{set args} has no arguments, @code{run} executes your program
1981 with no arguments. Once you have run your program with arguments,
1982 using @code{set args} before the next @code{run} is the only way to run
1983 it again without arguments.
1984
1985 @kindex show args
1986 @item show args
1987 Show the arguments to give your program when it is started.
1988 @end table
1989
1990 @node Environment
1991 @section Your Program's Environment
1992
1993 @cindex environment (of your program)
1994 The @dfn{environment} consists of a set of environment variables and
1995 their values. Environment variables conventionally record such things as
1996 your user name, your home directory, your terminal type, and your search
1997 path for programs to run. Usually you set up environment variables with
1998 the shell and they are inherited by all the other programs you run. When
1999 debugging, it can be useful to try running your program with a modified
2000 environment without having to start @value{GDBN} over again.
2001
2002 @table @code
2003 @kindex path
2004 @item path @var{directory}
2005 Add @var{directory} to the front of the @code{PATH} environment variable
2006 (the search path for executables) that will be passed to your program.
2007 The value of @code{PATH} used by @value{GDBN} does not change.
2008 You may specify several directory names, separated by whitespace or by a
2009 system-dependent separator character (@samp{:} on Unix, @samp{;} on
2010 MS-DOS and MS-Windows). If @var{directory} is already in the path, it
2011 is moved to the front, so it is searched sooner.
2012
2013 You can use the string @samp{$cwd} to refer to whatever is the current
2014 working directory at the time @value{GDBN} searches the path. If you
2015 use @samp{.} instead, it refers to the directory where you executed the
2016 @code{path} command. @value{GDBN} replaces @samp{.} in the
2017 @var{directory} argument (with the current path) before adding
2018 @var{directory} to the search path.
2019 @c 'path' is explicitly nonrepeatable, but RMS points out it is silly to
2020 @c document that, since repeating it would be a no-op.
2021
2022 @kindex show paths
2023 @item show paths
2024 Display the list of search paths for executables (the @code{PATH}
2025 environment variable).
2026
2027 @kindex show environment
2028 @item show environment @r{[}@var{varname}@r{]}
2029 Print the value of environment variable @var{varname} to be given to
2030 your program when it starts. If you do not supply @var{varname},
2031 print the names and values of all environment variables to be given to
2032 your program. You can abbreviate @code{environment} as @code{env}.
2033
2034 @kindex set environment
2035 @item set environment @var{varname} @r{[}=@var{value}@r{]}
2036 Set environment variable @var{varname} to @var{value}. The value
2037 changes for your program only, not for @value{GDBN} itself. @var{value} may
2038 be any string; the values of environment variables are just strings, and
2039 any interpretation is supplied by your program itself. The @var{value}
2040 parameter is optional; if it is eliminated, the variable is set to a
2041 null value.
2042 @c "any string" here does not include leading, trailing
2043 @c blanks. Gnu asks: does anyone care?
2044
2045 For example, this command:
2046
2047 @smallexample
2048 set env USER = foo
2049 @end smallexample
2050
2051 @noindent
2052 tells the debugged program, when subsequently run, that its user is named
2053 @samp{foo}. (The spaces around @samp{=} are used for clarity here; they
2054 are not actually required.)
2055
2056 @kindex unset environment
2057 @item unset environment @var{varname}
2058 Remove variable @var{varname} from the environment to be passed to your
2059 program. This is different from @samp{set env @var{varname} =};
2060 @code{unset environment} removes the variable from the environment,
2061 rather than assigning it an empty value.
2062 @end table
2063
2064 @emph{Warning:} On Unix systems, @value{GDBN} runs your program using
2065 the shell indicated
2066 by your @code{SHELL} environment variable if it exists (or
2067 @code{/bin/sh} if not). If your @code{SHELL} variable names a shell
2068 that runs an initialization file---such as @file{.cshrc} for C-shell, or
2069 @file{.bashrc} for BASH---any variables you set in that file affect
2070 your program. You may wish to move setting of environment variables to
2071 files that are only run when you sign on, such as @file{.login} or
2072 @file{.profile}.
2073
2074 @node Working Directory
2075 @section Your Program's Working Directory
2076
2077 @cindex working directory (of your program)
2078 Each time you start your program with @code{run}, it inherits its
2079 working directory from the current working directory of @value{GDBN}.
2080 The @value{GDBN} working directory is initially whatever it inherited
2081 from its parent process (typically the shell), but you can specify a new
2082 working directory in @value{GDBN} with the @code{cd} command.
2083
2084 The @value{GDBN} working directory also serves as a default for the commands
2085 that specify files for @value{GDBN} to operate on. @xref{Files, ,Commands to
2086 Specify Files}.
2087
2088 @table @code
2089 @kindex cd
2090 @cindex change working directory
2091 @item cd @var{directory}
2092 Set the @value{GDBN} working directory to @var{directory}.
2093
2094 @kindex pwd
2095 @item pwd
2096 Print the @value{GDBN} working directory.
2097 @end table
2098
2099 It is generally impossible to find the current working directory of
2100 the process being debugged (since a program can change its directory
2101 during its run). If you work on a system where @value{GDBN} is
2102 configured with the @file{/proc} support, you can use the @code{info
2103 proc} command (@pxref{SVR4 Process Information}) to find out the
2104 current working directory of the debuggee.
2105
2106 @node Input/Output
2107 @section Your Program's Input and Output
2108
2109 @cindex redirection
2110 @cindex i/o
2111 @cindex terminal
2112 By default, the program you run under @value{GDBN} does input and output to
2113 the same terminal that @value{GDBN} uses. @value{GDBN} switches the terminal
2114 to its own terminal modes to interact with you, but it records the terminal
2115 modes your program was using and switches back to them when you continue
2116 running your program.
2117
2118 @table @code
2119 @kindex info terminal
2120 @item info terminal
2121 Displays information recorded by @value{GDBN} about the terminal modes your
2122 program is using.
2123 @end table
2124
2125 You can redirect your program's input and/or output using shell
2126 redirection with the @code{run} command. For example,
2127
2128 @smallexample
2129 run > outfile
2130 @end smallexample
2131
2132 @noindent
2133 starts your program, diverting its output to the file @file{outfile}.
2134
2135 @kindex tty
2136 @cindex controlling terminal
2137 Another way to specify where your program should do input and output is
2138 with the @code{tty} command. This command accepts a file name as
2139 argument, and causes this file to be the default for future @code{run}
2140 commands. It also resets the controlling terminal for the child
2141 process, for future @code{run} commands. For example,
2142
2143 @smallexample
2144 tty /dev/ttyb
2145 @end smallexample
2146
2147 @noindent
2148 directs that processes started with subsequent @code{run} commands
2149 default to do input and output on the terminal @file{/dev/ttyb} and have
2150 that as their controlling terminal.
2151
2152 An explicit redirection in @code{run} overrides the @code{tty} command's
2153 effect on the input/output device, but not its effect on the controlling
2154 terminal.
2155
2156 When you use the @code{tty} command or redirect input in the @code{run}
2157 command, only the input @emph{for your program} is affected. The input
2158 for @value{GDBN} still comes from your terminal. @code{tty} is an alias
2159 for @code{set inferior-tty}.
2160
2161 @cindex inferior tty
2162 @cindex set inferior controlling terminal
2163 You can use the @code{show inferior-tty} command to tell @value{GDBN} to
2164 display the name of the terminal that will be used for future runs of your
2165 program.
2166
2167 @table @code
2168 @item set inferior-tty /dev/ttyb
2169 @kindex set inferior-tty
2170 Set the tty for the program being debugged to /dev/ttyb.
2171
2172 @item show inferior-tty
2173 @kindex show inferior-tty
2174 Show the current tty for the program being debugged.
2175 @end table
2176
2177 @node Attach
2178 @section Debugging an Already-running Process
2179 @kindex attach
2180 @cindex attach
2181
2182 @table @code
2183 @item attach @var{process-id}
2184 This command attaches to a running process---one that was started
2185 outside @value{GDBN}. (@code{info files} shows your active
2186 targets.) The command takes as argument a process ID. The usual way to
2187 find out the @var{process-id} of a Unix process is with the @code{ps} utility,
2188 or with the @samp{jobs -l} shell command.
2189
2190 @code{attach} does not repeat if you press @key{RET} a second time after
2191 executing the command.
2192 @end table
2193
2194 To use @code{attach}, your program must be running in an environment
2195 which supports processes; for example, @code{attach} does not work for
2196 programs on bare-board targets that lack an operating system. You must
2197 also have permission to send the process a signal.
2198
2199 When you use @code{attach}, the debugger finds the program running in
2200 the process first by looking in the current working directory, then (if
2201 the program is not found) by using the source file search path
2202 (@pxref{Source Path, ,Specifying Source Directories}). You can also use
2203 the @code{file} command to load the program. @xref{Files, ,Commands to
2204 Specify Files}.
2205
2206 The first thing @value{GDBN} does after arranging to debug the specified
2207 process is to stop it. You can examine and modify an attached process
2208 with all the @value{GDBN} commands that are ordinarily available when
2209 you start processes with @code{run}. You can insert breakpoints; you
2210 can step and continue; you can modify storage. If you would rather the
2211 process continue running, you may use the @code{continue} command after
2212 attaching @value{GDBN} to the process.
2213
2214 @table @code
2215 @kindex detach
2216 @item detach
2217 When you have finished debugging the attached process, you can use the
2218 @code{detach} command to release it from @value{GDBN} control. Detaching
2219 the process continues its execution. After the @code{detach} command,
2220 that process and @value{GDBN} become completely independent once more, and you
2221 are ready to @code{attach} another process or start one with @code{run}.
2222 @code{detach} does not repeat if you press @key{RET} again after
2223 executing the command.
2224 @end table
2225
2226 If you exit @value{GDBN} while you have an attached process, you detach
2227 that process. If you use the @code{run} command, you kill that process.
2228 By default, @value{GDBN} asks for confirmation if you try to do either of these
2229 things; you can control whether or not you need to confirm by using the
2230 @code{set confirm} command (@pxref{Messages/Warnings, ,Optional Warnings and
2231 Messages}).
2232
2233 @node Kill Process
2234 @section Killing the Child Process
2235
2236 @table @code
2237 @kindex kill
2238 @item kill
2239 Kill the child process in which your program is running under @value{GDBN}.
2240 @end table
2241
2242 This command is useful if you wish to debug a core dump instead of a
2243 running process. @value{GDBN} ignores any core dump file while your program
2244 is running.
2245
2246 On some operating systems, a program cannot be executed outside @value{GDBN}
2247 while you have breakpoints set on it inside @value{GDBN}. You can use the
2248 @code{kill} command in this situation to permit running your program
2249 outside the debugger.
2250
2251 The @code{kill} command is also useful if you wish to recompile and
2252 relink your program, since on many systems it is impossible to modify an
2253 executable file while it is running in a process. In this case, when you
2254 next type @code{run}, @value{GDBN} notices that the file has changed, and
2255 reads the symbol table again (while trying to preserve your current
2256 breakpoint settings).
2257
2258 @node Threads
2259 @section Debugging Programs with Multiple Threads
2260
2261 @cindex threads of execution
2262 @cindex multiple threads
2263 @cindex switching threads
2264 In some operating systems, such as HP-UX and Solaris, a single program
2265 may have more than one @dfn{thread} of execution. The precise semantics
2266 of threads differ from one operating system to another, but in general
2267 the threads of a single program are akin to multiple processes---except
2268 that they share one address space (that is, they can all examine and
2269 modify the same variables). On the other hand, each thread has its own
2270 registers and execution stack, and perhaps private memory.
2271
2272 @value{GDBN} provides these facilities for debugging multi-thread
2273 programs:
2274
2275 @itemize @bullet
2276 @item automatic notification of new threads
2277 @item @samp{thread @var{threadno}}, a command to switch among threads
2278 @item @samp{info threads}, a command to inquire about existing threads
2279 @item @samp{thread apply [@var{threadno}] [@var{all}] @var{args}},
2280 a command to apply a command to a list of threads
2281 @item thread-specific breakpoints
2282 @item @samp{set print thread-events}, which controls printing of
2283 messages on thread start and exit.
2284 @end itemize
2285
2286 @quotation
2287 @emph{Warning:} These facilities are not yet available on every
2288 @value{GDBN} configuration where the operating system supports threads.
2289 If your @value{GDBN} does not support threads, these commands have no
2290 effect. For example, a system without thread support shows no output
2291 from @samp{info threads}, and always rejects the @code{thread} command,
2292 like this:
2293
2294 @smallexample
2295 (@value{GDBP}) info threads
2296 (@value{GDBP}) thread 1
2297 Thread ID 1 not known. Use the "info threads" command to
2298 see the IDs of currently known threads.
2299 @end smallexample
2300 @c FIXME to implementors: how hard would it be to say "sorry, this GDB
2301 @c doesn't support threads"?
2302 @end quotation
2303
2304 @cindex focus of debugging
2305 @cindex current thread
2306 The @value{GDBN} thread debugging facility allows you to observe all
2307 threads while your program runs---but whenever @value{GDBN} takes
2308 control, one thread in particular is always the focus of debugging.
2309 This thread is called the @dfn{current thread}. Debugging commands show
2310 program information from the perspective of the current thread.
2311
2312 @cindex @code{New} @var{systag} message
2313 @cindex thread identifier (system)
2314 @c FIXME-implementors!! It would be more helpful if the [New...] message
2315 @c included GDB's numeric thread handle, so you could just go to that
2316 @c thread without first checking `info threads'.
2317 Whenever @value{GDBN} detects a new thread in your program, it displays
2318 the target system's identification for the thread with a message in the
2319 form @samp{[New @var{systag}]}. @var{systag} is a thread identifier
2320 whose form varies depending on the particular system. For example, on
2321 @sc{gnu}/Linux, you might see
2322
2323 @smallexample
2324 [New Thread 46912507313328 (LWP 25582)]
2325 @end smallexample
2326
2327 @noindent
2328 when @value{GDBN} notices a new thread. In contrast, on an SGI system,
2329 the @var{systag} is simply something like @samp{process 368}, with no
2330 further qualifier.
2331
2332 @c FIXME!! (1) Does the [New...] message appear even for the very first
2333 @c thread of a program, or does it only appear for the
2334 @c second---i.e.@: when it becomes obvious we have a multithread
2335 @c program?
2336 @c (2) *Is* there necessarily a first thread always? Or do some
2337 @c multithread systems permit starting a program with multiple
2338 @c threads ab initio?
2339
2340 @cindex thread number
2341 @cindex thread identifier (GDB)
2342 For debugging purposes, @value{GDBN} associates its own thread
2343 number---always a single integer---with each thread in your program.
2344
2345 @table @code
2346 @kindex info threads
2347 @item info threads
2348 Display a summary of all threads currently in your
2349 program. @value{GDBN} displays for each thread (in this order):
2350
2351 @enumerate
2352 @item
2353 the thread number assigned by @value{GDBN}
2354
2355 @item
2356 the target system's thread identifier (@var{systag})
2357
2358 @item
2359 the current stack frame summary for that thread
2360 @end enumerate
2361
2362 @noindent
2363 An asterisk @samp{*} to the left of the @value{GDBN} thread number
2364 indicates the current thread.
2365
2366 For example,
2367 @end table
2368 @c end table here to get a little more width for example
2369
2370 @smallexample
2371 (@value{GDBP}) info threads
2372 3 process 35 thread 27 0x34e5 in sigpause ()
2373 2 process 35 thread 23 0x34e5 in sigpause ()
2374 * 1 process 35 thread 13 main (argc=1, argv=0x7ffffff8)
2375 at threadtest.c:68
2376 @end smallexample
2377
2378 On HP-UX systems:
2379
2380 @cindex debugging multithreaded programs (on HP-UX)
2381 @cindex thread identifier (GDB), on HP-UX
2382 For debugging purposes, @value{GDBN} associates its own thread
2383 number---a small integer assigned in thread-creation order---with each
2384 thread in your program.
2385
2386 @cindex @code{New} @var{systag} message, on HP-UX
2387 @cindex thread identifier (system), on HP-UX
2388 @c FIXME-implementors!! It would be more helpful if the [New...] message
2389 @c included GDB's numeric thread handle, so you could just go to that
2390 @c thread without first checking `info threads'.
2391 Whenever @value{GDBN} detects a new thread in your program, it displays
2392 both @value{GDBN}'s thread number and the target system's identification for the thread with a message in the
2393 form @samp{[New @var{systag}]}. @var{systag} is a thread identifier
2394 whose form varies depending on the particular system. For example, on
2395 HP-UX, you see
2396
2397 @smallexample
2398 [New thread 2 (system thread 26594)]
2399 @end smallexample
2400
2401 @noindent
2402 when @value{GDBN} notices a new thread.
2403
2404 @table @code
2405 @kindex info threads (HP-UX)
2406 @item info threads
2407 Display a summary of all threads currently in your
2408 program. @value{GDBN} displays for each thread (in this order):
2409
2410 @enumerate
2411 @item the thread number assigned by @value{GDBN}
2412
2413 @item the target system's thread identifier (@var{systag})
2414
2415 @item the current stack frame summary for that thread
2416 @end enumerate
2417
2418 @noindent
2419 An asterisk @samp{*} to the left of the @value{GDBN} thread number
2420 indicates the current thread.
2421
2422 For example,
2423 @end table
2424 @c end table here to get a little more width for example
2425
2426 @smallexample
2427 (@value{GDBP}) info threads
2428 * 3 system thread 26607 worker (wptr=0x7b09c318 "@@") \@*
2429 at quicksort.c:137
2430 2 system thread 26606 0x7b0030d8 in __ksleep () \@*
2431 from /usr/lib/libc.2
2432 1 system thread 27905 0x7b003498 in _brk () \@*
2433 from /usr/lib/libc.2
2434 @end smallexample
2435
2436 On Solaris, you can display more information about user threads with a
2437 Solaris-specific command:
2438
2439 @table @code
2440 @item maint info sol-threads
2441 @kindex maint info sol-threads
2442 @cindex thread info (Solaris)
2443 Display info on Solaris user threads.
2444 @end table
2445
2446 @table @code
2447 @kindex thread @var{threadno}
2448 @item thread @var{threadno}
2449 Make thread number @var{threadno} the current thread. The command
2450 argument @var{threadno} is the internal @value{GDBN} thread number, as
2451 shown in the first field of the @samp{info threads} display.
2452 @value{GDBN} responds by displaying the system identifier of the thread
2453 you selected, and its current stack frame summary:
2454
2455 @smallexample
2456 @c FIXME!! This example made up; find a @value{GDBN} w/threads and get real one
2457 (@value{GDBP}) thread 2
2458 [Switching to process 35 thread 23]
2459 0x34e5 in sigpause ()
2460 @end smallexample
2461
2462 @noindent
2463 As with the @samp{[New @dots{}]} message, the form of the text after
2464 @samp{Switching to} depends on your system's conventions for identifying
2465 threads.
2466
2467 @kindex thread apply
2468 @cindex apply command to several threads
2469 @item thread apply [@var{threadno}] [@var{all}] @var{command}
2470 The @code{thread apply} command allows you to apply the named
2471 @var{command} to one or more threads. Specify the numbers of the
2472 threads that you want affected with the command argument
2473 @var{threadno}. It can be a single thread number, one of the numbers
2474 shown in the first field of the @samp{info threads} display; or it
2475 could be a range of thread numbers, as in @code{2-4}. To apply a
2476 command to all threads, type @kbd{thread apply all @var{command}}.
2477
2478 @kindex set print thread-events
2479 @cindex print messages on thread start and exit
2480 @item set print thread-events
2481 @itemx set print thread-events on
2482 @itemx set print thread-events off
2483 The @code{set print thread-events} command allows you to enable or
2484 disable printing of messages when @value{GDBN} notices that new threads have
2485 started or that threads have exited. By default, these messages will
2486 be printed if detection of these events is supported by the target.
2487 Note that these messages cannot be disabled on all targets.
2488
2489 @kindex show print thread-events
2490 @item show print thread-events
2491 Show whether messages will be printed when @value{GDBN} detects that threads
2492 have started and exited.
2493 @end table
2494
2495 @cindex automatic thread selection
2496 @cindex switching threads automatically
2497 @cindex threads, automatic switching
2498 Whenever @value{GDBN} stops your program, due to a breakpoint or a
2499 signal, it automatically selects the thread where that breakpoint or
2500 signal happened. @value{GDBN} alerts you to the context switch with a
2501 message of the form @samp{[Switching to @var{systag}]} to identify the
2502 thread.
2503
2504 @xref{Thread Stops,,Stopping and Starting Multi-thread Programs}, for
2505 more information about how @value{GDBN} behaves when you stop and start
2506 programs with multiple threads.
2507
2508 @xref{Set Watchpoints,,Setting Watchpoints}, for information about
2509 watchpoints in programs with multiple threads.
2510
2511 @node Processes
2512 @section Debugging Programs with Multiple Processes
2513
2514 @cindex fork, debugging programs which call
2515 @cindex multiple processes
2516 @cindex processes, multiple
2517 On most systems, @value{GDBN} has no special support for debugging
2518 programs which create additional processes using the @code{fork}
2519 function. When a program forks, @value{GDBN} will continue to debug the
2520 parent process and the child process will run unimpeded. If you have
2521 set a breakpoint in any code which the child then executes, the child
2522 will get a @code{SIGTRAP} signal which (unless it catches the signal)
2523 will cause it to terminate.
2524
2525 However, if you want to debug the child process there is a workaround
2526 which isn't too painful. Put a call to @code{sleep} in the code which
2527 the child process executes after the fork. It may be useful to sleep
2528 only if a certain environment variable is set, or a certain file exists,
2529 so that the delay need not occur when you don't want to run @value{GDBN}
2530 on the child. While the child is sleeping, use the @code{ps} program to
2531 get its process ID. Then tell @value{GDBN} (a new invocation of
2532 @value{GDBN} if you are also debugging the parent process) to attach to
2533 the child process (@pxref{Attach}). From that point on you can debug
2534 the child process just like any other process which you attached to.
2535
2536 On some systems, @value{GDBN} provides support for debugging programs that
2537 create additional processes using the @code{fork} or @code{vfork} functions.
2538 Currently, the only platforms with this feature are HP-UX (11.x and later
2539 only?) and @sc{gnu}/Linux (kernel version 2.5.60 and later).
2540
2541 By default, when a program forks, @value{GDBN} will continue to debug
2542 the parent process and the child process will run unimpeded.
2543
2544 If you want to follow the child process instead of the parent process,
2545 use the command @w{@code{set follow-fork-mode}}.
2546
2547 @table @code
2548 @kindex set follow-fork-mode
2549 @item set follow-fork-mode @var{mode}
2550 Set the debugger response to a program call of @code{fork} or
2551 @code{vfork}. A call to @code{fork} or @code{vfork} creates a new
2552 process. The @var{mode} argument can be:
2553
2554 @table @code
2555 @item parent
2556 The original process is debugged after a fork. The child process runs
2557 unimpeded. This is the default.
2558
2559 @item child
2560 The new process is debugged after a fork. The parent process runs
2561 unimpeded.
2562
2563 @end table
2564
2565 @kindex show follow-fork-mode
2566 @item show follow-fork-mode
2567 Display the current debugger response to a @code{fork} or @code{vfork} call.
2568 @end table
2569
2570 @cindex debugging multiple processes
2571 On Linux, if you want to debug both the parent and child processes, use the
2572 command @w{@code{set detach-on-fork}}.
2573
2574 @table @code
2575 @kindex set detach-on-fork
2576 @item set detach-on-fork @var{mode}
2577 Tells gdb whether to detach one of the processes after a fork, or
2578 retain debugger control over them both.
2579
2580 @table @code
2581 @item on
2582 The child process (or parent process, depending on the value of
2583 @code{follow-fork-mode}) will be detached and allowed to run
2584 independently. This is the default.
2585
2586 @item off
2587 Both processes will be held under the control of @value{GDBN}.
2588 One process (child or parent, depending on the value of
2589 @code{follow-fork-mode}) is debugged as usual, while the other
2590 is held suspended.
2591
2592 @end table
2593
2594 @kindex show detach-on-fork
2595 @item show detach-on-fork
2596 Show whether detach-on-fork mode is on/off.
2597 @end table
2598
2599 If you choose to set @samp{detach-on-fork} mode off, then
2600 @value{GDBN} will retain control of all forked processes (including
2601 nested forks). You can list the forked processes under the control of
2602 @value{GDBN} by using the @w{@code{info forks}} command, and switch
2603 from one fork to another by using the @w{@code{fork}} command.
2604
2605 @table @code
2606 @kindex info forks
2607 @item info forks
2608 Print a list of all forked processes under the control of @value{GDBN}.
2609 The listing will include a fork id, a process id, and the current
2610 position (program counter) of the process.
2611
2612 @kindex fork @var{fork-id}
2613 @item fork @var{fork-id}
2614 Make fork number @var{fork-id} the current process. The argument
2615 @var{fork-id} is the internal fork number assigned by @value{GDBN},
2616 as shown in the first field of the @samp{info forks} display.
2617
2618 @kindex process @var{process-id}
2619 @item process @var{process-id}
2620 Make process number @var{process-id} the current process. The
2621 argument @var{process-id} must be one that is listed in the output of
2622 @samp{info forks}.
2623
2624 @end table
2625
2626 To quit debugging one of the forked processes, you can either detach
2627 from it by using the @w{@code{detach fork}} command (allowing it to
2628 run independently), or delete (and kill) it using the
2629 @w{@code{delete fork}} command.
2630
2631 @table @code
2632 @kindex detach fork @var{fork-id}
2633 @item detach fork @var{fork-id}
2634 Detach from the process identified by @value{GDBN} fork number
2635 @var{fork-id}, and remove it from the fork list. The process will be
2636 allowed to run independently.
2637
2638 @kindex delete fork @var{fork-id}
2639 @item delete fork @var{fork-id}
2640 Kill the process identified by @value{GDBN} fork number @var{fork-id},
2641 and remove it from the fork list.
2642
2643 @end table
2644
2645 If you ask to debug a child process and a @code{vfork} is followed by an
2646 @code{exec}, @value{GDBN} executes the new target up to the first
2647 breakpoint in the new target. If you have a breakpoint set on
2648 @code{main} in your original program, the breakpoint will also be set on
2649 the child process's @code{main}.
2650
2651 When a child process is spawned by @code{vfork}, you cannot debug the
2652 child or parent until an @code{exec} call completes.
2653
2654 If you issue a @code{run} command to @value{GDBN} after an @code{exec}
2655 call executes, the new target restarts. To restart the parent process,
2656 use the @code{file} command with the parent executable name as its
2657 argument.
2658
2659 You can use the @code{catch} command to make @value{GDBN} stop whenever
2660 a @code{fork}, @code{vfork}, or @code{exec} call is made. @xref{Set
2661 Catchpoints, ,Setting Catchpoints}.
2662
2663 @node Checkpoint/Restart
2664 @section Setting a @emph{Bookmark} to Return to Later
2665
2666 @cindex checkpoint
2667 @cindex restart
2668 @cindex bookmark
2669 @cindex snapshot of a process
2670 @cindex rewind program state
2671
2672 On certain operating systems@footnote{Currently, only
2673 @sc{gnu}/Linux.}, @value{GDBN} is able to save a @dfn{snapshot} of a
2674 program's state, called a @dfn{checkpoint}, and come back to it
2675 later.
2676
2677 Returning to a checkpoint effectively undoes everything that has
2678 happened in the program since the @code{checkpoint} was saved. This
2679 includes changes in memory, registers, and even (within some limits)
2680 system state. Effectively, it is like going back in time to the
2681 moment when the checkpoint was saved.
2682
2683 Thus, if you're stepping thru a program and you think you're
2684 getting close to the point where things go wrong, you can save
2685 a checkpoint. Then, if you accidentally go too far and miss
2686 the critical statement, instead of having to restart your program
2687 from the beginning, you can just go back to the checkpoint and
2688 start again from there.
2689
2690 This can be especially useful if it takes a lot of time or
2691 steps to reach the point where you think the bug occurs.
2692
2693 To use the @code{checkpoint}/@code{restart} method of debugging:
2694
2695 @table @code
2696 @kindex checkpoint
2697 @item checkpoint
2698 Save a snapshot of the debugged program's current execution state.
2699 The @code{checkpoint} command takes no arguments, but each checkpoint
2700 is assigned a small integer id, similar to a breakpoint id.
2701
2702 @kindex info checkpoints
2703 @item info checkpoints
2704 List the checkpoints that have been saved in the current debugging
2705 session. For each checkpoint, the following information will be
2706 listed:
2707
2708 @table @code
2709 @item Checkpoint ID
2710 @item Process ID
2711 @item Code Address
2712 @item Source line, or label
2713 @end table
2714
2715 @kindex restart @var{checkpoint-id}
2716 @item restart @var{checkpoint-id}
2717 Restore the program state that was saved as checkpoint number
2718 @var{checkpoint-id}. All program variables, registers, stack frames
2719 etc.@: will be returned to the values that they had when the checkpoint
2720 was saved. In essence, gdb will ``wind back the clock'' to the point
2721 in time when the checkpoint was saved.
2722
2723 Note that breakpoints, @value{GDBN} variables, command history etc.
2724 are not affected by restoring a checkpoint. In general, a checkpoint
2725 only restores things that reside in the program being debugged, not in
2726 the debugger.
2727
2728 @kindex delete checkpoint @var{checkpoint-id}
2729 @item delete checkpoint @var{checkpoint-id}
2730 Delete the previously-saved checkpoint identified by @var{checkpoint-id}.
2731
2732 @end table
2733
2734 Returning to a previously saved checkpoint will restore the user state
2735 of the program being debugged, plus a significant subset of the system
2736 (OS) state, including file pointers. It won't ``un-write'' data from
2737 a file, but it will rewind the file pointer to the previous location,
2738 so that the previously written data can be overwritten. For files
2739 opened in read mode, the pointer will also be restored so that the
2740 previously read data can be read again.
2741
2742 Of course, characters that have been sent to a printer (or other
2743 external device) cannot be ``snatched back'', and characters received
2744 from eg.@: a serial device can be removed from internal program buffers,
2745 but they cannot be ``pushed back'' into the serial pipeline, ready to
2746 be received again. Similarly, the actual contents of files that have
2747 been changed cannot be restored (at this time).
2748
2749 However, within those constraints, you actually can ``rewind'' your
2750 program to a previously saved point in time, and begin debugging it
2751 again --- and you can change the course of events so as to debug a
2752 different execution path this time.
2753
2754 @cindex checkpoints and process id
2755 Finally, there is one bit of internal program state that will be
2756 different when you return to a checkpoint --- the program's process
2757 id. Each checkpoint will have a unique process id (or @var{pid}),
2758 and each will be different from the program's original @var{pid}.
2759 If your program has saved a local copy of its process id, this could
2760 potentially pose a problem.
2761
2762 @subsection A Non-obvious Benefit of Using Checkpoints
2763
2764 On some systems such as @sc{gnu}/Linux, address space randomization
2765 is performed on new processes for security reasons. This makes it
2766 difficult or impossible to set a breakpoint, or watchpoint, on an
2767 absolute address if you have to restart the program, since the
2768 absolute location of a symbol will change from one execution to the
2769 next.
2770
2771 A checkpoint, however, is an @emph{identical} copy of a process.
2772 Therefore if you create a checkpoint at (eg.@:) the start of main,
2773 and simply return to that checkpoint instead of restarting the
2774 process, you can avoid the effects of address randomization and
2775 your symbols will all stay in the same place.
2776
2777 @node Stopping
2778 @chapter Stopping and Continuing
2779
2780 The principal purposes of using a debugger are so that you can stop your
2781 program before it terminates; or so that, if your program runs into
2782 trouble, you can investigate and find out why.
2783
2784 Inside @value{GDBN}, your program may stop for any of several reasons,
2785 such as a signal, a breakpoint, or reaching a new line after a
2786 @value{GDBN} command such as @code{step}. You may then examine and
2787 change variables, set new breakpoints or remove old ones, and then
2788 continue execution. Usually, the messages shown by @value{GDBN} provide
2789 ample explanation of the status of your program---but you can also
2790 explicitly request this information at any time.
2791
2792 @table @code
2793 @kindex info program
2794 @item info program
2795 Display information about the status of your program: whether it is
2796 running or not, what process it is, and why it stopped.
2797 @end table
2798
2799 @menu
2800 * Breakpoints:: Breakpoints, watchpoints, and catchpoints
2801 * Continuing and Stepping:: Resuming execution
2802 * Signals:: Signals
2803 * Thread Stops:: Stopping and starting multi-thread programs
2804 @end menu
2805
2806 @node Breakpoints
2807 @section Breakpoints, Watchpoints, and Catchpoints
2808
2809 @cindex breakpoints
2810 A @dfn{breakpoint} makes your program stop whenever a certain point in
2811 the program is reached. For each breakpoint, you can add conditions to
2812 control in finer detail whether your program stops. You can set
2813 breakpoints with the @code{break} command and its variants (@pxref{Set
2814 Breaks, ,Setting Breakpoints}), to specify the place where your program
2815 should stop by line number, function name or exact address in the
2816 program.
2817
2818 On some systems, you can set breakpoints in shared libraries before
2819 the executable is run. There is a minor limitation on HP-UX systems:
2820 you must wait until the executable is run in order to set breakpoints
2821 in shared library routines that are not called directly by the program
2822 (for example, routines that are arguments in a @code{pthread_create}
2823 call).
2824
2825 @cindex watchpoints
2826 @cindex data breakpoints
2827 @cindex memory tracing
2828 @cindex breakpoint on memory address
2829 @cindex breakpoint on variable modification
2830 A @dfn{watchpoint} is a special breakpoint that stops your program
2831 when the value of an expression changes. The expression may be a value
2832 of a variable, or it could involve values of one or more variables
2833 combined by operators, such as @samp{a + b}. This is sometimes called
2834 @dfn{data breakpoints}. You must use a different command to set
2835 watchpoints (@pxref{Set Watchpoints, ,Setting Watchpoints}), but aside
2836 from that, you can manage a watchpoint like any other breakpoint: you
2837 enable, disable, and delete both breakpoints and watchpoints using the
2838 same commands.
2839
2840 You can arrange to have values from your program displayed automatically
2841 whenever @value{GDBN} stops at a breakpoint. @xref{Auto Display,,
2842 Automatic Display}.
2843
2844 @cindex catchpoints
2845 @cindex breakpoint on events
2846 A @dfn{catchpoint} is another special breakpoint that stops your program
2847 when a certain kind of event occurs, such as the throwing of a C@t{++}
2848 exception or the loading of a library. As with watchpoints, you use a
2849 different command to set a catchpoint (@pxref{Set Catchpoints, ,Setting
2850 Catchpoints}), but aside from that, you can manage a catchpoint like any
2851 other breakpoint. (To stop when your program receives a signal, use the
2852 @code{handle} command; see @ref{Signals, ,Signals}.)
2853
2854 @cindex breakpoint numbers
2855 @cindex numbers for breakpoints
2856 @value{GDBN} assigns a number to each breakpoint, watchpoint, or
2857 catchpoint when you create it; these numbers are successive integers
2858 starting with one. In many of the commands for controlling various
2859 features of breakpoints you use the breakpoint number to say which
2860 breakpoint you want to change. Each breakpoint may be @dfn{enabled} or
2861 @dfn{disabled}; if disabled, it has no effect on your program until you
2862 enable it again.
2863
2864 @cindex breakpoint ranges
2865 @cindex ranges of breakpoints
2866 Some @value{GDBN} commands accept a range of breakpoints on which to
2867 operate. A breakpoint range is either a single breakpoint number, like
2868 @samp{5}, or two such numbers, in increasing order, separated by a
2869 hyphen, like @samp{5-7}. When a breakpoint range is given to a command,
2870 all breakpoints in that range are operated on.
2871
2872 @menu
2873 * Set Breaks:: Setting breakpoints
2874 * Set Watchpoints:: Setting watchpoints
2875 * Set Catchpoints:: Setting catchpoints
2876 * Delete Breaks:: Deleting breakpoints
2877 * Disabling:: Disabling breakpoints
2878 * Conditions:: Break conditions
2879 * Break Commands:: Breakpoint command lists
2880 * Error in Breakpoints:: ``Cannot insert breakpoints''
2881 * Breakpoint-related Warnings:: ``Breakpoint address adjusted...''
2882 @end menu
2883
2884 @node Set Breaks
2885 @subsection Setting Breakpoints
2886
2887 @c FIXME LMB what does GDB do if no code on line of breakpt?
2888 @c consider in particular declaration with/without initialization.
2889 @c
2890 @c FIXME 2 is there stuff on this already? break at fun start, already init?
2891
2892 @kindex break
2893 @kindex b @r{(@code{break})}
2894 @vindex $bpnum@r{, convenience variable}
2895 @cindex latest breakpoint
2896 Breakpoints are set with the @code{break} command (abbreviated
2897 @code{b}). The debugger convenience variable @samp{$bpnum} records the
2898 number of the breakpoint you've set most recently; see @ref{Convenience
2899 Vars,, Convenience Variables}, for a discussion of what you can do with
2900 convenience variables.
2901
2902 @table @code
2903 @item break @var{location}
2904 Set a breakpoint at the given @var{location}, which can specify a
2905 function name, a line number, or an address of an instruction.
2906 (@xref{Specify Location}, for a list of all the possible ways to
2907 specify a @var{location}.) The breakpoint will stop your program just
2908 before it executes any of the code in the specified @var{location}.
2909
2910 When using source languages that permit overloading of symbols, such as
2911 C@t{++}, a function name may refer to more than one possible place to break.
2912 @xref{Ambiguous Expressions,,Ambiguous Expressions}, for a discussion of
2913 that situation.
2914
2915 @item break
2916 When called without any arguments, @code{break} sets a breakpoint at
2917 the next instruction to be executed in the selected stack frame
2918 (@pxref{Stack, ,Examining the Stack}). In any selected frame but the
2919 innermost, this makes your program stop as soon as control
2920 returns to that frame. This is similar to the effect of a
2921 @code{finish} command in the frame inside the selected frame---except
2922 that @code{finish} does not leave an active breakpoint. If you use
2923 @code{break} without an argument in the innermost frame, @value{GDBN} stops
2924 the next time it reaches the current location; this may be useful
2925 inside loops.
2926
2927 @value{GDBN} normally ignores breakpoints when it resumes execution, until at
2928 least one instruction has been executed. If it did not do this, you
2929 would be unable to proceed past a breakpoint without first disabling the
2930 breakpoint. This rule applies whether or not the breakpoint already
2931 existed when your program stopped.
2932
2933 @item break @dots{} if @var{cond}
2934 Set a breakpoint with condition @var{cond}; evaluate the expression
2935 @var{cond} each time the breakpoint is reached, and stop only if the
2936 value is nonzero---that is, if @var{cond} evaluates as true.
2937 @samp{@dots{}} stands for one of the possible arguments described
2938 above (or no argument) specifying where to break. @xref{Conditions,
2939 ,Break Conditions}, for more information on breakpoint conditions.
2940
2941 @kindex tbreak
2942 @item tbreak @var{args}
2943 Set a breakpoint enabled only for one stop. @var{args} are the
2944 same as for the @code{break} command, and the breakpoint is set in the same
2945 way, but the breakpoint is automatically deleted after the first time your
2946 program stops there. @xref{Disabling, ,Disabling Breakpoints}.
2947
2948 @kindex hbreak
2949 @cindex hardware breakpoints
2950 @item hbreak @var{args}
2951 Set a hardware-assisted breakpoint. @var{args} are the same as for the
2952 @code{break} command and the breakpoint is set in the same way, but the
2953 breakpoint requires hardware support and some target hardware may not
2954 have this support. The main purpose of this is EPROM/ROM code
2955 debugging, so you can set a breakpoint at an instruction without
2956 changing the instruction. This can be used with the new trap-generation
2957 provided by SPARClite DSU and most x86-based targets. These targets
2958 will generate traps when a program accesses some data or instruction
2959 address that is assigned to the debug registers. However the hardware
2960 breakpoint registers can take a limited number of breakpoints. For
2961 example, on the DSU, only two data breakpoints can be set at a time, and
2962 @value{GDBN} will reject this command if more than two are used. Delete
2963 or disable unused hardware breakpoints before setting new ones
2964 (@pxref{Disabling, ,Disabling Breakpoints}).
2965 @xref{Conditions, ,Break Conditions}.
2966 For remote targets, you can restrict the number of hardware
2967 breakpoints @value{GDBN} will use, see @ref{set remote
2968 hardware-breakpoint-limit}.
2969
2970 @kindex thbreak
2971 @item thbreak @var{args}
2972 Set a hardware-assisted breakpoint enabled only for one stop. @var{args}
2973 are the same as for the @code{hbreak} command and the breakpoint is set in
2974 the same way. However, like the @code{tbreak} command,
2975 the breakpoint is automatically deleted after the
2976 first time your program stops there. Also, like the @code{hbreak}
2977 command, the breakpoint requires hardware support and some target hardware
2978 may not have this support. @xref{Disabling, ,Disabling Breakpoints}.
2979 See also @ref{Conditions, ,Break Conditions}.
2980
2981 @kindex rbreak
2982 @cindex regular expression
2983 @cindex breakpoints in functions matching a regexp
2984 @cindex set breakpoints in many functions
2985 @item rbreak @var{regex}
2986 Set breakpoints on all functions matching the regular expression
2987 @var{regex}. This command sets an unconditional breakpoint on all
2988 matches, printing a list of all breakpoints it set. Once these
2989 breakpoints are set, they are treated just like the breakpoints set with
2990 the @code{break} command. You can delete them, disable them, or make
2991 them conditional the same way as any other breakpoint.
2992
2993 The syntax of the regular expression is the standard one used with tools
2994 like @file{grep}. Note that this is different from the syntax used by
2995 shells, so for instance @code{foo*} matches all functions that include
2996 an @code{fo} followed by zero or more @code{o}s. There is an implicit
2997 @code{.*} leading and trailing the regular expression you supply, so to
2998 match only functions that begin with @code{foo}, use @code{^foo}.
2999
3000 @cindex non-member C@t{++} functions, set breakpoint in
3001 When debugging C@t{++} programs, @code{rbreak} is useful for setting
3002 breakpoints on overloaded functions that are not members of any special
3003 classes.
3004
3005 @cindex set breakpoints on all functions
3006 The @code{rbreak} command can be used to set breakpoints in
3007 @strong{all} the functions in a program, like this:
3008
3009 @smallexample
3010 (@value{GDBP}) rbreak .
3011 @end smallexample
3012
3013 @kindex info breakpoints
3014 @cindex @code{$_} and @code{info breakpoints}
3015 @item info breakpoints @r{[}@var{n}@r{]}
3016 @itemx info break @r{[}@var{n}@r{]}
3017 @itemx info watchpoints @r{[}@var{n}@r{]}
3018 Print a table of all breakpoints, watchpoints, and catchpoints set and
3019 not deleted. Optional argument @var{n} means print information only
3020 about the specified breakpoint (or watchpoint or catchpoint). For
3021 each breakpoint, following columns are printed:
3022
3023 @table @emph
3024 @item Breakpoint Numbers
3025 @item Type
3026 Breakpoint, watchpoint, or catchpoint.
3027 @item Disposition
3028 Whether the breakpoint is marked to be disabled or deleted when hit.
3029 @item Enabled or Disabled
3030 Enabled breakpoints are marked with @samp{y}. @samp{n} marks breakpoints
3031 that are not enabled.
3032 @item Address
3033 Where the breakpoint is in your program, as a memory address. For a
3034 pending breakpoint whose address is not yet known, this field will
3035 contain @samp{<PENDING>}. Such breakpoint won't fire until a shared
3036 library that has the symbol or line referred by breakpoint is loaded.
3037 See below for details. A breakpoint with several locations will
3038 have @samp{<MULTIPLE>} in this field---see below for details.
3039 @item What
3040 Where the breakpoint is in the source for your program, as a file and
3041 line number. For a pending breakpoint, the original string passed to
3042 the breakpoint command will be listed as it cannot be resolved until
3043 the appropriate shared library is loaded in the future.
3044 @end table
3045
3046 @noindent
3047 If a breakpoint is conditional, @code{info break} shows the condition on
3048 the line following the affected breakpoint; breakpoint commands, if any,
3049 are listed after that. A pending breakpoint is allowed to have a condition
3050 specified for it. The condition is not parsed for validity until a shared
3051 library is loaded that allows the pending breakpoint to resolve to a
3052 valid location.
3053
3054 @noindent
3055 @code{info break} with a breakpoint
3056 number @var{n} as argument lists only that breakpoint. The
3057 convenience variable @code{$_} and the default examining-address for
3058 the @code{x} command are set to the address of the last breakpoint
3059 listed (@pxref{Memory, ,Examining Memory}).
3060
3061 @noindent
3062 @code{info break} displays a count of the number of times the breakpoint
3063 has been hit. This is especially useful in conjunction with the
3064 @code{ignore} command. You can ignore a large number of breakpoint
3065 hits, look at the breakpoint info to see how many times the breakpoint
3066 was hit, and then run again, ignoring one less than that number. This
3067 will get you quickly to the last hit of that breakpoint.
3068 @end table
3069
3070 @value{GDBN} allows you to set any number of breakpoints at the same place in
3071 your program. There is nothing silly or meaningless about this. When
3072 the breakpoints are conditional, this is even useful
3073 (@pxref{Conditions, ,Break Conditions}).
3074
3075 @cindex multiple locations, breakpoints
3076 @cindex breakpoints, multiple locations
3077 It is possible that a breakpoint corresponds to several locations
3078 in your program. Examples of this situation are:
3079
3080 @itemize @bullet
3081 @item
3082 For a C@t{++} constructor, the @value{NGCC} compiler generates several
3083 instances of the function body, used in different cases.
3084
3085 @item
3086 For a C@t{++} template function, a given line in the function can
3087 correspond to any number of instantiations.
3088
3089 @item
3090 For an inlined function, a given source line can correspond to
3091 several places where that function is inlined.
3092 @end itemize
3093
3094 In all those cases, @value{GDBN} will insert a breakpoint at all
3095 the relevant locations@footnote{
3096 As of this writing, multiple-location breakpoints work only if there's
3097 line number information for all the locations. This means that they
3098 will generally not work in system libraries, unless you have debug
3099 info with line numbers for them.}.
3100
3101 A breakpoint with multiple locations is displayed in the breakpoint
3102 table using several rows---one header row, followed by one row for
3103 each breakpoint location. The header row has @samp{<MULTIPLE>} in the
3104 address column. The rows for individual locations contain the actual
3105 addresses for locations, and show the functions to which those
3106 locations belong. The number column for a location is of the form
3107 @var{breakpoint-number}.@var{location-number}.
3108
3109 For example:
3110
3111 @smallexample
3112 Num Type Disp Enb Address What
3113 1 breakpoint keep y <MULTIPLE>
3114 stop only if i==1
3115 breakpoint already hit 1 time
3116 1.1 y 0x080486a2 in void foo<int>() at t.cc:8
3117 1.2 y 0x080486ca in void foo<double>() at t.cc:8
3118 @end smallexample
3119
3120 Each location can be individually enabled or disabled by passing
3121 @var{breakpoint-number}.@var{location-number} as argument to the
3122 @code{enable} and @code{disable} commands. Note that you cannot
3123 delete the individual locations from the list, you can only delete the
3124 entire list of locations that belong to their parent breakpoint (with
3125 the @kbd{delete @var{num}} command, where @var{num} is the number of
3126 the parent breakpoint, 1 in the above example). Disabling or enabling
3127 the parent breakpoint (@pxref{Disabling}) affects all of the locations
3128 that belong to that breakpoint.
3129
3130 @cindex pending breakpoints
3131 It's quite common to have a breakpoint inside a shared library.
3132 Shared libraries can be loaded and unloaded explicitly,
3133 and possibly repeatedly, as the program is executed. To support
3134 this use case, @value{GDBN} updates breakpoint locations whenever
3135 any shared library is loaded or unloaded. Typically, you would
3136 set a breakpoint in a shared library at the beginning of your
3137 debugging session, when the library is not loaded, and when the
3138 symbols from the library are not available. When you try to set
3139 breakpoint, @value{GDBN} will ask you if you want to set
3140 a so called @dfn{pending breakpoint}---breakpoint whose address
3141 is not yet resolved.
3142
3143 After the program is run, whenever a new shared library is loaded,
3144 @value{GDBN} reevaluates all the breakpoints. When a newly loaded
3145 shared library contains the symbol or line referred to by some
3146 pending breakpoint, that breakpoint is resolved and becomes an
3147 ordinary breakpoint. When a library is unloaded, all breakpoints
3148 that refer to its symbols or source lines become pending again.
3149
3150 This logic works for breakpoints with multiple locations, too. For
3151 example, if you have a breakpoint in a C@t{++} template function, and
3152 a newly loaded shared library has an instantiation of that template,
3153 a new location is added to the list of locations for the breakpoint.
3154
3155 Except for having unresolved address, pending breakpoints do not
3156 differ from regular breakpoints. You can set conditions or commands,
3157 enable and disable them and perform other breakpoint operations.
3158
3159 @value{GDBN} provides some additional commands for controlling what
3160 happens when the @samp{break} command cannot resolve breakpoint
3161 address specification to an address:
3162
3163 @kindex set breakpoint pending
3164 @kindex show breakpoint pending
3165 @table @code
3166 @item set breakpoint pending auto
3167 This is the default behavior. When @value{GDBN} cannot find the breakpoint
3168 location, it queries you whether a pending breakpoint should be created.
3169
3170 @item set breakpoint pending on
3171 This indicates that an unrecognized breakpoint location should automatically
3172 result in a pending breakpoint being created.
3173
3174 @item set breakpoint pending off
3175 This indicates that pending breakpoints are not to be created. Any
3176 unrecognized breakpoint location results in an error. This setting does
3177 not affect any pending breakpoints previously created.
3178
3179 @item show breakpoint pending
3180 Show the current behavior setting for creating pending breakpoints.
3181 @end table
3182
3183 The settings above only affect the @code{break} command and its
3184 variants. Once breakpoint is set, it will be automatically updated
3185 as shared libraries are loaded and unloaded.
3186
3187 @cindex automatic hardware breakpoints
3188 For some targets, @value{GDBN} can automatically decide if hardware or
3189 software breakpoints should be used, depending on whether the
3190 breakpoint address is read-only or read-write. This applies to
3191 breakpoints set with the @code{break} command as well as to internal
3192 breakpoints set by commands like @code{next} and @code{finish}. For
3193 breakpoints set with @code{hbreak}, @value{GDBN} will always use hardware
3194 breakpoints.
3195
3196 You can control this automatic behaviour with the following commands::
3197
3198 @kindex set breakpoint auto-hw
3199 @kindex show breakpoint auto-hw
3200 @table @code
3201 @item set breakpoint auto-hw on
3202 This is the default behavior. When @value{GDBN} sets a breakpoint, it
3203 will try to use the target memory map to decide if software or hardware
3204 breakpoint must be used.
3205
3206 @item set breakpoint auto-hw off
3207 This indicates @value{GDBN} should not automatically select breakpoint
3208 type. If the target provides a memory map, @value{GDBN} will warn when
3209 trying to set software breakpoint at a read-only address.
3210 @end table
3211
3212
3213 @cindex negative breakpoint numbers
3214 @cindex internal @value{GDBN} breakpoints
3215 @value{GDBN} itself sometimes sets breakpoints in your program for
3216 special purposes, such as proper handling of @code{longjmp} (in C
3217 programs). These internal breakpoints are assigned negative numbers,
3218 starting with @code{-1}; @samp{info breakpoints} does not display them.
3219 You can see these breakpoints with the @value{GDBN} maintenance command
3220 @samp{maint info breakpoints} (@pxref{maint info breakpoints}).
3221
3222
3223 @node Set Watchpoints
3224 @subsection Setting Watchpoints
3225
3226 @cindex setting watchpoints
3227 You can use a watchpoint to stop execution whenever the value of an
3228 expression changes, without having to predict a particular place where
3229 this may happen. (This is sometimes called a @dfn{data breakpoint}.)
3230 The expression may be as simple as the value of a single variable, or
3231 as complex as many variables combined by operators. Examples include:
3232
3233 @itemize @bullet
3234 @item
3235 A reference to the value of a single variable.
3236
3237 @item
3238 An address cast to an appropriate data type. For example,
3239 @samp{*(int *)0x12345678} will watch a 4-byte region at the specified
3240 address (assuming an @code{int} occupies 4 bytes).
3241
3242 @item
3243 An arbitrarily complex expression, such as @samp{a*b + c/d}. The
3244 expression can use any operators valid in the program's native
3245 language (@pxref{Languages}).
3246 @end itemize
3247
3248 You can set a watchpoint on an expression even if the expression can
3249 not be evaluated yet. For instance, you can set a watchpoint on
3250 @samp{*global_ptr} before @samp{global_ptr} is initialized.
3251 @value{GDBN} will stop when your program sets @samp{global_ptr} and
3252 the expression produces a valid value. If the expression becomes
3253 valid in some other way than changing a variable (e.g.@: if the memory
3254 pointed to by @samp{*global_ptr} becomes readable as the result of a
3255 @code{malloc} call), @value{GDBN} may not stop until the next time
3256 the expression changes.
3257
3258 @cindex software watchpoints
3259 @cindex hardware watchpoints
3260 Depending on your system, watchpoints may be implemented in software or
3261 hardware. @value{GDBN} does software watchpointing by single-stepping your
3262 program and testing the variable's value each time, which is hundreds of
3263 times slower than normal execution. (But this may still be worth it, to
3264 catch errors where you have no clue what part of your program is the
3265 culprit.)
3266
3267 On some systems, such as HP-UX, PowerPC, @sc{gnu}/Linux and most other
3268 x86-based targets, @value{GDBN} includes support for hardware
3269 watchpoints, which do not slow down the running of your program.
3270
3271 @table @code
3272 @kindex watch
3273 @item watch @var{expr} @r{[}thread @var{threadnum}@r{]}
3274 Set a watchpoint for an expression. @value{GDBN} will break when the
3275 expression @var{expr} is written into by the program and its value
3276 changes. The simplest (and the most popular) use of this command is
3277 to watch the value of a single variable:
3278
3279 @smallexample
3280 (@value{GDBP}) watch foo
3281 @end smallexample
3282
3283 If the command includes a @code{@r{[}thread @var{threadnum}@r{]}}
3284 clause, @value{GDBN} breaks only when the thread identified by
3285 @var{threadnum} changes the value of @var{expr}. If any other threads
3286 change the value of @var{expr}, @value{GDBN} will not break. Note
3287 that watchpoints restricted to a single thread in this way only work
3288 with Hardware Watchpoints.
3289
3290 @kindex rwatch
3291 @item rwatch @var{expr} @r{[}thread @var{threadnum}@r{]}
3292 Set a watchpoint that will break when the value of @var{expr} is read
3293 by the program.
3294
3295 @kindex awatch
3296 @item awatch @var{expr} @r{[}thread @var{threadnum}@r{]}
3297 Set a watchpoint that will break when @var{expr} is either read from
3298 or written into by the program.
3299
3300 @kindex info watchpoints @r{[}@var{n}@r{]}
3301 @item info watchpoints
3302 This command prints a list of watchpoints, breakpoints, and catchpoints;
3303 it is the same as @code{info break} (@pxref{Set Breaks}).
3304 @end table
3305
3306 @value{GDBN} sets a @dfn{hardware watchpoint} if possible. Hardware
3307 watchpoints execute very quickly, and the debugger reports a change in
3308 value at the exact instruction where the change occurs. If @value{GDBN}
3309 cannot set a hardware watchpoint, it sets a software watchpoint, which
3310 executes more slowly and reports the change in value at the next
3311 @emph{statement}, not the instruction, after the change occurs.
3312
3313 @cindex use only software watchpoints
3314 You can force @value{GDBN} to use only software watchpoints with the
3315 @kbd{set can-use-hw-watchpoints 0} command. With this variable set to
3316 zero, @value{GDBN} will never try to use hardware watchpoints, even if
3317 the underlying system supports them. (Note that hardware-assisted
3318 watchpoints that were set @emph{before} setting
3319 @code{can-use-hw-watchpoints} to zero will still use the hardware
3320 mechanism of watching expression values.)
3321
3322 @table @code
3323 @item set can-use-hw-watchpoints
3324 @kindex set can-use-hw-watchpoints
3325 Set whether or not to use hardware watchpoints.
3326
3327 @item show can-use-hw-watchpoints
3328 @kindex show can-use-hw-watchpoints
3329 Show the current mode of using hardware watchpoints.
3330 @end table
3331
3332 For remote targets, you can restrict the number of hardware
3333 watchpoints @value{GDBN} will use, see @ref{set remote
3334 hardware-breakpoint-limit}.
3335
3336 When you issue the @code{watch} command, @value{GDBN} reports
3337
3338 @smallexample
3339 Hardware watchpoint @var{num}: @var{expr}
3340 @end smallexample
3341
3342 @noindent
3343 if it was able to set a hardware watchpoint.
3344
3345 Currently, the @code{awatch} and @code{rwatch} commands can only set
3346 hardware watchpoints, because accesses to data that don't change the
3347 value of the watched expression cannot be detected without examining
3348 every instruction as it is being executed, and @value{GDBN} does not do
3349 that currently. If @value{GDBN} finds that it is unable to set a
3350 hardware breakpoint with the @code{awatch} or @code{rwatch} command, it
3351 will print a message like this:
3352
3353 @smallexample
3354 Expression cannot be implemented with read/access watchpoint.
3355 @end smallexample
3356
3357 Sometimes, @value{GDBN} cannot set a hardware watchpoint because the
3358 data type of the watched expression is wider than what a hardware
3359 watchpoint on the target machine can handle. For example, some systems
3360 can only watch regions that are up to 4 bytes wide; on such systems you
3361 cannot set hardware watchpoints for an expression that yields a
3362 double-precision floating-point number (which is typically 8 bytes
3363 wide). As a work-around, it might be possible to break the large region
3364 into a series of smaller ones and watch them with separate watchpoints.
3365
3366 If you set too many hardware watchpoints, @value{GDBN} might be unable
3367 to insert all of them when you resume the execution of your program.
3368 Since the precise number of active watchpoints is unknown until such
3369 time as the program is about to be resumed, @value{GDBN} might not be
3370 able to warn you about this when you set the watchpoints, and the
3371 warning will be printed only when the program is resumed:
3372
3373 @smallexample
3374 Hardware watchpoint @var{num}: Could not insert watchpoint
3375 @end smallexample
3376
3377 @noindent
3378 If this happens, delete or disable some of the watchpoints.
3379
3380 Watching complex expressions that reference many variables can also
3381 exhaust the resources available for hardware-assisted watchpoints.
3382 That's because @value{GDBN} needs to watch every variable in the
3383 expression with separately allocated resources.
3384
3385 If you call a function interactively using @code{print} or @code{call},
3386 any watchpoints you have set will be inactive until @value{GDBN} reaches another
3387 kind of breakpoint or the call completes.
3388
3389 @value{GDBN} automatically deletes watchpoints that watch local
3390 (automatic) variables, or expressions that involve such variables, when
3391 they go out of scope, that is, when the execution leaves the block in
3392 which these variables were defined. In particular, when the program
3393 being debugged terminates, @emph{all} local variables go out of scope,
3394 and so only watchpoints that watch global variables remain set. If you
3395 rerun the program, you will need to set all such watchpoints again. One
3396 way of doing that would be to set a code breakpoint at the entry to the
3397 @code{main} function and when it breaks, set all the watchpoints.
3398
3399 @cindex watchpoints and threads
3400 @cindex threads and watchpoints
3401 In multi-threaded programs, watchpoints will detect changes to the
3402 watched expression from every thread.
3403
3404 @quotation
3405 @emph{Warning:} In multi-threaded programs, software watchpoints
3406 have only limited usefulness. If @value{GDBN} creates a software
3407 watchpoint, it can only watch the value of an expression @emph{in a
3408 single thread}. If you are confident that the expression can only
3409 change due to the current thread's activity (and if you are also
3410 confident that no other thread can become current), then you can use
3411 software watchpoints as usual. However, @value{GDBN} may not notice
3412 when a non-current thread's activity changes the expression. (Hardware
3413 watchpoints, in contrast, watch an expression in all threads.)
3414 @end quotation
3415
3416 @xref{set remote hardware-watchpoint-limit}.
3417
3418 @node Set Catchpoints
3419 @subsection Setting Catchpoints
3420 @cindex catchpoints, setting
3421 @cindex exception handlers
3422 @cindex event handling
3423
3424 You can use @dfn{catchpoints} to cause the debugger to stop for certain
3425 kinds of program events, such as C@t{++} exceptions or the loading of a
3426 shared library. Use the @code{catch} command to set a catchpoint.
3427
3428 @table @code
3429 @kindex catch
3430 @item catch @var{event}
3431 Stop when @var{event} occurs. @var{event} can be any of the following:
3432 @table @code
3433 @item throw
3434 @cindex stop on C@t{++} exceptions
3435 The throwing of a C@t{++} exception.
3436
3437 @item catch
3438 The catching of a C@t{++} exception.
3439
3440 @item exception
3441 @cindex Ada exception catching
3442 @cindex catch Ada exceptions
3443 An Ada exception being raised. If an exception name is specified
3444 at the end of the command (eg @code{catch exception Program_Error}),
3445 the debugger will stop only when this specific exception is raised.
3446 Otherwise, the debugger stops execution when any Ada exception is raised.
3447
3448 @item exception unhandled
3449 An exception that was raised but is not handled by the program.
3450
3451 @item assert
3452 A failed Ada assertion.
3453
3454 @item exec
3455 @cindex break on fork/exec
3456 A call to @code{exec}. This is currently only available for HP-UX
3457 and @sc{gnu}/Linux.
3458
3459 @item fork
3460 A call to @code{fork}. This is currently only available for HP-UX
3461 and @sc{gnu}/Linux.
3462
3463 @item vfork
3464 A call to @code{vfork}. This is currently only available for HP-UX
3465 and @sc{gnu}/Linux.
3466
3467 @item load
3468 @itemx load @var{libname}
3469 @cindex break on load/unload of shared library
3470 The dynamic loading of any shared library, or the loading of the library
3471 @var{libname}. This is currently only available for HP-UX.
3472
3473 @item unload
3474 @itemx unload @var{libname}
3475 The unloading of any dynamically loaded shared library, or the unloading
3476 of the library @var{libname}. This is currently only available for HP-UX.
3477 @end table
3478
3479 @item tcatch @var{event}
3480 Set a catchpoint that is enabled only for one stop. The catchpoint is
3481 automatically deleted after the first time the event is caught.
3482
3483 @end table
3484
3485 Use the @code{info break} command to list the current catchpoints.
3486
3487 There are currently some limitations to C@t{++} exception handling
3488 (@code{catch throw} and @code{catch catch}) in @value{GDBN}:
3489
3490 @itemize @bullet
3491 @item
3492 If you call a function interactively, @value{GDBN} normally returns
3493 control to you when the function has finished executing. If the call
3494 raises an exception, however, the call may bypass the mechanism that
3495 returns control to you and cause your program either to abort or to
3496 simply continue running until it hits a breakpoint, catches a signal
3497 that @value{GDBN} is listening for, or exits. This is the case even if
3498 you set a catchpoint for the exception; catchpoints on exceptions are
3499 disabled within interactive calls.
3500
3501 @item
3502 You cannot raise an exception interactively.
3503
3504 @item
3505 You cannot install an exception handler interactively.
3506 @end itemize
3507
3508 @cindex raise exceptions
3509 Sometimes @code{catch} is not the best way to debug exception handling:
3510 if you need to know exactly where an exception is raised, it is better to
3511 stop @emph{before} the exception handler is called, since that way you
3512 can see the stack before any unwinding takes place. If you set a
3513 breakpoint in an exception handler instead, it may not be easy to find
3514 out where the exception was raised.
3515
3516 To stop just before an exception handler is called, you need some
3517 knowledge of the implementation. In the case of @sc{gnu} C@t{++}, exceptions are
3518 raised by calling a library function named @code{__raise_exception}
3519 which has the following ANSI C interface:
3520
3521 @smallexample
3522 /* @var{addr} is where the exception identifier is stored.
3523 @var{id} is the exception identifier. */
3524 void __raise_exception (void **addr, void *id);
3525 @end smallexample
3526
3527 @noindent
3528 To make the debugger catch all exceptions before any stack
3529 unwinding takes place, set a breakpoint on @code{__raise_exception}
3530 (@pxref{Breakpoints, ,Breakpoints; Watchpoints; and Exceptions}).
3531
3532 With a conditional breakpoint (@pxref{Conditions, ,Break Conditions})
3533 that depends on the value of @var{id}, you can stop your program when
3534 a specific exception is raised. You can use multiple conditional
3535 breakpoints to stop your program when any of a number of exceptions are
3536 raised.
3537
3538
3539 @node Delete Breaks
3540 @subsection Deleting Breakpoints
3541
3542 @cindex clearing breakpoints, watchpoints, catchpoints
3543 @cindex deleting breakpoints, watchpoints, catchpoints
3544 It is often necessary to eliminate a breakpoint, watchpoint, or
3545 catchpoint once it has done its job and you no longer want your program
3546 to stop there. This is called @dfn{deleting} the breakpoint. A
3547 breakpoint that has been deleted no longer exists; it is forgotten.
3548
3549 With the @code{clear} command you can delete breakpoints according to
3550 where they are in your program. With the @code{delete} command you can
3551 delete individual breakpoints, watchpoints, or catchpoints by specifying
3552 their breakpoint numbers.
3553
3554 It is not necessary to delete a breakpoint to proceed past it. @value{GDBN}
3555 automatically ignores breakpoints on the first instruction to be executed
3556 when you continue execution without changing the execution address.
3557
3558 @table @code
3559 @kindex clear
3560 @item clear
3561 Delete any breakpoints at the next instruction to be executed in the
3562 selected stack frame (@pxref{Selection, ,Selecting a Frame}). When
3563 the innermost frame is selected, this is a good way to delete a
3564 breakpoint where your program just stopped.
3565
3566 @item clear @var{location}
3567 Delete any breakpoints set at the specified @var{location}.
3568 @xref{Specify Location}, for the various forms of @var{location}; the
3569 most useful ones are listed below:
3570
3571 @table @code
3572 @item clear @var{function}
3573 @itemx clear @var{filename}:@var{function}
3574 Delete any breakpoints set at entry to the named @var{function}.
3575
3576 @item clear @var{linenum}
3577 @itemx clear @var{filename}:@var{linenum}
3578 Delete any breakpoints set at or within the code of the specified
3579 @var{linenum} of the specified @var{filename}.
3580 @end table
3581
3582 @cindex delete breakpoints
3583 @kindex delete
3584 @kindex d @r{(@code{delete})}
3585 @item delete @r{[}breakpoints@r{]} @r{[}@var{range}@dots{}@r{]}
3586 Delete the breakpoints, watchpoints, or catchpoints of the breakpoint
3587 ranges specified as arguments. If no argument is specified, delete all
3588 breakpoints (@value{GDBN} asks confirmation, unless you have @code{set
3589 confirm off}). You can abbreviate this command as @code{d}.
3590 @end table
3591
3592 @node Disabling
3593 @subsection Disabling Breakpoints
3594
3595 @cindex enable/disable a breakpoint
3596 Rather than deleting a breakpoint, watchpoint, or catchpoint, you might
3597 prefer to @dfn{disable} it. This makes the breakpoint inoperative as if
3598 it had been deleted, but remembers the information on the breakpoint so
3599 that you can @dfn{enable} it again later.
3600
3601 You disable and enable breakpoints, watchpoints, and catchpoints with
3602 the @code{enable} and @code{disable} commands, optionally specifying one
3603 or more breakpoint numbers as arguments. Use @code{info break} or
3604 @code{info watch} to print a list of breakpoints, watchpoints, and
3605 catchpoints if you do not know which numbers to use.
3606
3607 Disabling and enabling a breakpoint that has multiple locations
3608 affects all of its locations.
3609
3610 A breakpoint, watchpoint, or catchpoint can have any of four different
3611 states of enablement:
3612
3613 @itemize @bullet
3614 @item
3615 Enabled. The breakpoint stops your program. A breakpoint set
3616 with the @code{break} command starts out in this state.
3617 @item
3618 Disabled. The breakpoint has no effect on your program.
3619 @item
3620 Enabled once. The breakpoint stops your program, but then becomes
3621 disabled.
3622 @item
3623 Enabled for deletion. The breakpoint stops your program, but
3624 immediately after it does so it is deleted permanently. A breakpoint
3625 set with the @code{tbreak} command starts out in this state.
3626 @end itemize
3627
3628 You can use the following commands to enable or disable breakpoints,
3629 watchpoints, and catchpoints:
3630
3631 @table @code
3632 @kindex disable
3633 @kindex dis @r{(@code{disable})}
3634 @item disable @r{[}breakpoints@r{]} @r{[}@var{range}@dots{}@r{]}
3635 Disable the specified breakpoints---or all breakpoints, if none are
3636 listed. A disabled breakpoint has no effect but is not forgotten. All
3637 options such as ignore-counts, conditions and commands are remembered in
3638 case the breakpoint is enabled again later. You may abbreviate
3639 @code{disable} as @code{dis}.
3640
3641 @kindex enable
3642 @item enable @r{[}breakpoints@r{]} @r{[}@var{range}@dots{}@r{]}
3643 Enable the specified breakpoints (or all defined breakpoints). They
3644 become effective once again in stopping your program.
3645
3646 @item enable @r{[}breakpoints@r{]} once @var{range}@dots{}
3647 Enable the specified breakpoints temporarily. @value{GDBN} disables any
3648 of these breakpoints immediately after stopping your program.
3649
3650 @item enable @r{[}breakpoints@r{]} delete @var{range}@dots{}
3651 Enable the specified breakpoints to work once, then die. @value{GDBN}
3652 deletes any of these breakpoints as soon as your program stops there.
3653 Breakpoints set by the @code{tbreak} command start out in this state.
3654 @end table
3655
3656 @c FIXME: I think the following ``Except for [...] @code{tbreak}'' is
3657 @c confusing: tbreak is also initially enabled.
3658 Except for a breakpoint set with @code{tbreak} (@pxref{Set Breaks,
3659 ,Setting Breakpoints}), breakpoints that you set are initially enabled;
3660 subsequently, they become disabled or enabled only when you use one of
3661 the commands above. (The command @code{until} can set and delete a
3662 breakpoint of its own, but it does not change the state of your other
3663 breakpoints; see @ref{Continuing and Stepping, ,Continuing and
3664 Stepping}.)
3665
3666 @node Conditions
3667 @subsection Break Conditions
3668 @cindex conditional breakpoints
3669 @cindex breakpoint conditions
3670
3671 @c FIXME what is scope of break condition expr? Context where wanted?
3672 @c in particular for a watchpoint?
3673 The simplest sort of breakpoint breaks every time your program reaches a
3674 specified place. You can also specify a @dfn{condition} for a
3675 breakpoint. A condition is just a Boolean expression in your
3676 programming language (@pxref{Expressions, ,Expressions}). A breakpoint with
3677 a condition evaluates the expression each time your program reaches it,
3678 and your program stops only if the condition is @emph{true}.
3679
3680 This is the converse of using assertions for program validation; in that
3681 situation, you want to stop when the assertion is violated---that is,
3682 when the condition is false. In C, if you want to test an assertion expressed
3683 by the condition @var{assert}, you should set the condition
3684 @samp{! @var{assert}} on the appropriate breakpoint.
3685
3686 Conditions are also accepted for watchpoints; you may not need them,
3687 since a watchpoint is inspecting the value of an expression anyhow---but
3688 it might be simpler, say, to just set a watchpoint on a variable name,
3689 and specify a condition that tests whether the new value is an interesting
3690 one.
3691
3692 Break conditions can have side effects, and may even call functions in
3693 your program. This can be useful, for example, to activate functions
3694 that log program progress, or to use your own print functions to
3695 format special data structures. The effects are completely predictable
3696 unless there is another enabled breakpoint at the same address. (In
3697 that case, @value{GDBN} might see the other breakpoint first and stop your
3698 program without checking the condition of this one.) Note that
3699 breakpoint commands are usually more convenient and flexible than break
3700 conditions for the
3701 purpose of performing side effects when a breakpoint is reached
3702 (@pxref{Break Commands, ,Breakpoint Command Lists}).
3703
3704 Break conditions can be specified when a breakpoint is set, by using
3705 @samp{if} in the arguments to the @code{break} command. @xref{Set
3706 Breaks, ,Setting Breakpoints}. They can also be changed at any time
3707 with the @code{condition} command.
3708
3709 You can also use the @code{if} keyword with the @code{watch} command.
3710 The @code{catch} command does not recognize the @code{if} keyword;
3711 @code{condition} is the only way to impose a further condition on a
3712 catchpoint.
3713
3714 @table @code
3715 @kindex condition
3716 @item condition @var{bnum} @var{expression}
3717 Specify @var{expression} as the break condition for breakpoint,
3718 watchpoint, or catchpoint number @var{bnum}. After you set a condition,
3719 breakpoint @var{bnum} stops your program only if the value of
3720 @var{expression} is true (nonzero, in C). When you use
3721 @code{condition}, @value{GDBN} checks @var{expression} immediately for
3722 syntactic correctness, and to determine whether symbols in it have
3723 referents in the context of your breakpoint. If @var{expression} uses
3724 symbols not referenced in the context of the breakpoint, @value{GDBN}
3725 prints an error message:
3726
3727 @smallexample
3728 No symbol "foo" in current context.
3729 @end smallexample
3730
3731 @noindent
3732 @value{GDBN} does
3733 not actually evaluate @var{expression} at the time the @code{condition}
3734 command (or a command that sets a breakpoint with a condition, like
3735 @code{break if @dots{}}) is given, however. @xref{Expressions, ,Expressions}.
3736
3737 @item condition @var{bnum}
3738 Remove the condition from breakpoint number @var{bnum}. It becomes
3739 an ordinary unconditional breakpoint.
3740 @end table
3741
3742 @cindex ignore count (of breakpoint)
3743 A special case of a breakpoint condition is to stop only when the
3744 breakpoint has been reached a certain number of times. This is so
3745 useful that there is a special way to do it, using the @dfn{ignore
3746 count} of the breakpoint. Every breakpoint has an ignore count, which
3747 is an integer. Most of the time, the ignore count is zero, and
3748 therefore has no effect. But if your program reaches a breakpoint whose
3749 ignore count is positive, then instead of stopping, it just decrements
3750 the ignore count by one and continues. As a result, if the ignore count
3751 value is @var{n}, the breakpoint does not stop the next @var{n} times
3752 your program reaches it.
3753
3754 @table @code
3755 @kindex ignore
3756 @item ignore @var{bnum} @var{count}
3757 Set the ignore count of breakpoint number @var{bnum} to @var{count}.
3758 The next @var{count} times the breakpoint is reached, your program's
3759 execution does not stop; other than to decrement the ignore count, @value{GDBN}
3760 takes no action.
3761
3762 To make the breakpoint stop the next time it is reached, specify
3763 a count of zero.
3764
3765 When you use @code{continue} to resume execution of your program from a
3766 breakpoint, you can specify an ignore count directly as an argument to
3767 @code{continue}, rather than using @code{ignore}. @xref{Continuing and
3768 Stepping,,Continuing and Stepping}.
3769
3770 If a breakpoint has a positive ignore count and a condition, the
3771 condition is not checked. Once the ignore count reaches zero,
3772 @value{GDBN} resumes checking the condition.
3773
3774 You could achieve the effect of the ignore count with a condition such
3775 as @w{@samp{$foo-- <= 0}} using a debugger convenience variable that
3776 is decremented each time. @xref{Convenience Vars, ,Convenience
3777 Variables}.
3778 @end table
3779
3780 Ignore counts apply to breakpoints, watchpoints, and catchpoints.
3781
3782
3783 @node Break Commands
3784 @subsection Breakpoint Command Lists
3785
3786 @cindex breakpoint commands
3787 You can give any breakpoint (or watchpoint or catchpoint) a series of
3788 commands to execute when your program stops due to that breakpoint. For
3789 example, you might want to print the values of certain expressions, or
3790 enable other breakpoints.
3791
3792 @table @code
3793 @kindex commands
3794 @kindex end@r{ (breakpoint commands)}
3795 @item commands @r{[}@var{bnum}@r{]}
3796 @itemx @dots{} @var{command-list} @dots{}
3797 @itemx end
3798 Specify a list of commands for breakpoint number @var{bnum}. The commands
3799 themselves appear on the following lines. Type a line containing just
3800 @code{end} to terminate the commands.
3801
3802 To remove all commands from a breakpoint, type @code{commands} and
3803 follow it immediately with @code{end}; that is, give no commands.
3804
3805 With no @var{bnum} argument, @code{commands} refers to the last
3806 breakpoint, watchpoint, or catchpoint set (not to the breakpoint most
3807 recently encountered).
3808 @end table
3809
3810 Pressing @key{RET} as a means of repeating the last @value{GDBN} command is
3811 disabled within a @var{command-list}.
3812
3813 You can use breakpoint commands to start your program up again. Simply
3814 use the @code{continue} command, or @code{step}, or any other command
3815 that resumes execution.
3816
3817 Any other commands in the command list, after a command that resumes
3818 execution, are ignored. This is because any time you resume execution
3819 (even with a simple @code{next} or @code{step}), you may encounter
3820 another breakpoint---which could have its own command list, leading to
3821 ambiguities about which list to execute.
3822
3823 @kindex silent
3824 If the first command you specify in a command list is @code{silent}, the
3825 usual message about stopping at a breakpoint is not printed. This may
3826 be desirable for breakpoints that are to print a specific message and
3827 then continue. If none of the remaining commands print anything, you
3828 see no sign that the breakpoint was reached. @code{silent} is
3829 meaningful only at the beginning of a breakpoint command list.
3830
3831 The commands @code{echo}, @code{output}, and @code{printf} allow you to
3832 print precisely controlled output, and are often useful in silent
3833 breakpoints. @xref{Output, ,Commands for Controlled Output}.
3834
3835 For example, here is how you could use breakpoint commands to print the
3836 value of @code{x} at entry to @code{foo} whenever @code{x} is positive.
3837
3838 @smallexample
3839 break foo if x>0
3840 commands
3841 silent
3842 printf "x is %d\n",x
3843 cont
3844 end
3845 @end smallexample
3846
3847 One application for breakpoint commands is to compensate for one bug so
3848 you can test for another. Put a breakpoint just after the erroneous line
3849 of code, give it a condition to detect the case in which something
3850 erroneous has been done, and give it commands to assign correct values
3851 to any variables that need them. End with the @code{continue} command
3852 so that your program does not stop, and start with the @code{silent}
3853 command so that no output is produced. Here is an example:
3854
3855 @smallexample
3856 break 403
3857 commands
3858 silent
3859 set x = y + 4
3860 cont
3861 end
3862 @end smallexample
3863
3864 @c @ifclear BARETARGET
3865 @node Error in Breakpoints
3866 @subsection ``Cannot insert breakpoints''
3867 @c
3868 @c FIXME!! 14/6/95 Is there a real example of this? Let's use it.
3869 @c
3870 Under some operating systems, breakpoints cannot be used in a program if
3871 any other process is running that program. In this situation,
3872 attempting to run or continue a program with a breakpoint causes
3873 @value{GDBN} to print an error message:
3874
3875 @smallexample
3876 Cannot insert breakpoints.
3877 The same program may be running in another process.
3878 @end smallexample
3879
3880 When this happens, you have three ways to proceed:
3881
3882 @enumerate
3883 @item
3884 Remove or disable the breakpoints, then continue.
3885
3886 @item
3887 Suspend @value{GDBN}, and copy the file containing your program to a new
3888 name. Resume @value{GDBN} and use the @code{exec-file} command to specify
3889 that @value{GDBN} should run your program under that name.
3890 Then start your program again.
3891
3892 @item
3893 Relink your program so that the text segment is nonsharable, using the
3894 linker option @samp{-N}. The operating system limitation may not apply
3895 to nonsharable executables.
3896 @end enumerate
3897 @c @end ifclear
3898
3899 A similar message can be printed if you request too many active
3900 hardware-assisted breakpoints and watchpoints:
3901
3902 @c FIXME: the precise wording of this message may change; the relevant
3903 @c source change is not committed yet (Sep 3, 1999).
3904 @smallexample
3905 Stopped; cannot insert breakpoints.
3906 You may have requested too many hardware breakpoints and watchpoints.
3907 @end smallexample
3908
3909 @noindent
3910 This message is printed when you attempt to resume the program, since
3911 only then @value{GDBN} knows exactly how many hardware breakpoints and
3912 watchpoints it needs to insert.
3913
3914 When this message is printed, you need to disable or remove some of the
3915 hardware-assisted breakpoints and watchpoints, and then continue.
3916
3917 @node Breakpoint-related Warnings
3918 @subsection ``Breakpoint address adjusted...''
3919 @cindex breakpoint address adjusted
3920
3921 Some processor architectures place constraints on the addresses at
3922 which breakpoints may be placed. For architectures thus constrained,
3923 @value{GDBN} will attempt to adjust the breakpoint's address to comply
3924 with the constraints dictated by the architecture.
3925
3926 One example of such an architecture is the Fujitsu FR-V. The FR-V is
3927 a VLIW architecture in which a number of RISC-like instructions may be
3928 bundled together for parallel execution. The FR-V architecture
3929 constrains the location of a breakpoint instruction within such a
3930 bundle to the instruction with the lowest address. @value{GDBN}
3931 honors this constraint by adjusting a breakpoint's address to the
3932 first in the bundle.
3933
3934 It is not uncommon for optimized code to have bundles which contain
3935 instructions from different source statements, thus it may happen that
3936 a breakpoint's address will be adjusted from one source statement to
3937 another. Since this adjustment may significantly alter @value{GDBN}'s
3938 breakpoint related behavior from what the user expects, a warning is
3939 printed when the breakpoint is first set and also when the breakpoint
3940 is hit.
3941
3942 A warning like the one below is printed when setting a breakpoint
3943 that's been subject to address adjustment:
3944
3945 @smallexample
3946 warning: Breakpoint address adjusted from 0x00010414 to 0x00010410.
3947 @end smallexample
3948
3949 Such warnings are printed both for user settable and @value{GDBN}'s
3950 internal breakpoints. If you see one of these warnings, you should
3951 verify that a breakpoint set at the adjusted address will have the
3952 desired affect. If not, the breakpoint in question may be removed and
3953 other breakpoints may be set which will have the desired behavior.
3954 E.g., it may be sufficient to place the breakpoint at a later
3955 instruction. A conditional breakpoint may also be useful in some
3956 cases to prevent the breakpoint from triggering too often.
3957
3958 @value{GDBN} will also issue a warning when stopping at one of these
3959 adjusted breakpoints:
3960
3961 @smallexample
3962 warning: Breakpoint 1 address previously adjusted from 0x00010414
3963 to 0x00010410.
3964 @end smallexample
3965
3966 When this warning is encountered, it may be too late to take remedial
3967 action except in cases where the breakpoint is hit earlier or more
3968 frequently than expected.
3969
3970 @node Continuing and Stepping
3971 @section Continuing and Stepping
3972
3973 @cindex stepping
3974 @cindex continuing
3975 @cindex resuming execution
3976 @dfn{Continuing} means resuming program execution until your program
3977 completes normally. In contrast, @dfn{stepping} means executing just
3978 one more ``step'' of your program, where ``step'' may mean either one
3979 line of source code, or one machine instruction (depending on what
3980 particular command you use). Either when continuing or when stepping,
3981 your program may stop even sooner, due to a breakpoint or a signal. (If
3982 it stops due to a signal, you may want to use @code{handle}, or use
3983 @samp{signal 0} to resume execution. @xref{Signals, ,Signals}.)
3984
3985 @table @code
3986 @kindex continue
3987 @kindex c @r{(@code{continue})}
3988 @kindex fg @r{(resume foreground execution)}
3989 @item continue @r{[}@var{ignore-count}@r{]}
3990 @itemx c @r{[}@var{ignore-count}@r{]}
3991 @itemx fg @r{[}@var{ignore-count}@r{]}
3992 Resume program execution, at the address where your program last stopped;
3993 any breakpoints set at that address are bypassed. The optional argument
3994 @var{ignore-count} allows you to specify a further number of times to
3995 ignore a breakpoint at this location; its effect is like that of
3996 @code{ignore} (@pxref{Conditions, ,Break Conditions}).
3997
3998 The argument @var{ignore-count} is meaningful only when your program
3999 stopped due to a breakpoint. At other times, the argument to
4000 @code{continue} is ignored.
4001
4002 The synonyms @code{c} and @code{fg} (for @dfn{foreground}, as the
4003 debugged program is deemed to be the foreground program) are provided
4004 purely for convenience, and have exactly the same behavior as
4005 @code{continue}.
4006 @end table
4007
4008 To resume execution at a different place, you can use @code{return}
4009 (@pxref{Returning, ,Returning from a Function}) to go back to the
4010 calling function; or @code{jump} (@pxref{Jumping, ,Continuing at a
4011 Different Address}) to go to an arbitrary location in your program.
4012
4013 A typical technique for using stepping is to set a breakpoint
4014 (@pxref{Breakpoints, ,Breakpoints; Watchpoints; and Catchpoints}) at the
4015 beginning of the function or the section of your program where a problem
4016 is believed to lie, run your program until it stops at that breakpoint,
4017 and then step through the suspect area, examining the variables that are
4018 interesting, until you see the problem happen.
4019
4020 @table @code
4021 @kindex step
4022 @kindex s @r{(@code{step})}
4023 @item step
4024 Continue running your program until control reaches a different source
4025 line, then stop it and return control to @value{GDBN}. This command is
4026 abbreviated @code{s}.
4027
4028 @quotation
4029 @c "without debugging information" is imprecise; actually "without line
4030 @c numbers in the debugging information". (gcc -g1 has debugging info but
4031 @c not line numbers). But it seems complex to try to make that
4032 @c distinction here.
4033 @emph{Warning:} If you use the @code{step} command while control is
4034 within a function that was compiled without debugging information,
4035 execution proceeds until control reaches a function that does have
4036 debugging information. Likewise, it will not step into a function which
4037 is compiled without debugging information. To step through functions
4038 without debugging information, use the @code{stepi} command, described
4039 below.
4040 @end quotation
4041
4042 The @code{step} command only stops at the first instruction of a source
4043 line. This prevents the multiple stops that could otherwise occur in
4044 @code{switch} statements, @code{for} loops, etc. @code{step} continues
4045 to stop if a function that has debugging information is called within
4046 the line. In other words, @code{step} @emph{steps inside} any functions
4047 called within the line.
4048
4049 Also, the @code{step} command only enters a function if there is line
4050 number information for the function. Otherwise it acts like the
4051 @code{next} command. This avoids problems when using @code{cc -gl}
4052 on MIPS machines. Previously, @code{step} entered subroutines if there
4053 was any debugging information about the routine.
4054
4055 @item step @var{count}
4056 Continue running as in @code{step}, but do so @var{count} times. If a
4057 breakpoint is reached, or a signal not related to stepping occurs before
4058 @var{count} steps, stepping stops right away.
4059
4060 @kindex next
4061 @kindex n @r{(@code{next})}
4062 @item next @r{[}@var{count}@r{]}
4063 Continue to the next source line in the current (innermost) stack frame.
4064 This is similar to @code{step}, but function calls that appear within
4065 the line of code are executed without stopping. Execution stops when
4066 control reaches a different line of code at the original stack level
4067 that was executing when you gave the @code{next} command. This command
4068 is abbreviated @code{n}.
4069
4070 An argument @var{count} is a repeat count, as for @code{step}.
4071
4072
4073 @c FIX ME!! Do we delete this, or is there a way it fits in with
4074 @c the following paragraph? --- Vctoria
4075 @c
4076 @c @code{next} within a function that lacks debugging information acts like
4077 @c @code{step}, but any function calls appearing within the code of the
4078 @c function are executed without stopping.
4079
4080 The @code{next} command only stops at the first instruction of a
4081 source line. This prevents multiple stops that could otherwise occur in
4082 @code{switch} statements, @code{for} loops, etc.
4083
4084 @kindex set step-mode
4085 @item set step-mode
4086 @cindex functions without line info, and stepping
4087 @cindex stepping into functions with no line info
4088 @itemx set step-mode on
4089 The @code{set step-mode on} command causes the @code{step} command to
4090 stop at the first instruction of a function which contains no debug line
4091 information rather than stepping over it.
4092
4093 This is useful in cases where you may be interested in inspecting the
4094 machine instructions of a function which has no symbolic info and do not
4095 want @value{GDBN} to automatically skip over this function.
4096
4097 @item set step-mode off
4098 Causes the @code{step} command to step over any functions which contains no
4099 debug information. This is the default.
4100
4101 @item show step-mode
4102 Show whether @value{GDBN} will stop in or step over functions without
4103 source line debug information.
4104
4105 @kindex finish
4106 @item finish
4107 Continue running until just after function in the selected stack frame
4108 returns. Print the returned value (if any).
4109
4110 Contrast this with the @code{return} command (@pxref{Returning,
4111 ,Returning from a Function}).
4112
4113 @kindex until
4114 @kindex u @r{(@code{until})}
4115 @cindex run until specified location
4116 @item until
4117 @itemx u
4118 Continue running until a source line past the current line, in the
4119 current stack frame, is reached. This command is used to avoid single
4120 stepping through a loop more than once. It is like the @code{next}
4121 command, except that when @code{until} encounters a jump, it
4122 automatically continues execution until the program counter is greater
4123 than the address of the jump.
4124
4125 This means that when you reach the end of a loop after single stepping
4126 though it, @code{until} makes your program continue execution until it
4127 exits the loop. In contrast, a @code{next} command at the end of a loop
4128 simply steps back to the beginning of the loop, which forces you to step
4129 through the next iteration.
4130
4131 @code{until} always stops your program if it attempts to exit the current
4132 stack frame.
4133
4134 @code{until} may produce somewhat counterintuitive results if the order
4135 of machine code does not match the order of the source lines. For
4136 example, in the following excerpt from a debugging session, the @code{f}
4137 (@code{frame}) command shows that execution is stopped at line
4138 @code{206}; yet when we use @code{until}, we get to line @code{195}:
4139
4140 @smallexample
4141 (@value{GDBP}) f
4142 #0 main (argc=4, argv=0xf7fffae8) at m4.c:206
4143 206 expand_input();
4144 (@value{GDBP}) until
4145 195 for ( ; argc > 0; NEXTARG) @{
4146 @end smallexample
4147
4148 This happened because, for execution efficiency, the compiler had
4149 generated code for the loop closure test at the end, rather than the
4150 start, of the loop---even though the test in a C @code{for}-loop is
4151 written before the body of the loop. The @code{until} command appeared
4152 to step back to the beginning of the loop when it advanced to this
4153 expression; however, it has not really gone to an earlier
4154 statement---not in terms of the actual machine code.
4155
4156 @code{until} with no argument works by means of single
4157 instruction stepping, and hence is slower than @code{until} with an
4158 argument.
4159
4160 @item until @var{location}
4161 @itemx u @var{location}
4162 Continue running your program until either the specified location is
4163 reached, or the current stack frame returns. @var{location} is any of
4164 the forms described in @ref{Specify Location}.
4165 This form of the command uses temporary breakpoints, and
4166 hence is quicker than @code{until} without an argument. The specified
4167 location is actually reached only if it is in the current frame. This
4168 implies that @code{until} can be used to skip over recursive function
4169 invocations. For instance in the code below, if the current location is
4170 line @code{96}, issuing @code{until 99} will execute the program up to
4171 line @code{99} in the same invocation of factorial, i.e., after the inner
4172 invocations have returned.
4173
4174 @smallexample
4175 94 int factorial (int value)
4176 95 @{
4177 96 if (value > 1) @{
4178 97 value *= factorial (value - 1);
4179 98 @}
4180 99 return (value);
4181 100 @}
4182 @end smallexample
4183
4184
4185 @kindex advance @var{location}
4186 @itemx advance @var{location}
4187 Continue running the program up to the given @var{location}. An argument is
4188 required, which should be of one of the forms described in
4189 @ref{Specify Location}.
4190 Execution will also stop upon exit from the current stack
4191 frame. This command is similar to @code{until}, but @code{advance} will
4192 not skip over recursive function calls, and the target location doesn't
4193 have to be in the same frame as the current one.
4194
4195
4196 @kindex stepi
4197 @kindex si @r{(@code{stepi})}
4198 @item stepi
4199 @itemx stepi @var{arg}
4200 @itemx si
4201 Execute one machine instruction, then stop and return to the debugger.
4202
4203 It is often useful to do @samp{display/i $pc} when stepping by machine
4204 instructions. This makes @value{GDBN} automatically display the next
4205 instruction to be executed, each time your program stops. @xref{Auto
4206 Display,, Automatic Display}.
4207
4208 An argument is a repeat count, as in @code{step}.
4209
4210 @need 750
4211 @kindex nexti
4212 @kindex ni @r{(@code{nexti})}
4213 @item nexti
4214 @itemx nexti @var{arg}
4215 @itemx ni
4216 Execute one machine instruction, but if it is a function call,
4217 proceed until the function returns.
4218
4219 An argument is a repeat count, as in @code{next}.
4220 @end table
4221
4222 @node Signals
4223 @section Signals
4224 @cindex signals
4225
4226 A signal is an asynchronous event that can happen in a program. The
4227 operating system defines the possible kinds of signals, and gives each
4228 kind a name and a number. For example, in Unix @code{SIGINT} is the
4229 signal a program gets when you type an interrupt character (often @kbd{Ctrl-c});
4230 @code{SIGSEGV} is the signal a program gets from referencing a place in
4231 memory far away from all the areas in use; @code{SIGALRM} occurs when
4232 the alarm clock timer goes off (which happens only if your program has
4233 requested an alarm).
4234
4235 @cindex fatal signals
4236 Some signals, including @code{SIGALRM}, are a normal part of the
4237 functioning of your program. Others, such as @code{SIGSEGV}, indicate
4238 errors; these signals are @dfn{fatal} (they kill your program immediately) if the
4239 program has not specified in advance some other way to handle the signal.
4240 @code{SIGINT} does not indicate an error in your program, but it is normally
4241 fatal so it can carry out the purpose of the interrupt: to kill the program.
4242
4243 @value{GDBN} has the ability to detect any occurrence of a signal in your
4244 program. You can tell @value{GDBN} in advance what to do for each kind of
4245 signal.
4246
4247 @cindex handling signals
4248 Normally, @value{GDBN} is set up to let the non-erroneous signals like
4249 @code{SIGALRM} be silently passed to your program
4250 (so as not to interfere with their role in the program's functioning)
4251 but to stop your program immediately whenever an error signal happens.
4252 You can change these settings with the @code{handle} command.
4253
4254 @table @code
4255 @kindex info signals
4256 @kindex info handle
4257 @item info signals
4258 @itemx info handle
4259 Print a table of all the kinds of signals and how @value{GDBN} has been told to
4260 handle each one. You can use this to see the signal numbers of all
4261 the defined types of signals.
4262
4263 @item info signals @var{sig}
4264 Similar, but print information only about the specified signal number.
4265
4266 @code{info handle} is an alias for @code{info signals}.
4267
4268 @kindex handle
4269 @item handle @var{signal} @r{[}@var{keywords}@dots{}@r{]}
4270 Change the way @value{GDBN} handles signal @var{signal}. @var{signal}
4271 can be the number of a signal or its name (with or without the
4272 @samp{SIG} at the beginning); a list of signal numbers of the form
4273 @samp{@var{low}-@var{high}}; or the word @samp{all}, meaning all the
4274 known signals. Optional arguments @var{keywords}, described below,
4275 say what change to make.
4276 @end table
4277
4278 @c @group
4279 The keywords allowed by the @code{handle} command can be abbreviated.
4280 Their full names are:
4281
4282 @table @code
4283 @item nostop
4284 @value{GDBN} should not stop your program when this signal happens. It may
4285 still print a message telling you that the signal has come in.
4286
4287 @item stop
4288 @value{GDBN} should stop your program when this signal happens. This implies
4289 the @code{print} keyword as well.
4290
4291 @item print
4292 @value{GDBN} should print a message when this signal happens.
4293
4294 @item noprint
4295 @value{GDBN} should not mention the occurrence of the signal at all. This
4296 implies the @code{nostop} keyword as well.
4297
4298 @item pass
4299 @itemx noignore
4300 @value{GDBN} should allow your program to see this signal; your program
4301 can handle the signal, or else it may terminate if the signal is fatal
4302 and not handled. @code{pass} and @code{noignore} are synonyms.
4303
4304 @item nopass
4305 @itemx ignore
4306 @value{GDBN} should not allow your program to see this signal.
4307 @code{nopass} and @code{ignore} are synonyms.
4308 @end table
4309 @c @end group
4310
4311 When a signal stops your program, the signal is not visible to the
4312 program until you
4313 continue. Your program sees the signal then, if @code{pass} is in
4314 effect for the signal in question @emph{at that time}. In other words,
4315 after @value{GDBN} reports a signal, you can use the @code{handle}
4316 command with @code{pass} or @code{nopass} to control whether your
4317 program sees that signal when you continue.
4318
4319 The default is set to @code{nostop}, @code{noprint}, @code{pass} for
4320 non-erroneous signals such as @code{SIGALRM}, @code{SIGWINCH} and
4321 @code{SIGCHLD}, and to @code{stop}, @code{print}, @code{pass} for the
4322 erroneous signals.
4323
4324 You can also use the @code{signal} command to prevent your program from
4325 seeing a signal, or cause it to see a signal it normally would not see,
4326 or to give it any signal at any time. For example, if your program stopped
4327 due to some sort of memory reference error, you might store correct
4328 values into the erroneous variables and continue, hoping to see more
4329 execution; but your program would probably terminate immediately as
4330 a result of the fatal signal once it saw the signal. To prevent this,
4331 you can continue with @samp{signal 0}. @xref{Signaling, ,Giving your
4332 Program a Signal}.
4333
4334 @node Thread Stops
4335 @section Stopping and Starting Multi-thread Programs
4336
4337 When your program has multiple threads (@pxref{Threads,, Debugging
4338 Programs with Multiple Threads}), you can choose whether to set
4339 breakpoints on all threads, or on a particular thread.
4340
4341 @table @code
4342 @cindex breakpoints and threads
4343 @cindex thread breakpoints
4344 @kindex break @dots{} thread @var{threadno}
4345 @item break @var{linespec} thread @var{threadno}
4346 @itemx break @var{linespec} thread @var{threadno} if @dots{}
4347 @var{linespec} specifies source lines; there are several ways of
4348 writing them (@pxref{Specify Location}), but the effect is always to
4349 specify some source line.
4350
4351 Use the qualifier @samp{thread @var{threadno}} with a breakpoint command
4352 to specify that you only want @value{GDBN} to stop the program when a
4353 particular thread reaches this breakpoint. @var{threadno} is one of the
4354 numeric thread identifiers assigned by @value{GDBN}, shown in the first
4355 column of the @samp{info threads} display.
4356
4357 If you do not specify @samp{thread @var{threadno}} when you set a
4358 breakpoint, the breakpoint applies to @emph{all} threads of your
4359 program.
4360
4361 You can use the @code{thread} qualifier on conditional breakpoints as
4362 well; in this case, place @samp{thread @var{threadno}} before the
4363 breakpoint condition, like this:
4364
4365 @smallexample
4366 (@value{GDBP}) break frik.c:13 thread 28 if bartab > lim
4367 @end smallexample
4368
4369 @end table
4370
4371 @cindex stopped threads
4372 @cindex threads, stopped
4373 Whenever your program stops under @value{GDBN} for any reason,
4374 @emph{all} threads of execution stop, not just the current thread. This
4375 allows you to examine the overall state of the program, including
4376 switching between threads, without worrying that things may change
4377 underfoot.
4378
4379 @cindex thread breakpoints and system calls
4380 @cindex system calls and thread breakpoints
4381 @cindex premature return from system calls
4382 There is an unfortunate side effect. If one thread stops for a
4383 breakpoint, or for some other reason, and another thread is blocked in a
4384 system call, then the system call may return prematurely. This is a
4385 consequence of the interaction between multiple threads and the signals
4386 that @value{GDBN} uses to implement breakpoints and other events that
4387 stop execution.
4388
4389 To handle this problem, your program should check the return value of
4390 each system call and react appropriately. This is good programming
4391 style anyways.
4392
4393 For example, do not write code like this:
4394
4395 @smallexample
4396 sleep (10);
4397 @end smallexample
4398
4399 The call to @code{sleep} will return early if a different thread stops
4400 at a breakpoint or for some other reason.
4401
4402 Instead, write this:
4403
4404 @smallexample
4405 int unslept = 10;
4406 while (unslept > 0)
4407 unslept = sleep (unslept);
4408 @end smallexample
4409
4410 A system call is allowed to return early, so the system is still
4411 conforming to its specification. But @value{GDBN} does cause your
4412 multi-threaded program to behave differently than it would without
4413 @value{GDBN}.
4414
4415 Also, @value{GDBN} uses internal breakpoints in the thread library to
4416 monitor certain events such as thread creation and thread destruction.
4417 When such an event happens, a system call in another thread may return
4418 prematurely, even though your program does not appear to stop.
4419
4420 @cindex continuing threads
4421 @cindex threads, continuing
4422 Conversely, whenever you restart the program, @emph{all} threads start
4423 executing. @emph{This is true even when single-stepping} with commands
4424 like @code{step} or @code{next}.
4425
4426 In particular, @value{GDBN} cannot single-step all threads in lockstep.
4427 Since thread scheduling is up to your debugging target's operating
4428 system (not controlled by @value{GDBN}), other threads may
4429 execute more than one statement while the current thread completes a
4430 single step. Moreover, in general other threads stop in the middle of a
4431 statement, rather than at a clean statement boundary, when the program
4432 stops.
4433
4434 You might even find your program stopped in another thread after
4435 continuing or even single-stepping. This happens whenever some other
4436 thread runs into a breakpoint, a signal, or an exception before the
4437 first thread completes whatever you requested.
4438
4439 On some OSes, you can lock the OS scheduler and thus allow only a single
4440 thread to run.
4441
4442 @table @code
4443 @item set scheduler-locking @var{mode}
4444 @cindex scheduler locking mode
4445 @cindex lock scheduler
4446 Set the scheduler locking mode. If it is @code{off}, then there is no
4447 locking and any thread may run at any time. If @code{on}, then only the
4448 current thread may run when the inferior is resumed. The @code{step}
4449 mode optimizes for single-stepping. It stops other threads from
4450 ``seizing the prompt'' by preempting the current thread while you are
4451 stepping. Other threads will only rarely (or never) get a chance to run
4452 when you step. They are more likely to run when you @samp{next} over a
4453 function call, and they are completely free to run when you use commands
4454 like @samp{continue}, @samp{until}, or @samp{finish}. However, unless another
4455 thread hits a breakpoint during its timeslice, they will never steal the
4456 @value{GDBN} prompt away from the thread that you are debugging.
4457
4458 @item show scheduler-locking
4459 Display the current scheduler locking mode.
4460 @end table
4461
4462
4463 @node Stack
4464 @chapter Examining the Stack
4465
4466 When your program has stopped, the first thing you need to know is where it
4467 stopped and how it got there.
4468
4469 @cindex call stack
4470 Each time your program performs a function call, information about the call
4471 is generated.
4472 That information includes the location of the call in your program,
4473 the arguments of the call,
4474 and the local variables of the function being called.
4475 The information is saved in a block of data called a @dfn{stack frame}.
4476 The stack frames are allocated in a region of memory called the @dfn{call
4477 stack}.
4478
4479 When your program stops, the @value{GDBN} commands for examining the
4480 stack allow you to see all of this information.
4481
4482 @cindex selected frame
4483 One of the stack frames is @dfn{selected} by @value{GDBN} and many
4484 @value{GDBN} commands refer implicitly to the selected frame. In
4485 particular, whenever you ask @value{GDBN} for the value of a variable in
4486 your program, the value is found in the selected frame. There are
4487 special @value{GDBN} commands to select whichever frame you are
4488 interested in. @xref{Selection, ,Selecting a Frame}.
4489
4490 When your program stops, @value{GDBN} automatically selects the
4491 currently executing frame and describes it briefly, similar to the
4492 @code{frame} command (@pxref{Frame Info, ,Information about a Frame}).
4493
4494 @menu
4495 * Frames:: Stack frames
4496 * Backtrace:: Backtraces
4497 * Selection:: Selecting a frame
4498 * Frame Info:: Information on a frame
4499
4500 @end menu
4501
4502 @node Frames
4503 @section Stack Frames
4504
4505 @cindex frame, definition
4506 @cindex stack frame
4507 The call stack is divided up into contiguous pieces called @dfn{stack
4508 frames}, or @dfn{frames} for short; each frame is the data associated
4509 with one call to one function. The frame contains the arguments given
4510 to the function, the function's local variables, and the address at
4511 which the function is executing.
4512
4513 @cindex initial frame
4514 @cindex outermost frame
4515 @cindex innermost frame
4516 When your program is started, the stack has only one frame, that of the
4517 function @code{main}. This is called the @dfn{initial} frame or the
4518 @dfn{outermost} frame. Each time a function is called, a new frame is
4519 made. Each time a function returns, the frame for that function invocation
4520 is eliminated. If a function is recursive, there can be many frames for
4521 the same function. The frame for the function in which execution is
4522 actually occurring is called the @dfn{innermost} frame. This is the most
4523 recently created of all the stack frames that still exist.
4524
4525 @cindex frame pointer
4526 Inside your program, stack frames are identified by their addresses. A
4527 stack frame consists of many bytes, each of which has its own address; each
4528 kind of computer has a convention for choosing one byte whose
4529 address serves as the address of the frame. Usually this address is kept
4530 in a register called the @dfn{frame pointer register}
4531 (@pxref{Registers, $fp}) while execution is going on in that frame.
4532
4533 @cindex frame number
4534 @value{GDBN} assigns numbers to all existing stack frames, starting with
4535 zero for the innermost frame, one for the frame that called it,
4536 and so on upward. These numbers do not really exist in your program;
4537 they are assigned by @value{GDBN} to give you a way of designating stack
4538 frames in @value{GDBN} commands.
4539
4540 @c The -fomit-frame-pointer below perennially causes hbox overflow
4541 @c underflow problems.
4542 @cindex frameless execution
4543 Some compilers provide a way to compile functions so that they operate
4544 without stack frames. (For example, the @value{NGCC} option
4545 @smallexample
4546 @samp{-fomit-frame-pointer}
4547 @end smallexample
4548 generates functions without a frame.)
4549 This is occasionally done with heavily used library functions to save
4550 the frame setup time. @value{GDBN} has limited facilities for dealing
4551 with these function invocations. If the innermost function invocation
4552 has no stack frame, @value{GDBN} nevertheless regards it as though
4553 it had a separate frame, which is numbered zero as usual, allowing
4554 correct tracing of the function call chain. However, @value{GDBN} has
4555 no provision for frameless functions elsewhere in the stack.
4556
4557 @table @code
4558 @kindex frame@r{, command}
4559 @cindex current stack frame
4560 @item frame @var{args}
4561 The @code{frame} command allows you to move from one stack frame to another,
4562 and to print the stack frame you select. @var{args} may be either the
4563 address of the frame or the stack frame number. Without an argument,
4564 @code{frame} prints the current stack frame.
4565
4566 @kindex select-frame
4567 @cindex selecting frame silently
4568 @item select-frame
4569 The @code{select-frame} command allows you to move from one stack frame
4570 to another without printing the frame. This is the silent version of
4571 @code{frame}.
4572 @end table
4573
4574 @node Backtrace
4575 @section Backtraces
4576
4577 @cindex traceback
4578 @cindex call stack traces
4579 A backtrace is a summary of how your program got where it is. It shows one
4580 line per frame, for many frames, starting with the currently executing
4581 frame (frame zero), followed by its caller (frame one), and on up the
4582 stack.
4583
4584 @table @code
4585 @kindex backtrace
4586 @kindex bt @r{(@code{backtrace})}
4587 @item backtrace
4588 @itemx bt
4589 Print a backtrace of the entire stack: one line per frame for all
4590 frames in the stack.
4591
4592 You can stop the backtrace at any time by typing the system interrupt
4593 character, normally @kbd{Ctrl-c}.
4594
4595 @item backtrace @var{n}
4596 @itemx bt @var{n}
4597 Similar, but print only the innermost @var{n} frames.
4598
4599 @item backtrace -@var{n}
4600 @itemx bt -@var{n}
4601 Similar, but print only the outermost @var{n} frames.
4602
4603 @item backtrace full
4604 @itemx bt full
4605 @itemx bt full @var{n}
4606 @itemx bt full -@var{n}
4607 Print the values of the local variables also. @var{n} specifies the
4608 number of frames to print, as described above.
4609 @end table
4610
4611 @kindex where
4612 @kindex info stack
4613 The names @code{where} and @code{info stack} (abbreviated @code{info s})
4614 are additional aliases for @code{backtrace}.
4615
4616 @cindex multiple threads, backtrace
4617 In a multi-threaded program, @value{GDBN} by default shows the
4618 backtrace only for the current thread. To display the backtrace for
4619 several or all of the threads, use the command @code{thread apply}
4620 (@pxref{Threads, thread apply}). For example, if you type @kbd{thread
4621 apply all backtrace}, @value{GDBN} will display the backtrace for all
4622 the threads; this is handy when you debug a core dump of a
4623 multi-threaded program.
4624
4625 Each line in the backtrace shows the frame number and the function name.
4626 The program counter value is also shown---unless you use @code{set
4627 print address off}. The backtrace also shows the source file name and
4628 line number, as well as the arguments to the function. The program
4629 counter value is omitted if it is at the beginning of the code for that
4630 line number.
4631
4632 Here is an example of a backtrace. It was made with the command
4633 @samp{bt 3}, so it shows the innermost three frames.
4634
4635 @smallexample
4636 @group
4637 #0 m4_traceon (obs=0x24eb0, argc=1, argv=0x2b8c8)
4638 at builtin.c:993
4639 #1 0x6e38 in expand_macro (sym=0x2b600) at macro.c:242
4640 #2 0x6840 in expand_token (obs=0x0, t=177664, td=0xf7fffb08)
4641 at macro.c:71
4642 (More stack frames follow...)
4643 @end group
4644 @end smallexample
4645
4646 @noindent
4647 The display for frame zero does not begin with a program counter
4648 value, indicating that your program has stopped at the beginning of the
4649 code for line @code{993} of @code{builtin.c}.
4650
4651 @cindex value optimized out, in backtrace
4652 @cindex function call arguments, optimized out
4653 If your program was compiled with optimizations, some compilers will
4654 optimize away arguments passed to functions if those arguments are
4655 never used after the call. Such optimizations generate code that
4656 passes arguments through registers, but doesn't store those arguments
4657 in the stack frame. @value{GDBN} has no way of displaying such
4658 arguments in stack frames other than the innermost one. Here's what
4659 such a backtrace might look like:
4660
4661 @smallexample
4662 @group
4663 #0 m4_traceon (obs=0x24eb0, argc=1, argv=0x2b8c8)
4664 at builtin.c:993
4665 #1 0x6e38 in expand_macro (sym=<value optimized out>) at macro.c:242
4666 #2 0x6840 in expand_token (obs=0x0, t=<value optimized out>, td=0xf7fffb08)
4667 at macro.c:71
4668 (More stack frames follow...)
4669 @end group
4670 @end smallexample
4671
4672 @noindent
4673 The values of arguments that were not saved in their stack frames are
4674 shown as @samp{<value optimized out>}.
4675
4676 If you need to display the values of such optimized-out arguments,
4677 either deduce that from other variables whose values depend on the one
4678 you are interested in, or recompile without optimizations.
4679
4680 @cindex backtrace beyond @code{main} function
4681 @cindex program entry point
4682 @cindex startup code, and backtrace
4683 Most programs have a standard user entry point---a place where system
4684 libraries and startup code transition into user code. For C this is
4685 @code{main}@footnote{
4686 Note that embedded programs (the so-called ``free-standing''
4687 environment) are not required to have a @code{main} function as the
4688 entry point. They could even have multiple entry points.}.
4689 When @value{GDBN} finds the entry function in a backtrace
4690 it will terminate the backtrace, to avoid tracing into highly
4691 system-specific (and generally uninteresting) code.
4692
4693 If you need to examine the startup code, or limit the number of levels
4694 in a backtrace, you can change this behavior:
4695
4696 @table @code
4697 @item set backtrace past-main
4698 @itemx set backtrace past-main on
4699 @kindex set backtrace
4700 Backtraces will continue past the user entry point.
4701
4702 @item set backtrace past-main off
4703 Backtraces will stop when they encounter the user entry point. This is the
4704 default.
4705
4706 @item show backtrace past-main
4707 @kindex show backtrace
4708 Display the current user entry point backtrace policy.
4709
4710 @item set backtrace past-entry
4711 @itemx set backtrace past-entry on
4712 Backtraces will continue past the internal entry point of an application.
4713 This entry point is encoded by the linker when the application is built,
4714 and is likely before the user entry point @code{main} (or equivalent) is called.
4715
4716 @item set backtrace past-entry off
4717 Backtraces will stop when they encounter the internal entry point of an
4718 application. This is the default.
4719
4720 @item show backtrace past-entry
4721 Display the current internal entry point backtrace policy.
4722
4723 @item set backtrace limit @var{n}
4724 @itemx set backtrace limit 0
4725 @cindex backtrace limit
4726 Limit the backtrace to @var{n} levels. A value of zero means
4727 unlimited.
4728
4729 @item show backtrace limit
4730 Display the current limit on backtrace levels.
4731 @end table
4732
4733 @node Selection
4734 @section Selecting a Frame
4735
4736 Most commands for examining the stack and other data in your program work on
4737 whichever stack frame is selected at the moment. Here are the commands for
4738 selecting a stack frame; all of them finish by printing a brief description
4739 of the stack frame just selected.
4740
4741 @table @code
4742 @kindex frame@r{, selecting}
4743 @kindex f @r{(@code{frame})}
4744 @item frame @var{n}
4745 @itemx f @var{n}
4746 Select frame number @var{n}. Recall that frame zero is the innermost
4747 (currently executing) frame, frame one is the frame that called the
4748 innermost one, and so on. The highest-numbered frame is the one for
4749 @code{main}.
4750
4751 @item frame @var{addr}
4752 @itemx f @var{addr}
4753 Select the frame at address @var{addr}. This is useful mainly if the
4754 chaining of stack frames has been damaged by a bug, making it
4755 impossible for @value{GDBN} to assign numbers properly to all frames. In
4756 addition, this can be useful when your program has multiple stacks and
4757 switches between them.
4758
4759 On the SPARC architecture, @code{frame} needs two addresses to
4760 select an arbitrary frame: a frame pointer and a stack pointer.
4761
4762 On the MIPS and Alpha architecture, it needs two addresses: a stack
4763 pointer and a program counter.
4764
4765 On the 29k architecture, it needs three addresses: a register stack
4766 pointer, a program counter, and a memory stack pointer.
4767
4768 @kindex up
4769 @item up @var{n}
4770 Move @var{n} frames up the stack. For positive numbers @var{n}, this
4771 advances toward the outermost frame, to higher frame numbers, to frames
4772 that have existed longer. @var{n} defaults to one.
4773
4774 @kindex down
4775 @kindex do @r{(@code{down})}
4776 @item down @var{n}
4777 Move @var{n} frames down the stack. For positive numbers @var{n}, this
4778 advances toward the innermost frame, to lower frame numbers, to frames
4779 that were created more recently. @var{n} defaults to one. You may
4780 abbreviate @code{down} as @code{do}.
4781 @end table
4782
4783 All of these commands end by printing two lines of output describing the
4784 frame. The first line shows the frame number, the function name, the
4785 arguments, and the source file and line number of execution in that
4786 frame. The second line shows the text of that source line.
4787
4788 @need 1000
4789 For example:
4790
4791 @smallexample
4792 @group
4793 (@value{GDBP}) up
4794 #1 0x22f0 in main (argc=1, argv=0xf7fffbf4, env=0xf7fffbfc)
4795 at env.c:10
4796 10 read_input_file (argv[i]);
4797 @end group
4798 @end smallexample
4799
4800 After such a printout, the @code{list} command with no arguments
4801 prints ten lines centered on the point of execution in the frame.
4802 You can also edit the program at the point of execution with your favorite
4803 editing program by typing @code{edit}.
4804 @xref{List, ,Printing Source Lines},
4805 for details.
4806
4807 @table @code
4808 @kindex down-silently
4809 @kindex up-silently
4810 @item up-silently @var{n}
4811 @itemx down-silently @var{n}
4812 These two commands are variants of @code{up} and @code{down},
4813 respectively; they differ in that they do their work silently, without
4814 causing display of the new frame. They are intended primarily for use
4815 in @value{GDBN} command scripts, where the output might be unnecessary and
4816 distracting.
4817 @end table
4818
4819 @node Frame Info
4820 @section Information About a Frame
4821
4822 There are several other commands to print information about the selected
4823 stack frame.
4824
4825 @table @code
4826 @item frame
4827 @itemx f
4828 When used without any argument, this command does not change which
4829 frame is selected, but prints a brief description of the currently
4830 selected stack frame. It can be abbreviated @code{f}. With an
4831 argument, this command is used to select a stack frame.
4832 @xref{Selection, ,Selecting a Frame}.
4833
4834 @kindex info frame
4835 @kindex info f @r{(@code{info frame})}
4836 @item info frame
4837 @itemx info f
4838 This command prints a verbose description of the selected stack frame,
4839 including:
4840
4841 @itemize @bullet
4842 @item
4843 the address of the frame
4844 @item
4845 the address of the next frame down (called by this frame)
4846 @item
4847 the address of the next frame up (caller of this frame)
4848 @item
4849 the language in which the source code corresponding to this frame is written
4850 @item
4851 the address of the frame's arguments
4852 @item
4853 the address of the frame's local variables
4854 @item
4855 the program counter saved in it (the address of execution in the caller frame)
4856 @item
4857 which registers were saved in the frame
4858 @end itemize
4859
4860 @noindent The verbose description is useful when
4861 something has gone wrong that has made the stack format fail to fit
4862 the usual conventions.
4863
4864 @item info frame @var{addr}
4865 @itemx info f @var{addr}
4866 Print a verbose description of the frame at address @var{addr}, without
4867 selecting that frame. The selected frame remains unchanged by this
4868 command. This requires the same kind of address (more than one for some
4869 architectures) that you specify in the @code{frame} command.
4870 @xref{Selection, ,Selecting a Frame}.
4871
4872 @kindex info args
4873 @item info args
4874 Print the arguments of the selected frame, each on a separate line.
4875
4876 @item info locals
4877 @kindex info locals
4878 Print the local variables of the selected frame, each on a separate
4879 line. These are all variables (declared either static or automatic)
4880 accessible at the point of execution of the selected frame.
4881
4882 @kindex info catch
4883 @cindex catch exceptions, list active handlers
4884 @cindex exception handlers, how to list
4885 @item info catch
4886 Print a list of all the exception handlers that are active in the
4887 current stack frame at the current point of execution. To see other
4888 exception handlers, visit the associated frame (using the @code{up},
4889 @code{down}, or @code{frame} commands); then type @code{info catch}.
4890 @xref{Set Catchpoints, , Setting Catchpoints}.
4891
4892 @end table
4893
4894
4895 @node Source
4896 @chapter Examining Source Files
4897
4898 @value{GDBN} can print parts of your program's source, since the debugging
4899 information recorded in the program tells @value{GDBN} what source files were
4900 used to build it. When your program stops, @value{GDBN} spontaneously prints
4901 the line where it stopped. Likewise, when you select a stack frame
4902 (@pxref{Selection, ,Selecting a Frame}), @value{GDBN} prints the line where
4903 execution in that frame has stopped. You can print other portions of
4904 source files by explicit command.
4905
4906 If you use @value{GDBN} through its @sc{gnu} Emacs interface, you may
4907 prefer to use Emacs facilities to view source; see @ref{Emacs, ,Using
4908 @value{GDBN} under @sc{gnu} Emacs}.
4909
4910 @menu
4911 * List:: Printing source lines
4912 * Specify Location:: How to specify code locations
4913 * Edit:: Editing source files
4914 * Search:: Searching source files
4915 * Source Path:: Specifying source directories
4916 * Machine Code:: Source and machine code
4917 @end menu
4918
4919 @node List
4920 @section Printing Source Lines
4921
4922 @kindex list
4923 @kindex l @r{(@code{list})}
4924 To print lines from a source file, use the @code{list} command
4925 (abbreviated @code{l}). By default, ten lines are printed.
4926 There are several ways to specify what part of the file you want to
4927 print; see @ref{Specify Location}, for the full list.
4928
4929 Here are the forms of the @code{list} command most commonly used:
4930
4931 @table @code
4932 @item list @var{linenum}
4933 Print lines centered around line number @var{linenum} in the
4934 current source file.
4935
4936 @item list @var{function}
4937 Print lines centered around the beginning of function
4938 @var{function}.
4939
4940 @item list
4941 Print more lines. If the last lines printed were printed with a
4942 @code{list} command, this prints lines following the last lines
4943 printed; however, if the last line printed was a solitary line printed
4944 as part of displaying a stack frame (@pxref{Stack, ,Examining the
4945 Stack}), this prints lines centered around that line.
4946
4947 @item list -
4948 Print lines just before the lines last printed.
4949 @end table
4950
4951 @cindex @code{list}, how many lines to display
4952 By default, @value{GDBN} prints ten source lines with any of these forms of
4953 the @code{list} command. You can change this using @code{set listsize}:
4954
4955 @table @code
4956 @kindex set listsize
4957 @item set listsize @var{count}
4958 Make the @code{list} command display @var{count} source lines (unless
4959 the @code{list} argument explicitly specifies some other number).
4960
4961 @kindex show listsize
4962 @item show listsize
4963 Display the number of lines that @code{list} prints.
4964 @end table
4965
4966 Repeating a @code{list} command with @key{RET} discards the argument,
4967 so it is equivalent to typing just @code{list}. This is more useful
4968 than listing the same lines again. An exception is made for an
4969 argument of @samp{-}; that argument is preserved in repetition so that
4970 each repetition moves up in the source file.
4971
4972 In general, the @code{list} command expects you to supply zero, one or two
4973 @dfn{linespecs}. Linespecs specify source lines; there are several ways
4974 of writing them (@pxref{Specify Location}), but the effect is always
4975 to specify some source line.
4976
4977 Here is a complete description of the possible arguments for @code{list}:
4978
4979 @table @code
4980 @item list @var{linespec}
4981 Print lines centered around the line specified by @var{linespec}.
4982
4983 @item list @var{first},@var{last}
4984 Print lines from @var{first} to @var{last}. Both arguments are
4985 linespecs. When a @code{list} command has two linespecs, and the
4986 source file of the second linespec is omitted, this refers to
4987 the same source file as the first linespec.
4988
4989 @item list ,@var{last}
4990 Print lines ending with @var{last}.
4991
4992 @item list @var{first},
4993 Print lines starting with @var{first}.
4994
4995 @item list +
4996 Print lines just after the lines last printed.
4997
4998 @item list -
4999 Print lines just before the lines last printed.
5000
5001 @item list
5002 As described in the preceding table.
5003 @end table
5004
5005 @node Specify Location
5006 @section Specifying a Location
5007 @cindex specifying location
5008 @cindex linespec
5009
5010 Several @value{GDBN} commands accept arguments that specify a location
5011 of your program's code. Since @value{GDBN} is a source-level
5012 debugger, a location usually specifies some line in the source code;
5013 for that reason, locations are also known as @dfn{linespecs}.
5014
5015 Here are all the different ways of specifying a code location that
5016 @value{GDBN} understands:
5017
5018 @table @code
5019 @item @var{linenum}
5020 Specifies the line number @var{linenum} of the current source file.
5021
5022 @item -@var{offset}
5023 @itemx +@var{offset}
5024 Specifies the line @var{offset} lines before or after the @dfn{current
5025 line}. For the @code{list} command, the current line is the last one
5026 printed; for the breakpoint commands, this is the line at which
5027 execution stopped in the currently selected @dfn{stack frame}
5028 (@pxref{Frames, ,Frames}, for a description of stack frames.) When
5029 used as the second of the two linespecs in a @code{list} command,
5030 this specifies the line @var{offset} lines up or down from the first
5031 linespec.
5032
5033 @item @var{filename}:@var{linenum}
5034 Specifies the line @var{linenum} in the source file @var{filename}.
5035
5036 @item @var{function}
5037 Specifies the line that begins the body of the function @var{function}.
5038 For example, in C, this is the line with the open brace.
5039
5040 @item @var{filename}:@var{function}
5041 Specifies the line that begins the body of the function @var{function}
5042 in the file @var{filename}. You only need the file name with a
5043 function name to avoid ambiguity when there are identically named
5044 functions in different source files.
5045
5046 @item *@var{address}
5047 Specifies the program address @var{address}. For line-oriented
5048 commands, such as @code{list} and @code{edit}, this specifies a source
5049 line that contains @var{address}. For @code{break} and other
5050 breakpoint oriented commands, this can be used to set breakpoints in
5051 parts of your program which do not have debugging information or
5052 source files.
5053
5054 Here @var{address} may be any expression valid in the current working
5055 language (@pxref{Languages, working language}) that specifies a code
5056 address. In addition, as a convenience, @value{GDBN} extends the
5057 semantics of expressions used in locations to cover the situations
5058 that frequently happen during debugging. Here are the various forms
5059 of @var{address}:
5060
5061 @table @code
5062 @item @var{expression}
5063 Any expression valid in the current working language.
5064
5065 @item @var{funcaddr}
5066 An address of a function or procedure derived from its name. In C,
5067 C@t{++}, Java, Objective-C, Fortran, minimal, and assembly, this is
5068 simply the function's name @var{function} (and actually a special case
5069 of a valid expression). In Pascal and Modula-2, this is
5070 @code{&@var{function}}. In Ada, this is @code{@var{function}'Address}
5071 (although the Pascal form also works).
5072
5073 This form specifies the address of the function's first instruction,
5074 before the stack frame and arguments have been set up.
5075
5076 @item '@var{filename}'::@var{funcaddr}
5077 Like @var{funcaddr} above, but also specifies the name of the source
5078 file explicitly. This is useful if the name of the function does not
5079 specify the function unambiguously, e.g., if there are several
5080 functions with identical names in different source files.
5081 @end table
5082
5083 @end table
5084
5085
5086 @node Edit
5087 @section Editing Source Files
5088 @cindex editing source files
5089
5090 @kindex edit
5091 @kindex e @r{(@code{edit})}
5092 To edit the lines in a source file, use the @code{edit} command.
5093 The editing program of your choice
5094 is invoked with the current line set to
5095 the active line in the program.
5096 Alternatively, there are several ways to specify what part of the file you
5097 want to print if you want to see other parts of the program:
5098
5099 @table @code
5100 @item edit @var{location}
5101 Edit the source file specified by @code{location}. Editing starts at
5102 that @var{location}, e.g., at the specified source line of the
5103 specified file. @xref{Specify Location}, for all the possible forms
5104 of the @var{location} argument; here are the forms of the @code{edit}
5105 command most commonly used:
5106
5107 @table @code
5108 @item edit @var{number}
5109 Edit the current source file with @var{number} as the active line number.
5110
5111 @item edit @var{function}
5112 Edit the file containing @var{function} at the beginning of its definition.
5113 @end table
5114
5115 @end table
5116
5117 @subsection Choosing your Editor
5118 You can customize @value{GDBN} to use any editor you want
5119 @footnote{
5120 The only restriction is that your editor (say @code{ex}), recognizes the
5121 following command-line syntax:
5122 @smallexample
5123 ex +@var{number} file
5124 @end smallexample
5125 The optional numeric value +@var{number} specifies the number of the line in
5126 the file where to start editing.}.
5127 By default, it is @file{@value{EDITOR}}, but you can change this
5128 by setting the environment variable @code{EDITOR} before using
5129 @value{GDBN}. For example, to configure @value{GDBN} to use the
5130 @code{vi} editor, you could use these commands with the @code{sh} shell:
5131 @smallexample
5132 EDITOR=/usr/bin/vi
5133 export EDITOR
5134 gdb @dots{}
5135 @end smallexample
5136 or in the @code{csh} shell,
5137 @smallexample
5138 setenv EDITOR /usr/bin/vi
5139 gdb @dots{}
5140 @end smallexample
5141
5142 @node Search
5143 @section Searching Source Files
5144 @cindex searching source files
5145
5146 There are two commands for searching through the current source file for a
5147 regular expression.
5148
5149 @table @code
5150 @kindex search
5151 @kindex forward-search
5152 @item forward-search @var{regexp}
5153 @itemx search @var{regexp}
5154 The command @samp{forward-search @var{regexp}} checks each line,
5155 starting with the one following the last line listed, for a match for
5156 @var{regexp}. It lists the line that is found. You can use the
5157 synonym @samp{search @var{regexp}} or abbreviate the command name as
5158 @code{fo}.
5159
5160 @kindex reverse-search
5161 @item reverse-search @var{regexp}
5162 The command @samp{reverse-search @var{regexp}} checks each line, starting
5163 with the one before the last line listed and going backward, for a match
5164 for @var{regexp}. It lists the line that is found. You can abbreviate
5165 this command as @code{rev}.
5166 @end table
5167
5168 @node Source Path
5169 @section Specifying Source Directories
5170
5171 @cindex source path
5172 @cindex directories for source files
5173 Executable programs sometimes do not record the directories of the source
5174 files from which they were compiled, just the names. Even when they do,
5175 the directories could be moved between the compilation and your debugging
5176 session. @value{GDBN} has a list of directories to search for source files;
5177 this is called the @dfn{source path}. Each time @value{GDBN} wants a source file,
5178 it tries all the directories in the list, in the order they are present
5179 in the list, until it finds a file with the desired name.
5180
5181 For example, suppose an executable references the file
5182 @file{/usr/src/foo-1.0/lib/foo.c}, and our source path is
5183 @file{/mnt/cross}. The file is first looked up literally; if this
5184 fails, @file{/mnt/cross/usr/src/foo-1.0/lib/foo.c} is tried; if this
5185 fails, @file{/mnt/cross/foo.c} is opened; if this fails, an error
5186 message is printed. @value{GDBN} does not look up the parts of the
5187 source file name, such as @file{/mnt/cross/src/foo-1.0/lib/foo.c}.
5188 Likewise, the subdirectories of the source path are not searched: if
5189 the source path is @file{/mnt/cross}, and the binary refers to
5190 @file{foo.c}, @value{GDBN} would not find it under
5191 @file{/mnt/cross/usr/src/foo-1.0/lib}.
5192
5193 Plain file names, relative file names with leading directories, file
5194 names containing dots, etc.@: are all treated as described above; for
5195 instance, if the source path is @file{/mnt/cross}, and the source file
5196 is recorded as @file{../lib/foo.c}, @value{GDBN} would first try
5197 @file{../lib/foo.c}, then @file{/mnt/cross/../lib/foo.c}, and after
5198 that---@file{/mnt/cross/foo.c}.
5199
5200 Note that the executable search path is @emph{not} used to locate the
5201 source files.
5202
5203 Whenever you reset or rearrange the source path, @value{GDBN} clears out
5204 any information it has cached about where source files are found and where
5205 each line is in the file.
5206
5207 @kindex directory
5208 @kindex dir
5209 When you start @value{GDBN}, its source path includes only @samp{cdir}
5210 and @samp{cwd}, in that order.
5211 To add other directories, use the @code{directory} command.
5212
5213 The search path is used to find both program source files and @value{GDBN}
5214 script files (read using the @samp{-command} option and @samp{source} command).
5215
5216 In addition to the source path, @value{GDBN} provides a set of commands
5217 that manage a list of source path substitution rules. A @dfn{substitution
5218 rule} specifies how to rewrite source directories stored in the program's
5219 debug information in case the sources were moved to a different
5220 directory between compilation and debugging. A rule is made of
5221 two strings, the first specifying what needs to be rewritten in
5222 the path, and the second specifying how it should be rewritten.
5223 In @ref{set substitute-path}, we name these two parts @var{from} and
5224 @var{to} respectively. @value{GDBN} does a simple string replacement
5225 of @var{from} with @var{to} at the start of the directory part of the
5226 source file name, and uses that result instead of the original file
5227 name to look up the sources.
5228
5229 Using the previous example, suppose the @file{foo-1.0} tree has been
5230 moved from @file{/usr/src} to @file{/mnt/cross}, then you can tell
5231 @value{GDBN} to replace @file{/usr/src} in all source path names with
5232 @file{/mnt/cross}. The first lookup will then be
5233 @file{/mnt/cross/foo-1.0/lib/foo.c} in place of the original location
5234 of @file{/usr/src/foo-1.0/lib/foo.c}. To define a source path
5235 substitution rule, use the @code{set substitute-path} command
5236 (@pxref{set substitute-path}).
5237
5238 To avoid unexpected substitution results, a rule is applied only if the
5239 @var{from} part of the directory name ends at a directory separator.
5240 For instance, a rule substituting @file{/usr/source} into
5241 @file{/mnt/cross} will be applied to @file{/usr/source/foo-1.0} but
5242 not to @file{/usr/sourceware/foo-2.0}. And because the substitution
5243 is applied only at the beginning of the directory name, this rule will
5244 not be applied to @file{/root/usr/source/baz.c} either.
5245
5246 In many cases, you can achieve the same result using the @code{directory}
5247 command. However, @code{set substitute-path} can be more efficient in
5248 the case where the sources are organized in a complex tree with multiple
5249 subdirectories. With the @code{directory} command, you need to add each
5250 subdirectory of your project. If you moved the entire tree while
5251 preserving its internal organization, then @code{set substitute-path}
5252 allows you to direct the debugger to all the sources with one single
5253 command.
5254
5255 @code{set substitute-path} is also more than just a shortcut command.
5256 The source path is only used if the file at the original location no
5257 longer exists. On the other hand, @code{set substitute-path} modifies
5258 the debugger behavior to look at the rewritten location instead. So, if
5259 for any reason a source file that is not relevant to your executable is
5260 located at the original location, a substitution rule is the only
5261 method available to point @value{GDBN} at the new location.
5262
5263 @table @code
5264 @item directory @var{dirname} @dots{}
5265 @item dir @var{dirname} @dots{}
5266 Add directory @var{dirname} to the front of the source path. Several
5267 directory names may be given to this command, separated by @samp{:}
5268 (@samp{;} on MS-DOS and MS-Windows, where @samp{:} usually appears as
5269 part of absolute file names) or
5270 whitespace. You may specify a directory that is already in the source
5271 path; this moves it forward, so @value{GDBN} searches it sooner.
5272
5273 @kindex cdir
5274 @kindex cwd
5275 @vindex $cdir@r{, convenience variable}
5276 @vindex $cwd@r{, convenience variable}
5277 @cindex compilation directory
5278 @cindex current directory
5279 @cindex working directory
5280 @cindex directory, current
5281 @cindex directory, compilation
5282 You can use the string @samp{$cdir} to refer to the compilation
5283 directory (if one is recorded), and @samp{$cwd} to refer to the current
5284 working directory. @samp{$cwd} is not the same as @samp{.}---the former
5285 tracks the current working directory as it changes during your @value{GDBN}
5286 session, while the latter is immediately expanded to the current
5287 directory at the time you add an entry to the source path.
5288
5289 @item directory
5290 Reset the source path to its default value (@samp{$cdir:$cwd} on Unix systems). This requires confirmation.
5291
5292 @c RET-repeat for @code{directory} is explicitly disabled, but since
5293 @c repeating it would be a no-op we do not say that. (thanks to RMS)
5294
5295 @item show directories
5296 @kindex show directories
5297 Print the source path: show which directories it contains.
5298
5299 @anchor{set substitute-path}
5300 @item set substitute-path @var{from} @var{to}
5301 @kindex set substitute-path
5302 Define a source path substitution rule, and add it at the end of the
5303 current list of existing substitution rules. If a rule with the same
5304 @var{from} was already defined, then the old rule is also deleted.
5305
5306 For example, if the file @file{/foo/bar/baz.c} was moved to
5307 @file{/mnt/cross/baz.c}, then the command
5308
5309 @smallexample
5310 (@value{GDBP}) set substitute-path /usr/src /mnt/cross
5311 @end smallexample
5312
5313 @noindent
5314 will tell @value{GDBN} to replace @samp{/usr/src} with
5315 @samp{/mnt/cross}, which will allow @value{GDBN} to find the file
5316 @file{baz.c} even though it was moved.
5317
5318 In the case when more than one substitution rule have been defined,
5319 the rules are evaluated one by one in the order where they have been
5320 defined. The first one matching, if any, is selected to perform
5321 the substitution.
5322
5323 For instance, if we had entered the following commands:
5324
5325 @smallexample
5326 (@value{GDBP}) set substitute-path /usr/src/include /mnt/include
5327 (@value{GDBP}) set substitute-path /usr/src /mnt/src
5328 @end smallexample
5329
5330 @noindent
5331 @value{GDBN} would then rewrite @file{/usr/src/include/defs.h} into
5332 @file{/mnt/include/defs.h} by using the first rule. However, it would
5333 use the second rule to rewrite @file{/usr/src/lib/foo.c} into
5334 @file{/mnt/src/lib/foo.c}.
5335
5336
5337 @item unset substitute-path [path]
5338 @kindex unset substitute-path
5339 If a path is specified, search the current list of substitution rules
5340 for a rule that would rewrite that path. Delete that rule if found.
5341 A warning is emitted by the debugger if no rule could be found.
5342
5343 If no path is specified, then all substitution rules are deleted.
5344
5345 @item show substitute-path [path]
5346 @kindex show substitute-path
5347 If a path is specified, then print the source path substitution rule
5348 which would rewrite that path, if any.
5349
5350 If no path is specified, then print all existing source path substitution
5351 rules.
5352
5353 @end table
5354
5355 If your source path is cluttered with directories that are no longer of
5356 interest, @value{GDBN} may sometimes cause confusion by finding the wrong
5357 versions of source. You can correct the situation as follows:
5358
5359 @enumerate
5360 @item
5361 Use @code{directory} with no argument to reset the source path to its default value.
5362
5363 @item
5364 Use @code{directory} with suitable arguments to reinstall the
5365 directories you want in the source path. You can add all the
5366 directories in one command.
5367 @end enumerate
5368
5369 @node Machine Code
5370 @section Source and Machine Code
5371 @cindex source line and its code address
5372
5373 You can use the command @code{info line} to map source lines to program
5374 addresses (and vice versa), and the command @code{disassemble} to display
5375 a range of addresses as machine instructions. When run under @sc{gnu} Emacs
5376 mode, the @code{info line} command causes the arrow to point to the
5377 line specified. Also, @code{info line} prints addresses in symbolic form as
5378 well as hex.
5379
5380 @table @code
5381 @kindex info line
5382 @item info line @var{linespec}
5383 Print the starting and ending addresses of the compiled code for
5384 source line @var{linespec}. You can specify source lines in any of
5385 the ways documented in @ref{Specify Location}.
5386 @end table
5387
5388 For example, we can use @code{info line} to discover the location of
5389 the object code for the first line of function
5390 @code{m4_changequote}:
5391
5392 @c FIXME: I think this example should also show the addresses in
5393 @c symbolic form, as they usually would be displayed.
5394 @smallexample
5395 (@value{GDBP}) info line m4_changequote
5396 Line 895 of "builtin.c" starts at pc 0x634c and ends at 0x6350.
5397 @end smallexample
5398
5399 @noindent
5400 @cindex code address and its source line
5401 We can also inquire (using @code{*@var{addr}} as the form for
5402 @var{linespec}) what source line covers a particular address:
5403 @smallexample
5404 (@value{GDBP}) info line *0x63ff
5405 Line 926 of "builtin.c" starts at pc 0x63e4 and ends at 0x6404.
5406 @end smallexample
5407
5408 @cindex @code{$_} and @code{info line}
5409 @cindex @code{x} command, default address
5410 @kindex x@r{(examine), and} info line
5411 After @code{info line}, the default address for the @code{x} command
5412 is changed to the starting address of the line, so that @samp{x/i} is
5413 sufficient to begin examining the machine code (@pxref{Memory,
5414 ,Examining Memory}). Also, this address is saved as the value of the
5415 convenience variable @code{$_} (@pxref{Convenience Vars, ,Convenience
5416 Variables}).
5417
5418 @table @code
5419 @kindex disassemble
5420 @cindex assembly instructions
5421 @cindex instructions, assembly
5422 @cindex machine instructions
5423 @cindex listing machine instructions
5424 @item disassemble
5425 This specialized command dumps a range of memory as machine
5426 instructions. The default memory range is the function surrounding the
5427 program counter of the selected frame. A single argument to this
5428 command is a program counter value; @value{GDBN} dumps the function
5429 surrounding this value. Two arguments specify a range of addresses
5430 (first inclusive, second exclusive) to dump.
5431 @end table
5432
5433 The following example shows the disassembly of a range of addresses of
5434 HP PA-RISC 2.0 code:
5435
5436 @smallexample
5437 (@value{GDBP}) disas 0x32c4 0x32e4
5438 Dump of assembler code from 0x32c4 to 0x32e4:
5439 0x32c4 <main+204>: addil 0,dp
5440 0x32c8 <main+208>: ldw 0x22c(sr0,r1),r26
5441 0x32cc <main+212>: ldil 0x3000,r31
5442 0x32d0 <main+216>: ble 0x3f8(sr4,r31)
5443 0x32d4 <main+220>: ldo 0(r31),rp
5444 0x32d8 <main+224>: addil -0x800,dp
5445 0x32dc <main+228>: ldo 0x588(r1),r26
5446 0x32e0 <main+232>: ldil 0x3000,r31
5447 End of assembler dump.
5448 @end smallexample
5449
5450 Some architectures have more than one commonly-used set of instruction
5451 mnemonics or other syntax.
5452
5453 For programs that were dynamically linked and use shared libraries,
5454 instructions that call functions or branch to locations in the shared
5455 libraries might show a seemingly bogus location---it's actually a
5456 location of the relocation table. On some architectures, @value{GDBN}
5457 might be able to resolve these to actual function names.
5458
5459 @table @code
5460 @kindex set disassembly-flavor
5461 @cindex Intel disassembly flavor
5462 @cindex AT&T disassembly flavor
5463 @item set disassembly-flavor @var{instruction-set}
5464 Select the instruction set to use when disassembling the
5465 program via the @code{disassemble} or @code{x/i} commands.
5466
5467 Currently this command is only defined for the Intel x86 family. You
5468 can set @var{instruction-set} to either @code{intel} or @code{att}.
5469 The default is @code{att}, the AT&T flavor used by default by Unix
5470 assemblers for x86-based targets.
5471
5472 @kindex show disassembly-flavor
5473 @item show disassembly-flavor
5474 Show the current setting of the disassembly flavor.
5475 @end table
5476
5477
5478 @node Data
5479 @chapter Examining Data
5480
5481 @cindex printing data
5482 @cindex examining data
5483 @kindex print
5484 @kindex inspect
5485 @c "inspect" is not quite a synonym if you are using Epoch, which we do not
5486 @c document because it is nonstandard... Under Epoch it displays in a
5487 @c different window or something like that.
5488 The usual way to examine data in your program is with the @code{print}
5489 command (abbreviated @code{p}), or its synonym @code{inspect}. It
5490 evaluates and prints the value of an expression of the language your
5491 program is written in (@pxref{Languages, ,Using @value{GDBN} with
5492 Different Languages}).
5493
5494 @table @code
5495 @item print @var{expr}
5496 @itemx print /@var{f} @var{expr}
5497 @var{expr} is an expression (in the source language). By default the
5498 value of @var{expr} is printed in a format appropriate to its data type;
5499 you can choose a different format by specifying @samp{/@var{f}}, where
5500 @var{f} is a letter specifying the format; see @ref{Output Formats,,Output
5501 Formats}.
5502
5503 @item print
5504 @itemx print /@var{f}
5505 @cindex reprint the last value
5506 If you omit @var{expr}, @value{GDBN} displays the last value again (from the
5507 @dfn{value history}; @pxref{Value History, ,Value History}). This allows you to
5508 conveniently inspect the same value in an alternative format.
5509 @end table
5510
5511 A more low-level way of examining data is with the @code{x} command.
5512 It examines data in memory at a specified address and prints it in a
5513 specified format. @xref{Memory, ,Examining Memory}.
5514
5515 If you are interested in information about types, or about how the
5516 fields of a struct or a class are declared, use the @code{ptype @var{exp}}
5517 command rather than @code{print}. @xref{Symbols, ,Examining the Symbol
5518 Table}.
5519
5520 @menu
5521 * Expressions:: Expressions
5522 * Ambiguous Expressions:: Ambiguous Expressions
5523 * Variables:: Program variables
5524 * Arrays:: Artificial arrays
5525 * Output Formats:: Output formats
5526 * Memory:: Examining memory
5527 * Auto Display:: Automatic display
5528 * Print Settings:: Print settings
5529 * Value History:: Value history
5530 * Convenience Vars:: Convenience variables
5531 * Registers:: Registers
5532 * Floating Point Hardware:: Floating point hardware
5533 * Vector Unit:: Vector Unit
5534 * OS Information:: Auxiliary data provided by operating system
5535 * Memory Region Attributes:: Memory region attributes
5536 * Dump/Restore Files:: Copy between memory and a file
5537 * Core File Generation:: Cause a program dump its core
5538 * Character Sets:: Debugging programs that use a different
5539 character set than GDB does
5540 * Caching Remote Data:: Data caching for remote targets
5541 @end menu
5542
5543 @node Expressions
5544 @section Expressions
5545
5546 @cindex expressions
5547 @code{print} and many other @value{GDBN} commands accept an expression and
5548 compute its value. Any kind of constant, variable or operator defined
5549 by the programming language you are using is valid in an expression in
5550 @value{GDBN}. This includes conditional expressions, function calls,
5551 casts, and string constants. It also includes preprocessor macros, if
5552 you compiled your program to include this information; see
5553 @ref{Compilation}.
5554
5555 @cindex arrays in expressions
5556 @value{GDBN} supports array constants in expressions input by
5557 the user. The syntax is @{@var{element}, @var{element}@dots{}@}. For example,
5558 you can use the command @code{print @{1, 2, 3@}} to create an array
5559 of three integers. If you pass an array to a function or assign it
5560 to a program variable, @value{GDBN} copies the array to memory that
5561 is @code{malloc}ed in the target program.
5562
5563 Because C is so widespread, most of the expressions shown in examples in
5564 this manual are in C. @xref{Languages, , Using @value{GDBN} with Different
5565 Languages}, for information on how to use expressions in other
5566 languages.
5567
5568 In this section, we discuss operators that you can use in @value{GDBN}
5569 expressions regardless of your programming language.
5570
5571 @cindex casts, in expressions
5572 Casts are supported in all languages, not just in C, because it is so
5573 useful to cast a number into a pointer in order to examine a structure
5574 at that address in memory.
5575 @c FIXME: casts supported---Mod2 true?
5576
5577 @value{GDBN} supports these operators, in addition to those common
5578 to programming languages:
5579
5580 @table @code
5581 @item @@
5582 @samp{@@} is a binary operator for treating parts of memory as arrays.
5583 @xref{Arrays, ,Artificial Arrays}, for more information.
5584
5585 @item ::
5586 @samp{::} allows you to specify a variable in terms of the file or
5587 function where it is defined. @xref{Variables, ,Program Variables}.
5588
5589 @cindex @{@var{type}@}
5590 @cindex type casting memory
5591 @cindex memory, viewing as typed object
5592 @cindex casts, to view memory
5593 @item @{@var{type}@} @var{addr}
5594 Refers to an object of type @var{type} stored at address @var{addr} in
5595 memory. @var{addr} may be any expression whose value is an integer or
5596 pointer (but parentheses are required around binary operators, just as in
5597 a cast). This construct is allowed regardless of what kind of data is
5598 normally supposed to reside at @var{addr}.
5599 @end table
5600
5601 @node Ambiguous Expressions
5602 @section Ambiguous Expressions
5603 @cindex ambiguous expressions
5604
5605 Expressions can sometimes contain some ambiguous elements. For instance,
5606 some programming languages (notably Ada, C@t{++} and Objective-C) permit
5607 a single function name to be defined several times, for application in
5608 different contexts. This is called @dfn{overloading}. Another example
5609 involving Ada is generics. A @dfn{generic package} is similar to C@t{++}
5610 templates and is typically instantiated several times, resulting in
5611 the same function name being defined in different contexts.
5612
5613 In some cases and depending on the language, it is possible to adjust
5614 the expression to remove the ambiguity. For instance in C@t{++}, you
5615 can specify the signature of the function you want to break on, as in
5616 @kbd{break @var{function}(@var{types})}. In Ada, using the fully
5617 qualified name of your function often makes the expression unambiguous
5618 as well.
5619
5620 When an ambiguity that needs to be resolved is detected, the debugger
5621 has the capability to display a menu of numbered choices for each
5622 possibility, and then waits for the selection with the prompt @samp{>}.
5623 The first option is always @samp{[0] cancel}, and typing @kbd{0 @key{RET}}
5624 aborts the current command. If the command in which the expression was
5625 used allows more than one choice to be selected, the next option in the
5626 menu is @samp{[1] all}, and typing @kbd{1 @key{RET}} selects all possible
5627 choices.
5628
5629 For example, the following session excerpt shows an attempt to set a
5630 breakpoint at the overloaded symbol @code{String::after}.
5631 We choose three particular definitions of that function name:
5632
5633 @c FIXME! This is likely to change to show arg type lists, at least
5634 @smallexample
5635 @group
5636 (@value{GDBP}) b String::after
5637 [0] cancel
5638 [1] all
5639 [2] file:String.cc; line number:867
5640 [3] file:String.cc; line number:860
5641 [4] file:String.cc; line number:875
5642 [5] file:String.cc; line number:853
5643 [6] file:String.cc; line number:846
5644 [7] file:String.cc; line number:735
5645 > 2 4 6
5646 Breakpoint 1 at 0xb26c: file String.cc, line 867.
5647 Breakpoint 2 at 0xb344: file String.cc, line 875.
5648 Breakpoint 3 at 0xafcc: file String.cc, line 846.
5649 Multiple breakpoints were set.
5650 Use the "delete" command to delete unwanted
5651 breakpoints.
5652 (@value{GDBP})
5653 @end group
5654 @end smallexample
5655
5656 @table @code
5657 @kindex set multiple-symbols
5658 @item set multiple-symbols @var{mode}
5659 @cindex multiple-symbols menu
5660
5661 This option allows you to adjust the debugger behavior when an expression
5662 is ambiguous.
5663
5664 By default, @var{mode} is set to @code{all}. If the command with which
5665 the expression is used allows more than one choice, then @value{GDBN}
5666 automatically selects all possible choices. For instance, inserting
5667 a breakpoint on a function using an ambiguous name results in a breakpoint
5668 inserted on each possible match. However, if a unique choice must be made,
5669 then @value{GDBN} uses the menu to help you disambiguate the expression.
5670 For instance, printing the address of an overloaded function will result
5671 in the use of the menu.
5672
5673 When @var{mode} is set to @code{ask}, the debugger always uses the menu
5674 when an ambiguity is detected.
5675
5676 Finally, when @var{mode} is set to @code{cancel}, the debugger reports
5677 an error due to the ambiguity and the command is aborted.
5678
5679 @kindex show multiple-symbols
5680 @item show multiple-symbols
5681 Show the current value of the @code{multiple-symbols} setting.
5682 @end table
5683
5684 @node Variables
5685 @section Program Variables
5686
5687 The most common kind of expression to use is the name of a variable
5688 in your program.
5689
5690 Variables in expressions are understood in the selected stack frame
5691 (@pxref{Selection, ,Selecting a Frame}); they must be either:
5692
5693 @itemize @bullet
5694 @item
5695 global (or file-static)
5696 @end itemize
5697
5698 @noindent or
5699
5700 @itemize @bullet
5701 @item
5702 visible according to the scope rules of the
5703 programming language from the point of execution in that frame
5704 @end itemize
5705
5706 @noindent This means that in the function
5707
5708 @smallexample
5709 foo (a)
5710 int a;
5711 @{
5712 bar (a);
5713 @{
5714 int b = test ();
5715 bar (b);
5716 @}
5717 @}
5718 @end smallexample
5719
5720 @noindent
5721 you can examine and use the variable @code{a} whenever your program is
5722 executing within the function @code{foo}, but you can only use or
5723 examine the variable @code{b} while your program is executing inside
5724 the block where @code{b} is declared.
5725
5726 @cindex variable name conflict
5727 There is an exception: you can refer to a variable or function whose
5728 scope is a single source file even if the current execution point is not
5729 in this file. But it is possible to have more than one such variable or
5730 function with the same name (in different source files). If that
5731 happens, referring to that name has unpredictable effects. If you wish,
5732 you can specify a static variable in a particular function or file,
5733 using the colon-colon (@code{::}) notation:
5734
5735 @cindex colon-colon, context for variables/functions
5736 @ifnotinfo
5737 @c info cannot cope with a :: index entry, but why deprive hard copy readers?
5738 @cindex @code{::}, context for variables/functions
5739 @end ifnotinfo
5740 @smallexample
5741 @var{file}::@var{variable}
5742 @var{function}::@var{variable}
5743 @end smallexample
5744
5745 @noindent
5746 Here @var{file} or @var{function} is the name of the context for the
5747 static @var{variable}. In the case of file names, you can use quotes to
5748 make sure @value{GDBN} parses the file name as a single word---for example,
5749 to print a global value of @code{x} defined in @file{f2.c}:
5750
5751 @smallexample
5752 (@value{GDBP}) p 'f2.c'::x
5753 @end smallexample
5754
5755 @cindex C@t{++} scope resolution
5756 This use of @samp{::} is very rarely in conflict with the very similar
5757 use of the same notation in C@t{++}. @value{GDBN} also supports use of the C@t{++}
5758 scope resolution operator in @value{GDBN} expressions.
5759 @c FIXME: Um, so what happens in one of those rare cases where it's in
5760 @c conflict?? --mew
5761
5762 @cindex wrong values
5763 @cindex variable values, wrong
5764 @cindex function entry/exit, wrong values of variables
5765 @cindex optimized code, wrong values of variables
5766 @quotation
5767 @emph{Warning:} Occasionally, a local variable may appear to have the
5768 wrong value at certain points in a function---just after entry to a new
5769 scope, and just before exit.
5770 @end quotation
5771 You may see this problem when you are stepping by machine instructions.
5772 This is because, on most machines, it takes more than one instruction to
5773 set up a stack frame (including local variable definitions); if you are
5774 stepping by machine instructions, variables may appear to have the wrong
5775 values until the stack frame is completely built. On exit, it usually
5776 also takes more than one machine instruction to destroy a stack frame;
5777 after you begin stepping through that group of instructions, local
5778 variable definitions may be gone.
5779
5780 This may also happen when the compiler does significant optimizations.
5781 To be sure of always seeing accurate values, turn off all optimization
5782 when compiling.
5783
5784 @cindex ``No symbol "foo" in current context''
5785 Another possible effect of compiler optimizations is to optimize
5786 unused variables out of existence, or assign variables to registers (as
5787 opposed to memory addresses). Depending on the support for such cases
5788 offered by the debug info format used by the compiler, @value{GDBN}
5789 might not be able to display values for such local variables. If that
5790 happens, @value{GDBN} will print a message like this:
5791
5792 @smallexample
5793 No symbol "foo" in current context.
5794 @end smallexample
5795
5796 To solve such problems, either recompile without optimizations, or use a
5797 different debug info format, if the compiler supports several such
5798 formats. For example, @value{NGCC}, the @sc{gnu} C/C@t{++} compiler,
5799 usually supports the @option{-gstabs+} option. @option{-gstabs+}
5800 produces debug info in a format that is superior to formats such as
5801 COFF. You may be able to use DWARF 2 (@option{-gdwarf-2}), which is also
5802 an effective form for debug info. @xref{Debugging Options,,Options
5803 for Debugging Your Program or GCC, gcc.info, Using the @sc{gnu}
5804 Compiler Collection (GCC)}.
5805 @xref{C, ,C and C@t{++}}, for more information about debug info formats
5806 that are best suited to C@t{++} programs.
5807
5808 If you ask to print an object whose contents are unknown to
5809 @value{GDBN}, e.g., because its data type is not completely specified
5810 by the debug information, @value{GDBN} will say @samp{<incomplete
5811 type>}. @xref{Symbols, incomplete type}, for more about this.
5812
5813 Strings are identified as arrays of @code{char} values without specified
5814 signedness. Arrays of either @code{signed char} or @code{unsigned char} get
5815 printed as arrays of 1 byte sized integers. @code{-fsigned-char} or
5816 @code{-funsigned-char} @value{NGCC} options have no effect as @value{GDBN}
5817 defines literal string type @code{"char"} as @code{char} without a sign.
5818 For program code
5819
5820 @smallexample
5821 char var0[] = "A";
5822 signed char var1[] = "A";
5823 @end smallexample
5824
5825 You get during debugging
5826 @smallexample
5827 (gdb) print var0
5828 $1 = "A"
5829 (gdb) print var1
5830 $2 = @{65 'A', 0 '\0'@}
5831 @end smallexample
5832
5833 @node Arrays
5834 @section Artificial Arrays
5835
5836 @cindex artificial array
5837 @cindex arrays
5838 @kindex @@@r{, referencing memory as an array}
5839 It is often useful to print out several successive objects of the
5840 same type in memory; a section of an array, or an array of
5841 dynamically determined size for which only a pointer exists in the
5842 program.
5843
5844 You can do this by referring to a contiguous span of memory as an
5845 @dfn{artificial array}, using the binary operator @samp{@@}. The left
5846 operand of @samp{@@} should be the first element of the desired array
5847 and be an individual object. The right operand should be the desired length
5848 of the array. The result is an array value whose elements are all of
5849 the type of the left argument. The first element is actually the left
5850 argument; the second element comes from bytes of memory immediately
5851 following those that hold the first element, and so on. Here is an
5852 example. If a program says
5853
5854 @smallexample
5855 int *array = (int *) malloc (len * sizeof (int));
5856 @end smallexample
5857
5858 @noindent
5859 you can print the contents of @code{array} with
5860
5861 @smallexample
5862 p *array@@len
5863 @end smallexample
5864
5865 The left operand of @samp{@@} must reside in memory. Array values made
5866 with @samp{@@} in this way behave just like other arrays in terms of
5867 subscripting, and are coerced to pointers when used in expressions.
5868 Artificial arrays most often appear in expressions via the value history
5869 (@pxref{Value History, ,Value History}), after printing one out.
5870
5871 Another way to create an artificial array is to use a cast.
5872 This re-interprets a value as if it were an array.
5873 The value need not be in memory:
5874 @smallexample
5875 (@value{GDBP}) p/x (short[2])0x12345678
5876 $1 = @{0x1234, 0x5678@}
5877 @end smallexample
5878
5879 As a convenience, if you leave the array length out (as in
5880 @samp{(@var{type}[])@var{value}}) @value{GDBN} calculates the size to fill
5881 the value (as @samp{sizeof(@var{value})/sizeof(@var{type})}:
5882 @smallexample
5883 (@value{GDBP}) p/x (short[])0x12345678
5884 $2 = @{0x1234, 0x5678@}
5885 @end smallexample
5886
5887 Sometimes the artificial array mechanism is not quite enough; in
5888 moderately complex data structures, the elements of interest may not
5889 actually be adjacent---for example, if you are interested in the values
5890 of pointers in an array. One useful work-around in this situation is
5891 to use a convenience variable (@pxref{Convenience Vars, ,Convenience
5892 Variables}) as a counter in an expression that prints the first
5893 interesting value, and then repeat that expression via @key{RET}. For
5894 instance, suppose you have an array @code{dtab} of pointers to
5895 structures, and you are interested in the values of a field @code{fv}
5896 in each structure. Here is an example of what you might type:
5897
5898 @smallexample
5899 set $i = 0
5900 p dtab[$i++]->fv
5901 @key{RET}
5902 @key{RET}
5903 @dots{}
5904 @end smallexample
5905
5906 @node Output Formats
5907 @section Output Formats
5908
5909 @cindex formatted output
5910 @cindex output formats
5911 By default, @value{GDBN} prints a value according to its data type. Sometimes
5912 this is not what you want. For example, you might want to print a number
5913 in hex, or a pointer in decimal. Or you might want to view data in memory
5914 at a certain address as a character string or as an instruction. To do
5915 these things, specify an @dfn{output format} when you print a value.
5916
5917 The simplest use of output formats is to say how to print a value
5918 already computed. This is done by starting the arguments of the
5919 @code{print} command with a slash and a format letter. The format
5920 letters supported are:
5921
5922 @table @code
5923 @item x
5924 Regard the bits of the value as an integer, and print the integer in
5925 hexadecimal.
5926
5927 @item d
5928 Print as integer in signed decimal.
5929
5930 @item u
5931 Print as integer in unsigned decimal.
5932
5933 @item o
5934 Print as integer in octal.
5935
5936 @item t
5937 Print as integer in binary. The letter @samp{t} stands for ``two''.
5938 @footnote{@samp{b} cannot be used because these format letters are also
5939 used with the @code{x} command, where @samp{b} stands for ``byte'';
5940 see @ref{Memory,,Examining Memory}.}
5941
5942 @item a
5943 @cindex unknown address, locating
5944 @cindex locate address
5945 Print as an address, both absolute in hexadecimal and as an offset from
5946 the nearest preceding symbol. You can use this format used to discover
5947 where (in what function) an unknown address is located:
5948
5949 @smallexample
5950 (@value{GDBP}) p/a 0x54320
5951 $3 = 0x54320 <_initialize_vx+396>
5952 @end smallexample
5953
5954 @noindent
5955 The command @code{info symbol 0x54320} yields similar results.
5956 @xref{Symbols, info symbol}.
5957
5958 @item c
5959 Regard as an integer and print it as a character constant. This
5960 prints both the numerical value and its character representation. The
5961 character representation is replaced with the octal escape @samp{\nnn}
5962 for characters outside the 7-bit @sc{ascii} range.
5963
5964 Without this format, @value{GDBN} displays @code{char},
5965 @w{@code{unsigned char}}, and @w{@code{signed char}} data as character
5966 constants. Single-byte members of vectors are displayed as integer
5967 data.
5968
5969 @item f
5970 Regard the bits of the value as a floating point number and print
5971 using typical floating point syntax.
5972
5973 @item s
5974 @cindex printing strings
5975 @cindex printing byte arrays
5976 Regard as a string, if possible. With this format, pointers to single-byte
5977 data are displayed as null-terminated strings and arrays of single-byte data
5978 are displayed as fixed-length strings. Other values are displayed in their
5979 natural types.
5980
5981 Without this format, @value{GDBN} displays pointers to and arrays of
5982 @code{char}, @w{@code{unsigned char}}, and @w{@code{signed char}} as
5983 strings. Single-byte members of a vector are displayed as an integer
5984 array.
5985 @end table
5986
5987 For example, to print the program counter in hex (@pxref{Registers}), type
5988
5989 @smallexample
5990 p/x $pc
5991 @end smallexample
5992
5993 @noindent
5994 Note that no space is required before the slash; this is because command
5995 names in @value{GDBN} cannot contain a slash.
5996
5997 To reprint the last value in the value history with a different format,
5998 you can use the @code{print} command with just a format and no
5999 expression. For example, @samp{p/x} reprints the last value in hex.
6000
6001 @node Memory
6002 @section Examining Memory
6003
6004 You can use the command @code{x} (for ``examine'') to examine memory in
6005 any of several formats, independently of your program's data types.
6006
6007 @cindex examining memory
6008 @table @code
6009 @kindex x @r{(examine memory)}
6010 @item x/@var{nfu} @var{addr}
6011 @itemx x @var{addr}
6012 @itemx x
6013 Use the @code{x} command to examine memory.
6014 @end table
6015
6016 @var{n}, @var{f}, and @var{u} are all optional parameters that specify how
6017 much memory to display and how to format it; @var{addr} is an
6018 expression giving the address where you want to start displaying memory.
6019 If you use defaults for @var{nfu}, you need not type the slash @samp{/}.
6020 Several commands set convenient defaults for @var{addr}.
6021
6022 @table @r
6023 @item @var{n}, the repeat count
6024 The repeat count is a decimal integer; the default is 1. It specifies
6025 how much memory (counting by units @var{u}) to display.
6026 @c This really is **decimal**; unaffected by 'set radix' as of GDB
6027 @c 4.1.2.
6028
6029 @item @var{f}, the display format
6030 The display format is one of the formats used by @code{print}
6031 (@samp{x}, @samp{d}, @samp{u}, @samp{o}, @samp{t}, @samp{a}, @samp{c},
6032 @samp{f}, @samp{s}), and in addition @samp{i} (for machine instructions).
6033 The default is @samp{x} (hexadecimal) initially. The default changes
6034 each time you use either @code{x} or @code{print}.
6035
6036 @item @var{u}, the unit size
6037 The unit size is any of
6038
6039 @table @code
6040 @item b
6041 Bytes.
6042 @item h
6043 Halfwords (two bytes).
6044 @item w
6045 Words (four bytes). This is the initial default.
6046 @item g
6047 Giant words (eight bytes).
6048 @end table
6049
6050 Each time you specify a unit size with @code{x}, that size becomes the
6051 default unit the next time you use @code{x}. (For the @samp{s} and
6052 @samp{i} formats, the unit size is ignored and is normally not written.)
6053
6054 @item @var{addr}, starting display address
6055 @var{addr} is the address where you want @value{GDBN} to begin displaying
6056 memory. The expression need not have a pointer value (though it may);
6057 it is always interpreted as an integer address of a byte of memory.
6058 @xref{Expressions, ,Expressions}, for more information on expressions. The default for
6059 @var{addr} is usually just after the last address examined---but several
6060 other commands also set the default address: @code{info breakpoints} (to
6061 the address of the last breakpoint listed), @code{info line} (to the
6062 starting address of a line), and @code{print} (if you use it to display
6063 a value from memory).
6064 @end table
6065
6066 For example, @samp{x/3uh 0x54320} is a request to display three halfwords
6067 (@code{h}) of memory, formatted as unsigned decimal integers (@samp{u}),
6068 starting at address @code{0x54320}. @samp{x/4xw $sp} prints the four
6069 words (@samp{w}) of memory above the stack pointer (here, @samp{$sp};
6070 @pxref{Registers, ,Registers}) in hexadecimal (@samp{x}).
6071
6072 Since the letters indicating unit sizes are all distinct from the
6073 letters specifying output formats, you do not have to remember whether
6074 unit size or format comes first; either order works. The output
6075 specifications @samp{4xw} and @samp{4wx} mean exactly the same thing.
6076 (However, the count @var{n} must come first; @samp{wx4} does not work.)
6077
6078 Even though the unit size @var{u} is ignored for the formats @samp{s}
6079 and @samp{i}, you might still want to use a count @var{n}; for example,
6080 @samp{3i} specifies that you want to see three machine instructions,
6081 including any operands. For convenience, especially when used with
6082 the @code{display} command, the @samp{i} format also prints branch delay
6083 slot instructions, if any, beyond the count specified, which immediately
6084 follow the last instruction that is within the count. The command
6085 @code{disassemble} gives an alternative way of inspecting machine
6086 instructions; see @ref{Machine Code,,Source and Machine Code}.
6087
6088 All the defaults for the arguments to @code{x} are designed to make it
6089 easy to continue scanning memory with minimal specifications each time
6090 you use @code{x}. For example, after you have inspected three machine
6091 instructions with @samp{x/3i @var{addr}}, you can inspect the next seven
6092 with just @samp{x/7}. If you use @key{RET} to repeat the @code{x} command,
6093 the repeat count @var{n} is used again; the other arguments default as
6094 for successive uses of @code{x}.
6095
6096 @cindex @code{$_}, @code{$__}, and value history
6097 The addresses and contents printed by the @code{x} command are not saved
6098 in the value history because there is often too much of them and they
6099 would get in the way. Instead, @value{GDBN} makes these values available for
6100 subsequent use in expressions as values of the convenience variables
6101 @code{$_} and @code{$__}. After an @code{x} command, the last address
6102 examined is available for use in expressions in the convenience variable
6103 @code{$_}. The contents of that address, as examined, are available in
6104 the convenience variable @code{$__}.
6105
6106 If the @code{x} command has a repeat count, the address and contents saved
6107 are from the last memory unit printed; this is not the same as the last
6108 address printed if several units were printed on the last line of output.
6109
6110 @cindex remote memory comparison
6111 @cindex verify remote memory image
6112 When you are debugging a program running on a remote target machine
6113 (@pxref{Remote Debugging}), you may wish to verify the program's image in the
6114 remote machine's memory against the executable file you downloaded to
6115 the target. The @code{compare-sections} command is provided for such
6116 situations.
6117
6118 @table @code
6119 @kindex compare-sections
6120 @item compare-sections @r{[}@var{section-name}@r{]}
6121 Compare the data of a loadable section @var{section-name} in the
6122 executable file of the program being debugged with the same section in
6123 the remote machine's memory, and report any mismatches. With no
6124 arguments, compares all loadable sections. This command's
6125 availability depends on the target's support for the @code{"qCRC"}
6126 remote request.
6127 @end table
6128
6129 @node Auto Display
6130 @section Automatic Display
6131 @cindex automatic display
6132 @cindex display of expressions
6133
6134 If you find that you want to print the value of an expression frequently
6135 (to see how it changes), you might want to add it to the @dfn{automatic
6136 display list} so that @value{GDBN} prints its value each time your program stops.
6137 Each expression added to the list is given a number to identify it;
6138 to remove an expression from the list, you specify that number.
6139 The automatic display looks like this:
6140
6141 @smallexample
6142 2: foo = 38
6143 3: bar[5] = (struct hack *) 0x3804
6144 @end smallexample
6145
6146 @noindent
6147 This display shows item numbers, expressions and their current values. As with
6148 displays you request manually using @code{x} or @code{print}, you can
6149 specify the output format you prefer; in fact, @code{display} decides
6150 whether to use @code{print} or @code{x} depending your format
6151 specification---it uses @code{x} if you specify either the @samp{i}
6152 or @samp{s} format, or a unit size; otherwise it uses @code{print}.
6153
6154 @table @code
6155 @kindex display
6156 @item display @var{expr}
6157 Add the expression @var{expr} to the list of expressions to display
6158 each time your program stops. @xref{Expressions, ,Expressions}.
6159
6160 @code{display} does not repeat if you press @key{RET} again after using it.
6161
6162 @item display/@var{fmt} @var{expr}
6163 For @var{fmt} specifying only a display format and not a size or
6164 count, add the expression @var{expr} to the auto-display list but
6165 arrange to display it each time in the specified format @var{fmt}.
6166 @xref{Output Formats,,Output Formats}.
6167
6168 @item display/@var{fmt} @var{addr}
6169 For @var{fmt} @samp{i} or @samp{s}, or including a unit-size or a
6170 number of units, add the expression @var{addr} as a memory address to
6171 be examined each time your program stops. Examining means in effect
6172 doing @samp{x/@var{fmt} @var{addr}}. @xref{Memory, ,Examining Memory}.
6173 @end table
6174
6175 For example, @samp{display/i $pc} can be helpful, to see the machine
6176 instruction about to be executed each time execution stops (@samp{$pc}
6177 is a common name for the program counter; @pxref{Registers, ,Registers}).
6178
6179 @table @code
6180 @kindex delete display
6181 @kindex undisplay
6182 @item undisplay @var{dnums}@dots{}
6183 @itemx delete display @var{dnums}@dots{}
6184 Remove item numbers @var{dnums} from the list of expressions to display.
6185
6186 @code{undisplay} does not repeat if you press @key{RET} after using it.
6187 (Otherwise you would just get the error @samp{No display number @dots{}}.)
6188
6189 @kindex disable display
6190 @item disable display @var{dnums}@dots{}
6191 Disable the display of item numbers @var{dnums}. A disabled display
6192 item is not printed automatically, but is not forgotten. It may be
6193 enabled again later.
6194
6195 @kindex enable display
6196 @item enable display @var{dnums}@dots{}
6197 Enable display of item numbers @var{dnums}. It becomes effective once
6198 again in auto display of its expression, until you specify otherwise.
6199
6200 @item display
6201 Display the current values of the expressions on the list, just as is
6202 done when your program stops.
6203
6204 @kindex info display
6205 @item info display
6206 Print the list of expressions previously set up to display
6207 automatically, each one with its item number, but without showing the
6208 values. This includes disabled expressions, which are marked as such.
6209 It also includes expressions which would not be displayed right now
6210 because they refer to automatic variables not currently available.
6211 @end table
6212
6213 @cindex display disabled out of scope
6214 If a display expression refers to local variables, then it does not make
6215 sense outside the lexical context for which it was set up. Such an
6216 expression is disabled when execution enters a context where one of its
6217 variables is not defined. For example, if you give the command
6218 @code{display last_char} while inside a function with an argument
6219 @code{last_char}, @value{GDBN} displays this argument while your program
6220 continues to stop inside that function. When it stops elsewhere---where
6221 there is no variable @code{last_char}---the display is disabled
6222 automatically. The next time your program stops where @code{last_char}
6223 is meaningful, you can enable the display expression once again.
6224
6225 @node Print Settings
6226 @section Print Settings
6227
6228 @cindex format options
6229 @cindex print settings
6230 @value{GDBN} provides the following ways to control how arrays, structures,
6231 and symbols are printed.
6232
6233 @noindent
6234 These settings are useful for debugging programs in any language:
6235
6236 @table @code
6237 @kindex set print
6238 @item set print address
6239 @itemx set print address on
6240 @cindex print/don't print memory addresses
6241 @value{GDBN} prints memory addresses showing the location of stack
6242 traces, structure values, pointer values, breakpoints, and so forth,
6243 even when it also displays the contents of those addresses. The default
6244 is @code{on}. For example, this is what a stack frame display looks like with
6245 @code{set print address on}:
6246
6247 @smallexample
6248 @group
6249 (@value{GDBP}) f
6250 #0 set_quotes (lq=0x34c78 "<<", rq=0x34c88 ">>")
6251 at input.c:530
6252 530 if (lquote != def_lquote)
6253 @end group
6254 @end smallexample
6255
6256 @item set print address off
6257 Do not print addresses when displaying their contents. For example,
6258 this is the same stack frame displayed with @code{set print address off}:
6259
6260 @smallexample
6261 @group
6262 (@value{GDBP}) set print addr off
6263 (@value{GDBP}) f
6264 #0 set_quotes (lq="<<", rq=">>") at input.c:530
6265 530 if (lquote != def_lquote)
6266 @end group
6267 @end smallexample
6268
6269 You can use @samp{set print address off} to eliminate all machine
6270 dependent displays from the @value{GDBN} interface. For example, with
6271 @code{print address off}, you should get the same text for backtraces on
6272 all machines---whether or not they involve pointer arguments.
6273
6274 @kindex show print
6275 @item show print address
6276 Show whether or not addresses are to be printed.
6277 @end table
6278
6279 When @value{GDBN} prints a symbolic address, it normally prints the
6280 closest earlier symbol plus an offset. If that symbol does not uniquely
6281 identify the address (for example, it is a name whose scope is a single
6282 source file), you may need to clarify. One way to do this is with
6283 @code{info line}, for example @samp{info line *0x4537}. Alternately,
6284 you can set @value{GDBN} to print the source file and line number when
6285 it prints a symbolic address:
6286
6287 @table @code
6288 @item set print symbol-filename on
6289 @cindex source file and line of a symbol
6290 @cindex symbol, source file and line
6291 Tell @value{GDBN} to print the source file name and line number of a
6292 symbol in the symbolic form of an address.
6293
6294 @item set print symbol-filename off
6295 Do not print source file name and line number of a symbol. This is the
6296 default.
6297
6298 @item show print symbol-filename
6299 Show whether or not @value{GDBN} will print the source file name and
6300 line number of a symbol in the symbolic form of an address.
6301 @end table
6302
6303 Another situation where it is helpful to show symbol filenames and line
6304 numbers is when disassembling code; @value{GDBN} shows you the line
6305 number and source file that corresponds to each instruction.
6306
6307 Also, you may wish to see the symbolic form only if the address being
6308 printed is reasonably close to the closest earlier symbol:
6309
6310 @table @code
6311 @item set print max-symbolic-offset @var{max-offset}
6312 @cindex maximum value for offset of closest symbol
6313 Tell @value{GDBN} to only display the symbolic form of an address if the
6314 offset between the closest earlier symbol and the address is less than
6315 @var{max-offset}. The default is 0, which tells @value{GDBN}
6316 to always print the symbolic form of an address if any symbol precedes it.
6317
6318 @item show print max-symbolic-offset
6319 Ask how large the maximum offset is that @value{GDBN} prints in a
6320 symbolic address.
6321 @end table
6322
6323 @cindex wild pointer, interpreting
6324 @cindex pointer, finding referent
6325 If you have a pointer and you are not sure where it points, try
6326 @samp{set print symbol-filename on}. Then you can determine the name
6327 and source file location of the variable where it points, using
6328 @samp{p/a @var{pointer}}. This interprets the address in symbolic form.
6329 For example, here @value{GDBN} shows that a variable @code{ptt} points
6330 at another variable @code{t}, defined in @file{hi2.c}:
6331
6332 @smallexample
6333 (@value{GDBP}) set print symbol-filename on
6334 (@value{GDBP}) p/a ptt
6335 $4 = 0xe008 <t in hi2.c>
6336 @end smallexample
6337
6338 @quotation
6339 @emph{Warning:} For pointers that point to a local variable, @samp{p/a}
6340 does not show the symbol name and filename of the referent, even with
6341 the appropriate @code{set print} options turned on.
6342 @end quotation
6343
6344 Other settings control how different kinds of objects are printed:
6345
6346 @table @code
6347 @item set print array
6348 @itemx set print array on
6349 @cindex pretty print arrays
6350 Pretty print arrays. This format is more convenient to read,
6351 but uses more space. The default is off.
6352
6353 @item set print array off
6354 Return to compressed format for arrays.
6355
6356 @item show print array
6357 Show whether compressed or pretty format is selected for displaying
6358 arrays.
6359
6360 @cindex print array indexes
6361 @item set print array-indexes
6362 @itemx set print array-indexes on
6363 Print the index of each element when displaying arrays. May be more
6364 convenient to locate a given element in the array or quickly find the
6365 index of a given element in that printed array. The default is off.
6366
6367 @item set print array-indexes off
6368 Stop printing element indexes when displaying arrays.
6369
6370 @item show print array-indexes
6371 Show whether the index of each element is printed when displaying
6372 arrays.
6373
6374 @item set print elements @var{number-of-elements}
6375 @cindex number of array elements to print
6376 @cindex limit on number of printed array elements
6377 Set a limit on how many elements of an array @value{GDBN} will print.
6378 If @value{GDBN} is printing a large array, it stops printing after it has
6379 printed the number of elements set by the @code{set print elements} command.
6380 This limit also applies to the display of strings.
6381 When @value{GDBN} starts, this limit is set to 200.
6382 Setting @var{number-of-elements} to zero means that the printing is unlimited.
6383
6384 @item show print elements
6385 Display the number of elements of a large array that @value{GDBN} will print.
6386 If the number is 0, then the printing is unlimited.
6387
6388 @item set print frame-arguments @var{value}
6389 @cindex printing frame argument values
6390 @cindex print all frame argument values
6391 @cindex print frame argument values for scalars only
6392 @cindex do not print frame argument values
6393 This command allows to control how the values of arguments are printed
6394 when the debugger prints a frame (@pxref{Frames}). The possible
6395 values are:
6396
6397 @table @code
6398 @item all
6399 The values of all arguments are printed. This is the default.
6400
6401 @item scalars
6402 Print the value of an argument only if it is a scalar. The value of more
6403 complex arguments such as arrays, structures, unions, etc, is replaced
6404 by @code{@dots{}}. Here is an example where only scalar arguments are shown:
6405
6406 @smallexample
6407 #1 0x08048361 in call_me (i=3, s=@dots{}, ss=0xbf8d508c, u=@dots{}, e=green)
6408 at frame-args.c:23
6409 @end smallexample
6410
6411 @item none
6412 None of the argument values are printed. Instead, the value of each argument
6413 is replaced by @code{@dots{}}. In this case, the example above now becomes:
6414
6415 @smallexample
6416 #1 0x08048361 in call_me (i=@dots{}, s=@dots{}, ss=@dots{}, u=@dots{}, e=@dots{})
6417 at frame-args.c:23
6418 @end smallexample
6419 @end table
6420
6421 By default, all argument values are always printed. But this command
6422 can be useful in several cases. For instance, it can be used to reduce
6423 the amount of information printed in each frame, making the backtrace
6424 more readable. Also, this command can be used to improve performance
6425 when displaying Ada frames, because the computation of large arguments
6426 can sometimes be CPU-intensive, especiallly in large applications.
6427 Setting @code{print frame-arguments} to @code{scalars} or @code{none}
6428 avoids this computation, thus speeding up the display of each Ada frame.
6429
6430 @item show print frame-arguments
6431 Show how the value of arguments should be displayed when printing a frame.
6432
6433 @item set print repeats
6434 @cindex repeated array elements
6435 Set the threshold for suppressing display of repeated array
6436 elements. When the number of consecutive identical elements of an
6437 array exceeds the threshold, @value{GDBN} prints the string
6438 @code{"<repeats @var{n} times>"}, where @var{n} is the number of
6439 identical repetitions, instead of displaying the identical elements
6440 themselves. Setting the threshold to zero will cause all elements to
6441 be individually printed. The default threshold is 10.
6442
6443 @item show print repeats
6444 Display the current threshold for printing repeated identical
6445 elements.
6446
6447 @item set print null-stop
6448 @cindex @sc{null} elements in arrays
6449 Cause @value{GDBN} to stop printing the characters of an array when the first
6450 @sc{null} is encountered. This is useful when large arrays actually
6451 contain only short strings.
6452 The default is off.
6453
6454 @item show print null-stop
6455 Show whether @value{GDBN} stops printing an array on the first
6456 @sc{null} character.
6457
6458 @item set print pretty on
6459 @cindex print structures in indented form
6460 @cindex indentation in structure display
6461 Cause @value{GDBN} to print structures in an indented format with one member
6462 per line, like this:
6463
6464 @smallexample
6465 @group
6466 $1 = @{
6467 next = 0x0,
6468 flags = @{
6469 sweet = 1,
6470 sour = 1
6471 @},
6472 meat = 0x54 "Pork"
6473 @}
6474 @end group
6475 @end smallexample
6476
6477 @item set print pretty off
6478 Cause @value{GDBN} to print structures in a compact format, like this:
6479
6480 @smallexample
6481 @group
6482 $1 = @{next = 0x0, flags = @{sweet = 1, sour = 1@}, \
6483 meat = 0x54 "Pork"@}
6484 @end group
6485 @end smallexample
6486
6487 @noindent
6488 This is the default format.
6489
6490 @item show print pretty
6491 Show which format @value{GDBN} is using to print structures.
6492
6493 @item set print sevenbit-strings on
6494 @cindex eight-bit characters in strings
6495 @cindex octal escapes in strings
6496 Print using only seven-bit characters; if this option is set,
6497 @value{GDBN} displays any eight-bit characters (in strings or
6498 character values) using the notation @code{\}@var{nnn}. This setting is
6499 best if you are working in English (@sc{ascii}) and you use the
6500 high-order bit of characters as a marker or ``meta'' bit.
6501
6502 @item set print sevenbit-strings off
6503 Print full eight-bit characters. This allows the use of more
6504 international character sets, and is the default.
6505
6506 @item show print sevenbit-strings
6507 Show whether or not @value{GDBN} is printing only seven-bit characters.
6508
6509 @item set print union on
6510 @cindex unions in structures, printing
6511 Tell @value{GDBN} to print unions which are contained in structures
6512 and other unions. This is the default setting.
6513
6514 @item set print union off
6515 Tell @value{GDBN} not to print unions which are contained in
6516 structures and other unions. @value{GDBN} will print @code{"@{...@}"}
6517 instead.
6518
6519 @item show print union
6520 Ask @value{GDBN} whether or not it will print unions which are contained in
6521 structures and other unions.
6522
6523 For example, given the declarations
6524
6525 @smallexample
6526 typedef enum @{Tree, Bug@} Species;
6527 typedef enum @{Big_tree, Acorn, Seedling@} Tree_forms;
6528 typedef enum @{Caterpillar, Cocoon, Butterfly@}
6529 Bug_forms;
6530
6531 struct thing @{
6532 Species it;
6533 union @{
6534 Tree_forms tree;
6535 Bug_forms bug;
6536 @} form;
6537 @};
6538
6539 struct thing foo = @{Tree, @{Acorn@}@};
6540 @end smallexample
6541
6542 @noindent
6543 with @code{set print union on} in effect @samp{p foo} would print
6544
6545 @smallexample
6546 $1 = @{it = Tree, form = @{tree = Acorn, bug = Cocoon@}@}
6547 @end smallexample
6548
6549 @noindent
6550 and with @code{set print union off} in effect it would print
6551
6552 @smallexample
6553 $1 = @{it = Tree, form = @{...@}@}
6554 @end smallexample
6555
6556 @noindent
6557 @code{set print union} affects programs written in C-like languages
6558 and in Pascal.
6559 @end table
6560
6561 @need 1000
6562 @noindent
6563 These settings are of interest when debugging C@t{++} programs:
6564
6565 @table @code
6566 @cindex demangling C@t{++} names
6567 @item set print demangle
6568 @itemx set print demangle on
6569 Print C@t{++} names in their source form rather than in the encoded
6570 (``mangled'') form passed to the assembler and linker for type-safe
6571 linkage. The default is on.
6572
6573 @item show print demangle
6574 Show whether C@t{++} names are printed in mangled or demangled form.
6575
6576 @item set print asm-demangle
6577 @itemx set print asm-demangle on
6578 Print C@t{++} names in their source form rather than their mangled form, even
6579 in assembler code printouts such as instruction disassemblies.
6580 The default is off.
6581
6582 @item show print asm-demangle
6583 Show whether C@t{++} names in assembly listings are printed in mangled
6584 or demangled form.
6585
6586 @cindex C@t{++} symbol decoding style
6587 @cindex symbol decoding style, C@t{++}
6588 @kindex set demangle-style
6589 @item set demangle-style @var{style}
6590 Choose among several encoding schemes used by different compilers to
6591 represent C@t{++} names. The choices for @var{style} are currently:
6592
6593 @table @code
6594 @item auto
6595 Allow @value{GDBN} to choose a decoding style by inspecting your program.
6596
6597 @item gnu
6598 Decode based on the @sc{gnu} C@t{++} compiler (@code{g++}) encoding algorithm.
6599 This is the default.
6600
6601 @item hp
6602 Decode based on the HP ANSI C@t{++} (@code{aCC}) encoding algorithm.
6603
6604 @item lucid
6605 Decode based on the Lucid C@t{++} compiler (@code{lcc}) encoding algorithm.
6606
6607 @item arm
6608 Decode using the algorithm in the @cite{C@t{++} Annotated Reference Manual}.
6609 @strong{Warning:} this setting alone is not sufficient to allow
6610 debugging @code{cfront}-generated executables. @value{GDBN} would
6611 require further enhancement to permit that.
6612
6613 @end table
6614 If you omit @var{style}, you will see a list of possible formats.
6615
6616 @item show demangle-style
6617 Display the encoding style currently in use for decoding C@t{++} symbols.
6618
6619 @item set print object
6620 @itemx set print object on
6621 @cindex derived type of an object, printing
6622 @cindex display derived types
6623 When displaying a pointer to an object, identify the @emph{actual}
6624 (derived) type of the object rather than the @emph{declared} type, using
6625 the virtual function table.
6626
6627 @item set print object off
6628 Display only the declared type of objects, without reference to the
6629 virtual function table. This is the default setting.
6630
6631 @item show print object
6632 Show whether actual, or declared, object types are displayed.
6633
6634 @item set print static-members
6635 @itemx set print static-members on
6636 @cindex static members of C@t{++} objects
6637 Print static members when displaying a C@t{++} object. The default is on.
6638
6639 @item set print static-members off
6640 Do not print static members when displaying a C@t{++} object.
6641
6642 @item show print static-members
6643 Show whether C@t{++} static members are printed or not.
6644
6645 @item set print pascal_static-members
6646 @itemx set print pascal_static-members on
6647 @cindex static members of Pascal objects
6648 @cindex Pascal objects, static members display
6649 Print static members when displaying a Pascal object. The default is on.
6650
6651 @item set print pascal_static-members off
6652 Do not print static members when displaying a Pascal object.
6653
6654 @item show print pascal_static-members
6655 Show whether Pascal static members are printed or not.
6656
6657 @c These don't work with HP ANSI C++ yet.
6658 @item set print vtbl
6659 @itemx set print vtbl on
6660 @cindex pretty print C@t{++} virtual function tables
6661 @cindex virtual functions (C@t{++}) display
6662 @cindex VTBL display
6663 Pretty print C@t{++} virtual function tables. The default is off.
6664 (The @code{vtbl} commands do not work on programs compiled with the HP
6665 ANSI C@t{++} compiler (@code{aCC}).)
6666
6667 @item set print vtbl off
6668 Do not pretty print C@t{++} virtual function tables.
6669
6670 @item show print vtbl
6671 Show whether C@t{++} virtual function tables are pretty printed, or not.
6672 @end table
6673
6674 @node Value History
6675 @section Value History
6676
6677 @cindex value history
6678 @cindex history of values printed by @value{GDBN}
6679 Values printed by the @code{print} command are saved in the @value{GDBN}
6680 @dfn{value history}. This allows you to refer to them in other expressions.
6681 Values are kept until the symbol table is re-read or discarded
6682 (for example with the @code{file} or @code{symbol-file} commands).
6683 When the symbol table changes, the value history is discarded,
6684 since the values may contain pointers back to the types defined in the
6685 symbol table.
6686
6687 @cindex @code{$}
6688 @cindex @code{$$}
6689 @cindex history number
6690 The values printed are given @dfn{history numbers} by which you can
6691 refer to them. These are successive integers starting with one.
6692 @code{print} shows you the history number assigned to a value by
6693 printing @samp{$@var{num} = } before the value; here @var{num} is the
6694 history number.
6695
6696 To refer to any previous value, use @samp{$} followed by the value's
6697 history number. The way @code{print} labels its output is designed to
6698 remind you of this. Just @code{$} refers to the most recent value in
6699 the history, and @code{$$} refers to the value before that.
6700 @code{$$@var{n}} refers to the @var{n}th value from the end; @code{$$2}
6701 is the value just prior to @code{$$}, @code{$$1} is equivalent to
6702 @code{$$}, and @code{$$0} is equivalent to @code{$}.
6703
6704 For example, suppose you have just printed a pointer to a structure and
6705 want to see the contents of the structure. It suffices to type
6706
6707 @smallexample
6708 p *$
6709 @end smallexample
6710
6711 If you have a chain of structures where the component @code{next} points
6712 to the next one, you can print the contents of the next one with this:
6713
6714 @smallexample
6715 p *$.next
6716 @end smallexample
6717
6718 @noindent
6719 You can print successive links in the chain by repeating this
6720 command---which you can do by just typing @key{RET}.
6721
6722 Note that the history records values, not expressions. If the value of
6723 @code{x} is 4 and you type these commands:
6724
6725 @smallexample
6726 print x
6727 set x=5
6728 @end smallexample
6729
6730 @noindent
6731 then the value recorded in the value history by the @code{print} command
6732 remains 4 even though the value of @code{x} has changed.
6733
6734 @table @code
6735 @kindex show values
6736 @item show values
6737 Print the last ten values in the value history, with their item numbers.
6738 This is like @samp{p@ $$9} repeated ten times, except that @code{show
6739 values} does not change the history.
6740
6741 @item show values @var{n}
6742 Print ten history values centered on history item number @var{n}.
6743
6744 @item show values +
6745 Print ten history values just after the values last printed. If no more
6746 values are available, @code{show values +} produces no display.
6747 @end table
6748
6749 Pressing @key{RET} to repeat @code{show values @var{n}} has exactly the
6750 same effect as @samp{show values +}.
6751
6752 @node Convenience Vars
6753 @section Convenience Variables
6754
6755 @cindex convenience variables
6756 @cindex user-defined variables
6757 @value{GDBN} provides @dfn{convenience variables} that you can use within
6758 @value{GDBN} to hold on to a value and refer to it later. These variables
6759 exist entirely within @value{GDBN}; they are not part of your program, and
6760 setting a convenience variable has no direct effect on further execution
6761 of your program. That is why you can use them freely.
6762
6763 Convenience variables are prefixed with @samp{$}. Any name preceded by
6764 @samp{$} can be used for a convenience variable, unless it is one of
6765 the predefined machine-specific register names (@pxref{Registers, ,Registers}).
6766 (Value history references, in contrast, are @emph{numbers} preceded
6767 by @samp{$}. @xref{Value History, ,Value History}.)
6768
6769 You can save a value in a convenience variable with an assignment
6770 expression, just as you would set a variable in your program.
6771 For example:
6772
6773 @smallexample
6774 set $foo = *object_ptr
6775 @end smallexample
6776
6777 @noindent
6778 would save in @code{$foo} the value contained in the object pointed to by
6779 @code{object_ptr}.
6780
6781 Using a convenience variable for the first time creates it, but its
6782 value is @code{void} until you assign a new value. You can alter the
6783 value with another assignment at any time.
6784
6785 Convenience variables have no fixed types. You can assign a convenience
6786 variable any type of value, including structures and arrays, even if
6787 that variable already has a value of a different type. The convenience
6788 variable, when used as an expression, has the type of its current value.
6789
6790 @table @code
6791 @kindex show convenience
6792 @cindex show all user variables
6793 @item show convenience
6794 Print a list of convenience variables used so far, and their values.
6795 Abbreviated @code{show conv}.
6796
6797 @kindex init-if-undefined
6798 @cindex convenience variables, initializing
6799 @item init-if-undefined $@var{variable} = @var{expression}
6800 Set a convenience variable if it has not already been set. This is useful
6801 for user-defined commands that keep some state. It is similar, in concept,
6802 to using local static variables with initializers in C (except that
6803 convenience variables are global). It can also be used to allow users to
6804 override default values used in a command script.
6805
6806 If the variable is already defined then the expression is not evaluated so
6807 any side-effects do not occur.
6808 @end table
6809
6810 One of the ways to use a convenience variable is as a counter to be
6811 incremented or a pointer to be advanced. For example, to print
6812 a field from successive elements of an array of structures:
6813
6814 @smallexample
6815 set $i = 0
6816 print bar[$i++]->contents
6817 @end smallexample
6818
6819 @noindent
6820 Repeat that command by typing @key{RET}.
6821
6822 Some convenience variables are created automatically by @value{GDBN} and given
6823 values likely to be useful.
6824
6825 @table @code
6826 @vindex $_@r{, convenience variable}
6827 @item $_
6828 The variable @code{$_} is automatically set by the @code{x} command to
6829 the last address examined (@pxref{Memory, ,Examining Memory}). Other
6830 commands which provide a default address for @code{x} to examine also
6831 set @code{$_} to that address; these commands include @code{info line}
6832 and @code{info breakpoint}. The type of @code{$_} is @code{void *}
6833 except when set by the @code{x} command, in which case it is a pointer
6834 to the type of @code{$__}.
6835
6836 @vindex $__@r{, convenience variable}
6837 @item $__
6838 The variable @code{$__} is automatically set by the @code{x} command
6839 to the value found in the last address examined. Its type is chosen
6840 to match the format in which the data was printed.
6841
6842 @item $_exitcode
6843 @vindex $_exitcode@r{, convenience variable}
6844 The variable @code{$_exitcode} is automatically set to the exit code when
6845 the program being debugged terminates.
6846 @end table
6847
6848 On HP-UX systems, if you refer to a function or variable name that
6849 begins with a dollar sign, @value{GDBN} searches for a user or system
6850 name first, before it searches for a convenience variable.
6851
6852 @node Registers
6853 @section Registers
6854
6855 @cindex registers
6856 You can refer to machine register contents, in expressions, as variables
6857 with names starting with @samp{$}. The names of registers are different
6858 for each machine; use @code{info registers} to see the names used on
6859 your machine.
6860
6861 @table @code
6862 @kindex info registers
6863 @item info registers
6864 Print the names and values of all registers except floating-point
6865 and vector registers (in the selected stack frame).
6866
6867 @kindex info all-registers
6868 @cindex floating point registers
6869 @item info all-registers
6870 Print the names and values of all registers, including floating-point
6871 and vector registers (in the selected stack frame).
6872
6873 @item info registers @var{regname} @dots{}
6874 Print the @dfn{relativized} value of each specified register @var{regname}.
6875 As discussed in detail below, register values are normally relative to
6876 the selected stack frame. @var{regname} may be any register name valid on
6877 the machine you are using, with or without the initial @samp{$}.
6878 @end table
6879
6880 @cindex stack pointer register
6881 @cindex program counter register
6882 @cindex process status register
6883 @cindex frame pointer register
6884 @cindex standard registers
6885 @value{GDBN} has four ``standard'' register names that are available (in
6886 expressions) on most machines---whenever they do not conflict with an
6887 architecture's canonical mnemonics for registers. The register names
6888 @code{$pc} and @code{$sp} are used for the program counter register and
6889 the stack pointer. @code{$fp} is used for a register that contains a
6890 pointer to the current stack frame, and @code{$ps} is used for a
6891 register that contains the processor status. For example,
6892 you could print the program counter in hex with
6893
6894 @smallexample
6895 p/x $pc
6896 @end smallexample
6897
6898 @noindent
6899 or print the instruction to be executed next with
6900
6901 @smallexample
6902 x/i $pc
6903 @end smallexample
6904
6905 @noindent
6906 or add four to the stack pointer@footnote{This is a way of removing
6907 one word from the stack, on machines where stacks grow downward in
6908 memory (most machines, nowadays). This assumes that the innermost
6909 stack frame is selected; setting @code{$sp} is not allowed when other
6910 stack frames are selected. To pop entire frames off the stack,
6911 regardless of machine architecture, use @code{return};
6912 see @ref{Returning, ,Returning from a Function}.} with
6913
6914 @smallexample
6915 set $sp += 4
6916 @end smallexample
6917
6918 Whenever possible, these four standard register names are available on
6919 your machine even though the machine has different canonical mnemonics,
6920 so long as there is no conflict. The @code{info registers} command
6921 shows the canonical names. For example, on the SPARC, @code{info
6922 registers} displays the processor status register as @code{$psr} but you
6923 can also refer to it as @code{$ps}; and on x86-based machines @code{$ps}
6924 is an alias for the @sc{eflags} register.
6925
6926 @value{GDBN} always considers the contents of an ordinary register as an
6927 integer when the register is examined in this way. Some machines have
6928 special registers which can hold nothing but floating point; these
6929 registers are considered to have floating point values. There is no way
6930 to refer to the contents of an ordinary register as floating point value
6931 (although you can @emph{print} it as a floating point value with
6932 @samp{print/f $@var{regname}}).
6933
6934 Some registers have distinct ``raw'' and ``virtual'' data formats. This
6935 means that the data format in which the register contents are saved by
6936 the operating system is not the same one that your program normally
6937 sees. For example, the registers of the 68881 floating point
6938 coprocessor are always saved in ``extended'' (raw) format, but all C
6939 programs expect to work with ``double'' (virtual) format. In such
6940 cases, @value{GDBN} normally works with the virtual format only (the format
6941 that makes sense for your program), but the @code{info registers} command
6942 prints the data in both formats.
6943
6944 @cindex SSE registers (x86)
6945 @cindex MMX registers (x86)
6946 Some machines have special registers whose contents can be interpreted
6947 in several different ways. For example, modern x86-based machines
6948 have SSE and MMX registers that can hold several values packed
6949 together in several different formats. @value{GDBN} refers to such
6950 registers in @code{struct} notation:
6951
6952 @smallexample
6953 (@value{GDBP}) print $xmm1
6954 $1 = @{
6955 v4_float = @{0, 3.43859137e-038, 1.54142831e-044, 1.821688e-044@},
6956 v2_double = @{9.92129282474342e-303, 2.7585945287983262e-313@},
6957 v16_int8 = "\000\000\000\000\3706;\001\v\000\000\000\r\000\000",
6958 v8_int16 = @{0, 0, 14072, 315, 11, 0, 13, 0@},
6959 v4_int32 = @{0, 20657912, 11, 13@},
6960 v2_int64 = @{88725056443645952, 55834574859@},
6961 uint128 = 0x0000000d0000000b013b36f800000000
6962 @}
6963 @end smallexample
6964
6965 @noindent
6966 To set values of such registers, you need to tell @value{GDBN} which
6967 view of the register you wish to change, as if you were assigning
6968 value to a @code{struct} member:
6969
6970 @smallexample
6971 (@value{GDBP}) set $xmm1.uint128 = 0x000000000000000000000000FFFFFFFF
6972 @end smallexample
6973
6974 Normally, register values are relative to the selected stack frame
6975 (@pxref{Selection, ,Selecting a Frame}). This means that you get the
6976 value that the register would contain if all stack frames farther in
6977 were exited and their saved registers restored. In order to see the
6978 true contents of hardware registers, you must select the innermost
6979 frame (with @samp{frame 0}).
6980
6981 However, @value{GDBN} must deduce where registers are saved, from the machine
6982 code generated by your compiler. If some registers are not saved, or if
6983 @value{GDBN} is unable to locate the saved registers, the selected stack
6984 frame makes no difference.
6985
6986 @node Floating Point Hardware
6987 @section Floating Point Hardware
6988 @cindex floating point
6989
6990 Depending on the configuration, @value{GDBN} may be able to give
6991 you more information about the status of the floating point hardware.
6992
6993 @table @code
6994 @kindex info float
6995 @item info float
6996 Display hardware-dependent information about the floating
6997 point unit. The exact contents and layout vary depending on the
6998 floating point chip. Currently, @samp{info float} is supported on
6999 the ARM and x86 machines.
7000 @end table
7001
7002 @node Vector Unit
7003 @section Vector Unit
7004 @cindex vector unit
7005
7006 Depending on the configuration, @value{GDBN} may be able to give you
7007 more information about the status of the vector unit.
7008
7009 @table @code
7010 @kindex info vector
7011 @item info vector
7012 Display information about the vector unit. The exact contents and
7013 layout vary depending on the hardware.
7014 @end table
7015
7016 @node OS Information
7017 @section Operating System Auxiliary Information
7018 @cindex OS information
7019
7020 @value{GDBN} provides interfaces to useful OS facilities that can help
7021 you debug your program.
7022
7023 @cindex @code{ptrace} system call
7024 @cindex @code{struct user} contents
7025 When @value{GDBN} runs on a @dfn{Posix system} (such as GNU or Unix
7026 machines), it interfaces with the inferior via the @code{ptrace}
7027 system call. The operating system creates a special sata structure,
7028 called @code{struct user}, for this interface. You can use the
7029 command @code{info udot} to display the contents of this data
7030 structure.
7031
7032 @table @code
7033 @item info udot
7034 @kindex info udot
7035 Display the contents of the @code{struct user} maintained by the OS
7036 kernel for the program being debugged. @value{GDBN} displays the
7037 contents of @code{struct user} as a list of hex numbers, similar to
7038 the @code{examine} command.
7039 @end table
7040
7041 @cindex auxiliary vector
7042 @cindex vector, auxiliary
7043 Some operating systems supply an @dfn{auxiliary vector} to programs at
7044 startup. This is akin to the arguments and environment that you
7045 specify for a program, but contains a system-dependent variety of
7046 binary values that tell system libraries important details about the
7047 hardware, operating system, and process. Each value's purpose is
7048 identified by an integer tag; the meanings are well-known but system-specific.
7049 Depending on the configuration and operating system facilities,
7050 @value{GDBN} may be able to show you this information. For remote
7051 targets, this functionality may further depend on the remote stub's
7052 support of the @samp{qXfer:auxv:read} packet, see
7053 @ref{qXfer auxiliary vector read}.
7054
7055 @table @code
7056 @kindex info auxv
7057 @item info auxv
7058 Display the auxiliary vector of the inferior, which can be either a
7059 live process or a core dump file. @value{GDBN} prints each tag value
7060 numerically, and also shows names and text descriptions for recognized
7061 tags. Some values in the vector are numbers, some bit masks, and some
7062 pointers to strings or other data. @value{GDBN} displays each value in the
7063 most appropriate form for a recognized tag, and in hexadecimal for
7064 an unrecognized tag.
7065 @end table
7066
7067
7068 @node Memory Region Attributes
7069 @section Memory Region Attributes
7070 @cindex memory region attributes
7071
7072 @dfn{Memory region attributes} allow you to describe special handling
7073 required by regions of your target's memory. @value{GDBN} uses
7074 attributes to determine whether to allow certain types of memory
7075 accesses; whether to use specific width accesses; and whether to cache
7076 target memory. By default the description of memory regions is
7077 fetched from the target (if the current target supports this), but the
7078 user can override the fetched regions.
7079
7080 Defined memory regions can be individually enabled and disabled. When a
7081 memory region is disabled, @value{GDBN} uses the default attributes when
7082 accessing memory in that region. Similarly, if no memory regions have
7083 been defined, @value{GDBN} uses the default attributes when accessing
7084 all memory.
7085
7086 When a memory region is defined, it is given a number to identify it;
7087 to enable, disable, or remove a memory region, you specify that number.
7088
7089 @table @code
7090 @kindex mem
7091 @item mem @var{lower} @var{upper} @var{attributes}@dots{}
7092 Define a memory region bounded by @var{lower} and @var{upper} with
7093 attributes @var{attributes}@dots{}, and add it to the list of regions
7094 monitored by @value{GDBN}. Note that @var{upper} == 0 is a special
7095 case: it is treated as the target's maximum memory address.
7096 (0xffff on 16 bit targets, 0xffffffff on 32 bit targets, etc.)
7097
7098 @item mem auto
7099 Discard any user changes to the memory regions and use target-supplied
7100 regions, if available, or no regions if the target does not support.
7101
7102 @kindex delete mem
7103 @item delete mem @var{nums}@dots{}
7104 Remove memory regions @var{nums}@dots{} from the list of regions
7105 monitored by @value{GDBN}.
7106
7107 @kindex disable mem
7108 @item disable mem @var{nums}@dots{}
7109 Disable monitoring of memory regions @var{nums}@dots{}.
7110 A disabled memory region is not forgotten.
7111 It may be enabled again later.
7112
7113 @kindex enable mem
7114 @item enable mem @var{nums}@dots{}
7115 Enable monitoring of memory regions @var{nums}@dots{}.
7116
7117 @kindex info mem
7118 @item info mem
7119 Print a table of all defined memory regions, with the following columns
7120 for each region:
7121
7122 @table @emph
7123 @item Memory Region Number
7124 @item Enabled or Disabled.
7125 Enabled memory regions are marked with @samp{y}.
7126 Disabled memory regions are marked with @samp{n}.
7127
7128 @item Lo Address
7129 The address defining the inclusive lower bound of the memory region.
7130
7131 @item Hi Address
7132 The address defining the exclusive upper bound of the memory region.
7133
7134 @item Attributes
7135 The list of attributes set for this memory region.
7136 @end table
7137 @end table
7138
7139
7140 @subsection Attributes
7141
7142 @subsubsection Memory Access Mode
7143 The access mode attributes set whether @value{GDBN} may make read or
7144 write accesses to a memory region.
7145
7146 While these attributes prevent @value{GDBN} from performing invalid
7147 memory accesses, they do nothing to prevent the target system, I/O DMA,
7148 etc.@: from accessing memory.
7149
7150 @table @code
7151 @item ro
7152 Memory is read only.
7153 @item wo
7154 Memory is write only.
7155 @item rw
7156 Memory is read/write. This is the default.
7157 @end table
7158
7159 @subsubsection Memory Access Size
7160 The access size attribute tells @value{GDBN} to use specific sized
7161 accesses in the memory region. Often memory mapped device registers
7162 require specific sized accesses. If no access size attribute is
7163 specified, @value{GDBN} may use accesses of any size.
7164
7165 @table @code
7166 @item 8
7167 Use 8 bit memory accesses.
7168 @item 16
7169 Use 16 bit memory accesses.
7170 @item 32
7171 Use 32 bit memory accesses.
7172 @item 64
7173 Use 64 bit memory accesses.
7174 @end table
7175
7176 @c @subsubsection Hardware/Software Breakpoints
7177 @c The hardware/software breakpoint attributes set whether @value{GDBN}
7178 @c will use hardware or software breakpoints for the internal breakpoints
7179 @c used by the step, next, finish, until, etc. commands.
7180 @c
7181 @c @table @code
7182 @c @item hwbreak
7183 @c Always use hardware breakpoints
7184 @c @item swbreak (default)
7185 @c @end table
7186
7187 @subsubsection Data Cache
7188 The data cache attributes set whether @value{GDBN} will cache target
7189 memory. While this generally improves performance by reducing debug
7190 protocol overhead, it can lead to incorrect results because @value{GDBN}
7191 does not know about volatile variables or memory mapped device
7192 registers.
7193
7194 @table @code
7195 @item cache
7196 Enable @value{GDBN} to cache target memory.
7197 @item nocache
7198 Disable @value{GDBN} from caching target memory. This is the default.
7199 @end table
7200
7201 @subsection Memory Access Checking
7202 @value{GDBN} can be instructed to refuse accesses to memory that is
7203 not explicitly described. This can be useful if accessing such
7204 regions has undesired effects for a specific target, or to provide
7205 better error checking. The following commands control this behaviour.
7206
7207 @table @code
7208 @kindex set mem inaccessible-by-default
7209 @item set mem inaccessible-by-default [on|off]
7210 If @code{on} is specified, make @value{GDBN} treat memory not
7211 explicitly described by the memory ranges as non-existent and refuse accesses
7212 to such memory. The checks are only performed if there's at least one
7213 memory range defined. If @code{off} is specified, make @value{GDBN}
7214 treat the memory not explicitly described by the memory ranges as RAM.
7215 The default value is @code{on}.
7216 @kindex show mem inaccessible-by-default
7217 @item show mem inaccessible-by-default
7218 Show the current handling of accesses to unknown memory.
7219 @end table
7220
7221
7222 @c @subsubsection Memory Write Verification
7223 @c The memory write verification attributes set whether @value{GDBN}
7224 @c will re-reads data after each write to verify the write was successful.
7225 @c
7226 @c @table @code
7227 @c @item verify
7228 @c @item noverify (default)
7229 @c @end table
7230
7231 @node Dump/Restore Files
7232 @section Copy Between Memory and a File
7233 @cindex dump/restore files
7234 @cindex append data to a file
7235 @cindex dump data to a file
7236 @cindex restore data from a file
7237
7238 You can use the commands @code{dump}, @code{append}, and
7239 @code{restore} to copy data between target memory and a file. The
7240 @code{dump} and @code{append} commands write data to a file, and the
7241 @code{restore} command reads data from a file back into the inferior's
7242 memory. Files may be in binary, Motorola S-record, Intel hex, or
7243 Tektronix Hex format; however, @value{GDBN} can only append to binary
7244 files.
7245
7246 @table @code
7247
7248 @kindex dump
7249 @item dump @r{[}@var{format}@r{]} memory @var{filename} @var{start_addr} @var{end_addr}
7250 @itemx dump @r{[}@var{format}@r{]} value @var{filename} @var{expr}
7251 Dump the contents of memory from @var{start_addr} to @var{end_addr},
7252 or the value of @var{expr}, to @var{filename} in the given format.
7253
7254 The @var{format} parameter may be any one of:
7255 @table @code
7256 @item binary
7257 Raw binary form.
7258 @item ihex
7259 Intel hex format.
7260 @item srec
7261 Motorola S-record format.
7262 @item tekhex
7263 Tektronix Hex format.
7264 @end table
7265
7266 @value{GDBN} uses the same definitions of these formats as the
7267 @sc{gnu} binary utilities, like @samp{objdump} and @samp{objcopy}. If
7268 @var{format} is omitted, @value{GDBN} dumps the data in raw binary
7269 form.
7270
7271 @kindex append
7272 @item append @r{[}binary@r{]} memory @var{filename} @var{start_addr} @var{end_addr}
7273 @itemx append @r{[}binary@r{]} value @var{filename} @var{expr}
7274 Append the contents of memory from @var{start_addr} to @var{end_addr},
7275 or the value of @var{expr}, to the file @var{filename}, in raw binary form.
7276 (@value{GDBN} can only append data to files in raw binary form.)
7277
7278 @kindex restore
7279 @item restore @var{filename} @r{[}binary@r{]} @var{bias} @var{start} @var{end}
7280 Restore the contents of file @var{filename} into memory. The
7281 @code{restore} command can automatically recognize any known @sc{bfd}
7282 file format, except for raw binary. To restore a raw binary file you
7283 must specify the optional keyword @code{binary} after the filename.
7284
7285 If @var{bias} is non-zero, its value will be added to the addresses
7286 contained in the file. Binary files always start at address zero, so
7287 they will be restored at address @var{bias}. Other bfd files have
7288 a built-in location; they will be restored at offset @var{bias}
7289 from that location.
7290
7291 If @var{start} and/or @var{end} are non-zero, then only data between
7292 file offset @var{start} and file offset @var{end} will be restored.
7293 These offsets are relative to the addresses in the file, before
7294 the @var{bias} argument is applied.
7295
7296 @end table
7297
7298 @node Core File Generation
7299 @section How to Produce a Core File from Your Program
7300 @cindex dump core from inferior
7301
7302 A @dfn{core file} or @dfn{core dump} is a file that records the memory
7303 image of a running process and its process status (register values
7304 etc.). Its primary use is post-mortem debugging of a program that
7305 crashed while it ran outside a debugger. A program that crashes
7306 automatically produces a core file, unless this feature is disabled by
7307 the user. @xref{Files}, for information on invoking @value{GDBN} in
7308 the post-mortem debugging mode.
7309
7310 Occasionally, you may wish to produce a core file of the program you
7311 are debugging in order to preserve a snapshot of its state.
7312 @value{GDBN} has a special command for that.
7313
7314 @table @code
7315 @kindex gcore
7316 @kindex generate-core-file
7317 @item generate-core-file [@var{file}]
7318 @itemx gcore [@var{file}]
7319 Produce a core dump of the inferior process. The optional argument
7320 @var{file} specifies the file name where to put the core dump. If not
7321 specified, the file name defaults to @file{core.@var{pid}}, where
7322 @var{pid} is the inferior process ID.
7323
7324 Note that this command is implemented only for some systems (as of
7325 this writing, @sc{gnu}/Linux, FreeBSD, Solaris, Unixware, and S390).
7326 @end table
7327
7328 @node Character Sets
7329 @section Character Sets
7330 @cindex character sets
7331 @cindex charset
7332 @cindex translating between character sets
7333 @cindex host character set
7334 @cindex target character set
7335
7336 If the program you are debugging uses a different character set to
7337 represent characters and strings than the one @value{GDBN} uses itself,
7338 @value{GDBN} can automatically translate between the character sets for
7339 you. The character set @value{GDBN} uses we call the @dfn{host
7340 character set}; the one the inferior program uses we call the
7341 @dfn{target character set}.
7342
7343 For example, if you are running @value{GDBN} on a @sc{gnu}/Linux system, which
7344 uses the ISO Latin 1 character set, but you are using @value{GDBN}'s
7345 remote protocol (@pxref{Remote Debugging}) to debug a program
7346 running on an IBM mainframe, which uses the @sc{ebcdic} character set,
7347 then the host character set is Latin-1, and the target character set is
7348 @sc{ebcdic}. If you give @value{GDBN} the command @code{set
7349 target-charset EBCDIC-US}, then @value{GDBN} translates between
7350 @sc{ebcdic} and Latin 1 as you print character or string values, or use
7351 character and string literals in expressions.
7352
7353 @value{GDBN} has no way to automatically recognize which character set
7354 the inferior program uses; you must tell it, using the @code{set
7355 target-charset} command, described below.
7356
7357 Here are the commands for controlling @value{GDBN}'s character set
7358 support:
7359
7360 @table @code
7361 @item set target-charset @var{charset}
7362 @kindex set target-charset
7363 Set the current target character set to @var{charset}. We list the
7364 character set names @value{GDBN} recognizes below, but if you type
7365 @code{set target-charset} followed by @key{TAB}@key{TAB}, @value{GDBN} will
7366 list the target character sets it supports.
7367 @end table
7368
7369 @table @code
7370 @item set host-charset @var{charset}
7371 @kindex set host-charset
7372 Set the current host character set to @var{charset}.
7373
7374 By default, @value{GDBN} uses a host character set appropriate to the
7375 system it is running on; you can override that default using the
7376 @code{set host-charset} command.
7377
7378 @value{GDBN} can only use certain character sets as its host character
7379 set. We list the character set names @value{GDBN} recognizes below, and
7380 indicate which can be host character sets, but if you type
7381 @code{set target-charset} followed by @key{TAB}@key{TAB}, @value{GDBN} will
7382 list the host character sets it supports.
7383
7384 @item set charset @var{charset}
7385 @kindex set charset
7386 Set the current host and target character sets to @var{charset}. As
7387 above, if you type @code{set charset} followed by @key{TAB}@key{TAB},
7388 @value{GDBN} will list the name of the character sets that can be used
7389 for both host and target.
7390
7391
7392 @item show charset
7393 @kindex show charset
7394 Show the names of the current host and target charsets.
7395
7396 @itemx show host-charset
7397 @kindex show host-charset
7398 Show the name of the current host charset.
7399
7400 @itemx show target-charset
7401 @kindex show target-charset
7402 Show the name of the current target charset.
7403
7404 @end table
7405
7406 @value{GDBN} currently includes support for the following character
7407 sets:
7408
7409 @table @code
7410
7411 @item ASCII
7412 @cindex ASCII character set
7413 Seven-bit U.S. @sc{ascii}. @value{GDBN} can use this as its host
7414 character set.
7415
7416 @item ISO-8859-1
7417 @cindex ISO 8859-1 character set
7418 @cindex ISO Latin 1 character set
7419 The ISO Latin 1 character set. This extends @sc{ascii} with accented
7420 characters needed for French, German, and Spanish. @value{GDBN} can use
7421 this as its host character set.
7422
7423 @item EBCDIC-US
7424 @itemx IBM1047
7425 @cindex EBCDIC character set
7426 @cindex IBM1047 character set
7427 Variants of the @sc{ebcdic} character set, used on some of IBM's
7428 mainframe operating systems. (@sc{gnu}/Linux on the S/390 uses U.S. @sc{ascii}.)
7429 @value{GDBN} cannot use these as its host character set.
7430
7431 @end table
7432
7433 Note that these are all single-byte character sets. More work inside
7434 @value{GDBN} is needed to support multi-byte or variable-width character
7435 encodings, like the UTF-8 and UCS-2 encodings of Unicode.
7436
7437 Here is an example of @value{GDBN}'s character set support in action.
7438 Assume that the following source code has been placed in the file
7439 @file{charset-test.c}:
7440
7441 @smallexample
7442 #include <stdio.h>
7443
7444 char ascii_hello[]
7445 = @{72, 101, 108, 108, 111, 44, 32, 119,
7446 111, 114, 108, 100, 33, 10, 0@};
7447 char ibm1047_hello[]
7448 = @{200, 133, 147, 147, 150, 107, 64, 166,
7449 150, 153, 147, 132, 90, 37, 0@};
7450
7451 main ()
7452 @{
7453 printf ("Hello, world!\n");
7454 @}
7455 @end smallexample
7456
7457 In this program, @code{ascii_hello} and @code{ibm1047_hello} are arrays
7458 containing the string @samp{Hello, world!} followed by a newline,
7459 encoded in the @sc{ascii} and @sc{ibm1047} character sets.
7460
7461 We compile the program, and invoke the debugger on it:
7462
7463 @smallexample
7464 $ gcc -g charset-test.c -o charset-test
7465 $ gdb -nw charset-test
7466 GNU gdb 2001-12-19-cvs
7467 Copyright 2001 Free Software Foundation, Inc.
7468 @dots{}
7469 (@value{GDBP})
7470 @end smallexample
7471
7472 We can use the @code{show charset} command to see what character sets
7473 @value{GDBN} is currently using to interpret and display characters and
7474 strings:
7475
7476 @smallexample
7477 (@value{GDBP}) show charset
7478 The current host and target character set is `ISO-8859-1'.
7479 (@value{GDBP})
7480 @end smallexample
7481
7482 For the sake of printing this manual, let's use @sc{ascii} as our
7483 initial character set:
7484 @smallexample
7485 (@value{GDBP}) set charset ASCII
7486 (@value{GDBP}) show charset
7487 The current host and target character set is `ASCII'.
7488 (@value{GDBP})
7489 @end smallexample
7490
7491 Let's assume that @sc{ascii} is indeed the correct character set for our
7492 host system --- in other words, let's assume that if @value{GDBN} prints
7493 characters using the @sc{ascii} character set, our terminal will display
7494 them properly. Since our current target character set is also
7495 @sc{ascii}, the contents of @code{ascii_hello} print legibly:
7496
7497 @smallexample
7498 (@value{GDBP}) print ascii_hello
7499 $1 = 0x401698 "Hello, world!\n"
7500 (@value{GDBP}) print ascii_hello[0]
7501 $2 = 72 'H'
7502 (@value{GDBP})
7503 @end smallexample
7504
7505 @value{GDBN} uses the target character set for character and string
7506 literals you use in expressions:
7507
7508 @smallexample
7509 (@value{GDBP}) print '+'
7510 $3 = 43 '+'
7511 (@value{GDBP})
7512 @end smallexample
7513
7514 The @sc{ascii} character set uses the number 43 to encode the @samp{+}
7515 character.
7516
7517 @value{GDBN} relies on the user to tell it which character set the
7518 target program uses. If we print @code{ibm1047_hello} while our target
7519 character set is still @sc{ascii}, we get jibberish:
7520
7521 @smallexample
7522 (@value{GDBP}) print ibm1047_hello
7523 $4 = 0x4016a8 "\310\205\223\223\226k@@\246\226\231\223\204Z%"
7524 (@value{GDBP}) print ibm1047_hello[0]
7525 $5 = 200 '\310'
7526 (@value{GDBP})
7527 @end smallexample
7528
7529 If we invoke the @code{set target-charset} followed by @key{TAB}@key{TAB},
7530 @value{GDBN} tells us the character sets it supports:
7531
7532 @smallexample
7533 (@value{GDBP}) set target-charset
7534 ASCII EBCDIC-US IBM1047 ISO-8859-1
7535 (@value{GDBP}) set target-charset
7536 @end smallexample
7537
7538 We can select @sc{ibm1047} as our target character set, and examine the
7539 program's strings again. Now the @sc{ascii} string is wrong, but
7540 @value{GDBN} translates the contents of @code{ibm1047_hello} from the
7541 target character set, @sc{ibm1047}, to the host character set,
7542 @sc{ascii}, and they display correctly:
7543
7544 @smallexample
7545 (@value{GDBP}) set target-charset IBM1047
7546 (@value{GDBP}) show charset
7547 The current host character set is `ASCII'.
7548 The current target character set is `IBM1047'.
7549 (@value{GDBP}) print ascii_hello
7550 $6 = 0x401698 "\110\145%%?\054\040\167?\162%\144\041\012"
7551 (@value{GDBP}) print ascii_hello[0]
7552 $7 = 72 '\110'
7553 (@value{GDBP}) print ibm1047_hello
7554 $8 = 0x4016a8 "Hello, world!\n"
7555 (@value{GDBP}) print ibm1047_hello[0]
7556 $9 = 200 'H'
7557 (@value{GDBP})
7558 @end smallexample
7559
7560 As above, @value{GDBN} uses the target character set for character and
7561 string literals you use in expressions:
7562
7563 @smallexample
7564 (@value{GDBP}) print '+'
7565 $10 = 78 '+'
7566 (@value{GDBP})
7567 @end smallexample
7568
7569 The @sc{ibm1047} character set uses the number 78 to encode the @samp{+}
7570 character.
7571
7572 @node Caching Remote Data
7573 @section Caching Data of Remote Targets
7574 @cindex caching data of remote targets
7575
7576 @value{GDBN} can cache data exchanged between the debugger and a
7577 remote target (@pxref{Remote Debugging}). Such caching generally improves
7578 performance, because it reduces the overhead of the remote protocol by
7579 bundling memory reads and writes into large chunks. Unfortunately,
7580 @value{GDBN} does not currently know anything about volatile
7581 registers, and thus data caching will produce incorrect results when
7582 volatile registers are in use.
7583
7584 @table @code
7585 @kindex set remotecache
7586 @item set remotecache on
7587 @itemx set remotecache off
7588 Set caching state for remote targets. When @code{ON}, use data
7589 caching. By default, this option is @code{OFF}.
7590
7591 @kindex show remotecache
7592 @item show remotecache
7593 Show the current state of data caching for remote targets.
7594
7595 @kindex info dcache
7596 @item info dcache
7597 Print the information about the data cache performance. The
7598 information displayed includes: the dcache width and depth; and for
7599 each cache line, how many times it was referenced, and its data and
7600 state (dirty, bad, ok, etc.). This command is useful for debugging
7601 the data cache operation.
7602 @end table
7603
7604
7605 @node Macros
7606 @chapter C Preprocessor Macros
7607
7608 Some languages, such as C and C@t{++}, provide a way to define and invoke
7609 ``preprocessor macros'' which expand into strings of tokens.
7610 @value{GDBN} can evaluate expressions containing macro invocations, show
7611 the result of macro expansion, and show a macro's definition, including
7612 where it was defined.
7613
7614 You may need to compile your program specially to provide @value{GDBN}
7615 with information about preprocessor macros. Most compilers do not
7616 include macros in their debugging information, even when you compile
7617 with the @option{-g} flag. @xref{Compilation}.
7618
7619 A program may define a macro at one point, remove that definition later,
7620 and then provide a different definition after that. Thus, at different
7621 points in the program, a macro may have different definitions, or have
7622 no definition at all. If there is a current stack frame, @value{GDBN}
7623 uses the macros in scope at that frame's source code line. Otherwise,
7624 @value{GDBN} uses the macros in scope at the current listing location;
7625 see @ref{List}.
7626
7627 At the moment, @value{GDBN} does not support the @code{##}
7628 token-splicing operator, the @code{#} stringification operator, or
7629 variable-arity macros.
7630
7631 Whenever @value{GDBN} evaluates an expression, it always expands any
7632 macro invocations present in the expression. @value{GDBN} also provides
7633 the following commands for working with macros explicitly.
7634
7635 @table @code
7636
7637 @kindex macro expand
7638 @cindex macro expansion, showing the results of preprocessor
7639 @cindex preprocessor macro expansion, showing the results of
7640 @cindex expanding preprocessor macros
7641 @item macro expand @var{expression}
7642 @itemx macro exp @var{expression}
7643 Show the results of expanding all preprocessor macro invocations in
7644 @var{expression}. Since @value{GDBN} simply expands macros, but does
7645 not parse the result, @var{expression} need not be a valid expression;
7646 it can be any string of tokens.
7647
7648 @kindex macro exp1
7649 @item macro expand-once @var{expression}
7650 @itemx macro exp1 @var{expression}
7651 @cindex expand macro once
7652 @i{(This command is not yet implemented.)} Show the results of
7653 expanding those preprocessor macro invocations that appear explicitly in
7654 @var{expression}. Macro invocations appearing in that expansion are
7655 left unchanged. This command allows you to see the effect of a
7656 particular macro more clearly, without being confused by further
7657 expansions. Since @value{GDBN} simply expands macros, but does not
7658 parse the result, @var{expression} need not be a valid expression; it
7659 can be any string of tokens.
7660
7661 @kindex info macro
7662 @cindex macro definition, showing
7663 @cindex definition, showing a macro's
7664 @item info macro @var{macro}
7665 Show the definition of the macro named @var{macro}, and describe the
7666 source location where that definition was established.
7667
7668 @kindex macro define
7669 @cindex user-defined macros
7670 @cindex defining macros interactively
7671 @cindex macros, user-defined
7672 @item macro define @var{macro} @var{replacement-list}
7673 @itemx macro define @var{macro}(@var{arglist}) @var{replacement-list}
7674 @i{(This command is not yet implemented.)} Introduce a definition for a
7675 preprocessor macro named @var{macro}, invocations of which are replaced
7676 by the tokens given in @var{replacement-list}. The first form of this
7677 command defines an ``object-like'' macro, which takes no arguments; the
7678 second form defines a ``function-like'' macro, which takes the arguments
7679 given in @var{arglist}.
7680
7681 A definition introduced by this command is in scope in every expression
7682 evaluated in @value{GDBN}, until it is removed with the @command{macro
7683 undef} command, described below. The definition overrides all
7684 definitions for @var{macro} present in the program being debugged, as
7685 well as any previous user-supplied definition.
7686
7687 @kindex macro undef
7688 @item macro undef @var{macro}
7689 @i{(This command is not yet implemented.)} Remove any user-supplied
7690 definition for the macro named @var{macro}. This command only affects
7691 definitions provided with the @command{macro define} command, described
7692 above; it cannot remove definitions present in the program being
7693 debugged.
7694
7695 @kindex macro list
7696 @item macro list
7697 @i{(This command is not yet implemented.)} List all the macros
7698 defined using the @code{macro define} command.
7699 @end table
7700
7701 @cindex macros, example of debugging with
7702 Here is a transcript showing the above commands in action. First, we
7703 show our source files:
7704
7705 @smallexample
7706 $ cat sample.c
7707 #include <stdio.h>
7708 #include "sample.h"
7709
7710 #define M 42
7711 #define ADD(x) (M + x)
7712
7713 main ()
7714 @{
7715 #define N 28
7716 printf ("Hello, world!\n");
7717 #undef N
7718 printf ("We're so creative.\n");
7719 #define N 1729
7720 printf ("Goodbye, world!\n");
7721 @}
7722 $ cat sample.h
7723 #define Q <
7724 $
7725 @end smallexample
7726
7727 Now, we compile the program using the @sc{gnu} C compiler, @value{NGCC}.
7728 We pass the @option{-gdwarf-2} and @option{-g3} flags to ensure the
7729 compiler includes information about preprocessor macros in the debugging
7730 information.
7731
7732 @smallexample
7733 $ gcc -gdwarf-2 -g3 sample.c -o sample
7734 $
7735 @end smallexample
7736
7737 Now, we start @value{GDBN} on our sample program:
7738
7739 @smallexample
7740 $ gdb -nw sample
7741 GNU gdb 2002-05-06-cvs
7742 Copyright 2002 Free Software Foundation, Inc.
7743 GDB is free software, @dots{}
7744 (@value{GDBP})
7745 @end smallexample
7746
7747 We can expand macros and examine their definitions, even when the
7748 program is not running. @value{GDBN} uses the current listing position
7749 to decide which macro definitions are in scope:
7750
7751 @smallexample
7752 (@value{GDBP}) list main
7753 3
7754 4 #define M 42
7755 5 #define ADD(x) (M + x)
7756 6
7757 7 main ()
7758 8 @{
7759 9 #define N 28
7760 10 printf ("Hello, world!\n");
7761 11 #undef N
7762 12 printf ("We're so creative.\n");
7763 (@value{GDBP}) info macro ADD
7764 Defined at /home/jimb/gdb/macros/play/sample.c:5
7765 #define ADD(x) (M + x)
7766 (@value{GDBP}) info macro Q
7767 Defined at /home/jimb/gdb/macros/play/sample.h:1
7768 included at /home/jimb/gdb/macros/play/sample.c:2
7769 #define Q <
7770 (@value{GDBP}) macro expand ADD(1)
7771 expands to: (42 + 1)
7772 (@value{GDBP}) macro expand-once ADD(1)
7773 expands to: once (M + 1)
7774 (@value{GDBP})
7775 @end smallexample
7776
7777 In the example above, note that @command{macro expand-once} expands only
7778 the macro invocation explicit in the original text --- the invocation of
7779 @code{ADD} --- but does not expand the invocation of the macro @code{M},
7780 which was introduced by @code{ADD}.
7781
7782 Once the program is running, @value{GDBN} uses the macro definitions in
7783 force at the source line of the current stack frame:
7784
7785 @smallexample
7786 (@value{GDBP}) break main
7787 Breakpoint 1 at 0x8048370: file sample.c, line 10.
7788 (@value{GDBP}) run
7789 Starting program: /home/jimb/gdb/macros/play/sample
7790
7791 Breakpoint 1, main () at sample.c:10
7792 10 printf ("Hello, world!\n");
7793 (@value{GDBP})
7794 @end smallexample
7795
7796 At line 10, the definition of the macro @code{N} at line 9 is in force:
7797
7798 @smallexample
7799 (@value{GDBP}) info macro N
7800 Defined at /home/jimb/gdb/macros/play/sample.c:9
7801 #define N 28
7802 (@value{GDBP}) macro expand N Q M
7803 expands to: 28 < 42
7804 (@value{GDBP}) print N Q M
7805 $1 = 1
7806 (@value{GDBP})
7807 @end smallexample
7808
7809 As we step over directives that remove @code{N}'s definition, and then
7810 give it a new definition, @value{GDBN} finds the definition (or lack
7811 thereof) in force at each point:
7812
7813 @smallexample
7814 (@value{GDBP}) next
7815 Hello, world!
7816 12 printf ("We're so creative.\n");
7817 (@value{GDBP}) info macro N
7818 The symbol `N' has no definition as a C/C++ preprocessor macro
7819 at /home/jimb/gdb/macros/play/sample.c:12
7820 (@value{GDBP}) next
7821 We're so creative.
7822 14 printf ("Goodbye, world!\n");
7823 (@value{GDBP}) info macro N
7824 Defined at /home/jimb/gdb/macros/play/sample.c:13
7825 #define N 1729
7826 (@value{GDBP}) macro expand N Q M
7827 expands to: 1729 < 42
7828 (@value{GDBP}) print N Q M
7829 $2 = 0
7830 (@value{GDBP})
7831 @end smallexample
7832
7833
7834 @node Tracepoints
7835 @chapter Tracepoints
7836 @c This chapter is based on the documentation written by Michael
7837 @c Snyder, David Taylor, Jim Blandy, and Elena Zannoni.
7838
7839 @cindex tracepoints
7840 In some applications, it is not feasible for the debugger to interrupt
7841 the program's execution long enough for the developer to learn
7842 anything helpful about its behavior. If the program's correctness
7843 depends on its real-time behavior, delays introduced by a debugger
7844 might cause the program to change its behavior drastically, or perhaps
7845 fail, even when the code itself is correct. It is useful to be able
7846 to observe the program's behavior without interrupting it.
7847
7848 Using @value{GDBN}'s @code{trace} and @code{collect} commands, you can
7849 specify locations in the program, called @dfn{tracepoints}, and
7850 arbitrary expressions to evaluate when those tracepoints are reached.
7851 Later, using the @code{tfind} command, you can examine the values
7852 those expressions had when the program hit the tracepoints. The
7853 expressions may also denote objects in memory---structures or arrays,
7854 for example---whose values @value{GDBN} should record; while visiting
7855 a particular tracepoint, you may inspect those objects as if they were
7856 in memory at that moment. However, because @value{GDBN} records these
7857 values without interacting with you, it can do so quickly and
7858 unobtrusively, hopefully not disturbing the program's behavior.
7859
7860 The tracepoint facility is currently available only for remote
7861 targets. @xref{Targets}. In addition, your remote target must know
7862 how to collect trace data. This functionality is implemented in the
7863 remote stub; however, none of the stubs distributed with @value{GDBN}
7864 support tracepoints as of this writing. The format of the remote
7865 packets used to implement tracepoints are described in @ref{Tracepoint
7866 Packets}.
7867
7868 This chapter describes the tracepoint commands and features.
7869
7870 @menu
7871 * Set Tracepoints::
7872 * Analyze Collected Data::
7873 * Tracepoint Variables::
7874 @end menu
7875
7876 @node Set Tracepoints
7877 @section Commands to Set Tracepoints
7878
7879 Before running such a @dfn{trace experiment}, an arbitrary number of
7880 tracepoints can be set. Like a breakpoint (@pxref{Set Breaks}), a
7881 tracepoint has a number assigned to it by @value{GDBN}. Like with
7882 breakpoints, tracepoint numbers are successive integers starting from
7883 one. Many of the commands associated with tracepoints take the
7884 tracepoint number as their argument, to identify which tracepoint to
7885 work on.
7886
7887 For each tracepoint, you can specify, in advance, some arbitrary set
7888 of data that you want the target to collect in the trace buffer when
7889 it hits that tracepoint. The collected data can include registers,
7890 local variables, or global data. Later, you can use @value{GDBN}
7891 commands to examine the values these data had at the time the
7892 tracepoint was hit.
7893
7894 This section describes commands to set tracepoints and associated
7895 conditions and actions.
7896
7897 @menu
7898 * Create and Delete Tracepoints::
7899 * Enable and Disable Tracepoints::
7900 * Tracepoint Passcounts::
7901 * Tracepoint Actions::
7902 * Listing Tracepoints::
7903 * Starting and Stopping Trace Experiments::
7904 @end menu
7905
7906 @node Create and Delete Tracepoints
7907 @subsection Create and Delete Tracepoints
7908
7909 @table @code
7910 @cindex set tracepoint
7911 @kindex trace
7912 @item trace
7913 The @code{trace} command is very similar to the @code{break} command.
7914 Its argument can be a source line, a function name, or an address in
7915 the target program. @xref{Set Breaks}. The @code{trace} command
7916 defines a tracepoint, which is a point in the target program where the
7917 debugger will briefly stop, collect some data, and then allow the
7918 program to continue. Setting a tracepoint or changing its commands
7919 doesn't take effect until the next @code{tstart} command; thus, you
7920 cannot change the tracepoint attributes once a trace experiment is
7921 running.
7922
7923 Here are some examples of using the @code{trace} command:
7924
7925 @smallexample
7926 (@value{GDBP}) @b{trace foo.c:121} // a source file and line number
7927
7928 (@value{GDBP}) @b{trace +2} // 2 lines forward
7929
7930 (@value{GDBP}) @b{trace my_function} // first source line of function
7931
7932 (@value{GDBP}) @b{trace *my_function} // EXACT start address of function
7933
7934 (@value{GDBP}) @b{trace *0x2117c4} // an address
7935 @end smallexample
7936
7937 @noindent
7938 You can abbreviate @code{trace} as @code{tr}.
7939
7940 @vindex $tpnum
7941 @cindex last tracepoint number
7942 @cindex recent tracepoint number
7943 @cindex tracepoint number
7944 The convenience variable @code{$tpnum} records the tracepoint number
7945 of the most recently set tracepoint.
7946
7947 @kindex delete tracepoint
7948 @cindex tracepoint deletion
7949 @item delete tracepoint @r{[}@var{num}@r{]}
7950 Permanently delete one or more tracepoints. With no argument, the
7951 default is to delete all tracepoints.
7952
7953 Examples:
7954
7955 @smallexample
7956 (@value{GDBP}) @b{delete trace 1 2 3} // remove three tracepoints
7957
7958 (@value{GDBP}) @b{delete trace} // remove all tracepoints
7959 @end smallexample
7960
7961 @noindent
7962 You can abbreviate this command as @code{del tr}.
7963 @end table
7964
7965 @node Enable and Disable Tracepoints
7966 @subsection Enable and Disable Tracepoints
7967
7968 @table @code
7969 @kindex disable tracepoint
7970 @item disable tracepoint @r{[}@var{num}@r{]}
7971 Disable tracepoint @var{num}, or all tracepoints if no argument
7972 @var{num} is given. A disabled tracepoint will have no effect during
7973 the next trace experiment, but it is not forgotten. You can re-enable
7974 a disabled tracepoint using the @code{enable tracepoint} command.
7975
7976 @kindex enable tracepoint
7977 @item enable tracepoint @r{[}@var{num}@r{]}
7978 Enable tracepoint @var{num}, or all tracepoints. The enabled
7979 tracepoints will become effective the next time a trace experiment is
7980 run.
7981 @end table
7982
7983 @node Tracepoint Passcounts
7984 @subsection Tracepoint Passcounts
7985
7986 @table @code
7987 @kindex passcount
7988 @cindex tracepoint pass count
7989 @item passcount @r{[}@var{n} @r{[}@var{num}@r{]]}
7990 Set the @dfn{passcount} of a tracepoint. The passcount is a way to
7991 automatically stop a trace experiment. If a tracepoint's passcount is
7992 @var{n}, then the trace experiment will be automatically stopped on
7993 the @var{n}'th time that tracepoint is hit. If the tracepoint number
7994 @var{num} is not specified, the @code{passcount} command sets the
7995 passcount of the most recently defined tracepoint. If no passcount is
7996 given, the trace experiment will run until stopped explicitly by the
7997 user.
7998
7999 Examples:
8000
8001 @smallexample
8002 (@value{GDBP}) @b{passcount 5 2} // Stop on the 5th execution of
8003 @exdent @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @code{// tracepoint 2}
8004
8005 (@value{GDBP}) @b{passcount 12} // Stop on the 12th execution of the
8006 @exdent @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @code{// most recently defined tracepoint.}
8007 (@value{GDBP}) @b{trace foo}
8008 (@value{GDBP}) @b{pass 3}
8009 (@value{GDBP}) @b{trace bar}
8010 (@value{GDBP}) @b{pass 2}
8011 (@value{GDBP}) @b{trace baz}
8012 (@value{GDBP}) @b{pass 1} // Stop tracing when foo has been
8013 @exdent @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @code{// executed 3 times OR when bar has}
8014 @exdent @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @code{// been executed 2 times}
8015 @exdent @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @code{// OR when baz has been executed 1 time.}
8016 @end smallexample
8017 @end table
8018
8019 @node Tracepoint Actions
8020 @subsection Tracepoint Action Lists
8021
8022 @table @code
8023 @kindex actions
8024 @cindex tracepoint actions
8025 @item actions @r{[}@var{num}@r{]}
8026 This command will prompt for a list of actions to be taken when the
8027 tracepoint is hit. If the tracepoint number @var{num} is not
8028 specified, this command sets the actions for the one that was most
8029 recently defined (so that you can define a tracepoint and then say
8030 @code{actions} without bothering about its number). You specify the
8031 actions themselves on the following lines, one action at a time, and
8032 terminate the actions list with a line containing just @code{end}. So
8033 far, the only defined actions are @code{collect} and
8034 @code{while-stepping}.
8035
8036 @cindex remove actions from a tracepoint
8037 To remove all actions from a tracepoint, type @samp{actions @var{num}}
8038 and follow it immediately with @samp{end}.
8039
8040 @smallexample
8041 (@value{GDBP}) @b{collect @var{data}} // collect some data
8042
8043 (@value{GDBP}) @b{while-stepping 5} // single-step 5 times, collect data
8044
8045 (@value{GDBP}) @b{end} // signals the end of actions.
8046 @end smallexample
8047
8048 In the following example, the action list begins with @code{collect}
8049 commands indicating the things to be collected when the tracepoint is
8050 hit. Then, in order to single-step and collect additional data
8051 following the tracepoint, a @code{while-stepping} command is used,
8052 followed by the list of things to be collected while stepping. The
8053 @code{while-stepping} command is terminated by its own separate
8054 @code{end} command. Lastly, the action list is terminated by an
8055 @code{end} command.
8056
8057 @smallexample
8058 (@value{GDBP}) @b{trace foo}
8059 (@value{GDBP}) @b{actions}
8060 Enter actions for tracepoint 1, one per line:
8061 > collect bar,baz
8062 > collect $regs
8063 > while-stepping 12
8064 > collect $fp, $sp
8065 > end
8066 end
8067 @end smallexample
8068
8069 @kindex collect @r{(tracepoints)}
8070 @item collect @var{expr1}, @var{expr2}, @dots{}
8071 Collect values of the given expressions when the tracepoint is hit.
8072 This command accepts a comma-separated list of any valid expressions.
8073 In addition to global, static, or local variables, the following
8074 special arguments are supported:
8075
8076 @table @code
8077 @item $regs
8078 collect all registers
8079
8080 @item $args
8081 collect all function arguments
8082
8083 @item $locals
8084 collect all local variables.
8085 @end table
8086
8087 You can give several consecutive @code{collect} commands, each one
8088 with a single argument, or one @code{collect} command with several
8089 arguments separated by commas: the effect is the same.
8090
8091 The command @code{info scope} (@pxref{Symbols, info scope}) is
8092 particularly useful for figuring out what data to collect.
8093
8094 @kindex while-stepping @r{(tracepoints)}
8095 @item while-stepping @var{n}
8096 Perform @var{n} single-step traces after the tracepoint, collecting
8097 new data at each step. The @code{while-stepping} command is
8098 followed by the list of what to collect while stepping (followed by
8099 its own @code{end} command):
8100
8101 @smallexample
8102 > while-stepping 12
8103 > collect $regs, myglobal
8104 > end
8105 >
8106 @end smallexample
8107
8108 @noindent
8109 You may abbreviate @code{while-stepping} as @code{ws} or
8110 @code{stepping}.
8111 @end table
8112
8113 @node Listing Tracepoints
8114 @subsection Listing Tracepoints
8115
8116 @table @code
8117 @kindex info tracepoints
8118 @kindex info tp
8119 @cindex information about tracepoints
8120 @item info tracepoints @r{[}@var{num}@r{]}
8121 Display information about the tracepoint @var{num}. If you don't specify
8122 a tracepoint number, displays information about all the tracepoints
8123 defined so far. For each tracepoint, the following information is
8124 shown:
8125
8126 @itemize @bullet
8127 @item
8128 its number
8129 @item
8130 whether it is enabled or disabled
8131 @item
8132 its address
8133 @item
8134 its passcount as given by the @code{passcount @var{n}} command
8135 @item
8136 its step count as given by the @code{while-stepping @var{n}} command
8137 @item
8138 where in the source files is the tracepoint set
8139 @item
8140 its action list as given by the @code{actions} command
8141 @end itemize
8142
8143 @smallexample
8144 (@value{GDBP}) @b{info trace}
8145 Num Enb Address PassC StepC What
8146 1 y 0x002117c4 0 0 <gdb_asm>
8147 2 y 0x0020dc64 0 0 in g_test at g_test.c:1375
8148 3 y 0x0020b1f4 0 0 in get_data at ../foo.c:41
8149 (@value{GDBP})
8150 @end smallexample
8151
8152 @noindent
8153 This command can be abbreviated @code{info tp}.
8154 @end table
8155
8156 @node Starting and Stopping Trace Experiments
8157 @subsection Starting and Stopping Trace Experiments
8158
8159 @table @code
8160 @kindex tstart
8161 @cindex start a new trace experiment
8162 @cindex collected data discarded
8163 @item tstart
8164 This command takes no arguments. It starts the trace experiment, and
8165 begins collecting data. This has the side effect of discarding all
8166 the data collected in the trace buffer during the previous trace
8167 experiment.
8168
8169 @kindex tstop
8170 @cindex stop a running trace experiment
8171 @item tstop
8172 This command takes no arguments. It ends the trace experiment, and
8173 stops collecting data.
8174
8175 @strong{Note}: a trace experiment and data collection may stop
8176 automatically if any tracepoint's passcount is reached
8177 (@pxref{Tracepoint Passcounts}), or if the trace buffer becomes full.
8178
8179 @kindex tstatus
8180 @cindex status of trace data collection
8181 @cindex trace experiment, status of
8182 @item tstatus
8183 This command displays the status of the current trace data
8184 collection.
8185 @end table
8186
8187 Here is an example of the commands we described so far:
8188
8189 @smallexample
8190 (@value{GDBP}) @b{trace gdb_c_test}
8191 (@value{GDBP}) @b{actions}
8192 Enter actions for tracepoint #1, one per line.
8193 > collect $regs,$locals,$args
8194 > while-stepping 11
8195 > collect $regs
8196 > end
8197 > end
8198 (@value{GDBP}) @b{tstart}
8199 [time passes @dots{}]
8200 (@value{GDBP}) @b{tstop}
8201 @end smallexample
8202
8203
8204 @node Analyze Collected Data
8205 @section Using the Collected Data
8206
8207 After the tracepoint experiment ends, you use @value{GDBN} commands
8208 for examining the trace data. The basic idea is that each tracepoint
8209 collects a trace @dfn{snapshot} every time it is hit and another
8210 snapshot every time it single-steps. All these snapshots are
8211 consecutively numbered from zero and go into a buffer, and you can
8212 examine them later. The way you examine them is to @dfn{focus} on a
8213 specific trace snapshot. When the remote stub is focused on a trace
8214 snapshot, it will respond to all @value{GDBN} requests for memory and
8215 registers by reading from the buffer which belongs to that snapshot,
8216 rather than from @emph{real} memory or registers of the program being
8217 debugged. This means that @strong{all} @value{GDBN} commands
8218 (@code{print}, @code{info registers}, @code{backtrace}, etc.) will
8219 behave as if we were currently debugging the program state as it was
8220 when the tracepoint occurred. Any requests for data that are not in
8221 the buffer will fail.
8222
8223 @menu
8224 * tfind:: How to select a trace snapshot
8225 * tdump:: How to display all data for a snapshot
8226 * save-tracepoints:: How to save tracepoints for a future run
8227 @end menu
8228
8229 @node tfind
8230 @subsection @code{tfind @var{n}}
8231
8232 @kindex tfind
8233 @cindex select trace snapshot
8234 @cindex find trace snapshot
8235 The basic command for selecting a trace snapshot from the buffer is
8236 @code{tfind @var{n}}, which finds trace snapshot number @var{n},
8237 counting from zero. If no argument @var{n} is given, the next
8238 snapshot is selected.
8239
8240 Here are the various forms of using the @code{tfind} command.
8241
8242 @table @code
8243 @item tfind start
8244 Find the first snapshot in the buffer. This is a synonym for
8245 @code{tfind 0} (since 0 is the number of the first snapshot).
8246
8247 @item tfind none
8248 Stop debugging trace snapshots, resume @emph{live} debugging.
8249
8250 @item tfind end
8251 Same as @samp{tfind none}.
8252
8253 @item tfind
8254 No argument means find the next trace snapshot.
8255
8256 @item tfind -
8257 Find the previous trace snapshot before the current one. This permits
8258 retracing earlier steps.
8259
8260 @item tfind tracepoint @var{num}
8261 Find the next snapshot associated with tracepoint @var{num}. Search
8262 proceeds forward from the last examined trace snapshot. If no
8263 argument @var{num} is given, it means find the next snapshot collected
8264 for the same tracepoint as the current snapshot.
8265
8266 @item tfind pc @var{addr}
8267 Find the next snapshot associated with the value @var{addr} of the
8268 program counter. Search proceeds forward from the last examined trace
8269 snapshot. If no argument @var{addr} is given, it means find the next
8270 snapshot with the same value of PC as the current snapshot.
8271
8272 @item tfind outside @var{addr1}, @var{addr2}
8273 Find the next snapshot whose PC is outside the given range of
8274 addresses.
8275
8276 @item tfind range @var{addr1}, @var{addr2}
8277 Find the next snapshot whose PC is between @var{addr1} and
8278 @var{addr2}. @c FIXME: Is the range inclusive or exclusive?
8279
8280 @item tfind line @r{[}@var{file}:@r{]}@var{n}
8281 Find the next snapshot associated with the source line @var{n}. If
8282 the optional argument @var{file} is given, refer to line @var{n} in
8283 that source file. Search proceeds forward from the last examined
8284 trace snapshot. If no argument @var{n} is given, it means find the
8285 next line other than the one currently being examined; thus saying
8286 @code{tfind line} repeatedly can appear to have the same effect as
8287 stepping from line to line in a @emph{live} debugging session.
8288 @end table
8289
8290 The default arguments for the @code{tfind} commands are specifically
8291 designed to make it easy to scan through the trace buffer. For
8292 instance, @code{tfind} with no argument selects the next trace
8293 snapshot, and @code{tfind -} with no argument selects the previous
8294 trace snapshot. So, by giving one @code{tfind} command, and then
8295 simply hitting @key{RET} repeatedly you can examine all the trace
8296 snapshots in order. Or, by saying @code{tfind -} and then hitting
8297 @key{RET} repeatedly you can examine the snapshots in reverse order.
8298 The @code{tfind line} command with no argument selects the snapshot
8299 for the next source line executed. The @code{tfind pc} command with
8300 no argument selects the next snapshot with the same program counter
8301 (PC) as the current frame. The @code{tfind tracepoint} command with
8302 no argument selects the next trace snapshot collected by the same
8303 tracepoint as the current one.
8304
8305 In addition to letting you scan through the trace buffer manually,
8306 these commands make it easy to construct @value{GDBN} scripts that
8307 scan through the trace buffer and print out whatever collected data
8308 you are interested in. Thus, if we want to examine the PC, FP, and SP
8309 registers from each trace frame in the buffer, we can say this:
8310
8311 @smallexample
8312 (@value{GDBP}) @b{tfind start}
8313 (@value{GDBP}) @b{while ($trace_frame != -1)}
8314 > printf "Frame %d, PC = %08X, SP = %08X, FP = %08X\n", \
8315 $trace_frame, $pc, $sp, $fp
8316 > tfind
8317 > end
8318
8319 Frame 0, PC = 0020DC64, SP = 0030BF3C, FP = 0030BF44
8320 Frame 1, PC = 0020DC6C, SP = 0030BF38, FP = 0030BF44
8321 Frame 2, PC = 0020DC70, SP = 0030BF34, FP = 0030BF44
8322 Frame 3, PC = 0020DC74, SP = 0030BF30, FP = 0030BF44
8323 Frame 4, PC = 0020DC78, SP = 0030BF2C, FP = 0030BF44
8324 Frame 5, PC = 0020DC7C, SP = 0030BF28, FP = 0030BF44
8325 Frame 6, PC = 0020DC80, SP = 0030BF24, FP = 0030BF44
8326 Frame 7, PC = 0020DC84, SP = 0030BF20, FP = 0030BF44
8327 Frame 8, PC = 0020DC88, SP = 0030BF1C, FP = 0030BF44
8328 Frame 9, PC = 0020DC8E, SP = 0030BF18, FP = 0030BF44
8329 Frame 10, PC = 00203F6C, SP = 0030BE3C, FP = 0030BF14
8330 @end smallexample
8331
8332 Or, if we want to examine the variable @code{X} at each source line in
8333 the buffer:
8334
8335 @smallexample
8336 (@value{GDBP}) @b{tfind start}
8337 (@value{GDBP}) @b{while ($trace_frame != -1)}
8338 > printf "Frame %d, X == %d\n", $trace_frame, X
8339 > tfind line
8340 > end
8341
8342 Frame 0, X = 1
8343 Frame 7, X = 2
8344 Frame 13, X = 255
8345 @end smallexample
8346
8347 @node tdump
8348 @subsection @code{tdump}
8349 @kindex tdump
8350 @cindex dump all data collected at tracepoint
8351 @cindex tracepoint data, display
8352
8353 This command takes no arguments. It prints all the data collected at
8354 the current trace snapshot.
8355
8356 @smallexample
8357 (@value{GDBP}) @b{trace 444}
8358 (@value{GDBP}) @b{actions}
8359 Enter actions for tracepoint #2, one per line:
8360 > collect $regs, $locals, $args, gdb_long_test
8361 > end
8362
8363 (@value{GDBP}) @b{tstart}
8364
8365 (@value{GDBP}) @b{tfind line 444}
8366 #0 gdb_test (p1=0x11, p2=0x22, p3=0x33, p4=0x44, p5=0x55, p6=0x66)
8367 at gdb_test.c:444
8368 444 printp( "%s: arguments = 0x%X 0x%X 0x%X 0x%X 0x%X 0x%X\n", )
8369
8370 (@value{GDBP}) @b{tdump}
8371 Data collected at tracepoint 2, trace frame 1:
8372 d0 0xc4aa0085 -995491707
8373 d1 0x18 24
8374 d2 0x80 128
8375 d3 0x33 51
8376 d4 0x71aea3d 119204413
8377 d5 0x22 34
8378 d6 0xe0 224
8379 d7 0x380035 3670069
8380 a0 0x19e24a 1696330
8381 a1 0x3000668 50333288
8382 a2 0x100 256
8383 a3 0x322000 3284992
8384 a4 0x3000698 50333336
8385 a5 0x1ad3cc 1758156
8386 fp 0x30bf3c 0x30bf3c
8387 sp 0x30bf34 0x30bf34
8388 ps 0x0 0
8389 pc 0x20b2c8 0x20b2c8
8390 fpcontrol 0x0 0
8391 fpstatus 0x0 0
8392 fpiaddr 0x0 0
8393 p = 0x20e5b4 "gdb-test"
8394 p1 = (void *) 0x11
8395 p2 = (void *) 0x22
8396 p3 = (void *) 0x33
8397 p4 = (void *) 0x44
8398 p5 = (void *) 0x55
8399 p6 = (void *) 0x66
8400 gdb_long_test = 17 '\021'
8401
8402 (@value{GDBP})
8403 @end smallexample
8404
8405 @node save-tracepoints
8406 @subsection @code{save-tracepoints @var{filename}}
8407 @kindex save-tracepoints
8408 @cindex save tracepoints for future sessions
8409
8410 This command saves all current tracepoint definitions together with
8411 their actions and passcounts, into a file @file{@var{filename}}
8412 suitable for use in a later debugging session. To read the saved
8413 tracepoint definitions, use the @code{source} command (@pxref{Command
8414 Files}).
8415
8416 @node Tracepoint Variables
8417 @section Convenience Variables for Tracepoints
8418 @cindex tracepoint variables
8419 @cindex convenience variables for tracepoints
8420
8421 @table @code
8422 @vindex $trace_frame
8423 @item (int) $trace_frame
8424 The current trace snapshot (a.k.a.@: @dfn{frame}) number, or -1 if no
8425 snapshot is selected.
8426
8427 @vindex $tracepoint
8428 @item (int) $tracepoint
8429 The tracepoint for the current trace snapshot.
8430
8431 @vindex $trace_line
8432 @item (int) $trace_line
8433 The line number for the current trace snapshot.
8434
8435 @vindex $trace_file
8436 @item (char []) $trace_file
8437 The source file for the current trace snapshot.
8438
8439 @vindex $trace_func
8440 @item (char []) $trace_func
8441 The name of the function containing @code{$tracepoint}.
8442 @end table
8443
8444 Note: @code{$trace_file} is not suitable for use in @code{printf},
8445 use @code{output} instead.
8446
8447 Here's a simple example of using these convenience variables for
8448 stepping through all the trace snapshots and printing some of their
8449 data.
8450
8451 @smallexample
8452 (@value{GDBP}) @b{tfind start}
8453
8454 (@value{GDBP}) @b{while $trace_frame != -1}
8455 > output $trace_file
8456 > printf ", line %d (tracepoint #%d)\n", $trace_line, $tracepoint
8457 > tfind
8458 > end
8459 @end smallexample
8460
8461 @node Overlays
8462 @chapter Debugging Programs That Use Overlays
8463 @cindex overlays
8464
8465 If your program is too large to fit completely in your target system's
8466 memory, you can sometimes use @dfn{overlays} to work around this
8467 problem. @value{GDBN} provides some support for debugging programs that
8468 use overlays.
8469
8470 @menu
8471 * How Overlays Work:: A general explanation of overlays.
8472 * Overlay Commands:: Managing overlays in @value{GDBN}.
8473 * Automatic Overlay Debugging:: @value{GDBN} can find out which overlays are
8474 mapped by asking the inferior.
8475 * Overlay Sample Program:: A sample program using overlays.
8476 @end menu
8477
8478 @node How Overlays Work
8479 @section How Overlays Work
8480 @cindex mapped overlays
8481 @cindex unmapped overlays
8482 @cindex load address, overlay's
8483 @cindex mapped address
8484 @cindex overlay area
8485
8486 Suppose you have a computer whose instruction address space is only 64
8487 kilobytes long, but which has much more memory which can be accessed by
8488 other means: special instructions, segment registers, or memory
8489 management hardware, for example. Suppose further that you want to
8490 adapt a program which is larger than 64 kilobytes to run on this system.
8491
8492 One solution is to identify modules of your program which are relatively
8493 independent, and need not call each other directly; call these modules
8494 @dfn{overlays}. Separate the overlays from the main program, and place
8495 their machine code in the larger memory. Place your main program in
8496 instruction memory, but leave at least enough space there to hold the
8497 largest overlay as well.
8498
8499 Now, to call a function located in an overlay, you must first copy that
8500 overlay's machine code from the large memory into the space set aside
8501 for it in the instruction memory, and then jump to its entry point
8502 there.
8503
8504 @c NB: In the below the mapped area's size is greater or equal to the
8505 @c size of all overlays. This is intentional to remind the developer
8506 @c that overlays don't necessarily need to be the same size.
8507
8508 @smallexample
8509 @group
8510 Data Instruction Larger
8511 Address Space Address Space Address Space
8512 +-----------+ +-----------+ +-----------+
8513 | | | | | |
8514 +-----------+ +-----------+ +-----------+<-- overlay 1
8515 | program | | main | .----| overlay 1 | load address
8516 | variables | | program | | +-----------+
8517 | and heap | | | | | |
8518 +-----------+ | | | +-----------+<-- overlay 2
8519 | | +-----------+ | | | load address
8520 +-----------+ | | | .-| overlay 2 |
8521 | | | | | |
8522 mapped --->+-----------+ | | +-----------+
8523 address | | | | | |
8524 | overlay | <-' | | |
8525 | area | <---' +-----------+<-- overlay 3
8526 | | <---. | | load address
8527 +-----------+ `--| overlay 3 |
8528 | | | |
8529 +-----------+ | |
8530 +-----------+
8531 | |
8532 +-----------+
8533
8534 @anchor{A code overlay}A code overlay
8535 @end group
8536 @end smallexample
8537
8538 The diagram (@pxref{A code overlay}) shows a system with separate data
8539 and instruction address spaces. To map an overlay, the program copies
8540 its code from the larger address space to the instruction address space.
8541 Since the overlays shown here all use the same mapped address, only one
8542 may be mapped at a time. For a system with a single address space for
8543 data and instructions, the diagram would be similar, except that the
8544 program variables and heap would share an address space with the main
8545 program and the overlay area.
8546
8547 An overlay loaded into instruction memory and ready for use is called a
8548 @dfn{mapped} overlay; its @dfn{mapped address} is its address in the
8549 instruction memory. An overlay not present (or only partially present)
8550 in instruction memory is called @dfn{unmapped}; its @dfn{load address}
8551 is its address in the larger memory. The mapped address is also called
8552 the @dfn{virtual memory address}, or @dfn{VMA}; the load address is also
8553 called the @dfn{load memory address}, or @dfn{LMA}.
8554
8555 Unfortunately, overlays are not a completely transparent way to adapt a
8556 program to limited instruction memory. They introduce a new set of
8557 global constraints you must keep in mind as you design your program:
8558
8559 @itemize @bullet
8560
8561 @item
8562 Before calling or returning to a function in an overlay, your program
8563 must make sure that overlay is actually mapped. Otherwise, the call or
8564 return will transfer control to the right address, but in the wrong
8565 overlay, and your program will probably crash.
8566
8567 @item
8568 If the process of mapping an overlay is expensive on your system, you
8569 will need to choose your overlays carefully to minimize their effect on
8570 your program's performance.
8571
8572 @item
8573 The executable file you load onto your system must contain each
8574 overlay's instructions, appearing at the overlay's load address, not its
8575 mapped address. However, each overlay's instructions must be relocated
8576 and its symbols defined as if the overlay were at its mapped address.
8577 You can use GNU linker scripts to specify different load and relocation
8578 addresses for pieces of your program; see @ref{Overlay Description,,,
8579 ld.info, Using ld: the GNU linker}.
8580
8581 @item
8582 The procedure for loading executable files onto your system must be able
8583 to load their contents into the larger address space as well as the
8584 instruction and data spaces.
8585
8586 @end itemize
8587
8588 The overlay system described above is rather simple, and could be
8589 improved in many ways:
8590
8591 @itemize @bullet
8592
8593 @item
8594 If your system has suitable bank switch registers or memory management
8595 hardware, you could use those facilities to make an overlay's load area
8596 contents simply appear at their mapped address in instruction space.
8597 This would probably be faster than copying the overlay to its mapped
8598 area in the usual way.
8599
8600 @item
8601 If your overlays are small enough, you could set aside more than one
8602 overlay area, and have more than one overlay mapped at a time.
8603
8604 @item
8605 You can use overlays to manage data, as well as instructions. In
8606 general, data overlays are even less transparent to your design than
8607 code overlays: whereas code overlays only require care when you call or
8608 return to functions, data overlays require care every time you access
8609 the data. Also, if you change the contents of a data overlay, you
8610 must copy its contents back out to its load address before you can copy a
8611 different data overlay into the same mapped area.
8612
8613 @end itemize
8614
8615
8616 @node Overlay Commands
8617 @section Overlay Commands
8618
8619 To use @value{GDBN}'s overlay support, each overlay in your program must
8620 correspond to a separate section of the executable file. The section's
8621 virtual memory address and load memory address must be the overlay's
8622 mapped and load addresses. Identifying overlays with sections allows
8623 @value{GDBN} to determine the appropriate address of a function or
8624 variable, depending on whether the overlay is mapped or not.
8625
8626 @value{GDBN}'s overlay commands all start with the word @code{overlay};
8627 you can abbreviate this as @code{ov} or @code{ovly}. The commands are:
8628
8629 @table @code
8630 @item overlay off
8631 @kindex overlay
8632 Disable @value{GDBN}'s overlay support. When overlay support is
8633 disabled, @value{GDBN} assumes that all functions and variables are
8634 always present at their mapped addresses. By default, @value{GDBN}'s
8635 overlay support is disabled.
8636
8637 @item overlay manual
8638 @cindex manual overlay debugging
8639 Enable @dfn{manual} overlay debugging. In this mode, @value{GDBN}
8640 relies on you to tell it which overlays are mapped, and which are not,
8641 using the @code{overlay map-overlay} and @code{overlay unmap-overlay}
8642 commands described below.
8643
8644 @item overlay map-overlay @var{overlay}
8645 @itemx overlay map @var{overlay}
8646 @cindex map an overlay
8647 Tell @value{GDBN} that @var{overlay} is now mapped; @var{overlay} must
8648 be the name of the object file section containing the overlay. When an
8649 overlay is mapped, @value{GDBN} assumes it can find the overlay's
8650 functions and variables at their mapped addresses. @value{GDBN} assumes
8651 that any other overlays whose mapped ranges overlap that of
8652 @var{overlay} are now unmapped.
8653
8654 @item overlay unmap-overlay @var{overlay}
8655 @itemx overlay unmap @var{overlay}
8656 @cindex unmap an overlay
8657 Tell @value{GDBN} that @var{overlay} is no longer mapped; @var{overlay}
8658 must be the name of the object file section containing the overlay.
8659 When an overlay is unmapped, @value{GDBN} assumes it can find the
8660 overlay's functions and variables at their load addresses.
8661
8662 @item overlay auto
8663 Enable @dfn{automatic} overlay debugging. In this mode, @value{GDBN}
8664 consults a data structure the overlay manager maintains in the inferior
8665 to see which overlays are mapped. For details, see @ref{Automatic
8666 Overlay Debugging}.
8667
8668 @item overlay load-target
8669 @itemx overlay load
8670 @cindex reloading the overlay table
8671 Re-read the overlay table from the inferior. Normally, @value{GDBN}
8672 re-reads the table @value{GDBN} automatically each time the inferior
8673 stops, so this command should only be necessary if you have changed the
8674 overlay mapping yourself using @value{GDBN}. This command is only
8675 useful when using automatic overlay debugging.
8676
8677 @item overlay list-overlays
8678 @itemx overlay list
8679 @cindex listing mapped overlays
8680 Display a list of the overlays currently mapped, along with their mapped
8681 addresses, load addresses, and sizes.
8682
8683 @end table
8684
8685 Normally, when @value{GDBN} prints a code address, it includes the name
8686 of the function the address falls in:
8687
8688 @smallexample
8689 (@value{GDBP}) print main
8690 $3 = @{int ()@} 0x11a0 <main>
8691 @end smallexample
8692 @noindent
8693 When overlay debugging is enabled, @value{GDBN} recognizes code in
8694 unmapped overlays, and prints the names of unmapped functions with
8695 asterisks around them. For example, if @code{foo} is a function in an
8696 unmapped overlay, @value{GDBN} prints it this way:
8697
8698 @smallexample
8699 (@value{GDBP}) overlay list
8700 No sections are mapped.
8701 (@value{GDBP}) print foo
8702 $5 = @{int (int)@} 0x100000 <*foo*>
8703 @end smallexample
8704 @noindent
8705 When @code{foo}'s overlay is mapped, @value{GDBN} prints the function's
8706 name normally:
8707
8708 @smallexample
8709 (@value{GDBP}) overlay list
8710 Section .ov.foo.text, loaded at 0x100000 - 0x100034,
8711 mapped at 0x1016 - 0x104a
8712 (@value{GDBP}) print foo
8713 $6 = @{int (int)@} 0x1016 <foo>
8714 @end smallexample
8715
8716 When overlay debugging is enabled, @value{GDBN} can find the correct
8717 address for functions and variables in an overlay, whether or not the
8718 overlay is mapped. This allows most @value{GDBN} commands, like
8719 @code{break} and @code{disassemble}, to work normally, even on unmapped
8720 code. However, @value{GDBN}'s breakpoint support has some limitations:
8721
8722 @itemize @bullet
8723 @item
8724 @cindex breakpoints in overlays
8725 @cindex overlays, setting breakpoints in
8726 You can set breakpoints in functions in unmapped overlays, as long as
8727 @value{GDBN} can write to the overlay at its load address.
8728 @item
8729 @value{GDBN} can not set hardware or simulator-based breakpoints in
8730 unmapped overlays. However, if you set a breakpoint at the end of your
8731 overlay manager (and tell @value{GDBN} which overlays are now mapped, if
8732 you are using manual overlay management), @value{GDBN} will re-set its
8733 breakpoints properly.
8734 @end itemize
8735
8736
8737 @node Automatic Overlay Debugging
8738 @section Automatic Overlay Debugging
8739 @cindex automatic overlay debugging
8740
8741 @value{GDBN} can automatically track which overlays are mapped and which
8742 are not, given some simple co-operation from the overlay manager in the
8743 inferior. If you enable automatic overlay debugging with the
8744 @code{overlay auto} command (@pxref{Overlay Commands}), @value{GDBN}
8745 looks in the inferior's memory for certain variables describing the
8746 current state of the overlays.
8747
8748 Here are the variables your overlay manager must define to support
8749 @value{GDBN}'s automatic overlay debugging:
8750
8751 @table @asis
8752
8753 @item @code{_ovly_table}:
8754 This variable must be an array of the following structures:
8755
8756 @smallexample
8757 struct
8758 @{
8759 /* The overlay's mapped address. */
8760 unsigned long vma;
8761
8762 /* The size of the overlay, in bytes. */
8763 unsigned long size;
8764
8765 /* The overlay's load address. */
8766 unsigned long lma;
8767
8768 /* Non-zero if the overlay is currently mapped;
8769 zero otherwise. */
8770 unsigned long mapped;
8771 @}
8772 @end smallexample
8773
8774 @item @code{_novlys}:
8775 This variable must be a four-byte signed integer, holding the total
8776 number of elements in @code{_ovly_table}.
8777
8778 @end table
8779
8780 To decide whether a particular overlay is mapped or not, @value{GDBN}
8781 looks for an entry in @w{@code{_ovly_table}} whose @code{vma} and
8782 @code{lma} members equal the VMA and LMA of the overlay's section in the
8783 executable file. When @value{GDBN} finds a matching entry, it consults
8784 the entry's @code{mapped} member to determine whether the overlay is
8785 currently mapped.
8786
8787 In addition, your overlay manager may define a function called
8788 @code{_ovly_debug_event}. If this function is defined, @value{GDBN}
8789 will silently set a breakpoint there. If the overlay manager then
8790 calls this function whenever it has changed the overlay table, this
8791 will enable @value{GDBN} to accurately keep track of which overlays
8792 are in program memory, and update any breakpoints that may be set
8793 in overlays. This will allow breakpoints to work even if the
8794 overlays are kept in ROM or other non-writable memory while they
8795 are not being executed.
8796
8797 @node Overlay Sample Program
8798 @section Overlay Sample Program
8799 @cindex overlay example program
8800
8801 When linking a program which uses overlays, you must place the overlays
8802 at their load addresses, while relocating them to run at their mapped
8803 addresses. To do this, you must write a linker script (@pxref{Overlay
8804 Description,,, ld.info, Using ld: the GNU linker}). Unfortunately,
8805 since linker scripts are specific to a particular host system, target
8806 architecture, and target memory layout, this manual cannot provide
8807 portable sample code demonstrating @value{GDBN}'s overlay support.
8808
8809 However, the @value{GDBN} source distribution does contain an overlaid
8810 program, with linker scripts for a few systems, as part of its test
8811 suite. The program consists of the following files from
8812 @file{gdb/testsuite/gdb.base}:
8813
8814 @table @file
8815 @item overlays.c
8816 The main program file.
8817 @item ovlymgr.c
8818 A simple overlay manager, used by @file{overlays.c}.
8819 @item foo.c
8820 @itemx bar.c
8821 @itemx baz.c
8822 @itemx grbx.c
8823 Overlay modules, loaded and used by @file{overlays.c}.
8824 @item d10v.ld
8825 @itemx m32r.ld
8826 Linker scripts for linking the test program on the @code{d10v-elf}
8827 and @code{m32r-elf} targets.
8828 @end table
8829
8830 You can build the test program using the @code{d10v-elf} GCC
8831 cross-compiler like this:
8832
8833 @smallexample
8834 $ d10v-elf-gcc -g -c overlays.c
8835 $ d10v-elf-gcc -g -c ovlymgr.c
8836 $ d10v-elf-gcc -g -c foo.c
8837 $ d10v-elf-gcc -g -c bar.c
8838 $ d10v-elf-gcc -g -c baz.c
8839 $ d10v-elf-gcc -g -c grbx.c
8840 $ d10v-elf-gcc -g overlays.o ovlymgr.o foo.o bar.o \
8841 baz.o grbx.o -Wl,-Td10v.ld -o overlays
8842 @end smallexample
8843
8844 The build process is identical for any other architecture, except that
8845 you must substitute the appropriate compiler and linker script for the
8846 target system for @code{d10v-elf-gcc} and @code{d10v.ld}.
8847
8848
8849 @node Languages
8850 @chapter Using @value{GDBN} with Different Languages
8851 @cindex languages
8852
8853 Although programming languages generally have common aspects, they are
8854 rarely expressed in the same manner. For instance, in ANSI C,
8855 dereferencing a pointer @code{p} is accomplished by @code{*p}, but in
8856 Modula-2, it is accomplished by @code{p^}. Values can also be
8857 represented (and displayed) differently. Hex numbers in C appear as
8858 @samp{0x1ae}, while in Modula-2 they appear as @samp{1AEH}.
8859
8860 @cindex working language
8861 Language-specific information is built into @value{GDBN} for some languages,
8862 allowing you to express operations like the above in your program's
8863 native language, and allowing @value{GDBN} to output values in a manner
8864 consistent with the syntax of your program's native language. The
8865 language you use to build expressions is called the @dfn{working
8866 language}.
8867
8868 @menu
8869 * Setting:: Switching between source languages
8870 * Show:: Displaying the language
8871 * Checks:: Type and range checks
8872 * Supported Languages:: Supported languages
8873 * Unsupported Languages:: Unsupported languages
8874 @end menu
8875
8876 @node Setting
8877 @section Switching Between Source Languages
8878
8879 There are two ways to control the working language---either have @value{GDBN}
8880 set it automatically, or select it manually yourself. You can use the
8881 @code{set language} command for either purpose. On startup, @value{GDBN}
8882 defaults to setting the language automatically. The working language is
8883 used to determine how expressions you type are interpreted, how values
8884 are printed, etc.
8885
8886 In addition to the working language, every source file that
8887 @value{GDBN} knows about has its own working language. For some object
8888 file formats, the compiler might indicate which language a particular
8889 source file is in. However, most of the time @value{GDBN} infers the
8890 language from the name of the file. The language of a source file
8891 controls whether C@t{++} names are demangled---this way @code{backtrace} can
8892 show each frame appropriately for its own language. There is no way to
8893 set the language of a source file from within @value{GDBN}, but you can
8894 set the language associated with a filename extension. @xref{Show, ,
8895 Displaying the Language}.
8896
8897 This is most commonly a problem when you use a program, such
8898 as @code{cfront} or @code{f2c}, that generates C but is written in
8899 another language. In that case, make the
8900 program use @code{#line} directives in its C output; that way
8901 @value{GDBN} will know the correct language of the source code of the original
8902 program, and will display that source code, not the generated C code.
8903
8904 @menu
8905 * Filenames:: Filename extensions and languages.
8906 * Manually:: Setting the working language manually
8907 * Automatically:: Having @value{GDBN} infer the source language
8908 @end menu
8909
8910 @node Filenames
8911 @subsection List of Filename Extensions and Languages
8912
8913 If a source file name ends in one of the following extensions, then
8914 @value{GDBN} infers that its language is the one indicated.
8915
8916 @table @file
8917 @item .ada
8918 @itemx .ads
8919 @itemx .adb
8920 @itemx .a
8921 Ada source file.
8922
8923 @item .c
8924 C source file
8925
8926 @item .C
8927 @itemx .cc
8928 @itemx .cp
8929 @itemx .cpp
8930 @itemx .cxx
8931 @itemx .c++
8932 C@t{++} source file
8933
8934 @item .m
8935 Objective-C source file
8936
8937 @item .f
8938 @itemx .F
8939 Fortran source file
8940
8941 @item .mod
8942 Modula-2 source file
8943
8944 @item .s
8945 @itemx .S
8946 Assembler source file. This actually behaves almost like C, but
8947 @value{GDBN} does not skip over function prologues when stepping.
8948 @end table
8949
8950 In addition, you may set the language associated with a filename
8951 extension. @xref{Show, , Displaying the Language}.
8952
8953 @node Manually
8954 @subsection Setting the Working Language
8955
8956 If you allow @value{GDBN} to set the language automatically,
8957 expressions are interpreted the same way in your debugging session and
8958 your program.
8959
8960 @kindex set language
8961 If you wish, you may set the language manually. To do this, issue the
8962 command @samp{set language @var{lang}}, where @var{lang} is the name of
8963 a language, such as
8964 @code{c} or @code{modula-2}.
8965 For a list of the supported languages, type @samp{set language}.
8966
8967 Setting the language manually prevents @value{GDBN} from updating the working
8968 language automatically. This can lead to confusion if you try
8969 to debug a program when the working language is not the same as the
8970 source language, when an expression is acceptable to both
8971 languages---but means different things. For instance, if the current
8972 source file were written in C, and @value{GDBN} was parsing Modula-2, a
8973 command such as:
8974
8975 @smallexample
8976 print a = b + c
8977 @end smallexample
8978
8979 @noindent
8980 might not have the effect you intended. In C, this means to add
8981 @code{b} and @code{c} and place the result in @code{a}. The result
8982 printed would be the value of @code{a}. In Modula-2, this means to compare
8983 @code{a} to the result of @code{b+c}, yielding a @code{BOOLEAN} value.
8984
8985 @node Automatically
8986 @subsection Having @value{GDBN} Infer the Source Language
8987
8988 To have @value{GDBN} set the working language automatically, use
8989 @samp{set language local} or @samp{set language auto}. @value{GDBN}
8990 then infers the working language. That is, when your program stops in a
8991 frame (usually by encountering a breakpoint), @value{GDBN} sets the
8992 working language to the language recorded for the function in that
8993 frame. If the language for a frame is unknown (that is, if the function
8994 or block corresponding to the frame was defined in a source file that
8995 does not have a recognized extension), the current working language is
8996 not changed, and @value{GDBN} issues a warning.
8997
8998 This may not seem necessary for most programs, which are written
8999 entirely in one source language. However, program modules and libraries
9000 written in one source language can be used by a main program written in
9001 a different source language. Using @samp{set language auto} in this
9002 case frees you from having to set the working language manually.
9003
9004 @node Show
9005 @section Displaying the Language
9006
9007 The following commands help you find out which language is the
9008 working language, and also what language source files were written in.
9009
9010 @table @code
9011 @item show language
9012 @kindex show language
9013 Display the current working language. This is the
9014 language you can use with commands such as @code{print} to
9015 build and compute expressions that may involve variables in your program.
9016
9017 @item info frame
9018 @kindex info frame@r{, show the source language}
9019 Display the source language for this frame. This language becomes the
9020 working language if you use an identifier from this frame.
9021 @xref{Frame Info, ,Information about a Frame}, to identify the other
9022 information listed here.
9023
9024 @item info source
9025 @kindex info source@r{, show the source language}
9026 Display the source language of this source file.
9027 @xref{Symbols, ,Examining the Symbol Table}, to identify the other
9028 information listed here.
9029 @end table
9030
9031 In unusual circumstances, you may have source files with extensions
9032 not in the standard list. You can then set the extension associated
9033 with a language explicitly:
9034
9035 @table @code
9036 @item set extension-language @var{ext} @var{language}
9037 @kindex set extension-language
9038 Tell @value{GDBN} that source files with extension @var{ext} are to be
9039 assumed as written in the source language @var{language}.
9040
9041 @item info extensions
9042 @kindex info extensions
9043 List all the filename extensions and the associated languages.
9044 @end table
9045
9046 @node Checks
9047 @section Type and Range Checking
9048
9049 @quotation
9050 @emph{Warning:} In this release, the @value{GDBN} commands for type and range
9051 checking are included, but they do not yet have any effect. This
9052 section documents the intended facilities.
9053 @end quotation
9054 @c FIXME remove warning when type/range code added
9055
9056 Some languages are designed to guard you against making seemingly common
9057 errors through a series of compile- and run-time checks. These include
9058 checking the type of arguments to functions and operators, and making
9059 sure mathematical overflows are caught at run time. Checks such as
9060 these help to ensure a program's correctness once it has been compiled
9061 by eliminating type mismatches, and providing active checks for range
9062 errors when your program is running.
9063
9064 @value{GDBN} can check for conditions like the above if you wish.
9065 Although @value{GDBN} does not check the statements in your program,
9066 it can check expressions entered directly into @value{GDBN} for
9067 evaluation via the @code{print} command, for example. As with the
9068 working language, @value{GDBN} can also decide whether or not to check
9069 automatically based on your program's source language.
9070 @xref{Supported Languages, ,Supported Languages}, for the default
9071 settings of supported languages.
9072
9073 @menu
9074 * Type Checking:: An overview of type checking
9075 * Range Checking:: An overview of range checking
9076 @end menu
9077
9078 @cindex type checking
9079 @cindex checks, type
9080 @node Type Checking
9081 @subsection An Overview of Type Checking
9082
9083 Some languages, such as Modula-2, are strongly typed, meaning that the
9084 arguments to operators and functions have to be of the correct type,
9085 otherwise an error occurs. These checks prevent type mismatch
9086 errors from ever causing any run-time problems. For example,
9087
9088 @smallexample
9089 1 + 2 @result{} 3
9090 @exdent but
9091 @error{} 1 + 2.3
9092 @end smallexample
9093
9094 The second example fails because the @code{CARDINAL} 1 is not
9095 type-compatible with the @code{REAL} 2.3.
9096
9097 For the expressions you use in @value{GDBN} commands, you can tell the
9098 @value{GDBN} type checker to skip checking;
9099 to treat any mismatches as errors and abandon the expression;
9100 or to only issue warnings when type mismatches occur,
9101 but evaluate the expression anyway. When you choose the last of
9102 these, @value{GDBN} evaluates expressions like the second example above, but
9103 also issues a warning.
9104
9105 Even if you turn type checking off, there may be other reasons
9106 related to type that prevent @value{GDBN} from evaluating an expression.
9107 For instance, @value{GDBN} does not know how to add an @code{int} and
9108 a @code{struct foo}. These particular type errors have nothing to do
9109 with the language in use, and usually arise from expressions, such as
9110 the one described above, which make little sense to evaluate anyway.
9111
9112 Each language defines to what degree it is strict about type. For
9113 instance, both Modula-2 and C require the arguments to arithmetical
9114 operators to be numbers. In C, enumerated types and pointers can be
9115 represented as numbers, so that they are valid arguments to mathematical
9116 operators. @xref{Supported Languages, ,Supported Languages}, for further
9117 details on specific languages.
9118
9119 @value{GDBN} provides some additional commands for controlling the type checker:
9120
9121 @kindex set check type
9122 @kindex show check type
9123 @table @code
9124 @item set check type auto
9125 Set type checking on or off based on the current working language.
9126 @xref{Supported Languages, ,Supported Languages}, for the default settings for
9127 each language.
9128
9129 @item set check type on
9130 @itemx set check type off
9131 Set type checking on or off, overriding the default setting for the
9132 current working language. Issue a warning if the setting does not
9133 match the language default. If any type mismatches occur in
9134 evaluating an expression while type checking is on, @value{GDBN} prints a
9135 message and aborts evaluation of the expression.
9136
9137 @item set check type warn
9138 Cause the type checker to issue warnings, but to always attempt to
9139 evaluate the expression. Evaluating the expression may still
9140 be impossible for other reasons. For example, @value{GDBN} cannot add
9141 numbers and structures.
9142
9143 @item show type
9144 Show the current setting of the type checker, and whether or not @value{GDBN}
9145 is setting it automatically.
9146 @end table
9147
9148 @cindex range checking
9149 @cindex checks, range
9150 @node Range Checking
9151 @subsection An Overview of Range Checking
9152
9153 In some languages (such as Modula-2), it is an error to exceed the
9154 bounds of a type; this is enforced with run-time checks. Such range
9155 checking is meant to ensure program correctness by making sure
9156 computations do not overflow, or indices on an array element access do
9157 not exceed the bounds of the array.
9158
9159 For expressions you use in @value{GDBN} commands, you can tell
9160 @value{GDBN} to treat range errors in one of three ways: ignore them,
9161 always treat them as errors and abandon the expression, or issue
9162 warnings but evaluate the expression anyway.
9163
9164 A range error can result from numerical overflow, from exceeding an
9165 array index bound, or when you type a constant that is not a member
9166 of any type. Some languages, however, do not treat overflows as an
9167 error. In many implementations of C, mathematical overflow causes the
9168 result to ``wrap around'' to lower values---for example, if @var{m} is
9169 the largest integer value, and @var{s} is the smallest, then
9170
9171 @smallexample
9172 @var{m} + 1 @result{} @var{s}
9173 @end smallexample
9174
9175 This, too, is specific to individual languages, and in some cases
9176 specific to individual compilers or machines. @xref{Supported Languages, ,
9177 Supported Languages}, for further details on specific languages.
9178
9179 @value{GDBN} provides some additional commands for controlling the range checker:
9180
9181 @kindex set check range
9182 @kindex show check range
9183 @table @code
9184 @item set check range auto
9185 Set range checking on or off based on the current working language.
9186 @xref{Supported Languages, ,Supported Languages}, for the default settings for
9187 each language.
9188
9189 @item set check range on
9190 @itemx set check range off
9191 Set range checking on or off, overriding the default setting for the
9192 current working language. A warning is issued if the setting does not
9193 match the language default. If a range error occurs and range checking is on,
9194 then a message is printed and evaluation of the expression is aborted.
9195
9196 @item set check range warn
9197 Output messages when the @value{GDBN} range checker detects a range error,
9198 but attempt to evaluate the expression anyway. Evaluating the
9199 expression may still be impossible for other reasons, such as accessing
9200 memory that the process does not own (a typical example from many Unix
9201 systems).
9202
9203 @item show range
9204 Show the current setting of the range checker, and whether or not it is
9205 being set automatically by @value{GDBN}.
9206 @end table
9207
9208 @node Supported Languages
9209 @section Supported Languages
9210
9211 @value{GDBN} supports C, C@t{++}, Objective-C, Fortran, Java, Pascal,
9212 assembly, Modula-2, and Ada.
9213 @c This is false ...
9214 Some @value{GDBN} features may be used in expressions regardless of the
9215 language you use: the @value{GDBN} @code{@@} and @code{::} operators,
9216 and the @samp{@{type@}addr} construct (@pxref{Expressions,
9217 ,Expressions}) can be used with the constructs of any supported
9218 language.
9219
9220 The following sections detail to what degree each source language is
9221 supported by @value{GDBN}. These sections are not meant to be language
9222 tutorials or references, but serve only as a reference guide to what the
9223 @value{GDBN} expression parser accepts, and what input and output
9224 formats should look like for different languages. There are many good
9225 books written on each of these languages; please look to these for a
9226 language reference or tutorial.
9227
9228 @menu
9229 * C:: C and C@t{++}
9230 * Objective-C:: Objective-C
9231 * Fortran:: Fortran
9232 * Pascal:: Pascal
9233 * Modula-2:: Modula-2
9234 * Ada:: Ada
9235 @end menu
9236
9237 @node C
9238 @subsection C and C@t{++}
9239
9240 @cindex C and C@t{++}
9241 @cindex expressions in C or C@t{++}
9242
9243 Since C and C@t{++} are so closely related, many features of @value{GDBN} apply
9244 to both languages. Whenever this is the case, we discuss those languages
9245 together.
9246
9247 @cindex C@t{++}
9248 @cindex @code{g++}, @sc{gnu} C@t{++} compiler
9249 @cindex @sc{gnu} C@t{++}
9250 The C@t{++} debugging facilities are jointly implemented by the C@t{++}
9251 compiler and @value{GDBN}. Therefore, to debug your C@t{++} code
9252 effectively, you must compile your C@t{++} programs with a supported
9253 C@t{++} compiler, such as @sc{gnu} @code{g++}, or the HP ANSI C@t{++}
9254 compiler (@code{aCC}).
9255
9256 For best results when using @sc{gnu} C@t{++}, use the DWARF 2 debugging
9257 format; if it doesn't work on your system, try the stabs+ debugging
9258 format. You can select those formats explicitly with the @code{g++}
9259 command-line options @option{-gdwarf-2} and @option{-gstabs+}.
9260 @xref{Debugging Options,,Options for Debugging Your Program or GCC,
9261 gcc.info, Using the @sc{gnu} Compiler Collection (GCC)}.
9262
9263 @menu
9264 * C Operators:: C and C@t{++} operators
9265 * C Constants:: C and C@t{++} constants
9266 * C Plus Plus Expressions:: C@t{++} expressions
9267 * C Defaults:: Default settings for C and C@t{++}
9268 * C Checks:: C and C@t{++} type and range checks
9269 * Debugging C:: @value{GDBN} and C
9270 * Debugging C Plus Plus:: @value{GDBN} features for C@t{++}
9271 * Decimal Floating Point:: Numbers in Decimal Floating Point format
9272 @end menu
9273
9274 @node C Operators
9275 @subsubsection C and C@t{++} Operators
9276
9277 @cindex C and C@t{++} operators
9278
9279 Operators must be defined on values of specific types. For instance,
9280 @code{+} is defined on numbers, but not on structures. Operators are
9281 often defined on groups of types.
9282
9283 For the purposes of C and C@t{++}, the following definitions hold:
9284
9285 @itemize @bullet
9286
9287 @item
9288 @emph{Integral types} include @code{int} with any of its storage-class
9289 specifiers; @code{char}; @code{enum}; and, for C@t{++}, @code{bool}.
9290
9291 @item
9292 @emph{Floating-point types} include @code{float}, @code{double}, and
9293 @code{long double} (if supported by the target platform).
9294
9295 @item
9296 @emph{Pointer types} include all types defined as @code{(@var{type} *)}.
9297
9298 @item
9299 @emph{Scalar types} include all of the above.
9300
9301 @end itemize
9302
9303 @noindent
9304 The following operators are supported. They are listed here
9305 in order of increasing precedence:
9306
9307 @table @code
9308 @item ,
9309 The comma or sequencing operator. Expressions in a comma-separated list
9310 are evaluated from left to right, with the result of the entire
9311 expression being the last expression evaluated.
9312
9313 @item =
9314 Assignment. The value of an assignment expression is the value
9315 assigned. Defined on scalar types.
9316
9317 @item @var{op}=
9318 Used in an expression of the form @w{@code{@var{a} @var{op}= @var{b}}},
9319 and translated to @w{@code{@var{a} = @var{a op b}}}.
9320 @w{@code{@var{op}=}} and @code{=} have the same precedence.
9321 @var{op} is any one of the operators @code{|}, @code{^}, @code{&},
9322 @code{<<}, @code{>>}, @code{+}, @code{-}, @code{*}, @code{/}, @code{%}.
9323
9324 @item ?:
9325 The ternary operator. @code{@var{a} ? @var{b} : @var{c}} can be thought
9326 of as: if @var{a} then @var{b} else @var{c}. @var{a} should be of an
9327 integral type.
9328
9329 @item ||
9330 Logical @sc{or}. Defined on integral types.
9331
9332 @item &&
9333 Logical @sc{and}. Defined on integral types.
9334
9335 @item |
9336 Bitwise @sc{or}. Defined on integral types.
9337
9338 @item ^
9339 Bitwise exclusive-@sc{or}. Defined on integral types.
9340
9341 @item &
9342 Bitwise @sc{and}. Defined on integral types.
9343
9344 @item ==@r{, }!=
9345 Equality and inequality. Defined on scalar types. The value of these
9346 expressions is 0 for false and non-zero for true.
9347
9348 @item <@r{, }>@r{, }<=@r{, }>=
9349 Less than, greater than, less than or equal, greater than or equal.
9350 Defined on scalar types. The value of these expressions is 0 for false
9351 and non-zero for true.
9352
9353 @item <<@r{, }>>
9354 left shift, and right shift. Defined on integral types.
9355
9356 @item @@
9357 The @value{GDBN} ``artificial array'' operator (@pxref{Expressions, ,Expressions}).
9358
9359 @item +@r{, }-
9360 Addition and subtraction. Defined on integral types, floating-point types and
9361 pointer types.
9362
9363 @item *@r{, }/@r{, }%
9364 Multiplication, division, and modulus. Multiplication and division are
9365 defined on integral and floating-point types. Modulus is defined on
9366 integral types.
9367
9368 @item ++@r{, }--
9369 Increment and decrement. When appearing before a variable, the
9370 operation is performed before the variable is used in an expression;
9371 when appearing after it, the variable's value is used before the
9372 operation takes place.
9373
9374 @item *
9375 Pointer dereferencing. Defined on pointer types. Same precedence as
9376 @code{++}.
9377
9378 @item &
9379 Address operator. Defined on variables. Same precedence as @code{++}.
9380
9381 For debugging C@t{++}, @value{GDBN} implements a use of @samp{&} beyond what is
9382 allowed in the C@t{++} language itself: you can use @samp{&(&@var{ref})}
9383 to examine the address
9384 where a C@t{++} reference variable (declared with @samp{&@var{ref}}) is
9385 stored.
9386
9387 @item -
9388 Negative. Defined on integral and floating-point types. Same
9389 precedence as @code{++}.
9390
9391 @item !
9392 Logical negation. Defined on integral types. Same precedence as
9393 @code{++}.
9394
9395 @item ~
9396 Bitwise complement operator. Defined on integral types. Same precedence as
9397 @code{++}.
9398
9399
9400 @item .@r{, }->
9401 Structure member, and pointer-to-structure member. For convenience,
9402 @value{GDBN} regards the two as equivalent, choosing whether to dereference a
9403 pointer based on the stored type information.
9404 Defined on @code{struct} and @code{union} data.
9405
9406 @item .*@r{, }->*
9407 Dereferences of pointers to members.
9408
9409 @item []
9410 Array indexing. @code{@var{a}[@var{i}]} is defined as
9411 @code{*(@var{a}+@var{i})}. Same precedence as @code{->}.
9412
9413 @item ()
9414 Function parameter list. Same precedence as @code{->}.
9415
9416 @item ::
9417 C@t{++} scope resolution operator. Defined on @code{struct}, @code{union},
9418 and @code{class} types.
9419
9420 @item ::
9421 Doubled colons also represent the @value{GDBN} scope operator
9422 (@pxref{Expressions, ,Expressions}). Same precedence as @code{::},
9423 above.
9424 @end table
9425
9426 If an operator is redefined in the user code, @value{GDBN} usually
9427 attempts to invoke the redefined version instead of using the operator's
9428 predefined meaning.
9429
9430 @node C Constants
9431 @subsubsection C and C@t{++} Constants
9432
9433 @cindex C and C@t{++} constants
9434
9435 @value{GDBN} allows you to express the constants of C and C@t{++} in the
9436 following ways:
9437
9438 @itemize @bullet
9439 @item
9440 Integer constants are a sequence of digits. Octal constants are
9441 specified by a leading @samp{0} (i.e.@: zero), and hexadecimal constants
9442 by a leading @samp{0x} or @samp{0X}. Constants may also end with a letter
9443 @samp{l}, specifying that the constant should be treated as a
9444 @code{long} value.
9445
9446 @item
9447 Floating point constants are a sequence of digits, followed by a decimal
9448 point, followed by a sequence of digits, and optionally followed by an
9449 exponent. An exponent is of the form:
9450 @samp{@w{e@r{[[}+@r{]|}-@r{]}@var{nnn}}}, where @var{nnn} is another
9451 sequence of digits. The @samp{+} is optional for positive exponents.
9452 A floating-point constant may also end with a letter @samp{f} or
9453 @samp{F}, specifying that the constant should be treated as being of
9454 the @code{float} (as opposed to the default @code{double}) type; or with
9455 a letter @samp{l} or @samp{L}, which specifies a @code{long double}
9456 constant.
9457
9458 @item
9459 Enumerated constants consist of enumerated identifiers, or their
9460 integral equivalents.
9461
9462 @item
9463 Character constants are a single character surrounded by single quotes
9464 (@code{'}), or a number---the ordinal value of the corresponding character
9465 (usually its @sc{ascii} value). Within quotes, the single character may
9466 be represented by a letter or by @dfn{escape sequences}, which are of
9467 the form @samp{\@var{nnn}}, where @var{nnn} is the octal representation
9468 of the character's ordinal value; or of the form @samp{\@var{x}}, where
9469 @samp{@var{x}} is a predefined special character---for example,
9470 @samp{\n} for newline.
9471
9472 @item
9473 String constants are a sequence of character constants surrounded by
9474 double quotes (@code{"}). Any valid character constant (as described
9475 above) may appear. Double quotes within the string must be preceded by
9476 a backslash, so for instance @samp{"a\"b'c"} is a string of five
9477 characters.
9478
9479 @item
9480 Pointer constants are an integral value. You can also write pointers
9481 to constants using the C operator @samp{&}.
9482
9483 @item
9484 Array constants are comma-separated lists surrounded by braces @samp{@{}
9485 and @samp{@}}; for example, @samp{@{1,2,3@}} is a three-element array of
9486 integers, @samp{@{@{1,2@}, @{3,4@}, @{5,6@}@}} is a three-by-two array,
9487 and @samp{@{&"hi", &"there", &"fred"@}} is a three-element array of pointers.
9488 @end itemize
9489
9490 @node C Plus Plus Expressions
9491 @subsubsection C@t{++} Expressions
9492
9493 @cindex expressions in C@t{++}
9494 @value{GDBN} expression handling can interpret most C@t{++} expressions.
9495
9496 @cindex debugging C@t{++} programs
9497 @cindex C@t{++} compilers
9498 @cindex debug formats and C@t{++}
9499 @cindex @value{NGCC} and C@t{++}
9500 @quotation
9501 @emph{Warning:} @value{GDBN} can only debug C@t{++} code if you use the
9502 proper compiler and the proper debug format. Currently, @value{GDBN}
9503 works best when debugging C@t{++} code that is compiled with
9504 @value{NGCC} 2.95.3 or with @value{NGCC} 3.1 or newer, using the options
9505 @option{-gdwarf-2} or @option{-gstabs+}. DWARF 2 is preferred over
9506 stabs+. Most configurations of @value{NGCC} emit either DWARF 2 or
9507 stabs+ as their default debug format, so you usually don't need to
9508 specify a debug format explicitly. Other compilers and/or debug formats
9509 are likely to work badly or not at all when using @value{GDBN} to debug
9510 C@t{++} code.
9511 @end quotation
9512
9513 @enumerate
9514
9515 @cindex member functions
9516 @item
9517 Member function calls are allowed; you can use expressions like
9518
9519 @smallexample
9520 count = aml->GetOriginal(x, y)
9521 @end smallexample
9522
9523 @vindex this@r{, inside C@t{++} member functions}
9524 @cindex namespace in C@t{++}
9525 @item
9526 While a member function is active (in the selected stack frame), your
9527 expressions have the same namespace available as the member function;
9528 that is, @value{GDBN} allows implicit references to the class instance
9529 pointer @code{this} following the same rules as C@t{++}.
9530
9531 @cindex call overloaded functions
9532 @cindex overloaded functions, calling
9533 @cindex type conversions in C@t{++}
9534 @item
9535 You can call overloaded functions; @value{GDBN} resolves the function
9536 call to the right definition, with some restrictions. @value{GDBN} does not
9537 perform overload resolution involving user-defined type conversions,
9538 calls to constructors, or instantiations of templates that do not exist
9539 in the program. It also cannot handle ellipsis argument lists or
9540 default arguments.
9541
9542 It does perform integral conversions and promotions, floating-point
9543 promotions, arithmetic conversions, pointer conversions, conversions of
9544 class objects to base classes, and standard conversions such as those of
9545 functions or arrays to pointers; it requires an exact match on the
9546 number of function arguments.
9547
9548 Overload resolution is always performed, unless you have specified
9549 @code{set overload-resolution off}. @xref{Debugging C Plus Plus,
9550 ,@value{GDBN} Features for C@t{++}}.
9551
9552 You must specify @code{set overload-resolution off} in order to use an
9553 explicit function signature to call an overloaded function, as in
9554 @smallexample
9555 p 'foo(char,int)'('x', 13)
9556 @end smallexample
9557
9558 The @value{GDBN} command-completion facility can simplify this;
9559 see @ref{Completion, ,Command Completion}.
9560
9561 @cindex reference declarations
9562 @item
9563 @value{GDBN} understands variables declared as C@t{++} references; you can use
9564 them in expressions just as you do in C@t{++} source---they are automatically
9565 dereferenced.
9566
9567 In the parameter list shown when @value{GDBN} displays a frame, the values of
9568 reference variables are not displayed (unlike other variables); this
9569 avoids clutter, since references are often used for large structures.
9570 The @emph{address} of a reference variable is always shown, unless
9571 you have specified @samp{set print address off}.
9572
9573 @item
9574 @value{GDBN} supports the C@t{++} name resolution operator @code{::}---your
9575 expressions can use it just as expressions in your program do. Since
9576 one scope may be defined in another, you can use @code{::} repeatedly if
9577 necessary, for example in an expression like
9578 @samp{@var{scope1}::@var{scope2}::@var{name}}. @value{GDBN} also allows
9579 resolving name scope by reference to source files, in both C and C@t{++}
9580 debugging (@pxref{Variables, ,Program Variables}).
9581 @end enumerate
9582
9583 In addition, when used with HP's C@t{++} compiler, @value{GDBN} supports
9584 calling virtual functions correctly, printing out virtual bases of
9585 objects, calling functions in a base subobject, casting objects, and
9586 invoking user-defined operators.
9587
9588 @node C Defaults
9589 @subsubsection C and C@t{++} Defaults
9590
9591 @cindex C and C@t{++} defaults
9592
9593 If you allow @value{GDBN} to set type and range checking automatically, they
9594 both default to @code{off} whenever the working language changes to
9595 C or C@t{++}. This happens regardless of whether you or @value{GDBN}
9596 selects the working language.
9597
9598 If you allow @value{GDBN} to set the language automatically, it
9599 recognizes source files whose names end with @file{.c}, @file{.C}, or
9600 @file{.cc}, etc, and when @value{GDBN} enters code compiled from one of
9601 these files, it sets the working language to C or C@t{++}.
9602 @xref{Automatically, ,Having @value{GDBN} Infer the Source Language},
9603 for further details.
9604
9605 @c Type checking is (a) primarily motivated by Modula-2, and (b)
9606 @c unimplemented. If (b) changes, it might make sense to let this node
9607 @c appear even if Mod-2 does not, but meanwhile ignore it. roland 16jul93.
9608
9609 @node C Checks
9610 @subsubsection C and C@t{++} Type and Range Checks
9611
9612 @cindex C and C@t{++} checks
9613
9614 By default, when @value{GDBN} parses C or C@t{++} expressions, type checking
9615 is not used. However, if you turn type checking on, @value{GDBN}
9616 considers two variables type equivalent if:
9617
9618 @itemize @bullet
9619 @item
9620 The two variables are structured and have the same structure, union, or
9621 enumerated tag.
9622
9623 @item
9624 The two variables have the same type name, or types that have been
9625 declared equivalent through @code{typedef}.
9626
9627 @ignore
9628 @c leaving this out because neither J Gilmore nor R Pesch understand it.
9629 @c FIXME--beers?
9630 @item
9631 The two @code{struct}, @code{union}, or @code{enum} variables are
9632 declared in the same declaration. (Note: this may not be true for all C
9633 compilers.)
9634 @end ignore
9635 @end itemize
9636
9637 Range checking, if turned on, is done on mathematical operations. Array
9638 indices are not checked, since they are often used to index a pointer
9639 that is not itself an array.
9640
9641 @node Debugging C
9642 @subsubsection @value{GDBN} and C
9643
9644 The @code{set print union} and @code{show print union} commands apply to
9645 the @code{union} type. When set to @samp{on}, any @code{union} that is
9646 inside a @code{struct} or @code{class} is also printed. Otherwise, it
9647 appears as @samp{@{...@}}.
9648
9649 The @code{@@} operator aids in the debugging of dynamic arrays, formed
9650 with pointers and a memory allocation function. @xref{Expressions,
9651 ,Expressions}.
9652
9653 @node Debugging C Plus Plus
9654 @subsubsection @value{GDBN} Features for C@t{++}
9655
9656 @cindex commands for C@t{++}
9657
9658 Some @value{GDBN} commands are particularly useful with C@t{++}, and some are
9659 designed specifically for use with C@t{++}. Here is a summary:
9660
9661 @table @code
9662 @cindex break in overloaded functions
9663 @item @r{breakpoint menus}
9664 When you want a breakpoint in a function whose name is overloaded,
9665 @value{GDBN} has the capability to display a menu of possible breakpoint
9666 locations to help you specify which function definition you want.
9667 @xref{Ambiguous Expressions,,Ambiguous Expressions}.
9668
9669 @cindex overloading in C@t{++}
9670 @item rbreak @var{regex}
9671 Setting breakpoints using regular expressions is helpful for setting
9672 breakpoints on overloaded functions that are not members of any special
9673 classes.
9674 @xref{Set Breaks, ,Setting Breakpoints}.
9675
9676 @cindex C@t{++} exception handling
9677 @item catch throw
9678 @itemx catch catch
9679 Debug C@t{++} exception handling using these commands. @xref{Set
9680 Catchpoints, , Setting Catchpoints}.
9681
9682 @cindex inheritance
9683 @item ptype @var{typename}
9684 Print inheritance relationships as well as other information for type
9685 @var{typename}.
9686 @xref{Symbols, ,Examining the Symbol Table}.
9687
9688 @cindex C@t{++} symbol display
9689 @item set print demangle
9690 @itemx show print demangle
9691 @itemx set print asm-demangle
9692 @itemx show print asm-demangle
9693 Control whether C@t{++} symbols display in their source form, both when
9694 displaying code as C@t{++} source and when displaying disassemblies.
9695 @xref{Print Settings, ,Print Settings}.
9696
9697 @item set print object
9698 @itemx show print object
9699 Choose whether to print derived (actual) or declared types of objects.
9700 @xref{Print Settings, ,Print Settings}.
9701
9702 @item set print vtbl
9703 @itemx show print vtbl
9704 Control the format for printing virtual function tables.
9705 @xref{Print Settings, ,Print Settings}.
9706 (The @code{vtbl} commands do not work on programs compiled with the HP
9707 ANSI C@t{++} compiler (@code{aCC}).)
9708
9709 @kindex set overload-resolution
9710 @cindex overloaded functions, overload resolution
9711 @item set overload-resolution on
9712 Enable overload resolution for C@t{++} expression evaluation. The default
9713 is on. For overloaded functions, @value{GDBN} evaluates the arguments
9714 and searches for a function whose signature matches the argument types,
9715 using the standard C@t{++} conversion rules (see @ref{C Plus Plus
9716 Expressions, ,C@t{++} Expressions}, for details).
9717 If it cannot find a match, it emits a message.
9718
9719 @item set overload-resolution off
9720 Disable overload resolution for C@t{++} expression evaluation. For
9721 overloaded functions that are not class member functions, @value{GDBN}
9722 chooses the first function of the specified name that it finds in the
9723 symbol table, whether or not its arguments are of the correct type. For
9724 overloaded functions that are class member functions, @value{GDBN}
9725 searches for a function whose signature @emph{exactly} matches the
9726 argument types.
9727
9728 @kindex show overload-resolution
9729 @item show overload-resolution
9730 Show the current setting of overload resolution.
9731
9732 @item @r{Overloaded symbol names}
9733 You can specify a particular definition of an overloaded symbol, using
9734 the same notation that is used to declare such symbols in C@t{++}: type
9735 @code{@var{symbol}(@var{types})} rather than just @var{symbol}. You can
9736 also use the @value{GDBN} command-line word completion facilities to list the
9737 available choices, or to finish the type list for you.
9738 @xref{Completion,, Command Completion}, for details on how to do this.
9739 @end table
9740
9741 @node Decimal Floating Point
9742 @subsubsection Decimal Floating Point format
9743 @cindex decimal floating point format
9744
9745 @value{GDBN} can examine, set and perform computations with numbers in
9746 decimal floating point format, which in the C language correspond to the
9747 @code{_Decimal32}, @code{_Decimal64} and @code{_Decimal128} types as
9748 specified by the extension to support decimal floating-point arithmetic.
9749
9750 There are two encodings in use, depending on the architecture: BID (Binary
9751 Integer Decimal) for x86 and x86-64, and DPD (Densely Packed Decimal) for
9752 PowerPC. @value{GDBN} will use the appropriate encoding for the configured
9753 target.
9754
9755 Because of a limitation in @file{libdecnumber}, the library used by @value{GDBN}
9756 to manipulate decimal floating point numbers, it is not possible to convert
9757 (using a cast, for example) integers wider than 32-bit to decimal float.
9758
9759 In addition, in order to imitate @value{GDBN}'s behaviour with binary floating
9760 point computations, error checking in decimal float operations ignores
9761 underflow, overflow and divide by zero exceptions.
9762
9763 In the PowerPC architecture, @value{GDBN} provides a set of pseudo-registers
9764 to inspect @code{_Decimal128} values stored in floating point registers. See
9765 @ref{PowerPC,,PowerPC} for more details.
9766
9767 @node Objective-C
9768 @subsection Objective-C
9769
9770 @cindex Objective-C
9771 This section provides information about some commands and command
9772 options that are useful for debugging Objective-C code. See also
9773 @ref{Symbols, info classes}, and @ref{Symbols, info selectors}, for a
9774 few more commands specific to Objective-C support.
9775
9776 @menu
9777 * Method Names in Commands::
9778 * The Print Command with Objective-C::
9779 @end menu
9780
9781 @node Method Names in Commands
9782 @subsubsection Method Names in Commands
9783
9784 The following commands have been extended to accept Objective-C method
9785 names as line specifications:
9786
9787 @kindex clear@r{, and Objective-C}
9788 @kindex break@r{, and Objective-C}
9789 @kindex info line@r{, and Objective-C}
9790 @kindex jump@r{, and Objective-C}
9791 @kindex list@r{, and Objective-C}
9792 @itemize
9793 @item @code{clear}
9794 @item @code{break}
9795 @item @code{info line}
9796 @item @code{jump}
9797 @item @code{list}
9798 @end itemize
9799
9800 A fully qualified Objective-C method name is specified as
9801
9802 @smallexample
9803 -[@var{Class} @var{methodName}]
9804 @end smallexample
9805
9806 where the minus sign is used to indicate an instance method and a
9807 plus sign (not shown) is used to indicate a class method. The class
9808 name @var{Class} and method name @var{methodName} are enclosed in
9809 brackets, similar to the way messages are specified in Objective-C
9810 source code. For example, to set a breakpoint at the @code{create}
9811 instance method of class @code{Fruit} in the program currently being
9812 debugged, enter:
9813
9814 @smallexample
9815 break -[Fruit create]
9816 @end smallexample
9817
9818 To list ten program lines around the @code{initialize} class method,
9819 enter:
9820
9821 @smallexample
9822 list +[NSText initialize]
9823 @end smallexample
9824
9825 In the current version of @value{GDBN}, the plus or minus sign is
9826 required. In future versions of @value{GDBN}, the plus or minus
9827 sign will be optional, but you can use it to narrow the search. It
9828 is also possible to specify just a method name:
9829
9830 @smallexample
9831 break create
9832 @end smallexample
9833
9834 You must specify the complete method name, including any colons. If
9835 your program's source files contain more than one @code{create} method,
9836 you'll be presented with a numbered list of classes that implement that
9837 method. Indicate your choice by number, or type @samp{0} to exit if
9838 none apply.
9839
9840 As another example, to clear a breakpoint established at the
9841 @code{makeKeyAndOrderFront:} method of the @code{NSWindow} class, enter:
9842
9843 @smallexample
9844 clear -[NSWindow makeKeyAndOrderFront:]
9845 @end smallexample
9846
9847 @node The Print Command with Objective-C
9848 @subsubsection The Print Command With Objective-C
9849 @cindex Objective-C, print objects
9850 @kindex print-object
9851 @kindex po @r{(@code{print-object})}
9852
9853 The print command has also been extended to accept methods. For example:
9854
9855 @smallexample
9856 print -[@var{object} hash]
9857 @end smallexample
9858
9859 @cindex print an Objective-C object description
9860 @cindex @code{_NSPrintForDebugger}, and printing Objective-C objects
9861 @noindent
9862 will tell @value{GDBN} to send the @code{hash} message to @var{object}
9863 and print the result. Also, an additional command has been added,
9864 @code{print-object} or @code{po} for short, which is meant to print
9865 the description of an object. However, this command may only work
9866 with certain Objective-C libraries that have a particular hook
9867 function, @code{_NSPrintForDebugger}, defined.
9868
9869 @node Fortran
9870 @subsection Fortran
9871 @cindex Fortran-specific support in @value{GDBN}
9872
9873 @value{GDBN} can be used to debug programs written in Fortran, but it
9874 currently supports only the features of Fortran 77 language.
9875
9876 @cindex trailing underscore, in Fortran symbols
9877 Some Fortran compilers (@sc{gnu} Fortran 77 and Fortran 95 compilers
9878 among them) append an underscore to the names of variables and
9879 functions. When you debug programs compiled by those compilers, you
9880 will need to refer to variables and functions with a trailing
9881 underscore.
9882
9883 @menu
9884 * Fortran Operators:: Fortran operators and expressions
9885 * Fortran Defaults:: Default settings for Fortran
9886 * Special Fortran Commands:: Special @value{GDBN} commands for Fortran
9887 @end menu
9888
9889 @node Fortran Operators
9890 @subsubsection Fortran Operators and Expressions
9891
9892 @cindex Fortran operators and expressions
9893
9894 Operators must be defined on values of specific types. For instance,
9895 @code{+} is defined on numbers, but not on characters or other non-
9896 arithmetic types. Operators are often defined on groups of types.
9897
9898 @table @code
9899 @item **
9900 The exponentiation operator. It raises the first operand to the power
9901 of the second one.
9902
9903 @item :
9904 The range operator. Normally used in the form of array(low:high) to
9905 represent a section of array.
9906
9907 @item %
9908 The access component operator. Normally used to access elements in derived
9909 types. Also suitable for unions. As unions aren't part of regular Fortran,
9910 this can only happen when accessing a register that uses a gdbarch-defined
9911 union type.
9912 @end table
9913
9914 @node Fortran Defaults
9915 @subsubsection Fortran Defaults
9916
9917 @cindex Fortran Defaults
9918
9919 Fortran symbols are usually case-insensitive, so @value{GDBN} by
9920 default uses case-insensitive matches for Fortran symbols. You can
9921 change that with the @samp{set case-insensitive} command, see
9922 @ref{Symbols}, for the details.
9923
9924 @node Special Fortran Commands
9925 @subsubsection Special Fortran Commands
9926
9927 @cindex Special Fortran commands
9928
9929 @value{GDBN} has some commands to support Fortran-specific features,
9930 such as displaying common blocks.
9931
9932 @table @code
9933 @cindex @code{COMMON} blocks, Fortran
9934 @kindex info common
9935 @item info common @r{[}@var{common-name}@r{]}
9936 This command prints the values contained in the Fortran @code{COMMON}
9937 block whose name is @var{common-name}. With no argument, the names of
9938 all @code{COMMON} blocks visible at the current program location are
9939 printed.
9940 @end table
9941
9942 @node Pascal
9943 @subsection Pascal
9944
9945 @cindex Pascal support in @value{GDBN}, limitations
9946 Debugging Pascal programs which use sets, subranges, file variables, or
9947 nested functions does not currently work. @value{GDBN} does not support
9948 entering expressions, printing values, or similar features using Pascal
9949 syntax.
9950
9951 The Pascal-specific command @code{set print pascal_static-members}
9952 controls whether static members of Pascal objects are displayed.
9953 @xref{Print Settings, pascal_static-members}.
9954
9955 @node Modula-2
9956 @subsection Modula-2
9957
9958 @cindex Modula-2, @value{GDBN} support
9959
9960 The extensions made to @value{GDBN} to support Modula-2 only support
9961 output from the @sc{gnu} Modula-2 compiler (which is currently being
9962 developed). Other Modula-2 compilers are not currently supported, and
9963 attempting to debug executables produced by them is most likely
9964 to give an error as @value{GDBN} reads in the executable's symbol
9965 table.
9966
9967 @cindex expressions in Modula-2
9968 @menu
9969 * M2 Operators:: Built-in operators
9970 * Built-In Func/Proc:: Built-in functions and procedures
9971 * M2 Constants:: Modula-2 constants
9972 * M2 Types:: Modula-2 types
9973 * M2 Defaults:: Default settings for Modula-2
9974 * Deviations:: Deviations from standard Modula-2
9975 * M2 Checks:: Modula-2 type and range checks
9976 * M2 Scope:: The scope operators @code{::} and @code{.}
9977 * GDB/M2:: @value{GDBN} and Modula-2
9978 @end menu
9979
9980 @node M2 Operators
9981 @subsubsection Operators
9982 @cindex Modula-2 operators
9983
9984 Operators must be defined on values of specific types. For instance,
9985 @code{+} is defined on numbers, but not on structures. Operators are
9986 often defined on groups of types. For the purposes of Modula-2, the
9987 following definitions hold:
9988
9989 @itemize @bullet
9990
9991 @item
9992 @emph{Integral types} consist of @code{INTEGER}, @code{CARDINAL}, and
9993 their subranges.
9994
9995 @item
9996 @emph{Character types} consist of @code{CHAR} and its subranges.
9997
9998 @item
9999 @emph{Floating-point types} consist of @code{REAL}.
10000
10001 @item
10002 @emph{Pointer types} consist of anything declared as @code{POINTER TO
10003 @var{type}}.
10004
10005 @item
10006 @emph{Scalar types} consist of all of the above.
10007
10008 @item
10009 @emph{Set types} consist of @code{SET} and @code{BITSET} types.
10010
10011 @item
10012 @emph{Boolean types} consist of @code{BOOLEAN}.
10013 @end itemize
10014
10015 @noindent
10016 The following operators are supported, and appear in order of
10017 increasing precedence:
10018
10019 @table @code
10020 @item ,
10021 Function argument or array index separator.
10022
10023 @item :=
10024 Assignment. The value of @var{var} @code{:=} @var{value} is
10025 @var{value}.
10026
10027 @item <@r{, }>
10028 Less than, greater than on integral, floating-point, or enumerated
10029 types.
10030
10031 @item <=@r{, }>=
10032 Less than or equal to, greater than or equal to
10033 on integral, floating-point and enumerated types, or set inclusion on
10034 set types. Same precedence as @code{<}.
10035
10036 @item =@r{, }<>@r{, }#
10037 Equality and two ways of expressing inequality, valid on scalar types.
10038 Same precedence as @code{<}. In @value{GDBN} scripts, only @code{<>} is
10039 available for inequality, since @code{#} conflicts with the script
10040 comment character.
10041
10042 @item IN
10043 Set membership. Defined on set types and the types of their members.
10044 Same precedence as @code{<}.
10045
10046 @item OR
10047 Boolean disjunction. Defined on boolean types.
10048
10049 @item AND@r{, }&
10050 Boolean conjunction. Defined on boolean types.
10051
10052 @item @@
10053 The @value{GDBN} ``artificial array'' operator (@pxref{Expressions, ,Expressions}).
10054
10055 @item +@r{, }-
10056 Addition and subtraction on integral and floating-point types, or union
10057 and difference on set types.
10058
10059 @item *
10060 Multiplication on integral and floating-point types, or set intersection
10061 on set types.
10062
10063 @item /
10064 Division on floating-point types, or symmetric set difference on set
10065 types. Same precedence as @code{*}.
10066
10067 @item DIV@r{, }MOD
10068 Integer division and remainder. Defined on integral types. Same
10069 precedence as @code{*}.
10070
10071 @item -
10072 Negative. Defined on @code{INTEGER} and @code{REAL} data.
10073
10074 @item ^
10075 Pointer dereferencing. Defined on pointer types.
10076
10077 @item NOT
10078 Boolean negation. Defined on boolean types. Same precedence as
10079 @code{^}.
10080
10081 @item .
10082 @code{RECORD} field selector. Defined on @code{RECORD} data. Same
10083 precedence as @code{^}.
10084
10085 @item []
10086 Array indexing. Defined on @code{ARRAY} data. Same precedence as @code{^}.
10087
10088 @item ()
10089 Procedure argument list. Defined on @code{PROCEDURE} objects. Same precedence
10090 as @code{^}.
10091
10092 @item ::@r{, }.
10093 @value{GDBN} and Modula-2 scope operators.
10094 @end table
10095
10096 @quotation
10097 @emph{Warning:} Set expressions and their operations are not yet supported, so @value{GDBN}
10098 treats the use of the operator @code{IN}, or the use of operators
10099 @code{+}, @code{-}, @code{*}, @code{/}, @code{=}, , @code{<>}, @code{#},
10100 @code{<=}, and @code{>=} on sets as an error.
10101 @end quotation
10102
10103
10104 @node Built-In Func/Proc
10105 @subsubsection Built-in Functions and Procedures
10106 @cindex Modula-2 built-ins
10107
10108 Modula-2 also makes available several built-in procedures and functions.
10109 In describing these, the following metavariables are used:
10110
10111 @table @var
10112
10113 @item a
10114 represents an @code{ARRAY} variable.
10115
10116 @item c
10117 represents a @code{CHAR} constant or variable.
10118
10119 @item i
10120 represents a variable or constant of integral type.
10121
10122 @item m
10123 represents an identifier that belongs to a set. Generally used in the
10124 same function with the metavariable @var{s}. The type of @var{s} should
10125 be @code{SET OF @var{mtype}} (where @var{mtype} is the type of @var{m}).
10126
10127 @item n
10128 represents a variable or constant of integral or floating-point type.
10129
10130 @item r
10131 represents a variable or constant of floating-point type.
10132
10133 @item t
10134 represents a type.
10135
10136 @item v
10137 represents a variable.
10138
10139 @item x
10140 represents a variable or constant of one of many types. See the
10141 explanation of the function for details.
10142 @end table
10143
10144 All Modula-2 built-in procedures also return a result, described below.
10145
10146 @table @code
10147 @item ABS(@var{n})
10148 Returns the absolute value of @var{n}.
10149
10150 @item CAP(@var{c})
10151 If @var{c} is a lower case letter, it returns its upper case
10152 equivalent, otherwise it returns its argument.
10153
10154 @item CHR(@var{i})
10155 Returns the character whose ordinal value is @var{i}.
10156
10157 @item DEC(@var{v})
10158 Decrements the value in the variable @var{v} by one. Returns the new value.
10159
10160 @item DEC(@var{v},@var{i})
10161 Decrements the value in the variable @var{v} by @var{i}. Returns the
10162 new value.
10163
10164 @item EXCL(@var{m},@var{s})
10165 Removes the element @var{m} from the set @var{s}. Returns the new
10166 set.
10167
10168 @item FLOAT(@var{i})
10169 Returns the floating point equivalent of the integer @var{i}.
10170
10171 @item HIGH(@var{a})
10172 Returns the index of the last member of @var{a}.
10173
10174 @item INC(@var{v})
10175 Increments the value in the variable @var{v} by one. Returns the new value.
10176
10177 @item INC(@var{v},@var{i})
10178 Increments the value in the variable @var{v} by @var{i}. Returns the
10179 new value.
10180
10181 @item INCL(@var{m},@var{s})
10182 Adds the element @var{m} to the set @var{s} if it is not already
10183 there. Returns the new set.
10184
10185 @item MAX(@var{t})
10186 Returns the maximum value of the type @var{t}.
10187
10188 @item MIN(@var{t})
10189 Returns the minimum value of the type @var{t}.
10190
10191 @item ODD(@var{i})
10192 Returns boolean TRUE if @var{i} is an odd number.
10193
10194 @item ORD(@var{x})
10195 Returns the ordinal value of its argument. For example, the ordinal
10196 value of a character is its @sc{ascii} value (on machines supporting the
10197 @sc{ascii} character set). @var{x} must be of an ordered type, which include
10198 integral, character and enumerated types.
10199
10200 @item SIZE(@var{x})
10201 Returns the size of its argument. @var{x} can be a variable or a type.
10202
10203 @item TRUNC(@var{r})
10204 Returns the integral part of @var{r}.
10205
10206 @item TSIZE(@var{x})
10207 Returns the size of its argument. @var{x} can be a variable or a type.
10208
10209 @item VAL(@var{t},@var{i})
10210 Returns the member of the type @var{t} whose ordinal value is @var{i}.
10211 @end table
10212
10213 @quotation
10214 @emph{Warning:} Sets and their operations are not yet supported, so
10215 @value{GDBN} treats the use of procedures @code{INCL} and @code{EXCL} as
10216 an error.
10217 @end quotation
10218
10219 @cindex Modula-2 constants
10220 @node M2 Constants
10221 @subsubsection Constants
10222
10223 @value{GDBN} allows you to express the constants of Modula-2 in the following
10224 ways:
10225
10226 @itemize @bullet
10227
10228 @item
10229 Integer constants are simply a sequence of digits. When used in an
10230 expression, a constant is interpreted to be type-compatible with the
10231 rest of the expression. Hexadecimal integers are specified by a
10232 trailing @samp{H}, and octal integers by a trailing @samp{B}.
10233
10234 @item
10235 Floating point constants appear as a sequence of digits, followed by a
10236 decimal point and another sequence of digits. An optional exponent can
10237 then be specified, in the form @samp{E@r{[}+@r{|}-@r{]}@var{nnn}}, where
10238 @samp{@r{[}+@r{|}-@r{]}@var{nnn}} is the desired exponent. All of the
10239 digits of the floating point constant must be valid decimal (base 10)
10240 digits.
10241
10242 @item
10243 Character constants consist of a single character enclosed by a pair of
10244 like quotes, either single (@code{'}) or double (@code{"}). They may
10245 also be expressed by their ordinal value (their @sc{ascii} value, usually)
10246 followed by a @samp{C}.
10247
10248 @item
10249 String constants consist of a sequence of characters enclosed by a
10250 pair of like quotes, either single (@code{'}) or double (@code{"}).
10251 Escape sequences in the style of C are also allowed. @xref{C
10252 Constants, ,C and C@t{++} Constants}, for a brief explanation of escape
10253 sequences.
10254
10255 @item
10256 Enumerated constants consist of an enumerated identifier.
10257
10258 @item
10259 Boolean constants consist of the identifiers @code{TRUE} and
10260 @code{FALSE}.
10261
10262 @item
10263 Pointer constants consist of integral values only.
10264
10265 @item
10266 Set constants are not yet supported.
10267 @end itemize
10268
10269 @node M2 Types
10270 @subsubsection Modula-2 Types
10271 @cindex Modula-2 types
10272
10273 Currently @value{GDBN} can print the following data types in Modula-2
10274 syntax: array types, record types, set types, pointer types, procedure
10275 types, enumerated types, subrange types and base types. You can also
10276 print the contents of variables declared using these type.
10277 This section gives a number of simple source code examples together with
10278 sample @value{GDBN} sessions.
10279
10280 The first example contains the following section of code:
10281
10282 @smallexample
10283 VAR
10284 s: SET OF CHAR ;
10285 r: [20..40] ;
10286 @end smallexample
10287
10288 @noindent
10289 and you can request @value{GDBN} to interrogate the type and value of
10290 @code{r} and @code{s}.
10291
10292 @smallexample
10293 (@value{GDBP}) print s
10294 @{'A'..'C', 'Z'@}
10295 (@value{GDBP}) ptype s
10296 SET OF CHAR
10297 (@value{GDBP}) print r
10298 21
10299 (@value{GDBP}) ptype r
10300 [20..40]
10301 @end smallexample
10302
10303 @noindent
10304 Likewise if your source code declares @code{s} as:
10305
10306 @smallexample
10307 VAR
10308 s: SET ['A'..'Z'] ;
10309 @end smallexample
10310
10311 @noindent
10312 then you may query the type of @code{s} by:
10313
10314 @smallexample
10315 (@value{GDBP}) ptype s
10316 type = SET ['A'..'Z']
10317 @end smallexample
10318
10319 @noindent
10320 Note that at present you cannot interactively manipulate set
10321 expressions using the debugger.
10322
10323 The following example shows how you might declare an array in Modula-2
10324 and how you can interact with @value{GDBN} to print its type and contents:
10325
10326 @smallexample
10327 VAR
10328 s: ARRAY [-10..10] OF CHAR ;
10329 @end smallexample
10330
10331 @smallexample
10332 (@value{GDBP}) ptype s
10333 ARRAY [-10..10] OF CHAR
10334 @end smallexample
10335
10336 Note that the array handling is not yet complete and although the type
10337 is printed correctly, expression handling still assumes that all
10338 arrays have a lower bound of zero and not @code{-10} as in the example
10339 above.
10340
10341 Here are some more type related Modula-2 examples:
10342
10343 @smallexample
10344 TYPE
10345 colour = (blue, red, yellow, green) ;
10346 t = [blue..yellow] ;
10347 VAR
10348 s: t ;
10349 BEGIN
10350 s := blue ;
10351 @end smallexample
10352
10353 @noindent
10354 The @value{GDBN} interaction shows how you can query the data type
10355 and value of a variable.
10356
10357 @smallexample
10358 (@value{GDBP}) print s
10359 $1 = blue
10360 (@value{GDBP}) ptype t
10361 type = [blue..yellow]
10362 @end smallexample
10363
10364 @noindent
10365 In this example a Modula-2 array is declared and its contents
10366 displayed. Observe that the contents are written in the same way as
10367 their @code{C} counterparts.
10368
10369 @smallexample
10370 VAR
10371 s: ARRAY [1..5] OF CARDINAL ;
10372 BEGIN
10373 s[1] := 1 ;
10374 @end smallexample
10375
10376 @smallexample
10377 (@value{GDBP}) print s
10378 $1 = @{1, 0, 0, 0, 0@}
10379 (@value{GDBP}) ptype s
10380 type = ARRAY [1..5] OF CARDINAL
10381 @end smallexample
10382
10383 The Modula-2 language interface to @value{GDBN} also understands
10384 pointer types as shown in this example:
10385
10386 @smallexample
10387 VAR
10388 s: POINTER TO ARRAY [1..5] OF CARDINAL ;
10389 BEGIN
10390 NEW(s) ;
10391 s^[1] := 1 ;
10392 @end smallexample
10393
10394 @noindent
10395 and you can request that @value{GDBN} describes the type of @code{s}.
10396
10397 @smallexample
10398 (@value{GDBP}) ptype s
10399 type = POINTER TO ARRAY [1..5] OF CARDINAL
10400 @end smallexample
10401
10402 @value{GDBN} handles compound types as we can see in this example.
10403 Here we combine array types, record types, pointer types and subrange
10404 types:
10405
10406 @smallexample
10407 TYPE
10408 foo = RECORD
10409 f1: CARDINAL ;
10410 f2: CHAR ;
10411 f3: myarray ;
10412 END ;
10413
10414 myarray = ARRAY myrange OF CARDINAL ;
10415 myrange = [-2..2] ;
10416 VAR
10417 s: POINTER TO ARRAY myrange OF foo ;
10418 @end smallexample
10419
10420 @noindent
10421 and you can ask @value{GDBN} to describe the type of @code{s} as shown
10422 below.
10423
10424 @smallexample
10425 (@value{GDBP}) ptype s
10426 type = POINTER TO ARRAY [-2..2] OF foo = RECORD
10427 f1 : CARDINAL;
10428 f2 : CHAR;
10429 f3 : ARRAY [-2..2] OF CARDINAL;
10430 END
10431 @end smallexample
10432
10433 @node M2 Defaults
10434 @subsubsection Modula-2 Defaults
10435 @cindex Modula-2 defaults
10436
10437 If type and range checking are set automatically by @value{GDBN}, they
10438 both default to @code{on} whenever the working language changes to
10439 Modula-2. This happens regardless of whether you or @value{GDBN}
10440 selected the working language.
10441
10442 If you allow @value{GDBN} to set the language automatically, then entering
10443 code compiled from a file whose name ends with @file{.mod} sets the
10444 working language to Modula-2. @xref{Automatically, ,Having @value{GDBN}
10445 Infer the Source Language}, for further details.
10446
10447 @node Deviations
10448 @subsubsection Deviations from Standard Modula-2
10449 @cindex Modula-2, deviations from
10450
10451 A few changes have been made to make Modula-2 programs easier to debug.
10452 This is done primarily via loosening its type strictness:
10453
10454 @itemize @bullet
10455 @item
10456 Unlike in standard Modula-2, pointer constants can be formed by
10457 integers. This allows you to modify pointer variables during
10458 debugging. (In standard Modula-2, the actual address contained in a
10459 pointer variable is hidden from you; it can only be modified
10460 through direct assignment to another pointer variable or expression that
10461 returned a pointer.)
10462
10463 @item
10464 C escape sequences can be used in strings and characters to represent
10465 non-printable characters. @value{GDBN} prints out strings with these
10466 escape sequences embedded. Single non-printable characters are
10467 printed using the @samp{CHR(@var{nnn})} format.
10468
10469 @item
10470 The assignment operator (@code{:=}) returns the value of its right-hand
10471 argument.
10472
10473 @item
10474 All built-in procedures both modify @emph{and} return their argument.
10475 @end itemize
10476
10477 @node M2 Checks
10478 @subsubsection Modula-2 Type and Range Checks
10479 @cindex Modula-2 checks
10480
10481 @quotation
10482 @emph{Warning:} in this release, @value{GDBN} does not yet perform type or
10483 range checking.
10484 @end quotation
10485 @c FIXME remove warning when type/range checks added
10486
10487 @value{GDBN} considers two Modula-2 variables type equivalent if:
10488
10489 @itemize @bullet
10490 @item
10491 They are of types that have been declared equivalent via a @code{TYPE
10492 @var{t1} = @var{t2}} statement
10493
10494 @item
10495 They have been declared on the same line. (Note: This is true of the
10496 @sc{gnu} Modula-2 compiler, but it may not be true of other compilers.)
10497 @end itemize
10498
10499 As long as type checking is enabled, any attempt to combine variables
10500 whose types are not equivalent is an error.
10501
10502 Range checking is done on all mathematical operations, assignment, array
10503 index bounds, and all built-in functions and procedures.
10504
10505 @node M2 Scope
10506 @subsubsection The Scope Operators @code{::} and @code{.}
10507 @cindex scope
10508 @cindex @code{.}, Modula-2 scope operator
10509 @cindex colon, doubled as scope operator
10510 @ifinfo
10511 @vindex colon-colon@r{, in Modula-2}
10512 @c Info cannot handle :: but TeX can.
10513 @end ifinfo
10514 @iftex
10515 @vindex ::@r{, in Modula-2}
10516 @end iftex
10517
10518 There are a few subtle differences between the Modula-2 scope operator
10519 (@code{.}) and the @value{GDBN} scope operator (@code{::}). The two have
10520 similar syntax:
10521
10522 @smallexample
10523
10524 @var{module} . @var{id}
10525 @var{scope} :: @var{id}
10526 @end smallexample
10527
10528 @noindent
10529 where @var{scope} is the name of a module or a procedure,
10530 @var{module} the name of a module, and @var{id} is any declared
10531 identifier within your program, except another module.
10532
10533 Using the @code{::} operator makes @value{GDBN} search the scope
10534 specified by @var{scope} for the identifier @var{id}. If it is not
10535 found in the specified scope, then @value{GDBN} searches all scopes
10536 enclosing the one specified by @var{scope}.
10537
10538 Using the @code{.} operator makes @value{GDBN} search the current scope for
10539 the identifier specified by @var{id} that was imported from the
10540 definition module specified by @var{module}. With this operator, it is
10541 an error if the identifier @var{id} was not imported from definition
10542 module @var{module}, or if @var{id} is not an identifier in
10543 @var{module}.
10544
10545 @node GDB/M2
10546 @subsubsection @value{GDBN} and Modula-2
10547
10548 Some @value{GDBN} commands have little use when debugging Modula-2 programs.
10549 Five subcommands of @code{set print} and @code{show print} apply
10550 specifically to C and C@t{++}: @samp{vtbl}, @samp{demangle},
10551 @samp{asm-demangle}, @samp{object}, and @samp{union}. The first four
10552 apply to C@t{++}, and the last to the C @code{union} type, which has no direct
10553 analogue in Modula-2.
10554
10555 The @code{@@} operator (@pxref{Expressions, ,Expressions}), while available
10556 with any language, is not useful with Modula-2. Its
10557 intent is to aid the debugging of @dfn{dynamic arrays}, which cannot be
10558 created in Modula-2 as they can in C or C@t{++}. However, because an
10559 address can be specified by an integral constant, the construct
10560 @samp{@{@var{type}@}@var{adrexp}} is still useful.
10561
10562 @cindex @code{#} in Modula-2
10563 In @value{GDBN} scripts, the Modula-2 inequality operator @code{#} is
10564 interpreted as the beginning of a comment. Use @code{<>} instead.
10565
10566 @node Ada
10567 @subsection Ada
10568 @cindex Ada
10569
10570 The extensions made to @value{GDBN} for Ada only support
10571 output from the @sc{gnu} Ada (GNAT) compiler.
10572 Other Ada compilers are not currently supported, and
10573 attempting to debug executables produced by them is most likely
10574 to be difficult.
10575
10576
10577 @cindex expressions in Ada
10578 @menu
10579 * Ada Mode Intro:: General remarks on the Ada syntax
10580 and semantics supported by Ada mode
10581 in @value{GDBN}.
10582 * Omissions from Ada:: Restrictions on the Ada expression syntax.
10583 * Additions to Ada:: Extensions of the Ada expression syntax.
10584 * Stopping Before Main Program:: Debugging the program during elaboration.
10585 * Ada Glitches:: Known peculiarities of Ada mode.
10586 @end menu
10587
10588 @node Ada Mode Intro
10589 @subsubsection Introduction
10590 @cindex Ada mode, general
10591
10592 The Ada mode of @value{GDBN} supports a fairly large subset of Ada expression
10593 syntax, with some extensions.
10594 The philosophy behind the design of this subset is
10595
10596 @itemize @bullet
10597 @item
10598 That @value{GDBN} should provide basic literals and access to operations for
10599 arithmetic, dereferencing, field selection, indexing, and subprogram calls,
10600 leaving more sophisticated computations to subprograms written into the
10601 program (which therefore may be called from @value{GDBN}).
10602
10603 @item
10604 That type safety and strict adherence to Ada language restrictions
10605 are not particularly important to the @value{GDBN} user.
10606
10607 @item
10608 That brevity is important to the @value{GDBN} user.
10609 @end itemize
10610
10611 Thus, for brevity, the debugger acts as if there were
10612 implicit @code{with} and @code{use} clauses in effect for all user-written
10613 packages, making it unnecessary to fully qualify most names with
10614 their packages, regardless of context. Where this causes ambiguity,
10615 @value{GDBN} asks the user's intent.
10616
10617 The debugger will start in Ada mode if it detects an Ada main program.
10618 As for other languages, it will enter Ada mode when stopped in a program that
10619 was translated from an Ada source file.
10620
10621 While in Ada mode, you may use `@t{--}' for comments. This is useful
10622 mostly for documenting command files. The standard @value{GDBN} comment
10623 (@samp{#}) still works at the beginning of a line in Ada mode, but not in the
10624 middle (to allow based literals).
10625
10626 The debugger supports limited overloading. Given a subprogram call in which
10627 the function symbol has multiple definitions, it will use the number of
10628 actual parameters and some information about their types to attempt to narrow
10629 the set of definitions. It also makes very limited use of context, preferring
10630 procedures to functions in the context of the @code{call} command, and
10631 functions to procedures elsewhere.
10632
10633 @node Omissions from Ada
10634 @subsubsection Omissions from Ada
10635 @cindex Ada, omissions from
10636
10637 Here are the notable omissions from the subset:
10638
10639 @itemize @bullet
10640 @item
10641 Only a subset of the attributes are supported:
10642
10643 @itemize @minus
10644 @item
10645 @t{'First}, @t{'Last}, and @t{'Length}
10646 on array objects (not on types and subtypes).
10647
10648 @item
10649 @t{'Min} and @t{'Max}.
10650
10651 @item
10652 @t{'Pos} and @t{'Val}.
10653
10654 @item
10655 @t{'Tag}.
10656
10657 @item
10658 @t{'Range} on array objects (not subtypes), but only as the right
10659 operand of the membership (@code{in}) operator.
10660
10661 @item
10662 @t{'Access}, @t{'Unchecked_Access}, and
10663 @t{'Unrestricted_Access} (a GNAT extension).
10664
10665 @item
10666 @t{'Address}.
10667 @end itemize
10668
10669 @item
10670 The names in
10671 @code{Characters.Latin_1} are not available and
10672 concatenation is not implemented. Thus, escape characters in strings are
10673 not currently available.
10674
10675 @item
10676 Equality tests (@samp{=} and @samp{/=}) on arrays test for bitwise
10677 equality of representations. They will generally work correctly
10678 for strings and arrays whose elements have integer or enumeration types.
10679 They may not work correctly for arrays whose element
10680 types have user-defined equality, for arrays of real values
10681 (in particular, IEEE-conformant floating point, because of negative
10682 zeroes and NaNs), and for arrays whose elements contain unused bits with
10683 indeterminate values.
10684
10685 @item
10686 The other component-by-component array operations (@code{and}, @code{or},
10687 @code{xor}, @code{not}, and relational tests other than equality)
10688 are not implemented.
10689
10690 @item
10691 @cindex array aggregates (Ada)
10692 @cindex record aggregates (Ada)
10693 @cindex aggregates (Ada)
10694 There is limited support for array and record aggregates. They are
10695 permitted only on the right sides of assignments, as in these examples:
10696
10697 @smallexample
10698 set An_Array := (1, 2, 3, 4, 5, 6)
10699 set An_Array := (1, others => 0)
10700 set An_Array := (0|4 => 1, 1..3 => 2, 5 => 6)
10701 set A_2D_Array := ((1, 2, 3), (4, 5, 6), (7, 8, 9))
10702 set A_Record := (1, "Peter", True);
10703 set A_Record := (Name => "Peter", Id => 1, Alive => True)
10704 @end smallexample
10705
10706 Changing a
10707 discriminant's value by assigning an aggregate has an
10708 undefined effect if that discriminant is used within the record.
10709 However, you can first modify discriminants by directly assigning to
10710 them (which normally would not be allowed in Ada), and then performing an
10711 aggregate assignment. For example, given a variable @code{A_Rec}
10712 declared to have a type such as:
10713
10714 @smallexample
10715 type Rec (Len : Small_Integer := 0) is record
10716 Id : Integer;
10717 Vals : IntArray (1 .. Len);
10718 end record;
10719 @end smallexample
10720
10721 you can assign a value with a different size of @code{Vals} with two
10722 assignments:
10723
10724 @smallexample
10725 set A_Rec.Len := 4
10726 set A_Rec := (Id => 42, Vals => (1, 2, 3, 4))
10727 @end smallexample
10728
10729 As this example also illustrates, @value{GDBN} is very loose about the usual
10730 rules concerning aggregates. You may leave out some of the
10731 components of an array or record aggregate (such as the @code{Len}
10732 component in the assignment to @code{A_Rec} above); they will retain their
10733 original values upon assignment. You may freely use dynamic values as
10734 indices in component associations. You may even use overlapping or
10735 redundant component associations, although which component values are
10736 assigned in such cases is not defined.
10737
10738 @item
10739 Calls to dispatching subprograms are not implemented.
10740
10741 @item
10742 The overloading algorithm is much more limited (i.e., less selective)
10743 than that of real Ada. It makes only limited use of the context in
10744 which a subexpression appears to resolve its meaning, and it is much
10745 looser in its rules for allowing type matches. As a result, some
10746 function calls will be ambiguous, and the user will be asked to choose
10747 the proper resolution.
10748
10749 @item
10750 The @code{new} operator is not implemented.
10751
10752 @item
10753 Entry calls are not implemented.
10754
10755 @item
10756 Aside from printing, arithmetic operations on the native VAX floating-point
10757 formats are not supported.
10758
10759 @item
10760 It is not possible to slice a packed array.
10761 @end itemize
10762
10763 @node Additions to Ada
10764 @subsubsection Additions to Ada
10765 @cindex Ada, deviations from
10766
10767 As it does for other languages, @value{GDBN} makes certain generic
10768 extensions to Ada (@pxref{Expressions}):
10769
10770 @itemize @bullet
10771 @item
10772 If the expression @var{E} is a variable residing in memory (typically
10773 a local variable or array element) and @var{N} is a positive integer,
10774 then @code{@var{E}@@@var{N}} displays the values of @var{E} and the
10775 @var{N}-1 adjacent variables following it in memory as an array. In
10776 Ada, this operator is generally not necessary, since its prime use is
10777 in displaying parts of an array, and slicing will usually do this in
10778 Ada. However, there are occasional uses when debugging programs in
10779 which certain debugging information has been optimized away.
10780
10781 @item
10782 @code{@var{B}::@var{var}} means ``the variable named @var{var} that
10783 appears in function or file @var{B}.'' When @var{B} is a file name,
10784 you must typically surround it in single quotes.
10785
10786 @item
10787 The expression @code{@{@var{type}@} @var{addr}} means ``the variable of type
10788 @var{type} that appears at address @var{addr}.''
10789
10790 @item
10791 A name starting with @samp{$} is a convenience variable
10792 (@pxref{Convenience Vars}) or a machine register (@pxref{Registers}).
10793 @end itemize
10794
10795 In addition, @value{GDBN} provides a few other shortcuts and outright
10796 additions specific to Ada:
10797
10798 @itemize @bullet
10799 @item
10800 The assignment statement is allowed as an expression, returning
10801 its right-hand operand as its value. Thus, you may enter
10802
10803 @smallexample
10804 set x := y + 3
10805 print A(tmp := y + 1)
10806 @end smallexample
10807
10808 @item
10809 The semicolon is allowed as an ``operator,'' returning as its value
10810 the value of its right-hand operand.
10811 This allows, for example,
10812 complex conditional breaks:
10813
10814 @smallexample
10815 break f
10816 condition 1 (report(i); k += 1; A(k) > 100)
10817 @end smallexample
10818
10819 @item
10820 Rather than use catenation and symbolic character names to introduce special
10821 characters into strings, one may instead use a special bracket notation,
10822 which is also used to print strings. A sequence of characters of the form
10823 @samp{["@var{XX}"]} within a string or character literal denotes the
10824 (single) character whose numeric encoding is @var{XX} in hexadecimal. The
10825 sequence of characters @samp{["""]} also denotes a single quotation mark
10826 in strings. For example,
10827 @smallexample
10828 "One line.["0a"]Next line.["0a"]"
10829 @end smallexample
10830 @noindent
10831 contains an ASCII newline character (@code{Ada.Characters.Latin_1.LF})
10832 after each period.
10833
10834 @item
10835 The subtype used as a prefix for the attributes @t{'Pos}, @t{'Min}, and
10836 @t{'Max} is optional (and is ignored in any case). For example, it is valid
10837 to write
10838
10839 @smallexample
10840 print 'max(x, y)
10841 @end smallexample
10842
10843 @item
10844 When printing arrays, @value{GDBN} uses positional notation when the
10845 array has a lower bound of 1, and uses a modified named notation otherwise.
10846 For example, a one-dimensional array of three integers with a lower bound
10847 of 3 might print as
10848
10849 @smallexample
10850 (3 => 10, 17, 1)
10851 @end smallexample
10852
10853 @noindent
10854 That is, in contrast to valid Ada, only the first component has a @code{=>}
10855 clause.
10856
10857 @item
10858 You may abbreviate attributes in expressions with any unique,
10859 multi-character subsequence of
10860 their names (an exact match gets preference).
10861 For example, you may use @t{a'len}, @t{a'gth}, or @t{a'lh}
10862 in place of @t{a'length}.
10863
10864 @item
10865 @cindex quoting Ada internal identifiers
10866 Since Ada is case-insensitive, the debugger normally maps identifiers you type
10867 to lower case. The GNAT compiler uses upper-case characters for
10868 some of its internal identifiers, which are normally of no interest to users.
10869 For the rare occasions when you actually have to look at them,
10870 enclose them in angle brackets to avoid the lower-case mapping.
10871 For example,
10872 @smallexample
10873 @value{GDBP} print <JMPBUF_SAVE>[0]
10874 @end smallexample
10875
10876 @item
10877 Printing an object of class-wide type or dereferencing an
10878 access-to-class-wide value will display all the components of the object's
10879 specific type (as indicated by its run-time tag). Likewise, component
10880 selection on such a value will operate on the specific type of the
10881 object.
10882
10883 @end itemize
10884
10885 @node Stopping Before Main Program
10886 @subsubsection Stopping at the Very Beginning
10887
10888 @cindex breakpointing Ada elaboration code
10889 It is sometimes necessary to debug the program during elaboration, and
10890 before reaching the main procedure.
10891 As defined in the Ada Reference
10892 Manual, the elaboration code is invoked from a procedure called
10893 @code{adainit}. To run your program up to the beginning of
10894 elaboration, simply use the following two commands:
10895 @code{tbreak adainit} and @code{run}.
10896
10897 @node Ada Glitches
10898 @subsubsection Known Peculiarities of Ada Mode
10899 @cindex Ada, problems
10900
10901 Besides the omissions listed previously (@pxref{Omissions from Ada}),
10902 we know of several problems with and limitations of Ada mode in
10903 @value{GDBN},
10904 some of which will be fixed with planned future releases of the debugger
10905 and the GNU Ada compiler.
10906
10907 @itemize @bullet
10908 @item
10909 Currently, the debugger
10910 has insufficient information to determine whether certain pointers represent
10911 pointers to objects or the objects themselves.
10912 Thus, the user may have to tack an extra @code{.all} after an expression
10913 to get it printed properly.
10914
10915 @item
10916 Static constants that the compiler chooses not to materialize as objects in
10917 storage are invisible to the debugger.
10918
10919 @item
10920 Named parameter associations in function argument lists are ignored (the
10921 argument lists are treated as positional).
10922
10923 @item
10924 Many useful library packages are currently invisible to the debugger.
10925
10926 @item
10927 Fixed-point arithmetic, conversions, input, and output is carried out using
10928 floating-point arithmetic, and may give results that only approximate those on
10929 the host machine.
10930
10931 @item
10932 The type of the @t{'Address} attribute may not be @code{System.Address}.
10933
10934 @item
10935 The GNAT compiler never generates the prefix @code{Standard} for any of
10936 the standard symbols defined by the Ada language. @value{GDBN} knows about
10937 this: it will strip the prefix from names when you use it, and will never
10938 look for a name you have so qualified among local symbols, nor match against
10939 symbols in other packages or subprograms. If you have
10940 defined entities anywhere in your program other than parameters and
10941 local variables whose simple names match names in @code{Standard},
10942 GNAT's lack of qualification here can cause confusion. When this happens,
10943 you can usually resolve the confusion
10944 by qualifying the problematic names with package
10945 @code{Standard} explicitly.
10946 @end itemize
10947
10948 @node Unsupported Languages
10949 @section Unsupported Languages
10950
10951 @cindex unsupported languages
10952 @cindex minimal language
10953 In addition to the other fully-supported programming languages,
10954 @value{GDBN} also provides a pseudo-language, called @code{minimal}.
10955 It does not represent a real programming language, but provides a set
10956 of capabilities close to what the C or assembly languages provide.
10957 This should allow most simple operations to be performed while debugging
10958 an application that uses a language currently not supported by @value{GDBN}.
10959
10960 If the language is set to @code{auto}, @value{GDBN} will automatically
10961 select this language if the current frame corresponds to an unsupported
10962 language.
10963
10964 @node Symbols
10965 @chapter Examining the Symbol Table
10966
10967 The commands described in this chapter allow you to inquire about the
10968 symbols (names of variables, functions and types) defined in your
10969 program. This information is inherent in the text of your program and
10970 does not change as your program executes. @value{GDBN} finds it in your
10971 program's symbol table, in the file indicated when you started @value{GDBN}
10972 (@pxref{File Options, ,Choosing Files}), or by one of the
10973 file-management commands (@pxref{Files, ,Commands to Specify Files}).
10974
10975 @cindex symbol names
10976 @cindex names of symbols
10977 @cindex quoting names
10978 Occasionally, you may need to refer to symbols that contain unusual
10979 characters, which @value{GDBN} ordinarily treats as word delimiters. The
10980 most frequent case is in referring to static variables in other
10981 source files (@pxref{Variables,,Program Variables}). File names
10982 are recorded in object files as debugging symbols, but @value{GDBN} would
10983 ordinarily parse a typical file name, like @file{foo.c}, as the three words
10984 @samp{foo} @samp{.} @samp{c}. To allow @value{GDBN} to recognize
10985 @samp{foo.c} as a single symbol, enclose it in single quotes; for example,
10986
10987 @smallexample
10988 p 'foo.c'::x
10989 @end smallexample
10990
10991 @noindent
10992 looks up the value of @code{x} in the scope of the file @file{foo.c}.
10993
10994 @table @code
10995 @cindex case-insensitive symbol names
10996 @cindex case sensitivity in symbol names
10997 @kindex set case-sensitive
10998 @item set case-sensitive on
10999 @itemx set case-sensitive off
11000 @itemx set case-sensitive auto
11001 Normally, when @value{GDBN} looks up symbols, it matches their names
11002 with case sensitivity determined by the current source language.
11003 Occasionally, you may wish to control that. The command @code{set
11004 case-sensitive} lets you do that by specifying @code{on} for
11005 case-sensitive matches or @code{off} for case-insensitive ones. If
11006 you specify @code{auto}, case sensitivity is reset to the default
11007 suitable for the source language. The default is case-sensitive
11008 matches for all languages except for Fortran, for which the default is
11009 case-insensitive matches.
11010
11011 @kindex show case-sensitive
11012 @item show case-sensitive
11013 This command shows the current setting of case sensitivity for symbols
11014 lookups.
11015
11016 @kindex info address
11017 @cindex address of a symbol
11018 @item info address @var{symbol}
11019 Describe where the data for @var{symbol} is stored. For a register
11020 variable, this says which register it is kept in. For a non-register
11021 local variable, this prints the stack-frame offset at which the variable
11022 is always stored.
11023
11024 Note the contrast with @samp{print &@var{symbol}}, which does not work
11025 at all for a register variable, and for a stack local variable prints
11026 the exact address of the current instantiation of the variable.
11027
11028 @kindex info symbol
11029 @cindex symbol from address
11030 @cindex closest symbol and offset for an address
11031 @item info symbol @var{addr}
11032 Print the name of a symbol which is stored at the address @var{addr}.
11033 If no symbol is stored exactly at @var{addr}, @value{GDBN} prints the
11034 nearest symbol and an offset from it:
11035
11036 @smallexample
11037 (@value{GDBP}) info symbol 0x54320
11038 _initialize_vx + 396 in section .text
11039 @end smallexample
11040
11041 @noindent
11042 This is the opposite of the @code{info address} command. You can use
11043 it to find out the name of a variable or a function given its address.
11044
11045 @kindex whatis
11046 @item whatis [@var{arg}]
11047 Print the data type of @var{arg}, which can be either an expression or
11048 a data type. With no argument, print the data type of @code{$}, the
11049 last value in the value history. If @var{arg} is an expression, it is
11050 not actually evaluated, and any side-effecting operations (such as
11051 assignments or function calls) inside it do not take place. If
11052 @var{arg} is a type name, it may be the name of a type or typedef, or
11053 for C code it may have the form @samp{class @var{class-name}},
11054 @samp{struct @var{struct-tag}}, @samp{union @var{union-tag}} or
11055 @samp{enum @var{enum-tag}}.
11056 @xref{Expressions, ,Expressions}.
11057
11058 @kindex ptype
11059 @item ptype [@var{arg}]
11060 @code{ptype} accepts the same arguments as @code{whatis}, but prints a
11061 detailed description of the type, instead of just the name of the type.
11062 @xref{Expressions, ,Expressions}.
11063
11064 For example, for this variable declaration:
11065
11066 @smallexample
11067 struct complex @{double real; double imag;@} v;
11068 @end smallexample
11069
11070 @noindent
11071 the two commands give this output:
11072
11073 @smallexample
11074 @group
11075 (@value{GDBP}) whatis v
11076 type = struct complex
11077 (@value{GDBP}) ptype v
11078 type = struct complex @{
11079 double real;
11080 double imag;
11081 @}
11082 @end group
11083 @end smallexample
11084
11085 @noindent
11086 As with @code{whatis}, using @code{ptype} without an argument refers to
11087 the type of @code{$}, the last value in the value history.
11088
11089 @cindex incomplete type
11090 Sometimes, programs use opaque data types or incomplete specifications
11091 of complex data structure. If the debug information included in the
11092 program does not allow @value{GDBN} to display a full declaration of
11093 the data type, it will say @samp{<incomplete type>}. For example,
11094 given these declarations:
11095
11096 @smallexample
11097 struct foo;
11098 struct foo *fooptr;
11099 @end smallexample
11100
11101 @noindent
11102 but no definition for @code{struct foo} itself, @value{GDBN} will say:
11103
11104 @smallexample
11105 (@value{GDBP}) ptype foo
11106 $1 = <incomplete type>
11107 @end smallexample
11108
11109 @noindent
11110 ``Incomplete type'' is C terminology for data types that are not
11111 completely specified.
11112
11113 @kindex info types
11114 @item info types @var{regexp}
11115 @itemx info types
11116 Print a brief description of all types whose names match the regular
11117 expression @var{regexp} (or all types in your program, if you supply
11118 no argument). Each complete typename is matched as though it were a
11119 complete line; thus, @samp{i type value} gives information on all
11120 types in your program whose names include the string @code{value}, but
11121 @samp{i type ^value$} gives information only on types whose complete
11122 name is @code{value}.
11123
11124 This command differs from @code{ptype} in two ways: first, like
11125 @code{whatis}, it does not print a detailed description; second, it
11126 lists all source files where a type is defined.
11127
11128 @kindex info scope
11129 @cindex local variables
11130 @item info scope @var{location}
11131 List all the variables local to a particular scope. This command
11132 accepts a @var{location} argument---a function name, a source line, or
11133 an address preceded by a @samp{*}, and prints all the variables local
11134 to the scope defined by that location. (@xref{Specify Location}, for
11135 details about supported forms of @var{location}.) For example:
11136
11137 @smallexample
11138 (@value{GDBP}) @b{info scope command_line_handler}
11139 Scope for command_line_handler:
11140 Symbol rl is an argument at stack/frame offset 8, length 4.
11141 Symbol linebuffer is in static storage at address 0x150a18, length 4.
11142 Symbol linelength is in static storage at address 0x150a1c, length 4.
11143 Symbol p is a local variable in register $esi, length 4.
11144 Symbol p1 is a local variable in register $ebx, length 4.
11145 Symbol nline is a local variable in register $edx, length 4.
11146 Symbol repeat is a local variable at frame offset -8, length 4.
11147 @end smallexample
11148
11149 @noindent
11150 This command is especially useful for determining what data to collect
11151 during a @dfn{trace experiment}, see @ref{Tracepoint Actions,
11152 collect}.
11153
11154 @kindex info source
11155 @item info source
11156 Show information about the current source file---that is, the source file for
11157 the function containing the current point of execution:
11158 @itemize @bullet
11159 @item
11160 the name of the source file, and the directory containing it,
11161 @item
11162 the directory it was compiled in,
11163 @item
11164 its length, in lines,
11165 @item
11166 which programming language it is written in,
11167 @item
11168 whether the executable includes debugging information for that file, and
11169 if so, what format the information is in (e.g., STABS, Dwarf 2, etc.), and
11170 @item
11171 whether the debugging information includes information about
11172 preprocessor macros.
11173 @end itemize
11174
11175
11176 @kindex info sources
11177 @item info sources
11178 Print the names of all source files in your program for which there is
11179 debugging information, organized into two lists: files whose symbols
11180 have already been read, and files whose symbols will be read when needed.
11181
11182 @kindex info functions
11183 @item info functions
11184 Print the names and data types of all defined functions.
11185
11186 @item info functions @var{regexp}
11187 Print the names and data types of all defined functions
11188 whose names contain a match for regular expression @var{regexp}.
11189 Thus, @samp{info fun step} finds all functions whose names
11190 include @code{step}; @samp{info fun ^step} finds those whose names
11191 start with @code{step}. If a function name contains characters
11192 that conflict with the regular expression language (e.g.@:
11193 @samp{operator*()}), they may be quoted with a backslash.
11194
11195 @kindex info variables
11196 @item info variables
11197 Print the names and data types of all variables that are declared
11198 outside of functions (i.e.@: excluding local variables).
11199
11200 @item info variables @var{regexp}
11201 Print the names and data types of all variables (except for local
11202 variables) whose names contain a match for regular expression
11203 @var{regexp}.
11204
11205 @kindex info classes
11206 @cindex Objective-C, classes and selectors
11207 @item info classes
11208 @itemx info classes @var{regexp}
11209 Display all Objective-C classes in your program, or
11210 (with the @var{regexp} argument) all those matching a particular regular
11211 expression.
11212
11213 @kindex info selectors
11214 @item info selectors
11215 @itemx info selectors @var{regexp}
11216 Display all Objective-C selectors in your program, or
11217 (with the @var{regexp} argument) all those matching a particular regular
11218 expression.
11219
11220 @ignore
11221 This was never implemented.
11222 @kindex info methods
11223 @item info methods
11224 @itemx info methods @var{regexp}
11225 The @code{info methods} command permits the user to examine all defined
11226 methods within C@t{++} program, or (with the @var{regexp} argument) a
11227 specific set of methods found in the various C@t{++} classes. Many
11228 C@t{++} classes provide a large number of methods. Thus, the output
11229 from the @code{ptype} command can be overwhelming and hard to use. The
11230 @code{info-methods} command filters the methods, printing only those
11231 which match the regular-expression @var{regexp}.
11232 @end ignore
11233
11234 @cindex reloading symbols
11235 Some systems allow individual object files that make up your program to
11236 be replaced without stopping and restarting your program. For example,
11237 in VxWorks you can simply recompile a defective object file and keep on
11238 running. If you are running on one of these systems, you can allow
11239 @value{GDBN} to reload the symbols for automatically relinked modules:
11240
11241 @table @code
11242 @kindex set symbol-reloading
11243 @item set symbol-reloading on
11244 Replace symbol definitions for the corresponding source file when an
11245 object file with a particular name is seen again.
11246
11247 @item set symbol-reloading off
11248 Do not replace symbol definitions when encountering object files of the
11249 same name more than once. This is the default state; if you are not
11250 running on a system that permits automatic relinking of modules, you
11251 should leave @code{symbol-reloading} off, since otherwise @value{GDBN}
11252 may discard symbols when linking large programs, that may contain
11253 several modules (from different directories or libraries) with the same
11254 name.
11255
11256 @kindex show symbol-reloading
11257 @item show symbol-reloading
11258 Show the current @code{on} or @code{off} setting.
11259 @end table
11260
11261 @cindex opaque data types
11262 @kindex set opaque-type-resolution
11263 @item set opaque-type-resolution on
11264 Tell @value{GDBN} to resolve opaque types. An opaque type is a type
11265 declared as a pointer to a @code{struct}, @code{class}, or
11266 @code{union}---for example, @code{struct MyType *}---that is used in one
11267 source file although the full declaration of @code{struct MyType} is in
11268 another source file. The default is on.
11269
11270 A change in the setting of this subcommand will not take effect until
11271 the next time symbols for a file are loaded.
11272
11273 @item set opaque-type-resolution off
11274 Tell @value{GDBN} not to resolve opaque types. In this case, the type
11275 is printed as follows:
11276 @smallexample
11277 @{<no data fields>@}
11278 @end smallexample
11279
11280 @kindex show opaque-type-resolution
11281 @item show opaque-type-resolution
11282 Show whether opaque types are resolved or not.
11283
11284 @kindex maint print symbols
11285 @cindex symbol dump
11286 @kindex maint print psymbols
11287 @cindex partial symbol dump
11288 @item maint print symbols @var{filename}
11289 @itemx maint print psymbols @var{filename}
11290 @itemx maint print msymbols @var{filename}
11291 Write a dump of debugging symbol data into the file @var{filename}.
11292 These commands are used to debug the @value{GDBN} symbol-reading code. Only
11293 symbols with debugging data are included. If you use @samp{maint print
11294 symbols}, @value{GDBN} includes all the symbols for which it has already
11295 collected full details: that is, @var{filename} reflects symbols for
11296 only those files whose symbols @value{GDBN} has read. You can use the
11297 command @code{info sources} to find out which files these are. If you
11298 use @samp{maint print psymbols} instead, the dump shows information about
11299 symbols that @value{GDBN} only knows partially---that is, symbols defined in
11300 files that @value{GDBN} has skimmed, but not yet read completely. Finally,
11301 @samp{maint print msymbols} dumps just the minimal symbol information
11302 required for each object file from which @value{GDBN} has read some symbols.
11303 @xref{Files, ,Commands to Specify Files}, for a discussion of how
11304 @value{GDBN} reads symbols (in the description of @code{symbol-file}).
11305
11306 @kindex maint info symtabs
11307 @kindex maint info psymtabs
11308 @cindex listing @value{GDBN}'s internal symbol tables
11309 @cindex symbol tables, listing @value{GDBN}'s internal
11310 @cindex full symbol tables, listing @value{GDBN}'s internal
11311 @cindex partial symbol tables, listing @value{GDBN}'s internal
11312 @item maint info symtabs @r{[} @var{regexp} @r{]}
11313 @itemx maint info psymtabs @r{[} @var{regexp} @r{]}
11314
11315 List the @code{struct symtab} or @code{struct partial_symtab}
11316 structures whose names match @var{regexp}. If @var{regexp} is not
11317 given, list them all. The output includes expressions which you can
11318 copy into a @value{GDBN} debugging this one to examine a particular
11319 structure in more detail. For example:
11320
11321 @smallexample
11322 (@value{GDBP}) maint info psymtabs dwarf2read
11323 @{ objfile /home/gnu/build/gdb/gdb
11324 ((struct objfile *) 0x82e69d0)
11325 @{ psymtab /home/gnu/src/gdb/dwarf2read.c
11326 ((struct partial_symtab *) 0x8474b10)
11327 readin no
11328 fullname (null)
11329 text addresses 0x814d3c8 -- 0x8158074
11330 globals (* (struct partial_symbol **) 0x8507a08 @@ 9)
11331 statics (* (struct partial_symbol **) 0x40e95b78 @@ 2882)
11332 dependencies (none)
11333 @}
11334 @}
11335 (@value{GDBP}) maint info symtabs
11336 (@value{GDBP})
11337 @end smallexample
11338 @noindent
11339 We see that there is one partial symbol table whose filename contains
11340 the string @samp{dwarf2read}, belonging to the @samp{gdb} executable;
11341 and we see that @value{GDBN} has not read in any symtabs yet at all.
11342 If we set a breakpoint on a function, that will cause @value{GDBN} to
11343 read the symtab for the compilation unit containing that function:
11344
11345 @smallexample
11346 (@value{GDBP}) break dwarf2_psymtab_to_symtab
11347 Breakpoint 1 at 0x814e5da: file /home/gnu/src/gdb/dwarf2read.c,
11348 line 1574.
11349 (@value{GDBP}) maint info symtabs
11350 @{ objfile /home/gnu/build/gdb/gdb
11351 ((struct objfile *) 0x82e69d0)
11352 @{ symtab /home/gnu/src/gdb/dwarf2read.c
11353 ((struct symtab *) 0x86c1f38)
11354 dirname (null)
11355 fullname (null)
11356 blockvector ((struct blockvector *) 0x86c1bd0) (primary)
11357 linetable ((struct linetable *) 0x8370fa0)
11358 debugformat DWARF 2
11359 @}
11360 @}
11361 (@value{GDBP})
11362 @end smallexample
11363 @end table
11364
11365
11366 @node Altering
11367 @chapter Altering Execution
11368
11369 Once you think you have found an error in your program, you might want to
11370 find out for certain whether correcting the apparent error would lead to
11371 correct results in the rest of the run. You can find the answer by
11372 experiment, using the @value{GDBN} features for altering execution of the
11373 program.
11374
11375 For example, you can store new values into variables or memory
11376 locations, give your program a signal, restart it at a different
11377 address, or even return prematurely from a function.
11378
11379 @menu
11380 * Assignment:: Assignment to variables
11381 * Jumping:: Continuing at a different address
11382 * Signaling:: Giving your program a signal
11383 * Returning:: Returning from a function
11384 * Calling:: Calling your program's functions
11385 * Patching:: Patching your program
11386 @end menu
11387
11388 @node Assignment
11389 @section Assignment to Variables
11390
11391 @cindex assignment
11392 @cindex setting variables
11393 To alter the value of a variable, evaluate an assignment expression.
11394 @xref{Expressions, ,Expressions}. For example,
11395
11396 @smallexample
11397 print x=4
11398 @end smallexample
11399
11400 @noindent
11401 stores the value 4 into the variable @code{x}, and then prints the
11402 value of the assignment expression (which is 4).
11403 @xref{Languages, ,Using @value{GDBN} with Different Languages}, for more
11404 information on operators in supported languages.
11405
11406 @kindex set variable
11407 @cindex variables, setting
11408 If you are not interested in seeing the value of the assignment, use the
11409 @code{set} command instead of the @code{print} command. @code{set} is
11410 really the same as @code{print} except that the expression's value is
11411 not printed and is not put in the value history (@pxref{Value History,
11412 ,Value History}). The expression is evaluated only for its effects.
11413
11414 If the beginning of the argument string of the @code{set} command
11415 appears identical to a @code{set} subcommand, use the @code{set
11416 variable} command instead of just @code{set}. This command is identical
11417 to @code{set} except for its lack of subcommands. For example, if your
11418 program has a variable @code{width}, you get an error if you try to set
11419 a new value with just @samp{set width=13}, because @value{GDBN} has the
11420 command @code{set width}:
11421
11422 @smallexample
11423 (@value{GDBP}) whatis width
11424 type = double
11425 (@value{GDBP}) p width
11426 $4 = 13
11427 (@value{GDBP}) set width=47
11428 Invalid syntax in expression.
11429 @end smallexample
11430
11431 @noindent
11432 The invalid expression, of course, is @samp{=47}. In
11433 order to actually set the program's variable @code{width}, use
11434
11435 @smallexample
11436 (@value{GDBP}) set var width=47
11437 @end smallexample
11438
11439 Because the @code{set} command has many subcommands that can conflict
11440 with the names of program variables, it is a good idea to use the
11441 @code{set variable} command instead of just @code{set}. For example, if
11442 your program has a variable @code{g}, you run into problems if you try
11443 to set a new value with just @samp{set g=4}, because @value{GDBN} has
11444 the command @code{set gnutarget}, abbreviated @code{set g}:
11445
11446 @smallexample
11447 @group
11448 (@value{GDBP}) whatis g
11449 type = double
11450 (@value{GDBP}) p g
11451 $1 = 1
11452 (@value{GDBP}) set g=4
11453 (@value{GDBP}) p g
11454 $2 = 1
11455 (@value{GDBP}) r
11456 The program being debugged has been started already.
11457 Start it from the beginning? (y or n) y
11458 Starting program: /home/smith/cc_progs/a.out
11459 "/home/smith/cc_progs/a.out": can't open to read symbols:
11460 Invalid bfd target.
11461 (@value{GDBP}) show g
11462 The current BFD target is "=4".
11463 @end group
11464 @end smallexample
11465
11466 @noindent
11467 The program variable @code{g} did not change, and you silently set the
11468 @code{gnutarget} to an invalid value. In order to set the variable
11469 @code{g}, use
11470
11471 @smallexample
11472 (@value{GDBP}) set var g=4
11473 @end smallexample
11474
11475 @value{GDBN} allows more implicit conversions in assignments than C; you can
11476 freely store an integer value into a pointer variable or vice versa,
11477 and you can convert any structure to any other structure that is the
11478 same length or shorter.
11479 @comment FIXME: how do structs align/pad in these conversions?
11480 @comment /doc@cygnus.com 18dec1990
11481
11482 To store values into arbitrary places in memory, use the @samp{@{@dots{}@}}
11483 construct to generate a value of specified type at a specified address
11484 (@pxref{Expressions, ,Expressions}). For example, @code{@{int@}0x83040} refers
11485 to memory location @code{0x83040} as an integer (which implies a certain size
11486 and representation in memory), and
11487
11488 @smallexample
11489 set @{int@}0x83040 = 4
11490 @end smallexample
11491
11492 @noindent
11493 stores the value 4 into that memory location.
11494
11495 @node Jumping
11496 @section Continuing at a Different Address
11497
11498 Ordinarily, when you continue your program, you do so at the place where
11499 it stopped, with the @code{continue} command. You can instead continue at
11500 an address of your own choosing, with the following commands:
11501
11502 @table @code
11503 @kindex jump
11504 @item jump @var{linespec}
11505 @itemx jump @var{location}
11506 Resume execution at line @var{linespec} or at address given by
11507 @var{location}. Execution stops again immediately if there is a
11508 breakpoint there. @xref{Specify Location}, for a description of the
11509 different forms of @var{linespec} and @var{location}. It is common
11510 practice to use the @code{tbreak} command in conjunction with
11511 @code{jump}. @xref{Set Breaks, ,Setting Breakpoints}.
11512
11513 The @code{jump} command does not change the current stack frame, or
11514 the stack pointer, or the contents of any memory location or any
11515 register other than the program counter. If line @var{linespec} is in
11516 a different function from the one currently executing, the results may
11517 be bizarre if the two functions expect different patterns of arguments or
11518 of local variables. For this reason, the @code{jump} command requests
11519 confirmation if the specified line is not in the function currently
11520 executing. However, even bizarre results are predictable if you are
11521 well acquainted with the machine-language code of your program.
11522 @end table
11523
11524 @c Doesn't work on HP-UX; have to set $pcoqh and $pcoqt.
11525 On many systems, you can get much the same effect as the @code{jump}
11526 command by storing a new value into the register @code{$pc}. The
11527 difference is that this does not start your program running; it only
11528 changes the address of where it @emph{will} run when you continue. For
11529 example,
11530
11531 @smallexample
11532 set $pc = 0x485
11533 @end smallexample
11534
11535 @noindent
11536 makes the next @code{continue} command or stepping command execute at
11537 address @code{0x485}, rather than at the address where your program stopped.
11538 @xref{Continuing and Stepping, ,Continuing and Stepping}.
11539
11540 The most common occasion to use the @code{jump} command is to back
11541 up---perhaps with more breakpoints set---over a portion of a program
11542 that has already executed, in order to examine its execution in more
11543 detail.
11544
11545 @c @group
11546 @node Signaling
11547 @section Giving your Program a Signal
11548 @cindex deliver a signal to a program
11549
11550 @table @code
11551 @kindex signal
11552 @item signal @var{signal}
11553 Resume execution where your program stopped, but immediately give it the
11554 signal @var{signal}. @var{signal} can be the name or the number of a
11555 signal. For example, on many systems @code{signal 2} and @code{signal
11556 SIGINT} are both ways of sending an interrupt signal.
11557
11558 Alternatively, if @var{signal} is zero, continue execution without
11559 giving a signal. This is useful when your program stopped on account of
11560 a signal and would ordinary see the signal when resumed with the
11561 @code{continue} command; @samp{signal 0} causes it to resume without a
11562 signal.
11563
11564 @code{signal} does not repeat when you press @key{RET} a second time
11565 after executing the command.
11566 @end table
11567 @c @end group
11568
11569 Invoking the @code{signal} command is not the same as invoking the
11570 @code{kill} utility from the shell. Sending a signal with @code{kill}
11571 causes @value{GDBN} to decide what to do with the signal depending on
11572 the signal handling tables (@pxref{Signals}). The @code{signal} command
11573 passes the signal directly to your program.
11574
11575
11576 @node Returning
11577 @section Returning from a Function
11578
11579 @table @code
11580 @cindex returning from a function
11581 @kindex return
11582 @item return
11583 @itemx return @var{expression}
11584 You can cancel execution of a function call with the @code{return}
11585 command. If you give an
11586 @var{expression} argument, its value is used as the function's return
11587 value.
11588 @end table
11589
11590 When you use @code{return}, @value{GDBN} discards the selected stack frame
11591 (and all frames within it). You can think of this as making the
11592 discarded frame return prematurely. If you wish to specify a value to
11593 be returned, give that value as the argument to @code{return}.
11594
11595 This pops the selected stack frame (@pxref{Selection, ,Selecting a
11596 Frame}), and any other frames inside of it, leaving its caller as the
11597 innermost remaining frame. That frame becomes selected. The
11598 specified value is stored in the registers used for returning values
11599 of functions.
11600
11601 The @code{return} command does not resume execution; it leaves the
11602 program stopped in the state that would exist if the function had just
11603 returned. In contrast, the @code{finish} command (@pxref{Continuing
11604 and Stepping, ,Continuing and Stepping}) resumes execution until the
11605 selected stack frame returns naturally.
11606
11607 @node Calling
11608 @section Calling Program Functions
11609
11610 @table @code
11611 @cindex calling functions
11612 @cindex inferior functions, calling
11613 @item print @var{expr}
11614 Evaluate the expression @var{expr} and display the resulting value.
11615 @var{expr} may include calls to functions in the program being
11616 debugged.
11617
11618 @kindex call
11619 @item call @var{expr}
11620 Evaluate the expression @var{expr} without displaying @code{void}
11621 returned values.
11622
11623 You can use this variant of the @code{print} command if you want to
11624 execute a function from your program that does not return anything
11625 (a.k.a.@: @dfn{a void function}), but without cluttering the output
11626 with @code{void} returned values that @value{GDBN} will otherwise
11627 print. If the result is not void, it is printed and saved in the
11628 value history.
11629 @end table
11630
11631 It is possible for the function you call via the @code{print} or
11632 @code{call} command to generate a signal (e.g., if there's a bug in
11633 the function, or if you passed it incorrect arguments). What happens
11634 in that case is controlled by the @code{set unwindonsignal} command.
11635
11636 @table @code
11637 @item set unwindonsignal
11638 @kindex set unwindonsignal
11639 @cindex unwind stack in called functions
11640 @cindex call dummy stack unwinding
11641 Set unwinding of the stack if a signal is received while in a function
11642 that @value{GDBN} called in the program being debugged. If set to on,
11643 @value{GDBN} unwinds the stack it created for the call and restores
11644 the context to what it was before the call. If set to off (the
11645 default), @value{GDBN} stops in the frame where the signal was
11646 received.
11647
11648 @item show unwindonsignal
11649 @kindex show unwindonsignal
11650 Show the current setting of stack unwinding in the functions called by
11651 @value{GDBN}.
11652 @end table
11653
11654 @cindex weak alias functions
11655 Sometimes, a function you wish to call is actually a @dfn{weak alias}
11656 for another function. In such case, @value{GDBN} might not pick up
11657 the type information, including the types of the function arguments,
11658 which causes @value{GDBN} to call the inferior function incorrectly.
11659 As a result, the called function will function erroneously and may
11660 even crash. A solution to that is to use the name of the aliased
11661 function instead.
11662
11663 @node Patching
11664 @section Patching Programs
11665
11666 @cindex patching binaries
11667 @cindex writing into executables
11668 @cindex writing into corefiles
11669
11670 By default, @value{GDBN} opens the file containing your program's
11671 executable code (or the corefile) read-only. This prevents accidental
11672 alterations to machine code; but it also prevents you from intentionally
11673 patching your program's binary.
11674
11675 If you'd like to be able to patch the binary, you can specify that
11676 explicitly with the @code{set write} command. For example, you might
11677 want to turn on internal debugging flags, or even to make emergency
11678 repairs.
11679
11680 @table @code
11681 @kindex set write
11682 @item set write on
11683 @itemx set write off
11684 If you specify @samp{set write on}, @value{GDBN} opens executable and
11685 core files for both reading and writing; if you specify @samp{set write
11686 off} (the default), @value{GDBN} opens them read-only.
11687
11688 If you have already loaded a file, you must load it again (using the
11689 @code{exec-file} or @code{core-file} command) after changing @code{set
11690 write}, for your new setting to take effect.
11691
11692 @item show write
11693 @kindex show write
11694 Display whether executable files and core files are opened for writing
11695 as well as reading.
11696 @end table
11697
11698 @node GDB Files
11699 @chapter @value{GDBN} Files
11700
11701 @value{GDBN} needs to know the file name of the program to be debugged,
11702 both in order to read its symbol table and in order to start your
11703 program. To debug a core dump of a previous run, you must also tell
11704 @value{GDBN} the name of the core dump file.
11705
11706 @menu
11707 * Files:: Commands to specify files
11708 * Separate Debug Files:: Debugging information in separate files
11709 * Symbol Errors:: Errors reading symbol files
11710 @end menu
11711
11712 @node Files
11713 @section Commands to Specify Files
11714
11715 @cindex symbol table
11716 @cindex core dump file
11717
11718 You may want to specify executable and core dump file names. The usual
11719 way to do this is at start-up time, using the arguments to
11720 @value{GDBN}'s start-up commands (@pxref{Invocation, , Getting In and
11721 Out of @value{GDBN}}).
11722
11723 Occasionally it is necessary to change to a different file during a
11724 @value{GDBN} session. Or you may run @value{GDBN} and forget to
11725 specify a file you want to use. Or you are debugging a remote target
11726 via @code{gdbserver} (@pxref{Server, file, Using the @code{gdbserver}
11727 Program}). In these situations the @value{GDBN} commands to specify
11728 new files are useful.
11729
11730 @table @code
11731 @cindex executable file
11732 @kindex file
11733 @item file @var{filename}
11734 Use @var{filename} as the program to be debugged. It is read for its
11735 symbols and for the contents of pure memory. It is also the program
11736 executed when you use the @code{run} command. If you do not specify a
11737 directory and the file is not found in the @value{GDBN} working directory,
11738 @value{GDBN} uses the environment variable @code{PATH} as a list of
11739 directories to search, just as the shell does when looking for a program
11740 to run. You can change the value of this variable, for both @value{GDBN}
11741 and your program, using the @code{path} command.
11742
11743 @cindex unlinked object files
11744 @cindex patching object files
11745 You can load unlinked object @file{.o} files into @value{GDBN} using
11746 the @code{file} command. You will not be able to ``run'' an object
11747 file, but you can disassemble functions and inspect variables. Also,
11748 if the underlying BFD functionality supports it, you could use
11749 @kbd{gdb -write} to patch object files using this technique. Note
11750 that @value{GDBN} can neither interpret nor modify relocations in this
11751 case, so branches and some initialized variables will appear to go to
11752 the wrong place. But this feature is still handy from time to time.
11753
11754 @item file
11755 @code{file} with no argument makes @value{GDBN} discard any information it
11756 has on both executable file and the symbol table.
11757
11758 @kindex exec-file
11759 @item exec-file @r{[} @var{filename} @r{]}
11760 Specify that the program to be run (but not the symbol table) is found
11761 in @var{filename}. @value{GDBN} searches the environment variable @code{PATH}
11762 if necessary to locate your program. Omitting @var{filename} means to
11763 discard information on the executable file.
11764
11765 @kindex symbol-file
11766 @item symbol-file @r{[} @var{filename} @r{]}
11767 Read symbol table information from file @var{filename}. @code{PATH} is
11768 searched when necessary. Use the @code{file} command to get both symbol
11769 table and program to run from the same file.
11770
11771 @code{symbol-file} with no argument clears out @value{GDBN} information on your
11772 program's symbol table.
11773
11774 The @code{symbol-file} command causes @value{GDBN} to forget the contents of
11775 some breakpoints and auto-display expressions. This is because they may
11776 contain pointers to the internal data recording symbols and data types,
11777 which are part of the old symbol table data being discarded inside
11778 @value{GDBN}.
11779
11780 @code{symbol-file} does not repeat if you press @key{RET} again after
11781 executing it once.
11782
11783 When @value{GDBN} is configured for a particular environment, it
11784 understands debugging information in whatever format is the standard
11785 generated for that environment; you may use either a @sc{gnu} compiler, or
11786 other compilers that adhere to the local conventions.
11787 Best results are usually obtained from @sc{gnu} compilers; for example,
11788 using @code{@value{NGCC}} you can generate debugging information for
11789 optimized code.
11790
11791 For most kinds of object files, with the exception of old SVR3 systems
11792 using COFF, the @code{symbol-file} command does not normally read the
11793 symbol table in full right away. Instead, it scans the symbol table
11794 quickly to find which source files and which symbols are present. The
11795 details are read later, one source file at a time, as they are needed.
11796
11797 The purpose of this two-stage reading strategy is to make @value{GDBN}
11798 start up faster. For the most part, it is invisible except for
11799 occasional pauses while the symbol table details for a particular source
11800 file are being read. (The @code{set verbose} command can turn these
11801 pauses into messages if desired. @xref{Messages/Warnings, ,Optional
11802 Warnings and Messages}.)
11803
11804 We have not implemented the two-stage strategy for COFF yet. When the
11805 symbol table is stored in COFF format, @code{symbol-file} reads the
11806 symbol table data in full right away. Note that ``stabs-in-COFF''
11807 still does the two-stage strategy, since the debug info is actually
11808 in stabs format.
11809
11810 @kindex readnow
11811 @cindex reading symbols immediately
11812 @cindex symbols, reading immediately
11813 @item symbol-file @var{filename} @r{[} -readnow @r{]}
11814 @itemx file @var{filename} @r{[} -readnow @r{]}
11815 You can override the @value{GDBN} two-stage strategy for reading symbol
11816 tables by using the @samp{-readnow} option with any of the commands that
11817 load symbol table information, if you want to be sure @value{GDBN} has the
11818 entire symbol table available.
11819
11820 @c FIXME: for now no mention of directories, since this seems to be in
11821 @c flux. 13mar1992 status is that in theory GDB would look either in
11822 @c current dir or in same dir as myprog; but issues like competing
11823 @c GDB's, or clutter in system dirs, mean that in practice right now
11824 @c only current dir is used. FFish says maybe a special GDB hierarchy
11825 @c (eg rooted in val of env var GDBSYMS) could exist for mappable symbol
11826 @c files.
11827
11828 @kindex core-file
11829 @item core-file @r{[}@var{filename}@r{]}
11830 @itemx core
11831 Specify the whereabouts of a core dump file to be used as the ``contents
11832 of memory''. Traditionally, core files contain only some parts of the
11833 address space of the process that generated them; @value{GDBN} can access the
11834 executable file itself for other parts.
11835
11836 @code{core-file} with no argument specifies that no core file is
11837 to be used.
11838
11839 Note that the core file is ignored when your program is actually running
11840 under @value{GDBN}. So, if you have been running your program and you
11841 wish to debug a core file instead, you must kill the subprocess in which
11842 the program is running. To do this, use the @code{kill} command
11843 (@pxref{Kill Process, ,Killing the Child Process}).
11844
11845 @kindex add-symbol-file
11846 @cindex dynamic linking
11847 @item add-symbol-file @var{filename} @var{address}
11848 @itemx add-symbol-file @var{filename} @var{address} @r{[} -readnow @r{]}
11849 @itemx add-symbol-file @var{filename} @r{-s}@var{section} @var{address} @dots{}
11850 The @code{add-symbol-file} command reads additional symbol table
11851 information from the file @var{filename}. You would use this command
11852 when @var{filename} has been dynamically loaded (by some other means)
11853 into the program that is running. @var{address} should be the memory
11854 address at which the file has been loaded; @value{GDBN} cannot figure
11855 this out for itself. You can additionally specify an arbitrary number
11856 of @samp{@r{-s}@var{section} @var{address}} pairs, to give an explicit
11857 section name and base address for that section. You can specify any
11858 @var{address} as an expression.
11859
11860 The symbol table of the file @var{filename} is added to the symbol table
11861 originally read with the @code{symbol-file} command. You can use the
11862 @code{add-symbol-file} command any number of times; the new symbol data
11863 thus read keeps adding to the old. To discard all old symbol data
11864 instead, use the @code{symbol-file} command without any arguments.
11865
11866 @cindex relocatable object files, reading symbols from
11867 @cindex object files, relocatable, reading symbols from
11868 @cindex reading symbols from relocatable object files
11869 @cindex symbols, reading from relocatable object files
11870 @cindex @file{.o} files, reading symbols from
11871 Although @var{filename} is typically a shared library file, an
11872 executable file, or some other object file which has been fully
11873 relocated for loading into a process, you can also load symbolic
11874 information from relocatable @file{.o} files, as long as:
11875
11876 @itemize @bullet
11877 @item
11878 the file's symbolic information refers only to linker symbols defined in
11879 that file, not to symbols defined by other object files,
11880 @item
11881 every section the file's symbolic information refers to has actually
11882 been loaded into the inferior, as it appears in the file, and
11883 @item
11884 you can determine the address at which every section was loaded, and
11885 provide these to the @code{add-symbol-file} command.
11886 @end itemize
11887
11888 @noindent
11889 Some embedded operating systems, like Sun Chorus and VxWorks, can load
11890 relocatable files into an already running program; such systems
11891 typically make the requirements above easy to meet. However, it's
11892 important to recognize that many native systems use complex link
11893 procedures (@code{.linkonce} section factoring and C@t{++} constructor table
11894 assembly, for example) that make the requirements difficult to meet. In
11895 general, one cannot assume that using @code{add-symbol-file} to read a
11896 relocatable object file's symbolic information will have the same effect
11897 as linking the relocatable object file into the program in the normal
11898 way.
11899
11900 @code{add-symbol-file} does not repeat if you press @key{RET} after using it.
11901
11902 @kindex add-symbol-file-from-memory
11903 @cindex @code{syscall DSO}
11904 @cindex load symbols from memory
11905 @item add-symbol-file-from-memory @var{address}
11906 Load symbols from the given @var{address} in a dynamically loaded
11907 object file whose image is mapped directly into the inferior's memory.
11908 For example, the Linux kernel maps a @code{syscall DSO} into each
11909 process's address space; this DSO provides kernel-specific code for
11910 some system calls. The argument can be any expression whose
11911 evaluation yields the address of the file's shared object file header.
11912 For this command to work, you must have used @code{symbol-file} or
11913 @code{exec-file} commands in advance.
11914
11915 @kindex add-shared-symbol-files
11916 @kindex assf
11917 @item add-shared-symbol-files @var{library-file}
11918 @itemx assf @var{library-file}
11919 The @code{add-shared-symbol-files} command can currently be used only
11920 in the Cygwin build of @value{GDBN} on MS-Windows OS, where it is an
11921 alias for the @code{dll-symbols} command (@pxref{Cygwin Native}).
11922 @value{GDBN} automatically looks for shared libraries, however if
11923 @value{GDBN} does not find yours, you can invoke
11924 @code{add-shared-symbol-files}. It takes one argument: the shared
11925 library's file name. @code{assf} is a shorthand alias for
11926 @code{add-shared-symbol-files}.
11927
11928 @kindex section
11929 @item section @var{section} @var{addr}
11930 The @code{section} command changes the base address of the named
11931 @var{section} of the exec file to @var{addr}. This can be used if the
11932 exec file does not contain section addresses, (such as in the
11933 @code{a.out} format), or when the addresses specified in the file
11934 itself are wrong. Each section must be changed separately. The
11935 @code{info files} command, described below, lists all the sections and
11936 their addresses.
11937
11938 @kindex info files
11939 @kindex info target
11940 @item info files
11941 @itemx info target
11942 @code{info files} and @code{info target} are synonymous; both print the
11943 current target (@pxref{Targets, ,Specifying a Debugging Target}),
11944 including the names of the executable and core dump files currently in
11945 use by @value{GDBN}, and the files from which symbols were loaded. The
11946 command @code{help target} lists all possible targets rather than
11947 current ones.
11948
11949 @kindex maint info sections
11950 @item maint info sections
11951 Another command that can give you extra information about program sections
11952 is @code{maint info sections}. In addition to the section information
11953 displayed by @code{info files}, this command displays the flags and file
11954 offset of each section in the executable and core dump files. In addition,
11955 @code{maint info sections} provides the following command options (which
11956 may be arbitrarily combined):
11957
11958 @table @code
11959 @item ALLOBJ
11960 Display sections for all loaded object files, including shared libraries.
11961 @item @var{sections}
11962 Display info only for named @var{sections}.
11963 @item @var{section-flags}
11964 Display info only for sections for which @var{section-flags} are true.
11965 The section flags that @value{GDBN} currently knows about are:
11966 @table @code
11967 @item ALLOC
11968 Section will have space allocated in the process when loaded.
11969 Set for all sections except those containing debug information.
11970 @item LOAD
11971 Section will be loaded from the file into the child process memory.
11972 Set for pre-initialized code and data, clear for @code{.bss} sections.
11973 @item RELOC
11974 Section needs to be relocated before loading.
11975 @item READONLY
11976 Section cannot be modified by the child process.
11977 @item CODE
11978 Section contains executable code only.
11979 @item DATA
11980 Section contains data only (no executable code).
11981 @item ROM
11982 Section will reside in ROM.
11983 @item CONSTRUCTOR
11984 Section contains data for constructor/destructor lists.
11985 @item HAS_CONTENTS
11986 Section is not empty.
11987 @item NEVER_LOAD
11988 An instruction to the linker to not output the section.
11989 @item COFF_SHARED_LIBRARY
11990 A notification to the linker that the section contains
11991 COFF shared library information.
11992 @item IS_COMMON
11993 Section contains common symbols.
11994 @end table
11995 @end table
11996 @kindex set trust-readonly-sections
11997 @cindex read-only sections
11998 @item set trust-readonly-sections on
11999 Tell @value{GDBN} that readonly sections in your object file
12000 really are read-only (i.e.@: that their contents will not change).
12001 In that case, @value{GDBN} can fetch values from these sections
12002 out of the object file, rather than from the target program.
12003 For some targets (notably embedded ones), this can be a significant
12004 enhancement to debugging performance.
12005
12006 The default is off.
12007
12008 @item set trust-readonly-sections off
12009 Tell @value{GDBN} not to trust readonly sections. This means that
12010 the contents of the section might change while the program is running,
12011 and must therefore be fetched from the target when needed.
12012
12013 @item show trust-readonly-sections
12014 Show the current setting of trusting readonly sections.
12015 @end table
12016
12017 All file-specifying commands allow both absolute and relative file names
12018 as arguments. @value{GDBN} always converts the file name to an absolute file
12019 name and remembers it that way.
12020
12021 @cindex shared libraries
12022 @anchor{Shared Libraries}
12023 @value{GDBN} supports @sc{gnu}/Linux, MS-Windows, HP-UX, SunOS, SVr4, Irix,
12024 and IBM RS/6000 AIX shared libraries.
12025
12026 On MS-Windows @value{GDBN} must be linked with the Expat library to support
12027 shared libraries. @xref{Expat}.
12028
12029 @value{GDBN} automatically loads symbol definitions from shared libraries
12030 when you use the @code{run} command, or when you examine a core file.
12031 (Before you issue the @code{run} command, @value{GDBN} does not understand
12032 references to a function in a shared library, however---unless you are
12033 debugging a core file).
12034
12035 On HP-UX, if the program loads a library explicitly, @value{GDBN}
12036 automatically loads the symbols at the time of the @code{shl_load} call.
12037
12038 @c FIXME: some @value{GDBN} release may permit some refs to undef
12039 @c FIXME...symbols---eg in a break cmd---assuming they are from a shared
12040 @c FIXME...lib; check this from time to time when updating manual
12041
12042 There are times, however, when you may wish to not automatically load
12043 symbol definitions from shared libraries, such as when they are
12044 particularly large or there are many of them.
12045
12046 To control the automatic loading of shared library symbols, use the
12047 commands:
12048
12049 @table @code
12050 @kindex set auto-solib-add
12051 @item set auto-solib-add @var{mode}
12052 If @var{mode} is @code{on}, symbols from all shared object libraries
12053 will be loaded automatically when the inferior begins execution, you
12054 attach to an independently started inferior, or when the dynamic linker
12055 informs @value{GDBN} that a new library has been loaded. If @var{mode}
12056 is @code{off}, symbols must be loaded manually, using the
12057 @code{sharedlibrary} command. The default value is @code{on}.
12058
12059 @cindex memory used for symbol tables
12060 If your program uses lots of shared libraries with debug info that
12061 takes large amounts of memory, you can decrease the @value{GDBN}
12062 memory footprint by preventing it from automatically loading the
12063 symbols from shared libraries. To that end, type @kbd{set
12064 auto-solib-add off} before running the inferior, then load each
12065 library whose debug symbols you do need with @kbd{sharedlibrary
12066 @var{regexp}}, where @var{regexp} is a regular expression that matches
12067 the libraries whose symbols you want to be loaded.
12068
12069 @kindex show auto-solib-add
12070 @item show auto-solib-add
12071 Display the current autoloading mode.
12072 @end table
12073
12074 @cindex load shared library
12075 To explicitly load shared library symbols, use the @code{sharedlibrary}
12076 command:
12077
12078 @table @code
12079 @kindex info sharedlibrary
12080 @kindex info share
12081 @item info share
12082 @itemx info sharedlibrary
12083 Print the names of the shared libraries which are currently loaded.
12084
12085 @kindex sharedlibrary
12086 @kindex share
12087 @item sharedlibrary @var{regex}
12088 @itemx share @var{regex}
12089 Load shared object library symbols for files matching a
12090 Unix regular expression.
12091 As with files loaded automatically, it only loads shared libraries
12092 required by your program for a core file or after typing @code{run}. If
12093 @var{regex} is omitted all shared libraries required by your program are
12094 loaded.
12095
12096 @item nosharedlibrary
12097 @kindex nosharedlibrary
12098 @cindex unload symbols from shared libraries
12099 Unload all shared object library symbols. This discards all symbols
12100 that have been loaded from all shared libraries. Symbols from shared
12101 libraries that were loaded by explicit user requests are not
12102 discarded.
12103 @end table
12104
12105 Sometimes you may wish that @value{GDBN} stops and gives you control
12106 when any of shared library events happen. Use the @code{set
12107 stop-on-solib-events} command for this:
12108
12109 @table @code
12110 @item set stop-on-solib-events
12111 @kindex set stop-on-solib-events
12112 This command controls whether @value{GDBN} should give you control
12113 when the dynamic linker notifies it about some shared library event.
12114 The most common event of interest is loading or unloading of a new
12115 shared library.
12116
12117 @item show stop-on-solib-events
12118 @kindex show stop-on-solib-events
12119 Show whether @value{GDBN} stops and gives you control when shared
12120 library events happen.
12121 @end table
12122
12123 Shared libraries are also supported in many cross or remote debugging
12124 configurations. A copy of the target's libraries need to be present on the
12125 host system; they need to be the same as the target libraries, although the
12126 copies on the target can be stripped as long as the copies on the host are
12127 not.
12128
12129 @cindex where to look for shared libraries
12130 For remote debugging, you need to tell @value{GDBN} where the target
12131 libraries are, so that it can load the correct copies---otherwise, it
12132 may try to load the host's libraries. @value{GDBN} has two variables
12133 to specify the search directories for target libraries.
12134
12135 @table @code
12136 @cindex prefix for shared library file names
12137 @cindex system root, alternate
12138 @kindex set solib-absolute-prefix
12139 @kindex set sysroot
12140 @item set sysroot @var{path}
12141 Use @var{path} as the system root for the program being debugged. Any
12142 absolute shared library paths will be prefixed with @var{path}; many
12143 runtime loaders store the absolute paths to the shared library in the
12144 target program's memory. If you use @code{set sysroot} to find shared
12145 libraries, they need to be laid out in the same way that they are on
12146 the target, with e.g.@: a @file{/lib} and @file{/usr/lib} hierarchy
12147 under @var{path}.
12148
12149 The @code{set solib-absolute-prefix} command is an alias for @code{set
12150 sysroot}.
12151
12152 @cindex default system root
12153 @cindex @samp{--with-sysroot}
12154 You can set the default system root by using the configure-time
12155 @samp{--with-sysroot} option. If the system root is inside
12156 @value{GDBN}'s configured binary prefix (set with @samp{--prefix} or
12157 @samp{--exec-prefix}), then the default system root will be updated
12158 automatically if the installed @value{GDBN} is moved to a new
12159 location.
12160
12161 @kindex show sysroot
12162 @item show sysroot
12163 Display the current shared library prefix.
12164
12165 @kindex set solib-search-path
12166 @item set solib-search-path @var{path}
12167 If this variable is set, @var{path} is a colon-separated list of
12168 directories to search for shared libraries. @samp{solib-search-path}
12169 is used after @samp{sysroot} fails to locate the library, or if the
12170 path to the library is relative instead of absolute. If you want to
12171 use @samp{solib-search-path} instead of @samp{sysroot}, be sure to set
12172 @samp{sysroot} to a nonexistent directory to prevent @value{GDBN} from
12173 finding your host's libraries. @samp{sysroot} is preferred; setting
12174 it to a nonexistent directory may interfere with automatic loading
12175 of shared library symbols.
12176
12177 @kindex show solib-search-path
12178 @item show solib-search-path
12179 Display the current shared library search path.
12180 @end table
12181
12182
12183 @node Separate Debug Files
12184 @section Debugging Information in Separate Files
12185 @cindex separate debugging information files
12186 @cindex debugging information in separate files
12187 @cindex @file{.debug} subdirectories
12188 @cindex debugging information directory, global
12189 @cindex global debugging information directory
12190 @cindex build ID, and separate debugging files
12191 @cindex @file{.build-id} directory
12192
12193 @value{GDBN} allows you to put a program's debugging information in a
12194 file separate from the executable itself, in a way that allows
12195 @value{GDBN} to find and load the debugging information automatically.
12196 Since debugging information can be very large---sometimes larger
12197 than the executable code itself---some systems distribute debugging
12198 information for their executables in separate files, which users can
12199 install only when they need to debug a problem.
12200
12201 @value{GDBN} supports two ways of specifying the separate debug info
12202 file:
12203
12204 @itemize @bullet
12205 @item
12206 The executable contains a @dfn{debug link} that specifies the name of
12207 the separate debug info file. The separate debug file's name is
12208 usually @file{@var{executable}.debug}, where @var{executable} is the
12209 name of the corresponding executable file without leading directories
12210 (e.g., @file{ls.debug} for @file{/usr/bin/ls}). In addition, the
12211 debug link specifies a CRC32 checksum for the debug file, which
12212 @value{GDBN} uses to validate that the executable and the debug file
12213 came from the same build.
12214
12215 @item
12216 The executable contains a @dfn{build ID}, a unique bit string that is
12217 also present in the corresponding debug info file. (This is supported
12218 only on some operating systems, notably those which use the ELF format
12219 for binary files and the @sc{gnu} Binutils.) For more details about
12220 this feature, see the description of the @option{--build-id}
12221 command-line option in @ref{Options, , Command Line Options, ld.info,
12222 The GNU Linker}. The debug info file's name is not specified
12223 explicitly by the build ID, but can be computed from the build ID, see
12224 below.
12225 @end itemize
12226
12227 Depending on the way the debug info file is specified, @value{GDBN}
12228 uses two different methods of looking for the debug file:
12229
12230 @itemize @bullet
12231 @item
12232 For the ``debug link'' method, @value{GDBN} looks up the named file in
12233 the directory of the executable file, then in a subdirectory of that
12234 directory named @file{.debug}, and finally under the global debug
12235 directory, in a subdirectory whose name is identical to the leading
12236 directories of the executable's absolute file name.
12237
12238 @item
12239 For the ``build ID'' method, @value{GDBN} looks in the
12240 @file{.build-id} subdirectory of the global debug directory for a file
12241 named @file{@var{nn}/@var{nnnnnnnn}.debug}, where @var{nn} are the
12242 first 2 hex characters of the build ID bit string, and @var{nnnnnnnn}
12243 are the rest of the bit string. (Real build ID strings are 32 or more
12244 hex characters, not 10.)
12245 @end itemize
12246
12247 So, for example, suppose you ask @value{GDBN} to debug
12248 @file{/usr/bin/ls}, which has a debug link that specifies the
12249 file @file{ls.debug}, and a build ID whose value in hex is
12250 @code{abcdef1234}. If the global debug directory is
12251 @file{/usr/lib/debug}, then @value{GDBN} will look for the following
12252 debug information files, in the indicated order:
12253
12254 @itemize @minus
12255 @item
12256 @file{/usr/lib/debug/.build-id/ab/cdef1234.debug}
12257 @item
12258 @file{/usr/bin/ls.debug}
12259 @item
12260 @file{/usr/bin/.debug/ls.debug}
12261 @item
12262 @file{/usr/lib/debug/usr/bin/ls.debug}.
12263 @end itemize
12264
12265 You can set the global debugging info directory's name, and view the
12266 name @value{GDBN} is currently using.
12267
12268 @table @code
12269
12270 @kindex set debug-file-directory
12271 @item set debug-file-directory @var{directory}
12272 Set the directory which @value{GDBN} searches for separate debugging
12273 information files to @var{directory}.
12274
12275 @kindex show debug-file-directory
12276 @item show debug-file-directory
12277 Show the directory @value{GDBN} searches for separate debugging
12278 information files.
12279
12280 @end table
12281
12282 @cindex @code{.gnu_debuglink} sections
12283 @cindex debug link sections
12284 A debug link is a special section of the executable file named
12285 @code{.gnu_debuglink}. The section must contain:
12286
12287 @itemize
12288 @item
12289 A filename, with any leading directory components removed, followed by
12290 a zero byte,
12291 @item
12292 zero to three bytes of padding, as needed to reach the next four-byte
12293 boundary within the section, and
12294 @item
12295 a four-byte CRC checksum, stored in the same endianness used for the
12296 executable file itself. The checksum is computed on the debugging
12297 information file's full contents by the function given below, passing
12298 zero as the @var{crc} argument.
12299 @end itemize
12300
12301 Any executable file format can carry a debug link, as long as it can
12302 contain a section named @code{.gnu_debuglink} with the contents
12303 described above.
12304
12305 @cindex @code{.note.gnu.build-id} sections
12306 @cindex build ID sections
12307 The build ID is a special section in the executable file (and in other
12308 ELF binary files that @value{GDBN} may consider). This section is
12309 often named @code{.note.gnu.build-id}, but that name is not mandatory.
12310 It contains unique identification for the built files---the ID remains
12311 the same across multiple builds of the same build tree. The default
12312 algorithm SHA1 produces 160 bits (40 hexadecimal characters) of the
12313 content for the build ID string. The same section with an identical
12314 value is present in the original built binary with symbols, in its
12315 stripped variant, and in the separate debugging information file.
12316
12317 The debugging information file itself should be an ordinary
12318 executable, containing a full set of linker symbols, sections, and
12319 debugging information. The sections of the debugging information file
12320 should have the same names, addresses, and sizes as the original file,
12321 but they need not contain any data---much like a @code{.bss} section
12322 in an ordinary executable.
12323
12324 The @sc{gnu} binary utilities (Binutils) package includes the
12325 @samp{objcopy} utility that can produce
12326 the separated executable / debugging information file pairs using the
12327 following commands:
12328
12329 @smallexample
12330 @kbd{objcopy --only-keep-debug foo foo.debug}
12331 @kbd{strip -g foo}
12332 @end smallexample
12333
12334 @noindent
12335 These commands remove the debugging
12336 information from the executable file @file{foo} and place it in the file
12337 @file{foo.debug}. You can use the first, second or both methods to link the
12338 two files:
12339
12340 @itemize @bullet
12341 @item
12342 The debug link method needs the following additional command to also leave
12343 behind a debug link in @file{foo}:
12344
12345 @smallexample
12346 @kbd{objcopy --add-gnu-debuglink=foo.debug foo}
12347 @end smallexample
12348
12349 Ulrich Drepper's @file{elfutils} package, starting with version 0.53, contains
12350 a version of the @code{strip} command such that the command @kbd{strip foo -f
12351 foo.debug} has the same functionality as the two @code{objcopy} commands and
12352 the @code{ln -s} command above, together.
12353
12354 @item
12355 Build ID gets embedded into the main executable using @code{ld --build-id} or
12356 the @value{NGCC} counterpart @code{gcc -Wl,--build-id}. Build ID support plus
12357 compatibility fixes for debug files separation are present in @sc{gnu} binary
12358 utilities (Binutils) package since version 2.18.
12359 @end itemize
12360
12361 @noindent
12362
12363 Since there are many different ways to compute CRC's for the debug
12364 link (different polynomials, reversals, byte ordering, etc.), the
12365 simplest way to describe the CRC used in @code{.gnu_debuglink}
12366 sections is to give the complete code for a function that computes it:
12367
12368 @kindex gnu_debuglink_crc32
12369 @smallexample
12370 unsigned long
12371 gnu_debuglink_crc32 (unsigned long crc,
12372 unsigned char *buf, size_t len)
12373 @{
12374 static const unsigned long crc32_table[256] =
12375 @{
12376 0x00000000, 0x77073096, 0xee0e612c, 0x990951ba, 0x076dc419,
12377 0x706af48f, 0xe963a535, 0x9e6495a3, 0x0edb8832, 0x79dcb8a4,
12378 0xe0d5e91e, 0x97d2d988, 0x09b64c2b, 0x7eb17cbd, 0xe7b82d07,
12379 0x90bf1d91, 0x1db71064, 0x6ab020f2, 0xf3b97148, 0x84be41de,
12380 0x1adad47d, 0x6ddde4eb, 0xf4d4b551, 0x83d385c7, 0x136c9856,
12381 0x646ba8c0, 0xfd62f97a, 0x8a65c9ec, 0x14015c4f, 0x63066cd9,
12382 0xfa0f3d63, 0x8d080df5, 0x3b6e20c8, 0x4c69105e, 0xd56041e4,
12383 0xa2677172, 0x3c03e4d1, 0x4b04d447, 0xd20d85fd, 0xa50ab56b,
12384 0x35b5a8fa, 0x42b2986c, 0xdbbbc9d6, 0xacbcf940, 0x32d86ce3,
12385 0x45df5c75, 0xdcd60dcf, 0xabd13d59, 0x26d930ac, 0x51de003a,
12386 0xc8d75180, 0xbfd06116, 0x21b4f4b5, 0x56b3c423, 0xcfba9599,
12387 0xb8bda50f, 0x2802b89e, 0x5f058808, 0xc60cd9b2, 0xb10be924,
12388 0x2f6f7c87, 0x58684c11, 0xc1611dab, 0xb6662d3d, 0x76dc4190,
12389 0x01db7106, 0x98d220bc, 0xefd5102a, 0x71b18589, 0x06b6b51f,
12390 0x9fbfe4a5, 0xe8b8d433, 0x7807c9a2, 0x0f00f934, 0x9609a88e,
12391 0xe10e9818, 0x7f6a0dbb, 0x086d3d2d, 0x91646c97, 0xe6635c01,
12392 0x6b6b51f4, 0x1c6c6162, 0x856530d8, 0xf262004e, 0x6c0695ed,
12393 0x1b01a57b, 0x8208f4c1, 0xf50fc457, 0x65b0d9c6, 0x12b7e950,
12394 0x8bbeb8ea, 0xfcb9887c, 0x62dd1ddf, 0x15da2d49, 0x8cd37cf3,
12395 0xfbd44c65, 0x4db26158, 0x3ab551ce, 0xa3bc0074, 0xd4bb30e2,
12396 0x4adfa541, 0x3dd895d7, 0xa4d1c46d, 0xd3d6f4fb, 0x4369e96a,
12397 0x346ed9fc, 0xad678846, 0xda60b8d0, 0x44042d73, 0x33031de5,
12398 0xaa0a4c5f, 0xdd0d7cc9, 0x5005713c, 0x270241aa, 0xbe0b1010,
12399 0xc90c2086, 0x5768b525, 0x206f85b3, 0xb966d409, 0xce61e49f,
12400 0x5edef90e, 0x29d9c998, 0xb0d09822, 0xc7d7a8b4, 0x59b33d17,
12401 0x2eb40d81, 0xb7bd5c3b, 0xc0ba6cad, 0xedb88320, 0x9abfb3b6,
12402 0x03b6e20c, 0x74b1d29a, 0xead54739, 0x9dd277af, 0x04db2615,
12403 0x73dc1683, 0xe3630b12, 0x94643b84, 0x0d6d6a3e, 0x7a6a5aa8,
12404 0xe40ecf0b, 0x9309ff9d, 0x0a00ae27, 0x7d079eb1, 0xf00f9344,
12405 0x8708a3d2, 0x1e01f268, 0x6906c2fe, 0xf762575d, 0x806567cb,
12406 0x196c3671, 0x6e6b06e7, 0xfed41b76, 0x89d32be0, 0x10da7a5a,
12407 0x67dd4acc, 0xf9b9df6f, 0x8ebeeff9, 0x17b7be43, 0x60b08ed5,
12408 0xd6d6a3e8, 0xa1d1937e, 0x38d8c2c4, 0x4fdff252, 0xd1bb67f1,
12409 0xa6bc5767, 0x3fb506dd, 0x48b2364b, 0xd80d2bda, 0xaf0a1b4c,
12410 0x36034af6, 0x41047a60, 0xdf60efc3, 0xa867df55, 0x316e8eef,
12411 0x4669be79, 0xcb61b38c, 0xbc66831a, 0x256fd2a0, 0x5268e236,
12412 0xcc0c7795, 0xbb0b4703, 0x220216b9, 0x5505262f, 0xc5ba3bbe,
12413 0xb2bd0b28, 0x2bb45a92, 0x5cb36a04, 0xc2d7ffa7, 0xb5d0cf31,
12414 0x2cd99e8b, 0x5bdeae1d, 0x9b64c2b0, 0xec63f226, 0x756aa39c,
12415 0x026d930a, 0x9c0906a9, 0xeb0e363f, 0x72076785, 0x05005713,
12416 0x95bf4a82, 0xe2b87a14, 0x7bb12bae, 0x0cb61b38, 0x92d28e9b,
12417 0xe5d5be0d, 0x7cdcefb7, 0x0bdbdf21, 0x86d3d2d4, 0xf1d4e242,
12418 0x68ddb3f8, 0x1fda836e, 0x81be16cd, 0xf6b9265b, 0x6fb077e1,
12419 0x18b74777, 0x88085ae6, 0xff0f6a70, 0x66063bca, 0x11010b5c,
12420 0x8f659eff, 0xf862ae69, 0x616bffd3, 0x166ccf45, 0xa00ae278,
12421 0xd70dd2ee, 0x4e048354, 0x3903b3c2, 0xa7672661, 0xd06016f7,
12422 0x4969474d, 0x3e6e77db, 0xaed16a4a, 0xd9d65adc, 0x40df0b66,
12423 0x37d83bf0, 0xa9bcae53, 0xdebb9ec5, 0x47b2cf7f, 0x30b5ffe9,
12424 0xbdbdf21c, 0xcabac28a, 0x53b39330, 0x24b4a3a6, 0xbad03605,
12425 0xcdd70693, 0x54de5729, 0x23d967bf, 0xb3667a2e, 0xc4614ab8,
12426 0x5d681b02, 0x2a6f2b94, 0xb40bbe37, 0xc30c8ea1, 0x5a05df1b,
12427 0x2d02ef8d
12428 @};
12429 unsigned char *end;
12430
12431 crc = ~crc & 0xffffffff;
12432 for (end = buf + len; buf < end; ++buf)
12433 crc = crc32_table[(crc ^ *buf) & 0xff] ^ (crc >> 8);
12434 return ~crc & 0xffffffff;
12435 @}
12436 @end smallexample
12437
12438 @noindent
12439 This computation does not apply to the ``build ID'' method.
12440
12441
12442 @node Symbol Errors
12443 @section Errors Reading Symbol Files
12444
12445 While reading a symbol file, @value{GDBN} occasionally encounters problems,
12446 such as symbol types it does not recognize, or known bugs in compiler
12447 output. By default, @value{GDBN} does not notify you of such problems, since
12448 they are relatively common and primarily of interest to people
12449 debugging compilers. If you are interested in seeing information
12450 about ill-constructed symbol tables, you can either ask @value{GDBN} to print
12451 only one message about each such type of problem, no matter how many
12452 times the problem occurs; or you can ask @value{GDBN} to print more messages,
12453 to see how many times the problems occur, with the @code{set
12454 complaints} command (@pxref{Messages/Warnings, ,Optional Warnings and
12455 Messages}).
12456
12457 The messages currently printed, and their meanings, include:
12458
12459 @table @code
12460 @item inner block not inside outer block in @var{symbol}
12461
12462 The symbol information shows where symbol scopes begin and end
12463 (such as at the start of a function or a block of statements). This
12464 error indicates that an inner scope block is not fully contained
12465 in its outer scope blocks.
12466
12467 @value{GDBN} circumvents the problem by treating the inner block as if it had
12468 the same scope as the outer block. In the error message, @var{symbol}
12469 may be shown as ``@code{(don't know)}'' if the outer block is not a
12470 function.
12471
12472 @item block at @var{address} out of order
12473
12474 The symbol information for symbol scope blocks should occur in
12475 order of increasing addresses. This error indicates that it does not
12476 do so.
12477
12478 @value{GDBN} does not circumvent this problem, and has trouble
12479 locating symbols in the source file whose symbols it is reading. (You
12480 can often determine what source file is affected by specifying
12481 @code{set verbose on}. @xref{Messages/Warnings, ,Optional Warnings and
12482 Messages}.)
12483
12484 @item bad block start address patched
12485
12486 The symbol information for a symbol scope block has a start address
12487 smaller than the address of the preceding source line. This is known
12488 to occur in the SunOS 4.1.1 (and earlier) C compiler.
12489
12490 @value{GDBN} circumvents the problem by treating the symbol scope block as
12491 starting on the previous source line.
12492
12493 @item bad string table offset in symbol @var{n}
12494
12495 @cindex foo
12496 Symbol number @var{n} contains a pointer into the string table which is
12497 larger than the size of the string table.
12498
12499 @value{GDBN} circumvents the problem by considering the symbol to have the
12500 name @code{foo}, which may cause other problems if many symbols end up
12501 with this name.
12502
12503 @item unknown symbol type @code{0x@var{nn}}
12504
12505 The symbol information contains new data types that @value{GDBN} does
12506 not yet know how to read. @code{0x@var{nn}} is the symbol type of the
12507 uncomprehended information, in hexadecimal.
12508
12509 @value{GDBN} circumvents the error by ignoring this symbol information.
12510 This usually allows you to debug your program, though certain symbols
12511 are not accessible. If you encounter such a problem and feel like
12512 debugging it, you can debug @code{@value{GDBP}} with itself, breakpoint
12513 on @code{complain}, then go up to the function @code{read_dbx_symtab}
12514 and examine @code{*bufp} to see the symbol.
12515
12516 @item stub type has NULL name
12517
12518 @value{GDBN} could not find the full definition for a struct or class.
12519
12520 @item const/volatile indicator missing (ok if using g++ v1.x), got@dots{}
12521 The symbol information for a C@t{++} member function is missing some
12522 information that recent versions of the compiler should have output for
12523 it.
12524
12525 @item info mismatch between compiler and debugger
12526
12527 @value{GDBN} could not parse a type specification output by the compiler.
12528
12529 @end table
12530
12531 @node Targets
12532 @chapter Specifying a Debugging Target
12533
12534 @cindex debugging target
12535 A @dfn{target} is the execution environment occupied by your program.
12536
12537 Often, @value{GDBN} runs in the same host environment as your program;
12538 in that case, the debugging target is specified as a side effect when
12539 you use the @code{file} or @code{core} commands. When you need more
12540 flexibility---for example, running @value{GDBN} on a physically separate
12541 host, or controlling a standalone system over a serial port or a
12542 realtime system over a TCP/IP connection---you can use the @code{target}
12543 command to specify one of the target types configured for @value{GDBN}
12544 (@pxref{Target Commands, ,Commands for Managing Targets}).
12545
12546 @cindex target architecture
12547 It is possible to build @value{GDBN} for several different @dfn{target
12548 architectures}. When @value{GDBN} is built like that, you can choose
12549 one of the available architectures with the @kbd{set architecture}
12550 command.
12551
12552 @table @code
12553 @kindex set architecture
12554 @kindex show architecture
12555 @item set architecture @var{arch}
12556 This command sets the current target architecture to @var{arch}. The
12557 value of @var{arch} can be @code{"auto"}, in addition to one of the
12558 supported architectures.
12559
12560 @item show architecture
12561 Show the current target architecture.
12562
12563 @item set processor
12564 @itemx processor
12565 @kindex set processor
12566 @kindex show processor
12567 These are alias commands for, respectively, @code{set architecture}
12568 and @code{show architecture}.
12569 @end table
12570
12571 @menu
12572 * Active Targets:: Active targets
12573 * Target Commands:: Commands for managing targets
12574 * Byte Order:: Choosing target byte order
12575 @end menu
12576
12577 @node Active Targets
12578 @section Active Targets
12579
12580 @cindex stacking targets
12581 @cindex active targets
12582 @cindex multiple targets
12583
12584 There are three classes of targets: processes, core files, and
12585 executable files. @value{GDBN} can work concurrently on up to three
12586 active targets, one in each class. This allows you to (for example)
12587 start a process and inspect its activity without abandoning your work on
12588 a core file.
12589
12590 For example, if you execute @samp{gdb a.out}, then the executable file
12591 @code{a.out} is the only active target. If you designate a core file as
12592 well---presumably from a prior run that crashed and coredumped---then
12593 @value{GDBN} has two active targets and uses them in tandem, looking
12594 first in the corefile target, then in the executable file, to satisfy
12595 requests for memory addresses. (Typically, these two classes of target
12596 are complementary, since core files contain only a program's
12597 read-write memory---variables and so on---plus machine status, while
12598 executable files contain only the program text and initialized data.)
12599
12600 When you type @code{run}, your executable file becomes an active process
12601 target as well. When a process target is active, all @value{GDBN}
12602 commands requesting memory addresses refer to that target; addresses in
12603 an active core file or executable file target are obscured while the
12604 process target is active.
12605
12606 Use the @code{core-file} and @code{exec-file} commands to select a new
12607 core file or executable target (@pxref{Files, ,Commands to Specify
12608 Files}). To specify as a target a process that is already running, use
12609 the @code{attach} command (@pxref{Attach, ,Debugging an Already-running
12610 Process}).
12611
12612 @node Target Commands
12613 @section Commands for Managing Targets
12614
12615 @table @code
12616 @item target @var{type} @var{parameters}
12617 Connects the @value{GDBN} host environment to a target machine or
12618 process. A target is typically a protocol for talking to debugging
12619 facilities. You use the argument @var{type} to specify the type or
12620 protocol of the target machine.
12621
12622 Further @var{parameters} are interpreted by the target protocol, but
12623 typically include things like device names or host names to connect
12624 with, process numbers, and baud rates.
12625
12626 The @code{target} command does not repeat if you press @key{RET} again
12627 after executing the command.
12628
12629 @kindex help target
12630 @item help target
12631 Displays the names of all targets available. To display targets
12632 currently selected, use either @code{info target} or @code{info files}
12633 (@pxref{Files, ,Commands to Specify Files}).
12634
12635 @item help target @var{name}
12636 Describe a particular target, including any parameters necessary to
12637 select it.
12638
12639 @kindex set gnutarget
12640 @item set gnutarget @var{args}
12641 @value{GDBN} uses its own library BFD to read your files. @value{GDBN}
12642 knows whether it is reading an @dfn{executable},
12643 a @dfn{core}, or a @dfn{.o} file; however, you can specify the file format
12644 with the @code{set gnutarget} command. Unlike most @code{target} commands,
12645 with @code{gnutarget} the @code{target} refers to a program, not a machine.
12646
12647 @quotation
12648 @emph{Warning:} To specify a file format with @code{set gnutarget},
12649 you must know the actual BFD name.
12650 @end quotation
12651
12652 @noindent
12653 @xref{Files, , Commands to Specify Files}.
12654
12655 @kindex show gnutarget
12656 @item show gnutarget
12657 Use the @code{show gnutarget} command to display what file format
12658 @code{gnutarget} is set to read. If you have not set @code{gnutarget},
12659 @value{GDBN} will determine the file format for each file automatically,
12660 and @code{show gnutarget} displays @samp{The current BDF target is "auto"}.
12661 @end table
12662
12663 @cindex common targets
12664 Here are some common targets (available, or not, depending on the GDB
12665 configuration):
12666
12667 @table @code
12668 @kindex target
12669 @item target exec @var{program}
12670 @cindex executable file target
12671 An executable file. @samp{target exec @var{program}} is the same as
12672 @samp{exec-file @var{program}}.
12673
12674 @item target core @var{filename}
12675 @cindex core dump file target
12676 A core dump file. @samp{target core @var{filename}} is the same as
12677 @samp{core-file @var{filename}}.
12678
12679 @item target remote @var{medium}
12680 @cindex remote target
12681 A remote system connected to @value{GDBN} via a serial line or network
12682 connection. This command tells @value{GDBN} to use its own remote
12683 protocol over @var{medium} for debugging. @xref{Remote Debugging}.
12684
12685 For example, if you have a board connected to @file{/dev/ttya} on the
12686 machine running @value{GDBN}, you could say:
12687
12688 @smallexample
12689 target remote /dev/ttya
12690 @end smallexample
12691
12692 @code{target remote} supports the @code{load} command. This is only
12693 useful if you have some other way of getting the stub to the target
12694 system, and you can put it somewhere in memory where it won't get
12695 clobbered by the download.
12696
12697 @item target sim
12698 @cindex built-in simulator target
12699 Builtin CPU simulator. @value{GDBN} includes simulators for most architectures.
12700 In general,
12701 @smallexample
12702 target sim
12703 load
12704 run
12705 @end smallexample
12706 @noindent
12707 works; however, you cannot assume that a specific memory map, device
12708 drivers, or even basic I/O is available, although some simulators do
12709 provide these. For info about any processor-specific simulator details,
12710 see the appropriate section in @ref{Embedded Processors, ,Embedded
12711 Processors}.
12712
12713 @end table
12714
12715 Some configurations may include these targets as well:
12716
12717 @table @code
12718
12719 @item target nrom @var{dev}
12720 @cindex NetROM ROM emulator target
12721 NetROM ROM emulator. This target only supports downloading.
12722
12723 @end table
12724
12725 Different targets are available on different configurations of @value{GDBN};
12726 your configuration may have more or fewer targets.
12727
12728 Many remote targets require you to download the executable's code once
12729 you've successfully established a connection. You may wish to control
12730 various aspects of this process.
12731
12732 @table @code
12733
12734 @item set hash
12735 @kindex set hash@r{, for remote monitors}
12736 @cindex hash mark while downloading
12737 This command controls whether a hash mark @samp{#} is displayed while
12738 downloading a file to the remote monitor. If on, a hash mark is
12739 displayed after each S-record is successfully downloaded to the
12740 monitor.
12741
12742 @item show hash
12743 @kindex show hash@r{, for remote monitors}
12744 Show the current status of displaying the hash mark.
12745
12746 @item set debug monitor
12747 @kindex set debug monitor
12748 @cindex display remote monitor communications
12749 Enable or disable display of communications messages between
12750 @value{GDBN} and the remote monitor.
12751
12752 @item show debug monitor
12753 @kindex show debug monitor
12754 Show the current status of displaying communications between
12755 @value{GDBN} and the remote monitor.
12756 @end table
12757
12758 @table @code
12759
12760 @kindex load @var{filename}
12761 @item load @var{filename}
12762 @anchor{load}
12763 Depending on what remote debugging facilities are configured into
12764 @value{GDBN}, the @code{load} command may be available. Where it exists, it
12765 is meant to make @var{filename} (an executable) available for debugging
12766 on the remote system---by downloading, or dynamic linking, for example.
12767 @code{load} also records the @var{filename} symbol table in @value{GDBN}, like
12768 the @code{add-symbol-file} command.
12769
12770 If your @value{GDBN} does not have a @code{load} command, attempting to
12771 execute it gets the error message ``@code{You can't do that when your
12772 target is @dots{}}''
12773
12774 The file is loaded at whatever address is specified in the executable.
12775 For some object file formats, you can specify the load address when you
12776 link the program; for other formats, like a.out, the object file format
12777 specifies a fixed address.
12778 @c FIXME! This would be a good place for an xref to the GNU linker doc.
12779
12780 Depending on the remote side capabilities, @value{GDBN} may be able to
12781 load programs into flash memory.
12782
12783 @code{load} does not repeat if you press @key{RET} again after using it.
12784 @end table
12785
12786 @node Byte Order
12787 @section Choosing Target Byte Order
12788
12789 @cindex choosing target byte order
12790 @cindex target byte order
12791
12792 Some types of processors, such as the MIPS, PowerPC, and Renesas SH,
12793 offer the ability to run either big-endian or little-endian byte
12794 orders. Usually the executable or symbol will include a bit to
12795 designate the endian-ness, and you will not need to worry about
12796 which to use. However, you may still find it useful to adjust
12797 @value{GDBN}'s idea of processor endian-ness manually.
12798
12799 @table @code
12800 @kindex set endian
12801 @item set endian big
12802 Instruct @value{GDBN} to assume the target is big-endian.
12803
12804 @item set endian little
12805 Instruct @value{GDBN} to assume the target is little-endian.
12806
12807 @item set endian auto
12808 Instruct @value{GDBN} to use the byte order associated with the
12809 executable.
12810
12811 @item show endian
12812 Display @value{GDBN}'s current idea of the target byte order.
12813
12814 @end table
12815
12816 Note that these commands merely adjust interpretation of symbolic
12817 data on the host, and that they have absolutely no effect on the
12818 target system.
12819
12820
12821 @node Remote Debugging
12822 @chapter Debugging Remote Programs
12823 @cindex remote debugging
12824
12825 If you are trying to debug a program running on a machine that cannot run
12826 @value{GDBN} in the usual way, it is often useful to use remote debugging.
12827 For example, you might use remote debugging on an operating system kernel,
12828 or on a small system which does not have a general purpose operating system
12829 powerful enough to run a full-featured debugger.
12830
12831 Some configurations of @value{GDBN} have special serial or TCP/IP interfaces
12832 to make this work with particular debugging targets. In addition,
12833 @value{GDBN} comes with a generic serial protocol (specific to @value{GDBN},
12834 but not specific to any particular target system) which you can use if you
12835 write the remote stubs---the code that runs on the remote system to
12836 communicate with @value{GDBN}.
12837
12838 Other remote targets may be available in your
12839 configuration of @value{GDBN}; use @code{help target} to list them.
12840
12841 @menu
12842 * Connecting:: Connecting to a remote target
12843 * File Transfer:: Sending files to a remote system
12844 * Server:: Using the gdbserver program
12845 * Remote Configuration:: Remote configuration
12846 * Remote Stub:: Implementing a remote stub
12847 @end menu
12848
12849 @node Connecting
12850 @section Connecting to a Remote Target
12851
12852 On the @value{GDBN} host machine, you will need an unstripped copy of
12853 your program, since @value{GDBN} needs symbol and debugging information.
12854 Start up @value{GDBN} as usual, using the name of the local copy of your
12855 program as the first argument.
12856
12857 @cindex @code{target remote}
12858 @value{GDBN} can communicate with the target over a serial line, or
12859 over an @acronym{IP} network using @acronym{TCP} or @acronym{UDP}. In
12860 each case, @value{GDBN} uses the same protocol for debugging your
12861 program; only the medium carrying the debugging packets varies. The
12862 @code{target remote} command establishes a connection to the target.
12863 Its arguments indicate which medium to use:
12864
12865 @table @code
12866
12867 @item target remote @var{serial-device}
12868 @cindex serial line, @code{target remote}
12869 Use @var{serial-device} to communicate with the target. For example,
12870 to use a serial line connected to the device named @file{/dev/ttyb}:
12871
12872 @smallexample
12873 target remote /dev/ttyb
12874 @end smallexample
12875
12876 If you're using a serial line, you may want to give @value{GDBN} the
12877 @w{@samp{--baud}} option, or use the @code{set remotebaud} command
12878 (@pxref{Remote Configuration, set remotebaud}) before the
12879 @code{target} command.
12880
12881 @item target remote @code{@var{host}:@var{port}}
12882 @itemx target remote @code{tcp:@var{host}:@var{port}}
12883 @cindex @acronym{TCP} port, @code{target remote}
12884 Debug using a @acronym{TCP} connection to @var{port} on @var{host}.
12885 The @var{host} may be either a host name or a numeric @acronym{IP}
12886 address; @var{port} must be a decimal number. The @var{host} could be
12887 the target machine itself, if it is directly connected to the net, or
12888 it might be a terminal server which in turn has a serial line to the
12889 target.
12890
12891 For example, to connect to port 2828 on a terminal server named
12892 @code{manyfarms}:
12893
12894 @smallexample
12895 target remote manyfarms:2828
12896 @end smallexample
12897
12898 If your remote target is actually running on the same machine as your
12899 debugger session (e.g.@: a simulator for your target running on the
12900 same host), you can omit the hostname. For example, to connect to
12901 port 1234 on your local machine:
12902
12903 @smallexample
12904 target remote :1234
12905 @end smallexample
12906 @noindent
12907
12908 Note that the colon is still required here.
12909
12910 @item target remote @code{udp:@var{host}:@var{port}}
12911 @cindex @acronym{UDP} port, @code{target remote}
12912 Debug using @acronym{UDP} packets to @var{port} on @var{host}. For example, to
12913 connect to @acronym{UDP} port 2828 on a terminal server named @code{manyfarms}:
12914
12915 @smallexample
12916 target remote udp:manyfarms:2828
12917 @end smallexample
12918
12919 When using a @acronym{UDP} connection for remote debugging, you should
12920 keep in mind that the `U' stands for ``Unreliable''. @acronym{UDP}
12921 can silently drop packets on busy or unreliable networks, which will
12922 cause havoc with your debugging session.
12923
12924 @item target remote | @var{command}
12925 @cindex pipe, @code{target remote} to
12926 Run @var{command} in the background and communicate with it using a
12927 pipe. The @var{command} is a shell command, to be parsed and expanded
12928 by the system's command shell, @code{/bin/sh}; it should expect remote
12929 protocol packets on its standard input, and send replies on its
12930 standard output. You could use this to run a stand-alone simulator
12931 that speaks the remote debugging protocol, to make net connections
12932 using programs like @code{ssh}, or for other similar tricks.
12933
12934 If @var{command} closes its standard output (perhaps by exiting),
12935 @value{GDBN} will try to send it a @code{SIGTERM} signal. (If the
12936 program has already exited, this will have no effect.)
12937
12938 @end table
12939
12940 Once the connection has been established, you can use all the usual
12941 commands to examine and change data. The remote program is already
12942 running; you can use @kbd{step} and @kbd{continue}, and you do not
12943 need to use @kbd{run}.
12944
12945 @cindex interrupting remote programs
12946 @cindex remote programs, interrupting
12947 Whenever @value{GDBN} is waiting for the remote program, if you type the
12948 interrupt character (often @kbd{Ctrl-c}), @value{GDBN} attempts to stop the
12949 program. This may or may not succeed, depending in part on the hardware
12950 and the serial drivers the remote system uses. If you type the
12951 interrupt character once again, @value{GDBN} displays this prompt:
12952
12953 @smallexample
12954 Interrupted while waiting for the program.
12955 Give up (and stop debugging it)? (y or n)
12956 @end smallexample
12957
12958 If you type @kbd{y}, @value{GDBN} abandons the remote debugging session.
12959 (If you decide you want to try again later, you can use @samp{target
12960 remote} again to connect once more.) If you type @kbd{n}, @value{GDBN}
12961 goes back to waiting.
12962
12963 @table @code
12964 @kindex detach (remote)
12965 @item detach
12966 When you have finished debugging the remote program, you can use the
12967 @code{detach} command to release it from @value{GDBN} control.
12968 Detaching from the target normally resumes its execution, but the results
12969 will depend on your particular remote stub. After the @code{detach}
12970 command, @value{GDBN} is free to connect to another target.
12971
12972 @kindex disconnect
12973 @item disconnect
12974 The @code{disconnect} command behaves like @code{detach}, except that
12975 the target is generally not resumed. It will wait for @value{GDBN}
12976 (this instance or another one) to connect and continue debugging. After
12977 the @code{disconnect} command, @value{GDBN} is again free to connect to
12978 another target.
12979
12980 @cindex send command to remote monitor
12981 @cindex extend @value{GDBN} for remote targets
12982 @cindex add new commands for external monitor
12983 @kindex monitor
12984 @item monitor @var{cmd}
12985 This command allows you to send arbitrary commands directly to the
12986 remote monitor. Since @value{GDBN} doesn't care about the commands it
12987 sends like this, this command is the way to extend @value{GDBN}---you
12988 can add new commands that only the external monitor will understand
12989 and implement.
12990 @end table
12991
12992 @node File Transfer
12993 @section Sending files to a remote system
12994 @cindex remote target, file transfer
12995 @cindex file transfer
12996 @cindex sending files to remote systems
12997
12998 Some remote targets offer the ability to transfer files over the same
12999 connection used to communicate with @value{GDBN}. This is convenient
13000 for targets accessible through other means, e.g.@: @sc{gnu}/Linux systems
13001 running @code{gdbserver} over a network interface. For other targets,
13002 e.g.@: embedded devices with only a single serial port, this may be
13003 the only way to upload or download files.
13004
13005 Not all remote targets support these commands.
13006
13007 @table @code
13008 @kindex remote put
13009 @item remote put @var{hostfile} @var{targetfile}
13010 Copy file @var{hostfile} from the host system (the machine running
13011 @value{GDBN}) to @var{targetfile} on the target system.
13012
13013 @kindex remote get
13014 @item remote get @var{targetfile} @var{hostfile}
13015 Copy file @var{targetfile} from the target system to @var{hostfile}
13016 on the host system.
13017
13018 @kindex remote delete
13019 @item remote delete @var{targetfile}
13020 Delete @var{targetfile} from the target system.
13021
13022 @end table
13023
13024 @node Server
13025 @section Using the @code{gdbserver} Program
13026
13027 @kindex gdbserver
13028 @cindex remote connection without stubs
13029 @code{gdbserver} is a control program for Unix-like systems, which
13030 allows you to connect your program with a remote @value{GDBN} via
13031 @code{target remote}---but without linking in the usual debugging stub.
13032
13033 @code{gdbserver} is not a complete replacement for the debugging stubs,
13034 because it requires essentially the same operating-system facilities
13035 that @value{GDBN} itself does. In fact, a system that can run
13036 @code{gdbserver} to connect to a remote @value{GDBN} could also run
13037 @value{GDBN} locally! @code{gdbserver} is sometimes useful nevertheless,
13038 because it is a much smaller program than @value{GDBN} itself. It is
13039 also easier to port than all of @value{GDBN}, so you may be able to get
13040 started more quickly on a new system by using @code{gdbserver}.
13041 Finally, if you develop code for real-time systems, you may find that
13042 the tradeoffs involved in real-time operation make it more convenient to
13043 do as much development work as possible on another system, for example
13044 by cross-compiling. You can use @code{gdbserver} to make a similar
13045 choice for debugging.
13046
13047 @value{GDBN} and @code{gdbserver} communicate via either a serial line
13048 or a TCP connection, using the standard @value{GDBN} remote serial
13049 protocol.
13050
13051 @quotation
13052 @emph{Warning:} @code{gdbserver} does not have any built-in security.
13053 Do not run @code{gdbserver} connected to any public network; a
13054 @value{GDBN} connection to @code{gdbserver} provides access to the
13055 target system with the same privileges as the user running
13056 @code{gdbserver}.
13057 @end quotation
13058
13059 @subsection Running @code{gdbserver}
13060 @cindex arguments, to @code{gdbserver}
13061
13062 Run @code{gdbserver} on the target system. You need a copy of the
13063 program you want to debug, including any libraries it requires.
13064 @code{gdbserver} does not need your program's symbol table, so you can
13065 strip the program if necessary to save space. @value{GDBN} on the host
13066 system does all the symbol handling.
13067
13068 To use the server, you must tell it how to communicate with @value{GDBN};
13069 the name of your program; and the arguments for your program. The usual
13070 syntax is:
13071
13072 @smallexample
13073 target> gdbserver @var{comm} @var{program} [ @var{args} @dots{} ]
13074 @end smallexample
13075
13076 @var{comm} is either a device name (to use a serial line) or a TCP
13077 hostname and portnumber. For example, to debug Emacs with the argument
13078 @samp{foo.txt} and communicate with @value{GDBN} over the serial port
13079 @file{/dev/com1}:
13080
13081 @smallexample
13082 target> gdbserver /dev/com1 emacs foo.txt
13083 @end smallexample
13084
13085 @code{gdbserver} waits passively for the host @value{GDBN} to communicate
13086 with it.
13087
13088 To use a TCP connection instead of a serial line:
13089
13090 @smallexample
13091 target> gdbserver host:2345 emacs foo.txt
13092 @end smallexample
13093
13094 The only difference from the previous example is the first argument,
13095 specifying that you are communicating with the host @value{GDBN} via
13096 TCP. The @samp{host:2345} argument means that @code{gdbserver} is to
13097 expect a TCP connection from machine @samp{host} to local TCP port 2345.
13098 (Currently, the @samp{host} part is ignored.) You can choose any number
13099 you want for the port number as long as it does not conflict with any
13100 TCP ports already in use on the target system (for example, @code{23} is
13101 reserved for @code{telnet}).@footnote{If you choose a port number that
13102 conflicts with another service, @code{gdbserver} prints an error message
13103 and exits.} You must use the same port number with the host @value{GDBN}
13104 @code{target remote} command.
13105
13106 @subsubsection Attaching to a Running Program
13107
13108 On some targets, @code{gdbserver} can also attach to running programs.
13109 This is accomplished via the @code{--attach} argument. The syntax is:
13110
13111 @smallexample
13112 target> gdbserver --attach @var{comm} @var{pid}
13113 @end smallexample
13114
13115 @var{pid} is the process ID of a currently running process. It isn't necessary
13116 to point @code{gdbserver} at a binary for the running process.
13117
13118 @pindex pidof
13119 @cindex attach to a program by name
13120 You can debug processes by name instead of process ID if your target has the
13121 @code{pidof} utility:
13122
13123 @smallexample
13124 target> gdbserver --attach @var{comm} `pidof @var{program}`
13125 @end smallexample
13126
13127 In case more than one copy of @var{program} is running, or @var{program}
13128 has multiple threads, most versions of @code{pidof} support the
13129 @code{-s} option to only return the first process ID.
13130
13131 @subsubsection Multi-Process Mode for @code{gdbserver}
13132 @cindex gdbserver, multiple processes
13133 @cindex multiple processes with gdbserver
13134
13135 When you connect to @code{gdbserver} using @code{target remote},
13136 @code{gdbserver} debugs the specified program only once. When the
13137 program exits, or you detach from it, @value{GDBN} closes the connection
13138 and @code{gdbserver} exits.
13139
13140 If you connect using @kbd{target extended-remote}, @code{gdbserver}
13141 enters multi-process mode. When the debugged program exits, or you
13142 detach from it, @value{GDBN} stays connected to @code{gdbserver} even
13143 though no program is running. The @code{run} and @code{attach}
13144 commands instruct @code{gdbserver} to run or attach to a new program.
13145 The @code{run} command uses @code{set remote exec-file} (@pxref{set
13146 remote exec-file}) to select the program to run. Command line
13147 arguments are supported, except for wildcard expansion and I/O
13148 redirection (@pxref{Arguments}).
13149
13150 To start @code{gdbserver} without supplying an initial command to run
13151 or process ID to attach, use the @option{--multi} command line option.
13152 Then you can connect using @kbd{target extended-remote} and start
13153 the program you want to debug.
13154
13155 @code{gdbserver} does not automatically exit in multi-process mode.
13156 You can terminate it by using @code{monitor exit}
13157 (@pxref{Monitor Commands for gdbserver}).
13158
13159 @subsubsection Other Command-Line Arguments for @code{gdbserver}
13160
13161 You can include @option{--debug} on the @code{gdbserver} command line.
13162 @code{gdbserver} will display extra status information about the debugging
13163 process. This option is intended for @code{gdbserver} development and
13164 for bug reports to the developers.
13165
13166 The @option{--wrapper} option specifies a wrapper to launch programs
13167 for debugging. The option should be followed by the name of the
13168 wrapper, then any command-line arguments to pass to the wrapper, then
13169 @kbd{--} indicating the end of the wrapper arguments.
13170
13171 @code{gdbserver} runs the specified wrapper program with a combined
13172 command line including the wrapper arguments, then the name of the
13173 program to debug, then any arguments to the program. The wrapper
13174 runs until it executes your program, and then @value{GDBN} gains control.
13175
13176 You can use any program that eventually calls @code{execve} with
13177 its arguments as a wrapper. Several standard Unix utilities do
13178 this, e.g.@: @code{env} and @code{nohup}. Any Unix shell script ending
13179 with @code{exec "$@@"} will also work.
13180
13181 For example, you can use @code{env} to pass an environment variable to
13182 the debugged program, without setting the variable in @code{gdbserver}'s
13183 environment:
13184
13185 @smallexample
13186 $ gdbserver --wrapper env LD_PRELOAD=libtest.so -- :2222 ./testprog
13187 @end smallexample
13188
13189 @subsection Connecting to @code{gdbserver}
13190
13191 Run @value{GDBN} on the host system.
13192
13193 First make sure you have the necessary symbol files. Load symbols for
13194 your application using the @code{file} command before you connect. Use
13195 @code{set sysroot} to locate target libraries (unless your @value{GDBN}
13196 was compiled with the correct sysroot using @code{--with-sysroot}).
13197
13198 The symbol file and target libraries must exactly match the executable
13199 and libraries on the target, with one exception: the files on the host
13200 system should not be stripped, even if the files on the target system
13201 are. Mismatched or missing files will lead to confusing results
13202 during debugging. On @sc{gnu}/Linux targets, mismatched or missing
13203 files may also prevent @code{gdbserver} from debugging multi-threaded
13204 programs.
13205
13206 Connect to your target (@pxref{Connecting,,Connecting to a Remote Target}).
13207 For TCP connections, you must start up @code{gdbserver} prior to using
13208 the @code{target remote} command. Otherwise you may get an error whose
13209 text depends on the host system, but which usually looks something like
13210 @samp{Connection refused}. Don't use the @code{load}
13211 command in @value{GDBN} when using @code{gdbserver}, since the program is
13212 already on the target.
13213
13214 @subsection Monitor Commands for @code{gdbserver}
13215 @cindex monitor commands, for @code{gdbserver}
13216 @anchor{Monitor Commands for gdbserver}
13217
13218 During a @value{GDBN} session using @code{gdbserver}, you can use the
13219 @code{monitor} command to send special requests to @code{gdbserver}.
13220 Here are the available commands.
13221
13222 @table @code
13223 @item monitor help
13224 List the available monitor commands.
13225
13226 @item monitor set debug 0
13227 @itemx monitor set debug 1
13228 Disable or enable general debugging messages.
13229
13230 @item monitor set remote-debug 0
13231 @itemx monitor set remote-debug 1
13232 Disable or enable specific debugging messages associated with the remote
13233 protocol (@pxref{Remote Protocol}).
13234
13235 @item monitor exit
13236 Tell gdbserver to exit immediately. This command should be followed by
13237 @code{disconnect} to close the debugging session. @code{gdbserver} will
13238 detach from any attached processes and kill any processes it created.
13239 Use @code{monitor exit} to terminate @code{gdbserver} at the end
13240 of a multi-process mode debug session.
13241
13242 @end table
13243
13244 @node Remote Configuration
13245 @section Remote Configuration
13246
13247 @kindex set remote
13248 @kindex show remote
13249 This section documents the configuration options available when
13250 debugging remote programs. For the options related to the File I/O
13251 extensions of the remote protocol, see @ref{system,
13252 system-call-allowed}.
13253
13254 @table @code
13255 @item set remoteaddresssize @var{bits}
13256 @cindex address size for remote targets
13257 @cindex bits in remote address
13258 Set the maximum size of address in a memory packet to the specified
13259 number of bits. @value{GDBN} will mask off the address bits above
13260 that number, when it passes addresses to the remote target. The
13261 default value is the number of bits in the target's address.
13262
13263 @item show remoteaddresssize
13264 Show the current value of remote address size in bits.
13265
13266 @item set remotebaud @var{n}
13267 @cindex baud rate for remote targets
13268 Set the baud rate for the remote serial I/O to @var{n} baud. The
13269 value is used to set the speed of the serial port used for debugging
13270 remote targets.
13271
13272 @item show remotebaud
13273 Show the current speed of the remote connection.
13274
13275 @item set remotebreak
13276 @cindex interrupt remote programs
13277 @cindex BREAK signal instead of Ctrl-C
13278 @anchor{set remotebreak}
13279 If set to on, @value{GDBN} sends a @code{BREAK} signal to the remote
13280 when you type @kbd{Ctrl-c} to interrupt the program running
13281 on the remote. If set to off, @value{GDBN} sends the @samp{Ctrl-C}
13282 character instead. The default is off, since most remote systems
13283 expect to see @samp{Ctrl-C} as the interrupt signal.
13284
13285 @item show remotebreak
13286 Show whether @value{GDBN} sends @code{BREAK} or @samp{Ctrl-C} to
13287 interrupt the remote program.
13288
13289 @item set remoteflow on
13290 @itemx set remoteflow off
13291 @kindex set remoteflow
13292 Enable or disable hardware flow control (@code{RTS}/@code{CTS})
13293 on the serial port used to communicate to the remote target.
13294
13295 @item show remoteflow
13296 @kindex show remoteflow
13297 Show the current setting of hardware flow control.
13298
13299 @item set remotelogbase @var{base}
13300 Set the base (a.k.a.@: radix) of logging serial protocol
13301 communications to @var{base}. Supported values of @var{base} are:
13302 @code{ascii}, @code{octal}, and @code{hex}. The default is
13303 @code{ascii}.
13304
13305 @item show remotelogbase
13306 Show the current setting of the radix for logging remote serial
13307 protocol.
13308
13309 @item set remotelogfile @var{file}
13310 @cindex record serial communications on file
13311 Record remote serial communications on the named @var{file}. The
13312 default is not to record at all.
13313
13314 @item show remotelogfile.
13315 Show the current setting of the file name on which to record the
13316 serial communications.
13317
13318 @item set remotetimeout @var{num}
13319 @cindex timeout for serial communications
13320 @cindex remote timeout
13321 Set the timeout limit to wait for the remote target to respond to
13322 @var{num} seconds. The default is 2 seconds.
13323
13324 @item show remotetimeout
13325 Show the current number of seconds to wait for the remote target
13326 responses.
13327
13328 @cindex limit hardware breakpoints and watchpoints
13329 @cindex remote target, limit break- and watchpoints
13330 @anchor{set remote hardware-watchpoint-limit}
13331 @anchor{set remote hardware-breakpoint-limit}
13332 @item set remote hardware-watchpoint-limit @var{limit}
13333 @itemx set remote hardware-breakpoint-limit @var{limit}
13334 Restrict @value{GDBN} to using @var{limit} remote hardware breakpoint or
13335 watchpoints. A limit of -1, the default, is treated as unlimited.
13336
13337 @item set remote exec-file @var{filename}
13338 @itemx show remote exec-file
13339 @anchor{set remote exec-file}
13340 @cindex executable file, for remote target
13341 Select the file used for @code{run} with @code{target
13342 extended-remote}. This should be set to a filename valid on the
13343 target system. If it is not set, the target will use a default
13344 filename (e.g.@: the last program run).
13345 @end table
13346
13347 @cindex remote packets, enabling and disabling
13348 The @value{GDBN} remote protocol autodetects the packets supported by
13349 your debugging stub. If you need to override the autodetection, you
13350 can use these commands to enable or disable individual packets. Each
13351 packet can be set to @samp{on} (the remote target supports this
13352 packet), @samp{off} (the remote target does not support this packet),
13353 or @samp{auto} (detect remote target support for this packet). They
13354 all default to @samp{auto}. For more information about each packet,
13355 see @ref{Remote Protocol}.
13356
13357 During normal use, you should not have to use any of these commands.
13358 If you do, that may be a bug in your remote debugging stub, or a bug
13359 in @value{GDBN}. You may want to report the problem to the
13360 @value{GDBN} developers.
13361
13362 For each packet @var{name}, the command to enable or disable the
13363 packet is @code{set remote @var{name}-packet}. The available settings
13364 are:
13365
13366 @multitable @columnfractions 0.28 0.32 0.25
13367 @item Command Name
13368 @tab Remote Packet
13369 @tab Related Features
13370
13371 @item @code{fetch-register}
13372 @tab @code{p}
13373 @tab @code{info registers}
13374
13375 @item @code{set-register}
13376 @tab @code{P}
13377 @tab @code{set}
13378
13379 @item @code{binary-download}
13380 @tab @code{X}
13381 @tab @code{load}, @code{set}
13382
13383 @item @code{read-aux-vector}
13384 @tab @code{qXfer:auxv:read}
13385 @tab @code{info auxv}
13386
13387 @item @code{symbol-lookup}
13388 @tab @code{qSymbol}
13389 @tab Detecting multiple threads
13390
13391 @item @code{attach}
13392 @tab @code{vAttach}
13393 @tab @code{attach}
13394
13395 @item @code{verbose-resume}
13396 @tab @code{vCont}
13397 @tab Stepping or resuming multiple threads
13398
13399 @item @code{run}
13400 @tab @code{vRun}
13401 @tab @code{run}
13402
13403 @item @code{software-breakpoint}
13404 @tab @code{Z0}
13405 @tab @code{break}
13406
13407 @item @code{hardware-breakpoint}
13408 @tab @code{Z1}
13409 @tab @code{hbreak}
13410
13411 @item @code{write-watchpoint}
13412 @tab @code{Z2}
13413 @tab @code{watch}
13414
13415 @item @code{read-watchpoint}
13416 @tab @code{Z3}
13417 @tab @code{rwatch}
13418
13419 @item @code{access-watchpoint}
13420 @tab @code{Z4}
13421 @tab @code{awatch}
13422
13423 @item @code{target-features}
13424 @tab @code{qXfer:features:read}
13425 @tab @code{set architecture}
13426
13427 @item @code{library-info}
13428 @tab @code{qXfer:libraries:read}
13429 @tab @code{info sharedlibrary}
13430
13431 @item @code{memory-map}
13432 @tab @code{qXfer:memory-map:read}
13433 @tab @code{info mem}
13434
13435 @item @code{read-spu-object}
13436 @tab @code{qXfer:spu:read}
13437 @tab @code{info spu}
13438
13439 @item @code{write-spu-object}
13440 @tab @code{qXfer:spu:write}
13441 @tab @code{info spu}
13442
13443 @item @code{get-thread-local-@*storage-address}
13444 @tab @code{qGetTLSAddr}
13445 @tab Displaying @code{__thread} variables
13446
13447 @item @code{supported-packets}
13448 @tab @code{qSupported}
13449 @tab Remote communications parameters
13450
13451 @item @code{pass-signals}
13452 @tab @code{QPassSignals}
13453 @tab @code{handle @var{signal}}
13454
13455 @item @code{hostio-close-packet}
13456 @tab @code{vFile:close}
13457 @tab @code{remote get}, @code{remote put}
13458
13459 @item @code{hostio-open-packet}
13460 @tab @code{vFile:open}
13461 @tab @code{remote get}, @code{remote put}
13462
13463 @item @code{hostio-pread-packet}
13464 @tab @code{vFile:pread}
13465 @tab @code{remote get}, @code{remote put}
13466
13467 @item @code{hostio-pwrite-packet}
13468 @tab @code{vFile:pwrite}
13469 @tab @code{remote get}, @code{remote put}
13470
13471 @item @code{hostio-unlink-packet}
13472 @tab @code{vFile:unlink}
13473 @tab @code{remote delete}
13474 @end multitable
13475
13476 @node Remote Stub
13477 @section Implementing a Remote Stub
13478
13479 @cindex debugging stub, example
13480 @cindex remote stub, example
13481 @cindex stub example, remote debugging
13482 The stub files provided with @value{GDBN} implement the target side of the
13483 communication protocol, and the @value{GDBN} side is implemented in the
13484 @value{GDBN} source file @file{remote.c}. Normally, you can simply allow
13485 these subroutines to communicate, and ignore the details. (If you're
13486 implementing your own stub file, you can still ignore the details: start
13487 with one of the existing stub files. @file{sparc-stub.c} is the best
13488 organized, and therefore the easiest to read.)
13489
13490 @cindex remote serial debugging, overview
13491 To debug a program running on another machine (the debugging
13492 @dfn{target} machine), you must first arrange for all the usual
13493 prerequisites for the program to run by itself. For example, for a C
13494 program, you need:
13495
13496 @enumerate
13497 @item
13498 A startup routine to set up the C runtime environment; these usually
13499 have a name like @file{crt0}. The startup routine may be supplied by
13500 your hardware supplier, or you may have to write your own.
13501
13502 @item
13503 A C subroutine library to support your program's
13504 subroutine calls, notably managing input and output.
13505
13506 @item
13507 A way of getting your program to the other machine---for example, a
13508 download program. These are often supplied by the hardware
13509 manufacturer, but you may have to write your own from hardware
13510 documentation.
13511 @end enumerate
13512
13513 The next step is to arrange for your program to use a serial port to
13514 communicate with the machine where @value{GDBN} is running (the @dfn{host}
13515 machine). In general terms, the scheme looks like this:
13516
13517 @table @emph
13518 @item On the host,
13519 @value{GDBN} already understands how to use this protocol; when everything
13520 else is set up, you can simply use the @samp{target remote} command
13521 (@pxref{Targets,,Specifying a Debugging Target}).
13522
13523 @item On the target,
13524 you must link with your program a few special-purpose subroutines that
13525 implement the @value{GDBN} remote serial protocol. The file containing these
13526 subroutines is called a @dfn{debugging stub}.
13527
13528 On certain remote targets, you can use an auxiliary program
13529 @code{gdbserver} instead of linking a stub into your program.
13530 @xref{Server,,Using the @code{gdbserver} Program}, for details.
13531 @end table
13532
13533 The debugging stub is specific to the architecture of the remote
13534 machine; for example, use @file{sparc-stub.c} to debug programs on
13535 @sc{sparc} boards.
13536
13537 @cindex remote serial stub list
13538 These working remote stubs are distributed with @value{GDBN}:
13539
13540 @table @code
13541
13542 @item i386-stub.c
13543 @cindex @file{i386-stub.c}
13544 @cindex Intel
13545 @cindex i386
13546 For Intel 386 and compatible architectures.
13547
13548 @item m68k-stub.c
13549 @cindex @file{m68k-stub.c}
13550 @cindex Motorola 680x0
13551 @cindex m680x0
13552 For Motorola 680x0 architectures.
13553
13554 @item sh-stub.c
13555 @cindex @file{sh-stub.c}
13556 @cindex Renesas
13557 @cindex SH
13558 For Renesas SH architectures.
13559
13560 @item sparc-stub.c
13561 @cindex @file{sparc-stub.c}
13562 @cindex Sparc
13563 For @sc{sparc} architectures.
13564
13565 @item sparcl-stub.c
13566 @cindex @file{sparcl-stub.c}
13567 @cindex Fujitsu
13568 @cindex SparcLite
13569 For Fujitsu @sc{sparclite} architectures.
13570
13571 @end table
13572
13573 The @file{README} file in the @value{GDBN} distribution may list other
13574 recently added stubs.
13575
13576 @menu
13577 * Stub Contents:: What the stub can do for you
13578 * Bootstrapping:: What you must do for the stub
13579 * Debug Session:: Putting it all together
13580 @end menu
13581
13582 @node Stub Contents
13583 @subsection What the Stub Can Do for You
13584
13585 @cindex remote serial stub
13586 The debugging stub for your architecture supplies these three
13587 subroutines:
13588
13589 @table @code
13590 @item set_debug_traps
13591 @findex set_debug_traps
13592 @cindex remote serial stub, initialization
13593 This routine arranges for @code{handle_exception} to run when your
13594 program stops. You must call this subroutine explicitly near the
13595 beginning of your program.
13596
13597 @item handle_exception
13598 @findex handle_exception
13599 @cindex remote serial stub, main routine
13600 This is the central workhorse, but your program never calls it
13601 explicitly---the setup code arranges for @code{handle_exception} to
13602 run when a trap is triggered.
13603
13604 @code{handle_exception} takes control when your program stops during
13605 execution (for example, on a breakpoint), and mediates communications
13606 with @value{GDBN} on the host machine. This is where the communications
13607 protocol is implemented; @code{handle_exception} acts as the @value{GDBN}
13608 representative on the target machine. It begins by sending summary
13609 information on the state of your program, then continues to execute,
13610 retrieving and transmitting any information @value{GDBN} needs, until you
13611 execute a @value{GDBN} command that makes your program resume; at that point,
13612 @code{handle_exception} returns control to your own code on the target
13613 machine.
13614
13615 @item breakpoint
13616 @cindex @code{breakpoint} subroutine, remote
13617 Use this auxiliary subroutine to make your program contain a
13618 breakpoint. Depending on the particular situation, this may be the only
13619 way for @value{GDBN} to get control. For instance, if your target
13620 machine has some sort of interrupt button, you won't need to call this;
13621 pressing the interrupt button transfers control to
13622 @code{handle_exception}---in effect, to @value{GDBN}. On some machines,
13623 simply receiving characters on the serial port may also trigger a trap;
13624 again, in that situation, you don't need to call @code{breakpoint} from
13625 your own program---simply running @samp{target remote} from the host
13626 @value{GDBN} session gets control.
13627
13628 Call @code{breakpoint} if none of these is true, or if you simply want
13629 to make certain your program stops at a predetermined point for the
13630 start of your debugging session.
13631 @end table
13632
13633 @node Bootstrapping
13634 @subsection What You Must Do for the Stub
13635
13636 @cindex remote stub, support routines
13637 The debugging stubs that come with @value{GDBN} are set up for a particular
13638 chip architecture, but they have no information about the rest of your
13639 debugging target machine.
13640
13641 First of all you need to tell the stub how to communicate with the
13642 serial port.
13643
13644 @table @code
13645 @item int getDebugChar()
13646 @findex getDebugChar
13647 Write this subroutine to read a single character from the serial port.
13648 It may be identical to @code{getchar} for your target system; a
13649 different name is used to allow you to distinguish the two if you wish.
13650
13651 @item void putDebugChar(int)
13652 @findex putDebugChar
13653 Write this subroutine to write a single character to the serial port.
13654 It may be identical to @code{putchar} for your target system; a
13655 different name is used to allow you to distinguish the two if you wish.
13656 @end table
13657
13658 @cindex control C, and remote debugging
13659 @cindex interrupting remote targets
13660 If you want @value{GDBN} to be able to stop your program while it is
13661 running, you need to use an interrupt-driven serial driver, and arrange
13662 for it to stop when it receives a @code{^C} (@samp{\003}, the control-C
13663 character). That is the character which @value{GDBN} uses to tell the
13664 remote system to stop.
13665
13666 Getting the debugging target to return the proper status to @value{GDBN}
13667 probably requires changes to the standard stub; one quick and dirty way
13668 is to just execute a breakpoint instruction (the ``dirty'' part is that
13669 @value{GDBN} reports a @code{SIGTRAP} instead of a @code{SIGINT}).
13670
13671 Other routines you need to supply are:
13672
13673 @table @code
13674 @item void exceptionHandler (int @var{exception_number}, void *@var{exception_address})
13675 @findex exceptionHandler
13676 Write this function to install @var{exception_address} in the exception
13677 handling tables. You need to do this because the stub does not have any
13678 way of knowing what the exception handling tables on your target system
13679 are like (for example, the processor's table might be in @sc{rom},
13680 containing entries which point to a table in @sc{ram}).
13681 @var{exception_number} is the exception number which should be changed;
13682 its meaning is architecture-dependent (for example, different numbers
13683 might represent divide by zero, misaligned access, etc). When this
13684 exception occurs, control should be transferred directly to
13685 @var{exception_address}, and the processor state (stack, registers,
13686 and so on) should be just as it is when a processor exception occurs. So if
13687 you want to use a jump instruction to reach @var{exception_address}, it
13688 should be a simple jump, not a jump to subroutine.
13689
13690 For the 386, @var{exception_address} should be installed as an interrupt
13691 gate so that interrupts are masked while the handler runs. The gate
13692 should be at privilege level 0 (the most privileged level). The
13693 @sc{sparc} and 68k stubs are able to mask interrupts themselves without
13694 help from @code{exceptionHandler}.
13695
13696 @item void flush_i_cache()
13697 @findex flush_i_cache
13698 On @sc{sparc} and @sc{sparclite} only, write this subroutine to flush the
13699 instruction cache, if any, on your target machine. If there is no
13700 instruction cache, this subroutine may be a no-op.
13701
13702 On target machines that have instruction caches, @value{GDBN} requires this
13703 function to make certain that the state of your program is stable.
13704 @end table
13705
13706 @noindent
13707 You must also make sure this library routine is available:
13708
13709 @table @code
13710 @item void *memset(void *, int, int)
13711 @findex memset
13712 This is the standard library function @code{memset} that sets an area of
13713 memory to a known value. If you have one of the free versions of
13714 @code{libc.a}, @code{memset} can be found there; otherwise, you must
13715 either obtain it from your hardware manufacturer, or write your own.
13716 @end table
13717
13718 If you do not use the GNU C compiler, you may need other standard
13719 library subroutines as well; this varies from one stub to another,
13720 but in general the stubs are likely to use any of the common library
13721 subroutines which @code{@value{NGCC}} generates as inline code.
13722
13723
13724 @node Debug Session
13725 @subsection Putting it All Together
13726
13727 @cindex remote serial debugging summary
13728 In summary, when your program is ready to debug, you must follow these
13729 steps.
13730
13731 @enumerate
13732 @item
13733 Make sure you have defined the supporting low-level routines
13734 (@pxref{Bootstrapping,,What You Must Do for the Stub}):
13735 @display
13736 @code{getDebugChar}, @code{putDebugChar},
13737 @code{flush_i_cache}, @code{memset}, @code{exceptionHandler}.
13738 @end display
13739
13740 @item
13741 Insert these lines near the top of your program:
13742
13743 @smallexample
13744 set_debug_traps();
13745 breakpoint();
13746 @end smallexample
13747
13748 @item
13749 For the 680x0 stub only, you need to provide a variable called
13750 @code{exceptionHook}. Normally you just use:
13751
13752 @smallexample
13753 void (*exceptionHook)() = 0;
13754 @end smallexample
13755
13756 @noindent
13757 but if before calling @code{set_debug_traps}, you set it to point to a
13758 function in your program, that function is called when
13759 @code{@value{GDBN}} continues after stopping on a trap (for example, bus
13760 error). The function indicated by @code{exceptionHook} is called with
13761 one parameter: an @code{int} which is the exception number.
13762
13763 @item
13764 Compile and link together: your program, the @value{GDBN} debugging stub for
13765 your target architecture, and the supporting subroutines.
13766
13767 @item
13768 Make sure you have a serial connection between your target machine and
13769 the @value{GDBN} host, and identify the serial port on the host.
13770
13771 @item
13772 @c The "remote" target now provides a `load' command, so we should
13773 @c document that. FIXME.
13774 Download your program to your target machine (or get it there by
13775 whatever means the manufacturer provides), and start it.
13776
13777 @item
13778 Start @value{GDBN} on the host, and connect to the target
13779 (@pxref{Connecting,,Connecting to a Remote Target}).
13780
13781 @end enumerate
13782
13783 @node Configurations
13784 @chapter Configuration-Specific Information
13785
13786 While nearly all @value{GDBN} commands are available for all native and
13787 cross versions of the debugger, there are some exceptions. This chapter
13788 describes things that are only available in certain configurations.
13789
13790 There are three major categories of configurations: native
13791 configurations, where the host and target are the same, embedded
13792 operating system configurations, which are usually the same for several
13793 different processor architectures, and bare embedded processors, which
13794 are quite different from each other.
13795
13796 @menu
13797 * Native::
13798 * Embedded OS::
13799 * Embedded Processors::
13800 * Architectures::
13801 @end menu
13802
13803 @node Native
13804 @section Native
13805
13806 This section describes details specific to particular native
13807 configurations.
13808
13809 @menu
13810 * HP-UX:: HP-UX
13811 * BSD libkvm Interface:: Debugging BSD kernel memory images
13812 * SVR4 Process Information:: SVR4 process information
13813 * DJGPP Native:: Features specific to the DJGPP port
13814 * Cygwin Native:: Features specific to the Cygwin port
13815 * Hurd Native:: Features specific to @sc{gnu} Hurd
13816 * Neutrino:: Features specific to QNX Neutrino
13817 @end menu
13818
13819 @node HP-UX
13820 @subsection HP-UX
13821
13822 On HP-UX systems, if you refer to a function or variable name that
13823 begins with a dollar sign, @value{GDBN} searches for a user or system
13824 name first, before it searches for a convenience variable.
13825
13826
13827 @node BSD libkvm Interface
13828 @subsection BSD libkvm Interface
13829
13830 @cindex libkvm
13831 @cindex kernel memory image
13832 @cindex kernel crash dump
13833
13834 BSD-derived systems (FreeBSD/NetBSD/OpenBSD) have a kernel memory
13835 interface that provides a uniform interface for accessing kernel virtual
13836 memory images, including live systems and crash dumps. @value{GDBN}
13837 uses this interface to allow you to debug live kernels and kernel crash
13838 dumps on many native BSD configurations. This is implemented as a
13839 special @code{kvm} debugging target. For debugging a live system, load
13840 the currently running kernel into @value{GDBN} and connect to the
13841 @code{kvm} target:
13842
13843 @smallexample
13844 (@value{GDBP}) @b{target kvm}
13845 @end smallexample
13846
13847 For debugging crash dumps, provide the file name of the crash dump as an
13848 argument:
13849
13850 @smallexample
13851 (@value{GDBP}) @b{target kvm /var/crash/bsd.0}
13852 @end smallexample
13853
13854 Once connected to the @code{kvm} target, the following commands are
13855 available:
13856
13857 @table @code
13858 @kindex kvm
13859 @item kvm pcb
13860 Set current context from the @dfn{Process Control Block} (PCB) address.
13861
13862 @item kvm proc
13863 Set current context from proc address. This command isn't available on
13864 modern FreeBSD systems.
13865 @end table
13866
13867 @node SVR4 Process Information
13868 @subsection SVR4 Process Information
13869 @cindex /proc
13870 @cindex examine process image
13871 @cindex process info via @file{/proc}
13872
13873 Many versions of SVR4 and compatible systems provide a facility called
13874 @samp{/proc} that can be used to examine the image of a running
13875 process using file-system subroutines. If @value{GDBN} is configured
13876 for an operating system with this facility, the command @code{info
13877 proc} is available to report information about the process running
13878 your program, or about any process running on your system. @code{info
13879 proc} works only on SVR4 systems that include the @code{procfs} code.
13880 This includes, as of this writing, @sc{gnu}/Linux, OSF/1 (Digital
13881 Unix), Solaris, Irix, and Unixware, but not HP-UX, for example.
13882
13883 @table @code
13884 @kindex info proc
13885 @cindex process ID
13886 @item info proc
13887 @itemx info proc @var{process-id}
13888 Summarize available information about any running process. If a
13889 process ID is specified by @var{process-id}, display information about
13890 that process; otherwise display information about the program being
13891 debugged. The summary includes the debugged process ID, the command
13892 line used to invoke it, its current working directory, and its
13893 executable file's absolute file name.
13894
13895 On some systems, @var{process-id} can be of the form
13896 @samp{[@var{pid}]/@var{tid}} which specifies a certain thread ID
13897 within a process. If the optional @var{pid} part is missing, it means
13898 a thread from the process being debugged (the leading @samp{/} still
13899 needs to be present, or else @value{GDBN} will interpret the number as
13900 a process ID rather than a thread ID).
13901
13902 @item info proc mappings
13903 @cindex memory address space mappings
13904 Report the memory address space ranges accessible in the program, with
13905 information on whether the process has read, write, or execute access
13906 rights to each range. On @sc{gnu}/Linux systems, each memory range
13907 includes the object file which is mapped to that range, instead of the
13908 memory access rights to that range.
13909
13910 @item info proc stat
13911 @itemx info proc status
13912 @cindex process detailed status information
13913 These subcommands are specific to @sc{gnu}/Linux systems. They show
13914 the process-related information, including the user ID and group ID;
13915 how many threads are there in the process; its virtual memory usage;
13916 the signals that are pending, blocked, and ignored; its TTY; its
13917 consumption of system and user time; its stack size; its @samp{nice}
13918 value; etc. For more information, see the @samp{proc} man page
13919 (type @kbd{man 5 proc} from your shell prompt).
13920
13921 @item info proc all
13922 Show all the information about the process described under all of the
13923 above @code{info proc} subcommands.
13924
13925 @ignore
13926 @comment These sub-options of 'info proc' were not included when
13927 @comment procfs.c was re-written. Keep their descriptions around
13928 @comment against the day when someone finds the time to put them back in.
13929 @kindex info proc times
13930 @item info proc times
13931 Starting time, user CPU time, and system CPU time for your program and
13932 its children.
13933
13934 @kindex info proc id
13935 @item info proc id
13936 Report on the process IDs related to your program: its own process ID,
13937 the ID of its parent, the process group ID, and the session ID.
13938 @end ignore
13939
13940 @item set procfs-trace
13941 @kindex set procfs-trace
13942 @cindex @code{procfs} API calls
13943 This command enables and disables tracing of @code{procfs} API calls.
13944
13945 @item show procfs-trace
13946 @kindex show procfs-trace
13947 Show the current state of @code{procfs} API call tracing.
13948
13949 @item set procfs-file @var{file}
13950 @kindex set procfs-file
13951 Tell @value{GDBN} to write @code{procfs} API trace to the named
13952 @var{file}. @value{GDBN} appends the trace info to the previous
13953 contents of the file. The default is to display the trace on the
13954 standard output.
13955
13956 @item show procfs-file
13957 @kindex show procfs-file
13958 Show the file to which @code{procfs} API trace is written.
13959
13960 @item proc-trace-entry
13961 @itemx proc-trace-exit
13962 @itemx proc-untrace-entry
13963 @itemx proc-untrace-exit
13964 @kindex proc-trace-entry
13965 @kindex proc-trace-exit
13966 @kindex proc-untrace-entry
13967 @kindex proc-untrace-exit
13968 These commands enable and disable tracing of entries into and exits
13969 from the @code{syscall} interface.
13970
13971 @item info pidlist
13972 @kindex info pidlist
13973 @cindex process list, QNX Neutrino
13974 For QNX Neutrino only, this command displays the list of all the
13975 processes and all the threads within each process.
13976
13977 @item info meminfo
13978 @kindex info meminfo
13979 @cindex mapinfo list, QNX Neutrino
13980 For QNX Neutrino only, this command displays the list of all mapinfos.
13981 @end table
13982
13983 @node DJGPP Native
13984 @subsection Features for Debugging @sc{djgpp} Programs
13985 @cindex @sc{djgpp} debugging
13986 @cindex native @sc{djgpp} debugging
13987 @cindex MS-DOS-specific commands
13988
13989 @cindex DPMI
13990 @sc{djgpp} is a port of the @sc{gnu} development tools to MS-DOS and
13991 MS-Windows. @sc{djgpp} programs are 32-bit protected-mode programs
13992 that use the @dfn{DPMI} (DOS Protected-Mode Interface) API to run on
13993 top of real-mode DOS systems and their emulations.
13994
13995 @value{GDBN} supports native debugging of @sc{djgpp} programs, and
13996 defines a few commands specific to the @sc{djgpp} port. This
13997 subsection describes those commands.
13998
13999 @table @code
14000 @kindex info dos
14001 @item info dos
14002 This is a prefix of @sc{djgpp}-specific commands which print
14003 information about the target system and important OS structures.
14004
14005 @kindex sysinfo
14006 @cindex MS-DOS system info
14007 @cindex free memory information (MS-DOS)
14008 @item info dos sysinfo
14009 This command displays assorted information about the underlying
14010 platform: the CPU type and features, the OS version and flavor, the
14011 DPMI version, and the available conventional and DPMI memory.
14012
14013 @cindex GDT
14014 @cindex LDT
14015 @cindex IDT
14016 @cindex segment descriptor tables
14017 @cindex descriptor tables display
14018 @item info dos gdt
14019 @itemx info dos ldt
14020 @itemx info dos idt
14021 These 3 commands display entries from, respectively, Global, Local,
14022 and Interrupt Descriptor Tables (GDT, LDT, and IDT). The descriptor
14023 tables are data structures which store a descriptor for each segment
14024 that is currently in use. The segment's selector is an index into a
14025 descriptor table; the table entry for that index holds the
14026 descriptor's base address and limit, and its attributes and access
14027 rights.
14028
14029 A typical @sc{djgpp} program uses 3 segments: a code segment, a data
14030 segment (used for both data and the stack), and a DOS segment (which
14031 allows access to DOS/BIOS data structures and absolute addresses in
14032 conventional memory). However, the DPMI host will usually define
14033 additional segments in order to support the DPMI environment.
14034
14035 @cindex garbled pointers
14036 These commands allow to display entries from the descriptor tables.
14037 Without an argument, all entries from the specified table are
14038 displayed. An argument, which should be an integer expression, means
14039 display a single entry whose index is given by the argument. For
14040 example, here's a convenient way to display information about the
14041 debugged program's data segment:
14042
14043 @smallexample
14044 @exdent @code{(@value{GDBP}) info dos ldt $ds}
14045 @exdent @code{0x13f: base=0x11970000 limit=0x0009ffff 32-Bit Data (Read/Write, Exp-up)}
14046 @end smallexample
14047
14048 @noindent
14049 This comes in handy when you want to see whether a pointer is outside
14050 the data segment's limit (i.e.@: @dfn{garbled}).
14051
14052 @cindex page tables display (MS-DOS)
14053 @item info dos pde
14054 @itemx info dos pte
14055 These two commands display entries from, respectively, the Page
14056 Directory and the Page Tables. Page Directories and Page Tables are
14057 data structures which control how virtual memory addresses are mapped
14058 into physical addresses. A Page Table includes an entry for every
14059 page of memory that is mapped into the program's address space; there
14060 may be several Page Tables, each one holding up to 4096 entries. A
14061 Page Directory has up to 4096 entries, one each for every Page Table
14062 that is currently in use.
14063
14064 Without an argument, @kbd{info dos pde} displays the entire Page
14065 Directory, and @kbd{info dos pte} displays all the entries in all of
14066 the Page Tables. An argument, an integer expression, given to the
14067 @kbd{info dos pde} command means display only that entry from the Page
14068 Directory table. An argument given to the @kbd{info dos pte} command
14069 means display entries from a single Page Table, the one pointed to by
14070 the specified entry in the Page Directory.
14071
14072 @cindex direct memory access (DMA) on MS-DOS
14073 These commands are useful when your program uses @dfn{DMA} (Direct
14074 Memory Access), which needs physical addresses to program the DMA
14075 controller.
14076
14077 These commands are supported only with some DPMI servers.
14078
14079 @cindex physical address from linear address
14080 @item info dos address-pte @var{addr}
14081 This command displays the Page Table entry for a specified linear
14082 address. The argument @var{addr} is a linear address which should
14083 already have the appropriate segment's base address added to it,
14084 because this command accepts addresses which may belong to @emph{any}
14085 segment. For example, here's how to display the Page Table entry for
14086 the page where a variable @code{i} is stored:
14087
14088 @smallexample
14089 @exdent @code{(@value{GDBP}) info dos address-pte __djgpp_base_address + (char *)&i}
14090 @exdent @code{Page Table entry for address 0x11a00d30:}
14091 @exdent @code{Base=0x02698000 Dirty Acc. Not-Cached Write-Back Usr Read-Write +0xd30}
14092 @end smallexample
14093
14094 @noindent
14095 This says that @code{i} is stored at offset @code{0xd30} from the page
14096 whose physical base address is @code{0x02698000}, and shows all the
14097 attributes of that page.
14098
14099 Note that you must cast the addresses of variables to a @code{char *},
14100 since otherwise the value of @code{__djgpp_base_address}, the base
14101 address of all variables and functions in a @sc{djgpp} program, will
14102 be added using the rules of C pointer arithmetics: if @code{i} is
14103 declared an @code{int}, @value{GDBN} will add 4 times the value of
14104 @code{__djgpp_base_address} to the address of @code{i}.
14105
14106 Here's another example, it displays the Page Table entry for the
14107 transfer buffer:
14108
14109 @smallexample
14110 @exdent @code{(@value{GDBP}) info dos address-pte *((unsigned *)&_go32_info_block + 3)}
14111 @exdent @code{Page Table entry for address 0x29110:}
14112 @exdent @code{Base=0x00029000 Dirty Acc. Not-Cached Write-Back Usr Read-Write +0x110}
14113 @end smallexample
14114
14115 @noindent
14116 (The @code{+ 3} offset is because the transfer buffer's address is the
14117 3rd member of the @code{_go32_info_block} structure.) The output
14118 clearly shows that this DPMI server maps the addresses in conventional
14119 memory 1:1, i.e.@: the physical (@code{0x00029000} + @code{0x110}) and
14120 linear (@code{0x29110}) addresses are identical.
14121
14122 This command is supported only with some DPMI servers.
14123 @end table
14124
14125 @cindex DOS serial data link, remote debugging
14126 In addition to native debugging, the DJGPP port supports remote
14127 debugging via a serial data link. The following commands are specific
14128 to remote serial debugging in the DJGPP port of @value{GDBN}.
14129
14130 @table @code
14131 @kindex set com1base
14132 @kindex set com1irq
14133 @kindex set com2base
14134 @kindex set com2irq
14135 @kindex set com3base
14136 @kindex set com3irq
14137 @kindex set com4base
14138 @kindex set com4irq
14139 @item set com1base @var{addr}
14140 This command sets the base I/O port address of the @file{COM1} serial
14141 port.
14142
14143 @item set com1irq @var{irq}
14144 This command sets the @dfn{Interrupt Request} (@code{IRQ}) line to use
14145 for the @file{COM1} serial port.
14146
14147 There are similar commands @samp{set com2base}, @samp{set com3irq},
14148 etc.@: for setting the port address and the @code{IRQ} lines for the
14149 other 3 COM ports.
14150
14151 @kindex show com1base
14152 @kindex show com1irq
14153 @kindex show com2base
14154 @kindex show com2irq
14155 @kindex show com3base
14156 @kindex show com3irq
14157 @kindex show com4base
14158 @kindex show com4irq
14159 The related commands @samp{show com1base}, @samp{show com1irq} etc.@:
14160 display the current settings of the base address and the @code{IRQ}
14161 lines used by the COM ports.
14162
14163 @item info serial
14164 @kindex info serial
14165 @cindex DOS serial port status
14166 This command prints the status of the 4 DOS serial ports. For each
14167 port, it prints whether it's active or not, its I/O base address and
14168 IRQ number, whether it uses a 16550-style FIFO, its baudrate, and the
14169 counts of various errors encountered so far.
14170 @end table
14171
14172
14173 @node Cygwin Native
14174 @subsection Features for Debugging MS Windows PE Executables
14175 @cindex MS Windows debugging
14176 @cindex native Cygwin debugging
14177 @cindex Cygwin-specific commands
14178
14179 @value{GDBN} supports native debugging of MS Windows programs, including
14180 DLLs with and without symbolic debugging information. There are various
14181 additional Cygwin-specific commands, described in this section.
14182 Working with DLLs that have no debugging symbols is described in
14183 @ref{Non-debug DLL Symbols}.
14184
14185 @table @code
14186 @kindex info w32
14187 @item info w32
14188 This is a prefix of MS Windows-specific commands which print
14189 information about the target system and important OS structures.
14190
14191 @item info w32 selector
14192 This command displays information returned by
14193 the Win32 API @code{GetThreadSelectorEntry} function.
14194 It takes an optional argument that is evaluated to
14195 a long value to give the information about this given selector.
14196 Without argument, this command displays information
14197 about the six segment registers.
14198
14199 @kindex info dll
14200 @item info dll
14201 This is a Cygwin-specific alias of @code{info shared}.
14202
14203 @kindex dll-symbols
14204 @item dll-symbols
14205 This command loads symbols from a dll similarly to
14206 add-sym command but without the need to specify a base address.
14207
14208 @kindex set cygwin-exceptions
14209 @cindex debugging the Cygwin DLL
14210 @cindex Cygwin DLL, debugging
14211 @item set cygwin-exceptions @var{mode}
14212 If @var{mode} is @code{on}, @value{GDBN} will break on exceptions that
14213 happen inside the Cygwin DLL. If @var{mode} is @code{off},
14214 @value{GDBN} will delay recognition of exceptions, and may ignore some
14215 exceptions which seem to be caused by internal Cygwin DLL
14216 ``bookkeeping''. This option is meant primarily for debugging the
14217 Cygwin DLL itself; the default value is @code{off} to avoid annoying
14218 @value{GDBN} users with false @code{SIGSEGV} signals.
14219
14220 @kindex show cygwin-exceptions
14221 @item show cygwin-exceptions
14222 Displays whether @value{GDBN} will break on exceptions that happen
14223 inside the Cygwin DLL itself.
14224
14225 @kindex set new-console
14226 @item set new-console @var{mode}
14227 If @var{mode} is @code{on} the debuggee will
14228 be started in a new console on next start.
14229 If @var{mode} is @code{off}i, the debuggee will
14230 be started in the same console as the debugger.
14231
14232 @kindex show new-console
14233 @item show new-console
14234 Displays whether a new console is used
14235 when the debuggee is started.
14236
14237 @kindex set new-group
14238 @item set new-group @var{mode}
14239 This boolean value controls whether the debuggee should
14240 start a new group or stay in the same group as the debugger.
14241 This affects the way the Windows OS handles
14242 @samp{Ctrl-C}.
14243
14244 @kindex show new-group
14245 @item show new-group
14246 Displays current value of new-group boolean.
14247
14248 @kindex set debugevents
14249 @item set debugevents
14250 This boolean value adds debug output concerning kernel events related
14251 to the debuggee seen by the debugger. This includes events that
14252 signal thread and process creation and exit, DLL loading and
14253 unloading, console interrupts, and debugging messages produced by the
14254 Windows @code{OutputDebugString} API call.
14255
14256 @kindex set debugexec
14257 @item set debugexec
14258 This boolean value adds debug output concerning execute events
14259 (such as resume thread) seen by the debugger.
14260
14261 @kindex set debugexceptions
14262 @item set debugexceptions
14263 This boolean value adds debug output concerning exceptions in the
14264 debuggee seen by the debugger.
14265
14266 @kindex set debugmemory
14267 @item set debugmemory
14268 This boolean value adds debug output concerning debuggee memory reads
14269 and writes by the debugger.
14270
14271 @kindex set shell
14272 @item set shell
14273 This boolean values specifies whether the debuggee is called
14274 via a shell or directly (default value is on).
14275
14276 @kindex show shell
14277 @item show shell
14278 Displays if the debuggee will be started with a shell.
14279
14280 @end table
14281
14282 @menu
14283 * Non-debug DLL Symbols:: Support for DLLs without debugging symbols
14284 @end menu
14285
14286 @node Non-debug DLL Symbols
14287 @subsubsection Support for DLLs without Debugging Symbols
14288 @cindex DLLs with no debugging symbols
14289 @cindex Minimal symbols and DLLs
14290
14291 Very often on windows, some of the DLLs that your program relies on do
14292 not include symbolic debugging information (for example,
14293 @file{kernel32.dll}). When @value{GDBN} doesn't recognize any debugging
14294 symbols in a DLL, it relies on the minimal amount of symbolic
14295 information contained in the DLL's export table. This section
14296 describes working with such symbols, known internally to @value{GDBN} as
14297 ``minimal symbols''.
14298
14299 Note that before the debugged program has started execution, no DLLs
14300 will have been loaded. The easiest way around this problem is simply to
14301 start the program --- either by setting a breakpoint or letting the
14302 program run once to completion. It is also possible to force
14303 @value{GDBN} to load a particular DLL before starting the executable ---
14304 see the shared library information in @ref{Files}, or the
14305 @code{dll-symbols} command in @ref{Cygwin Native}. Currently,
14306 explicitly loading symbols from a DLL with no debugging information will
14307 cause the symbol names to be duplicated in @value{GDBN}'s lookup table,
14308 which may adversely affect symbol lookup performance.
14309
14310 @subsubsection DLL Name Prefixes
14311
14312 In keeping with the naming conventions used by the Microsoft debugging
14313 tools, DLL export symbols are made available with a prefix based on the
14314 DLL name, for instance @code{KERNEL32!CreateFileA}. The plain name is
14315 also entered into the symbol table, so @code{CreateFileA} is often
14316 sufficient. In some cases there will be name clashes within a program
14317 (particularly if the executable itself includes full debugging symbols)
14318 necessitating the use of the fully qualified name when referring to the
14319 contents of the DLL. Use single-quotes around the name to avoid the
14320 exclamation mark (``!'') being interpreted as a language operator.
14321
14322 Note that the internal name of the DLL may be all upper-case, even
14323 though the file name of the DLL is lower-case, or vice-versa. Since
14324 symbols within @value{GDBN} are @emph{case-sensitive} this may cause
14325 some confusion. If in doubt, try the @code{info functions} and
14326 @code{info variables} commands or even @code{maint print msymbols}
14327 (@pxref{Symbols}). Here's an example:
14328
14329 @smallexample
14330 (@value{GDBP}) info function CreateFileA
14331 All functions matching regular expression "CreateFileA":
14332
14333 Non-debugging symbols:
14334 0x77e885f4 CreateFileA
14335 0x77e885f4 KERNEL32!CreateFileA
14336 @end smallexample
14337
14338 @smallexample
14339 (@value{GDBP}) info function !
14340 All functions matching regular expression "!":
14341
14342 Non-debugging symbols:
14343 0x6100114c cygwin1!__assert
14344 0x61004034 cygwin1!_dll_crt0@@0
14345 0x61004240 cygwin1!dll_crt0(per_process *)
14346 [etc...]
14347 @end smallexample
14348
14349 @subsubsection Working with Minimal Symbols
14350
14351 Symbols extracted from a DLL's export table do not contain very much
14352 type information. All that @value{GDBN} can do is guess whether a symbol
14353 refers to a function or variable depending on the linker section that
14354 contains the symbol. Also note that the actual contents of the memory
14355 contained in a DLL are not available unless the program is running. This
14356 means that you cannot examine the contents of a variable or disassemble
14357 a function within a DLL without a running program.
14358
14359 Variables are generally treated as pointers and dereferenced
14360 automatically. For this reason, it is often necessary to prefix a
14361 variable name with the address-of operator (``&'') and provide explicit
14362 type information in the command. Here's an example of the type of
14363 problem:
14364
14365 @smallexample
14366 (@value{GDBP}) print 'cygwin1!__argv'
14367 $1 = 268572168
14368 @end smallexample
14369
14370 @smallexample
14371 (@value{GDBP}) x 'cygwin1!__argv'
14372 0x10021610: "\230y\""
14373 @end smallexample
14374
14375 And two possible solutions:
14376
14377 @smallexample
14378 (@value{GDBP}) print ((char **)'cygwin1!__argv')[0]
14379 $2 = 0x22fd98 "/cygdrive/c/mydirectory/myprogram"
14380 @end smallexample
14381
14382 @smallexample
14383 (@value{GDBP}) x/2x &'cygwin1!__argv'
14384 0x610c0aa8 <cygwin1!__argv>: 0x10021608 0x00000000
14385 (@value{GDBP}) x/x 0x10021608
14386 0x10021608: 0x0022fd98
14387 (@value{GDBP}) x/s 0x0022fd98
14388 0x22fd98: "/cygdrive/c/mydirectory/myprogram"
14389 @end smallexample
14390
14391 Setting a break point within a DLL is possible even before the program
14392 starts execution. However, under these circumstances, @value{GDBN} can't
14393 examine the initial instructions of the function in order to skip the
14394 function's frame set-up code. You can work around this by using ``*&''
14395 to set the breakpoint at a raw memory address:
14396
14397 @smallexample
14398 (@value{GDBP}) break *&'python22!PyOS_Readline'
14399 Breakpoint 1 at 0x1e04eff0
14400 @end smallexample
14401
14402 The author of these extensions is not entirely convinced that setting a
14403 break point within a shared DLL like @file{kernel32.dll} is completely
14404 safe.
14405
14406 @node Hurd Native
14407 @subsection Commands Specific to @sc{gnu} Hurd Systems
14408 @cindex @sc{gnu} Hurd debugging
14409
14410 This subsection describes @value{GDBN} commands specific to the
14411 @sc{gnu} Hurd native debugging.
14412
14413 @table @code
14414 @item set signals
14415 @itemx set sigs
14416 @kindex set signals@r{, Hurd command}
14417 @kindex set sigs@r{, Hurd command}
14418 This command toggles the state of inferior signal interception by
14419 @value{GDBN}. Mach exceptions, such as breakpoint traps, are not
14420 affected by this command. @code{sigs} is a shorthand alias for
14421 @code{signals}.
14422
14423 @item show signals
14424 @itemx show sigs
14425 @kindex show signals@r{, Hurd command}
14426 @kindex show sigs@r{, Hurd command}
14427 Show the current state of intercepting inferior's signals.
14428
14429 @item set signal-thread
14430 @itemx set sigthread
14431 @kindex set signal-thread
14432 @kindex set sigthread
14433 This command tells @value{GDBN} which thread is the @code{libc} signal
14434 thread. That thread is run when a signal is delivered to a running
14435 process. @code{set sigthread} is the shorthand alias of @code{set
14436 signal-thread}.
14437
14438 @item show signal-thread
14439 @itemx show sigthread
14440 @kindex show signal-thread
14441 @kindex show sigthread
14442 These two commands show which thread will run when the inferior is
14443 delivered a signal.
14444
14445 @item set stopped
14446 @kindex set stopped@r{, Hurd command}
14447 This commands tells @value{GDBN} that the inferior process is stopped,
14448 as with the @code{SIGSTOP} signal. The stopped process can be
14449 continued by delivering a signal to it.
14450
14451 @item show stopped
14452 @kindex show stopped@r{, Hurd command}
14453 This command shows whether @value{GDBN} thinks the debuggee is
14454 stopped.
14455
14456 @item set exceptions
14457 @kindex set exceptions@r{, Hurd command}
14458 Use this command to turn off trapping of exceptions in the inferior.
14459 When exception trapping is off, neither breakpoints nor
14460 single-stepping will work. To restore the default, set exception
14461 trapping on.
14462
14463 @item show exceptions
14464 @kindex show exceptions@r{, Hurd command}
14465 Show the current state of trapping exceptions in the inferior.
14466
14467 @item set task pause
14468 @kindex set task@r{, Hurd commands}
14469 @cindex task attributes (@sc{gnu} Hurd)
14470 @cindex pause current task (@sc{gnu} Hurd)
14471 This command toggles task suspension when @value{GDBN} has control.
14472 Setting it to on takes effect immediately, and the task is suspended
14473 whenever @value{GDBN} gets control. Setting it to off will take
14474 effect the next time the inferior is continued. If this option is set
14475 to off, you can use @code{set thread default pause on} or @code{set
14476 thread pause on} (see below) to pause individual threads.
14477
14478 @item show task pause
14479 @kindex show task@r{, Hurd commands}
14480 Show the current state of task suspension.
14481
14482 @item set task detach-suspend-count
14483 @cindex task suspend count
14484 @cindex detach from task, @sc{gnu} Hurd
14485 This command sets the suspend count the task will be left with when
14486 @value{GDBN} detaches from it.
14487
14488 @item show task detach-suspend-count
14489 Show the suspend count the task will be left with when detaching.
14490
14491 @item set task exception-port
14492 @itemx set task excp
14493 @cindex task exception port, @sc{gnu} Hurd
14494 This command sets the task exception port to which @value{GDBN} will
14495 forward exceptions. The argument should be the value of the @dfn{send
14496 rights} of the task. @code{set task excp} is a shorthand alias.
14497
14498 @item set noninvasive
14499 @cindex noninvasive task options
14500 This command switches @value{GDBN} to a mode that is the least
14501 invasive as far as interfering with the inferior is concerned. This
14502 is the same as using @code{set task pause}, @code{set exceptions}, and
14503 @code{set signals} to values opposite to the defaults.
14504
14505 @item info send-rights
14506 @itemx info receive-rights
14507 @itemx info port-rights
14508 @itemx info port-sets
14509 @itemx info dead-names
14510 @itemx info ports
14511 @itemx info psets
14512 @cindex send rights, @sc{gnu} Hurd
14513 @cindex receive rights, @sc{gnu} Hurd
14514 @cindex port rights, @sc{gnu} Hurd
14515 @cindex port sets, @sc{gnu} Hurd
14516 @cindex dead names, @sc{gnu} Hurd
14517 These commands display information about, respectively, send rights,
14518 receive rights, port rights, port sets, and dead names of a task.
14519 There are also shorthand aliases: @code{info ports} for @code{info
14520 port-rights} and @code{info psets} for @code{info port-sets}.
14521
14522 @item set thread pause
14523 @kindex set thread@r{, Hurd command}
14524 @cindex thread properties, @sc{gnu} Hurd
14525 @cindex pause current thread (@sc{gnu} Hurd)
14526 This command toggles current thread suspension when @value{GDBN} has
14527 control. Setting it to on takes effect immediately, and the current
14528 thread is suspended whenever @value{GDBN} gets control. Setting it to
14529 off will take effect the next time the inferior is continued.
14530 Normally, this command has no effect, since when @value{GDBN} has
14531 control, the whole task is suspended. However, if you used @code{set
14532 task pause off} (see above), this command comes in handy to suspend
14533 only the current thread.
14534
14535 @item show thread pause
14536 @kindex show thread@r{, Hurd command}
14537 This command shows the state of current thread suspension.
14538
14539 @item set thread run
14540 This command sets whether the current thread is allowed to run.
14541
14542 @item show thread run
14543 Show whether the current thread is allowed to run.
14544
14545 @item set thread detach-suspend-count
14546 @cindex thread suspend count, @sc{gnu} Hurd
14547 @cindex detach from thread, @sc{gnu} Hurd
14548 This command sets the suspend count @value{GDBN} will leave on a
14549 thread when detaching. This number is relative to the suspend count
14550 found by @value{GDBN} when it notices the thread; use @code{set thread
14551 takeover-suspend-count} to force it to an absolute value.
14552
14553 @item show thread detach-suspend-count
14554 Show the suspend count @value{GDBN} will leave on the thread when
14555 detaching.
14556
14557 @item set thread exception-port
14558 @itemx set thread excp
14559 Set the thread exception port to which to forward exceptions. This
14560 overrides the port set by @code{set task exception-port} (see above).
14561 @code{set thread excp} is the shorthand alias.
14562
14563 @item set thread takeover-suspend-count
14564 Normally, @value{GDBN}'s thread suspend counts are relative to the
14565 value @value{GDBN} finds when it notices each thread. This command
14566 changes the suspend counts to be absolute instead.
14567
14568 @item set thread default
14569 @itemx show thread default
14570 @cindex thread default settings, @sc{gnu} Hurd
14571 Each of the above @code{set thread} commands has a @code{set thread
14572 default} counterpart (e.g., @code{set thread default pause}, @code{set
14573 thread default exception-port}, etc.). The @code{thread default}
14574 variety of commands sets the default thread properties for all
14575 threads; you can then change the properties of individual threads with
14576 the non-default commands.
14577 @end table
14578
14579
14580 @node Neutrino
14581 @subsection QNX Neutrino
14582 @cindex QNX Neutrino
14583
14584 @value{GDBN} provides the following commands specific to the QNX
14585 Neutrino target:
14586
14587 @table @code
14588 @item set debug nto-debug
14589 @kindex set debug nto-debug
14590 When set to on, enables debugging messages specific to the QNX
14591 Neutrino support.
14592
14593 @item show debug nto-debug
14594 @kindex show debug nto-debug
14595 Show the current state of QNX Neutrino messages.
14596 @end table
14597
14598
14599 @node Embedded OS
14600 @section Embedded Operating Systems
14601
14602 This section describes configurations involving the debugging of
14603 embedded operating systems that are available for several different
14604 architectures.
14605
14606 @menu
14607 * VxWorks:: Using @value{GDBN} with VxWorks
14608 @end menu
14609
14610 @value{GDBN} includes the ability to debug programs running on
14611 various real-time operating systems.
14612
14613 @node VxWorks
14614 @subsection Using @value{GDBN} with VxWorks
14615
14616 @cindex VxWorks
14617
14618 @table @code
14619
14620 @kindex target vxworks
14621 @item target vxworks @var{machinename}
14622 A VxWorks system, attached via TCP/IP. The argument @var{machinename}
14623 is the target system's machine name or IP address.
14624
14625 @end table
14626
14627 On VxWorks, @code{load} links @var{filename} dynamically on the
14628 current target system as well as adding its symbols in @value{GDBN}.
14629
14630 @value{GDBN} enables developers to spawn and debug tasks running on networked
14631 VxWorks targets from a Unix host. Already-running tasks spawned from
14632 the VxWorks shell can also be debugged. @value{GDBN} uses code that runs on
14633 both the Unix host and on the VxWorks target. The program
14634 @code{@value{GDBP}} is installed and executed on the Unix host. (It may be
14635 installed with the name @code{vxgdb}, to distinguish it from a
14636 @value{GDBN} for debugging programs on the host itself.)
14637
14638 @table @code
14639 @item VxWorks-timeout @var{args}
14640 @kindex vxworks-timeout
14641 All VxWorks-based targets now support the option @code{vxworks-timeout}.
14642 This option is set by the user, and @var{args} represents the number of
14643 seconds @value{GDBN} waits for responses to rpc's. You might use this if
14644 your VxWorks target is a slow software simulator or is on the far side
14645 of a thin network line.
14646 @end table
14647
14648 The following information on connecting to VxWorks was current when
14649 this manual was produced; newer releases of VxWorks may use revised
14650 procedures.
14651
14652 @findex INCLUDE_RDB
14653 To use @value{GDBN} with VxWorks, you must rebuild your VxWorks kernel
14654 to include the remote debugging interface routines in the VxWorks
14655 library @file{rdb.a}. To do this, define @code{INCLUDE_RDB} in the
14656 VxWorks configuration file @file{configAll.h} and rebuild your VxWorks
14657 kernel. The resulting kernel contains @file{rdb.a}, and spawns the
14658 source debugging task @code{tRdbTask} when VxWorks is booted. For more
14659 information on configuring and remaking VxWorks, see the manufacturer's
14660 manual.
14661 @c VxWorks, see the @cite{VxWorks Programmer's Guide}.
14662
14663 Once you have included @file{rdb.a} in your VxWorks system image and set
14664 your Unix execution search path to find @value{GDBN}, you are ready to
14665 run @value{GDBN}. From your Unix host, run @code{@value{GDBP}} (or
14666 @code{vxgdb}, depending on your installation).
14667
14668 @value{GDBN} comes up showing the prompt:
14669
14670 @smallexample
14671 (vxgdb)
14672 @end smallexample
14673
14674 @menu
14675 * VxWorks Connection:: Connecting to VxWorks
14676 * VxWorks Download:: VxWorks download
14677 * VxWorks Attach:: Running tasks
14678 @end menu
14679
14680 @node VxWorks Connection
14681 @subsubsection Connecting to VxWorks
14682
14683 The @value{GDBN} command @code{target} lets you connect to a VxWorks target on the
14684 network. To connect to a target whose host name is ``@code{tt}'', type:
14685
14686 @smallexample
14687 (vxgdb) target vxworks tt
14688 @end smallexample
14689
14690 @need 750
14691 @value{GDBN} displays messages like these:
14692
14693 @smallexample
14694 Attaching remote machine across net...
14695 Connected to tt.
14696 @end smallexample
14697
14698 @need 1000
14699 @value{GDBN} then attempts to read the symbol tables of any object modules
14700 loaded into the VxWorks target since it was last booted. @value{GDBN} locates
14701 these files by searching the directories listed in the command search
14702 path (@pxref{Environment, ,Your Program's Environment}); if it fails
14703 to find an object file, it displays a message such as:
14704
14705 @smallexample
14706 prog.o: No such file or directory.
14707 @end smallexample
14708
14709 When this happens, add the appropriate directory to the search path with
14710 the @value{GDBN} command @code{path}, and execute the @code{target}
14711 command again.
14712
14713 @node VxWorks Download
14714 @subsubsection VxWorks Download
14715
14716 @cindex download to VxWorks
14717 If you have connected to the VxWorks target and you want to debug an
14718 object that has not yet been loaded, you can use the @value{GDBN}
14719 @code{load} command to download a file from Unix to VxWorks
14720 incrementally. The object file given as an argument to the @code{load}
14721 command is actually opened twice: first by the VxWorks target in order
14722 to download the code, then by @value{GDBN} in order to read the symbol
14723 table. This can lead to problems if the current working directories on
14724 the two systems differ. If both systems have NFS mounted the same
14725 filesystems, you can avoid these problems by using absolute paths.
14726 Otherwise, it is simplest to set the working directory on both systems
14727 to the directory in which the object file resides, and then to reference
14728 the file by its name, without any path. For instance, a program
14729 @file{prog.o} may reside in @file{@var{vxpath}/vw/demo/rdb} in VxWorks
14730 and in @file{@var{hostpath}/vw/demo/rdb} on the host. To load this
14731 program, type this on VxWorks:
14732
14733 @smallexample
14734 -> cd "@var{vxpath}/vw/demo/rdb"
14735 @end smallexample
14736
14737 @noindent
14738 Then, in @value{GDBN}, type:
14739
14740 @smallexample
14741 (vxgdb) cd @var{hostpath}/vw/demo/rdb
14742 (vxgdb) load prog.o
14743 @end smallexample
14744
14745 @value{GDBN} displays a response similar to this:
14746
14747 @smallexample
14748 Reading symbol data from wherever/vw/demo/rdb/prog.o... done.
14749 @end smallexample
14750
14751 You can also use the @code{load} command to reload an object module
14752 after editing and recompiling the corresponding source file. Note that
14753 this makes @value{GDBN} delete all currently-defined breakpoints,
14754 auto-displays, and convenience variables, and to clear the value
14755 history. (This is necessary in order to preserve the integrity of
14756 debugger's data structures that reference the target system's symbol
14757 table.)
14758
14759 @node VxWorks Attach
14760 @subsubsection Running Tasks
14761
14762 @cindex running VxWorks tasks
14763 You can also attach to an existing task using the @code{attach} command as
14764 follows:
14765
14766 @smallexample
14767 (vxgdb) attach @var{task}
14768 @end smallexample
14769
14770 @noindent
14771 where @var{task} is the VxWorks hexadecimal task ID. The task can be running
14772 or suspended when you attach to it. Running tasks are suspended at
14773 the time of attachment.
14774
14775 @node Embedded Processors
14776 @section Embedded Processors
14777
14778 This section goes into details specific to particular embedded
14779 configurations.
14780
14781 @cindex send command to simulator
14782 Whenever a specific embedded processor has a simulator, @value{GDBN}
14783 allows to send an arbitrary command to the simulator.
14784
14785 @table @code
14786 @item sim @var{command}
14787 @kindex sim@r{, a command}
14788 Send an arbitrary @var{command} string to the simulator. Consult the
14789 documentation for the specific simulator in use for information about
14790 acceptable commands.
14791 @end table
14792
14793
14794 @menu
14795 * ARM:: ARM RDI
14796 * M32R/D:: Renesas M32R/D
14797 * M68K:: Motorola M68K
14798 * MIPS Embedded:: MIPS Embedded
14799 * OpenRISC 1000:: OpenRisc 1000
14800 * PA:: HP PA Embedded
14801 * PowerPC Embedded:: PowerPC Embedded
14802 * Sparclet:: Tsqware Sparclet
14803 * Sparclite:: Fujitsu Sparclite
14804 * Z8000:: Zilog Z8000
14805 * AVR:: Atmel AVR
14806 * CRIS:: CRIS
14807 * Super-H:: Renesas Super-H
14808 @end menu
14809
14810 @node ARM
14811 @subsection ARM
14812 @cindex ARM RDI
14813
14814 @table @code
14815 @kindex target rdi
14816 @item target rdi @var{dev}
14817 ARM Angel monitor, via RDI library interface to ADP protocol. You may
14818 use this target to communicate with both boards running the Angel
14819 monitor, or with the EmbeddedICE JTAG debug device.
14820
14821 @kindex target rdp
14822 @item target rdp @var{dev}
14823 ARM Demon monitor.
14824
14825 @end table
14826
14827 @value{GDBN} provides the following ARM-specific commands:
14828
14829 @table @code
14830 @item set arm disassembler
14831 @kindex set arm
14832 This commands selects from a list of disassembly styles. The
14833 @code{"std"} style is the standard style.
14834
14835 @item show arm disassembler
14836 @kindex show arm
14837 Show the current disassembly style.
14838
14839 @item set arm apcs32
14840 @cindex ARM 32-bit mode
14841 This command toggles ARM operation mode between 32-bit and 26-bit.
14842
14843 @item show arm apcs32
14844 Display the current usage of the ARM 32-bit mode.
14845
14846 @item set arm fpu @var{fputype}
14847 This command sets the ARM floating-point unit (FPU) type. The
14848 argument @var{fputype} can be one of these:
14849
14850 @table @code
14851 @item auto
14852 Determine the FPU type by querying the OS ABI.
14853 @item softfpa
14854 Software FPU, with mixed-endian doubles on little-endian ARM
14855 processors.
14856 @item fpa
14857 GCC-compiled FPA co-processor.
14858 @item softvfp
14859 Software FPU with pure-endian doubles.
14860 @item vfp
14861 VFP co-processor.
14862 @end table
14863
14864 @item show arm fpu
14865 Show the current type of the FPU.
14866
14867 @item set arm abi
14868 This command forces @value{GDBN} to use the specified ABI.
14869
14870 @item show arm abi
14871 Show the currently used ABI.
14872
14873 @item set debug arm
14874 Toggle whether to display ARM-specific debugging messages from the ARM
14875 target support subsystem.
14876
14877 @item show debug arm
14878 Show whether ARM-specific debugging messages are enabled.
14879 @end table
14880
14881 The following commands are available when an ARM target is debugged
14882 using the RDI interface:
14883
14884 @table @code
14885 @item rdilogfile @r{[}@var{file}@r{]}
14886 @kindex rdilogfile
14887 @cindex ADP (Angel Debugger Protocol) logging
14888 Set the filename for the ADP (Angel Debugger Protocol) packet log.
14889 With an argument, sets the log file to the specified @var{file}. With
14890 no argument, show the current log file name. The default log file is
14891 @file{rdi.log}.
14892
14893 @item rdilogenable @r{[}@var{arg}@r{]}
14894 @kindex rdilogenable
14895 Control logging of ADP packets. With an argument of 1 or @code{"yes"}
14896 enables logging, with an argument 0 or @code{"no"} disables it. With
14897 no arguments displays the current setting. When logging is enabled,
14898 ADP packets exchanged between @value{GDBN} and the RDI target device
14899 are logged to a file.
14900
14901 @item set rdiromatzero
14902 @kindex set rdiromatzero
14903 @cindex ROM at zero address, RDI
14904 Tell @value{GDBN} whether the target has ROM at address 0. If on,
14905 vector catching is disabled, so that zero address can be used. If off
14906 (the default), vector catching is enabled. For this command to take
14907 effect, it needs to be invoked prior to the @code{target rdi} command.
14908
14909 @item show rdiromatzero
14910 @kindex show rdiromatzero
14911 Show the current setting of ROM at zero address.
14912
14913 @item set rdiheartbeat
14914 @kindex set rdiheartbeat
14915 @cindex RDI heartbeat
14916 Enable or disable RDI heartbeat packets. It is not recommended to
14917 turn on this option, since it confuses ARM and EPI JTAG interface, as
14918 well as the Angel monitor.
14919
14920 @item show rdiheartbeat
14921 @kindex show rdiheartbeat
14922 Show the setting of RDI heartbeat packets.
14923 @end table
14924
14925
14926 @node M32R/D
14927 @subsection Renesas M32R/D and M32R/SDI
14928
14929 @table @code
14930 @kindex target m32r
14931 @item target m32r @var{dev}
14932 Renesas M32R/D ROM monitor.
14933
14934 @kindex target m32rsdi
14935 @item target m32rsdi @var{dev}
14936 Renesas M32R SDI server, connected via parallel port to the board.
14937 @end table
14938
14939 The following @value{GDBN} commands are specific to the M32R monitor:
14940
14941 @table @code
14942 @item set download-path @var{path}
14943 @kindex set download-path
14944 @cindex find downloadable @sc{srec} files (M32R)
14945 Set the default path for finding downloadable @sc{srec} files.
14946
14947 @item show download-path
14948 @kindex show download-path
14949 Show the default path for downloadable @sc{srec} files.
14950
14951 @item set board-address @var{addr}
14952 @kindex set board-address
14953 @cindex M32-EVA target board address
14954 Set the IP address for the M32R-EVA target board.
14955
14956 @item show board-address
14957 @kindex show board-address
14958 Show the current IP address of the target board.
14959
14960 @item set server-address @var{addr}
14961 @kindex set server-address
14962 @cindex download server address (M32R)
14963 Set the IP address for the download server, which is the @value{GDBN}'s
14964 host machine.
14965
14966 @item show server-address
14967 @kindex show server-address
14968 Display the IP address of the download server.
14969
14970 @item upload @r{[}@var{file}@r{]}
14971 @kindex upload@r{, M32R}
14972 Upload the specified @sc{srec} @var{file} via the monitor's Ethernet
14973 upload capability. If no @var{file} argument is given, the current
14974 executable file is uploaded.
14975
14976 @item tload @r{[}@var{file}@r{]}
14977 @kindex tload@r{, M32R}
14978 Test the @code{upload} command.
14979 @end table
14980
14981 The following commands are available for M32R/SDI:
14982
14983 @table @code
14984 @item sdireset
14985 @kindex sdireset
14986 @cindex reset SDI connection, M32R
14987 This command resets the SDI connection.
14988
14989 @item sdistatus
14990 @kindex sdistatus
14991 This command shows the SDI connection status.
14992
14993 @item debug_chaos
14994 @kindex debug_chaos
14995 @cindex M32R/Chaos debugging
14996 Instructs the remote that M32R/Chaos debugging is to be used.
14997
14998 @item use_debug_dma
14999 @kindex use_debug_dma
15000 Instructs the remote to use the DEBUG_DMA method of accessing memory.
15001
15002 @item use_mon_code
15003 @kindex use_mon_code
15004 Instructs the remote to use the MON_CODE method of accessing memory.
15005
15006 @item use_ib_break
15007 @kindex use_ib_break
15008 Instructs the remote to set breakpoints by IB break.
15009
15010 @item use_dbt_break
15011 @kindex use_dbt_break
15012 Instructs the remote to set breakpoints by DBT.
15013 @end table
15014
15015 @node M68K
15016 @subsection M68k
15017
15018 The Motorola m68k configuration includes ColdFire support, and a
15019 target command for the following ROM monitor.
15020
15021 @table @code
15022
15023 @kindex target dbug
15024 @item target dbug @var{dev}
15025 dBUG ROM monitor for Motorola ColdFire.
15026
15027 @end table
15028
15029 @node MIPS Embedded
15030 @subsection MIPS Embedded
15031
15032 @cindex MIPS boards
15033 @value{GDBN} can use the MIPS remote debugging protocol to talk to a
15034 MIPS board attached to a serial line. This is available when
15035 you configure @value{GDBN} with @samp{--target=mips-idt-ecoff}.
15036
15037 @need 1000
15038 Use these @value{GDBN} commands to specify the connection to your target board:
15039
15040 @table @code
15041 @item target mips @var{port}
15042 @kindex target mips @var{port}
15043 To run a program on the board, start up @code{@value{GDBP}} with the
15044 name of your program as the argument. To connect to the board, use the
15045 command @samp{target mips @var{port}}, where @var{port} is the name of
15046 the serial port connected to the board. If the program has not already
15047 been downloaded to the board, you may use the @code{load} command to
15048 download it. You can then use all the usual @value{GDBN} commands.
15049
15050 For example, this sequence connects to the target board through a serial
15051 port, and loads and runs a program called @var{prog} through the
15052 debugger:
15053
15054 @smallexample
15055 host$ @value{GDBP} @var{prog}
15056 @value{GDBN} is free software and @dots{}
15057 (@value{GDBP}) target mips /dev/ttyb
15058 (@value{GDBP}) load @var{prog}
15059 (@value{GDBP}) run
15060 @end smallexample
15061
15062 @item target mips @var{hostname}:@var{portnumber}
15063 On some @value{GDBN} host configurations, you can specify a TCP
15064 connection (for instance, to a serial line managed by a terminal
15065 concentrator) instead of a serial port, using the syntax
15066 @samp{@var{hostname}:@var{portnumber}}.
15067
15068 @item target pmon @var{port}
15069 @kindex target pmon @var{port}
15070 PMON ROM monitor.
15071
15072 @item target ddb @var{port}
15073 @kindex target ddb @var{port}
15074 NEC's DDB variant of PMON for Vr4300.
15075
15076 @item target lsi @var{port}
15077 @kindex target lsi @var{port}
15078 LSI variant of PMON.
15079
15080 @kindex target r3900
15081 @item target r3900 @var{dev}
15082 Densan DVE-R3900 ROM monitor for Toshiba R3900 Mips.
15083
15084 @kindex target array
15085 @item target array @var{dev}
15086 Array Tech LSI33K RAID controller board.
15087
15088 @end table
15089
15090
15091 @noindent
15092 @value{GDBN} also supports these special commands for MIPS targets:
15093
15094 @table @code
15095 @item set mipsfpu double
15096 @itemx set mipsfpu single
15097 @itemx set mipsfpu none
15098 @itemx set mipsfpu auto
15099 @itemx show mipsfpu
15100 @kindex set mipsfpu
15101 @kindex show mipsfpu
15102 @cindex MIPS remote floating point
15103 @cindex floating point, MIPS remote
15104 If your target board does not support the MIPS floating point
15105 coprocessor, you should use the command @samp{set mipsfpu none} (if you
15106 need this, you may wish to put the command in your @value{GDBN} init
15107 file). This tells @value{GDBN} how to find the return value of
15108 functions which return floating point values. It also allows
15109 @value{GDBN} to avoid saving the floating point registers when calling
15110 functions on the board. If you are using a floating point coprocessor
15111 with only single precision floating point support, as on the @sc{r4650}
15112 processor, use the command @samp{set mipsfpu single}. The default
15113 double precision floating point coprocessor may be selected using
15114 @samp{set mipsfpu double}.
15115
15116 In previous versions the only choices were double precision or no
15117 floating point, so @samp{set mipsfpu on} will select double precision
15118 and @samp{set mipsfpu off} will select no floating point.
15119
15120 As usual, you can inquire about the @code{mipsfpu} variable with
15121 @samp{show mipsfpu}.
15122
15123 @item set timeout @var{seconds}
15124 @itemx set retransmit-timeout @var{seconds}
15125 @itemx show timeout
15126 @itemx show retransmit-timeout
15127 @cindex @code{timeout}, MIPS protocol
15128 @cindex @code{retransmit-timeout}, MIPS protocol
15129 @kindex set timeout
15130 @kindex show timeout
15131 @kindex set retransmit-timeout
15132 @kindex show retransmit-timeout
15133 You can control the timeout used while waiting for a packet, in the MIPS
15134 remote protocol, with the @code{set timeout @var{seconds}} command. The
15135 default is 5 seconds. Similarly, you can control the timeout used while
15136 waiting for an acknowledgement of a packet with the @code{set
15137 retransmit-timeout @var{seconds}} command. The default is 3 seconds.
15138 You can inspect both values with @code{show timeout} and @code{show
15139 retransmit-timeout}. (These commands are @emph{only} available when
15140 @value{GDBN} is configured for @samp{--target=mips-idt-ecoff}.)
15141
15142 The timeout set by @code{set timeout} does not apply when @value{GDBN}
15143 is waiting for your program to stop. In that case, @value{GDBN} waits
15144 forever because it has no way of knowing how long the program is going
15145 to run before stopping.
15146
15147 @item set syn-garbage-limit @var{num}
15148 @kindex set syn-garbage-limit@r{, MIPS remote}
15149 @cindex synchronize with remote MIPS target
15150 Limit the maximum number of characters @value{GDBN} should ignore when
15151 it tries to synchronize with the remote target. The default is 10
15152 characters. Setting the limit to -1 means there's no limit.
15153
15154 @item show syn-garbage-limit
15155 @kindex show syn-garbage-limit@r{, MIPS remote}
15156 Show the current limit on the number of characters to ignore when
15157 trying to synchronize with the remote system.
15158
15159 @item set monitor-prompt @var{prompt}
15160 @kindex set monitor-prompt@r{, MIPS remote}
15161 @cindex remote monitor prompt
15162 Tell @value{GDBN} to expect the specified @var{prompt} string from the
15163 remote monitor. The default depends on the target:
15164 @table @asis
15165 @item pmon target
15166 @samp{PMON}
15167 @item ddb target
15168 @samp{NEC010}
15169 @item lsi target
15170 @samp{PMON>}
15171 @end table
15172
15173 @item show monitor-prompt
15174 @kindex show monitor-prompt@r{, MIPS remote}
15175 Show the current strings @value{GDBN} expects as the prompt from the
15176 remote monitor.
15177
15178 @item set monitor-warnings
15179 @kindex set monitor-warnings@r{, MIPS remote}
15180 Enable or disable monitor warnings about hardware breakpoints. This
15181 has effect only for the @code{lsi} target. When on, @value{GDBN} will
15182 display warning messages whose codes are returned by the @code{lsi}
15183 PMON monitor for breakpoint commands.
15184
15185 @item show monitor-warnings
15186 @kindex show monitor-warnings@r{, MIPS remote}
15187 Show the current setting of printing monitor warnings.
15188
15189 @item pmon @var{command}
15190 @kindex pmon@r{, MIPS remote}
15191 @cindex send PMON command
15192 This command allows sending an arbitrary @var{command} string to the
15193 monitor. The monitor must be in debug mode for this to work.
15194 @end table
15195
15196 @node OpenRISC 1000
15197 @subsection OpenRISC 1000
15198 @cindex OpenRISC 1000
15199
15200 @cindex or1k boards
15201 See OR1k Architecture document (@uref{www.opencores.org}) for more information
15202 about platform and commands.
15203
15204 @table @code
15205
15206 @kindex target jtag
15207 @item target jtag jtag://@var{host}:@var{port}
15208
15209 Connects to remote JTAG server.
15210 JTAG remote server can be either an or1ksim or JTAG server,
15211 connected via parallel port to the board.
15212
15213 Example: @code{target jtag jtag://localhost:9999}
15214
15215 @kindex or1ksim
15216 @item or1ksim @var{command}
15217 If connected to @code{or1ksim} OpenRISC 1000 Architectural
15218 Simulator, proprietary commands can be executed.
15219
15220 @kindex info or1k spr
15221 @item info or1k spr
15222 Displays spr groups.
15223
15224 @item info or1k spr @var{group}
15225 @itemx info or1k spr @var{groupno}
15226 Displays register names in selected group.
15227
15228 @item info or1k spr @var{group} @var{register}
15229 @itemx info or1k spr @var{register}
15230 @itemx info or1k spr @var{groupno} @var{registerno}
15231 @itemx info or1k spr @var{registerno}
15232 Shows information about specified spr register.
15233
15234 @kindex spr
15235 @item spr @var{group} @var{register} @var{value}
15236 @itemx spr @var{register @var{value}}
15237 @itemx spr @var{groupno} @var{registerno @var{value}}
15238 @itemx spr @var{registerno @var{value}}
15239 Writes @var{value} to specified spr register.
15240 @end table
15241
15242 Some implementations of OpenRISC 1000 Architecture also have hardware trace.
15243 It is very similar to @value{GDBN} trace, except it does not interfere with normal
15244 program execution and is thus much faster. Hardware breakpoints/watchpoint
15245 triggers can be set using:
15246 @table @code
15247 @item $LEA/$LDATA
15248 Load effective address/data
15249 @item $SEA/$SDATA
15250 Store effective address/data
15251 @item $AEA/$ADATA
15252 Access effective address ($SEA or $LEA) or data ($SDATA/$LDATA)
15253 @item $FETCH
15254 Fetch data
15255 @end table
15256
15257 When triggered, it can capture low level data, like: @code{PC}, @code{LSEA},
15258 @code{LDATA}, @code{SDATA}, @code{READSPR}, @code{WRITESPR}, @code{INSTR}.
15259
15260 @code{htrace} commands:
15261 @cindex OpenRISC 1000 htrace
15262 @table @code
15263 @kindex hwatch
15264 @item hwatch @var{conditional}
15265 Set hardware watchpoint on combination of Load/Store Effective Address(es)
15266 or Data. For example:
15267
15268 @code{hwatch ($LEA == my_var) && ($LDATA < 50) || ($SEA == my_var) && ($SDATA >= 50)}
15269
15270 @code{hwatch ($LEA == my_var) && ($LDATA < 50) || ($SEA == my_var) && ($SDATA >= 50)}
15271
15272 @kindex htrace
15273 @item htrace info
15274 Display information about current HW trace configuration.
15275
15276 @item htrace trigger @var{conditional}
15277 Set starting criteria for HW trace.
15278
15279 @item htrace qualifier @var{conditional}
15280 Set acquisition qualifier for HW trace.
15281
15282 @item htrace stop @var{conditional}
15283 Set HW trace stopping criteria.
15284
15285 @item htrace record [@var{data}]*
15286 Selects the data to be recorded, when qualifier is met and HW trace was
15287 triggered.
15288
15289 @item htrace enable
15290 @itemx htrace disable
15291 Enables/disables the HW trace.
15292
15293 @item htrace rewind [@var{filename}]
15294 Clears currently recorded trace data.
15295
15296 If filename is specified, new trace file is made and any newly collected data
15297 will be written there.
15298
15299 @item htrace print [@var{start} [@var{len}]]
15300 Prints trace buffer, using current record configuration.
15301
15302 @item htrace mode continuous
15303 Set continuous trace mode.
15304
15305 @item htrace mode suspend
15306 Set suspend trace mode.
15307
15308 @end table
15309
15310 @node PowerPC Embedded
15311 @subsection PowerPC Embedded
15312
15313 @value{GDBN} provides the following PowerPC-specific commands:
15314
15315 @table @code
15316 @kindex set powerpc
15317 @item set powerpc soft-float
15318 @itemx show powerpc soft-float
15319 Force @value{GDBN} to use (or not use) a software floating point calling
15320 convention. By default, @value{GDBN} selects the calling convention based
15321 on the selected architecture and the provided executable file.
15322
15323 @item set powerpc vector-abi
15324 @itemx show powerpc vector-abi
15325 Force @value{GDBN} to use the specified calling convention for vector
15326 arguments and return values. The valid options are @samp{auto};
15327 @samp{generic}, to avoid vector registers even if they are present;
15328 @samp{altivec}, to use AltiVec registers; and @samp{spe} to use SPE
15329 registers. By default, @value{GDBN} selects the calling convention
15330 based on the selected architecture and the provided executable file.
15331
15332 @kindex target dink32
15333 @item target dink32 @var{dev}
15334 DINK32 ROM monitor.
15335
15336 @kindex target ppcbug
15337 @item target ppcbug @var{dev}
15338 @kindex target ppcbug1
15339 @item target ppcbug1 @var{dev}
15340 PPCBUG ROM monitor for PowerPC.
15341
15342 @kindex target sds
15343 @item target sds @var{dev}
15344 SDS monitor, running on a PowerPC board (such as Motorola's ADS).
15345 @end table
15346
15347 @cindex SDS protocol
15348 The following commands specific to the SDS protocol are supported
15349 by @value{GDBN}:
15350
15351 @table @code
15352 @item set sdstimeout @var{nsec}
15353 @kindex set sdstimeout
15354 Set the timeout for SDS protocol reads to be @var{nsec} seconds. The
15355 default is 2 seconds.
15356
15357 @item show sdstimeout
15358 @kindex show sdstimeout
15359 Show the current value of the SDS timeout.
15360
15361 @item sds @var{command}
15362 @kindex sds@r{, a command}
15363 Send the specified @var{command} string to the SDS monitor.
15364 @end table
15365
15366
15367 @node PA
15368 @subsection HP PA Embedded
15369
15370 @table @code
15371
15372 @kindex target op50n
15373 @item target op50n @var{dev}
15374 OP50N monitor, running on an OKI HPPA board.
15375
15376 @kindex target w89k
15377 @item target w89k @var{dev}
15378 W89K monitor, running on a Winbond HPPA board.
15379
15380 @end table
15381
15382 @node Sparclet
15383 @subsection Tsqware Sparclet
15384
15385 @cindex Sparclet
15386
15387 @value{GDBN} enables developers to debug tasks running on
15388 Sparclet targets from a Unix host.
15389 @value{GDBN} uses code that runs on
15390 both the Unix host and on the Sparclet target. The program
15391 @code{@value{GDBP}} is installed and executed on the Unix host.
15392
15393 @table @code
15394 @item remotetimeout @var{args}
15395 @kindex remotetimeout
15396 @value{GDBN} supports the option @code{remotetimeout}.
15397 This option is set by the user, and @var{args} represents the number of
15398 seconds @value{GDBN} waits for responses.
15399 @end table
15400
15401 @cindex compiling, on Sparclet
15402 When compiling for debugging, include the options @samp{-g} to get debug
15403 information and @samp{-Ttext} to relocate the program to where you wish to
15404 load it on the target. You may also want to add the options @samp{-n} or
15405 @samp{-N} in order to reduce the size of the sections. Example:
15406
15407 @smallexample
15408 sparclet-aout-gcc prog.c -Ttext 0x12010000 -g -o prog -N
15409 @end smallexample
15410
15411 You can use @code{objdump} to verify that the addresses are what you intended:
15412
15413 @smallexample
15414 sparclet-aout-objdump --headers --syms prog
15415 @end smallexample
15416
15417 @cindex running, on Sparclet
15418 Once you have set
15419 your Unix execution search path to find @value{GDBN}, you are ready to
15420 run @value{GDBN}. From your Unix host, run @code{@value{GDBP}}
15421 (or @code{sparclet-aout-gdb}, depending on your installation).
15422
15423 @value{GDBN} comes up showing the prompt:
15424
15425 @smallexample
15426 (gdbslet)
15427 @end smallexample
15428
15429 @menu
15430 * Sparclet File:: Setting the file to debug
15431 * Sparclet Connection:: Connecting to Sparclet
15432 * Sparclet Download:: Sparclet download
15433 * Sparclet Execution:: Running and debugging
15434 @end menu
15435
15436 @node Sparclet File
15437 @subsubsection Setting File to Debug
15438
15439 The @value{GDBN} command @code{file} lets you choose with program to debug.
15440
15441 @smallexample
15442 (gdbslet) file prog
15443 @end smallexample
15444
15445 @need 1000
15446 @value{GDBN} then attempts to read the symbol table of @file{prog}.
15447 @value{GDBN} locates
15448 the file by searching the directories listed in the command search
15449 path.
15450 If the file was compiled with debug information (option @samp{-g}), source
15451 files will be searched as well.
15452 @value{GDBN} locates
15453 the source files by searching the directories listed in the directory search
15454 path (@pxref{Environment, ,Your Program's Environment}).
15455 If it fails
15456 to find a file, it displays a message such as:
15457
15458 @smallexample
15459 prog: No such file or directory.
15460 @end smallexample
15461
15462 When this happens, add the appropriate directories to the search paths with
15463 the @value{GDBN} commands @code{path} and @code{dir}, and execute the
15464 @code{target} command again.
15465
15466 @node Sparclet Connection
15467 @subsubsection Connecting to Sparclet
15468
15469 The @value{GDBN} command @code{target} lets you connect to a Sparclet target.
15470 To connect to a target on serial port ``@code{ttya}'', type:
15471
15472 @smallexample
15473 (gdbslet) target sparclet /dev/ttya
15474 Remote target sparclet connected to /dev/ttya
15475 main () at ../prog.c:3
15476 @end smallexample
15477
15478 @need 750
15479 @value{GDBN} displays messages like these:
15480
15481 @smallexample
15482 Connected to ttya.
15483 @end smallexample
15484
15485 @node Sparclet Download
15486 @subsubsection Sparclet Download
15487
15488 @cindex download to Sparclet
15489 Once connected to the Sparclet target,
15490 you can use the @value{GDBN}
15491 @code{load} command to download the file from the host to the target.
15492 The file name and load offset should be given as arguments to the @code{load}
15493 command.
15494 Since the file format is aout, the program must be loaded to the starting
15495 address. You can use @code{objdump} to find out what this value is. The load
15496 offset is an offset which is added to the VMA (virtual memory address)
15497 of each of the file's sections.
15498 For instance, if the program
15499 @file{prog} was linked to text address 0x1201000, with data at 0x12010160
15500 and bss at 0x12010170, in @value{GDBN}, type:
15501
15502 @smallexample
15503 (gdbslet) load prog 0x12010000
15504 Loading section .text, size 0xdb0 vma 0x12010000
15505 @end smallexample
15506
15507 If the code is loaded at a different address then what the program was linked
15508 to, you may need to use the @code{section} and @code{add-symbol-file} commands
15509 to tell @value{GDBN} where to map the symbol table.
15510
15511 @node Sparclet Execution
15512 @subsubsection Running and Debugging
15513
15514 @cindex running and debugging Sparclet programs
15515 You can now begin debugging the task using @value{GDBN}'s execution control
15516 commands, @code{b}, @code{step}, @code{run}, etc. See the @value{GDBN}
15517 manual for the list of commands.
15518
15519 @smallexample
15520 (gdbslet) b main
15521 Breakpoint 1 at 0x12010000: file prog.c, line 3.
15522 (gdbslet) run
15523 Starting program: prog
15524 Breakpoint 1, main (argc=1, argv=0xeffff21c) at prog.c:3
15525 3 char *symarg = 0;
15526 (gdbslet) step
15527 4 char *execarg = "hello!";
15528 (gdbslet)
15529 @end smallexample
15530
15531 @node Sparclite
15532 @subsection Fujitsu Sparclite
15533
15534 @table @code
15535
15536 @kindex target sparclite
15537 @item target sparclite @var{dev}
15538 Fujitsu sparclite boards, used only for the purpose of loading.
15539 You must use an additional command to debug the program.
15540 For example: target remote @var{dev} using @value{GDBN} standard
15541 remote protocol.
15542
15543 @end table
15544
15545 @node Z8000
15546 @subsection Zilog Z8000
15547
15548 @cindex Z8000
15549 @cindex simulator, Z8000
15550 @cindex Zilog Z8000 simulator
15551
15552 When configured for debugging Zilog Z8000 targets, @value{GDBN} includes
15553 a Z8000 simulator.
15554
15555 For the Z8000 family, @samp{target sim} simulates either the Z8002 (the
15556 unsegmented variant of the Z8000 architecture) or the Z8001 (the
15557 segmented variant). The simulator recognizes which architecture is
15558 appropriate by inspecting the object code.
15559
15560 @table @code
15561 @item target sim @var{args}
15562 @kindex sim
15563 @kindex target sim@r{, with Z8000}
15564 Debug programs on a simulated CPU. If the simulator supports setup
15565 options, specify them via @var{args}.
15566 @end table
15567
15568 @noindent
15569 After specifying this target, you can debug programs for the simulated
15570 CPU in the same style as programs for your host computer; use the
15571 @code{file} command to load a new program image, the @code{run} command
15572 to run your program, and so on.
15573
15574 As well as making available all the usual machine registers
15575 (@pxref{Registers, ,Registers}), the Z8000 simulator provides three
15576 additional items of information as specially named registers:
15577
15578 @table @code
15579
15580 @item cycles
15581 Counts clock-ticks in the simulator.
15582
15583 @item insts
15584 Counts instructions run in the simulator.
15585
15586 @item time
15587 Execution time in 60ths of a second.
15588
15589 @end table
15590
15591 You can refer to these values in @value{GDBN} expressions with the usual
15592 conventions; for example, @w{@samp{b fputc if $cycles>5000}} sets a
15593 conditional breakpoint that suspends only after at least 5000
15594 simulated clock ticks.
15595
15596 @node AVR
15597 @subsection Atmel AVR
15598 @cindex AVR
15599
15600 When configured for debugging the Atmel AVR, @value{GDBN} supports the
15601 following AVR-specific commands:
15602
15603 @table @code
15604 @item info io_registers
15605 @kindex info io_registers@r{, AVR}
15606 @cindex I/O registers (Atmel AVR)
15607 This command displays information about the AVR I/O registers. For
15608 each register, @value{GDBN} prints its number and value.
15609 @end table
15610
15611 @node CRIS
15612 @subsection CRIS
15613 @cindex CRIS
15614
15615 When configured for debugging CRIS, @value{GDBN} provides the
15616 following CRIS-specific commands:
15617
15618 @table @code
15619 @item set cris-version @var{ver}
15620 @cindex CRIS version
15621 Set the current CRIS version to @var{ver}, either @samp{10} or @samp{32}.
15622 The CRIS version affects register names and sizes. This command is useful in
15623 case autodetection of the CRIS version fails.
15624
15625 @item show cris-version
15626 Show the current CRIS version.
15627
15628 @item set cris-dwarf2-cfi
15629 @cindex DWARF-2 CFI and CRIS
15630 Set the usage of DWARF-2 CFI for CRIS debugging. The default is @samp{on}.
15631 Change to @samp{off} when using @code{gcc-cris} whose version is below
15632 @code{R59}.
15633
15634 @item show cris-dwarf2-cfi
15635 Show the current state of using DWARF-2 CFI.
15636
15637 @item set cris-mode @var{mode}
15638 @cindex CRIS mode
15639 Set the current CRIS mode to @var{mode}. It should only be changed when
15640 debugging in guru mode, in which case it should be set to
15641 @samp{guru} (the default is @samp{normal}).
15642
15643 @item show cris-mode
15644 Show the current CRIS mode.
15645 @end table
15646
15647 @node Super-H
15648 @subsection Renesas Super-H
15649 @cindex Super-H
15650
15651 For the Renesas Super-H processor, @value{GDBN} provides these
15652 commands:
15653
15654 @table @code
15655 @item regs
15656 @kindex regs@r{, Super-H}
15657 Show the values of all Super-H registers.
15658 @end table
15659
15660
15661 @node Architectures
15662 @section Architectures
15663
15664 This section describes characteristics of architectures that affect
15665 all uses of @value{GDBN} with the architecture, both native and cross.
15666
15667 @menu
15668 * i386::
15669 * A29K::
15670 * Alpha::
15671 * MIPS::
15672 * HPPA:: HP PA architecture
15673 * SPU:: Cell Broadband Engine SPU architecture
15674 * PowerPC::
15675 @end menu
15676
15677 @node i386
15678 @subsection x86 Architecture-specific Issues
15679
15680 @table @code
15681 @item set struct-convention @var{mode}
15682 @kindex set struct-convention
15683 @cindex struct return convention
15684 @cindex struct/union returned in registers
15685 Set the convention used by the inferior to return @code{struct}s and
15686 @code{union}s from functions to @var{mode}. Possible values of
15687 @var{mode} are @code{"pcc"}, @code{"reg"}, and @code{"default"} (the
15688 default). @code{"default"} or @code{"pcc"} means that @code{struct}s
15689 are returned on the stack, while @code{"reg"} means that a
15690 @code{struct} or a @code{union} whose size is 1, 2, 4, or 8 bytes will
15691 be returned in a register.
15692
15693 @item show struct-convention
15694 @kindex show struct-convention
15695 Show the current setting of the convention to return @code{struct}s
15696 from functions.
15697 @end table
15698
15699 @node A29K
15700 @subsection A29K
15701
15702 @table @code
15703
15704 @kindex set rstack_high_address
15705 @cindex AMD 29K register stack
15706 @cindex register stack, AMD29K
15707 @item set rstack_high_address @var{address}
15708 On AMD 29000 family processors, registers are saved in a separate
15709 @dfn{register stack}. There is no way for @value{GDBN} to determine the
15710 extent of this stack. Normally, @value{GDBN} just assumes that the
15711 stack is ``large enough''. This may result in @value{GDBN} referencing
15712 memory locations that do not exist. If necessary, you can get around
15713 this problem by specifying the ending address of the register stack with
15714 the @code{set rstack_high_address} command. The argument should be an
15715 address, which you probably want to precede with @samp{0x} to specify in
15716 hexadecimal.
15717
15718 @kindex show rstack_high_address
15719 @item show rstack_high_address
15720 Display the current limit of the register stack, on AMD 29000 family
15721 processors.
15722
15723 @end table
15724
15725 @node Alpha
15726 @subsection Alpha
15727
15728 See the following section.
15729
15730 @node MIPS
15731 @subsection MIPS
15732
15733 @cindex stack on Alpha
15734 @cindex stack on MIPS
15735 @cindex Alpha stack
15736 @cindex MIPS stack
15737 Alpha- and MIPS-based computers use an unusual stack frame, which
15738 sometimes requires @value{GDBN} to search backward in the object code to
15739 find the beginning of a function.
15740
15741 @cindex response time, MIPS debugging
15742 To improve response time (especially for embedded applications, where
15743 @value{GDBN} may be restricted to a slow serial line for this search)
15744 you may want to limit the size of this search, using one of these
15745 commands:
15746
15747 @table @code
15748 @cindex @code{heuristic-fence-post} (Alpha, MIPS)
15749 @item set heuristic-fence-post @var{limit}
15750 Restrict @value{GDBN} to examining at most @var{limit} bytes in its
15751 search for the beginning of a function. A value of @var{0} (the
15752 default) means there is no limit. However, except for @var{0}, the
15753 larger the limit the more bytes @code{heuristic-fence-post} must search
15754 and therefore the longer it takes to run. You should only need to use
15755 this command when debugging a stripped executable.
15756
15757 @item show heuristic-fence-post
15758 Display the current limit.
15759 @end table
15760
15761 @noindent
15762 These commands are available @emph{only} when @value{GDBN} is configured
15763 for debugging programs on Alpha or MIPS processors.
15764
15765 Several MIPS-specific commands are available when debugging MIPS
15766 programs:
15767
15768 @table @code
15769 @item set mips abi @var{arg}
15770 @kindex set mips abi
15771 @cindex set ABI for MIPS
15772 Tell @value{GDBN} which MIPS ABI is used by the inferior. Possible
15773 values of @var{arg} are:
15774
15775 @table @samp
15776 @item auto
15777 The default ABI associated with the current binary (this is the
15778 default).
15779 @item o32
15780 @item o64
15781 @item n32
15782 @item n64
15783 @item eabi32
15784 @item eabi64
15785 @item auto
15786 @end table
15787
15788 @item show mips abi
15789 @kindex show mips abi
15790 Show the MIPS ABI used by @value{GDBN} to debug the inferior.
15791
15792 @item set mipsfpu
15793 @itemx show mipsfpu
15794 @xref{MIPS Embedded, set mipsfpu}.
15795
15796 @item set mips mask-address @var{arg}
15797 @kindex set mips mask-address
15798 @cindex MIPS addresses, masking
15799 This command determines whether the most-significant 32 bits of 64-bit
15800 MIPS addresses are masked off. The argument @var{arg} can be
15801 @samp{on}, @samp{off}, or @samp{auto}. The latter is the default
15802 setting, which lets @value{GDBN} determine the correct value.
15803
15804 @item show mips mask-address
15805 @kindex show mips mask-address
15806 Show whether the upper 32 bits of MIPS addresses are masked off or
15807 not.
15808
15809 @item set remote-mips64-transfers-32bit-regs
15810 @kindex set remote-mips64-transfers-32bit-regs
15811 This command controls compatibility with 64-bit MIPS targets that
15812 transfer data in 32-bit quantities. If you have an old MIPS 64 target
15813 that transfers 32 bits for some registers, like @sc{sr} and @sc{fsr},
15814 and 64 bits for other registers, set this option to @samp{on}.
15815
15816 @item show remote-mips64-transfers-32bit-regs
15817 @kindex show remote-mips64-transfers-32bit-regs
15818 Show the current setting of compatibility with older MIPS 64 targets.
15819
15820 @item set debug mips
15821 @kindex set debug mips
15822 This command turns on and off debugging messages for the MIPS-specific
15823 target code in @value{GDBN}.
15824
15825 @item show debug mips
15826 @kindex show debug mips
15827 Show the current setting of MIPS debugging messages.
15828 @end table
15829
15830
15831 @node HPPA
15832 @subsection HPPA
15833 @cindex HPPA support
15834
15835 When @value{GDBN} is debugging the HP PA architecture, it provides the
15836 following special commands:
15837
15838 @table @code
15839 @item set debug hppa
15840 @kindex set debug hppa
15841 This command determines whether HPPA architecture-specific debugging
15842 messages are to be displayed.
15843
15844 @item show debug hppa
15845 Show whether HPPA debugging messages are displayed.
15846
15847 @item maint print unwind @var{address}
15848 @kindex maint print unwind@r{, HPPA}
15849 This command displays the contents of the unwind table entry at the
15850 given @var{address}.
15851
15852 @end table
15853
15854
15855 @node SPU
15856 @subsection Cell Broadband Engine SPU architecture
15857 @cindex Cell Broadband Engine
15858 @cindex SPU
15859
15860 When @value{GDBN} is debugging the Cell Broadband Engine SPU architecture,
15861 it provides the following special commands:
15862
15863 @table @code
15864 @item info spu event
15865 @kindex info spu
15866 Display SPU event facility status. Shows current event mask
15867 and pending event status.
15868
15869 @item info spu signal
15870 Display SPU signal notification facility status. Shows pending
15871 signal-control word and signal notification mode of both signal
15872 notification channels.
15873
15874 @item info spu mailbox
15875 Display SPU mailbox facility status. Shows all pending entries,
15876 in order of processing, in each of the SPU Write Outbound,
15877 SPU Write Outbound Interrupt, and SPU Read Inbound mailboxes.
15878
15879 @item info spu dma
15880 Display MFC DMA status. Shows all pending commands in the MFC
15881 DMA queue. For each entry, opcode, tag, class IDs, effective
15882 and local store addresses and transfer size are shown.
15883
15884 @item info spu proxydma
15885 Display MFC Proxy-DMA status. Shows all pending commands in the MFC
15886 Proxy-DMA queue. For each entry, opcode, tag, class IDs, effective
15887 and local store addresses and transfer size are shown.
15888
15889 @end table
15890
15891 @node PowerPC
15892 @subsection PowerPC
15893 @cindex PowerPC architecture
15894
15895 When @value{GDBN} is debugging the PowerPC architecture, it provides a set of
15896 pseudo-registers to enable inspection of 128-bit wide Decimal Floating Point
15897 numbers stored in the floating point registers. These values must be stored
15898 in two consecutive registers, always starting at an even register like
15899 @code{f0} or @code{f2}.
15900
15901 The pseudo-registers go from @code{$dl0} through @code{$dl15}, and are formed
15902 by joining the even/odd register pairs @code{f0} and @code{f1} for @code{$dl0},
15903 @code{f2} and @code{f3} for @code{$dl1} and so on.
15904
15905
15906 @node Controlling GDB
15907 @chapter Controlling @value{GDBN}
15908
15909 You can alter the way @value{GDBN} interacts with you by using the
15910 @code{set} command. For commands controlling how @value{GDBN} displays
15911 data, see @ref{Print Settings, ,Print Settings}. Other settings are
15912 described here.
15913
15914 @menu
15915 * Prompt:: Prompt
15916 * Editing:: Command editing
15917 * Command History:: Command history
15918 * Screen Size:: Screen size
15919 * Numbers:: Numbers
15920 * ABI:: Configuring the current ABI
15921 * Messages/Warnings:: Optional warnings and messages
15922 * Debugging Output:: Optional messages about internal happenings
15923 @end menu
15924
15925 @node Prompt
15926 @section Prompt
15927
15928 @cindex prompt
15929
15930 @value{GDBN} indicates its readiness to read a command by printing a string
15931 called the @dfn{prompt}. This string is normally @samp{(@value{GDBP})}. You
15932 can change the prompt string with the @code{set prompt} command. For
15933 instance, when debugging @value{GDBN} with @value{GDBN}, it is useful to change
15934 the prompt in one of the @value{GDBN} sessions so that you can always tell
15935 which one you are talking to.
15936
15937 @emph{Note:} @code{set prompt} does not add a space for you after the
15938 prompt you set. This allows you to set a prompt which ends in a space
15939 or a prompt that does not.
15940
15941 @table @code
15942 @kindex set prompt
15943 @item set prompt @var{newprompt}
15944 Directs @value{GDBN} to use @var{newprompt} as its prompt string henceforth.
15945
15946 @kindex show prompt
15947 @item show prompt
15948 Prints a line of the form: @samp{Gdb's prompt is: @var{your-prompt}}
15949 @end table
15950
15951 @node Editing
15952 @section Command Editing
15953 @cindex readline
15954 @cindex command line editing
15955
15956 @value{GDBN} reads its input commands via the @dfn{Readline} interface. This
15957 @sc{gnu} library provides consistent behavior for programs which provide a
15958 command line interface to the user. Advantages are @sc{gnu} Emacs-style
15959 or @dfn{vi}-style inline editing of commands, @code{csh}-like history
15960 substitution, and a storage and recall of command history across
15961 debugging sessions.
15962
15963 You may control the behavior of command line editing in @value{GDBN} with the
15964 command @code{set}.
15965
15966 @table @code
15967 @kindex set editing
15968 @cindex editing
15969 @item set editing
15970 @itemx set editing on
15971 Enable command line editing (enabled by default).
15972
15973 @item set editing off
15974 Disable command line editing.
15975
15976 @kindex show editing
15977 @item show editing
15978 Show whether command line editing is enabled.
15979 @end table
15980
15981 @xref{Command Line Editing}, for more details about the Readline
15982 interface. Users unfamiliar with @sc{gnu} Emacs or @code{vi} are
15983 encouraged to read that chapter.
15984
15985 @node Command History
15986 @section Command History
15987 @cindex command history
15988
15989 @value{GDBN} can keep track of the commands you type during your
15990 debugging sessions, so that you can be certain of precisely what
15991 happened. Use these commands to manage the @value{GDBN} command
15992 history facility.
15993
15994 @value{GDBN} uses the @sc{gnu} History library, a part of the Readline
15995 package, to provide the history facility. @xref{Using History
15996 Interactively}, for the detailed description of the History library.
15997
15998 To issue a command to @value{GDBN} without affecting certain aspects of
15999 the state which is seen by users, prefix it with @samp{server }
16000 (@pxref{Server Prefix}). This
16001 means that this command will not affect the command history, nor will it
16002 affect @value{GDBN}'s notion of which command to repeat if @key{RET} is
16003 pressed on a line by itself.
16004
16005 @cindex @code{server}, command prefix
16006 The server prefix does not affect the recording of values into the value
16007 history; to print a value without recording it into the value history,
16008 use the @code{output} command instead of the @code{print} command.
16009
16010 Here is the description of @value{GDBN} commands related to command
16011 history.
16012
16013 @table @code
16014 @cindex history substitution
16015 @cindex history file
16016 @kindex set history filename
16017 @cindex @env{GDBHISTFILE}, environment variable
16018 @item set history filename @var{fname}
16019 Set the name of the @value{GDBN} command history file to @var{fname}.
16020 This is the file where @value{GDBN} reads an initial command history
16021 list, and where it writes the command history from this session when it
16022 exits. You can access this list through history expansion or through
16023 the history command editing characters listed below. This file defaults
16024 to the value of the environment variable @code{GDBHISTFILE}, or to
16025 @file{./.gdb_history} (@file{./_gdb_history} on MS-DOS) if this variable
16026 is not set.
16027
16028 @cindex save command history
16029 @kindex set history save
16030 @item set history save
16031 @itemx set history save on
16032 Record command history in a file, whose name may be specified with the
16033 @code{set history filename} command. By default, this option is disabled.
16034
16035 @item set history save off
16036 Stop recording command history in a file.
16037
16038 @cindex history size
16039 @kindex set history size
16040 @cindex @env{HISTSIZE}, environment variable
16041 @item set history size @var{size}
16042 Set the number of commands which @value{GDBN} keeps in its history list.
16043 This defaults to the value of the environment variable
16044 @code{HISTSIZE}, or to 256 if this variable is not set.
16045 @end table
16046
16047 History expansion assigns special meaning to the character @kbd{!}.
16048 @xref{Event Designators}, for more details.
16049
16050 @cindex history expansion, turn on/off
16051 Since @kbd{!} is also the logical not operator in C, history expansion
16052 is off by default. If you decide to enable history expansion with the
16053 @code{set history expansion on} command, you may sometimes need to
16054 follow @kbd{!} (when it is used as logical not, in an expression) with
16055 a space or a tab to prevent it from being expanded. The readline
16056 history facilities do not attempt substitution on the strings
16057 @kbd{!=} and @kbd{!(}, even when history expansion is enabled.
16058
16059 The commands to control history expansion are:
16060
16061 @table @code
16062 @item set history expansion on
16063 @itemx set history expansion
16064 @kindex set history expansion
16065 Enable history expansion. History expansion is off by default.
16066
16067 @item set history expansion off
16068 Disable history expansion.
16069
16070 @c @group
16071 @kindex show history
16072 @item show history
16073 @itemx show history filename
16074 @itemx show history save
16075 @itemx show history size
16076 @itemx show history expansion
16077 These commands display the state of the @value{GDBN} history parameters.
16078 @code{show history} by itself displays all four states.
16079 @c @end group
16080 @end table
16081
16082 @table @code
16083 @kindex show commands
16084 @cindex show last commands
16085 @cindex display command history
16086 @item show commands
16087 Display the last ten commands in the command history.
16088
16089 @item show commands @var{n}
16090 Print ten commands centered on command number @var{n}.
16091
16092 @item show commands +
16093 Print ten commands just after the commands last printed.
16094 @end table
16095
16096 @node Screen Size
16097 @section Screen Size
16098 @cindex size of screen
16099 @cindex pauses in output
16100
16101 Certain commands to @value{GDBN} may produce large amounts of
16102 information output to the screen. To help you read all of it,
16103 @value{GDBN} pauses and asks you for input at the end of each page of
16104 output. Type @key{RET} when you want to continue the output, or @kbd{q}
16105 to discard the remaining output. Also, the screen width setting
16106 determines when to wrap lines of output. Depending on what is being
16107 printed, @value{GDBN} tries to break the line at a readable place,
16108 rather than simply letting it overflow onto the following line.
16109
16110 Normally @value{GDBN} knows the size of the screen from the terminal
16111 driver software. For example, on Unix @value{GDBN} uses the termcap data base
16112 together with the value of the @code{TERM} environment variable and the
16113 @code{stty rows} and @code{stty cols} settings. If this is not correct,
16114 you can override it with the @code{set height} and @code{set
16115 width} commands:
16116
16117 @table @code
16118 @kindex set height
16119 @kindex set width
16120 @kindex show width
16121 @kindex show height
16122 @item set height @var{lpp}
16123 @itemx show height
16124 @itemx set width @var{cpl}
16125 @itemx show width
16126 These @code{set} commands specify a screen height of @var{lpp} lines and
16127 a screen width of @var{cpl} characters. The associated @code{show}
16128 commands display the current settings.
16129
16130 If you specify a height of zero lines, @value{GDBN} does not pause during
16131 output no matter how long the output is. This is useful if output is to a
16132 file or to an editor buffer.
16133
16134 Likewise, you can specify @samp{set width 0} to prevent @value{GDBN}
16135 from wrapping its output.
16136
16137 @item set pagination on
16138 @itemx set pagination off
16139 @kindex set pagination
16140 Turn the output pagination on or off; the default is on. Turning
16141 pagination off is the alternative to @code{set height 0}.
16142
16143 @item show pagination
16144 @kindex show pagination
16145 Show the current pagination mode.
16146 @end table
16147
16148 @node Numbers
16149 @section Numbers
16150 @cindex number representation
16151 @cindex entering numbers
16152
16153 You can always enter numbers in octal, decimal, or hexadecimal in
16154 @value{GDBN} by the usual conventions: octal numbers begin with
16155 @samp{0}, decimal numbers end with @samp{.}, and hexadecimal numbers
16156 begin with @samp{0x}. Numbers that neither begin with @samp{0} or
16157 @samp{0x}, nor end with a @samp{.} are, by default, entered in base
16158 10; likewise, the default display for numbers---when no particular
16159 format is specified---is base 10. You can change the default base for
16160 both input and output with the commands described below.
16161
16162 @table @code
16163 @kindex set input-radix
16164 @item set input-radix @var{base}
16165 Set the default base for numeric input. Supported choices
16166 for @var{base} are decimal 8, 10, or 16. @var{base} must itself be
16167 specified either unambiguously or using the current input radix; for
16168 example, any of
16169
16170 @smallexample
16171 set input-radix 012
16172 set input-radix 10.
16173 set input-radix 0xa
16174 @end smallexample
16175
16176 @noindent
16177 sets the input base to decimal. On the other hand, @samp{set input-radix 10}
16178 leaves the input radix unchanged, no matter what it was, since
16179 @samp{10}, being without any leading or trailing signs of its base, is
16180 interpreted in the current radix. Thus, if the current radix is 16,
16181 @samp{10} is interpreted in hex, i.e.@: as 16 decimal, which doesn't
16182 change the radix.
16183
16184 @kindex set output-radix
16185 @item set output-radix @var{base}
16186 Set the default base for numeric display. Supported choices
16187 for @var{base} are decimal 8, 10, or 16. @var{base} must itself be
16188 specified either unambiguously or using the current input radix.
16189
16190 @kindex show input-radix
16191 @item show input-radix
16192 Display the current default base for numeric input.
16193
16194 @kindex show output-radix
16195 @item show output-radix
16196 Display the current default base for numeric display.
16197
16198 @item set radix @r{[}@var{base}@r{]}
16199 @itemx show radix
16200 @kindex set radix
16201 @kindex show radix
16202 These commands set and show the default base for both input and output
16203 of numbers. @code{set radix} sets the radix of input and output to
16204 the same base; without an argument, it resets the radix back to its
16205 default value of 10.
16206
16207 @end table
16208
16209 @node ABI
16210 @section Configuring the Current ABI
16211
16212 @value{GDBN} can determine the @dfn{ABI} (Application Binary Interface) of your
16213 application automatically. However, sometimes you need to override its
16214 conclusions. Use these commands to manage @value{GDBN}'s view of the
16215 current ABI.
16216
16217 @cindex OS ABI
16218 @kindex set osabi
16219 @kindex show osabi
16220
16221 One @value{GDBN} configuration can debug binaries for multiple operating
16222 system targets, either via remote debugging or native emulation.
16223 @value{GDBN} will autodetect the @dfn{OS ABI} (Operating System ABI) in use,
16224 but you can override its conclusion using the @code{set osabi} command.
16225 One example where this is useful is in debugging of binaries which use
16226 an alternate C library (e.g.@: @sc{uClibc} for @sc{gnu}/Linux) which does
16227 not have the same identifying marks that the standard C library for your
16228 platform provides.
16229
16230 @table @code
16231 @item show osabi
16232 Show the OS ABI currently in use.
16233
16234 @item set osabi
16235 With no argument, show the list of registered available OS ABI's.
16236
16237 @item set osabi @var{abi}
16238 Set the current OS ABI to @var{abi}.
16239 @end table
16240
16241 @cindex float promotion
16242
16243 Generally, the way that an argument of type @code{float} is passed to a
16244 function depends on whether the function is prototyped. For a prototyped
16245 (i.e.@: ANSI/ISO style) function, @code{float} arguments are passed unchanged,
16246 according to the architecture's convention for @code{float}. For unprototyped
16247 (i.e.@: K&R style) functions, @code{float} arguments are first promoted to type
16248 @code{double} and then passed.
16249
16250 Unfortunately, some forms of debug information do not reliably indicate whether
16251 a function is prototyped. If @value{GDBN} calls a function that is not marked
16252 as prototyped, it consults @kbd{set coerce-float-to-double}.
16253
16254 @table @code
16255 @kindex set coerce-float-to-double
16256 @item set coerce-float-to-double
16257 @itemx set coerce-float-to-double on
16258 Arguments of type @code{float} will be promoted to @code{double} when passed
16259 to an unprototyped function. This is the default setting.
16260
16261 @item set coerce-float-to-double off
16262 Arguments of type @code{float} will be passed directly to unprototyped
16263 functions.
16264
16265 @kindex show coerce-float-to-double
16266 @item show coerce-float-to-double
16267 Show the current setting of promoting @code{float} to @code{double}.
16268 @end table
16269
16270 @kindex set cp-abi
16271 @kindex show cp-abi
16272 @value{GDBN} needs to know the ABI used for your program's C@t{++}
16273 objects. The correct C@t{++} ABI depends on which C@t{++} compiler was
16274 used to build your application. @value{GDBN} only fully supports
16275 programs with a single C@t{++} ABI; if your program contains code using
16276 multiple C@t{++} ABI's or if @value{GDBN} can not identify your
16277 program's ABI correctly, you can tell @value{GDBN} which ABI to use.
16278 Currently supported ABI's include ``gnu-v2'', for @code{g++} versions
16279 before 3.0, ``gnu-v3'', for @code{g++} versions 3.0 and later, and
16280 ``hpaCC'' for the HP ANSI C@t{++} compiler. Other C@t{++} compilers may
16281 use the ``gnu-v2'' or ``gnu-v3'' ABI's as well. The default setting is
16282 ``auto''.
16283
16284 @table @code
16285 @item show cp-abi
16286 Show the C@t{++} ABI currently in use.
16287
16288 @item set cp-abi
16289 With no argument, show the list of supported C@t{++} ABI's.
16290
16291 @item set cp-abi @var{abi}
16292 @itemx set cp-abi auto
16293 Set the current C@t{++} ABI to @var{abi}, or return to automatic detection.
16294 @end table
16295
16296 @node Messages/Warnings
16297 @section Optional Warnings and Messages
16298
16299 @cindex verbose operation
16300 @cindex optional warnings
16301 By default, @value{GDBN} is silent about its inner workings. If you are
16302 running on a slow machine, you may want to use the @code{set verbose}
16303 command. This makes @value{GDBN} tell you when it does a lengthy
16304 internal operation, so you will not think it has crashed.
16305
16306 Currently, the messages controlled by @code{set verbose} are those
16307 which announce that the symbol table for a source file is being read;
16308 see @code{symbol-file} in @ref{Files, ,Commands to Specify Files}.
16309
16310 @table @code
16311 @kindex set verbose
16312 @item set verbose on
16313 Enables @value{GDBN} output of certain informational messages.
16314
16315 @item set verbose off
16316 Disables @value{GDBN} output of certain informational messages.
16317
16318 @kindex show verbose
16319 @item show verbose
16320 Displays whether @code{set verbose} is on or off.
16321 @end table
16322
16323 By default, if @value{GDBN} encounters bugs in the symbol table of an
16324 object file, it is silent; but if you are debugging a compiler, you may
16325 find this information useful (@pxref{Symbol Errors, ,Errors Reading
16326 Symbol Files}).
16327
16328 @table @code
16329
16330 @kindex set complaints
16331 @item set complaints @var{limit}
16332 Permits @value{GDBN} to output @var{limit} complaints about each type of
16333 unusual symbols before becoming silent about the problem. Set
16334 @var{limit} to zero to suppress all complaints; set it to a large number
16335 to prevent complaints from being suppressed.
16336
16337 @kindex show complaints
16338 @item show complaints
16339 Displays how many symbol complaints @value{GDBN} is permitted to produce.
16340
16341 @end table
16342
16343 By default, @value{GDBN} is cautious, and asks what sometimes seems to be a
16344 lot of stupid questions to confirm certain commands. For example, if
16345 you try to run a program which is already running:
16346
16347 @smallexample
16348 (@value{GDBP}) run
16349 The program being debugged has been started already.
16350 Start it from the beginning? (y or n)
16351 @end smallexample
16352
16353 If you are willing to unflinchingly face the consequences of your own
16354 commands, you can disable this ``feature'':
16355
16356 @table @code
16357
16358 @kindex set confirm
16359 @cindex flinching
16360 @cindex confirmation
16361 @cindex stupid questions
16362 @item set confirm off
16363 Disables confirmation requests.
16364
16365 @item set confirm on
16366 Enables confirmation requests (the default).
16367
16368 @kindex show confirm
16369 @item show confirm
16370 Displays state of confirmation requests.
16371
16372 @end table
16373
16374 @cindex command tracing
16375 If you need to debug user-defined commands or sourced files you may find it
16376 useful to enable @dfn{command tracing}. In this mode each command will be
16377 printed as it is executed, prefixed with one or more @samp{+} symbols, the
16378 quantity denoting the call depth of each command.
16379
16380 @table @code
16381 @kindex set trace-commands
16382 @cindex command scripts, debugging
16383 @item set trace-commands on
16384 Enable command tracing.
16385 @item set trace-commands off
16386 Disable command tracing.
16387 @item show trace-commands
16388 Display the current state of command tracing.
16389 @end table
16390
16391 @node Debugging Output
16392 @section Optional Messages about Internal Happenings
16393 @cindex optional debugging messages
16394
16395 @value{GDBN} has commands that enable optional debugging messages from
16396 various @value{GDBN} subsystems; normally these commands are of
16397 interest to @value{GDBN} maintainers, or when reporting a bug. This
16398 section documents those commands.
16399
16400 @table @code
16401 @kindex set exec-done-display
16402 @item set exec-done-display
16403 Turns on or off the notification of asynchronous commands'
16404 completion. When on, @value{GDBN} will print a message when an
16405 asynchronous command finishes its execution. The default is off.
16406 @kindex show exec-done-display
16407 @item show exec-done-display
16408 Displays the current setting of asynchronous command completion
16409 notification.
16410 @kindex set debug
16411 @cindex gdbarch debugging info
16412 @cindex architecture debugging info
16413 @item set debug arch
16414 Turns on or off display of gdbarch debugging info. The default is off
16415 @kindex show debug
16416 @item show debug arch
16417 Displays the current state of displaying gdbarch debugging info.
16418 @item set debug aix-thread
16419 @cindex AIX threads
16420 Display debugging messages about inner workings of the AIX thread
16421 module.
16422 @item show debug aix-thread
16423 Show the current state of AIX thread debugging info display.
16424 @item set debug event
16425 @cindex event debugging info
16426 Turns on or off display of @value{GDBN} event debugging info. The
16427 default is off.
16428 @item show debug event
16429 Displays the current state of displaying @value{GDBN} event debugging
16430 info.
16431 @item set debug expression
16432 @cindex expression debugging info
16433 Turns on or off display of debugging info about @value{GDBN}
16434 expression parsing. The default is off.
16435 @item show debug expression
16436 Displays the current state of displaying debugging info about
16437 @value{GDBN} expression parsing.
16438 @item set debug frame
16439 @cindex frame debugging info
16440 Turns on or off display of @value{GDBN} frame debugging info. The
16441 default is off.
16442 @item show debug frame
16443 Displays the current state of displaying @value{GDBN} frame debugging
16444 info.
16445 @item set debug infrun
16446 @cindex inferior debugging info
16447 Turns on or off display of @value{GDBN} debugging info for running the inferior.
16448 The default is off. @file{infrun.c} contains GDB's runtime state machine used
16449 for implementing operations such as single-stepping the inferior.
16450 @item show debug infrun
16451 Displays the current state of @value{GDBN} inferior debugging.
16452 @item set debug lin-lwp
16453 @cindex @sc{gnu}/Linux LWP debug messages
16454 @cindex Linux lightweight processes
16455 Turns on or off debugging messages from the Linux LWP debug support.
16456 @item show debug lin-lwp
16457 Show the current state of Linux LWP debugging messages.
16458 @item set debug lin-lwp-async
16459 @cindex @sc{gnu}/Linux LWP async debug messages
16460 @cindex Linux lightweight processes
16461 Turns on or off debugging messages from the Linux LWP async debug support.
16462 @item show debug lin-lwp-async
16463 Show the current state of Linux LWP async debugging messages.
16464 @item set debug observer
16465 @cindex observer debugging info
16466 Turns on or off display of @value{GDBN} observer debugging. This
16467 includes info such as the notification of observable events.
16468 @item show debug observer
16469 Displays the current state of observer debugging.
16470 @item set debug overload
16471 @cindex C@t{++} overload debugging info
16472 Turns on or off display of @value{GDBN} C@t{++} overload debugging
16473 info. This includes info such as ranking of functions, etc. The default
16474 is off.
16475 @item show debug overload
16476 Displays the current state of displaying @value{GDBN} C@t{++} overload
16477 debugging info.
16478 @cindex packets, reporting on stdout
16479 @cindex serial connections, debugging
16480 @cindex debug remote protocol
16481 @cindex remote protocol debugging
16482 @cindex display remote packets
16483 @item set debug remote
16484 Turns on or off display of reports on all packets sent back and forth across
16485 the serial line to the remote machine. The info is printed on the
16486 @value{GDBN} standard output stream. The default is off.
16487 @item show debug remote
16488 Displays the state of display of remote packets.
16489 @item set debug serial
16490 Turns on or off display of @value{GDBN} serial debugging info. The
16491 default is off.
16492 @item show debug serial
16493 Displays the current state of displaying @value{GDBN} serial debugging
16494 info.
16495 @item set debug solib-frv
16496 @cindex FR-V shared-library debugging
16497 Turns on or off debugging messages for FR-V shared-library code.
16498 @item show debug solib-frv
16499 Display the current state of FR-V shared-library code debugging
16500 messages.
16501 @item set debug target
16502 @cindex target debugging info
16503 Turns on or off display of @value{GDBN} target debugging info. This info
16504 includes what is going on at the target level of GDB, as it happens. The
16505 default is 0. Set it to 1 to track events, and to 2 to also track the
16506 value of large memory transfers. Changes to this flag do not take effect
16507 until the next time you connect to a target or use the @code{run} command.
16508 @item show debug target
16509 Displays the current state of displaying @value{GDBN} target debugging
16510 info.
16511 @item set debug timestamp
16512 @cindex timestampping debugging info
16513 Turns on or off display of timestamps with @value{GDBN} debugging info.
16514 When enabled, seconds and microseconds are displayed before each debugging
16515 message.
16516 @item show debug timestamp
16517 Displays the current state of displaying timestamps with @value{GDBN}
16518 debugging info.
16519 @item set debugvarobj
16520 @cindex variable object debugging info
16521 Turns on or off display of @value{GDBN} variable object debugging
16522 info. The default is off.
16523 @item show debugvarobj
16524 Displays the current state of displaying @value{GDBN} variable object
16525 debugging info.
16526 @item set debug xml
16527 @cindex XML parser debugging
16528 Turns on or off debugging messages for built-in XML parsers.
16529 @item show debug xml
16530 Displays the current state of XML debugging messages.
16531 @end table
16532
16533 @node Sequences
16534 @chapter Canned Sequences of Commands
16535
16536 Aside from breakpoint commands (@pxref{Break Commands, ,Breakpoint
16537 Command Lists}), @value{GDBN} provides two ways to store sequences of
16538 commands for execution as a unit: user-defined commands and command
16539 files.
16540
16541 @menu
16542 * Define:: How to define your own commands
16543 * Hooks:: Hooks for user-defined commands
16544 * Command Files:: How to write scripts of commands to be stored in a file
16545 * Output:: Commands for controlled output
16546 @end menu
16547
16548 @node Define
16549 @section User-defined Commands
16550
16551 @cindex user-defined command
16552 @cindex arguments, to user-defined commands
16553 A @dfn{user-defined command} is a sequence of @value{GDBN} commands to
16554 which you assign a new name as a command. This is done with the
16555 @code{define} command. User commands may accept up to 10 arguments
16556 separated by whitespace. Arguments are accessed within the user command
16557 via @code{$arg0@dots{}$arg9}. A trivial example:
16558
16559 @smallexample
16560 define adder
16561 print $arg0 + $arg1 + $arg2
16562 end
16563 @end smallexample
16564
16565 @noindent
16566 To execute the command use:
16567
16568 @smallexample
16569 adder 1 2 3
16570 @end smallexample
16571
16572 @noindent
16573 This defines the command @code{adder}, which prints the sum of
16574 its three arguments. Note the arguments are text substitutions, so they may
16575 reference variables, use complex expressions, or even perform inferior
16576 functions calls.
16577
16578 @cindex argument count in user-defined commands
16579 @cindex how many arguments (user-defined commands)
16580 In addition, @code{$argc} may be used to find out how many arguments have
16581 been passed. This expands to a number in the range 0@dots{}10.
16582
16583 @smallexample
16584 define adder
16585 if $argc == 2
16586 print $arg0 + $arg1
16587 end
16588 if $argc == 3
16589 print $arg0 + $arg1 + $arg2
16590 end
16591 end
16592 @end smallexample
16593
16594 @table @code
16595
16596 @kindex define
16597 @item define @var{commandname}
16598 Define a command named @var{commandname}. If there is already a command
16599 by that name, you are asked to confirm that you want to redefine it.
16600
16601 The definition of the command is made up of other @value{GDBN} command lines,
16602 which are given following the @code{define} command. The end of these
16603 commands is marked by a line containing @code{end}.
16604
16605 @kindex document
16606 @kindex end@r{ (user-defined commands)}
16607 @item document @var{commandname}
16608 Document the user-defined command @var{commandname}, so that it can be
16609 accessed by @code{help}. The command @var{commandname} must already be
16610 defined. This command reads lines of documentation just as @code{define}
16611 reads the lines of the command definition, ending with @code{end}.
16612 After the @code{document} command is finished, @code{help} on command
16613 @var{commandname} displays the documentation you have written.
16614
16615 You may use the @code{document} command again to change the
16616 documentation of a command. Redefining the command with @code{define}
16617 does not change the documentation.
16618
16619 @kindex dont-repeat
16620 @cindex don't repeat command
16621 @item dont-repeat
16622 Used inside a user-defined command, this tells @value{GDBN} that this
16623 command should not be repeated when the user hits @key{RET}
16624 (@pxref{Command Syntax, repeat last command}).
16625
16626 @kindex help user-defined
16627 @item help user-defined
16628 List all user-defined commands, with the first line of the documentation
16629 (if any) for each.
16630
16631 @kindex show user
16632 @item show user
16633 @itemx show user @var{commandname}
16634 Display the @value{GDBN} commands used to define @var{commandname} (but
16635 not its documentation). If no @var{commandname} is given, display the
16636 definitions for all user-defined commands.
16637
16638 @cindex infinite recursion in user-defined commands
16639 @kindex show max-user-call-depth
16640 @kindex set max-user-call-depth
16641 @item show max-user-call-depth
16642 @itemx set max-user-call-depth
16643 The value of @code{max-user-call-depth} controls how many recursion
16644 levels are allowed in user-defined commands before @value{GDBN} suspects an
16645 infinite recursion and aborts the command.
16646 @end table
16647
16648 In addition to the above commands, user-defined commands frequently
16649 use control flow commands, described in @ref{Command Files}.
16650
16651 When user-defined commands are executed, the
16652 commands of the definition are not printed. An error in any command
16653 stops execution of the user-defined command.
16654
16655 If used interactively, commands that would ask for confirmation proceed
16656 without asking when used inside a user-defined command. Many @value{GDBN}
16657 commands that normally print messages to say what they are doing omit the
16658 messages when used in a user-defined command.
16659
16660 @node Hooks
16661 @section User-defined Command Hooks
16662 @cindex command hooks
16663 @cindex hooks, for commands
16664 @cindex hooks, pre-command
16665
16666 @kindex hook
16667 You may define @dfn{hooks}, which are a special kind of user-defined
16668 command. Whenever you run the command @samp{foo}, if the user-defined
16669 command @samp{hook-foo} exists, it is executed (with no arguments)
16670 before that command.
16671
16672 @cindex hooks, post-command
16673 @kindex hookpost
16674 A hook may also be defined which is run after the command you executed.
16675 Whenever you run the command @samp{foo}, if the user-defined command
16676 @samp{hookpost-foo} exists, it is executed (with no arguments) after
16677 that command. Post-execution hooks may exist simultaneously with
16678 pre-execution hooks, for the same command.
16679
16680 It is valid for a hook to call the command which it hooks. If this
16681 occurs, the hook is not re-executed, thereby avoiding infinite recursion.
16682
16683 @c It would be nice if hookpost could be passed a parameter indicating
16684 @c if the command it hooks executed properly or not. FIXME!
16685
16686 @kindex stop@r{, a pseudo-command}
16687 In addition, a pseudo-command, @samp{stop} exists. Defining
16688 (@samp{hook-stop}) makes the associated commands execute every time
16689 execution stops in your program: before breakpoint commands are run,
16690 displays are printed, or the stack frame is printed.
16691
16692 For example, to ignore @code{SIGALRM} signals while
16693 single-stepping, but treat them normally during normal execution,
16694 you could define:
16695
16696 @smallexample
16697 define hook-stop
16698 handle SIGALRM nopass
16699 end
16700
16701 define hook-run
16702 handle SIGALRM pass
16703 end
16704
16705 define hook-continue
16706 handle SIGALRM pass
16707 end
16708 @end smallexample
16709
16710 As a further example, to hook at the beginning and end of the @code{echo}
16711 command, and to add extra text to the beginning and end of the message,
16712 you could define:
16713
16714 @smallexample
16715 define hook-echo
16716 echo <<<---
16717 end
16718
16719 define hookpost-echo
16720 echo --->>>\n
16721 end
16722
16723 (@value{GDBP}) echo Hello World
16724 <<<---Hello World--->>>
16725 (@value{GDBP})
16726
16727 @end smallexample
16728
16729 You can define a hook for any single-word command in @value{GDBN}, but
16730 not for command aliases; you should define a hook for the basic command
16731 name, e.g.@: @code{backtrace} rather than @code{bt}.
16732 @c FIXME! So how does Joe User discover whether a command is an alias
16733 @c or not?
16734 If an error occurs during the execution of your hook, execution of
16735 @value{GDBN} commands stops and @value{GDBN} issues a prompt
16736 (before the command that you actually typed had a chance to run).
16737
16738 If you try to define a hook which does not match any known command, you
16739 get a warning from the @code{define} command.
16740
16741 @node Command Files
16742 @section Command Files
16743
16744 @cindex command files
16745 @cindex scripting commands
16746 A command file for @value{GDBN} is a text file made of lines that are
16747 @value{GDBN} commands. Comments (lines starting with @kbd{#}) may
16748 also be included. An empty line in a command file does nothing; it
16749 does not mean to repeat the last command, as it would from the
16750 terminal.
16751
16752 You can request the execution of a command file with the @code{source}
16753 command:
16754
16755 @table @code
16756 @kindex source
16757 @cindex execute commands from a file
16758 @item source [@code{-v}] @var{filename}
16759 Execute the command file @var{filename}.
16760 @end table
16761
16762 The lines in a command file are generally executed sequentially,
16763 unless the order of execution is changed by one of the
16764 @emph{flow-control commands} described below. The commands are not
16765 printed as they are executed. An error in any command terminates
16766 execution of the command file and control is returned to the console.
16767
16768 @value{GDBN} searches for @var{filename} in the current directory and then
16769 on the search path (specified with the @samp{directory} command).
16770
16771 If @code{-v}, for verbose mode, is given then @value{GDBN} displays
16772 each command as it is executed. The option must be given before
16773 @var{filename}, and is interpreted as part of the filename anywhere else.
16774
16775 Commands that would ask for confirmation if used interactively proceed
16776 without asking when used in a command file. Many @value{GDBN} commands that
16777 normally print messages to say what they are doing omit the messages
16778 when called from command files.
16779
16780 @value{GDBN} also accepts command input from standard input. In this
16781 mode, normal output goes to standard output and error output goes to
16782 standard error. Errors in a command file supplied on standard input do
16783 not terminate execution of the command file---execution continues with
16784 the next command.
16785
16786 @smallexample
16787 gdb < cmds > log 2>&1
16788 @end smallexample
16789
16790 (The syntax above will vary depending on the shell used.) This example
16791 will execute commands from the file @file{cmds}. All output and errors
16792 would be directed to @file{log}.
16793
16794 Since commands stored on command files tend to be more general than
16795 commands typed interactively, they frequently need to deal with
16796 complicated situations, such as different or unexpected values of
16797 variables and symbols, changes in how the program being debugged is
16798 built, etc. @value{GDBN} provides a set of flow-control commands to
16799 deal with these complexities. Using these commands, you can write
16800 complex scripts that loop over data structures, execute commands
16801 conditionally, etc.
16802
16803 @table @code
16804 @kindex if
16805 @kindex else
16806 @item if
16807 @itemx else
16808 This command allows to include in your script conditionally executed
16809 commands. The @code{if} command takes a single argument, which is an
16810 expression to evaluate. It is followed by a series of commands that
16811 are executed only if the expression is true (its value is nonzero).
16812 There can then optionally be an @code{else} line, followed by a series
16813 of commands that are only executed if the expression was false. The
16814 end of the list is marked by a line containing @code{end}.
16815
16816 @kindex while
16817 @item while
16818 This command allows to write loops. Its syntax is similar to
16819 @code{if}: the command takes a single argument, which is an expression
16820 to evaluate, and must be followed by the commands to execute, one per
16821 line, terminated by an @code{end}. These commands are called the
16822 @dfn{body} of the loop. The commands in the body of @code{while} are
16823 executed repeatedly as long as the expression evaluates to true.
16824
16825 @kindex loop_break
16826 @item loop_break
16827 This command exits the @code{while} loop in whose body it is included.
16828 Execution of the script continues after that @code{while}s @code{end}
16829 line.
16830
16831 @kindex loop_continue
16832 @item loop_continue
16833 This command skips the execution of the rest of the body of commands
16834 in the @code{while} loop in whose body it is included. Execution
16835 branches to the beginning of the @code{while} loop, where it evaluates
16836 the controlling expression.
16837
16838 @kindex end@r{ (if/else/while commands)}
16839 @item end
16840 Terminate the block of commands that are the body of @code{if},
16841 @code{else}, or @code{while} flow-control commands.
16842 @end table
16843
16844
16845 @node Output
16846 @section Commands for Controlled Output
16847
16848 During the execution of a command file or a user-defined command, normal
16849 @value{GDBN} output is suppressed; the only output that appears is what is
16850 explicitly printed by the commands in the definition. This section
16851 describes three commands useful for generating exactly the output you
16852 want.
16853
16854 @table @code
16855 @kindex echo
16856 @item echo @var{text}
16857 @c I do not consider backslash-space a standard C escape sequence
16858 @c because it is not in ANSI.
16859 Print @var{text}. Nonprinting characters can be included in
16860 @var{text} using C escape sequences, such as @samp{\n} to print a
16861 newline. @strong{No newline is printed unless you specify one.}
16862 In addition to the standard C escape sequences, a backslash followed
16863 by a space stands for a space. This is useful for displaying a
16864 string with spaces at the beginning or the end, since leading and
16865 trailing spaces are otherwise trimmed from all arguments.
16866 To print @samp{@w{ }and foo =@w{ }}, use the command
16867 @samp{echo \@w{ }and foo = \@w{ }}.
16868
16869 A backslash at the end of @var{text} can be used, as in C, to continue
16870 the command onto subsequent lines. For example,
16871
16872 @smallexample
16873 echo This is some text\n\
16874 which is continued\n\
16875 onto several lines.\n
16876 @end smallexample
16877
16878 produces the same output as
16879
16880 @smallexample
16881 echo This is some text\n
16882 echo which is continued\n
16883 echo onto several lines.\n
16884 @end smallexample
16885
16886 @kindex output
16887 @item output @var{expression}
16888 Print the value of @var{expression} and nothing but that value: no
16889 newlines, no @samp{$@var{nn} = }. The value is not entered in the
16890 value history either. @xref{Expressions, ,Expressions}, for more information
16891 on expressions.
16892
16893 @item output/@var{fmt} @var{expression}
16894 Print the value of @var{expression} in format @var{fmt}. You can use
16895 the same formats as for @code{print}. @xref{Output Formats,,Output
16896 Formats}, for more information.
16897
16898 @kindex printf
16899 @item printf @var{template}, @var{expressions}@dots{}
16900 Print the values of one or more @var{expressions} under the control of
16901 the string @var{template}. To print several values, make
16902 @var{expressions} be a comma-separated list of individual expressions,
16903 which may be either numbers or pointers. Their values are printed as
16904 specified by @var{template}, exactly as a C program would do by
16905 executing the code below:
16906
16907 @smallexample
16908 printf (@var{template}, @var{expressions}@dots{});
16909 @end smallexample
16910
16911 As in @code{C} @code{printf}, ordinary characters in @var{template}
16912 are printed verbatim, while @dfn{conversion specification} introduced
16913 by the @samp{%} character cause subsequent @var{expressions} to be
16914 evaluated, their values converted and formatted according to type and
16915 style information encoded in the conversion specifications, and then
16916 printed.
16917
16918 For example, you can print two values in hex like this:
16919
16920 @smallexample
16921 printf "foo, bar-foo = 0x%x, 0x%x\n", foo, bar-foo
16922 @end smallexample
16923
16924 @code{printf} supports all the standard @code{C} conversion
16925 specifications, including the flags and modifiers between the @samp{%}
16926 character and the conversion letter, with the following exceptions:
16927
16928 @itemize @bullet
16929 @item
16930 The argument-ordering modifiers, such as @samp{2$}, are not supported.
16931
16932 @item
16933 The modifier @samp{*} is not supported for specifying precision or
16934 width.
16935
16936 @item
16937 The @samp{'} flag (for separation of digits into groups according to
16938 @code{LC_NUMERIC'}) is not supported.
16939
16940 @item
16941 The type modifiers @samp{hh}, @samp{j}, @samp{t}, and @samp{z} are not
16942 supported.
16943
16944 @item
16945 The conversion letter @samp{n} (as in @samp{%n}) is not supported.
16946
16947 @item
16948 The conversion letters @samp{a} and @samp{A} are not supported.
16949 @end itemize
16950
16951 @noindent
16952 Note that the @samp{ll} type modifier is supported only if the
16953 underlying @code{C} implementation used to build @value{GDBN} supports
16954 the @code{long long int} type, and the @samp{L} type modifier is
16955 supported only if @code{long double} type is available.
16956
16957 As in @code{C}, @code{printf} supports simple backslash-escape
16958 sequences, such as @code{\n}, @samp{\t}, @samp{\\}, @samp{\"},
16959 @samp{\a}, and @samp{\f}, that consist of backslash followed by a
16960 single character. Octal and hexadecimal escape sequences are not
16961 supported.
16962
16963 Additionally, @code{printf} supports conversion specifications for DFP
16964 (@dfn{Decimal Floating Point}) types using the following length modifiers
16965 together with a floating point specifier.
16966 letters:
16967
16968 @itemize @bullet
16969 @item
16970 @samp{H} for printing @code{Decimal32} types.
16971
16972 @item
16973 @samp{D} for printing @code{Decimal64} types.
16974
16975 @item
16976 @samp{DD} for printing @code{Decimal128} types.
16977 @end itemize
16978
16979 If the underlying @code{C} implementation used to build @value{GDBN} has
16980 support for the three length modifiers for DFP types, other modifiers
16981 such as width and precision will also be available for @value{GDBN} to use.
16982
16983 In case there is no such @code{C} support, no additional modifiers will be
16984 available and the value will be printed in the standard way.
16985
16986 Here's an example of printing DFP types using the above conversion letters:
16987 @smallexample
16988 printf "D32: %Hf - D64: %Df - D128: %DDf\n",1.2345df,1.2E10dd,1.2E1dl
16989 @end smallexample
16990
16991 @end table
16992
16993 @node Interpreters
16994 @chapter Command Interpreters
16995 @cindex command interpreters
16996
16997 @value{GDBN} supports multiple command interpreters, and some command
16998 infrastructure to allow users or user interface writers to switch
16999 between interpreters or run commands in other interpreters.
17000
17001 @value{GDBN} currently supports two command interpreters, the console
17002 interpreter (sometimes called the command-line interpreter or @sc{cli})
17003 and the machine interface interpreter (or @sc{gdb/mi}). This manual
17004 describes both of these interfaces in great detail.
17005
17006 By default, @value{GDBN} will start with the console interpreter.
17007 However, the user may choose to start @value{GDBN} with another
17008 interpreter by specifying the @option{-i} or @option{--interpreter}
17009 startup options. Defined interpreters include:
17010
17011 @table @code
17012 @item console
17013 @cindex console interpreter
17014 The traditional console or command-line interpreter. This is the most often
17015 used interpreter with @value{GDBN}. With no interpreter specified at runtime,
17016 @value{GDBN} will use this interpreter.
17017
17018 @item mi
17019 @cindex mi interpreter
17020 The newest @sc{gdb/mi} interface (currently @code{mi2}). Used primarily
17021 by programs wishing to use @value{GDBN} as a backend for a debugger GUI
17022 or an IDE. For more information, see @ref{GDB/MI, ,The @sc{gdb/mi}
17023 Interface}.
17024
17025 @item mi2
17026 @cindex mi2 interpreter
17027 The current @sc{gdb/mi} interface.
17028
17029 @item mi1
17030 @cindex mi1 interpreter
17031 The @sc{gdb/mi} interface included in @value{GDBN} 5.1, 5.2, and 5.3.
17032
17033 @end table
17034
17035 @cindex invoke another interpreter
17036 The interpreter being used by @value{GDBN} may not be dynamically
17037 switched at runtime. Although possible, this could lead to a very
17038 precarious situation. Consider an IDE using @sc{gdb/mi}. If a user
17039 enters the command "interpreter-set console" in a console view,
17040 @value{GDBN} would switch to using the console interpreter, rendering
17041 the IDE inoperable!
17042
17043 @kindex interpreter-exec
17044 Although you may only choose a single interpreter at startup, you may execute
17045 commands in any interpreter from the current interpreter using the appropriate
17046 command. If you are running the console interpreter, simply use the
17047 @code{interpreter-exec} command:
17048
17049 @smallexample
17050 interpreter-exec mi "-data-list-register-names"
17051 @end smallexample
17052
17053 @sc{gdb/mi} has a similar command, although it is only available in versions of
17054 @value{GDBN} which support @sc{gdb/mi} version 2 (or greater).
17055
17056 @node TUI
17057 @chapter @value{GDBN} Text User Interface
17058 @cindex TUI
17059 @cindex Text User Interface
17060
17061 @menu
17062 * TUI Overview:: TUI overview
17063 * TUI Keys:: TUI key bindings
17064 * TUI Single Key Mode:: TUI single key mode
17065 * TUI Commands:: TUI-specific commands
17066 * TUI Configuration:: TUI configuration variables
17067 @end menu
17068
17069 The @value{GDBN} Text User Interface (TUI) is a terminal
17070 interface which uses the @code{curses} library to show the source
17071 file, the assembly output, the program registers and @value{GDBN}
17072 commands in separate text windows. The TUI mode is supported only
17073 on platforms where a suitable version of the @code{curses} library
17074 is available.
17075
17076 @pindex @value{GDBTUI}
17077 The TUI mode is enabled by default when you invoke @value{GDBN} as
17078 either @samp{@value{GDBTUI}} or @samp{@value{GDBP} -tui}.
17079 You can also switch in and out of TUI mode while @value{GDBN} runs by
17080 using various TUI commands and key bindings, such as @kbd{C-x C-a}.
17081 @xref{TUI Keys, ,TUI Key Bindings}.
17082
17083 @node TUI Overview
17084 @section TUI Overview
17085
17086 In TUI mode, @value{GDBN} can display several text windows:
17087
17088 @table @emph
17089 @item command
17090 This window is the @value{GDBN} command window with the @value{GDBN}
17091 prompt and the @value{GDBN} output. The @value{GDBN} input is still
17092 managed using readline.
17093
17094 @item source
17095 The source window shows the source file of the program. The current
17096 line and active breakpoints are displayed in this window.
17097
17098 @item assembly
17099 The assembly window shows the disassembly output of the program.
17100
17101 @item register
17102 This window shows the processor registers. Registers are highlighted
17103 when their values change.
17104 @end table
17105
17106 The source and assembly windows show the current program position
17107 by highlighting the current line and marking it with a @samp{>} marker.
17108 Breakpoints are indicated with two markers. The first marker
17109 indicates the breakpoint type:
17110
17111 @table @code
17112 @item B
17113 Breakpoint which was hit at least once.
17114
17115 @item b
17116 Breakpoint which was never hit.
17117
17118 @item H
17119 Hardware breakpoint which was hit at least once.
17120
17121 @item h
17122 Hardware breakpoint which was never hit.
17123 @end table
17124
17125 The second marker indicates whether the breakpoint is enabled or not:
17126
17127 @table @code
17128 @item +
17129 Breakpoint is enabled.
17130
17131 @item -
17132 Breakpoint is disabled.
17133 @end table
17134
17135 The source, assembly and register windows are updated when the current
17136 thread changes, when the frame changes, or when the program counter
17137 changes.
17138
17139 These windows are not all visible at the same time. The command
17140 window is always visible. The others can be arranged in several
17141 layouts:
17142
17143 @itemize @bullet
17144 @item
17145 source only,
17146
17147 @item
17148 assembly only,
17149
17150 @item
17151 source and assembly,
17152
17153 @item
17154 source and registers, or
17155
17156 @item
17157 assembly and registers.
17158 @end itemize
17159
17160 A status line above the command window shows the following information:
17161
17162 @table @emph
17163 @item target
17164 Indicates the current @value{GDBN} target.
17165 (@pxref{Targets, ,Specifying a Debugging Target}).
17166
17167 @item process
17168 Gives the current process or thread number.
17169 When no process is being debugged, this field is set to @code{No process}.
17170
17171 @item function
17172 Gives the current function name for the selected frame.
17173 The name is demangled if demangling is turned on (@pxref{Print Settings}).
17174 When there is no symbol corresponding to the current program counter,
17175 the string @code{??} is displayed.
17176
17177 @item line
17178 Indicates the current line number for the selected frame.
17179 When the current line number is not known, the string @code{??} is displayed.
17180
17181 @item pc
17182 Indicates the current program counter address.
17183 @end table
17184
17185 @node TUI Keys
17186 @section TUI Key Bindings
17187 @cindex TUI key bindings
17188
17189 The TUI installs several key bindings in the readline keymaps
17190 (@pxref{Command Line Editing}). The following key bindings
17191 are installed for both TUI mode and the @value{GDBN} standard mode.
17192
17193 @table @kbd
17194 @kindex C-x C-a
17195 @item C-x C-a
17196 @kindex C-x a
17197 @itemx C-x a
17198 @kindex C-x A
17199 @itemx C-x A
17200 Enter or leave the TUI mode. When leaving the TUI mode,
17201 the curses window management stops and @value{GDBN} operates using
17202 its standard mode, writing on the terminal directly. When reentering
17203 the TUI mode, control is given back to the curses windows.
17204 The screen is then refreshed.
17205
17206 @kindex C-x 1
17207 @item C-x 1
17208 Use a TUI layout with only one window. The layout will
17209 either be @samp{source} or @samp{assembly}. When the TUI mode
17210 is not active, it will switch to the TUI mode.
17211
17212 Think of this key binding as the Emacs @kbd{C-x 1} binding.
17213
17214 @kindex C-x 2
17215 @item C-x 2
17216 Use a TUI layout with at least two windows. When the current
17217 layout already has two windows, the next layout with two windows is used.
17218 When a new layout is chosen, one window will always be common to the
17219 previous layout and the new one.
17220
17221 Think of it as the Emacs @kbd{C-x 2} binding.
17222
17223 @kindex C-x o
17224 @item C-x o
17225 Change the active window. The TUI associates several key bindings
17226 (like scrolling and arrow keys) with the active window. This command
17227 gives the focus to the next TUI window.
17228
17229 Think of it as the Emacs @kbd{C-x o} binding.
17230
17231 @kindex C-x s
17232 @item C-x s
17233 Switch in and out of the TUI SingleKey mode that binds single
17234 keys to @value{GDBN} commands (@pxref{TUI Single Key Mode}).
17235 @end table
17236
17237 The following key bindings only work in the TUI mode:
17238
17239 @table @asis
17240 @kindex PgUp
17241 @item @key{PgUp}
17242 Scroll the active window one page up.
17243
17244 @kindex PgDn
17245 @item @key{PgDn}
17246 Scroll the active window one page down.
17247
17248 @kindex Up
17249 @item @key{Up}
17250 Scroll the active window one line up.
17251
17252 @kindex Down
17253 @item @key{Down}
17254 Scroll the active window one line down.
17255
17256 @kindex Left
17257 @item @key{Left}
17258 Scroll the active window one column left.
17259
17260 @kindex Right
17261 @item @key{Right}
17262 Scroll the active window one column right.
17263
17264 @kindex C-L
17265 @item @kbd{C-L}
17266 Refresh the screen.
17267 @end table
17268
17269 Because the arrow keys scroll the active window in the TUI mode, they
17270 are not available for their normal use by readline unless the command
17271 window has the focus. When another window is active, you must use
17272 other readline key bindings such as @kbd{C-p}, @kbd{C-n}, @kbd{C-b}
17273 and @kbd{C-f} to control the command window.
17274
17275 @node TUI Single Key Mode
17276 @section TUI Single Key Mode
17277 @cindex TUI single key mode
17278
17279 The TUI also provides a @dfn{SingleKey} mode, which binds several
17280 frequently used @value{GDBN} commands to single keys. Type @kbd{C-x s} to
17281 switch into this mode, where the following key bindings are used:
17282
17283 @table @kbd
17284 @kindex c @r{(SingleKey TUI key)}
17285 @item c
17286 continue
17287
17288 @kindex d @r{(SingleKey TUI key)}
17289 @item d
17290 down
17291
17292 @kindex f @r{(SingleKey TUI key)}
17293 @item f
17294 finish
17295
17296 @kindex n @r{(SingleKey TUI key)}
17297 @item n
17298 next
17299
17300 @kindex q @r{(SingleKey TUI key)}
17301 @item q
17302 exit the SingleKey mode.
17303
17304 @kindex r @r{(SingleKey TUI key)}
17305 @item r
17306 run
17307
17308 @kindex s @r{(SingleKey TUI key)}
17309 @item s
17310 step
17311
17312 @kindex u @r{(SingleKey TUI key)}
17313 @item u
17314 up
17315
17316 @kindex v @r{(SingleKey TUI key)}
17317 @item v
17318 info locals
17319
17320 @kindex w @r{(SingleKey TUI key)}
17321 @item w
17322 where
17323 @end table
17324
17325 Other keys temporarily switch to the @value{GDBN} command prompt.
17326 The key that was pressed is inserted in the editing buffer so that
17327 it is possible to type most @value{GDBN} commands without interaction
17328 with the TUI SingleKey mode. Once the command is entered the TUI
17329 SingleKey mode is restored. The only way to permanently leave
17330 this mode is by typing @kbd{q} or @kbd{C-x s}.
17331
17332
17333 @node TUI Commands
17334 @section TUI-specific Commands
17335 @cindex TUI commands
17336
17337 The TUI has specific commands to control the text windows.
17338 These commands are always available, even when @value{GDBN} is not in
17339 the TUI mode. When @value{GDBN} is in the standard mode, most
17340 of these commands will automatically switch to the TUI mode.
17341
17342 @table @code
17343 @item info win
17344 @kindex info win
17345 List and give the size of all displayed windows.
17346
17347 @item layout next
17348 @kindex layout
17349 Display the next layout.
17350
17351 @item layout prev
17352 Display the previous layout.
17353
17354 @item layout src
17355 Display the source window only.
17356
17357 @item layout asm
17358 Display the assembly window only.
17359
17360 @item layout split
17361 Display the source and assembly window.
17362
17363 @item layout regs
17364 Display the register window together with the source or assembly window.
17365
17366 @item focus next
17367 @kindex focus
17368 Make the next window active for scrolling.
17369
17370 @item focus prev
17371 Make the previous window active for scrolling.
17372
17373 @item focus src
17374 Make the source window active for scrolling.
17375
17376 @item focus asm
17377 Make the assembly window active for scrolling.
17378
17379 @item focus regs
17380 Make the register window active for scrolling.
17381
17382 @item focus cmd
17383 Make the command window active for scrolling.
17384
17385 @item refresh
17386 @kindex refresh
17387 Refresh the screen. This is similar to typing @kbd{C-L}.
17388
17389 @item tui reg float
17390 @kindex tui reg
17391 Show the floating point registers in the register window.
17392
17393 @item tui reg general
17394 Show the general registers in the register window.
17395
17396 @item tui reg next
17397 Show the next register group. The list of register groups as well as
17398 their order is target specific. The predefined register groups are the
17399 following: @code{general}, @code{float}, @code{system}, @code{vector},
17400 @code{all}, @code{save}, @code{restore}.
17401
17402 @item tui reg system
17403 Show the system registers in the register window.
17404
17405 @item update
17406 @kindex update
17407 Update the source window and the current execution point.
17408
17409 @item winheight @var{name} +@var{count}
17410 @itemx winheight @var{name} -@var{count}
17411 @kindex winheight
17412 Change the height of the window @var{name} by @var{count}
17413 lines. Positive counts increase the height, while negative counts
17414 decrease it.
17415
17416 @item tabset @var{nchars}
17417 @kindex tabset
17418 Set the width of tab stops to be @var{nchars} characters.
17419 @end table
17420
17421 @node TUI Configuration
17422 @section TUI Configuration Variables
17423 @cindex TUI configuration variables
17424
17425 Several configuration variables control the appearance of TUI windows.
17426
17427 @table @code
17428 @item set tui border-kind @var{kind}
17429 @kindex set tui border-kind
17430 Select the border appearance for the source, assembly and register windows.
17431 The possible values are the following:
17432 @table @code
17433 @item space
17434 Use a space character to draw the border.
17435
17436 @item ascii
17437 Use @sc{ascii} characters @samp{+}, @samp{-} and @samp{|} to draw the border.
17438
17439 @item acs
17440 Use the Alternate Character Set to draw the border. The border is
17441 drawn using character line graphics if the terminal supports them.
17442 @end table
17443
17444 @item set tui border-mode @var{mode}
17445 @kindex set tui border-mode
17446 @itemx set tui active-border-mode @var{mode}
17447 @kindex set tui active-border-mode
17448 Select the display attributes for the borders of the inactive windows
17449 or the active window. The @var{mode} can be one of the following:
17450 @table @code
17451 @item normal
17452 Use normal attributes to display the border.
17453
17454 @item standout
17455 Use standout mode.
17456
17457 @item reverse
17458 Use reverse video mode.
17459
17460 @item half
17461 Use half bright mode.
17462
17463 @item half-standout
17464 Use half bright and standout mode.
17465
17466 @item bold
17467 Use extra bright or bold mode.
17468
17469 @item bold-standout
17470 Use extra bright or bold and standout mode.
17471 @end table
17472 @end table
17473
17474 @node Emacs
17475 @chapter Using @value{GDBN} under @sc{gnu} Emacs
17476
17477 @cindex Emacs
17478 @cindex @sc{gnu} Emacs
17479 A special interface allows you to use @sc{gnu} Emacs to view (and
17480 edit) the source files for the program you are debugging with
17481 @value{GDBN}.
17482
17483 To use this interface, use the command @kbd{M-x gdb} in Emacs. Give the
17484 executable file you want to debug as an argument. This command starts
17485 @value{GDBN} as a subprocess of Emacs, with input and output through a newly
17486 created Emacs buffer.
17487 @c (Do not use the @code{-tui} option to run @value{GDBN} from Emacs.)
17488
17489 Running @value{GDBN} under Emacs can be just like running @value{GDBN} normally except for two
17490 things:
17491
17492 @itemize @bullet
17493 @item
17494 All ``terminal'' input and output goes through an Emacs buffer, called
17495 the GUD buffer.
17496
17497 This applies both to @value{GDBN} commands and their output, and to the input
17498 and output done by the program you are debugging.
17499
17500 This is useful because it means that you can copy the text of previous
17501 commands and input them again; you can even use parts of the output
17502 in this way.
17503
17504 All the facilities of Emacs' Shell mode are available for interacting
17505 with your program. In particular, you can send signals the usual
17506 way---for example, @kbd{C-c C-c} for an interrupt, @kbd{C-c C-z} for a
17507 stop.
17508
17509 @item
17510 @value{GDBN} displays source code through Emacs.
17511
17512 Each time @value{GDBN} displays a stack frame, Emacs automatically finds the
17513 source file for that frame and puts an arrow (@samp{=>}) at the
17514 left margin of the current line. Emacs uses a separate buffer for
17515 source display, and splits the screen to show both your @value{GDBN} session
17516 and the source.
17517
17518 Explicit @value{GDBN} @code{list} or search commands still produce output as
17519 usual, but you probably have no reason to use them from Emacs.
17520 @end itemize
17521
17522 We call this @dfn{text command mode}. Emacs 22.1, and later, also uses
17523 a graphical mode, enabled by default, which provides further buffers
17524 that can control the execution and describe the state of your program.
17525 @xref{GDB Graphical Interface,,, Emacs, The @sc{gnu} Emacs Manual}.
17526
17527 If you specify an absolute file name when prompted for the @kbd{M-x
17528 gdb} argument, then Emacs sets your current working directory to where
17529 your program resides. If you only specify the file name, then Emacs
17530 sets your current working directory to to the directory associated
17531 with the previous buffer. In this case, @value{GDBN} may find your
17532 program by searching your environment's @code{PATH} variable, but on
17533 some operating systems it might not find the source. So, although the
17534 @value{GDBN} input and output session proceeds normally, the auxiliary
17535 buffer does not display the current source and line of execution.
17536
17537 The initial working directory of @value{GDBN} is printed on the top
17538 line of the GUD buffer and this serves as a default for the commands
17539 that specify files for @value{GDBN} to operate on. @xref{Files,
17540 ,Commands to Specify Files}.
17541
17542 By default, @kbd{M-x gdb} calls the program called @file{gdb}. If you
17543 need to call @value{GDBN} by a different name (for example, if you
17544 keep several configurations around, with different names) you can
17545 customize the Emacs variable @code{gud-gdb-command-name} to run the
17546 one you want.
17547
17548 In the GUD buffer, you can use these special Emacs commands in
17549 addition to the standard Shell mode commands:
17550
17551 @table @kbd
17552 @item C-h m
17553 Describe the features of Emacs' GUD Mode.
17554
17555 @item C-c C-s
17556 Execute to another source line, like the @value{GDBN} @code{step} command; also
17557 update the display window to show the current file and location.
17558
17559 @item C-c C-n
17560 Execute to next source line in this function, skipping all function
17561 calls, like the @value{GDBN} @code{next} command. Then update the display window
17562 to show the current file and location.
17563
17564 @item C-c C-i
17565 Execute one instruction, like the @value{GDBN} @code{stepi} command; update
17566 display window accordingly.
17567
17568 @item C-c C-f
17569 Execute until exit from the selected stack frame, like the @value{GDBN}
17570 @code{finish} command.
17571
17572 @item C-c C-r
17573 Continue execution of your program, like the @value{GDBN} @code{continue}
17574 command.
17575
17576 @item C-c <
17577 Go up the number of frames indicated by the numeric argument
17578 (@pxref{Arguments, , Numeric Arguments, Emacs, The @sc{gnu} Emacs Manual}),
17579 like the @value{GDBN} @code{up} command.
17580
17581 @item C-c >
17582 Go down the number of frames indicated by the numeric argument, like the
17583 @value{GDBN} @code{down} command.
17584 @end table
17585
17586 In any source file, the Emacs command @kbd{C-x @key{SPC}} (@code{gud-break})
17587 tells @value{GDBN} to set a breakpoint on the source line point is on.
17588
17589 In text command mode, if you type @kbd{M-x speedbar}, Emacs displays a
17590 separate frame which shows a backtrace when the GUD buffer is current.
17591 Move point to any frame in the stack and type @key{RET} to make it
17592 become the current frame and display the associated source in the
17593 source buffer. Alternatively, click @kbd{Mouse-2} to make the
17594 selected frame become the current one. In graphical mode, the
17595 speedbar displays watch expressions.
17596
17597 If you accidentally delete the source-display buffer, an easy way to get
17598 it back is to type the command @code{f} in the @value{GDBN} buffer, to
17599 request a frame display; when you run under Emacs, this recreates
17600 the source buffer if necessary to show you the context of the current
17601 frame.
17602
17603 The source files displayed in Emacs are in ordinary Emacs buffers
17604 which are visiting the source files in the usual way. You can edit
17605 the files with these buffers if you wish; but keep in mind that @value{GDBN}
17606 communicates with Emacs in terms of line numbers. If you add or
17607 delete lines from the text, the line numbers that @value{GDBN} knows cease
17608 to correspond properly with the code.
17609
17610 A more detailed description of Emacs' interaction with @value{GDBN} is
17611 given in the Emacs manual (@pxref{Debuggers,,, Emacs, The @sc{gnu}
17612 Emacs Manual}).
17613
17614 @c The following dropped because Epoch is nonstandard. Reactivate
17615 @c if/when v19 does something similar. ---doc@cygnus.com 19dec1990
17616 @ignore
17617 @kindex Emacs Epoch environment
17618 @kindex Epoch
17619 @kindex inspect
17620
17621 Version 18 of @sc{gnu} Emacs has a built-in window system
17622 called the @code{epoch}
17623 environment. Users of this environment can use a new command,
17624 @code{inspect} which performs identically to @code{print} except that
17625 each value is printed in its own window.
17626 @end ignore
17627
17628
17629 @node GDB/MI
17630 @chapter The @sc{gdb/mi} Interface
17631
17632 @unnumberedsec Function and Purpose
17633
17634 @cindex @sc{gdb/mi}, its purpose
17635 @sc{gdb/mi} is a line based machine oriented text interface to
17636 @value{GDBN} and is activated by specifying using the
17637 @option{--interpreter} command line option (@pxref{Mode Options}). It
17638 is specifically intended to support the development of systems which
17639 use the debugger as just one small component of a larger system.
17640
17641 This chapter is a specification of the @sc{gdb/mi} interface. It is written
17642 in the form of a reference manual.
17643
17644 Note that @sc{gdb/mi} is still under construction, so some of the
17645 features described below are incomplete and subject to change
17646 (@pxref{GDB/MI Development and Front Ends, , @sc{gdb/mi} Development and Front Ends}).
17647
17648 @unnumberedsec Notation and Terminology
17649
17650 @cindex notational conventions, for @sc{gdb/mi}
17651 This chapter uses the following notation:
17652
17653 @itemize @bullet
17654 @item
17655 @code{|} separates two alternatives.
17656
17657 @item
17658 @code{[ @var{something} ]} indicates that @var{something} is optional:
17659 it may or may not be given.
17660
17661 @item
17662 @code{( @var{group} )*} means that @var{group} inside the parentheses
17663 may repeat zero or more times.
17664
17665 @item
17666 @code{( @var{group} )+} means that @var{group} inside the parentheses
17667 may repeat one or more times.
17668
17669 @item
17670 @code{"@var{string}"} means a literal @var{string}.
17671 @end itemize
17672
17673 @ignore
17674 @heading Dependencies
17675 @end ignore
17676
17677 @menu
17678 * GDB/MI Command Syntax::
17679 * GDB/MI Compatibility with CLI::
17680 * GDB/MI Development and Front Ends::
17681 * GDB/MI Output Records::
17682 * GDB/MI Simple Examples::
17683 * GDB/MI Command Description Format::
17684 * GDB/MI Breakpoint Commands::
17685 * GDB/MI Program Context::
17686 * GDB/MI Thread Commands::
17687 * GDB/MI Program Execution::
17688 * GDB/MI Stack Manipulation::
17689 * GDB/MI Variable Objects::
17690 * GDB/MI Data Manipulation::
17691 * GDB/MI Tracepoint Commands::
17692 * GDB/MI Symbol Query::
17693 * GDB/MI File Commands::
17694 @ignore
17695 * GDB/MI Kod Commands::
17696 * GDB/MI Memory Overlay Commands::
17697 * GDB/MI Signal Handling Commands::
17698 @end ignore
17699 * GDB/MI Target Manipulation::
17700 * GDB/MI File Transfer Commands::
17701 * GDB/MI Miscellaneous Commands::
17702 @end menu
17703
17704 @c %%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%% SECTION %%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%
17705 @node GDB/MI Command Syntax
17706 @section @sc{gdb/mi} Command Syntax
17707
17708 @menu
17709 * GDB/MI Input Syntax::
17710 * GDB/MI Output Syntax::
17711 @end menu
17712
17713 @node GDB/MI Input Syntax
17714 @subsection @sc{gdb/mi} Input Syntax
17715
17716 @cindex input syntax for @sc{gdb/mi}
17717 @cindex @sc{gdb/mi}, input syntax
17718 @table @code
17719 @item @var{command} @expansion{}
17720 @code{@var{cli-command} | @var{mi-command}}
17721
17722 @item @var{cli-command} @expansion{}
17723 @code{[ @var{token} ] @var{cli-command} @var{nl}}, where
17724 @var{cli-command} is any existing @value{GDBN} CLI command.
17725
17726 @item @var{mi-command} @expansion{}
17727 @code{[ @var{token} ] "-" @var{operation} ( " " @var{option} )*
17728 @code{[} " --" @code{]} ( " " @var{parameter} )* @var{nl}}
17729
17730 @item @var{token} @expansion{}
17731 "any sequence of digits"
17732
17733 @item @var{option} @expansion{}
17734 @code{"-" @var{parameter} [ " " @var{parameter} ]}
17735
17736 @item @var{parameter} @expansion{}
17737 @code{@var{non-blank-sequence} | @var{c-string}}
17738
17739 @item @var{operation} @expansion{}
17740 @emph{any of the operations described in this chapter}
17741
17742 @item @var{non-blank-sequence} @expansion{}
17743 @emph{anything, provided it doesn't contain special characters such as
17744 "-", @var{nl}, """ and of course " "}
17745
17746 @item @var{c-string} @expansion{}
17747 @code{""" @var{seven-bit-iso-c-string-content} """}
17748
17749 @item @var{nl} @expansion{}
17750 @code{CR | CR-LF}
17751 @end table
17752
17753 @noindent
17754 Notes:
17755
17756 @itemize @bullet
17757 @item
17758 The CLI commands are still handled by the @sc{mi} interpreter; their
17759 output is described below.
17760
17761 @item
17762 The @code{@var{token}}, when present, is passed back when the command
17763 finishes.
17764
17765 @item
17766 Some @sc{mi} commands accept optional arguments as part of the parameter
17767 list. Each option is identified by a leading @samp{-} (dash) and may be
17768 followed by an optional argument parameter. Options occur first in the
17769 parameter list and can be delimited from normal parameters using
17770 @samp{--} (this is useful when some parameters begin with a dash).
17771 @end itemize
17772
17773 Pragmatics:
17774
17775 @itemize @bullet
17776 @item
17777 We want easy access to the existing CLI syntax (for debugging).
17778
17779 @item
17780 We want it to be easy to spot a @sc{mi} operation.
17781 @end itemize
17782
17783 @node GDB/MI Output Syntax
17784 @subsection @sc{gdb/mi} Output Syntax
17785
17786 @cindex output syntax of @sc{gdb/mi}
17787 @cindex @sc{gdb/mi}, output syntax
17788 The output from @sc{gdb/mi} consists of zero or more out-of-band records
17789 followed, optionally, by a single result record. This result record
17790 is for the most recent command. The sequence of output records is
17791 terminated by @samp{(gdb)}.
17792
17793 If an input command was prefixed with a @code{@var{token}} then the
17794 corresponding output for that command will also be prefixed by that same
17795 @var{token}.
17796
17797 @table @code
17798 @item @var{output} @expansion{}
17799 @code{( @var{out-of-band-record} )* [ @var{result-record} ] "(gdb)" @var{nl}}
17800
17801 @item @var{result-record} @expansion{}
17802 @code{ [ @var{token} ] "^" @var{result-class} ( "," @var{result} )* @var{nl}}
17803
17804 @item @var{out-of-band-record} @expansion{}
17805 @code{@var{async-record} | @var{stream-record}}
17806
17807 @item @var{async-record} @expansion{}
17808 @code{@var{exec-async-output} | @var{status-async-output} | @var{notify-async-output}}
17809
17810 @item @var{exec-async-output} @expansion{}
17811 @code{[ @var{token} ] "*" @var{async-output}}
17812
17813 @item @var{status-async-output} @expansion{}
17814 @code{[ @var{token} ] "+" @var{async-output}}
17815
17816 @item @var{notify-async-output} @expansion{}
17817 @code{[ @var{token} ] "=" @var{async-output}}
17818
17819 @item @var{async-output} @expansion{}
17820 @code{@var{async-class} ( "," @var{result} )* @var{nl}}
17821
17822 @item @var{result-class} @expansion{}
17823 @code{"done" | "running" | "connected" | "error" | "exit"}
17824
17825 @item @var{async-class} @expansion{}
17826 @code{"stopped" | @var{others}} (where @var{others} will be added
17827 depending on the needs---this is still in development).
17828
17829 @item @var{result} @expansion{}
17830 @code{ @var{variable} "=" @var{value}}
17831
17832 @item @var{variable} @expansion{}
17833 @code{ @var{string} }
17834
17835 @item @var{value} @expansion{}
17836 @code{ @var{const} | @var{tuple} | @var{list} }
17837
17838 @item @var{const} @expansion{}
17839 @code{@var{c-string}}
17840
17841 @item @var{tuple} @expansion{}
17842 @code{ "@{@}" | "@{" @var{result} ( "," @var{result} )* "@}" }
17843
17844 @item @var{list} @expansion{}
17845 @code{ "[]" | "[" @var{value} ( "," @var{value} )* "]" | "["
17846 @var{result} ( "," @var{result} )* "]" }
17847
17848 @item @var{stream-record} @expansion{}
17849 @code{@var{console-stream-output} | @var{target-stream-output} | @var{log-stream-output}}
17850
17851 @item @var{console-stream-output} @expansion{}
17852 @code{"~" @var{c-string}}
17853
17854 @item @var{target-stream-output} @expansion{}
17855 @code{"@@" @var{c-string}}
17856
17857 @item @var{log-stream-output} @expansion{}
17858 @code{"&" @var{c-string}}
17859
17860 @item @var{nl} @expansion{}
17861 @code{CR | CR-LF}
17862
17863 @item @var{token} @expansion{}
17864 @emph{any sequence of digits}.
17865 @end table
17866
17867 @noindent
17868 Notes:
17869
17870 @itemize @bullet
17871 @item
17872 All output sequences end in a single line containing a period.
17873
17874 @item
17875 The @code{@var{token}} is from the corresponding request. If an execution
17876 command is interrupted by the @samp{-exec-interrupt} command, the
17877 @var{token} associated with the @samp{*stopped} message is the one of the
17878 original execution command, not the one of the interrupt command.
17879
17880 @item
17881 @cindex status output in @sc{gdb/mi}
17882 @var{status-async-output} contains on-going status information about the
17883 progress of a slow operation. It can be discarded. All status output is
17884 prefixed by @samp{+}.
17885
17886 @item
17887 @cindex async output in @sc{gdb/mi}
17888 @var{exec-async-output} contains asynchronous state change on the target
17889 (stopped, started, disappeared). All async output is prefixed by
17890 @samp{*}.
17891
17892 @item
17893 @cindex notify output in @sc{gdb/mi}
17894 @var{notify-async-output} contains supplementary information that the
17895 client should handle (e.g., a new breakpoint information). All notify
17896 output is prefixed by @samp{=}.
17897
17898 @item
17899 @cindex console output in @sc{gdb/mi}
17900 @var{console-stream-output} is output that should be displayed as is in the
17901 console. It is the textual response to a CLI command. All the console
17902 output is prefixed by @samp{~}.
17903
17904 @item
17905 @cindex target output in @sc{gdb/mi}
17906 @var{target-stream-output} is the output produced by the target program.
17907 All the target output is prefixed by @samp{@@}.
17908
17909 @item
17910 @cindex log output in @sc{gdb/mi}
17911 @var{log-stream-output} is output text coming from @value{GDBN}'s internals, for
17912 instance messages that should be displayed as part of an error log. All
17913 the log output is prefixed by @samp{&}.
17914
17915 @item
17916 @cindex list output in @sc{gdb/mi}
17917 New @sc{gdb/mi} commands should only output @var{lists} containing
17918 @var{values}.
17919
17920
17921 @end itemize
17922
17923 @xref{GDB/MI Stream Records, , @sc{gdb/mi} Stream Records}, for more
17924 details about the various output records.
17925
17926 @c %%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%% SECTION %%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%
17927 @node GDB/MI Compatibility with CLI
17928 @section @sc{gdb/mi} Compatibility with CLI
17929
17930 @cindex compatibility, @sc{gdb/mi} and CLI
17931 @cindex @sc{gdb/mi}, compatibility with CLI
17932
17933 For the developers convenience CLI commands can be entered directly,
17934 but there may be some unexpected behaviour. For example, commands
17935 that query the user will behave as if the user replied yes, breakpoint
17936 command lists are not executed and some CLI commands, such as
17937 @code{if}, @code{when} and @code{define}, prompt for further input with
17938 @samp{>}, which is not valid MI output.
17939
17940 This feature may be removed at some stage in the future and it is
17941 recommended that front ends use the @code{-interpreter-exec} command
17942 (@pxref{-interpreter-exec}).
17943
17944 @c %%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%% SECTION %%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%
17945 @node GDB/MI Development and Front Ends
17946 @section @sc{gdb/mi} Development and Front Ends
17947 @cindex @sc{gdb/mi} development
17948
17949 The application which takes the MI output and presents the state of the
17950 program being debugged to the user is called a @dfn{front end}.
17951
17952 Although @sc{gdb/mi} is still incomplete, it is currently being used
17953 by a variety of front ends to @value{GDBN}. This makes it difficult
17954 to introduce new functionality without breaking existing usage. This
17955 section tries to minimize the problems by describing how the protocol
17956 might change.
17957
17958 Some changes in MI need not break a carefully designed front end, and
17959 for these the MI version will remain unchanged. The following is a
17960 list of changes that may occur within one level, so front ends should
17961 parse MI output in a way that can handle them:
17962
17963 @itemize @bullet
17964 @item
17965 New MI commands may be added.
17966
17967 @item
17968 New fields may be added to the output of any MI command.
17969
17970 @item
17971 The range of values for fields with specified values, e.g.,
17972 @code{in_scope} (@pxref{-var-update}) may be extended.
17973
17974 @c The format of field's content e.g type prefix, may change so parse it
17975 @c at your own risk. Yes, in general?
17976
17977 @c The order of fields may change? Shouldn't really matter but it might
17978 @c resolve inconsistencies.
17979 @end itemize
17980
17981 If the changes are likely to break front ends, the MI version level
17982 will be increased by one. This will allow the front end to parse the
17983 output according to the MI version. Apart from mi0, new versions of
17984 @value{GDBN} will not support old versions of MI and it will be the
17985 responsibility of the front end to work with the new one.
17986
17987 @c Starting with mi3, add a new command -mi-version that prints the MI
17988 @c version?
17989
17990 The best way to avoid unexpected changes in MI that might break your front
17991 end is to make your project known to @value{GDBN} developers and
17992 follow development on @email{gdb@@sourceware.org} and
17993 @email{gdb-patches@@sourceware.org}. There is also the mailing list
17994 @email{dmi-discuss@@lists.freestandards.org}, hosted by the Free Standards
17995 Group, which has the aim of creating a more general MI protocol
17996 called Debugger Machine Interface (DMI) that will become a standard
17997 for all debuggers, not just @value{GDBN}.
17998 @cindex mailing lists
17999
18000 @c %%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%% SECTION %%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%
18001 @node GDB/MI Output Records
18002 @section @sc{gdb/mi} Output Records
18003
18004 @menu
18005 * GDB/MI Result Records::
18006 * GDB/MI Stream Records::
18007 * GDB/MI Out-of-band Records::
18008 @end menu
18009
18010 @node GDB/MI Result Records
18011 @subsection @sc{gdb/mi} Result Records
18012
18013 @cindex result records in @sc{gdb/mi}
18014 @cindex @sc{gdb/mi}, result records
18015 In addition to a number of out-of-band notifications, the response to a
18016 @sc{gdb/mi} command includes one of the following result indications:
18017
18018 @table @code
18019 @findex ^done
18020 @item "^done" [ "," @var{results} ]
18021 The synchronous operation was successful, @code{@var{results}} are the return
18022 values.
18023
18024 @item "^running"
18025 @findex ^running
18026 @c Is this one correct? Should it be an out-of-band notification?
18027 The asynchronous operation was successfully started. The target is
18028 running.
18029
18030 @item "^connected"
18031 @findex ^connected
18032 @value{GDBN} has connected to a remote target.
18033
18034 @item "^error" "," @var{c-string}
18035 @findex ^error
18036 The operation failed. The @code{@var{c-string}} contains the corresponding
18037 error message.
18038
18039 @item "^exit"
18040 @findex ^exit
18041 @value{GDBN} has terminated.
18042
18043 @end table
18044
18045 @node GDB/MI Stream Records
18046 @subsection @sc{gdb/mi} Stream Records
18047
18048 @cindex @sc{gdb/mi}, stream records
18049 @cindex stream records in @sc{gdb/mi}
18050 @value{GDBN} internally maintains a number of output streams: the console, the
18051 target, and the log. The output intended for each of these streams is
18052 funneled through the @sc{gdb/mi} interface using @dfn{stream records}.
18053
18054 Each stream record begins with a unique @dfn{prefix character} which
18055 identifies its stream (@pxref{GDB/MI Output Syntax, , @sc{gdb/mi} Output
18056 Syntax}). In addition to the prefix, each stream record contains a
18057 @code{@var{string-output}}. This is either raw text (with an implicit new
18058 line) or a quoted C string (which does not contain an implicit newline).
18059
18060 @table @code
18061 @item "~" @var{string-output}
18062 The console output stream contains text that should be displayed in the
18063 CLI console window. It contains the textual responses to CLI commands.
18064
18065 @item "@@" @var{string-output}
18066 The target output stream contains any textual output from the running
18067 target. This is only present when GDB's event loop is truly
18068 asynchronous, which is currently only the case for remote targets.
18069
18070 @item "&" @var{string-output}
18071 The log stream contains debugging messages being produced by @value{GDBN}'s
18072 internals.
18073 @end table
18074
18075 @node GDB/MI Out-of-band Records
18076 @subsection @sc{gdb/mi} Out-of-band Records
18077
18078 @cindex out-of-band records in @sc{gdb/mi}
18079 @cindex @sc{gdb/mi}, out-of-band records
18080 @dfn{Out-of-band} records are used to notify the @sc{gdb/mi} client of
18081 additional changes that have occurred. Those changes can either be a
18082 consequence of @sc{gdb/mi} (e.g., a breakpoint modified) or a result of
18083 target activity (e.g., target stopped).
18084
18085 The following is a preliminary list of possible out-of-band records.
18086 In particular, the @var{exec-async-output} records.
18087
18088 @table @code
18089 @item *stopped,reason="@var{reason}"
18090 @end table
18091
18092 @var{reason} can be one of the following:
18093
18094 @table @code
18095 @item breakpoint-hit
18096 A breakpoint was reached.
18097 @item watchpoint-trigger
18098 A watchpoint was triggered.
18099 @item read-watchpoint-trigger
18100 A read watchpoint was triggered.
18101 @item access-watchpoint-trigger
18102 An access watchpoint was triggered.
18103 @item function-finished
18104 An -exec-finish or similar CLI command was accomplished.
18105 @item location-reached
18106 An -exec-until or similar CLI command was accomplished.
18107 @item watchpoint-scope
18108 A watchpoint has gone out of scope.
18109 @item end-stepping-range
18110 An -exec-next, -exec-next-instruction, -exec-step, -exec-step-instruction or
18111 similar CLI command was accomplished.
18112 @item exited-signalled
18113 The inferior exited because of a signal.
18114 @item exited
18115 The inferior exited.
18116 @item exited-normally
18117 The inferior exited normally.
18118 @item signal-received
18119 A signal was received by the inferior.
18120 @end table
18121
18122
18123 @c %%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%% SECTION %%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%
18124 @node GDB/MI Simple Examples
18125 @section Simple Examples of @sc{gdb/mi} Interaction
18126 @cindex @sc{gdb/mi}, simple examples
18127
18128 This subsection presents several simple examples of interaction using
18129 the @sc{gdb/mi} interface. In these examples, @samp{->} means that the
18130 following line is passed to @sc{gdb/mi} as input, while @samp{<-} means
18131 the output received from @sc{gdb/mi}.
18132
18133 Note the line breaks shown in the examples are here only for
18134 readability, they don't appear in the real output.
18135
18136 @subheading Setting a Breakpoint
18137
18138 Setting a breakpoint generates synchronous output which contains detailed
18139 information of the breakpoint.
18140
18141 @smallexample
18142 -> -break-insert main
18143 <- ^done,bkpt=@{number="1",type="breakpoint",disp="keep",
18144 enabled="y",addr="0x08048564",func="main",file="myprog.c",
18145 fullname="/home/nickrob/myprog.c",line="68",times="0"@}
18146 <- (gdb)
18147 @end smallexample
18148
18149 @subheading Program Execution
18150
18151 Program execution generates asynchronous records and MI gives the
18152 reason that execution stopped.
18153
18154 @smallexample
18155 -> -exec-run
18156 <- ^running
18157 <- (gdb)
18158 <- *stopped,reason="breakpoint-hit",disp="keep",bkptno="1",thread-id="0",
18159 frame=@{addr="0x08048564",func="main",
18160 args=[@{name="argc",value="1"@},@{name="argv",value="0xbfc4d4d4"@}],
18161 file="myprog.c",fullname="/home/nickrob/myprog.c",line="68"@}
18162 <- (gdb)
18163 -> -exec-continue
18164 <- ^running
18165 <- (gdb)
18166 <- *stopped,reason="exited-normally"
18167 <- (gdb)
18168 @end smallexample
18169
18170 @subheading Quitting @value{GDBN}
18171
18172 Quitting @value{GDBN} just prints the result class @samp{^exit}.
18173
18174 @smallexample
18175 -> (gdb)
18176 <- -gdb-exit
18177 <- ^exit
18178 @end smallexample
18179
18180 @subheading A Bad Command
18181
18182 Here's what happens if you pass a non-existent command:
18183
18184 @smallexample
18185 -> -rubbish
18186 <- ^error,msg="Undefined MI command: rubbish"
18187 <- (gdb)
18188 @end smallexample
18189
18190
18191 @c %%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%% SECTION %%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%
18192 @node GDB/MI Command Description Format
18193 @section @sc{gdb/mi} Command Description Format
18194
18195 The remaining sections describe blocks of commands. Each block of
18196 commands is laid out in a fashion similar to this section.
18197
18198 @subheading Motivation
18199
18200 The motivation for this collection of commands.
18201
18202 @subheading Introduction
18203
18204 A brief introduction to this collection of commands as a whole.
18205
18206 @subheading Commands
18207
18208 For each command in the block, the following is described:
18209
18210 @subsubheading Synopsis
18211
18212 @smallexample
18213 -command @var{args}@dots{}
18214 @end smallexample
18215
18216 @subsubheading Result
18217
18218 @subsubheading @value{GDBN} Command
18219
18220 The corresponding @value{GDBN} CLI command(s), if any.
18221
18222 @subsubheading Example
18223
18224 Example(s) formatted for readability. Some of the described commands have
18225 not been implemented yet and these are labeled N.A.@: (not available).
18226
18227
18228 @c %%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%% SECTION %%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%
18229 @node GDB/MI Breakpoint Commands
18230 @section @sc{gdb/mi} Breakpoint Commands
18231
18232 @cindex breakpoint commands for @sc{gdb/mi}
18233 @cindex @sc{gdb/mi}, breakpoint commands
18234 This section documents @sc{gdb/mi} commands for manipulating
18235 breakpoints.
18236
18237 @subheading The @code{-break-after} Command
18238 @findex -break-after
18239
18240 @subsubheading Synopsis
18241
18242 @smallexample
18243 -break-after @var{number} @var{count}
18244 @end smallexample
18245
18246 The breakpoint number @var{number} is not in effect until it has been
18247 hit @var{count} times. To see how this is reflected in the output of
18248 the @samp{-break-list} command, see the description of the
18249 @samp{-break-list} command below.
18250
18251 @subsubheading @value{GDBN} Command
18252
18253 The corresponding @value{GDBN} command is @samp{ignore}.
18254
18255 @subsubheading Example
18256
18257 @smallexample
18258 (gdb)
18259 -break-insert main
18260 ^done,bkpt=@{number="1",type="breakpoint",disp="keep",
18261 enabled="y",addr="0x000100d0",func="main",file="hello.c",
18262 fullname="/home/foo/hello.c",line="5",times="0"@}
18263 (gdb)
18264 -break-after 1 3
18265 ~
18266 ^done
18267 (gdb)
18268 -break-list
18269 ^done,BreakpointTable=@{nr_rows="1",nr_cols="6",
18270 hdr=[@{width="3",alignment="-1",col_name="number",colhdr="Num"@},
18271 @{width="14",alignment="-1",col_name="type",colhdr="Type"@},
18272 @{width="4",alignment="-1",col_name="disp",colhdr="Disp"@},
18273 @{width="3",alignment="-1",col_name="enabled",colhdr="Enb"@},
18274 @{width="10",alignment="-1",col_name="addr",colhdr="Address"@},
18275 @{width="40",alignment="2",col_name="what",colhdr="What"@}],
18276 body=[bkpt=@{number="1",type="breakpoint",disp="keep",enabled="y",
18277 addr="0x000100d0",func="main",file="hello.c",fullname="/home/foo/hello.c",
18278 line="5",times="0",ignore="3"@}]@}
18279 (gdb)
18280 @end smallexample
18281
18282 @ignore
18283 @subheading The @code{-break-catch} Command
18284 @findex -break-catch
18285
18286 @subheading The @code{-break-commands} Command
18287 @findex -break-commands
18288 @end ignore
18289
18290
18291 @subheading The @code{-break-condition} Command
18292 @findex -break-condition
18293
18294 @subsubheading Synopsis
18295
18296 @smallexample
18297 -break-condition @var{number} @var{expr}
18298 @end smallexample
18299
18300 Breakpoint @var{number} will stop the program only if the condition in
18301 @var{expr} is true. The condition becomes part of the
18302 @samp{-break-list} output (see the description of the @samp{-break-list}
18303 command below).
18304
18305 @subsubheading @value{GDBN} Command
18306
18307 The corresponding @value{GDBN} command is @samp{condition}.
18308
18309 @subsubheading Example
18310
18311 @smallexample
18312 (gdb)
18313 -break-condition 1 1
18314 ^done
18315 (gdb)
18316 -break-list
18317 ^done,BreakpointTable=@{nr_rows="1",nr_cols="6",
18318 hdr=[@{width="3",alignment="-1",col_name="number",colhdr="Num"@},
18319 @{width="14",alignment="-1",col_name="type",colhdr="Type"@},
18320 @{width="4",alignment="-1",col_name="disp",colhdr="Disp"@},
18321 @{width="3",alignment="-1",col_name="enabled",colhdr="Enb"@},
18322 @{width="10",alignment="-1",col_name="addr",colhdr="Address"@},
18323 @{width="40",alignment="2",col_name="what",colhdr="What"@}],
18324 body=[bkpt=@{number="1",type="breakpoint",disp="keep",enabled="y",
18325 addr="0x000100d0",func="main",file="hello.c",fullname="/home/foo/hello.c",
18326 line="5",cond="1",times="0",ignore="3"@}]@}
18327 (gdb)
18328 @end smallexample
18329
18330 @subheading The @code{-break-delete} Command
18331 @findex -break-delete
18332
18333 @subsubheading Synopsis
18334
18335 @smallexample
18336 -break-delete ( @var{breakpoint} )+
18337 @end smallexample
18338
18339 Delete the breakpoint(s) whose number(s) are specified in the argument
18340 list. This is obviously reflected in the breakpoint list.
18341
18342 @subsubheading @value{GDBN} Command
18343
18344 The corresponding @value{GDBN} command is @samp{delete}.
18345
18346 @subsubheading Example
18347
18348 @smallexample
18349 (gdb)
18350 -break-delete 1
18351 ^done
18352 (gdb)
18353 -break-list
18354 ^done,BreakpointTable=@{nr_rows="0",nr_cols="6",
18355 hdr=[@{width="3",alignment="-1",col_name="number",colhdr="Num"@},
18356 @{width="14",alignment="-1",col_name="type",colhdr="Type"@},
18357 @{width="4",alignment="-1",col_name="disp",colhdr="Disp"@},
18358 @{width="3",alignment="-1",col_name="enabled",colhdr="Enb"@},
18359 @{width="10",alignment="-1",col_name="addr",colhdr="Address"@},
18360 @{width="40",alignment="2",col_name="what",colhdr="What"@}],
18361 body=[]@}
18362 (gdb)
18363 @end smallexample
18364
18365 @subheading The @code{-break-disable} Command
18366 @findex -break-disable
18367
18368 @subsubheading Synopsis
18369
18370 @smallexample
18371 -break-disable ( @var{breakpoint} )+
18372 @end smallexample
18373
18374 Disable the named @var{breakpoint}(s). The field @samp{enabled} in the
18375 break list is now set to @samp{n} for the named @var{breakpoint}(s).
18376
18377 @subsubheading @value{GDBN} Command
18378
18379 The corresponding @value{GDBN} command is @samp{disable}.
18380
18381 @subsubheading Example
18382
18383 @smallexample
18384 (gdb)
18385 -break-disable 2
18386 ^done
18387 (gdb)
18388 -break-list
18389 ^done,BreakpointTable=@{nr_rows="1",nr_cols="6",
18390 hdr=[@{width="3",alignment="-1",col_name="number",colhdr="Num"@},
18391 @{width="14",alignment="-1",col_name="type",colhdr="Type"@},
18392 @{width="4",alignment="-1",col_name="disp",colhdr="Disp"@},
18393 @{width="3",alignment="-1",col_name="enabled",colhdr="Enb"@},
18394 @{width="10",alignment="-1",col_name="addr",colhdr="Address"@},
18395 @{width="40",alignment="2",col_name="what",colhdr="What"@}],
18396 body=[bkpt=@{number="2",type="breakpoint",disp="keep",enabled="n",
18397 addr="0x000100d0",func="main",file="hello.c",fullname="/home/foo/hello.c",
18398 line="5",times="0"@}]@}
18399 (gdb)
18400 @end smallexample
18401
18402 @subheading The @code{-break-enable} Command
18403 @findex -break-enable
18404
18405 @subsubheading Synopsis
18406
18407 @smallexample
18408 -break-enable ( @var{breakpoint} )+
18409 @end smallexample
18410
18411 Enable (previously disabled) @var{breakpoint}(s).
18412
18413 @subsubheading @value{GDBN} Command
18414
18415 The corresponding @value{GDBN} command is @samp{enable}.
18416
18417 @subsubheading Example
18418
18419 @smallexample
18420 (gdb)
18421 -break-enable 2
18422 ^done
18423 (gdb)
18424 -break-list
18425 ^done,BreakpointTable=@{nr_rows="1",nr_cols="6",
18426 hdr=[@{width="3",alignment="-1",col_name="number",colhdr="Num"@},
18427 @{width="14",alignment="-1",col_name="type",colhdr="Type"@},
18428 @{width="4",alignment="-1",col_name="disp",colhdr="Disp"@},
18429 @{width="3",alignment="-1",col_name="enabled",colhdr="Enb"@},
18430 @{width="10",alignment="-1",col_name="addr",colhdr="Address"@},
18431 @{width="40",alignment="2",col_name="what",colhdr="What"@}],
18432 body=[bkpt=@{number="2",type="breakpoint",disp="keep",enabled="y",
18433 addr="0x000100d0",func="main",file="hello.c",fullname="/home/foo/hello.c",
18434 line="5",times="0"@}]@}
18435 (gdb)
18436 @end smallexample
18437
18438 @subheading The @code{-break-info} Command
18439 @findex -break-info
18440
18441 @subsubheading Synopsis
18442
18443 @smallexample
18444 -break-info @var{breakpoint}
18445 @end smallexample
18446
18447 @c REDUNDANT???
18448 Get information about a single breakpoint.
18449
18450 @subsubheading @value{GDBN} Command
18451
18452 The corresponding @value{GDBN} command is @samp{info break @var{breakpoint}}.
18453
18454 @subsubheading Example
18455 N.A.
18456
18457 @subheading The @code{-break-insert} Command
18458 @findex -break-insert
18459
18460 @subsubheading Synopsis
18461
18462 @smallexample
18463 -break-insert [ -t ] [ -h ] [ -f ]
18464 [ -c @var{condition} ] [ -i @var{ignore-count} ]
18465 [ -p @var{thread} ] [ @var{location} ]
18466 @end smallexample
18467
18468 @noindent
18469 If specified, @var{location}, can be one of:
18470
18471 @itemize @bullet
18472 @item function
18473 @c @item +offset
18474 @c @item -offset
18475 @c @item linenum
18476 @item filename:linenum
18477 @item filename:function
18478 @item *address
18479 @end itemize
18480
18481 The possible optional parameters of this command are:
18482
18483 @table @samp
18484 @item -t
18485 Insert a temporary breakpoint.
18486 @item -h
18487 Insert a hardware breakpoint.
18488 @item -c @var{condition}
18489 Make the breakpoint conditional on @var{condition}.
18490 @item -i @var{ignore-count}
18491 Initialize the @var{ignore-count}.
18492 @item -f
18493 If @var{location} cannot be parsed (for example if it
18494 refers to unknown files or functions), create a pending
18495 breakpoint. Without this flag, @value{GDBN} will report
18496 an error, and won't create a breakpoint, if @var{location}
18497 cannot be parsed.
18498 @end table
18499
18500 @subsubheading Result
18501
18502 The result is in the form:
18503
18504 @smallexample
18505 ^done,bkpt=@{number="@var{number}",type="@var{type}",disp="del"|"keep",
18506 enabled="y"|"n",addr="@var{hex}",func="@var{funcname}",file="@var{filename}",
18507 fullname="@var{full_filename}",line="@var{lineno}",[thread="@var{threadno},]
18508 times="@var{times}"@}
18509 @end smallexample
18510
18511 @noindent
18512 where @var{number} is the @value{GDBN} number for this breakpoint,
18513 @var{funcname} is the name of the function where the breakpoint was
18514 inserted, @var{filename} is the name of the source file which contains
18515 this function, @var{lineno} is the source line number within that file
18516 and @var{times} the number of times that the breakpoint has been hit
18517 (always 0 for -break-insert but may be greater for -break-info or -break-list
18518 which use the same output).
18519
18520 Note: this format is open to change.
18521 @c An out-of-band breakpoint instead of part of the result?
18522
18523 @subsubheading @value{GDBN} Command
18524
18525 The corresponding @value{GDBN} commands are @samp{break}, @samp{tbreak},
18526 @samp{hbreak}, @samp{thbreak}, and @samp{rbreak}.
18527
18528 @subsubheading Example
18529
18530 @smallexample
18531 (gdb)
18532 -break-insert main
18533 ^done,bkpt=@{number="1",addr="0x0001072c",file="recursive2.c",
18534 fullname="/home/foo/recursive2.c,line="4",times="0"@}
18535 (gdb)
18536 -break-insert -t foo
18537 ^done,bkpt=@{number="2",addr="0x00010774",file="recursive2.c",
18538 fullname="/home/foo/recursive2.c,line="11",times="0"@}
18539 (gdb)
18540 -break-list
18541 ^done,BreakpointTable=@{nr_rows="2",nr_cols="6",
18542 hdr=[@{width="3",alignment="-1",col_name="number",colhdr="Num"@},
18543 @{width="14",alignment="-1",col_name="type",colhdr="Type"@},
18544 @{width="4",alignment="-1",col_name="disp",colhdr="Disp"@},
18545 @{width="3",alignment="-1",col_name="enabled",colhdr="Enb"@},
18546 @{width="10",alignment="-1",col_name="addr",colhdr="Address"@},
18547 @{width="40",alignment="2",col_name="what",colhdr="What"@}],
18548 body=[bkpt=@{number="1",type="breakpoint",disp="keep",enabled="y",
18549 addr="0x0001072c", func="main",file="recursive2.c",
18550 fullname="/home/foo/recursive2.c,"line="4",times="0"@},
18551 bkpt=@{number="2",type="breakpoint",disp="del",enabled="y",
18552 addr="0x00010774",func="foo",file="recursive2.c",
18553 fullname="/home/foo/recursive2.c",line="11",times="0"@}]@}
18554 (gdb)
18555 -break-insert -r foo.*
18556 ~int foo(int, int);
18557 ^done,bkpt=@{number="3",addr="0x00010774",file="recursive2.c,
18558 "fullname="/home/foo/recursive2.c",line="11",times="0"@}
18559 (gdb)
18560 @end smallexample
18561
18562 @subheading The @code{-break-list} Command
18563 @findex -break-list
18564
18565 @subsubheading Synopsis
18566
18567 @smallexample
18568 -break-list
18569 @end smallexample
18570
18571 Displays the list of inserted breakpoints, showing the following fields:
18572
18573 @table @samp
18574 @item Number
18575 number of the breakpoint
18576 @item Type
18577 type of the breakpoint: @samp{breakpoint} or @samp{watchpoint}
18578 @item Disposition
18579 should the breakpoint be deleted or disabled when it is hit: @samp{keep}
18580 or @samp{nokeep}
18581 @item Enabled
18582 is the breakpoint enabled or no: @samp{y} or @samp{n}
18583 @item Address
18584 memory location at which the breakpoint is set
18585 @item What
18586 logical location of the breakpoint, expressed by function name, file
18587 name, line number
18588 @item Times
18589 number of times the breakpoint has been hit
18590 @end table
18591
18592 If there are no breakpoints or watchpoints, the @code{BreakpointTable}
18593 @code{body} field is an empty list.
18594
18595 @subsubheading @value{GDBN} Command
18596
18597 The corresponding @value{GDBN} command is @samp{info break}.
18598
18599 @subsubheading Example
18600
18601 @smallexample
18602 (gdb)
18603 -break-list
18604 ^done,BreakpointTable=@{nr_rows="2",nr_cols="6",
18605 hdr=[@{width="3",alignment="-1",col_name="number",colhdr="Num"@},
18606 @{width="14",alignment="-1",col_name="type",colhdr="Type"@},
18607 @{width="4",alignment="-1",col_name="disp",colhdr="Disp"@},
18608 @{width="3",alignment="-1",col_name="enabled",colhdr="Enb"@},
18609 @{width="10",alignment="-1",col_name="addr",colhdr="Address"@},
18610 @{width="40",alignment="2",col_name="what",colhdr="What"@}],
18611 body=[bkpt=@{number="1",type="breakpoint",disp="keep",enabled="y",
18612 addr="0x000100d0",func="main",file="hello.c",line="5",times="0"@},
18613 bkpt=@{number="2",type="breakpoint",disp="keep",enabled="y",
18614 addr="0x00010114",func="foo",file="hello.c",fullname="/home/foo/hello.c",
18615 line="13",times="0"@}]@}
18616 (gdb)
18617 @end smallexample
18618
18619 Here's an example of the result when there are no breakpoints:
18620
18621 @smallexample
18622 (gdb)
18623 -break-list
18624 ^done,BreakpointTable=@{nr_rows="0",nr_cols="6",
18625 hdr=[@{width="3",alignment="-1",col_name="number",colhdr="Num"@},
18626 @{width="14",alignment="-1",col_name="type",colhdr="Type"@},
18627 @{width="4",alignment="-1",col_name="disp",colhdr="Disp"@},
18628 @{width="3",alignment="-1",col_name="enabled",colhdr="Enb"@},
18629 @{width="10",alignment="-1",col_name="addr",colhdr="Address"@},
18630 @{width="40",alignment="2",col_name="what",colhdr="What"@}],
18631 body=[]@}
18632 (gdb)
18633 @end smallexample
18634
18635 @subheading The @code{-break-watch} Command
18636 @findex -break-watch
18637
18638 @subsubheading Synopsis
18639
18640 @smallexample
18641 -break-watch [ -a | -r ]
18642 @end smallexample
18643
18644 Create a watchpoint. With the @samp{-a} option it will create an
18645 @dfn{access} watchpoint, i.e., a watchpoint that triggers either on a
18646 read from or on a write to the memory location. With the @samp{-r}
18647 option, the watchpoint created is a @dfn{read} watchpoint, i.e., it will
18648 trigger only when the memory location is accessed for reading. Without
18649 either of the options, the watchpoint created is a regular watchpoint,
18650 i.e., it will trigger when the memory location is accessed for writing.
18651 @xref{Set Watchpoints, , Setting Watchpoints}.
18652
18653 Note that @samp{-break-list} will report a single list of watchpoints and
18654 breakpoints inserted.
18655
18656 @subsubheading @value{GDBN} Command
18657
18658 The corresponding @value{GDBN} commands are @samp{watch}, @samp{awatch}, and
18659 @samp{rwatch}.
18660
18661 @subsubheading Example
18662
18663 Setting a watchpoint on a variable in the @code{main} function:
18664
18665 @smallexample
18666 (gdb)
18667 -break-watch x
18668 ^done,wpt=@{number="2",exp="x"@}
18669 (gdb)
18670 -exec-continue
18671 ^running
18672 (gdb)
18673 *stopped,reason="watchpoint-trigger",wpt=@{number="2",exp="x"@},
18674 value=@{old="-268439212",new="55"@},
18675 frame=@{func="main",args=[],file="recursive2.c",
18676 fullname="/home/foo/bar/recursive2.c",line="5"@}
18677 (gdb)
18678 @end smallexample
18679
18680 Setting a watchpoint on a variable local to a function. @value{GDBN} will stop
18681 the program execution twice: first for the variable changing value, then
18682 for the watchpoint going out of scope.
18683
18684 @smallexample
18685 (gdb)
18686 -break-watch C
18687 ^done,wpt=@{number="5",exp="C"@}
18688 (gdb)
18689 -exec-continue
18690 ^running
18691 (gdb)
18692 *stopped,reason="watchpoint-trigger",
18693 wpt=@{number="5",exp="C"@},value=@{old="-276895068",new="3"@},
18694 frame=@{func="callee4",args=[],
18695 file="../../../devo/gdb/testsuite/gdb.mi/basics.c",
18696 fullname="/home/foo/bar/devo/gdb/testsuite/gdb.mi/basics.c",line="13"@}
18697 (gdb)
18698 -exec-continue
18699 ^running
18700 (gdb)
18701 *stopped,reason="watchpoint-scope",wpnum="5",
18702 frame=@{func="callee3",args=[@{name="strarg",
18703 value="0x11940 \"A string argument.\""@}],
18704 file="../../../devo/gdb/testsuite/gdb.mi/basics.c",
18705 fullname="/home/foo/bar/devo/gdb/testsuite/gdb.mi/basics.c",line="18"@}
18706 (gdb)
18707 @end smallexample
18708
18709 Listing breakpoints and watchpoints, at different points in the program
18710 execution. Note that once the watchpoint goes out of scope, it is
18711 deleted.
18712
18713 @smallexample
18714 (gdb)
18715 -break-watch C
18716 ^done,wpt=@{number="2",exp="C"@}
18717 (gdb)
18718 -break-list
18719 ^done,BreakpointTable=@{nr_rows="2",nr_cols="6",
18720 hdr=[@{width="3",alignment="-1",col_name="number",colhdr="Num"@},
18721 @{width="14",alignment="-1",col_name="type",colhdr="Type"@},
18722 @{width="4",alignment="-1",col_name="disp",colhdr="Disp"@},
18723 @{width="3",alignment="-1",col_name="enabled",colhdr="Enb"@},
18724 @{width="10",alignment="-1",col_name="addr",colhdr="Address"@},
18725 @{width="40",alignment="2",col_name="what",colhdr="What"@}],
18726 body=[bkpt=@{number="1",type="breakpoint",disp="keep",enabled="y",
18727 addr="0x00010734",func="callee4",
18728 file="../../../devo/gdb/testsuite/gdb.mi/basics.c",
18729 fullname="/home/foo/devo/gdb/testsuite/gdb.mi/basics.c"line="8",times="1"@},
18730 bkpt=@{number="2",type="watchpoint",disp="keep",
18731 enabled="y",addr="",what="C",times="0"@}]@}
18732 (gdb)
18733 -exec-continue
18734 ^running
18735 (gdb)
18736 *stopped,reason="watchpoint-trigger",wpt=@{number="2",exp="C"@},
18737 value=@{old="-276895068",new="3"@},
18738 frame=@{func="callee4",args=[],
18739 file="../../../devo/gdb/testsuite/gdb.mi/basics.c",
18740 fullname="/home/foo/bar/devo/gdb/testsuite/gdb.mi/basics.c",line="13"@}
18741 (gdb)
18742 -break-list
18743 ^done,BreakpointTable=@{nr_rows="2",nr_cols="6",
18744 hdr=[@{width="3",alignment="-1",col_name="number",colhdr="Num"@},
18745 @{width="14",alignment="-1",col_name="type",colhdr="Type"@},
18746 @{width="4",alignment="-1",col_name="disp",colhdr="Disp"@},
18747 @{width="3",alignment="-1",col_name="enabled",colhdr="Enb"@},
18748 @{width="10",alignment="-1",col_name="addr",colhdr="Address"@},
18749 @{width="40",alignment="2",col_name="what",colhdr="What"@}],
18750 body=[bkpt=@{number="1",type="breakpoint",disp="keep",enabled="y",
18751 addr="0x00010734",func="callee4",
18752 file="../../../devo/gdb/testsuite/gdb.mi/basics.c",
18753 fullname="/home/foo/devo/gdb/testsuite/gdb.mi/basics.c",line="8",times="1"@},
18754 bkpt=@{number="2",type="watchpoint",disp="keep",
18755 enabled="y",addr="",what="C",times="-5"@}]@}
18756 (gdb)
18757 -exec-continue
18758 ^running
18759 ^done,reason="watchpoint-scope",wpnum="2",
18760 frame=@{func="callee3",args=[@{name="strarg",
18761 value="0x11940 \"A string argument.\""@}],
18762 file="../../../devo/gdb/testsuite/gdb.mi/basics.c",
18763 fullname="/home/foo/bar/devo/gdb/testsuite/gdb.mi/basics.c",line="18"@}
18764 (gdb)
18765 -break-list
18766 ^done,BreakpointTable=@{nr_rows="1",nr_cols="6",
18767 hdr=[@{width="3",alignment="-1",col_name="number",colhdr="Num"@},
18768 @{width="14",alignment="-1",col_name="type",colhdr="Type"@},
18769 @{width="4",alignment="-1",col_name="disp",colhdr="Disp"@},
18770 @{width="3",alignment="-1",col_name="enabled",colhdr="Enb"@},
18771 @{width="10",alignment="-1",col_name="addr",colhdr="Address"@},
18772 @{width="40",alignment="2",col_name="what",colhdr="What"@}],
18773 body=[bkpt=@{number="1",type="breakpoint",disp="keep",enabled="y",
18774 addr="0x00010734",func="callee4",
18775 file="../../../devo/gdb/testsuite/gdb.mi/basics.c",
18776 fullname="/home/foo/devo/gdb/testsuite/gdb.mi/basics.c",line="8",
18777 times="1"@}]@}
18778 (gdb)
18779 @end smallexample
18780
18781 @c %%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%% SECTION %%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%
18782 @node GDB/MI Program Context
18783 @section @sc{gdb/mi} Program Context
18784
18785 @subheading The @code{-exec-arguments} Command
18786 @findex -exec-arguments
18787
18788
18789 @subsubheading Synopsis
18790
18791 @smallexample
18792 -exec-arguments @var{args}
18793 @end smallexample
18794
18795 Set the inferior program arguments, to be used in the next
18796 @samp{-exec-run}.
18797
18798 @subsubheading @value{GDBN} Command
18799
18800 The corresponding @value{GDBN} command is @samp{set args}.
18801
18802 @subsubheading Example
18803
18804 @c FIXME!
18805 Don't have one around.
18806
18807
18808 @subheading The @code{-exec-show-arguments} Command
18809 @findex -exec-show-arguments
18810
18811 @subsubheading Synopsis
18812
18813 @smallexample
18814 -exec-show-arguments
18815 @end smallexample
18816
18817 Print the arguments of the program.
18818
18819 @subsubheading @value{GDBN} Command
18820
18821 The corresponding @value{GDBN} command is @samp{show args}.
18822
18823 @subsubheading Example
18824 N.A.
18825
18826
18827 @subheading The @code{-environment-cd} Command
18828 @findex -environment-cd
18829
18830 @subsubheading Synopsis
18831
18832 @smallexample
18833 -environment-cd @var{pathdir}
18834 @end smallexample
18835
18836 Set @value{GDBN}'s working directory.
18837
18838 @subsubheading @value{GDBN} Command
18839
18840 The corresponding @value{GDBN} command is @samp{cd}.
18841
18842 @subsubheading Example
18843
18844 @smallexample
18845 (gdb)
18846 -environment-cd /kwikemart/marge/ezannoni/flathead-dev/devo/gdb
18847 ^done
18848 (gdb)
18849 @end smallexample
18850
18851
18852 @subheading The @code{-environment-directory} Command
18853 @findex -environment-directory
18854
18855 @subsubheading Synopsis
18856
18857 @smallexample
18858 -environment-directory [ -r ] [ @var{pathdir} ]+
18859 @end smallexample
18860
18861 Add directories @var{pathdir} to beginning of search path for source files.
18862 If the @samp{-r} option is used, the search path is reset to the default
18863 search path. If directories @var{pathdir} are supplied in addition to the
18864 @samp{-r} option, the search path is first reset and then addition
18865 occurs as normal.
18866 Multiple directories may be specified, separated by blanks. Specifying
18867 multiple directories in a single command
18868 results in the directories added to the beginning of the
18869 search path in the same order they were presented in the command.
18870 If blanks are needed as
18871 part of a directory name, double-quotes should be used around
18872 the name. In the command output, the path will show up separated
18873 by the system directory-separator character. The directory-separator
18874 character must not be used
18875 in any directory name.
18876 If no directories are specified, the current search path is displayed.
18877
18878 @subsubheading @value{GDBN} Command
18879
18880 The corresponding @value{GDBN} command is @samp{dir}.
18881
18882 @subsubheading Example
18883
18884 @smallexample
18885 (gdb)
18886 -environment-directory /kwikemart/marge/ezannoni/flathead-dev/devo/gdb
18887 ^done,source-path="/kwikemart/marge/ezannoni/flathead-dev/devo/gdb:$cdir:$cwd"
18888 (gdb)
18889 -environment-directory ""
18890 ^done,source-path="/kwikemart/marge/ezannoni/flathead-dev/devo/gdb:$cdir:$cwd"
18891 (gdb)
18892 -environment-directory -r /home/jjohnstn/src/gdb /usr/src
18893 ^done,source-path="/home/jjohnstn/src/gdb:/usr/src:$cdir:$cwd"
18894 (gdb)
18895 -environment-directory -r
18896 ^done,source-path="$cdir:$cwd"
18897 (gdb)
18898 @end smallexample
18899
18900
18901 @subheading The @code{-environment-path} Command
18902 @findex -environment-path
18903
18904 @subsubheading Synopsis
18905
18906 @smallexample
18907 -environment-path [ -r ] [ @var{pathdir} ]+
18908 @end smallexample
18909
18910 Add directories @var{pathdir} to beginning of search path for object files.
18911 If the @samp{-r} option is used, the search path is reset to the original
18912 search path that existed at gdb start-up. If directories @var{pathdir} are
18913 supplied in addition to the
18914 @samp{-r} option, the search path is first reset and then addition
18915 occurs as normal.
18916 Multiple directories may be specified, separated by blanks. Specifying
18917 multiple directories in a single command
18918 results in the directories added to the beginning of the
18919 search path in the same order they were presented in the command.
18920 If blanks are needed as
18921 part of a directory name, double-quotes should be used around
18922 the name. In the command output, the path will show up separated
18923 by the system directory-separator character. The directory-separator
18924 character must not be used
18925 in any directory name.
18926 If no directories are specified, the current path is displayed.
18927
18928
18929 @subsubheading @value{GDBN} Command
18930
18931 The corresponding @value{GDBN} command is @samp{path}.
18932
18933 @subsubheading Example
18934
18935 @smallexample
18936 (gdb)
18937 -environment-path
18938 ^done,path="/usr/bin"
18939 (gdb)
18940 -environment-path /kwikemart/marge/ezannoni/flathead-dev/ppc-eabi/gdb /bin
18941 ^done,path="/kwikemart/marge/ezannoni/flathead-dev/ppc-eabi/gdb:/bin:/usr/bin"
18942 (gdb)
18943 -environment-path -r /usr/local/bin
18944 ^done,path="/usr/local/bin:/usr/bin"
18945 (gdb)
18946 @end smallexample
18947
18948
18949 @subheading The @code{-environment-pwd} Command
18950 @findex -environment-pwd
18951
18952 @subsubheading Synopsis
18953
18954 @smallexample
18955 -environment-pwd
18956 @end smallexample
18957
18958 Show the current working directory.
18959
18960 @subsubheading @value{GDBN} Command
18961
18962 The corresponding @value{GDBN} command is @samp{pwd}.
18963
18964 @subsubheading Example
18965
18966 @smallexample
18967 (gdb)
18968 -environment-pwd
18969 ^done,cwd="/kwikemart/marge/ezannoni/flathead-dev/devo/gdb"
18970 (gdb)
18971 @end smallexample
18972
18973 @c %%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%% SECTION %%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%
18974 @node GDB/MI Thread Commands
18975 @section @sc{gdb/mi} Thread Commands
18976
18977
18978 @subheading The @code{-thread-info} Command
18979 @findex -thread-info
18980
18981 @subsubheading Synopsis
18982
18983 @smallexample
18984 -thread-info [ @var{thread-id} ]
18985 @end smallexample
18986
18987 Reports information about either a specific thread, if
18988 the @var{thread-id} parameter is present, or about all
18989 threads. When printing information about all threads,
18990 also reports the current thread.
18991
18992 @subsubheading @value{GDBN} Command
18993
18994 The @samp{info thread} command prints the same information
18995 about all threads.
18996
18997 @subsubheading Example
18998
18999 @smallexample
19000 -thread-info
19001 ^done,threads=[
19002 @{id="2",target-id="Thread 0xb7e14b90 (LWP 21257)",
19003 frame=@{level="0",addr="0xffffe410",func="__kernel_vsyscall",args=[]@},
19004 @{id="1",target-id="Thread 0xb7e156b0 (LWP 21254)",
19005 frame=@{level="0",addr="0x0804891f",func="foo",args=[@{name="i",value="10"@}],
19006 file="/tmp/a.c",fullname="/tmp/a.c",line="158"@}@}],
19007 current-thread-id="1"
19008 (gdb)
19009 @end smallexample
19010
19011 @subheading The @code{-thread-list-ids} Command
19012 @findex -thread-list-ids
19013
19014 @subsubheading Synopsis
19015
19016 @smallexample
19017 -thread-list-ids
19018 @end smallexample
19019
19020 Produces a list of the currently known @value{GDBN} thread ids. At the
19021 end of the list it also prints the total number of such threads.
19022
19023 @subsubheading @value{GDBN} Command
19024
19025 Part of @samp{info threads} supplies the same information.
19026
19027 @subsubheading Example
19028
19029 No threads present, besides the main process:
19030
19031 @smallexample
19032 (gdb)
19033 -thread-list-ids
19034 ^done,thread-ids=@{@},number-of-threads="0"
19035 (gdb)
19036 @end smallexample
19037
19038
19039 Several threads:
19040
19041 @smallexample
19042 (gdb)
19043 -thread-list-ids
19044 ^done,thread-ids=@{thread-id="3",thread-id="2",thread-id="1"@},
19045 number-of-threads="3"
19046 (gdb)
19047 @end smallexample
19048
19049
19050 @subheading The @code{-thread-select} Command
19051 @findex -thread-select
19052
19053 @subsubheading Synopsis
19054
19055 @smallexample
19056 -thread-select @var{threadnum}
19057 @end smallexample
19058
19059 Make @var{threadnum} the current thread. It prints the number of the new
19060 current thread, and the topmost frame for that thread.
19061
19062 @subsubheading @value{GDBN} Command
19063
19064 The corresponding @value{GDBN} command is @samp{thread}.
19065
19066 @subsubheading Example
19067
19068 @smallexample
19069 (gdb)
19070 -exec-next
19071 ^running
19072 (gdb)
19073 *stopped,reason="end-stepping-range",thread-id="2",line="187",
19074 file="../../../devo/gdb/testsuite/gdb.threads/linux-dp.c"
19075 (gdb)
19076 -thread-list-ids
19077 ^done,
19078 thread-ids=@{thread-id="3",thread-id="2",thread-id="1"@},
19079 number-of-threads="3"
19080 (gdb)
19081 -thread-select 3
19082 ^done,new-thread-id="3",
19083 frame=@{level="0",func="vprintf",
19084 args=[@{name="format",value="0x8048e9c \"%*s%c %d %c\\n\""@},
19085 @{name="arg",value="0x2"@}],file="vprintf.c",line="31"@}
19086 (gdb)
19087 @end smallexample
19088
19089 @c %%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%% SECTION %%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%
19090 @node GDB/MI Program Execution
19091 @section @sc{gdb/mi} Program Execution
19092
19093 These are the asynchronous commands which generate the out-of-band
19094 record @samp{*stopped}. Currently @value{GDBN} only really executes
19095 asynchronously with remote targets and this interaction is mimicked in
19096 other cases.
19097
19098 @subheading The @code{-exec-continue} Command
19099 @findex -exec-continue
19100
19101 @subsubheading Synopsis
19102
19103 @smallexample
19104 -exec-continue
19105 @end smallexample
19106
19107 Resumes the execution of the inferior program until a breakpoint is
19108 encountered, or until the inferior exits.
19109
19110 @subsubheading @value{GDBN} Command
19111
19112 The corresponding @value{GDBN} corresponding is @samp{continue}.
19113
19114 @subsubheading Example
19115
19116 @smallexample
19117 -exec-continue
19118 ^running
19119 (gdb)
19120 @@Hello world
19121 *stopped,reason="breakpoint-hit",disp="keep",bkptno="2",frame=@{
19122 func="foo",args=[],file="hello.c",fullname="/home/foo/bar/hello.c",
19123 line="13"@}
19124 (gdb)
19125 @end smallexample
19126
19127
19128 @subheading The @code{-exec-finish} Command
19129 @findex -exec-finish
19130
19131 @subsubheading Synopsis
19132
19133 @smallexample
19134 -exec-finish
19135 @end smallexample
19136
19137 Resumes the execution of the inferior program until the current
19138 function is exited. Displays the results returned by the function.
19139
19140 @subsubheading @value{GDBN} Command
19141
19142 The corresponding @value{GDBN} command is @samp{finish}.
19143
19144 @subsubheading Example
19145
19146 Function returning @code{void}.
19147
19148 @smallexample
19149 -exec-finish
19150 ^running
19151 (gdb)
19152 @@hello from foo
19153 *stopped,reason="function-finished",frame=@{func="main",args=[],
19154 file="hello.c",fullname="/home/foo/bar/hello.c",line="7"@}
19155 (gdb)
19156 @end smallexample
19157
19158 Function returning other than @code{void}. The name of the internal
19159 @value{GDBN} variable storing the result is printed, together with the
19160 value itself.
19161
19162 @smallexample
19163 -exec-finish
19164 ^running
19165 (gdb)
19166 *stopped,reason="function-finished",frame=@{addr="0x000107b0",func="foo",
19167 args=[@{name="a",value="1"],@{name="b",value="9"@}@},
19168 file="recursive2.c",fullname="/home/foo/bar/recursive2.c",line="14"@},
19169 gdb-result-var="$1",return-value="0"
19170 (gdb)
19171 @end smallexample
19172
19173
19174 @subheading The @code{-exec-interrupt} Command
19175 @findex -exec-interrupt
19176
19177 @subsubheading Synopsis
19178
19179 @smallexample
19180 -exec-interrupt
19181 @end smallexample
19182
19183 Interrupts the background execution of the target. Note how the token
19184 associated with the stop message is the one for the execution command
19185 that has been interrupted. The token for the interrupt itself only
19186 appears in the @samp{^done} output. If the user is trying to
19187 interrupt a non-running program, an error message will be printed.
19188
19189 @subsubheading @value{GDBN} Command
19190
19191 The corresponding @value{GDBN} command is @samp{interrupt}.
19192
19193 @subsubheading Example
19194
19195 @smallexample
19196 (gdb)
19197 111-exec-continue
19198 111^running
19199
19200 (gdb)
19201 222-exec-interrupt
19202 222^done
19203 (gdb)
19204 111*stopped,signal-name="SIGINT",signal-meaning="Interrupt",
19205 frame=@{addr="0x00010140",func="foo",args=[],file="try.c",
19206 fullname="/home/foo/bar/try.c",line="13"@}
19207 (gdb)
19208
19209 (gdb)
19210 -exec-interrupt
19211 ^error,msg="mi_cmd_exec_interrupt: Inferior not executing."
19212 (gdb)
19213 @end smallexample
19214
19215
19216 @subheading The @code{-exec-next} Command
19217 @findex -exec-next
19218
19219 @subsubheading Synopsis
19220
19221 @smallexample
19222 -exec-next
19223 @end smallexample
19224
19225 Resumes execution of the inferior program, stopping when the beginning
19226 of the next source line is reached.
19227
19228 @subsubheading @value{GDBN} Command
19229
19230 The corresponding @value{GDBN} command is @samp{next}.
19231
19232 @subsubheading Example
19233
19234 @smallexample
19235 -exec-next
19236 ^running
19237 (gdb)
19238 *stopped,reason="end-stepping-range",line="8",file="hello.c"
19239 (gdb)
19240 @end smallexample
19241
19242
19243 @subheading The @code{-exec-next-instruction} Command
19244 @findex -exec-next-instruction
19245
19246 @subsubheading Synopsis
19247
19248 @smallexample
19249 -exec-next-instruction
19250 @end smallexample
19251
19252 Executes one machine instruction. If the instruction is a function
19253 call, continues until the function returns. If the program stops at an
19254 instruction in the middle of a source line, the address will be
19255 printed as well.
19256
19257 @subsubheading @value{GDBN} Command
19258
19259 The corresponding @value{GDBN} command is @samp{nexti}.
19260
19261 @subsubheading Example
19262
19263 @smallexample
19264 (gdb)
19265 -exec-next-instruction
19266 ^running
19267
19268 (gdb)
19269 *stopped,reason="end-stepping-range",
19270 addr="0x000100d4",line="5",file="hello.c"
19271 (gdb)
19272 @end smallexample
19273
19274
19275 @subheading The @code{-exec-return} Command
19276 @findex -exec-return
19277
19278 @subsubheading Synopsis
19279
19280 @smallexample
19281 -exec-return
19282 @end smallexample
19283
19284 Makes current function return immediately. Doesn't execute the inferior.
19285 Displays the new current frame.
19286
19287 @subsubheading @value{GDBN} Command
19288
19289 The corresponding @value{GDBN} command is @samp{return}.
19290
19291 @subsubheading Example
19292
19293 @smallexample
19294 (gdb)
19295 200-break-insert callee4
19296 200^done,bkpt=@{number="1",addr="0x00010734",
19297 file="../../../devo/gdb/testsuite/gdb.mi/basics.c",line="8"@}
19298 (gdb)
19299 000-exec-run
19300 000^running
19301 (gdb)
19302 000*stopped,reason="breakpoint-hit",disp="keep",bkptno="1",
19303 frame=@{func="callee4",args=[],
19304 file="../../../devo/gdb/testsuite/gdb.mi/basics.c",
19305 fullname="/home/foo/bar/devo/gdb/testsuite/gdb.mi/basics.c",line="8"@}
19306 (gdb)
19307 205-break-delete
19308 205^done
19309 (gdb)
19310 111-exec-return
19311 111^done,frame=@{level="0",func="callee3",
19312 args=[@{name="strarg",
19313 value="0x11940 \"A string argument.\""@}],
19314 file="../../../devo/gdb/testsuite/gdb.mi/basics.c",
19315 fullname="/home/foo/bar/devo/gdb/testsuite/gdb.mi/basics.c",line="18"@}
19316 (gdb)
19317 @end smallexample
19318
19319
19320 @subheading The @code{-exec-run} Command
19321 @findex -exec-run
19322
19323 @subsubheading Synopsis
19324
19325 @smallexample
19326 -exec-run
19327 @end smallexample
19328
19329 Starts execution of the inferior from the beginning. The inferior
19330 executes until either a breakpoint is encountered or the program
19331 exits. In the latter case the output will include an exit code, if
19332 the program has exited exceptionally.
19333
19334 @subsubheading @value{GDBN} Command
19335
19336 The corresponding @value{GDBN} command is @samp{run}.
19337
19338 @subsubheading Examples
19339
19340 @smallexample
19341 (gdb)
19342 -break-insert main
19343 ^done,bkpt=@{number="1",addr="0x0001072c",file="recursive2.c",line="4"@}
19344 (gdb)
19345 -exec-run
19346 ^running
19347 (gdb)
19348 *stopped,reason="breakpoint-hit",disp="keep",bkptno="1",
19349 frame=@{func="main",args=[],file="recursive2.c",
19350 fullname="/home/foo/bar/recursive2.c",line="4"@}
19351 (gdb)
19352 @end smallexample
19353
19354 @noindent
19355 Program exited normally:
19356
19357 @smallexample
19358 (gdb)
19359 -exec-run
19360 ^running
19361 (gdb)
19362 x = 55
19363 *stopped,reason="exited-normally"
19364 (gdb)
19365 @end smallexample
19366
19367 @noindent
19368 Program exited exceptionally:
19369
19370 @smallexample
19371 (gdb)
19372 -exec-run
19373 ^running
19374 (gdb)
19375 x = 55
19376 *stopped,reason="exited",exit-code="01"
19377 (gdb)
19378 @end smallexample
19379
19380 Another way the program can terminate is if it receives a signal such as
19381 @code{SIGINT}. In this case, @sc{gdb/mi} displays this:
19382
19383 @smallexample
19384 (gdb)
19385 *stopped,reason="exited-signalled",signal-name="SIGINT",
19386 signal-meaning="Interrupt"
19387 @end smallexample
19388
19389
19390 @c @subheading -exec-signal
19391
19392
19393 @subheading The @code{-exec-step} Command
19394 @findex -exec-step
19395
19396 @subsubheading Synopsis
19397
19398 @smallexample
19399 -exec-step
19400 @end smallexample
19401
19402 Resumes execution of the inferior program, stopping when the beginning
19403 of the next source line is reached, if the next source line is not a
19404 function call. If it is, stop at the first instruction of the called
19405 function.
19406
19407 @subsubheading @value{GDBN} Command
19408
19409 The corresponding @value{GDBN} command is @samp{step}.
19410
19411 @subsubheading Example
19412
19413 Stepping into a function:
19414
19415 @smallexample
19416 -exec-step
19417 ^running
19418 (gdb)
19419 *stopped,reason="end-stepping-range",
19420 frame=@{func="foo",args=[@{name="a",value="10"@},
19421 @{name="b",value="0"@}],file="recursive2.c",
19422 fullname="/home/foo/bar/recursive2.c",line="11"@}
19423 (gdb)
19424 @end smallexample
19425
19426 Regular stepping:
19427
19428 @smallexample
19429 -exec-step
19430 ^running
19431 (gdb)
19432 *stopped,reason="end-stepping-range",line="14",file="recursive2.c"
19433 (gdb)
19434 @end smallexample
19435
19436
19437 @subheading The @code{-exec-step-instruction} Command
19438 @findex -exec-step-instruction
19439
19440 @subsubheading Synopsis
19441
19442 @smallexample
19443 -exec-step-instruction
19444 @end smallexample
19445
19446 Resumes the inferior which executes one machine instruction. The
19447 output, once @value{GDBN} has stopped, will vary depending on whether
19448 we have stopped in the middle of a source line or not. In the former
19449 case, the address at which the program stopped will be printed as
19450 well.
19451
19452 @subsubheading @value{GDBN} Command
19453
19454 The corresponding @value{GDBN} command is @samp{stepi}.
19455
19456 @subsubheading Example
19457
19458 @smallexample
19459 (gdb)
19460 -exec-step-instruction
19461 ^running
19462
19463 (gdb)
19464 *stopped,reason="end-stepping-range",
19465 frame=@{func="foo",args=[],file="try.c",
19466 fullname="/home/foo/bar/try.c",line="10"@}
19467 (gdb)
19468 -exec-step-instruction
19469 ^running
19470
19471 (gdb)
19472 *stopped,reason="end-stepping-range",
19473 frame=@{addr="0x000100f4",func="foo",args=[],file="try.c",
19474 fullname="/home/foo/bar/try.c",line="10"@}
19475 (gdb)
19476 @end smallexample
19477
19478
19479 @subheading The @code{-exec-until} Command
19480 @findex -exec-until
19481
19482 @subsubheading Synopsis
19483
19484 @smallexample
19485 -exec-until [ @var{location} ]
19486 @end smallexample
19487
19488 Executes the inferior until the @var{location} specified in the
19489 argument is reached. If there is no argument, the inferior executes
19490 until a source line greater than the current one is reached. The
19491 reason for stopping in this case will be @samp{location-reached}.
19492
19493 @subsubheading @value{GDBN} Command
19494
19495 The corresponding @value{GDBN} command is @samp{until}.
19496
19497 @subsubheading Example
19498
19499 @smallexample
19500 (gdb)
19501 -exec-until recursive2.c:6
19502 ^running
19503 (gdb)
19504 x = 55
19505 *stopped,reason="location-reached",frame=@{func="main",args=[],
19506 file="recursive2.c",fullname="/home/foo/bar/recursive2.c",line="6"@}
19507 (gdb)
19508 @end smallexample
19509
19510 @ignore
19511 @subheading -file-clear
19512 Is this going away????
19513 @end ignore
19514
19515 @c %%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%% SECTION %%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%
19516 @node GDB/MI Stack Manipulation
19517 @section @sc{gdb/mi} Stack Manipulation Commands
19518
19519
19520 @subheading The @code{-stack-info-frame} Command
19521 @findex -stack-info-frame
19522
19523 @subsubheading Synopsis
19524
19525 @smallexample
19526 -stack-info-frame
19527 @end smallexample
19528
19529 Get info on the selected frame.
19530
19531 @subsubheading @value{GDBN} Command
19532
19533 The corresponding @value{GDBN} command is @samp{info frame} or @samp{frame}
19534 (without arguments).
19535
19536 @subsubheading Example
19537
19538 @smallexample
19539 (gdb)
19540 -stack-info-frame
19541 ^done,frame=@{level="1",addr="0x0001076c",func="callee3",
19542 file="../../../devo/gdb/testsuite/gdb.mi/basics.c",
19543 fullname="/home/foo/bar/devo/gdb/testsuite/gdb.mi/basics.c",line="17"@}
19544 (gdb)
19545 @end smallexample
19546
19547 @subheading The @code{-stack-info-depth} Command
19548 @findex -stack-info-depth
19549
19550 @subsubheading Synopsis
19551
19552 @smallexample
19553 -stack-info-depth [ @var{max-depth} ]
19554 @end smallexample
19555
19556 Return the depth of the stack. If the integer argument @var{max-depth}
19557 is specified, do not count beyond @var{max-depth} frames.
19558
19559 @subsubheading @value{GDBN} Command
19560
19561 There's no equivalent @value{GDBN} command.
19562
19563 @subsubheading Example
19564
19565 For a stack with frame levels 0 through 11:
19566
19567 @smallexample
19568 (gdb)
19569 -stack-info-depth
19570 ^done,depth="12"
19571 (gdb)
19572 -stack-info-depth 4
19573 ^done,depth="4"
19574 (gdb)
19575 -stack-info-depth 12
19576 ^done,depth="12"
19577 (gdb)
19578 -stack-info-depth 11
19579 ^done,depth="11"
19580 (gdb)
19581 -stack-info-depth 13
19582 ^done,depth="12"
19583 (gdb)
19584 @end smallexample
19585
19586 @subheading The @code{-stack-list-arguments} Command
19587 @findex -stack-list-arguments
19588
19589 @subsubheading Synopsis
19590
19591 @smallexample
19592 -stack-list-arguments @var{show-values}
19593 [ @var{low-frame} @var{high-frame} ]
19594 @end smallexample
19595
19596 Display a list of the arguments for the frames between @var{low-frame}
19597 and @var{high-frame} (inclusive). If @var{low-frame} and
19598 @var{high-frame} are not provided, list the arguments for the whole
19599 call stack. If the two arguments are equal, show the single frame
19600 at the corresponding level. It is an error if @var{low-frame} is
19601 larger than the actual number of frames. On the other hand,
19602 @var{high-frame} may be larger than the actual number of frames, in
19603 which case only existing frames will be returned.
19604
19605 The @var{show-values} argument must have a value of 0 or 1. A value of
19606 0 means that only the names of the arguments are listed, a value of 1
19607 means that both names and values of the arguments are printed.
19608
19609 @subsubheading @value{GDBN} Command
19610
19611 @value{GDBN} does not have an equivalent command. @code{gdbtk} has a
19612 @samp{gdb_get_args} command which partially overlaps with the
19613 functionality of @samp{-stack-list-arguments}.
19614
19615 @subsubheading Example
19616
19617 @smallexample
19618 (gdb)
19619 -stack-list-frames
19620 ^done,
19621 stack=[
19622 frame=@{level="0",addr="0x00010734",func="callee4",
19623 file="../../../devo/gdb/testsuite/gdb.mi/basics.c",
19624 fullname="/home/foo/bar/devo/gdb/testsuite/gdb.mi/basics.c",line="8"@},
19625 frame=@{level="1",addr="0x0001076c",func="callee3",
19626 file="../../../devo/gdb/testsuite/gdb.mi/basics.c",
19627 fullname="/home/foo/bar/devo/gdb/testsuite/gdb.mi/basics.c",line="17"@},
19628 frame=@{level="2",addr="0x0001078c",func="callee2",
19629 file="../../../devo/gdb/testsuite/gdb.mi/basics.c",
19630 fullname="/home/foo/bar/devo/gdb/testsuite/gdb.mi/basics.c",line="22"@},
19631 frame=@{level="3",addr="0x000107b4",func="callee1",
19632 file="../../../devo/gdb/testsuite/gdb.mi/basics.c",
19633 fullname="/home/foo/bar/devo/gdb/testsuite/gdb.mi/basics.c",line="27"@},
19634 frame=@{level="4",addr="0x000107e0",func="main",
19635 file="../../../devo/gdb/testsuite/gdb.mi/basics.c",
19636 fullname="/home/foo/bar/devo/gdb/testsuite/gdb.mi/basics.c",line="32"@}]
19637 (gdb)
19638 -stack-list-arguments 0
19639 ^done,
19640 stack-args=[
19641 frame=@{level="0",args=[]@},
19642 frame=@{level="1",args=[name="strarg"]@},
19643 frame=@{level="2",args=[name="intarg",name="strarg"]@},
19644 frame=@{level="3",args=[name="intarg",name="strarg",name="fltarg"]@},
19645 frame=@{level="4",args=[]@}]
19646 (gdb)
19647 -stack-list-arguments 1
19648 ^done,
19649 stack-args=[
19650 frame=@{level="0",args=[]@},
19651 frame=@{level="1",
19652 args=[@{name="strarg",value="0x11940 \"A string argument.\""@}]@},
19653 frame=@{level="2",args=[
19654 @{name="intarg",value="2"@},
19655 @{name="strarg",value="0x11940 \"A string argument.\""@}]@},
19656 @{frame=@{level="3",args=[
19657 @{name="intarg",value="2"@},
19658 @{name="strarg",value="0x11940 \"A string argument.\""@},
19659 @{name="fltarg",value="3.5"@}]@},
19660 frame=@{level="4",args=[]@}]
19661 (gdb)
19662 -stack-list-arguments 0 2 2
19663 ^done,stack-args=[frame=@{level="2",args=[name="intarg",name="strarg"]@}]
19664 (gdb)
19665 -stack-list-arguments 1 2 2
19666 ^done,stack-args=[frame=@{level="2",
19667 args=[@{name="intarg",value="2"@},
19668 @{name="strarg",value="0x11940 \"A string argument.\""@}]@}]
19669 (gdb)
19670 @end smallexample
19671
19672 @c @subheading -stack-list-exception-handlers
19673
19674
19675 @subheading The @code{-stack-list-frames} Command
19676 @findex -stack-list-frames
19677
19678 @subsubheading Synopsis
19679
19680 @smallexample
19681 -stack-list-frames [ @var{low-frame} @var{high-frame} ]
19682 @end smallexample
19683
19684 List the frames currently on the stack. For each frame it displays the
19685 following info:
19686
19687 @table @samp
19688 @item @var{level}
19689 The frame number, 0 being the topmost frame, i.e., the innermost function.
19690 @item @var{addr}
19691 The @code{$pc} value for that frame.
19692 @item @var{func}
19693 Function name.
19694 @item @var{file}
19695 File name of the source file where the function lives.
19696 @item @var{line}
19697 Line number corresponding to the @code{$pc}.
19698 @end table
19699
19700 If invoked without arguments, this command prints a backtrace for the
19701 whole stack. If given two integer arguments, it shows the frames whose
19702 levels are between the two arguments (inclusive). If the two arguments
19703 are equal, it shows the single frame at the corresponding level. It is
19704 an error if @var{low-frame} is larger than the actual number of
19705 frames. On the other hand, @var{high-frame} may be larger than the
19706 actual number of frames, in which case only existing frames will be returned.
19707
19708 @subsubheading @value{GDBN} Command
19709
19710 The corresponding @value{GDBN} commands are @samp{backtrace} and @samp{where}.
19711
19712 @subsubheading Example
19713
19714 Full stack backtrace:
19715
19716 @smallexample
19717 (gdb)
19718 -stack-list-frames
19719 ^done,stack=
19720 [frame=@{level="0",addr="0x0001076c",func="foo",
19721 file="recursive2.c",fullname="/home/foo/bar/recursive2.c",line="11"@},
19722 frame=@{level="1",addr="0x000107a4",func="foo",
19723 file="recursive2.c",fullname="/home/foo/bar/recursive2.c",line="14"@},
19724 frame=@{level="2",addr="0x000107a4",func="foo",
19725 file="recursive2.c",fullname="/home/foo/bar/recursive2.c",line="14"@},
19726 frame=@{level="3",addr="0x000107a4",func="foo",
19727 file="recursive2.c",fullname="/home/foo/bar/recursive2.c",line="14"@},
19728 frame=@{level="4",addr="0x000107a4",func="foo",
19729 file="recursive2.c",fullname="/home/foo/bar/recursive2.c",line="14"@},
19730 frame=@{level="5",addr="0x000107a4",func="foo",
19731 file="recursive2.c",fullname="/home/foo/bar/recursive2.c",line="14"@},
19732 frame=@{level="6",addr="0x000107a4",func="foo",
19733 file="recursive2.c",fullname="/home/foo/bar/recursive2.c",line="14"@},
19734 frame=@{level="7",addr="0x000107a4",func="foo",
19735 file="recursive2.c",fullname="/home/foo/bar/recursive2.c",line="14"@},
19736 frame=@{level="8",addr="0x000107a4",func="foo",
19737 file="recursive2.c",fullname="/home/foo/bar/recursive2.c",line="14"@},
19738 frame=@{level="9",addr="0x000107a4",func="foo",
19739 file="recursive2.c",fullname="/home/foo/bar/recursive2.c",line="14"@},
19740 frame=@{level="10",addr="0x000107a4",func="foo",
19741 file="recursive2.c",fullname="/home/foo/bar/recursive2.c",line="14"@},
19742 frame=@{level="11",addr="0x00010738",func="main",
19743 file="recursive2.c",fullname="/home/foo/bar/recursive2.c",line="4"@}]
19744 (gdb)
19745 @end smallexample
19746
19747 Show frames between @var{low_frame} and @var{high_frame}:
19748
19749 @smallexample
19750 (gdb)
19751 -stack-list-frames 3 5
19752 ^done,stack=
19753 [frame=@{level="3",addr="0x000107a4",func="foo",
19754 file="recursive2.c",fullname="/home/foo/bar/recursive2.c",line="14"@},
19755 frame=@{level="4",addr="0x000107a4",func="foo",
19756 file="recursive2.c",fullname="/home/foo/bar/recursive2.c",line="14"@},
19757 frame=@{level="5",addr="0x000107a4",func="foo",
19758 file="recursive2.c",fullname="/home/foo/bar/recursive2.c",line="14"@}]
19759 (gdb)
19760 @end smallexample
19761
19762 Show a single frame:
19763
19764 @smallexample
19765 (gdb)
19766 -stack-list-frames 3 3
19767 ^done,stack=
19768 [frame=@{level="3",addr="0x000107a4",func="foo",
19769 file="recursive2.c",fullname="/home/foo/bar/recursive2.c",line="14"@}]
19770 (gdb)
19771 @end smallexample
19772
19773
19774 @subheading The @code{-stack-list-locals} Command
19775 @findex -stack-list-locals
19776
19777 @subsubheading Synopsis
19778
19779 @smallexample
19780 -stack-list-locals @var{print-values}
19781 @end smallexample
19782
19783 Display the local variable names for the selected frame. If
19784 @var{print-values} is 0 or @code{--no-values}, print only the names of
19785 the variables; if it is 1 or @code{--all-values}, print also their
19786 values; and if it is 2 or @code{--simple-values}, print the name,
19787 type and value for simple data types and the name and type for arrays,
19788 structures and unions. In this last case, a frontend can immediately
19789 display the value of simple data types and create variable objects for
19790 other data types when the user wishes to explore their values in
19791 more detail.
19792
19793 @subsubheading @value{GDBN} Command
19794
19795 @samp{info locals} in @value{GDBN}, @samp{gdb_get_locals} in @code{gdbtk}.
19796
19797 @subsubheading Example
19798
19799 @smallexample
19800 (gdb)
19801 -stack-list-locals 0
19802 ^done,locals=[name="A",name="B",name="C"]
19803 (gdb)
19804 -stack-list-locals --all-values
19805 ^done,locals=[@{name="A",value="1"@},@{name="B",value="2"@},
19806 @{name="C",value="@{1, 2, 3@}"@}]
19807 -stack-list-locals --simple-values
19808 ^done,locals=[@{name="A",type="int",value="1"@},
19809 @{name="B",type="int",value="2"@},@{name="C",type="int [3]"@}]
19810 (gdb)
19811 @end smallexample
19812
19813
19814 @subheading The @code{-stack-select-frame} Command
19815 @findex -stack-select-frame
19816
19817 @subsubheading Synopsis
19818
19819 @smallexample
19820 -stack-select-frame @var{framenum}
19821 @end smallexample
19822
19823 Change the selected frame. Select a different frame @var{framenum} on
19824 the stack.
19825
19826 @subsubheading @value{GDBN} Command
19827
19828 The corresponding @value{GDBN} commands are @samp{frame}, @samp{up},
19829 @samp{down}, @samp{select-frame}, @samp{up-silent}, and @samp{down-silent}.
19830
19831 @subsubheading Example
19832
19833 @smallexample
19834 (gdb)
19835 -stack-select-frame 2
19836 ^done
19837 (gdb)
19838 @end smallexample
19839
19840 @c %%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%% SECTION %%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%
19841 @node GDB/MI Variable Objects
19842 @section @sc{gdb/mi} Variable Objects
19843
19844 @ignore
19845
19846 @subheading Motivation for Variable Objects in @sc{gdb/mi}
19847
19848 For the implementation of a variable debugger window (locals, watched
19849 expressions, etc.), we are proposing the adaptation of the existing code
19850 used by @code{Insight}.
19851
19852 The two main reasons for that are:
19853
19854 @enumerate 1
19855 @item
19856 It has been proven in practice (it is already on its second generation).
19857
19858 @item
19859 It will shorten development time (needless to say how important it is
19860 now).
19861 @end enumerate
19862
19863 The original interface was designed to be used by Tcl code, so it was
19864 slightly changed so it could be used through @sc{gdb/mi}. This section
19865 describes the @sc{gdb/mi} operations that will be available and gives some
19866 hints about their use.
19867
19868 @emph{Note}: In addition to the set of operations described here, we
19869 expect the @sc{gui} implementation of a variable window to require, at
19870 least, the following operations:
19871
19872 @itemize @bullet
19873 @item @code{-gdb-show} @code{output-radix}
19874 @item @code{-stack-list-arguments}
19875 @item @code{-stack-list-locals}
19876 @item @code{-stack-select-frame}
19877 @end itemize
19878
19879 @end ignore
19880
19881 @subheading Introduction to Variable Objects
19882
19883 @cindex variable objects in @sc{gdb/mi}
19884
19885 Variable objects are "object-oriented" MI interface for examining and
19886 changing values of expressions. Unlike some other MI interfaces that
19887 work with expressions, variable objects are specifically designed for
19888 simple and efficient presentation in the frontend. A variable object
19889 is identified by string name. When a variable object is created, the
19890 frontend specifies the expression for that variable object. The
19891 expression can be a simple variable, or it can be an arbitrary complex
19892 expression, and can even involve CPU registers. After creating a
19893 variable object, the frontend can invoke other variable object
19894 operations---for example to obtain or change the value of a variable
19895 object, or to change display format.
19896
19897 Variable objects have hierarchical tree structure. Any variable object
19898 that corresponds to a composite type, such as structure in C, has
19899 a number of child variable objects, for example corresponding to each
19900 element of a structure. A child variable object can itself have
19901 children, recursively. Recursion ends when we reach
19902 leaf variable objects, which always have built-in types. Child variable
19903 objects are created only by explicit request, so if a frontend
19904 is not interested in the children of a particular variable object, no
19905 child will be created.
19906
19907 For a leaf variable object it is possible to obtain its value as a
19908 string, or set the value from a string. String value can be also
19909 obtained for a non-leaf variable object, but it's generally a string
19910 that only indicates the type of the object, and does not list its
19911 contents. Assignment to a non-leaf variable object is not allowed.
19912
19913 A frontend does not need to read the values of all variable objects each time
19914 the program stops. Instead, MI provides an update command that lists all
19915 variable objects whose values has changed since the last update
19916 operation. This considerably reduces the amount of data that must
19917 be transferred to the frontend. As noted above, children variable
19918 objects are created on demand, and only leaf variable objects have a
19919 real value. As result, gdb will read target memory only for leaf
19920 variables that frontend has created.
19921
19922 The automatic update is not always desirable. For example, a frontend
19923 might want to keep a value of some expression for future reference,
19924 and never update it. For another example, fetching memory is
19925 relatively slow for embedded targets, so a frontend might want
19926 to disable automatic update for the variables that are either not
19927 visible on the screen, or ``closed''. This is possible using so
19928 called ``frozen variable objects''. Such variable objects are never
19929 implicitly updated.
19930
19931 The following is the complete set of @sc{gdb/mi} operations defined to
19932 access this functionality:
19933
19934 @multitable @columnfractions .4 .6
19935 @item @strong{Operation}
19936 @tab @strong{Description}
19937
19938 @item @code{-var-create}
19939 @tab create a variable object
19940 @item @code{-var-delete}
19941 @tab delete the variable object and/or its children
19942 @item @code{-var-set-format}
19943 @tab set the display format of this variable
19944 @item @code{-var-show-format}
19945 @tab show the display format of this variable
19946 @item @code{-var-info-num-children}
19947 @tab tells how many children this object has
19948 @item @code{-var-list-children}
19949 @tab return a list of the object's children
19950 @item @code{-var-info-type}
19951 @tab show the type of this variable object
19952 @item @code{-var-info-expression}
19953 @tab print parent-relative expression that this variable object represents
19954 @item @code{-var-info-path-expression}
19955 @tab print full expression that this variable object represents
19956 @item @code{-var-show-attributes}
19957 @tab is this variable editable? does it exist here?
19958 @item @code{-var-evaluate-expression}
19959 @tab get the value of this variable
19960 @item @code{-var-assign}
19961 @tab set the value of this variable
19962 @item @code{-var-update}
19963 @tab update the variable and its children
19964 @item @code{-var-set-frozen}
19965 @tab set frozeness attribute
19966 @end multitable
19967
19968 In the next subsection we describe each operation in detail and suggest
19969 how it can be used.
19970
19971 @subheading Description And Use of Operations on Variable Objects
19972
19973 @subheading The @code{-var-create} Command
19974 @findex -var-create
19975
19976 @subsubheading Synopsis
19977
19978 @smallexample
19979 -var-create @{@var{name} | "-"@}
19980 @{@var{frame-addr} | "*"@} @var{expression}
19981 @end smallexample
19982
19983 This operation creates a variable object, which allows the monitoring of
19984 a variable, the result of an expression, a memory cell or a CPU
19985 register.
19986
19987 The @var{name} parameter is the string by which the object can be
19988 referenced. It must be unique. If @samp{-} is specified, the varobj
19989 system will generate a string ``varNNNNNN'' automatically. It will be
19990 unique provided that one does not specify @var{name} on that format.
19991 The command fails if a duplicate name is found.
19992
19993 The frame under which the expression should be evaluated can be
19994 specified by @var{frame-addr}. A @samp{*} indicates that the current
19995 frame should be used.
19996
19997 @var{expression} is any expression valid on the current language set (must not
19998 begin with a @samp{*}), or one of the following:
19999
20000 @itemize @bullet
20001 @item
20002 @samp{*@var{addr}}, where @var{addr} is the address of a memory cell
20003
20004 @item
20005 @samp{*@var{addr}-@var{addr}} --- a memory address range (TBD)
20006
20007 @item
20008 @samp{$@var{regname}} --- a CPU register name
20009 @end itemize
20010
20011 @subsubheading Result
20012
20013 This operation returns the name, number of children and the type of the
20014 object created. Type is returned as a string as the ones generated by
20015 the @value{GDBN} CLI:
20016
20017 @smallexample
20018 name="@var{name}",numchild="N",type="@var{type}"
20019 @end smallexample
20020
20021
20022 @subheading The @code{-var-delete} Command
20023 @findex -var-delete
20024
20025 @subsubheading Synopsis
20026
20027 @smallexample
20028 -var-delete [ -c ] @var{name}
20029 @end smallexample
20030
20031 Deletes a previously created variable object and all of its children.
20032 With the @samp{-c} option, just deletes the children.
20033
20034 Returns an error if the object @var{name} is not found.
20035
20036
20037 @subheading The @code{-var-set-format} Command
20038 @findex -var-set-format
20039
20040 @subsubheading Synopsis
20041
20042 @smallexample
20043 -var-set-format @var{name} @var{format-spec}
20044 @end smallexample
20045
20046 Sets the output format for the value of the object @var{name} to be
20047 @var{format-spec}.
20048
20049 @anchor{-var-set-format}
20050 The syntax for the @var{format-spec} is as follows:
20051
20052 @smallexample
20053 @var{format-spec} @expansion{}
20054 @{binary | decimal | hexadecimal | octal | natural@}
20055 @end smallexample
20056
20057 The natural format is the default format choosen automatically
20058 based on the variable type (like decimal for an @code{int}, hex
20059 for pointers, etc.).
20060
20061 For a variable with children, the format is set only on the
20062 variable itself, and the children are not affected.
20063
20064 @subheading The @code{-var-show-format} Command
20065 @findex -var-show-format
20066
20067 @subsubheading Synopsis
20068
20069 @smallexample
20070 -var-show-format @var{name}
20071 @end smallexample
20072
20073 Returns the format used to display the value of the object @var{name}.
20074
20075 @smallexample
20076 @var{format} @expansion{}
20077 @var{format-spec}
20078 @end smallexample
20079
20080
20081 @subheading The @code{-var-info-num-children} Command
20082 @findex -var-info-num-children
20083
20084 @subsubheading Synopsis
20085
20086 @smallexample
20087 -var-info-num-children @var{name}
20088 @end smallexample
20089
20090 Returns the number of children of a variable object @var{name}:
20091
20092 @smallexample
20093 numchild=@var{n}
20094 @end smallexample
20095
20096
20097 @subheading The @code{-var-list-children} Command
20098 @findex -var-list-children
20099
20100 @subsubheading Synopsis
20101
20102 @smallexample
20103 -var-list-children [@var{print-values}] @var{name}
20104 @end smallexample
20105 @anchor{-var-list-children}
20106
20107 Return a list of the children of the specified variable object and
20108 create variable objects for them, if they do not already exist. With
20109 a single argument or if @var{print-values} has a value for of 0 or
20110 @code{--no-values}, print only the names of the variables; if
20111 @var{print-values} is 1 or @code{--all-values}, also print their
20112 values; and if it is 2 or @code{--simple-values} print the name and
20113 value for simple data types and just the name for arrays, structures
20114 and unions.
20115
20116 @subsubheading Example
20117
20118 @smallexample
20119 (gdb)
20120 -var-list-children n
20121 ^done,numchild=@var{n},children=[@{name=@var{name},
20122 numchild=@var{n},type=@var{type}@},@r{(repeats N times)}]
20123 (gdb)
20124 -var-list-children --all-values n
20125 ^done,numchild=@var{n},children=[@{name=@var{name},
20126 numchild=@var{n},value=@var{value},type=@var{type}@},@r{(repeats N times)}]
20127 @end smallexample
20128
20129
20130 @subheading The @code{-var-info-type} Command
20131 @findex -var-info-type
20132
20133 @subsubheading Synopsis
20134
20135 @smallexample
20136 -var-info-type @var{name}
20137 @end smallexample
20138
20139 Returns the type of the specified variable @var{name}. The type is
20140 returned as a string in the same format as it is output by the
20141 @value{GDBN} CLI:
20142
20143 @smallexample
20144 type=@var{typename}
20145 @end smallexample
20146
20147
20148 @subheading The @code{-var-info-expression} Command
20149 @findex -var-info-expression
20150
20151 @subsubheading Synopsis
20152
20153 @smallexample
20154 -var-info-expression @var{name}
20155 @end smallexample
20156
20157 Returns a string that is suitable for presenting this
20158 variable object in user interface. The string is generally
20159 not valid expression in the current language, and cannot be evaluated.
20160
20161 For example, if @code{a} is an array, and variable object
20162 @code{A} was created for @code{a}, then we'll get this output:
20163
20164 @smallexample
20165 (gdb) -var-info-expression A.1
20166 ^done,lang="C",exp="1"
20167 @end smallexample
20168
20169 @noindent
20170 Here, the values of @code{lang} can be @code{@{"C" | "C++" | "Java"@}}.
20171
20172 Note that the output of the @code{-var-list-children} command also
20173 includes those expressions, so the @code{-var-info-expression} command
20174 is of limited use.
20175
20176 @subheading The @code{-var-info-path-expression} Command
20177 @findex -var-info-path-expression
20178
20179 @subsubheading Synopsis
20180
20181 @smallexample
20182 -var-info-path-expression @var{name}
20183 @end smallexample
20184
20185 Returns an expression that can be evaluated in the current
20186 context and will yield the same value that a variable object has.
20187 Compare this with the @code{-var-info-expression} command, which
20188 result can be used only for UI presentation. Typical use of
20189 the @code{-var-info-path-expression} command is creating a
20190 watchpoint from a variable object.
20191
20192 For example, suppose @code{C} is a C@t{++} class, derived from class
20193 @code{Base}, and that the @code{Base} class has a member called
20194 @code{m_size}. Assume a variable @code{c} is has the type of
20195 @code{C} and a variable object @code{C} was created for variable
20196 @code{c}. Then, we'll get this output:
20197 @smallexample
20198 (gdb) -var-info-path-expression C.Base.public.m_size
20199 ^done,path_expr=((Base)c).m_size)
20200 @end smallexample
20201
20202 @subheading The @code{-var-show-attributes} Command
20203 @findex -var-show-attributes
20204
20205 @subsubheading Synopsis
20206
20207 @smallexample
20208 -var-show-attributes @var{name}
20209 @end smallexample
20210
20211 List attributes of the specified variable object @var{name}:
20212
20213 @smallexample
20214 status=@var{attr} [ ( ,@var{attr} )* ]
20215 @end smallexample
20216
20217 @noindent
20218 where @var{attr} is @code{@{ @{ editable | noneditable @} | TBD @}}.
20219
20220 @subheading The @code{-var-evaluate-expression} Command
20221 @findex -var-evaluate-expression
20222
20223 @subsubheading Synopsis
20224
20225 @smallexample
20226 -var-evaluate-expression [-f @var{format-spec}] @var{name}
20227 @end smallexample
20228
20229 Evaluates the expression that is represented by the specified variable
20230 object and returns its value as a string. The format of the string
20231 can be specified with the @samp{-f} option. The possible values of
20232 this option are the same as for @code{-var-set-format}
20233 (@pxref{-var-set-format}). If the @samp{-f} option is not specified,
20234 the current display format will be used. The current display format
20235 can be changed using the @code{-var-set-format} command.
20236
20237 @smallexample
20238 value=@var{value}
20239 @end smallexample
20240
20241 Note that one must invoke @code{-var-list-children} for a variable
20242 before the value of a child variable can be evaluated.
20243
20244 @subheading The @code{-var-assign} Command
20245 @findex -var-assign
20246
20247 @subsubheading Synopsis
20248
20249 @smallexample
20250 -var-assign @var{name} @var{expression}
20251 @end smallexample
20252
20253 Assigns the value of @var{expression} to the variable object specified
20254 by @var{name}. The object must be @samp{editable}. If the variable's
20255 value is altered by the assign, the variable will show up in any
20256 subsequent @code{-var-update} list.
20257
20258 @subsubheading Example
20259
20260 @smallexample
20261 (gdb)
20262 -var-assign var1 3
20263 ^done,value="3"
20264 (gdb)
20265 -var-update *
20266 ^done,changelist=[@{name="var1",in_scope="true",type_changed="false"@}]
20267 (gdb)
20268 @end smallexample
20269
20270 @subheading The @code{-var-update} Command
20271 @findex -var-update
20272
20273 @subsubheading Synopsis
20274
20275 @smallexample
20276 -var-update [@var{print-values}] @{@var{name} | "*"@}
20277 @end smallexample
20278
20279 Reevaluate the expressions corresponding to the variable object
20280 @var{name} and all its direct and indirect children, and return the
20281 list of variable objects whose values have changed; @var{name} must
20282 be a root variable object. Here, ``changed'' means that the result of
20283 @code{-var-evaluate-expression} before and after the
20284 @code{-var-update} is different. If @samp{*} is used as the variable
20285 object names, all existing variable objects are updated, except
20286 for frozen ones (@pxref{-var-set-frozen}). The option
20287 @var{print-values} determines whether both names and values, or just
20288 names are printed. The possible values of this option are the same
20289 as for @code{-var-list-children} (@pxref{-var-list-children}). It is
20290 recommended to use the @samp{--all-values} option, to reduce the
20291 number of MI commands needed on each program stop.
20292
20293
20294 @subsubheading Example
20295
20296 @smallexample
20297 (gdb)
20298 -var-assign var1 3
20299 ^done,value="3"
20300 (gdb)
20301 -var-update --all-values var1
20302 ^done,changelist=[@{name="var1",value="3",in_scope="true",
20303 type_changed="false"@}]
20304 (gdb)
20305 @end smallexample
20306
20307 @anchor{-var-update}
20308 The field in_scope may take three values:
20309
20310 @table @code
20311 @item "true"
20312 The variable object's current value is valid.
20313
20314 @item "false"
20315 The variable object does not currently hold a valid value but it may
20316 hold one in the future if its associated expression comes back into
20317 scope.
20318
20319 @item "invalid"
20320 The variable object no longer holds a valid value.
20321 This can occur when the executable file being debugged has changed,
20322 either through recompilation or by using the @value{GDBN} @code{file}
20323 command. The front end should normally choose to delete these variable
20324 objects.
20325 @end table
20326
20327 In the future new values may be added to this list so the front should
20328 be prepared for this possibility. @xref{GDB/MI Development and Front Ends, ,@sc{GDB/MI} Development and Front Ends}.
20329
20330 @subheading The @code{-var-set-frozen} Command
20331 @findex -var-set-frozen
20332 @anchor{-var-set-frozen}
20333
20334 @subsubheading Synopsis
20335
20336 @smallexample
20337 -var-set-frozen @var{name} @var{flag}
20338 @end smallexample
20339
20340 Set the frozenness flag on the variable object @var{name}. The
20341 @var{flag} parameter should be either @samp{1} to make the variable
20342 frozen or @samp{0} to make it unfrozen. If a variable object is
20343 frozen, then neither itself, nor any of its children, are
20344 implicitly updated by @code{-var-update} of
20345 a parent variable or by @code{-var-update *}. Only
20346 @code{-var-update} of the variable itself will update its value and
20347 values of its children. After a variable object is unfrozen, it is
20348 implicitly updated by all subsequent @code{-var-update} operations.
20349 Unfreezing a variable does not update it, only subsequent
20350 @code{-var-update} does.
20351
20352 @subsubheading Example
20353
20354 @smallexample
20355 (gdb)
20356 -var-set-frozen V 1
20357 ^done
20358 (gdb)
20359 @end smallexample
20360
20361
20362 @c %%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%% SECTION %%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%
20363 @node GDB/MI Data Manipulation
20364 @section @sc{gdb/mi} Data Manipulation
20365
20366 @cindex data manipulation, in @sc{gdb/mi}
20367 @cindex @sc{gdb/mi}, data manipulation
20368 This section describes the @sc{gdb/mi} commands that manipulate data:
20369 examine memory and registers, evaluate expressions, etc.
20370
20371 @c REMOVED FROM THE INTERFACE.
20372 @c @subheading -data-assign
20373 @c Change the value of a program variable. Plenty of side effects.
20374 @c @subsubheading GDB Command
20375 @c set variable
20376 @c @subsubheading Example
20377 @c N.A.
20378
20379 @subheading The @code{-data-disassemble} Command
20380 @findex -data-disassemble
20381
20382 @subsubheading Synopsis
20383
20384 @smallexample
20385 -data-disassemble
20386 [ -s @var{start-addr} -e @var{end-addr} ]
20387 | [ -f @var{filename} -l @var{linenum} [ -n @var{lines} ] ]
20388 -- @var{mode}
20389 @end smallexample
20390
20391 @noindent
20392 Where:
20393
20394 @table @samp
20395 @item @var{start-addr}
20396 is the beginning address (or @code{$pc})
20397 @item @var{end-addr}
20398 is the end address
20399 @item @var{filename}
20400 is the name of the file to disassemble
20401 @item @var{linenum}
20402 is the line number to disassemble around
20403 @item @var{lines}
20404 is the number of disassembly lines to be produced. If it is -1,
20405 the whole function will be disassembled, in case no @var{end-addr} is
20406 specified. If @var{end-addr} is specified as a non-zero value, and
20407 @var{lines} is lower than the number of disassembly lines between
20408 @var{start-addr} and @var{end-addr}, only @var{lines} lines are
20409 displayed; if @var{lines} is higher than the number of lines between
20410 @var{start-addr} and @var{end-addr}, only the lines up to @var{end-addr}
20411 are displayed.
20412 @item @var{mode}
20413 is either 0 (meaning only disassembly) or 1 (meaning mixed source and
20414 disassembly).
20415 @end table
20416
20417 @subsubheading Result
20418
20419 The output for each instruction is composed of four fields:
20420
20421 @itemize @bullet
20422 @item Address
20423 @item Func-name
20424 @item Offset
20425 @item Instruction
20426 @end itemize
20427
20428 Note that whatever included in the instruction field, is not manipulated
20429 directly by @sc{gdb/mi}, i.e., it is not possible to adjust its format.
20430
20431 @subsubheading @value{GDBN} Command
20432
20433 There's no direct mapping from this command to the CLI.
20434
20435 @subsubheading Example
20436
20437 Disassemble from the current value of @code{$pc} to @code{$pc + 20}:
20438
20439 @smallexample
20440 (gdb)
20441 -data-disassemble -s $pc -e "$pc + 20" -- 0
20442 ^done,
20443 asm_insns=[
20444 @{address="0x000107c0",func-name="main",offset="4",
20445 inst="mov 2, %o0"@},
20446 @{address="0x000107c4",func-name="main",offset="8",
20447 inst="sethi %hi(0x11800), %o2"@},
20448 @{address="0x000107c8",func-name="main",offset="12",
20449 inst="or %o2, 0x140, %o1\t! 0x11940 <_lib_version+8>"@},
20450 @{address="0x000107cc",func-name="main",offset="16",
20451 inst="sethi %hi(0x11800), %o2"@},
20452 @{address="0x000107d0",func-name="main",offset="20",
20453 inst="or %o2, 0x168, %o4\t! 0x11968 <_lib_version+48>"@}]
20454 (gdb)
20455 @end smallexample
20456
20457 Disassemble the whole @code{main} function. Line 32 is part of
20458 @code{main}.
20459
20460 @smallexample
20461 -data-disassemble -f basics.c -l 32 -- 0
20462 ^done,asm_insns=[
20463 @{address="0x000107bc",func-name="main",offset="0",
20464 inst="save %sp, -112, %sp"@},
20465 @{address="0x000107c0",func-name="main",offset="4",
20466 inst="mov 2, %o0"@},
20467 @{address="0x000107c4",func-name="main",offset="8",
20468 inst="sethi %hi(0x11800), %o2"@},
20469 [@dots{}]
20470 @{address="0x0001081c",func-name="main",offset="96",inst="ret "@},
20471 @{address="0x00010820",func-name="main",offset="100",inst="restore "@}]
20472 (gdb)
20473 @end smallexample
20474
20475 Disassemble 3 instructions from the start of @code{main}:
20476
20477 @smallexample
20478 (gdb)
20479 -data-disassemble -f basics.c -l 32 -n 3 -- 0
20480 ^done,asm_insns=[
20481 @{address="0x000107bc",func-name="main",offset="0",
20482 inst="save %sp, -112, %sp"@},
20483 @{address="0x000107c0",func-name="main",offset="4",
20484 inst="mov 2, %o0"@},
20485 @{address="0x000107c4",func-name="main",offset="8",
20486 inst="sethi %hi(0x11800), %o2"@}]
20487 (gdb)
20488 @end smallexample
20489
20490 Disassemble 3 instructions from the start of @code{main} in mixed mode:
20491
20492 @smallexample
20493 (gdb)
20494 -data-disassemble -f basics.c -l 32 -n 3 -- 1
20495 ^done,asm_insns=[
20496 src_and_asm_line=@{line="31",
20497 file="/kwikemart/marge/ezannoni/flathead-dev/devo/gdb/ \
20498 testsuite/gdb.mi/basics.c",line_asm_insn=[
20499 @{address="0x000107bc",func-name="main",offset="0",
20500 inst="save %sp, -112, %sp"@}]@},
20501 src_and_asm_line=@{line="32",
20502 file="/kwikemart/marge/ezannoni/flathead-dev/devo/gdb/ \
20503 testsuite/gdb.mi/basics.c",line_asm_insn=[
20504 @{address="0x000107c0",func-name="main",offset="4",
20505 inst="mov 2, %o0"@},
20506 @{address="0x000107c4",func-name="main",offset="8",
20507 inst="sethi %hi(0x11800), %o2"@}]@}]
20508 (gdb)
20509 @end smallexample
20510
20511
20512 @subheading The @code{-data-evaluate-expression} Command
20513 @findex -data-evaluate-expression
20514
20515 @subsubheading Synopsis
20516
20517 @smallexample
20518 -data-evaluate-expression @var{expr}
20519 @end smallexample
20520
20521 Evaluate @var{expr} as an expression. The expression could contain an
20522 inferior function call. The function call will execute synchronously.
20523 If the expression contains spaces, it must be enclosed in double quotes.
20524
20525 @subsubheading @value{GDBN} Command
20526
20527 The corresponding @value{GDBN} commands are @samp{print}, @samp{output}, and
20528 @samp{call}. In @code{gdbtk} only, there's a corresponding
20529 @samp{gdb_eval} command.
20530
20531 @subsubheading Example
20532
20533 In the following example, the numbers that precede the commands are the
20534 @dfn{tokens} described in @ref{GDB/MI Command Syntax, ,@sc{gdb/mi}
20535 Command Syntax}. Notice how @sc{gdb/mi} returns the same tokens in its
20536 output.
20537
20538 @smallexample
20539 211-data-evaluate-expression A
20540 211^done,value="1"
20541 (gdb)
20542 311-data-evaluate-expression &A
20543 311^done,value="0xefffeb7c"
20544 (gdb)
20545 411-data-evaluate-expression A+3
20546 411^done,value="4"
20547 (gdb)
20548 511-data-evaluate-expression "A + 3"
20549 511^done,value="4"
20550 (gdb)
20551 @end smallexample
20552
20553
20554 @subheading The @code{-data-list-changed-registers} Command
20555 @findex -data-list-changed-registers
20556
20557 @subsubheading Synopsis
20558
20559 @smallexample
20560 -data-list-changed-registers
20561 @end smallexample
20562
20563 Display a list of the registers that have changed.
20564
20565 @subsubheading @value{GDBN} Command
20566
20567 @value{GDBN} doesn't have a direct analog for this command; @code{gdbtk}
20568 has the corresponding command @samp{gdb_changed_register_list}.
20569
20570 @subsubheading Example
20571
20572 On a PPC MBX board:
20573
20574 @smallexample
20575 (gdb)
20576 -exec-continue
20577 ^running
20578
20579 (gdb)
20580 *stopped,reason="breakpoint-hit",disp="keep",bkptno="1",frame=@{
20581 func="main",args=[],file="try.c",fullname="/home/foo/bar/try.c",
20582 line="5"@}
20583 (gdb)
20584 -data-list-changed-registers
20585 ^done,changed-registers=["0","1","2","4","5","6","7","8","9",
20586 "10","11","13","14","15","16","17","18","19","20","21","22","23",
20587 "24","25","26","27","28","30","31","64","65","66","67","69"]
20588 (gdb)
20589 @end smallexample
20590
20591
20592 @subheading The @code{-data-list-register-names} Command
20593 @findex -data-list-register-names
20594
20595 @subsubheading Synopsis
20596
20597 @smallexample
20598 -data-list-register-names [ ( @var{regno} )+ ]
20599 @end smallexample
20600
20601 Show a list of register names for the current target. If no arguments
20602 are given, it shows a list of the names of all the registers. If
20603 integer numbers are given as arguments, it will print a list of the
20604 names of the registers corresponding to the arguments. To ensure
20605 consistency between a register name and its number, the output list may
20606 include empty register names.
20607
20608 @subsubheading @value{GDBN} Command
20609
20610 @value{GDBN} does not have a command which corresponds to
20611 @samp{-data-list-register-names}. In @code{gdbtk} there is a
20612 corresponding command @samp{gdb_regnames}.
20613
20614 @subsubheading Example
20615
20616 For the PPC MBX board:
20617 @smallexample
20618 (gdb)
20619 -data-list-register-names
20620 ^done,register-names=["r0","r1","r2","r3","r4","r5","r6","r7",
20621 "r8","r9","r10","r11","r12","r13","r14","r15","r16","r17","r18",
20622 "r19","r20","r21","r22","r23","r24","r25","r26","r27","r28","r29",
20623 "r30","r31","f0","f1","f2","f3","f4","f5","f6","f7","f8","f9",
20624 "f10","f11","f12","f13","f14","f15","f16","f17","f18","f19","f20",
20625 "f21","f22","f23","f24","f25","f26","f27","f28","f29","f30","f31",
20626 "", "pc","ps","cr","lr","ctr","xer"]
20627 (gdb)
20628 -data-list-register-names 1 2 3
20629 ^done,register-names=["r1","r2","r3"]
20630 (gdb)
20631 @end smallexample
20632
20633 @subheading The @code{-data-list-register-values} Command
20634 @findex -data-list-register-values
20635
20636 @subsubheading Synopsis
20637
20638 @smallexample
20639 -data-list-register-values @var{fmt} [ ( @var{regno} )*]
20640 @end smallexample
20641
20642 Display the registers' contents. @var{fmt} is the format according to
20643 which the registers' contents are to be returned, followed by an optional
20644 list of numbers specifying the registers to display. A missing list of
20645 numbers indicates that the contents of all the registers must be returned.
20646
20647 Allowed formats for @var{fmt} are:
20648
20649 @table @code
20650 @item x
20651 Hexadecimal
20652 @item o
20653 Octal
20654 @item t
20655 Binary
20656 @item d
20657 Decimal
20658 @item r
20659 Raw
20660 @item N
20661 Natural
20662 @end table
20663
20664 @subsubheading @value{GDBN} Command
20665
20666 The corresponding @value{GDBN} commands are @samp{info reg}, @samp{info
20667 all-reg}, and (in @code{gdbtk}) @samp{gdb_fetch_registers}.
20668
20669 @subsubheading Example
20670
20671 For a PPC MBX board (note: line breaks are for readability only, they
20672 don't appear in the actual output):
20673
20674 @smallexample
20675 (gdb)
20676 -data-list-register-values r 64 65
20677 ^done,register-values=[@{number="64",value="0xfe00a300"@},
20678 @{number="65",value="0x00029002"@}]
20679 (gdb)
20680 -data-list-register-values x
20681 ^done,register-values=[@{number="0",value="0xfe0043c8"@},
20682 @{number="1",value="0x3fff88"@},@{number="2",value="0xfffffffe"@},
20683 @{number="3",value="0x0"@},@{number="4",value="0xa"@},
20684 @{number="5",value="0x3fff68"@},@{number="6",value="0x3fff58"@},
20685 @{number="7",value="0xfe011e98"@},@{number="8",value="0x2"@},
20686 @{number="9",value="0xfa202820"@},@{number="10",value="0xfa202808"@},
20687 @{number="11",value="0x1"@},@{number="12",value="0x0"@},
20688 @{number="13",value="0x4544"@},@{number="14",value="0xffdfffff"@},
20689 @{number="15",value="0xffffffff"@},@{number="16",value="0xfffffeff"@},
20690 @{number="17",value="0xefffffed"@},@{number="18",value="0xfffffffe"@},
20691 @{number="19",value="0xffffffff"@},@{number="20",value="0xffffffff"@},
20692 @{number="21",value="0xffffffff"@},@{number="22",value="0xfffffff7"@},
20693 @{number="23",value="0xffffffff"@},@{number="24",value="0xffffffff"@},
20694 @{number="25",value="0xffffffff"@},@{number="26",value="0xfffffffb"@},
20695 @{number="27",value="0xffffffff"@},@{number="28",value="0xf7bfffff"@},
20696 @{number="29",value="0x0"@},@{number="30",value="0xfe010000"@},
20697 @{number="31",value="0x0"@},@{number="32",value="0x0"@},
20698 @{number="33",value="0x0"@},@{number="34",value="0x0"@},
20699 @{number="35",value="0x0"@},@{number="36",value="0x0"@},
20700 @{number="37",value="0x0"@},@{number="38",value="0x0"@},
20701 @{number="39",value="0x0"@},@{number="40",value="0x0"@},
20702 @{number="41",value="0x0"@},@{number="42",value="0x0"@},
20703 @{number="43",value="0x0"@},@{number="44",value="0x0"@},
20704 @{number="45",value="0x0"@},@{number="46",value="0x0"@},
20705 @{number="47",value="0x0"@},@{number="48",value="0x0"@},
20706 @{number="49",value="0x0"@},@{number="50",value="0x0"@},
20707 @{number="51",value="0x0"@},@{number="52",value="0x0"@},
20708 @{number="53",value="0x0"@},@{number="54",value="0x0"@},
20709 @{number="55",value="0x0"@},@{number="56",value="0x0"@},
20710 @{number="57",value="0x0"@},@{number="58",value="0x0"@},
20711 @{number="59",value="0x0"@},@{number="60",value="0x0"@},
20712 @{number="61",value="0x0"@},@{number="62",value="0x0"@},
20713 @{number="63",value="0x0"@},@{number="64",value="0xfe00a300"@},
20714 @{number="65",value="0x29002"@},@{number="66",value="0x202f04b5"@},
20715 @{number="67",value="0xfe0043b0"@},@{number="68",value="0xfe00b3e4"@},
20716 @{number="69",value="0x20002b03"@}]
20717 (gdb)
20718 @end smallexample
20719
20720
20721 @subheading The @code{-data-read-memory} Command
20722 @findex -data-read-memory
20723
20724 @subsubheading Synopsis
20725
20726 @smallexample
20727 -data-read-memory [ -o @var{byte-offset} ]
20728 @var{address} @var{word-format} @var{word-size}
20729 @var{nr-rows} @var{nr-cols} [ @var{aschar} ]
20730 @end smallexample
20731
20732 @noindent
20733 where:
20734
20735 @table @samp
20736 @item @var{address}
20737 An expression specifying the address of the first memory word to be
20738 read. Complex expressions containing embedded white space should be
20739 quoted using the C convention.
20740
20741 @item @var{word-format}
20742 The format to be used to print the memory words. The notation is the
20743 same as for @value{GDBN}'s @code{print} command (@pxref{Output Formats,
20744 ,Output Formats}).
20745
20746 @item @var{word-size}
20747 The size of each memory word in bytes.
20748
20749 @item @var{nr-rows}
20750 The number of rows in the output table.
20751
20752 @item @var{nr-cols}
20753 The number of columns in the output table.
20754
20755 @item @var{aschar}
20756 If present, indicates that each row should include an @sc{ascii} dump. The
20757 value of @var{aschar} is used as a padding character when a byte is not a
20758 member of the printable @sc{ascii} character set (printable @sc{ascii}
20759 characters are those whose code is between 32 and 126, inclusively).
20760
20761 @item @var{byte-offset}
20762 An offset to add to the @var{address} before fetching memory.
20763 @end table
20764
20765 This command displays memory contents as a table of @var{nr-rows} by
20766 @var{nr-cols} words, each word being @var{word-size} bytes. In total,
20767 @code{@var{nr-rows} * @var{nr-cols} * @var{word-size}} bytes are read
20768 (returned as @samp{total-bytes}). Should less than the requested number
20769 of bytes be returned by the target, the missing words are identified
20770 using @samp{N/A}. The number of bytes read from the target is returned
20771 in @samp{nr-bytes} and the starting address used to read memory in
20772 @samp{addr}.
20773
20774 The address of the next/previous row or page is available in
20775 @samp{next-row} and @samp{prev-row}, @samp{next-page} and
20776 @samp{prev-page}.
20777
20778 @subsubheading @value{GDBN} Command
20779
20780 The corresponding @value{GDBN} command is @samp{x}. @code{gdbtk} has
20781 @samp{gdb_get_mem} memory read command.
20782
20783 @subsubheading Example
20784
20785 Read six bytes of memory starting at @code{bytes+6} but then offset by
20786 @code{-6} bytes. Format as three rows of two columns. One byte per
20787 word. Display each word in hex.
20788
20789 @smallexample
20790 (gdb)
20791 9-data-read-memory -o -6 -- bytes+6 x 1 3 2
20792 9^done,addr="0x00001390",nr-bytes="6",total-bytes="6",
20793 next-row="0x00001396",prev-row="0x0000138e",next-page="0x00001396",
20794 prev-page="0x0000138a",memory=[
20795 @{addr="0x00001390",data=["0x00","0x01"]@},
20796 @{addr="0x00001392",data=["0x02","0x03"]@},
20797 @{addr="0x00001394",data=["0x04","0x05"]@}]
20798 (gdb)
20799 @end smallexample
20800
20801 Read two bytes of memory starting at address @code{shorts + 64} and
20802 display as a single word formatted in decimal.
20803
20804 @smallexample
20805 (gdb)
20806 5-data-read-memory shorts+64 d 2 1 1
20807 5^done,addr="0x00001510",nr-bytes="2",total-bytes="2",
20808 next-row="0x00001512",prev-row="0x0000150e",
20809 next-page="0x00001512",prev-page="0x0000150e",memory=[
20810 @{addr="0x00001510",data=["128"]@}]
20811 (gdb)
20812 @end smallexample
20813
20814 Read thirty two bytes of memory starting at @code{bytes+16} and format
20815 as eight rows of four columns. Include a string encoding with @samp{x}
20816 used as the non-printable character.
20817
20818 @smallexample
20819 (gdb)
20820 4-data-read-memory bytes+16 x 1 8 4 x
20821 4^done,addr="0x000013a0",nr-bytes="32",total-bytes="32",
20822 next-row="0x000013c0",prev-row="0x0000139c",
20823 next-page="0x000013c0",prev-page="0x00001380",memory=[
20824 @{addr="0x000013a0",data=["0x10","0x11","0x12","0x13"],ascii="xxxx"@},
20825 @{addr="0x000013a4",data=["0x14","0x15","0x16","0x17"],ascii="xxxx"@},
20826 @{addr="0x000013a8",data=["0x18","0x19","0x1a","0x1b"],ascii="xxxx"@},
20827 @{addr="0x000013ac",data=["0x1c","0x1d","0x1e","0x1f"],ascii="xxxx"@},
20828 @{addr="0x000013b0",data=["0x20","0x21","0x22","0x23"],ascii=" !\"#"@},
20829 @{addr="0x000013b4",data=["0x24","0x25","0x26","0x27"],ascii="$%&'"@},
20830 @{addr="0x000013b8",data=["0x28","0x29","0x2a","0x2b"],ascii="()*+"@},
20831 @{addr="0x000013bc",data=["0x2c","0x2d","0x2e","0x2f"],ascii=",-./"@}]
20832 (gdb)
20833 @end smallexample
20834
20835 @c %%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%% SECTION %%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%
20836 @node GDB/MI Tracepoint Commands
20837 @section @sc{gdb/mi} Tracepoint Commands
20838
20839 The tracepoint commands are not yet implemented.
20840
20841 @c @subheading -trace-actions
20842
20843 @c @subheading -trace-delete
20844
20845 @c @subheading -trace-disable
20846
20847 @c @subheading -trace-dump
20848
20849 @c @subheading -trace-enable
20850
20851 @c @subheading -trace-exists
20852
20853 @c @subheading -trace-find
20854
20855 @c @subheading -trace-frame-number
20856
20857 @c @subheading -trace-info
20858
20859 @c @subheading -trace-insert
20860
20861 @c @subheading -trace-list
20862
20863 @c @subheading -trace-pass-count
20864
20865 @c @subheading -trace-save
20866
20867 @c @subheading -trace-start
20868
20869 @c @subheading -trace-stop
20870
20871
20872 @c %%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%% SECTION %%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%
20873 @node GDB/MI Symbol Query
20874 @section @sc{gdb/mi} Symbol Query Commands
20875
20876
20877 @subheading The @code{-symbol-info-address} Command
20878 @findex -symbol-info-address
20879
20880 @subsubheading Synopsis
20881
20882 @smallexample
20883 -symbol-info-address @var{symbol}
20884 @end smallexample
20885
20886 Describe where @var{symbol} is stored.
20887
20888 @subsubheading @value{GDBN} Command
20889
20890 The corresponding @value{GDBN} command is @samp{info address}.
20891
20892 @subsubheading Example
20893 N.A.
20894
20895
20896 @subheading The @code{-symbol-info-file} Command
20897 @findex -symbol-info-file
20898
20899 @subsubheading Synopsis
20900
20901 @smallexample
20902 -symbol-info-file
20903 @end smallexample
20904
20905 Show the file for the symbol.
20906
20907 @subsubheading @value{GDBN} Command
20908
20909 There's no equivalent @value{GDBN} command. @code{gdbtk} has
20910 @samp{gdb_find_file}.
20911
20912 @subsubheading Example
20913 N.A.
20914
20915
20916 @subheading The @code{-symbol-info-function} Command
20917 @findex -symbol-info-function
20918
20919 @subsubheading Synopsis
20920
20921 @smallexample
20922 -symbol-info-function
20923 @end smallexample
20924
20925 Show which function the symbol lives in.
20926
20927 @subsubheading @value{GDBN} Command
20928
20929 @samp{gdb_get_function} in @code{gdbtk}.
20930
20931 @subsubheading Example
20932 N.A.
20933
20934
20935 @subheading The @code{-symbol-info-line} Command
20936 @findex -symbol-info-line
20937
20938 @subsubheading Synopsis
20939
20940 @smallexample
20941 -symbol-info-line
20942 @end smallexample
20943
20944 Show the core addresses of the code for a source line.
20945
20946 @subsubheading @value{GDBN} Command
20947
20948 The corresponding @value{GDBN} command is @samp{info line}.
20949 @code{gdbtk} has the @samp{gdb_get_line} and @samp{gdb_get_file} commands.
20950
20951 @subsubheading Example
20952 N.A.
20953
20954
20955 @subheading The @code{-symbol-info-symbol} Command
20956 @findex -symbol-info-symbol
20957
20958 @subsubheading Synopsis
20959
20960 @smallexample
20961 -symbol-info-symbol @var{addr}
20962 @end smallexample
20963
20964 Describe what symbol is at location @var{addr}.
20965
20966 @subsubheading @value{GDBN} Command
20967
20968 The corresponding @value{GDBN} command is @samp{info symbol}.
20969
20970 @subsubheading Example
20971 N.A.
20972
20973
20974 @subheading The @code{-symbol-list-functions} Command
20975 @findex -symbol-list-functions
20976
20977 @subsubheading Synopsis
20978
20979 @smallexample
20980 -symbol-list-functions
20981 @end smallexample
20982
20983 List the functions in the executable.
20984
20985 @subsubheading @value{GDBN} Command
20986
20987 @samp{info functions} in @value{GDBN}, @samp{gdb_listfunc} and
20988 @samp{gdb_search} in @code{gdbtk}.
20989
20990 @subsubheading Example
20991 N.A.
20992
20993
20994 @subheading The @code{-symbol-list-lines} Command
20995 @findex -symbol-list-lines
20996
20997 @subsubheading Synopsis
20998
20999 @smallexample
21000 -symbol-list-lines @var{filename}
21001 @end smallexample
21002
21003 Print the list of lines that contain code and their associated program
21004 addresses for the given source filename. The entries are sorted in
21005 ascending PC order.
21006
21007 @subsubheading @value{GDBN} Command
21008
21009 There is no corresponding @value{GDBN} command.
21010
21011 @subsubheading Example
21012 @smallexample
21013 (gdb)
21014 -symbol-list-lines basics.c
21015 ^done,lines=[@{pc="0x08048554",line="7"@},@{pc="0x0804855a",line="8"@}]
21016 (gdb)
21017 @end smallexample
21018
21019
21020 @subheading The @code{-symbol-list-types} Command
21021 @findex -symbol-list-types
21022
21023 @subsubheading Synopsis
21024
21025 @smallexample
21026 -symbol-list-types
21027 @end smallexample
21028
21029 List all the type names.
21030
21031 @subsubheading @value{GDBN} Command
21032
21033 The corresponding commands are @samp{info types} in @value{GDBN},
21034 @samp{gdb_search} in @code{gdbtk}.
21035
21036 @subsubheading Example
21037 N.A.
21038
21039
21040 @subheading The @code{-symbol-list-variables} Command
21041 @findex -symbol-list-variables
21042
21043 @subsubheading Synopsis
21044
21045 @smallexample
21046 -symbol-list-variables
21047 @end smallexample
21048
21049 List all the global and static variable names.
21050
21051 @subsubheading @value{GDBN} Command
21052
21053 @samp{info variables} in @value{GDBN}, @samp{gdb_search} in @code{gdbtk}.
21054
21055 @subsubheading Example
21056 N.A.
21057
21058
21059 @subheading The @code{-symbol-locate} Command
21060 @findex -symbol-locate
21061
21062 @subsubheading Synopsis
21063
21064 @smallexample
21065 -symbol-locate
21066 @end smallexample
21067
21068 @subsubheading @value{GDBN} Command
21069
21070 @samp{gdb_loc} in @code{gdbtk}.
21071
21072 @subsubheading Example
21073 N.A.
21074
21075
21076 @subheading The @code{-symbol-type} Command
21077 @findex -symbol-type
21078
21079 @subsubheading Synopsis
21080
21081 @smallexample
21082 -symbol-type @var{variable}
21083 @end smallexample
21084
21085 Show type of @var{variable}.
21086
21087 @subsubheading @value{GDBN} Command
21088
21089 The corresponding @value{GDBN} command is @samp{ptype}, @code{gdbtk} has
21090 @samp{gdb_obj_variable}.
21091
21092 @subsubheading Example
21093 N.A.
21094
21095
21096 @c %%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%% SECTION %%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%
21097 @node GDB/MI File Commands
21098 @section @sc{gdb/mi} File Commands
21099
21100 This section describes the GDB/MI commands to specify executable file names
21101 and to read in and obtain symbol table information.
21102
21103 @subheading The @code{-file-exec-and-symbols} Command
21104 @findex -file-exec-and-symbols
21105
21106 @subsubheading Synopsis
21107
21108 @smallexample
21109 -file-exec-and-symbols @var{file}
21110 @end smallexample
21111
21112 Specify the executable file to be debugged. This file is the one from
21113 which the symbol table is also read. If no file is specified, the
21114 command clears the executable and symbol information. If breakpoints
21115 are set when using this command with no arguments, @value{GDBN} will produce
21116 error messages. Otherwise, no output is produced, except a completion
21117 notification.
21118
21119 @subsubheading @value{GDBN} Command
21120
21121 The corresponding @value{GDBN} command is @samp{file}.
21122
21123 @subsubheading Example
21124
21125 @smallexample
21126 (gdb)
21127 -file-exec-and-symbols /kwikemart/marge/ezannoni/TRUNK/mbx/hello.mbx
21128 ^done
21129 (gdb)
21130 @end smallexample
21131
21132
21133 @subheading The @code{-file-exec-file} Command
21134 @findex -file-exec-file
21135
21136 @subsubheading Synopsis
21137
21138 @smallexample
21139 -file-exec-file @var{file}
21140 @end smallexample
21141
21142 Specify the executable file to be debugged. Unlike
21143 @samp{-file-exec-and-symbols}, the symbol table is @emph{not} read
21144 from this file. If used without argument, @value{GDBN} clears the information
21145 about the executable file. No output is produced, except a completion
21146 notification.
21147
21148 @subsubheading @value{GDBN} Command
21149
21150 The corresponding @value{GDBN} command is @samp{exec-file}.
21151
21152 @subsubheading Example
21153
21154 @smallexample
21155 (gdb)
21156 -file-exec-file /kwikemart/marge/ezannoni/TRUNK/mbx/hello.mbx
21157 ^done
21158 (gdb)
21159 @end smallexample
21160
21161
21162 @subheading The @code{-file-list-exec-sections} Command
21163 @findex -file-list-exec-sections
21164
21165 @subsubheading Synopsis
21166
21167 @smallexample
21168 -file-list-exec-sections
21169 @end smallexample
21170
21171 List the sections of the current executable file.
21172
21173 @subsubheading @value{GDBN} Command
21174
21175 The @value{GDBN} command @samp{info file} shows, among the rest, the same
21176 information as this command. @code{gdbtk} has a corresponding command
21177 @samp{gdb_load_info}.
21178
21179 @subsubheading Example
21180 N.A.
21181
21182
21183 @subheading The @code{-file-list-exec-source-file} Command
21184 @findex -file-list-exec-source-file
21185
21186 @subsubheading Synopsis
21187
21188 @smallexample
21189 -file-list-exec-source-file
21190 @end smallexample
21191
21192 List the line number, the current source file, and the absolute path
21193 to the current source file for the current executable. The macro
21194 information field has a value of @samp{1} or @samp{0} depending on
21195 whether or not the file includes preprocessor macro information.
21196
21197 @subsubheading @value{GDBN} Command
21198
21199 The @value{GDBN} equivalent is @samp{info source}
21200
21201 @subsubheading Example
21202
21203 @smallexample
21204 (gdb)
21205 123-file-list-exec-source-file
21206 123^done,line="1",file="foo.c",fullname="/home/bar/foo.c,macro-info="1"
21207 (gdb)
21208 @end smallexample
21209
21210
21211 @subheading The @code{-file-list-exec-source-files} Command
21212 @findex -file-list-exec-source-files
21213
21214 @subsubheading Synopsis
21215
21216 @smallexample
21217 -file-list-exec-source-files
21218 @end smallexample
21219
21220 List the source files for the current executable.
21221
21222 It will always output the filename, but only when @value{GDBN} can find
21223 the absolute file name of a source file, will it output the fullname.
21224
21225 @subsubheading @value{GDBN} Command
21226
21227 The @value{GDBN} equivalent is @samp{info sources}.
21228 @code{gdbtk} has an analogous command @samp{gdb_listfiles}.
21229
21230 @subsubheading Example
21231 @smallexample
21232 (gdb)
21233 -file-list-exec-source-files
21234 ^done,files=[
21235 @{file=foo.c,fullname=/home/foo.c@},
21236 @{file=/home/bar.c,fullname=/home/bar.c@},
21237 @{file=gdb_could_not_find_fullpath.c@}]
21238 (gdb)
21239 @end smallexample
21240
21241 @subheading The @code{-file-list-shared-libraries} Command
21242 @findex -file-list-shared-libraries
21243
21244 @subsubheading Synopsis
21245
21246 @smallexample
21247 -file-list-shared-libraries
21248 @end smallexample
21249
21250 List the shared libraries in the program.
21251
21252 @subsubheading @value{GDBN} Command
21253
21254 The corresponding @value{GDBN} command is @samp{info shared}.
21255
21256 @subsubheading Example
21257 N.A.
21258
21259
21260 @subheading The @code{-file-list-symbol-files} Command
21261 @findex -file-list-symbol-files
21262
21263 @subsubheading Synopsis
21264
21265 @smallexample
21266 -file-list-symbol-files
21267 @end smallexample
21268
21269 List symbol files.
21270
21271 @subsubheading @value{GDBN} Command
21272
21273 The corresponding @value{GDBN} command is @samp{info file} (part of it).
21274
21275 @subsubheading Example
21276 N.A.
21277
21278
21279 @subheading The @code{-file-symbol-file} Command
21280 @findex -file-symbol-file
21281
21282 @subsubheading Synopsis
21283
21284 @smallexample
21285 -file-symbol-file @var{file}
21286 @end smallexample
21287
21288 Read symbol table info from the specified @var{file} argument. When
21289 used without arguments, clears @value{GDBN}'s symbol table info. No output is
21290 produced, except for a completion notification.
21291
21292 @subsubheading @value{GDBN} Command
21293
21294 The corresponding @value{GDBN} command is @samp{symbol-file}.
21295
21296 @subsubheading Example
21297
21298 @smallexample
21299 (gdb)
21300 -file-symbol-file /kwikemart/marge/ezannoni/TRUNK/mbx/hello.mbx
21301 ^done
21302 (gdb)
21303 @end smallexample
21304
21305 @ignore
21306 @c %%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%% SECTION %%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%
21307 @node GDB/MI Memory Overlay Commands
21308 @section @sc{gdb/mi} Memory Overlay Commands
21309
21310 The memory overlay commands are not implemented.
21311
21312 @c @subheading -overlay-auto
21313
21314 @c @subheading -overlay-list-mapping-state
21315
21316 @c @subheading -overlay-list-overlays
21317
21318 @c @subheading -overlay-map
21319
21320 @c @subheading -overlay-off
21321
21322 @c @subheading -overlay-on
21323
21324 @c @subheading -overlay-unmap
21325
21326 @c %%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%% SECTION %%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%
21327 @node GDB/MI Signal Handling Commands
21328 @section @sc{gdb/mi} Signal Handling Commands
21329
21330 Signal handling commands are not implemented.
21331
21332 @c @subheading -signal-handle
21333
21334 @c @subheading -signal-list-handle-actions
21335
21336 @c @subheading -signal-list-signal-types
21337 @end ignore
21338
21339
21340 @c %%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%% SECTION %%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%
21341 @node GDB/MI Target Manipulation
21342 @section @sc{gdb/mi} Target Manipulation Commands
21343
21344
21345 @subheading The @code{-target-attach} Command
21346 @findex -target-attach
21347
21348 @subsubheading Synopsis
21349
21350 @smallexample
21351 -target-attach @var{pid} | @var{file}
21352 @end smallexample
21353
21354 Attach to a process @var{pid} or a file @var{file} outside of @value{GDBN}.
21355
21356 @subsubheading @value{GDBN} Command
21357
21358 The corresponding @value{GDBN} command is @samp{attach}.
21359
21360 @subsubheading Example
21361 N.A.
21362
21363
21364 @subheading The @code{-target-compare-sections} Command
21365 @findex -target-compare-sections
21366
21367 @subsubheading Synopsis
21368
21369 @smallexample
21370 -target-compare-sections [ @var{section} ]
21371 @end smallexample
21372
21373 Compare data of section @var{section} on target to the exec file.
21374 Without the argument, all sections are compared.
21375
21376 @subsubheading @value{GDBN} Command
21377
21378 The @value{GDBN} equivalent is @samp{compare-sections}.
21379
21380 @subsubheading Example
21381 N.A.
21382
21383
21384 @subheading The @code{-target-detach} Command
21385 @findex -target-detach
21386
21387 @subsubheading Synopsis
21388
21389 @smallexample
21390 -target-detach
21391 @end smallexample
21392
21393 Detach from the remote target which normally resumes its execution.
21394 There's no output.
21395
21396 @subsubheading @value{GDBN} Command
21397
21398 The corresponding @value{GDBN} command is @samp{detach}.
21399
21400 @subsubheading Example
21401
21402 @smallexample
21403 (gdb)
21404 -target-detach
21405 ^done
21406 (gdb)
21407 @end smallexample
21408
21409
21410 @subheading The @code{-target-disconnect} Command
21411 @findex -target-disconnect
21412
21413 @subsubheading Synopsis
21414
21415 @smallexample
21416 -target-disconnect
21417 @end smallexample
21418
21419 Disconnect from the remote target. There's no output and the target is
21420 generally not resumed.
21421
21422 @subsubheading @value{GDBN} Command
21423
21424 The corresponding @value{GDBN} command is @samp{disconnect}.
21425
21426 @subsubheading Example
21427
21428 @smallexample
21429 (gdb)
21430 -target-disconnect
21431 ^done
21432 (gdb)
21433 @end smallexample
21434
21435
21436 @subheading The @code{-target-download} Command
21437 @findex -target-download
21438
21439 @subsubheading Synopsis
21440
21441 @smallexample
21442 -target-download
21443 @end smallexample
21444
21445 Loads the executable onto the remote target.
21446 It prints out an update message every half second, which includes the fields:
21447
21448 @table @samp
21449 @item section
21450 The name of the section.
21451 @item section-sent
21452 The size of what has been sent so far for that section.
21453 @item section-size
21454 The size of the section.
21455 @item total-sent
21456 The total size of what was sent so far (the current and the previous sections).
21457 @item total-size
21458 The size of the overall executable to download.
21459 @end table
21460
21461 @noindent
21462 Each message is sent as status record (@pxref{GDB/MI Output Syntax, ,
21463 @sc{gdb/mi} Output Syntax}).
21464
21465 In addition, it prints the name and size of the sections, as they are
21466 downloaded. These messages include the following fields:
21467
21468 @table @samp
21469 @item section
21470 The name of the section.
21471 @item section-size
21472 The size of the section.
21473 @item total-size
21474 The size of the overall executable to download.
21475 @end table
21476
21477 @noindent
21478 At the end, a summary is printed.
21479
21480 @subsubheading @value{GDBN} Command
21481
21482 The corresponding @value{GDBN} command is @samp{load}.
21483
21484 @subsubheading Example
21485
21486 Note: each status message appears on a single line. Here the messages
21487 have been broken down so that they can fit onto a page.
21488
21489 @smallexample
21490 (gdb)
21491 -target-download
21492 +download,@{section=".text",section-size="6668",total-size="9880"@}
21493 +download,@{section=".text",section-sent="512",section-size="6668",
21494 total-sent="512",total-size="9880"@}
21495 +download,@{section=".text",section-sent="1024",section-size="6668",
21496 total-sent="1024",total-size="9880"@}
21497 +download,@{section=".text",section-sent="1536",section-size="6668",
21498 total-sent="1536",total-size="9880"@}
21499 +download,@{section=".text",section-sent="2048",section-size="6668",
21500 total-sent="2048",total-size="9880"@}
21501 +download,@{section=".text",section-sent="2560",section-size="6668",
21502 total-sent="2560",total-size="9880"@}
21503 +download,@{section=".text",section-sent="3072",section-size="6668",
21504 total-sent="3072",total-size="9880"@}
21505 +download,@{section=".text",section-sent="3584",section-size="6668",
21506 total-sent="3584",total-size="9880"@}
21507 +download,@{section=".text",section-sent="4096",section-size="6668",
21508 total-sent="4096",total-size="9880"@}
21509 +download,@{section=".text",section-sent="4608",section-size="6668",
21510 total-sent="4608",total-size="9880"@}
21511 +download,@{section=".text",section-sent="5120",section-size="6668",
21512 total-sent="5120",total-size="9880"@}
21513 +download,@{section=".text",section-sent="5632",section-size="6668",
21514 total-sent="5632",total-size="9880"@}
21515 +download,@{section=".text",section-sent="6144",section-size="6668",
21516 total-sent="6144",total-size="9880"@}
21517 +download,@{section=".text",section-sent="6656",section-size="6668",
21518 total-sent="6656",total-size="9880"@}
21519 +download,@{section=".init",section-size="28",total-size="9880"@}
21520 +download,@{section=".fini",section-size="28",total-size="9880"@}
21521 +download,@{section=".data",section-size="3156",total-size="9880"@}
21522 +download,@{section=".data",section-sent="512",section-size="3156",
21523 total-sent="7236",total-size="9880"@}
21524 +download,@{section=".data",section-sent="1024",section-size="3156",
21525 total-sent="7748",total-size="9880"@}
21526 +download,@{section=".data",section-sent="1536",section-size="3156",
21527 total-sent="8260",total-size="9880"@}
21528 +download,@{section=".data",section-sent="2048",section-size="3156",
21529 total-sent="8772",total-size="9880"@}
21530 +download,@{section=".data",section-sent="2560",section-size="3156",
21531 total-sent="9284",total-size="9880"@}
21532 +download,@{section=".data",section-sent="3072",section-size="3156",
21533 total-sent="9796",total-size="9880"@}
21534 ^done,address="0x10004",load-size="9880",transfer-rate="6586",
21535 write-rate="429"
21536 (gdb)
21537 @end smallexample
21538
21539
21540 @subheading The @code{-target-exec-status} Command
21541 @findex -target-exec-status
21542
21543 @subsubheading Synopsis
21544
21545 @smallexample
21546 -target-exec-status
21547 @end smallexample
21548
21549 Provide information on the state of the target (whether it is running or
21550 not, for instance).
21551
21552 @subsubheading @value{GDBN} Command
21553
21554 There's no equivalent @value{GDBN} command.
21555
21556 @subsubheading Example
21557 N.A.
21558
21559
21560 @subheading The @code{-target-list-available-targets} Command
21561 @findex -target-list-available-targets
21562
21563 @subsubheading Synopsis
21564
21565 @smallexample
21566 -target-list-available-targets
21567 @end smallexample
21568
21569 List the possible targets to connect to.
21570
21571 @subsubheading @value{GDBN} Command
21572
21573 The corresponding @value{GDBN} command is @samp{help target}.
21574
21575 @subsubheading Example
21576 N.A.
21577
21578
21579 @subheading The @code{-target-list-current-targets} Command
21580 @findex -target-list-current-targets
21581
21582 @subsubheading Synopsis
21583
21584 @smallexample
21585 -target-list-current-targets
21586 @end smallexample
21587
21588 Describe the current target.
21589
21590 @subsubheading @value{GDBN} Command
21591
21592 The corresponding information is printed by @samp{info file} (among
21593 other things).
21594
21595 @subsubheading Example
21596 N.A.
21597
21598
21599 @subheading The @code{-target-list-parameters} Command
21600 @findex -target-list-parameters
21601
21602 @subsubheading Synopsis
21603
21604 @smallexample
21605 -target-list-parameters
21606 @end smallexample
21607
21608 @c ????
21609
21610 @subsubheading @value{GDBN} Command
21611
21612 No equivalent.
21613
21614 @subsubheading Example
21615 N.A.
21616
21617
21618 @subheading The @code{-target-select} Command
21619 @findex -target-select
21620
21621 @subsubheading Synopsis
21622
21623 @smallexample
21624 -target-select @var{type} @var{parameters @dots{}}
21625 @end smallexample
21626
21627 Connect @value{GDBN} to the remote target. This command takes two args:
21628
21629 @table @samp
21630 @item @var{type}
21631 The type of target, for instance @samp{async}, @samp{remote}, etc.
21632 @item @var{parameters}
21633 Device names, host names and the like. @xref{Target Commands, ,
21634 Commands for Managing Targets}, for more details.
21635 @end table
21636
21637 The output is a connection notification, followed by the address at
21638 which the target program is, in the following form:
21639
21640 @smallexample
21641 ^connected,addr="@var{address}",func="@var{function name}",
21642 args=[@var{arg list}]
21643 @end smallexample
21644
21645 @subsubheading @value{GDBN} Command
21646
21647 The corresponding @value{GDBN} command is @samp{target}.
21648
21649 @subsubheading Example
21650
21651 @smallexample
21652 (gdb)
21653 -target-select async /dev/ttya
21654 ^connected,addr="0xfe00a300",func="??",args=[]
21655 (gdb)
21656 @end smallexample
21657
21658 @c %%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%% SECTION %%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%
21659 @node GDB/MI File Transfer Commands
21660 @section @sc{gdb/mi} File Transfer Commands
21661
21662
21663 @subheading The @code{-target-file-put} Command
21664 @findex -target-file-put
21665
21666 @subsubheading Synopsis
21667
21668 @smallexample
21669 -target-file-put @var{hostfile} @var{targetfile}
21670 @end smallexample
21671
21672 Copy file @var{hostfile} from the host system (the machine running
21673 @value{GDBN}) to @var{targetfile} on the target system.
21674
21675 @subsubheading @value{GDBN} Command
21676
21677 The corresponding @value{GDBN} command is @samp{remote put}.
21678
21679 @subsubheading Example
21680
21681 @smallexample
21682 (gdb)
21683 -target-file-put localfile remotefile
21684 ^done
21685 (gdb)
21686 @end smallexample
21687
21688
21689 @subheading The @code{-target-file-put} Command
21690 @findex -target-file-get
21691
21692 @subsubheading Synopsis
21693
21694 @smallexample
21695 -target-file-get @var{targetfile} @var{hostfile}
21696 @end smallexample
21697
21698 Copy file @var{targetfile} from the target system to @var{hostfile}
21699 on the host system.
21700
21701 @subsubheading @value{GDBN} Command
21702
21703 The corresponding @value{GDBN} command is @samp{remote get}.
21704
21705 @subsubheading Example
21706
21707 @smallexample
21708 (gdb)
21709 -target-file-get remotefile localfile
21710 ^done
21711 (gdb)
21712 @end smallexample
21713
21714
21715 @subheading The @code{-target-file-delete} Command
21716 @findex -target-file-delete
21717
21718 @subsubheading Synopsis
21719
21720 @smallexample
21721 -target-file-delete @var{targetfile}
21722 @end smallexample
21723
21724 Delete @var{targetfile} from the target system.
21725
21726 @subsubheading @value{GDBN} Command
21727
21728 The corresponding @value{GDBN} command is @samp{remote delete}.
21729
21730 @subsubheading Example
21731
21732 @smallexample
21733 (gdb)
21734 -target-file-delete remotefile
21735 ^done
21736 (gdb)
21737 @end smallexample
21738
21739
21740 @c %%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%% SECTION %%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%
21741 @node GDB/MI Miscellaneous Commands
21742 @section Miscellaneous @sc{gdb/mi} Commands
21743
21744 @c @subheading -gdb-complete
21745
21746 @subheading The @code{-gdb-exit} Command
21747 @findex -gdb-exit
21748
21749 @subsubheading Synopsis
21750
21751 @smallexample
21752 -gdb-exit
21753 @end smallexample
21754
21755 Exit @value{GDBN} immediately.
21756
21757 @subsubheading @value{GDBN} Command
21758
21759 Approximately corresponds to @samp{quit}.
21760
21761 @subsubheading Example
21762
21763 @smallexample
21764 (gdb)
21765 -gdb-exit
21766 ^exit
21767 @end smallexample
21768
21769
21770 @subheading The @code{-exec-abort} Command
21771 @findex -exec-abort
21772
21773 @subsubheading Synopsis
21774
21775 @smallexample
21776 -exec-abort
21777 @end smallexample
21778
21779 Kill the inferior running program.
21780
21781 @subsubheading @value{GDBN} Command
21782
21783 The corresponding @value{GDBN} command is @samp{kill}.
21784
21785 @subsubheading Example
21786 N.A.
21787
21788
21789 @subheading The @code{-gdb-set} Command
21790 @findex -gdb-set
21791
21792 @subsubheading Synopsis
21793
21794 @smallexample
21795 -gdb-set
21796 @end smallexample
21797
21798 Set an internal @value{GDBN} variable.
21799 @c IS THIS A DOLLAR VARIABLE? OR SOMETHING LIKE ANNOTATE ?????
21800
21801 @subsubheading @value{GDBN} Command
21802
21803 The corresponding @value{GDBN} command is @samp{set}.
21804
21805 @subsubheading Example
21806
21807 @smallexample
21808 (gdb)
21809 -gdb-set $foo=3
21810 ^done
21811 (gdb)
21812 @end smallexample
21813
21814
21815 @subheading The @code{-gdb-show} Command
21816 @findex -gdb-show
21817
21818 @subsubheading Synopsis
21819
21820 @smallexample
21821 -gdb-show
21822 @end smallexample
21823
21824 Show the current value of a @value{GDBN} variable.
21825
21826 @subsubheading @value{GDBN} Command
21827
21828 The corresponding @value{GDBN} command is @samp{show}.
21829
21830 @subsubheading Example
21831
21832 @smallexample
21833 (gdb)
21834 -gdb-show annotate
21835 ^done,value="0"
21836 (gdb)
21837 @end smallexample
21838
21839 @c @subheading -gdb-source
21840
21841
21842 @subheading The @code{-gdb-version} Command
21843 @findex -gdb-version
21844
21845 @subsubheading Synopsis
21846
21847 @smallexample
21848 -gdb-version
21849 @end smallexample
21850
21851 Show version information for @value{GDBN}. Used mostly in testing.
21852
21853 @subsubheading @value{GDBN} Command
21854
21855 The @value{GDBN} equivalent is @samp{show version}. @value{GDBN} by
21856 default shows this information when you start an interactive session.
21857
21858 @subsubheading Example
21859
21860 @c This example modifies the actual output from GDB to avoid overfull
21861 @c box in TeX.
21862 @smallexample
21863 (gdb)
21864 -gdb-version
21865 ~GNU gdb 5.2.1
21866 ~Copyright 2000 Free Software Foundation, Inc.
21867 ~GDB is free software, covered by the GNU General Public License, and
21868 ~you are welcome to change it and/or distribute copies of it under
21869 ~ certain conditions.
21870 ~Type "show copying" to see the conditions.
21871 ~There is absolutely no warranty for GDB. Type "show warranty" for
21872 ~ details.
21873 ~This GDB was configured as
21874 "--host=sparc-sun-solaris2.5.1 --target=ppc-eabi".
21875 ^done
21876 (gdb)
21877 @end smallexample
21878
21879 @subheading The @code{-list-features} Command
21880 @findex -list-features
21881
21882 Returns a list of particular features of the MI protocol that
21883 this version of gdb implements. A feature can be a command,
21884 or a new field in an output of some command, or even an
21885 important bugfix. While a frontend can sometimes detect presence
21886 of a feature at runtime, it is easier to perform detection at debugger
21887 startup.
21888
21889 The command returns a list of strings, with each string naming an
21890 available feature. Each returned string is just a name, it does not
21891 have any internal structure. The list of possible feature names
21892 is given below.
21893
21894 Example output:
21895
21896 @smallexample
21897 (gdb) -list-features
21898 ^done,result=["feature1","feature2"]
21899 @end smallexample
21900
21901 The current list of features is:
21902
21903 @itemize @minus
21904 @item
21905 @samp{frozen-varobjs}---indicates presence of the
21906 @code{-var-set-frozen} command, as well as possible presense of the
21907 @code{frozen} field in the output of @code{-varobj-create}.
21908 @item
21909 @samp{pending-breakpoints}---indicates presence of the @code{-f}
21910 option to the @code{-break-insert} command.
21911 @item
21912 @samp{thread-info}---indicates presence of the @code{-thread-info} command.
21913
21914 @end itemize
21915
21916 @subheading The @code{-interpreter-exec} Command
21917 @findex -interpreter-exec
21918
21919 @subheading Synopsis
21920
21921 @smallexample
21922 -interpreter-exec @var{interpreter} @var{command}
21923 @end smallexample
21924 @anchor{-interpreter-exec}
21925
21926 Execute the specified @var{command} in the given @var{interpreter}.
21927
21928 @subheading @value{GDBN} Command
21929
21930 The corresponding @value{GDBN} command is @samp{interpreter-exec}.
21931
21932 @subheading Example
21933
21934 @smallexample
21935 (gdb)
21936 -interpreter-exec console "break main"
21937 &"During symbol reading, couldn't parse type; debugger out of date?.\n"
21938 &"During symbol reading, bad structure-type format.\n"
21939 ~"Breakpoint 1 at 0x8074fc6: file ../../src/gdb/main.c, line 743.\n"
21940 ^done
21941 (gdb)
21942 @end smallexample
21943
21944 @subheading The @code{-inferior-tty-set} Command
21945 @findex -inferior-tty-set
21946
21947 @subheading Synopsis
21948
21949 @smallexample
21950 -inferior-tty-set /dev/pts/1
21951 @end smallexample
21952
21953 Set terminal for future runs of the program being debugged.
21954
21955 @subheading @value{GDBN} Command
21956
21957 The corresponding @value{GDBN} command is @samp{set inferior-tty} /dev/pts/1.
21958
21959 @subheading Example
21960
21961 @smallexample
21962 (gdb)
21963 -inferior-tty-set /dev/pts/1
21964 ^done
21965 (gdb)
21966 @end smallexample
21967
21968 @subheading The @code{-inferior-tty-show} Command
21969 @findex -inferior-tty-show
21970
21971 @subheading Synopsis
21972
21973 @smallexample
21974 -inferior-tty-show
21975 @end smallexample
21976
21977 Show terminal for future runs of program being debugged.
21978
21979 @subheading @value{GDBN} Command
21980
21981 The corresponding @value{GDBN} command is @samp{show inferior-tty}.
21982
21983 @subheading Example
21984
21985 @smallexample
21986 (gdb)
21987 -inferior-tty-set /dev/pts/1
21988 ^done
21989 (gdb)
21990 -inferior-tty-show
21991 ^done,inferior_tty_terminal="/dev/pts/1"
21992 (gdb)
21993 @end smallexample
21994
21995 @subheading The @code{-enable-timings} Command
21996 @findex -enable-timings
21997
21998 @subheading Synopsis
21999
22000 @smallexample
22001 -enable-timings [yes | no]
22002 @end smallexample
22003
22004 Toggle the printing of the wallclock, user and system times for an MI
22005 command as a field in its output. This command is to help frontend
22006 developers optimize the performance of their code. No argument is
22007 equivalent to @samp{yes}.
22008
22009 @subheading @value{GDBN} Command
22010
22011 No equivalent.
22012
22013 @subheading Example
22014
22015 @smallexample
22016 (gdb)
22017 -enable-timings
22018 ^done
22019 (gdb)
22020 -break-insert main
22021 ^done,bkpt=@{number="1",type="breakpoint",disp="keep",enabled="y",
22022 addr="0x080484ed",func="main",file="myprog.c",
22023 fullname="/home/nickrob/myprog.c",line="73",times="0"@},
22024 time=@{wallclock="0.05185",user="0.00800",system="0.00000"@}
22025 (gdb)
22026 -enable-timings no
22027 ^done
22028 (gdb)
22029 -exec-run
22030 ^running
22031 (gdb)
22032 *stopped,reason="breakpoint-hit",disp="keep",bkptno="1",thread-id="0",
22033 frame=@{addr="0x080484ed",func="main",args=[@{name="argc",value="1"@},
22034 @{name="argv",value="0xbfb60364"@}],file="myprog.c",
22035 fullname="/home/nickrob/myprog.c",line="73"@}
22036 (gdb)
22037 @end smallexample
22038
22039 @node Annotations
22040 @chapter @value{GDBN} Annotations
22041
22042 This chapter describes annotations in @value{GDBN}. Annotations were
22043 designed to interface @value{GDBN} to graphical user interfaces or other
22044 similar programs which want to interact with @value{GDBN} at a
22045 relatively high level.
22046
22047 The annotation mechanism has largely been superseded by @sc{gdb/mi}
22048 (@pxref{GDB/MI}).
22049
22050 @ignore
22051 This is Edition @value{EDITION}, @value{DATE}.
22052 @end ignore
22053
22054 @menu
22055 * Annotations Overview:: What annotations are; the general syntax.
22056 * Server Prefix:: Issuing a command without affecting user state.
22057 * Prompting:: Annotations marking @value{GDBN}'s need for input.
22058 * Errors:: Annotations for error messages.
22059 * Invalidation:: Some annotations describe things now invalid.
22060 * Annotations for Running::
22061 Whether the program is running, how it stopped, etc.
22062 * Source Annotations:: Annotations describing source code.
22063 @end menu
22064
22065 @node Annotations Overview
22066 @section What is an Annotation?
22067 @cindex annotations
22068
22069 Annotations start with a newline character, two @samp{control-z}
22070 characters, and the name of the annotation. If there is no additional
22071 information associated with this annotation, the name of the annotation
22072 is followed immediately by a newline. If there is additional
22073 information, the name of the annotation is followed by a space, the
22074 additional information, and a newline. The additional information
22075 cannot contain newline characters.
22076
22077 Any output not beginning with a newline and two @samp{control-z}
22078 characters denotes literal output from @value{GDBN}. Currently there is
22079 no need for @value{GDBN} to output a newline followed by two
22080 @samp{control-z} characters, but if there was such a need, the
22081 annotations could be extended with an @samp{escape} annotation which
22082 means those three characters as output.
22083
22084 The annotation @var{level}, which is specified using the
22085 @option{--annotate} command line option (@pxref{Mode Options}), controls
22086 how much information @value{GDBN} prints together with its prompt,
22087 values of expressions, source lines, and other types of output. Level 0
22088 is for no annotations, level 1 is for use when @value{GDBN} is run as a
22089 subprocess of @sc{gnu} Emacs, level 3 is the maximum annotation suitable
22090 for programs that control @value{GDBN}, and level 2 annotations have
22091 been made obsolete (@pxref{Limitations, , Limitations of the Annotation
22092 Interface, annotate, GDB's Obsolete Annotations}).
22093
22094 @table @code
22095 @kindex set annotate
22096 @item set annotate @var{level}
22097 The @value{GDBN} command @code{set annotate} sets the level of
22098 annotations to the specified @var{level}.
22099
22100 @item show annotate
22101 @kindex show annotate
22102 Show the current annotation level.
22103 @end table
22104
22105 This chapter describes level 3 annotations.
22106
22107 A simple example of starting up @value{GDBN} with annotations is:
22108
22109 @smallexample
22110 $ @kbd{gdb --annotate=3}
22111 GNU gdb 6.0
22112 Copyright 2003 Free Software Foundation, Inc.
22113 GDB is free software, covered by the GNU General Public License,
22114 and you are welcome to change it and/or distribute copies of it
22115 under certain conditions.
22116 Type "show copying" to see the conditions.
22117 There is absolutely no warranty for GDB. Type "show warranty"
22118 for details.
22119 This GDB was configured as "i386-pc-linux-gnu"
22120
22121 ^Z^Zpre-prompt
22122 (@value{GDBP})
22123 ^Z^Zprompt
22124 @kbd{quit}
22125
22126 ^Z^Zpost-prompt
22127 $
22128 @end smallexample
22129
22130 Here @samp{quit} is input to @value{GDBN}; the rest is output from
22131 @value{GDBN}. The three lines beginning @samp{^Z^Z} (where @samp{^Z}
22132 denotes a @samp{control-z} character) are annotations; the rest is
22133 output from @value{GDBN}.
22134
22135 @node Server Prefix
22136 @section The Server Prefix
22137 @cindex server prefix
22138
22139 If you prefix a command with @samp{server } then it will not affect
22140 the command history, nor will it affect @value{GDBN}'s notion of which
22141 command to repeat if @key{RET} is pressed on a line by itself. This
22142 means that commands can be run behind a user's back by a front-end in
22143 a transparent manner.
22144
22145 The server prefix does not affect the recording of values into the value
22146 history; to print a value without recording it into the value history,
22147 use the @code{output} command instead of the @code{print} command.
22148
22149 @node Prompting
22150 @section Annotation for @value{GDBN} Input
22151
22152 @cindex annotations for prompts
22153 When @value{GDBN} prompts for input, it annotates this fact so it is possible
22154 to know when to send output, when the output from a given command is
22155 over, etc.
22156
22157 Different kinds of input each have a different @dfn{input type}. Each
22158 input type has three annotations: a @code{pre-} annotation, which
22159 denotes the beginning of any prompt which is being output, a plain
22160 annotation, which denotes the end of the prompt, and then a @code{post-}
22161 annotation which denotes the end of any echo which may (or may not) be
22162 associated with the input. For example, the @code{prompt} input type
22163 features the following annotations:
22164
22165 @smallexample
22166 ^Z^Zpre-prompt
22167 ^Z^Zprompt
22168 ^Z^Zpost-prompt
22169 @end smallexample
22170
22171 The input types are
22172
22173 @table @code
22174 @findex pre-prompt annotation
22175 @findex prompt annotation
22176 @findex post-prompt annotation
22177 @item prompt
22178 When @value{GDBN} is prompting for a command (the main @value{GDBN} prompt).
22179
22180 @findex pre-commands annotation
22181 @findex commands annotation
22182 @findex post-commands annotation
22183 @item commands
22184 When @value{GDBN} prompts for a set of commands, like in the @code{commands}
22185 command. The annotations are repeated for each command which is input.
22186
22187 @findex pre-overload-choice annotation
22188 @findex overload-choice annotation
22189 @findex post-overload-choice annotation
22190 @item overload-choice
22191 When @value{GDBN} wants the user to select between various overloaded functions.
22192
22193 @findex pre-query annotation
22194 @findex query annotation
22195 @findex post-query annotation
22196 @item query
22197 When @value{GDBN} wants the user to confirm a potentially dangerous operation.
22198
22199 @findex pre-prompt-for-continue annotation
22200 @findex prompt-for-continue annotation
22201 @findex post-prompt-for-continue annotation
22202 @item prompt-for-continue
22203 When @value{GDBN} is asking the user to press return to continue. Note: Don't
22204 expect this to work well; instead use @code{set height 0} to disable
22205 prompting. This is because the counting of lines is buggy in the
22206 presence of annotations.
22207 @end table
22208
22209 @node Errors
22210 @section Errors
22211 @cindex annotations for errors, warnings and interrupts
22212
22213 @findex quit annotation
22214 @smallexample
22215 ^Z^Zquit
22216 @end smallexample
22217
22218 This annotation occurs right before @value{GDBN} responds to an interrupt.
22219
22220 @findex error annotation
22221 @smallexample
22222 ^Z^Zerror
22223 @end smallexample
22224
22225 This annotation occurs right before @value{GDBN} responds to an error.
22226
22227 Quit and error annotations indicate that any annotations which @value{GDBN} was
22228 in the middle of may end abruptly. For example, if a
22229 @code{value-history-begin} annotation is followed by a @code{error}, one
22230 cannot expect to receive the matching @code{value-history-end}. One
22231 cannot expect not to receive it either, however; an error annotation
22232 does not necessarily mean that @value{GDBN} is immediately returning all the way
22233 to the top level.
22234
22235 @findex error-begin annotation
22236 A quit or error annotation may be preceded by
22237
22238 @smallexample
22239 ^Z^Zerror-begin
22240 @end smallexample
22241
22242 Any output between that and the quit or error annotation is the error
22243 message.
22244
22245 Warning messages are not yet annotated.
22246 @c If we want to change that, need to fix warning(), type_error(),
22247 @c range_error(), and possibly other places.
22248
22249 @node Invalidation
22250 @section Invalidation Notices
22251
22252 @cindex annotations for invalidation messages
22253 The following annotations say that certain pieces of state may have
22254 changed.
22255
22256 @table @code
22257 @findex frames-invalid annotation
22258 @item ^Z^Zframes-invalid
22259
22260 The frames (for example, output from the @code{backtrace} command) may
22261 have changed.
22262
22263 @findex breakpoints-invalid annotation
22264 @item ^Z^Zbreakpoints-invalid
22265
22266 The breakpoints may have changed. For example, the user just added or
22267 deleted a breakpoint.
22268 @end table
22269
22270 @node Annotations for Running
22271 @section Running the Program
22272 @cindex annotations for running programs
22273
22274 @findex starting annotation
22275 @findex stopping annotation
22276 When the program starts executing due to a @value{GDBN} command such as
22277 @code{step} or @code{continue},
22278
22279 @smallexample
22280 ^Z^Zstarting
22281 @end smallexample
22282
22283 is output. When the program stops,
22284
22285 @smallexample
22286 ^Z^Zstopped
22287 @end smallexample
22288
22289 is output. Before the @code{stopped} annotation, a variety of
22290 annotations describe how the program stopped.
22291
22292 @table @code
22293 @findex exited annotation
22294 @item ^Z^Zexited @var{exit-status}
22295 The program exited, and @var{exit-status} is the exit status (zero for
22296 successful exit, otherwise nonzero).
22297
22298 @findex signalled annotation
22299 @findex signal-name annotation
22300 @findex signal-name-end annotation
22301 @findex signal-string annotation
22302 @findex signal-string-end annotation
22303 @item ^Z^Zsignalled
22304 The program exited with a signal. After the @code{^Z^Zsignalled}, the
22305 annotation continues:
22306
22307 @smallexample
22308 @var{intro-text}
22309 ^Z^Zsignal-name
22310 @var{name}
22311 ^Z^Zsignal-name-end
22312 @var{middle-text}
22313 ^Z^Zsignal-string
22314 @var{string}
22315 ^Z^Zsignal-string-end
22316 @var{end-text}
22317 @end smallexample
22318
22319 @noindent
22320 where @var{name} is the name of the signal, such as @code{SIGILL} or
22321 @code{SIGSEGV}, and @var{string} is the explanation of the signal, such
22322 as @code{Illegal Instruction} or @code{Segmentation fault}.
22323 @var{intro-text}, @var{middle-text}, and @var{end-text} are for the
22324 user's benefit and have no particular format.
22325
22326 @findex signal annotation
22327 @item ^Z^Zsignal
22328 The syntax of this annotation is just like @code{signalled}, but @value{GDBN} is
22329 just saying that the program received the signal, not that it was
22330 terminated with it.
22331
22332 @findex breakpoint annotation
22333 @item ^Z^Zbreakpoint @var{number}
22334 The program hit breakpoint number @var{number}.
22335
22336 @findex watchpoint annotation
22337 @item ^Z^Zwatchpoint @var{number}
22338 The program hit watchpoint number @var{number}.
22339 @end table
22340
22341 @node Source Annotations
22342 @section Displaying Source
22343 @cindex annotations for source display
22344
22345 @findex source annotation
22346 The following annotation is used instead of displaying source code:
22347
22348 @smallexample
22349 ^Z^Zsource @var{filename}:@var{line}:@var{character}:@var{middle}:@var{addr}
22350 @end smallexample
22351
22352 where @var{filename} is an absolute file name indicating which source
22353 file, @var{line} is the line number within that file (where 1 is the
22354 first line in the file), @var{character} is the character position
22355 within the file (where 0 is the first character in the file) (for most
22356 debug formats this will necessarily point to the beginning of a line),
22357 @var{middle} is @samp{middle} if @var{addr} is in the middle of the
22358 line, or @samp{beg} if @var{addr} is at the beginning of the line, and
22359 @var{addr} is the address in the target program associated with the
22360 source which is being displayed. @var{addr} is in the form @samp{0x}
22361 followed by one or more lowercase hex digits (note that this does not
22362 depend on the language).
22363
22364 @node GDB Bugs
22365 @chapter Reporting Bugs in @value{GDBN}
22366 @cindex bugs in @value{GDBN}
22367 @cindex reporting bugs in @value{GDBN}
22368
22369 Your bug reports play an essential role in making @value{GDBN} reliable.
22370
22371 Reporting a bug may help you by bringing a solution to your problem, or it
22372 may not. But in any case the principal function of a bug report is to help
22373 the entire community by making the next version of @value{GDBN} work better. Bug
22374 reports are your contribution to the maintenance of @value{GDBN}.
22375
22376 In order for a bug report to serve its purpose, you must include the
22377 information that enables us to fix the bug.
22378
22379 @menu
22380 * Bug Criteria:: Have you found a bug?
22381 * Bug Reporting:: How to report bugs
22382 @end menu
22383
22384 @node Bug Criteria
22385 @section Have You Found a Bug?
22386 @cindex bug criteria
22387
22388 If you are not sure whether you have found a bug, here are some guidelines:
22389
22390 @itemize @bullet
22391 @cindex fatal signal
22392 @cindex debugger crash
22393 @cindex crash of debugger
22394 @item
22395 If the debugger gets a fatal signal, for any input whatever, that is a
22396 @value{GDBN} bug. Reliable debuggers never crash.
22397
22398 @cindex error on valid input
22399 @item
22400 If @value{GDBN} produces an error message for valid input, that is a
22401 bug. (Note that if you're cross debugging, the problem may also be
22402 somewhere in the connection to the target.)
22403
22404 @cindex invalid input
22405 @item
22406 If @value{GDBN} does not produce an error message for invalid input,
22407 that is a bug. However, you should note that your idea of
22408 ``invalid input'' might be our idea of ``an extension'' or ``support
22409 for traditional practice''.
22410
22411 @item
22412 If you are an experienced user of debugging tools, your suggestions
22413 for improvement of @value{GDBN} are welcome in any case.
22414 @end itemize
22415
22416 @node Bug Reporting
22417 @section How to Report Bugs
22418 @cindex bug reports
22419 @cindex @value{GDBN} bugs, reporting
22420
22421 A number of companies and individuals offer support for @sc{gnu} products.
22422 If you obtained @value{GDBN} from a support organization, we recommend you
22423 contact that organization first.
22424
22425 You can find contact information for many support companies and
22426 individuals in the file @file{etc/SERVICE} in the @sc{gnu} Emacs
22427 distribution.
22428 @c should add a web page ref...
22429
22430 In any event, we also recommend that you submit bug reports for
22431 @value{GDBN}. The preferred method is to submit them directly using
22432 @uref{http://www.gnu.org/software/gdb/bugs/, @value{GDBN}'s Bugs web
22433 page}. Alternatively, the @email{bug-gdb@@gnu.org, e-mail gateway} can
22434 be used.
22435
22436 @strong{Do not send bug reports to @samp{info-gdb}, or to
22437 @samp{help-gdb}, or to any newsgroups.} Most users of @value{GDBN} do
22438 not want to receive bug reports. Those that do have arranged to receive
22439 @samp{bug-gdb}.
22440
22441 The mailing list @samp{bug-gdb} has a newsgroup @samp{gnu.gdb.bug} which
22442 serves as a repeater. The mailing list and the newsgroup carry exactly
22443 the same messages. Often people think of posting bug reports to the
22444 newsgroup instead of mailing them. This appears to work, but it has one
22445 problem which can be crucial: a newsgroup posting often lacks a mail
22446 path back to the sender. Thus, if we need to ask for more information,
22447 we may be unable to reach you. For this reason, it is better to send
22448 bug reports to the mailing list.
22449
22450 The fundamental principle of reporting bugs usefully is this:
22451 @strong{report all the facts}. If you are not sure whether to state a
22452 fact or leave it out, state it!
22453
22454 Often people omit facts because they think they know what causes the
22455 problem and assume that some details do not matter. Thus, you might
22456 assume that the name of the variable you use in an example does not matter.
22457 Well, probably it does not, but one cannot be sure. Perhaps the bug is a
22458 stray memory reference which happens to fetch from the location where that
22459 name is stored in memory; perhaps, if the name were different, the contents
22460 of that location would fool the debugger into doing the right thing despite
22461 the bug. Play it safe and give a specific, complete example. That is the
22462 easiest thing for you to do, and the most helpful.
22463
22464 Keep in mind that the purpose of a bug report is to enable us to fix the
22465 bug. It may be that the bug has been reported previously, but neither
22466 you nor we can know that unless your bug report is complete and
22467 self-contained.
22468
22469 Sometimes people give a few sketchy facts and ask, ``Does this ring a
22470 bell?'' Those bug reports are useless, and we urge everyone to
22471 @emph{refuse to respond to them} except to chide the sender to report
22472 bugs properly.
22473
22474 To enable us to fix the bug, you should include all these things:
22475
22476 @itemize @bullet
22477 @item
22478 The version of @value{GDBN}. @value{GDBN} announces it if you start
22479 with no arguments; you can also print it at any time using @code{show
22480 version}.
22481
22482 Without this, we will not know whether there is any point in looking for
22483 the bug in the current version of @value{GDBN}.
22484
22485 @item
22486 The type of machine you are using, and the operating system name and
22487 version number.
22488
22489 @item
22490 What compiler (and its version) was used to compile @value{GDBN}---e.g.@:
22491 ``@value{GCC}--2.8.1''.
22492
22493 @item
22494 What compiler (and its version) was used to compile the program you are
22495 debugging---e.g.@: ``@value{GCC}--2.8.1'', or ``HP92453-01 A.10.32.03 HP
22496 C Compiler''. For @value{NGCC}, you can say @kbd{@value{GCC} --version}
22497 to get this information; for other compilers, see the documentation for
22498 those compilers.
22499
22500 @item
22501 The command arguments you gave the compiler to compile your example and
22502 observe the bug. For example, did you use @samp{-O}? To guarantee
22503 you will not omit something important, list them all. A copy of the
22504 Makefile (or the output from make) is sufficient.
22505
22506 If we were to try to guess the arguments, we would probably guess wrong
22507 and then we might not encounter the bug.
22508
22509 @item
22510 A complete input script, and all necessary source files, that will
22511 reproduce the bug.
22512
22513 @item
22514 A description of what behavior you observe that you believe is
22515 incorrect. For example, ``It gets a fatal signal.''
22516
22517 Of course, if the bug is that @value{GDBN} gets a fatal signal, then we
22518 will certainly notice it. But if the bug is incorrect output, we might
22519 not notice unless it is glaringly wrong. You might as well not give us
22520 a chance to make a mistake.
22521
22522 Even if the problem you experience is a fatal signal, you should still
22523 say so explicitly. Suppose something strange is going on, such as, your
22524 copy of @value{GDBN} is out of synch, or you have encountered a bug in
22525 the C library on your system. (This has happened!) Your copy might
22526 crash and ours would not. If you told us to expect a crash, then when
22527 ours fails to crash, we would know that the bug was not happening for
22528 us. If you had not told us to expect a crash, then we would not be able
22529 to draw any conclusion from our observations.
22530
22531 @pindex script
22532 @cindex recording a session script
22533 To collect all this information, you can use a session recording program
22534 such as @command{script}, which is available on many Unix systems.
22535 Just run your @value{GDBN} session inside @command{script} and then
22536 include the @file{typescript} file with your bug report.
22537
22538 Another way to record a @value{GDBN} session is to run @value{GDBN}
22539 inside Emacs and then save the entire buffer to a file.
22540
22541 @item
22542 If you wish to suggest changes to the @value{GDBN} source, send us context
22543 diffs. If you even discuss something in the @value{GDBN} source, refer to
22544 it by context, not by line number.
22545
22546 The line numbers in our development sources will not match those in your
22547 sources. Your line numbers would convey no useful information to us.
22548
22549 @end itemize
22550
22551 Here are some things that are not necessary:
22552
22553 @itemize @bullet
22554 @item
22555 A description of the envelope of the bug.
22556
22557 Often people who encounter a bug spend a lot of time investigating
22558 which changes to the input file will make the bug go away and which
22559 changes will not affect it.
22560
22561 This is often time consuming and not very useful, because the way we
22562 will find the bug is by running a single example under the debugger
22563 with breakpoints, not by pure deduction from a series of examples.
22564 We recommend that you save your time for something else.
22565
22566 Of course, if you can find a simpler example to report @emph{instead}
22567 of the original one, that is a convenience for us. Errors in the
22568 output will be easier to spot, running under the debugger will take
22569 less time, and so on.
22570
22571 However, simplification is not vital; if you do not want to do this,
22572 report the bug anyway and send us the entire test case you used.
22573
22574 @item
22575 A patch for the bug.
22576
22577 A patch for the bug does help us if it is a good one. But do not omit
22578 the necessary information, such as the test case, on the assumption that
22579 a patch is all we need. We might see problems with your patch and decide
22580 to fix the problem another way, or we might not understand it at all.
22581
22582 Sometimes with a program as complicated as @value{GDBN} it is very hard to
22583 construct an example that will make the program follow a certain path
22584 through the code. If you do not send us the example, we will not be able
22585 to construct one, so we will not be able to verify that the bug is fixed.
22586
22587 And if we cannot understand what bug you are trying to fix, or why your
22588 patch should be an improvement, we will not install it. A test case will
22589 help us to understand.
22590
22591 @item
22592 A guess about what the bug is or what it depends on.
22593
22594 Such guesses are usually wrong. Even we cannot guess right about such
22595 things without first using the debugger to find the facts.
22596 @end itemize
22597
22598 @c The readline documentation is distributed with the readline code
22599 @c and consists of the two following files:
22600 @c rluser.texinfo
22601 @c inc-hist.texinfo
22602 @c Use -I with makeinfo to point to the appropriate directory,
22603 @c environment var TEXINPUTS with TeX.
22604 @include rluser.texi
22605 @include inc-hist.texinfo
22606
22607
22608 @node Formatting Documentation
22609 @appendix Formatting Documentation
22610
22611 @cindex @value{GDBN} reference card
22612 @cindex reference card
22613 The @value{GDBN} 4 release includes an already-formatted reference card, ready
22614 for printing with PostScript or Ghostscript, in the @file{gdb}
22615 subdirectory of the main source directory@footnote{In
22616 @file{gdb-@value{GDBVN}/gdb/refcard.ps} of the version @value{GDBVN}
22617 release.}. If you can use PostScript or Ghostscript with your printer,
22618 you can print the reference card immediately with @file{refcard.ps}.
22619
22620 The release also includes the source for the reference card. You
22621 can format it, using @TeX{}, by typing:
22622
22623 @smallexample
22624 make refcard.dvi
22625 @end smallexample
22626
22627 The @value{GDBN} reference card is designed to print in @dfn{landscape}
22628 mode on US ``letter'' size paper;
22629 that is, on a sheet 11 inches wide by 8.5 inches
22630 high. You will need to specify this form of printing as an option to
22631 your @sc{dvi} output program.
22632
22633 @cindex documentation
22634
22635 All the documentation for @value{GDBN} comes as part of the machine-readable
22636 distribution. The documentation is written in Texinfo format, which is
22637 a documentation system that uses a single source file to produce both
22638 on-line information and a printed manual. You can use one of the Info
22639 formatting commands to create the on-line version of the documentation
22640 and @TeX{} (or @code{texi2roff}) to typeset the printed version.
22641
22642 @value{GDBN} includes an already formatted copy of the on-line Info
22643 version of this manual in the @file{gdb} subdirectory. The main Info
22644 file is @file{gdb-@value{GDBVN}/gdb/gdb.info}, and it refers to
22645 subordinate files matching @samp{gdb.info*} in the same directory. If
22646 necessary, you can print out these files, or read them with any editor;
22647 but they are easier to read using the @code{info} subsystem in @sc{gnu}
22648 Emacs or the standalone @code{info} program, available as part of the
22649 @sc{gnu} Texinfo distribution.
22650
22651 If you want to format these Info files yourself, you need one of the
22652 Info formatting programs, such as @code{texinfo-format-buffer} or
22653 @code{makeinfo}.
22654
22655 If you have @code{makeinfo} installed, and are in the top level
22656 @value{GDBN} source directory (@file{gdb-@value{GDBVN}}, in the case of
22657 version @value{GDBVN}), you can make the Info file by typing:
22658
22659 @smallexample
22660 cd gdb
22661 make gdb.info
22662 @end smallexample
22663
22664 If you want to typeset and print copies of this manual, you need @TeX{},
22665 a program to print its @sc{dvi} output files, and @file{texinfo.tex}, the
22666 Texinfo definitions file.
22667
22668 @TeX{} is a typesetting program; it does not print files directly, but
22669 produces output files called @sc{dvi} files. To print a typeset
22670 document, you need a program to print @sc{dvi} files. If your system
22671 has @TeX{} installed, chances are it has such a program. The precise
22672 command to use depends on your system; @kbd{lpr -d} is common; another
22673 (for PostScript devices) is @kbd{dvips}. The @sc{dvi} print command may
22674 require a file name without any extension or a @samp{.dvi} extension.
22675
22676 @TeX{} also requires a macro definitions file called
22677 @file{texinfo.tex}. This file tells @TeX{} how to typeset a document
22678 written in Texinfo format. On its own, @TeX{} cannot either read or
22679 typeset a Texinfo file. @file{texinfo.tex} is distributed with GDB
22680 and is located in the @file{gdb-@var{version-number}/texinfo}
22681 directory.
22682
22683 If you have @TeX{} and a @sc{dvi} printer program installed, you can
22684 typeset and print this manual. First switch to the @file{gdb}
22685 subdirectory of the main source directory (for example, to
22686 @file{gdb-@value{GDBVN}/gdb}) and type:
22687
22688 @smallexample
22689 make gdb.dvi
22690 @end smallexample
22691
22692 Then give @file{gdb.dvi} to your @sc{dvi} printing program.
22693
22694 @node Installing GDB
22695 @appendix Installing @value{GDBN}
22696 @cindex installation
22697
22698 @menu
22699 * Requirements:: Requirements for building @value{GDBN}
22700 * Running Configure:: Invoking the @value{GDBN} @file{configure} script
22701 * Separate Objdir:: Compiling @value{GDBN} in another directory
22702 * Config Names:: Specifying names for hosts and targets
22703 * Configure Options:: Summary of options for configure
22704 @end menu
22705
22706 @node Requirements
22707 @section Requirements for Building @value{GDBN}
22708 @cindex building @value{GDBN}, requirements for
22709
22710 Building @value{GDBN} requires various tools and packages to be available.
22711 Other packages will be used only if they are found.
22712
22713 @heading Tools/Packages Necessary for Building @value{GDBN}
22714 @table @asis
22715 @item ISO C90 compiler
22716 @value{GDBN} is written in ISO C90. It should be buildable with any
22717 working C90 compiler, e.g.@: GCC.
22718
22719 @end table
22720
22721 @heading Tools/Packages Optional for Building @value{GDBN}
22722 @table @asis
22723 @item Expat
22724 @anchor{Expat}
22725 @value{GDBN} can use the Expat XML parsing library. This library may be
22726 included with your operating system distribution; if it is not, you
22727 can get the latest version from @url{http://expat.sourceforge.net}.
22728 The @file{configure} script will search for this library in several
22729 standard locations; if it is installed in an unusual path, you can
22730 use the @option{--with-libexpat-prefix} option to specify its location.
22731
22732 Expat is used for:
22733
22734 @itemize @bullet
22735 @item
22736 Remote protocol memory maps (@pxref{Memory Map Format})
22737 @item
22738 Target descriptions (@pxref{Target Descriptions})
22739 @item
22740 Remote shared library lists (@pxref{Library List Format})
22741 @item
22742 MS-Windows shared libraries (@pxref{Shared Libraries})
22743 @end itemize
22744
22745 @item zlib
22746 @cindex compressed debug sections
22747 @value{GDBN} will use the @samp{zlib} library, if available, to read
22748 compressed debug sections. Some linkers, such as GNU gold, are capable
22749 of producing binaries with compressed debug sections. If @value{GDBN}
22750 is compiled with @samp{zlib}, it will be able to read the debug
22751 information in such binaries.
22752
22753 The @samp{zlib} library is likely included with your operating system
22754 distribution; if it is not, you can get the latest version from
22755 @url{http://zlib.net}.
22756
22757 @end table
22758
22759 @node Running Configure
22760 @section Invoking the @value{GDBN} @file{configure} Script
22761 @cindex configuring @value{GDBN}
22762 @value{GDBN} comes with a @file{configure} script that automates the process
22763 of preparing @value{GDBN} for installation; you can then use @code{make} to
22764 build the @code{gdb} program.
22765 @iftex
22766 @c irrelevant in info file; it's as current as the code it lives with.
22767 @footnote{If you have a more recent version of @value{GDBN} than @value{GDBVN},
22768 look at the @file{README} file in the sources; we may have improved the
22769 installation procedures since publishing this manual.}
22770 @end iftex
22771
22772 The @value{GDBN} distribution includes all the source code you need for
22773 @value{GDBN} in a single directory, whose name is usually composed by
22774 appending the version number to @samp{gdb}.
22775
22776 For example, the @value{GDBN} version @value{GDBVN} distribution is in the
22777 @file{gdb-@value{GDBVN}} directory. That directory contains:
22778
22779 @table @code
22780 @item gdb-@value{GDBVN}/configure @r{(and supporting files)}
22781 script for configuring @value{GDBN} and all its supporting libraries
22782
22783 @item gdb-@value{GDBVN}/gdb
22784 the source specific to @value{GDBN} itself
22785
22786 @item gdb-@value{GDBVN}/bfd
22787 source for the Binary File Descriptor library
22788
22789 @item gdb-@value{GDBVN}/include
22790 @sc{gnu} include files
22791
22792 @item gdb-@value{GDBVN}/libiberty
22793 source for the @samp{-liberty} free software library
22794
22795 @item gdb-@value{GDBVN}/opcodes
22796 source for the library of opcode tables and disassemblers
22797
22798 @item gdb-@value{GDBVN}/readline
22799 source for the @sc{gnu} command-line interface
22800
22801 @item gdb-@value{GDBVN}/glob
22802 source for the @sc{gnu} filename pattern-matching subroutine
22803
22804 @item gdb-@value{GDBVN}/mmalloc
22805 source for the @sc{gnu} memory-mapped malloc package
22806 @end table
22807
22808 The simplest way to configure and build @value{GDBN} is to run @file{configure}
22809 from the @file{gdb-@var{version-number}} source directory, which in
22810 this example is the @file{gdb-@value{GDBVN}} directory.
22811
22812 First switch to the @file{gdb-@var{version-number}} source directory
22813 if you are not already in it; then run @file{configure}. Pass the
22814 identifier for the platform on which @value{GDBN} will run as an
22815 argument.
22816
22817 For example:
22818
22819 @smallexample
22820 cd gdb-@value{GDBVN}
22821 ./configure @var{host}
22822 make
22823 @end smallexample
22824
22825 @noindent
22826 where @var{host} is an identifier such as @samp{sun4} or
22827 @samp{decstation}, that identifies the platform where @value{GDBN} will run.
22828 (You can often leave off @var{host}; @file{configure} tries to guess the
22829 correct value by examining your system.)
22830
22831 Running @samp{configure @var{host}} and then running @code{make} builds the
22832 @file{bfd}, @file{readline}, @file{mmalloc}, and @file{libiberty}
22833 libraries, then @code{gdb} itself. The configured source files, and the
22834 binaries, are left in the corresponding source directories.
22835
22836 @need 750
22837 @file{configure} is a Bourne-shell (@code{/bin/sh}) script; if your
22838 system does not recognize this automatically when you run a different
22839 shell, you may need to run @code{sh} on it explicitly:
22840
22841 @smallexample
22842 sh configure @var{host}
22843 @end smallexample
22844
22845 If you run @file{configure} from a directory that contains source
22846 directories for multiple libraries or programs, such as the
22847 @file{gdb-@value{GDBVN}} source directory for version @value{GDBVN},
22848 @file{configure}
22849 creates configuration files for every directory level underneath (unless
22850 you tell it not to, with the @samp{--norecursion} option).
22851
22852 You should run the @file{configure} script from the top directory in the
22853 source tree, the @file{gdb-@var{version-number}} directory. If you run
22854 @file{configure} from one of the subdirectories, you will configure only
22855 that subdirectory. That is usually not what you want. In particular,
22856 if you run the first @file{configure} from the @file{gdb} subdirectory
22857 of the @file{gdb-@var{version-number}} directory, you will omit the
22858 configuration of @file{bfd}, @file{readline}, and other sibling
22859 directories of the @file{gdb} subdirectory. This leads to build errors
22860 about missing include files such as @file{bfd/bfd.h}.
22861
22862 You can install @code{@value{GDBP}} anywhere; it has no hardwired paths.
22863 However, you should make sure that the shell on your path (named by
22864 the @samp{SHELL} environment variable) is publicly readable. Remember
22865 that @value{GDBN} uses the shell to start your program---some systems refuse to
22866 let @value{GDBN} debug child processes whose programs are not readable.
22867
22868 @node Separate Objdir
22869 @section Compiling @value{GDBN} in Another Directory
22870
22871 If you want to run @value{GDBN} versions for several host or target machines,
22872 you need a different @code{gdb} compiled for each combination of
22873 host and target. @file{configure} is designed to make this easy by
22874 allowing you to generate each configuration in a separate subdirectory,
22875 rather than in the source directory. If your @code{make} program
22876 handles the @samp{VPATH} feature (@sc{gnu} @code{make} does), running
22877 @code{make} in each of these directories builds the @code{gdb}
22878 program specified there.
22879
22880 To build @code{gdb} in a separate directory, run @file{configure}
22881 with the @samp{--srcdir} option to specify where to find the source.
22882 (You also need to specify a path to find @file{configure}
22883 itself from your working directory. If the path to @file{configure}
22884 would be the same as the argument to @samp{--srcdir}, you can leave out
22885 the @samp{--srcdir} option; it is assumed.)
22886
22887 For example, with version @value{GDBVN}, you can build @value{GDBN} in a
22888 separate directory for a Sun 4 like this:
22889
22890 @smallexample
22891 @group
22892 cd gdb-@value{GDBVN}
22893 mkdir ../gdb-sun4
22894 cd ../gdb-sun4
22895 ../gdb-@value{GDBVN}/configure sun4
22896 make
22897 @end group
22898 @end smallexample
22899
22900 When @file{configure} builds a configuration using a remote source
22901 directory, it creates a tree for the binaries with the same structure
22902 (and using the same names) as the tree under the source directory. In
22903 the example, you'd find the Sun 4 library @file{libiberty.a} in the
22904 directory @file{gdb-sun4/libiberty}, and @value{GDBN} itself in
22905 @file{gdb-sun4/gdb}.
22906
22907 Make sure that your path to the @file{configure} script has just one
22908 instance of @file{gdb} in it. If your path to @file{configure} looks
22909 like @file{../gdb-@value{GDBVN}/gdb/configure}, you are configuring only
22910 one subdirectory of @value{GDBN}, not the whole package. This leads to
22911 build errors about missing include files such as @file{bfd/bfd.h}.
22912
22913 One popular reason to build several @value{GDBN} configurations in separate
22914 directories is to configure @value{GDBN} for cross-compiling (where
22915 @value{GDBN} runs on one machine---the @dfn{host}---while debugging
22916 programs that run on another machine---the @dfn{target}).
22917 You specify a cross-debugging target by
22918 giving the @samp{--target=@var{target}} option to @file{configure}.
22919
22920 When you run @code{make} to build a program or library, you must run
22921 it in a configured directory---whatever directory you were in when you
22922 called @file{configure} (or one of its subdirectories).
22923
22924 The @code{Makefile} that @file{configure} generates in each source
22925 directory also runs recursively. If you type @code{make} in a source
22926 directory such as @file{gdb-@value{GDBVN}} (or in a separate configured
22927 directory configured with @samp{--srcdir=@var{dirname}/gdb-@value{GDBVN}}), you
22928 will build all the required libraries, and then build GDB.
22929
22930 When you have multiple hosts or targets configured in separate
22931 directories, you can run @code{make} on them in parallel (for example,
22932 if they are NFS-mounted on each of the hosts); they will not interfere
22933 with each other.
22934
22935 @node Config Names
22936 @section Specifying Names for Hosts and Targets
22937
22938 The specifications used for hosts and targets in the @file{configure}
22939 script are based on a three-part naming scheme, but some short predefined
22940 aliases are also supported. The full naming scheme encodes three pieces
22941 of information in the following pattern:
22942
22943 @smallexample
22944 @var{architecture}-@var{vendor}-@var{os}
22945 @end smallexample
22946
22947 For example, you can use the alias @code{sun4} as a @var{host} argument,
22948 or as the value for @var{target} in a @code{--target=@var{target}}
22949 option. The equivalent full name is @samp{sparc-sun-sunos4}.
22950
22951 The @file{configure} script accompanying @value{GDBN} does not provide
22952 any query facility to list all supported host and target names or
22953 aliases. @file{configure} calls the Bourne shell script
22954 @code{config.sub} to map abbreviations to full names; you can read the
22955 script, if you wish, or you can use it to test your guesses on
22956 abbreviations---for example:
22957
22958 @smallexample
22959 % sh config.sub i386-linux
22960 i386-pc-linux-gnu
22961 % sh config.sub alpha-linux
22962 alpha-unknown-linux-gnu
22963 % sh config.sub hp9k700
22964 hppa1.1-hp-hpux
22965 % sh config.sub sun4
22966 sparc-sun-sunos4.1.1
22967 % sh config.sub sun3
22968 m68k-sun-sunos4.1.1
22969 % sh config.sub i986v
22970 Invalid configuration `i986v': machine `i986v' not recognized
22971 @end smallexample
22972
22973 @noindent
22974 @code{config.sub} is also distributed in the @value{GDBN} source
22975 directory (@file{gdb-@value{GDBVN}}, for version @value{GDBVN}).
22976
22977 @node Configure Options
22978 @section @file{configure} Options
22979
22980 Here is a summary of the @file{configure} options and arguments that
22981 are most often useful for building @value{GDBN}. @file{configure} also has
22982 several other options not listed here. @inforef{What Configure
22983 Does,,configure.info}, for a full explanation of @file{configure}.
22984
22985 @smallexample
22986 configure @r{[}--help@r{]}
22987 @r{[}--prefix=@var{dir}@r{]}
22988 @r{[}--exec-prefix=@var{dir}@r{]}
22989 @r{[}--srcdir=@var{dirname}@r{]}
22990 @r{[}--norecursion@r{]} @r{[}--rm@r{]}
22991 @r{[}--target=@var{target}@r{]}
22992 @var{host}
22993 @end smallexample
22994
22995 @noindent
22996 You may introduce options with a single @samp{-} rather than
22997 @samp{--} if you prefer; but you may abbreviate option names if you use
22998 @samp{--}.
22999
23000 @table @code
23001 @item --help
23002 Display a quick summary of how to invoke @file{configure}.
23003
23004 @item --prefix=@var{dir}
23005 Configure the source to install programs and files under directory
23006 @file{@var{dir}}.
23007
23008 @item --exec-prefix=@var{dir}
23009 Configure the source to install programs under directory
23010 @file{@var{dir}}.
23011
23012 @c avoid splitting the warning from the explanation:
23013 @need 2000
23014 @item --srcdir=@var{dirname}
23015 @strong{Warning: using this option requires @sc{gnu} @code{make}, or another
23016 @code{make} that implements the @code{VPATH} feature.}@*
23017 Use this option to make configurations in directories separate from the
23018 @value{GDBN} source directories. Among other things, you can use this to
23019 build (or maintain) several configurations simultaneously, in separate
23020 directories. @file{configure} writes configuration-specific files in
23021 the current directory, but arranges for them to use the source in the
23022 directory @var{dirname}. @file{configure} creates directories under
23023 the working directory in parallel to the source directories below
23024 @var{dirname}.
23025
23026 @item --norecursion
23027 Configure only the directory level where @file{configure} is executed; do not
23028 propagate configuration to subdirectories.
23029
23030 @item --target=@var{target}
23031 Configure @value{GDBN} for cross-debugging programs running on the specified
23032 @var{target}. Without this option, @value{GDBN} is configured to debug
23033 programs that run on the same machine (@var{host}) as @value{GDBN} itself.
23034
23035 There is no convenient way to generate a list of all available targets.
23036
23037 @item @var{host} @dots{}
23038 Configure @value{GDBN} to run on the specified @var{host}.
23039
23040 There is no convenient way to generate a list of all available hosts.
23041 @end table
23042
23043 There are many other options available as well, but they are generally
23044 needed for special purposes only.
23045
23046 @node Maintenance Commands
23047 @appendix Maintenance Commands
23048 @cindex maintenance commands
23049 @cindex internal commands
23050
23051 In addition to commands intended for @value{GDBN} users, @value{GDBN}
23052 includes a number of commands intended for @value{GDBN} developers,
23053 that are not documented elsewhere in this manual. These commands are
23054 provided here for reference. (For commands that turn on debugging
23055 messages, see @ref{Debugging Output}.)
23056
23057 @table @code
23058 @kindex maint agent
23059 @item maint agent @var{expression}
23060 Translate the given @var{expression} into remote agent bytecodes.
23061 This command is useful for debugging the Agent Expression mechanism
23062 (@pxref{Agent Expressions}).
23063
23064 @kindex maint info breakpoints
23065 @item @anchor{maint info breakpoints}maint info breakpoints
23066 Using the same format as @samp{info breakpoints}, display both the
23067 breakpoints you've set explicitly, and those @value{GDBN} is using for
23068 internal purposes. Internal breakpoints are shown with negative
23069 breakpoint numbers. The type column identifies what kind of breakpoint
23070 is shown:
23071
23072 @table @code
23073 @item breakpoint
23074 Normal, explicitly set breakpoint.
23075
23076 @item watchpoint
23077 Normal, explicitly set watchpoint.
23078
23079 @item longjmp
23080 Internal breakpoint, used to handle correctly stepping through
23081 @code{longjmp} calls.
23082
23083 @item longjmp resume
23084 Internal breakpoint at the target of a @code{longjmp}.
23085
23086 @item until
23087 Temporary internal breakpoint used by the @value{GDBN} @code{until} command.
23088
23089 @item finish
23090 Temporary internal breakpoint used by the @value{GDBN} @code{finish} command.
23091
23092 @item shlib events
23093 Shared library events.
23094
23095 @end table
23096
23097 @kindex maint check-symtabs
23098 @item maint check-symtabs
23099 Check the consistency of psymtabs and symtabs.
23100
23101 @kindex maint cplus first_component
23102 @item maint cplus first_component @var{name}
23103 Print the first C@t{++} class/namespace component of @var{name}.
23104
23105 @kindex maint cplus namespace
23106 @item maint cplus namespace
23107 Print the list of possible C@t{++} namespaces.
23108
23109 @kindex maint demangle
23110 @item maint demangle @var{name}
23111 Demangle a C@t{++} or Objective-C mangled @var{name}.
23112
23113 @kindex maint deprecate
23114 @kindex maint undeprecate
23115 @cindex deprecated commands
23116 @item maint deprecate @var{command} @r{[}@var{replacement}@r{]}
23117 @itemx maint undeprecate @var{command}
23118 Deprecate or undeprecate the named @var{command}. Deprecated commands
23119 cause @value{GDBN} to issue a warning when you use them. The optional
23120 argument @var{replacement} says which newer command should be used in
23121 favor of the deprecated one; if it is given, @value{GDBN} will mention
23122 the replacement as part of the warning.
23123
23124 @kindex maint dump-me
23125 @item maint dump-me
23126 @cindex @code{SIGQUIT} signal, dump core of @value{GDBN}
23127 Cause a fatal signal in the debugger and force it to dump its core.
23128 This is supported only on systems which support aborting a program
23129 with the @code{SIGQUIT} signal.
23130
23131 @kindex maint internal-error
23132 @kindex maint internal-warning
23133 @item maint internal-error @r{[}@var{message-text}@r{]}
23134 @itemx maint internal-warning @r{[}@var{message-text}@r{]}
23135 Cause @value{GDBN} to call the internal function @code{internal_error}
23136 or @code{internal_warning} and hence behave as though an internal error
23137 or internal warning has been detected. In addition to reporting the
23138 internal problem, these functions give the user the opportunity to
23139 either quit @value{GDBN} or create a core file of the current
23140 @value{GDBN} session.
23141
23142 These commands take an optional parameter @var{message-text} that is
23143 used as the text of the error or warning message.
23144
23145 Here's an example of using @code{internal-error}:
23146
23147 @smallexample
23148 (@value{GDBP}) @kbd{maint internal-error testing, 1, 2}
23149 @dots{}/maint.c:121: internal-error: testing, 1, 2
23150 A problem internal to GDB has been detected. Further
23151 debugging may prove unreliable.
23152 Quit this debugging session? (y or n) @kbd{n}
23153 Create a core file? (y or n) @kbd{n}
23154 (@value{GDBP})
23155 @end smallexample
23156
23157 @kindex maint packet
23158 @item maint packet @var{text}
23159 If @value{GDBN} is talking to an inferior via the serial protocol,
23160 then this command sends the string @var{text} to the inferior, and
23161 displays the response packet. @value{GDBN} supplies the initial
23162 @samp{$} character, the terminating @samp{#} character, and the
23163 checksum.
23164
23165 @kindex maint print architecture
23166 @item maint print architecture @r{[}@var{file}@r{]}
23167 Print the entire architecture configuration. The optional argument
23168 @var{file} names the file where the output goes.
23169
23170 @kindex maint print c-tdesc
23171 @item maint print c-tdesc
23172 Print the current target description (@pxref{Target Descriptions}) as
23173 a C source file. The created source file can be used in @value{GDBN}
23174 when an XML parser is not available to parse the description.
23175
23176 @kindex maint print dummy-frames
23177 @item maint print dummy-frames
23178 Prints the contents of @value{GDBN}'s internal dummy-frame stack.
23179
23180 @smallexample
23181 (@value{GDBP}) @kbd{b add}
23182 @dots{}
23183 (@value{GDBP}) @kbd{print add(2,3)}
23184 Breakpoint 2, add (a=2, b=3) at @dots{}
23185 58 return (a + b);
23186 The program being debugged stopped while in a function called from GDB.
23187 @dots{}
23188 (@value{GDBP}) @kbd{maint print dummy-frames}
23189 0x1a57c80: pc=0x01014068 fp=0x0200bddc sp=0x0200bdd6
23190 top=0x0200bdd4 id=@{stack=0x200bddc,code=0x101405c@}
23191 call_lo=0x01014000 call_hi=0x01014001
23192 (@value{GDBP})
23193 @end smallexample
23194
23195 Takes an optional file parameter.
23196
23197 @kindex maint print registers
23198 @kindex maint print raw-registers
23199 @kindex maint print cooked-registers
23200 @kindex maint print register-groups
23201 @item maint print registers @r{[}@var{file}@r{]}
23202 @itemx maint print raw-registers @r{[}@var{file}@r{]}
23203 @itemx maint print cooked-registers @r{[}@var{file}@r{]}
23204 @itemx maint print register-groups @r{[}@var{file}@r{]}
23205 Print @value{GDBN}'s internal register data structures.
23206
23207 The command @code{maint print raw-registers} includes the contents of
23208 the raw register cache; the command @code{maint print cooked-registers}
23209 includes the (cooked) value of all registers; and the command
23210 @code{maint print register-groups} includes the groups that each
23211 register is a member of. @xref{Registers,, Registers, gdbint,
23212 @value{GDBN} Internals}.
23213
23214 These commands take an optional parameter, a file name to which to
23215 write the information.
23216
23217 @kindex maint print reggroups
23218 @item maint print reggroups @r{[}@var{file}@r{]}
23219 Print @value{GDBN}'s internal register group data structures. The
23220 optional argument @var{file} tells to what file to write the
23221 information.
23222
23223 The register groups info looks like this:
23224
23225 @smallexample
23226 (@value{GDBP}) @kbd{maint print reggroups}
23227 Group Type
23228 general user
23229 float user
23230 all user
23231 vector user
23232 system user
23233 save internal
23234 restore internal
23235 @end smallexample
23236
23237 @kindex flushregs
23238 @item flushregs
23239 This command forces @value{GDBN} to flush its internal register cache.
23240
23241 @kindex maint print objfiles
23242 @cindex info for known object files
23243 @item maint print objfiles
23244 Print a dump of all known object files. For each object file, this
23245 command prints its name, address in memory, and all of its psymtabs
23246 and symtabs.
23247
23248 @kindex maint print statistics
23249 @cindex bcache statistics
23250 @item maint print statistics
23251 This command prints, for each object file in the program, various data
23252 about that object file followed by the byte cache (@dfn{bcache})
23253 statistics for the object file. The objfile data includes the number
23254 of minimal, partial, full, and stabs symbols, the number of types
23255 defined by the objfile, the number of as yet unexpanded psym tables,
23256 the number of line tables and string tables, and the amount of memory
23257 used by the various tables. The bcache statistics include the counts,
23258 sizes, and counts of duplicates of all and unique objects, max,
23259 average, and median entry size, total memory used and its overhead and
23260 savings, and various measures of the hash table size and chain
23261 lengths.
23262
23263 @kindex maint print target-stack
23264 @cindex target stack description
23265 @item maint print target-stack
23266 A @dfn{target} is an interface between the debugger and a particular
23267 kind of file or process. Targets can be stacked in @dfn{strata},
23268 so that more than one target can potentially respond to a request.
23269 In particular, memory accesses will walk down the stack of targets
23270 until they find a target that is interested in handling that particular
23271 address.
23272
23273 This command prints a short description of each layer that was pushed on
23274 the @dfn{target stack}, starting from the top layer down to the bottom one.
23275
23276 @kindex maint print type
23277 @cindex type chain of a data type
23278 @item maint print type @var{expr}
23279 Print the type chain for a type specified by @var{expr}. The argument
23280 can be either a type name or a symbol. If it is a symbol, the type of
23281 that symbol is described. The type chain produced by this command is
23282 a recursive definition of the data type as stored in @value{GDBN}'s
23283 data structures, including its flags and contained types.
23284
23285 @kindex maint set dwarf2 max-cache-age
23286 @kindex maint show dwarf2 max-cache-age
23287 @item maint set dwarf2 max-cache-age
23288 @itemx maint show dwarf2 max-cache-age
23289 Control the DWARF 2 compilation unit cache.
23290
23291 @cindex DWARF 2 compilation units cache
23292 In object files with inter-compilation-unit references, such as those
23293 produced by the GCC option @samp{-feliminate-dwarf2-dups}, the DWARF 2
23294 reader needs to frequently refer to previously read compilation units.
23295 This setting controls how long a compilation unit will remain in the
23296 cache if it is not referenced. A higher limit means that cached
23297 compilation units will be stored in memory longer, and more total
23298 memory will be used. Setting it to zero disables caching, which will
23299 slow down @value{GDBN} startup, but reduce memory consumption.
23300
23301 @kindex maint set profile
23302 @kindex maint show profile
23303 @cindex profiling GDB
23304 @item maint set profile
23305 @itemx maint show profile
23306 Control profiling of @value{GDBN}.
23307
23308 Profiling will be disabled until you use the @samp{maint set profile}
23309 command to enable it. When you enable profiling, the system will begin
23310 collecting timing and execution count data; when you disable profiling or
23311 exit @value{GDBN}, the results will be written to a log file. Remember that
23312 if you use profiling, @value{GDBN} will overwrite the profiling log file
23313 (often called @file{gmon.out}). If you have a record of important profiling
23314 data in a @file{gmon.out} file, be sure to move it to a safe location.
23315
23316 Configuring with @samp{--enable-profiling} arranges for @value{GDBN} to be
23317 compiled with the @samp{-pg} compiler option.
23318
23319 @kindex maint set linux-async
23320 @kindex maint show linux-async
23321 @cindex asynchronous support
23322 @item maint set linux-async
23323 @itemx maint show linux-async
23324 Control the GNU/Linux native asynchronous support of @value{GDBN}.
23325
23326 GNU/Linux native asynchronous support will be disabled until you use
23327 the @samp{maint set linux-async} command to enable it.
23328
23329 @kindex maint show-debug-regs
23330 @cindex x86 hardware debug registers
23331 @item maint show-debug-regs
23332 Control whether to show variables that mirror the x86 hardware debug
23333 registers. Use @code{ON} to enable, @code{OFF} to disable. If
23334 enabled, the debug registers values are shown when @value{GDBN} inserts or
23335 removes a hardware breakpoint or watchpoint, and when the inferior
23336 triggers a hardware-assisted breakpoint or watchpoint.
23337
23338 @kindex maint space
23339 @cindex memory used by commands
23340 @item maint space
23341 Control whether to display memory usage for each command. If set to a
23342 nonzero value, @value{GDBN} will display how much memory each command
23343 took, following the command's own output. This can also be requested
23344 by invoking @value{GDBN} with the @option{--statistics} command-line
23345 switch (@pxref{Mode Options}).
23346
23347 @kindex maint time
23348 @cindex time of command execution
23349 @item maint time
23350 Control whether to display the execution time for each command. If
23351 set to a nonzero value, @value{GDBN} will display how much time it
23352 took to execute each command, following the command's own output.
23353 This can also be requested by invoking @value{GDBN} with the
23354 @option{--statistics} command-line switch (@pxref{Mode Options}).
23355
23356 @kindex maint translate-address
23357 @item maint translate-address @r{[}@var{section}@r{]} @var{addr}
23358 Find the symbol stored at the location specified by the address
23359 @var{addr} and an optional section name @var{section}. If found,
23360 @value{GDBN} prints the name of the closest symbol and an offset from
23361 the symbol's location to the specified address. This is similar to
23362 the @code{info address} command (@pxref{Symbols}), except that this
23363 command also allows to find symbols in other sections.
23364
23365 @end table
23366
23367 The following command is useful for non-interactive invocations of
23368 @value{GDBN}, such as in the test suite.
23369
23370 @table @code
23371 @item set watchdog @var{nsec}
23372 @kindex set watchdog
23373 @cindex watchdog timer
23374 @cindex timeout for commands
23375 Set the maximum number of seconds @value{GDBN} will wait for the
23376 target operation to finish. If this time expires, @value{GDBN}
23377 reports and error and the command is aborted.
23378
23379 @item show watchdog
23380 Show the current setting of the target wait timeout.
23381 @end table
23382
23383 @node Remote Protocol
23384 @appendix @value{GDBN} Remote Serial Protocol
23385
23386 @menu
23387 * Overview::
23388 * Packets::
23389 * Stop Reply Packets::
23390 * General Query Packets::
23391 * Register Packet Format::
23392 * Tracepoint Packets::
23393 * Host I/O Packets::
23394 * Interrupts::
23395 * Examples::
23396 * File-I/O Remote Protocol Extension::
23397 * Library List Format::
23398 * Memory Map Format::
23399 @end menu
23400
23401 @node Overview
23402 @section Overview
23403
23404 There may be occasions when you need to know something about the
23405 protocol---for example, if there is only one serial port to your target
23406 machine, you might want your program to do something special if it
23407 recognizes a packet meant for @value{GDBN}.
23408
23409 In the examples below, @samp{->} and @samp{<-} are used to indicate
23410 transmitted and received data, respectively.
23411
23412 @cindex protocol, @value{GDBN} remote serial
23413 @cindex serial protocol, @value{GDBN} remote
23414 @cindex remote serial protocol
23415 All @value{GDBN} commands and responses (other than acknowledgments) are
23416 sent as a @var{packet}. A @var{packet} is introduced with the character
23417 @samp{$}, the actual @var{packet-data}, and the terminating character
23418 @samp{#} followed by a two-digit @var{checksum}:
23419
23420 @smallexample
23421 @code{$}@var{packet-data}@code{#}@var{checksum}
23422 @end smallexample
23423 @noindent
23424
23425 @cindex checksum, for @value{GDBN} remote
23426 @noindent
23427 The two-digit @var{checksum} is computed as the modulo 256 sum of all
23428 characters between the leading @samp{$} and the trailing @samp{#} (an
23429 eight bit unsigned checksum).
23430
23431 Implementors should note that prior to @value{GDBN} 5.0 the protocol
23432 specification also included an optional two-digit @var{sequence-id}:
23433
23434 @smallexample
23435 @code{$}@var{sequence-id}@code{:}@var{packet-data}@code{#}@var{checksum}
23436 @end smallexample
23437
23438 @cindex sequence-id, for @value{GDBN} remote
23439 @noindent
23440 That @var{sequence-id} was appended to the acknowledgment. @value{GDBN}
23441 has never output @var{sequence-id}s. Stubs that handle packets added
23442 since @value{GDBN} 5.0 must not accept @var{sequence-id}.
23443
23444 @cindex acknowledgment, for @value{GDBN} remote
23445 When either the host or the target machine receives a packet, the first
23446 response expected is an acknowledgment: either @samp{+} (to indicate
23447 the package was received correctly) or @samp{-} (to request
23448 retransmission):
23449
23450 @smallexample
23451 -> @code{$}@var{packet-data}@code{#}@var{checksum}
23452 <- @code{+}
23453 @end smallexample
23454 @noindent
23455
23456 The host (@value{GDBN}) sends @var{command}s, and the target (the
23457 debugging stub incorporated in your program) sends a @var{response}. In
23458 the case of step and continue @var{command}s, the response is only sent
23459 when the operation has completed (the target has again stopped).
23460
23461 @var{packet-data} consists of a sequence of characters with the
23462 exception of @samp{#} and @samp{$} (see @samp{X} packet for additional
23463 exceptions).
23464
23465 @cindex remote protocol, field separator
23466 Fields within the packet should be separated using @samp{,} @samp{;} or
23467 @samp{:}. Except where otherwise noted all numbers are represented in
23468 @sc{hex} with leading zeros suppressed.
23469
23470 Implementors should note that prior to @value{GDBN} 5.0, the character
23471 @samp{:} could not appear as the third character in a packet (as it
23472 would potentially conflict with the @var{sequence-id}).
23473
23474 @cindex remote protocol, binary data
23475 @anchor{Binary Data}
23476 Binary data in most packets is encoded either as two hexadecimal
23477 digits per byte of binary data. This allowed the traditional remote
23478 protocol to work over connections which were only seven-bit clean.
23479 Some packets designed more recently assume an eight-bit clean
23480 connection, and use a more efficient encoding to send and receive
23481 binary data.
23482
23483 The binary data representation uses @code{7d} (@sc{ascii} @samp{@}})
23484 as an escape character. Any escaped byte is transmitted as the escape
23485 character followed by the original character XORed with @code{0x20}.
23486 For example, the byte @code{0x7d} would be transmitted as the two
23487 bytes @code{0x7d 0x5d}. The bytes @code{0x23} (@sc{ascii} @samp{#}),
23488 @code{0x24} (@sc{ascii} @samp{$}), and @code{0x7d} (@sc{ascii}
23489 @samp{@}}) must always be escaped. Responses sent by the stub
23490 must also escape @code{0x2a} (@sc{ascii} @samp{*}), so that it
23491 is not interpreted as the start of a run-length encoded sequence
23492 (described next).
23493
23494 Response @var{data} can be run-length encoded to save space.
23495 Run-length encoding replaces runs of identical characters with one
23496 instance of the repeated character, followed by a @samp{*} and a
23497 repeat count. The repeat count is itself sent encoded, to avoid
23498 binary characters in @var{data}: a value of @var{n} is sent as
23499 @code{@var{n}+29}. For a repeat count greater or equal to 3, this
23500 produces a printable @sc{ascii} character, e.g.@: a space (@sc{ascii}
23501 code 32) for a repeat count of 3. (This is because run-length
23502 encoding starts to win for counts 3 or more.) Thus, for example,
23503 @samp{0* } is a run-length encoding of ``0000'': the space character
23504 after @samp{*} means repeat the leading @code{0} @w{@code{32 - 29 =
23505 3}} more times.
23506
23507 The printable characters @samp{#} and @samp{$} or with a numeric value
23508 greater than 126 must not be used. Runs of six repeats (@samp{#}) or
23509 seven repeats (@samp{$}) can be expanded using a repeat count of only
23510 five (@samp{"}). For example, @samp{00000000} can be encoded as
23511 @samp{0*"00}.
23512
23513 The error response returned for some packets includes a two character
23514 error number. That number is not well defined.
23515
23516 @cindex empty response, for unsupported packets
23517 For any @var{command} not supported by the stub, an empty response
23518 (@samp{$#00}) should be returned. That way it is possible to extend the
23519 protocol. A newer @value{GDBN} can tell if a packet is supported based
23520 on that response.
23521
23522 A stub is required to support the @samp{g}, @samp{G}, @samp{m}, @samp{M},
23523 @samp{c}, and @samp{s} @var{command}s. All other @var{command}s are
23524 optional.
23525
23526 @node Packets
23527 @section Packets
23528
23529 The following table provides a complete list of all currently defined
23530 @var{command}s and their corresponding response @var{data}.
23531 @xref{File-I/O Remote Protocol Extension}, for details about the File
23532 I/O extension of the remote protocol.
23533
23534 Each packet's description has a template showing the packet's overall
23535 syntax, followed by an explanation of the packet's meaning. We
23536 include spaces in some of the templates for clarity; these are not
23537 part of the packet's syntax. No @value{GDBN} packet uses spaces to
23538 separate its components. For example, a template like @samp{foo
23539 @var{bar} @var{baz}} describes a packet beginning with the three ASCII
23540 bytes @samp{foo}, followed by a @var{bar}, followed directly by a
23541 @var{baz}. @value{GDBN} does not transmit a space character between the
23542 @samp{foo} and the @var{bar}, or between the @var{bar} and the
23543 @var{baz}.
23544
23545 Note that all packet forms beginning with an upper- or lower-case
23546 letter, other than those described here, are reserved for future use.
23547
23548 Here are the packet descriptions.
23549
23550 @table @samp
23551
23552 @item !
23553 @cindex @samp{!} packet
23554 @anchor{extended mode}
23555 Enable extended mode. In extended mode, the remote server is made
23556 persistent. The @samp{R} packet is used to restart the program being
23557 debugged.
23558
23559 Reply:
23560 @table @samp
23561 @item OK
23562 The remote target both supports and has enabled extended mode.
23563 @end table
23564
23565 @item ?
23566 @cindex @samp{?} packet
23567 Indicate the reason the target halted. The reply is the same as for
23568 step and continue.
23569
23570 Reply:
23571 @xref{Stop Reply Packets}, for the reply specifications.
23572
23573 @item A @var{arglen},@var{argnum},@var{arg},@dots{}
23574 @cindex @samp{A} packet
23575 Initialized @code{argv[]} array passed into program. @var{arglen}
23576 specifies the number of bytes in the hex encoded byte stream
23577 @var{arg}. See @code{gdbserver} for more details.
23578
23579 Reply:
23580 @table @samp
23581 @item OK
23582 The arguments were set.
23583 @item E @var{NN}
23584 An error occurred.
23585 @end table
23586
23587 @item b @var{baud}
23588 @cindex @samp{b} packet
23589 (Don't use this packet; its behavior is not well-defined.)
23590 Change the serial line speed to @var{baud}.
23591
23592 JTC: @emph{When does the transport layer state change? When it's
23593 received, or after the ACK is transmitted. In either case, there are
23594 problems if the command or the acknowledgment packet is dropped.}
23595
23596 Stan: @emph{If people really wanted to add something like this, and get
23597 it working for the first time, they ought to modify ser-unix.c to send
23598 some kind of out-of-band message to a specially-setup stub and have the
23599 switch happen "in between" packets, so that from remote protocol's point
23600 of view, nothing actually happened.}
23601
23602 @item B @var{addr},@var{mode}
23603 @cindex @samp{B} packet
23604 Set (@var{mode} is @samp{S}) or clear (@var{mode} is @samp{C}) a
23605 breakpoint at @var{addr}.
23606
23607 Don't use this packet. Use the @samp{Z} and @samp{z} packets instead
23608 (@pxref{insert breakpoint or watchpoint packet}).
23609
23610 @item c @r{[}@var{addr}@r{]}
23611 @cindex @samp{c} packet
23612 Continue. @var{addr} is address to resume. If @var{addr} is omitted,
23613 resume at current address.
23614
23615 Reply:
23616 @xref{Stop Reply Packets}, for the reply specifications.
23617
23618 @item C @var{sig}@r{[};@var{addr}@r{]}
23619 @cindex @samp{C} packet
23620 Continue with signal @var{sig} (hex signal number). If
23621 @samp{;@var{addr}} is omitted, resume at same address.
23622
23623 Reply:
23624 @xref{Stop Reply Packets}, for the reply specifications.
23625
23626 @item d
23627 @cindex @samp{d} packet
23628 Toggle debug flag.
23629
23630 Don't use this packet; instead, define a general set packet
23631 (@pxref{General Query Packets}).
23632
23633 @item D
23634 @cindex @samp{D} packet
23635 Detach @value{GDBN} from the remote system. Sent to the remote target
23636 before @value{GDBN} disconnects via the @code{detach} command.
23637
23638 Reply:
23639 @table @samp
23640 @item OK
23641 for success
23642 @item E @var{NN}
23643 for an error
23644 @end table
23645
23646 @item F @var{RC},@var{EE},@var{CF};@var{XX}
23647 @cindex @samp{F} packet
23648 A reply from @value{GDBN} to an @samp{F} packet sent by the target.
23649 This is part of the File-I/O protocol extension. @xref{File-I/O
23650 Remote Protocol Extension}, for the specification.
23651
23652 @item g
23653 @anchor{read registers packet}
23654 @cindex @samp{g} packet
23655 Read general registers.
23656
23657 Reply:
23658 @table @samp
23659 @item @var{XX@dots{}}
23660 Each byte of register data is described by two hex digits. The bytes
23661 with the register are transmitted in target byte order. The size of
23662 each register and their position within the @samp{g} packet are
23663 determined by the @value{GDBN} internal gdbarch functions
23664 @code{DEPRECATED_REGISTER_RAW_SIZE} and @code{gdbarch_register_name}. The
23665 specification of several standard @samp{g} packets is specified below.
23666 @item E @var{NN}
23667 for an error.
23668 @end table
23669
23670 @item G @var{XX@dots{}}
23671 @cindex @samp{G} packet
23672 Write general registers. @xref{read registers packet}, for a
23673 description of the @var{XX@dots{}} data.
23674
23675 Reply:
23676 @table @samp
23677 @item OK
23678 for success
23679 @item E @var{NN}
23680 for an error
23681 @end table
23682
23683 @item H @var{c} @var{t}
23684 @cindex @samp{H} packet
23685 Set thread for subsequent operations (@samp{m}, @samp{M}, @samp{g},
23686 @samp{G}, et.al.). @var{c} depends on the operation to be performed: it
23687 should be @samp{c} for step and continue operations, @samp{g} for other
23688 operations. The thread designator @var{t} may be @samp{-1}, meaning all
23689 the threads, a thread number, or @samp{0} which means pick any thread.
23690
23691 Reply:
23692 @table @samp
23693 @item OK
23694 for success
23695 @item E @var{NN}
23696 for an error
23697 @end table
23698
23699 @c FIXME: JTC:
23700 @c 'H': How restrictive (or permissive) is the thread model. If a
23701 @c thread is selected and stopped, are other threads allowed
23702 @c to continue to execute? As I mentioned above, I think the
23703 @c semantics of each command when a thread is selected must be
23704 @c described. For example:
23705 @c
23706 @c 'g': If the stub supports threads and a specific thread is
23707 @c selected, returns the register block from that thread;
23708 @c otherwise returns current registers.
23709 @c
23710 @c 'G' If the stub supports threads and a specific thread is
23711 @c selected, sets the registers of the register block of
23712 @c that thread; otherwise sets current registers.
23713
23714 @item i @r{[}@var{addr}@r{[},@var{nnn}@r{]]}
23715 @anchor{cycle step packet}
23716 @cindex @samp{i} packet
23717 Step the remote target by a single clock cycle. If @samp{,@var{nnn}} is
23718 present, cycle step @var{nnn} cycles. If @var{addr} is present, cycle
23719 step starting at that address.
23720
23721 @item I
23722 @cindex @samp{I} packet
23723 Signal, then cycle step. @xref{step with signal packet}. @xref{cycle
23724 step packet}.
23725
23726 @item k
23727 @cindex @samp{k} packet
23728 Kill request.
23729
23730 FIXME: @emph{There is no description of how to operate when a specific
23731 thread context has been selected (i.e.@: does 'k' kill only that
23732 thread?)}.
23733
23734 @item m @var{addr},@var{length}
23735 @cindex @samp{m} packet
23736 Read @var{length} bytes of memory starting at address @var{addr}.
23737 Note that @var{addr} may not be aligned to any particular boundary.
23738
23739 The stub need not use any particular size or alignment when gathering
23740 data from memory for the response; even if @var{addr} is word-aligned
23741 and @var{length} is a multiple of the word size, the stub is free to
23742 use byte accesses, or not. For this reason, this packet may not be
23743 suitable for accessing memory-mapped I/O devices.
23744 @cindex alignment of remote memory accesses
23745 @cindex size of remote memory accesses
23746 @cindex memory, alignment and size of remote accesses
23747
23748 Reply:
23749 @table @samp
23750 @item @var{XX@dots{}}
23751 Memory contents; each byte is transmitted as a two-digit hexadecimal
23752 number. The reply may contain fewer bytes than requested if the
23753 server was able to read only part of the region of memory.
23754 @item E @var{NN}
23755 @var{NN} is errno
23756 @end table
23757
23758 @item M @var{addr},@var{length}:@var{XX@dots{}}
23759 @cindex @samp{M} packet
23760 Write @var{length} bytes of memory starting at address @var{addr}.
23761 @var{XX@dots{}} is the data; each byte is transmitted as a two-digit
23762 hexadecimal number.
23763
23764 Reply:
23765 @table @samp
23766 @item OK
23767 for success
23768 @item E @var{NN}
23769 for an error (this includes the case where only part of the data was
23770 written).
23771 @end table
23772
23773 @item p @var{n}
23774 @cindex @samp{p} packet
23775 Read the value of register @var{n}; @var{n} is in hex.
23776 @xref{read registers packet}, for a description of how the returned
23777 register value is encoded.
23778
23779 Reply:
23780 @table @samp
23781 @item @var{XX@dots{}}
23782 the register's value
23783 @item E @var{NN}
23784 for an error
23785 @item
23786 Indicating an unrecognized @var{query}.
23787 @end table
23788
23789 @item P @var{n@dots{}}=@var{r@dots{}}
23790 @anchor{write register packet}
23791 @cindex @samp{P} packet
23792 Write register @var{n@dots{}} with value @var{r@dots{}}. The register
23793 number @var{n} is in hexadecimal, and @var{r@dots{}} contains two hex
23794 digits for each byte in the register (target byte order).
23795
23796 Reply:
23797 @table @samp
23798 @item OK
23799 for success
23800 @item E @var{NN}
23801 for an error
23802 @end table
23803
23804 @item q @var{name} @var{params}@dots{}
23805 @itemx Q @var{name} @var{params}@dots{}
23806 @cindex @samp{q} packet
23807 @cindex @samp{Q} packet
23808 General query (@samp{q}) and set (@samp{Q}). These packets are
23809 described fully in @ref{General Query Packets}.
23810
23811 @item r
23812 @cindex @samp{r} packet
23813 Reset the entire system.
23814
23815 Don't use this packet; use the @samp{R} packet instead.
23816
23817 @item R @var{XX}
23818 @cindex @samp{R} packet
23819 Restart the program being debugged. @var{XX}, while needed, is ignored.
23820 This packet is only available in extended mode (@pxref{extended mode}).
23821
23822 The @samp{R} packet has no reply.
23823
23824 @item s @r{[}@var{addr}@r{]}
23825 @cindex @samp{s} packet
23826 Single step. @var{addr} is the address at which to resume. If
23827 @var{addr} is omitted, resume at same address.
23828
23829 Reply:
23830 @xref{Stop Reply Packets}, for the reply specifications.
23831
23832 @item S @var{sig}@r{[};@var{addr}@r{]}
23833 @anchor{step with signal packet}
23834 @cindex @samp{S} packet
23835 Step with signal. This is analogous to the @samp{C} packet, but
23836 requests a single-step, rather than a normal resumption of execution.
23837
23838 Reply:
23839 @xref{Stop Reply Packets}, for the reply specifications.
23840
23841 @item t @var{addr}:@var{PP},@var{MM}
23842 @cindex @samp{t} packet
23843 Search backwards starting at address @var{addr} for a match with pattern
23844 @var{PP} and mask @var{MM}. @var{PP} and @var{MM} are 4 bytes.
23845 @var{addr} must be at least 3 digits.
23846
23847 @item T @var{XX}
23848 @cindex @samp{T} packet
23849 Find out if the thread XX is alive.
23850
23851 Reply:
23852 @table @samp
23853 @item OK
23854 thread is still alive
23855 @item E @var{NN}
23856 thread is dead
23857 @end table
23858
23859 @item v
23860 Packets starting with @samp{v} are identified by a multi-letter name,
23861 up to the first @samp{;} or @samp{?} (or the end of the packet).
23862
23863 @item vAttach;@var{pid}
23864 @cindex @samp{vAttach} packet
23865 Attach to a new process with the specified process ID. @var{pid} is a
23866 hexadecimal integer identifying the process. If the stub is currently
23867 controlling a process, it is killed. The attached process is stopped.
23868
23869 This packet is only available in extended mode (@pxref{extended mode}).
23870
23871 Reply:
23872 @table @samp
23873 @item E @var{nn}
23874 for an error
23875 @item @r{Any stop packet}
23876 for success (@pxref{Stop Reply Packets})
23877 @end table
23878
23879 @item vCont@r{[};@var{action}@r{[}:@var{tid}@r{]]}@dots{}
23880 @cindex @samp{vCont} packet
23881 Resume the inferior, specifying different actions for each thread.
23882 If an action is specified with no @var{tid}, then it is applied to any
23883 threads that don't have a specific action specified; if no default action is
23884 specified then other threads should remain stopped. Specifying multiple
23885 default actions is an error; specifying no actions is also an error.
23886 Thread IDs are specified in hexadecimal. Currently supported actions are:
23887
23888 @table @samp
23889 @item c
23890 Continue.
23891 @item C @var{sig}
23892 Continue with signal @var{sig}. @var{sig} should be two hex digits.
23893 @item s
23894 Step.
23895 @item S @var{sig}
23896 Step with signal @var{sig}. @var{sig} should be two hex digits.
23897 @end table
23898
23899 The optional @var{addr} argument normally associated with these packets is
23900 not supported in @samp{vCont}.
23901
23902 Reply:
23903 @xref{Stop Reply Packets}, for the reply specifications.
23904
23905 @item vCont?
23906 @cindex @samp{vCont?} packet
23907 Request a list of actions supported by the @samp{vCont} packet.
23908
23909 Reply:
23910 @table @samp
23911 @item vCont@r{[};@var{action}@dots{}@r{]}
23912 The @samp{vCont} packet is supported. Each @var{action} is a supported
23913 command in the @samp{vCont} packet.
23914 @item
23915 The @samp{vCont} packet is not supported.
23916 @end table
23917
23918 @item vFile:@var{operation}:@var{parameter}@dots{}
23919 @cindex @samp{vFile} packet
23920 Perform a file operation on the target system. For details,
23921 see @ref{Host I/O Packets}.
23922
23923 @item vFlashErase:@var{addr},@var{length}
23924 @cindex @samp{vFlashErase} packet
23925 Direct the stub to erase @var{length} bytes of flash starting at
23926 @var{addr}. The region may enclose any number of flash blocks, but
23927 its start and end must fall on block boundaries, as indicated by the
23928 flash block size appearing in the memory map (@pxref{Memory Map
23929 Format}). @value{GDBN} groups flash memory programming operations
23930 together, and sends a @samp{vFlashDone} request after each group; the
23931 stub is allowed to delay erase operation until the @samp{vFlashDone}
23932 packet is received.
23933
23934 Reply:
23935 @table @samp
23936 @item OK
23937 for success
23938 @item E @var{NN}
23939 for an error
23940 @end table
23941
23942 @item vFlashWrite:@var{addr}:@var{XX@dots{}}
23943 @cindex @samp{vFlashWrite} packet
23944 Direct the stub to write data to flash address @var{addr}. The data
23945 is passed in binary form using the same encoding as for the @samp{X}
23946 packet (@pxref{Binary Data}). The memory ranges specified by
23947 @samp{vFlashWrite} packets preceding a @samp{vFlashDone} packet must
23948 not overlap, and must appear in order of increasing addresses
23949 (although @samp{vFlashErase} packets for higher addresses may already
23950 have been received; the ordering is guaranteed only between
23951 @samp{vFlashWrite} packets). If a packet writes to an address that was
23952 neither erased by a preceding @samp{vFlashErase} packet nor by some other
23953 target-specific method, the results are unpredictable.
23954
23955
23956 Reply:
23957 @table @samp
23958 @item OK
23959 for success
23960 @item E.memtype
23961 for vFlashWrite addressing non-flash memory
23962 @item E @var{NN}
23963 for an error
23964 @end table
23965
23966 @item vFlashDone
23967 @cindex @samp{vFlashDone} packet
23968 Indicate to the stub that flash programming operation is finished.
23969 The stub is permitted to delay or batch the effects of a group of
23970 @samp{vFlashErase} and @samp{vFlashWrite} packets until a
23971 @samp{vFlashDone} packet is received. The contents of the affected
23972 regions of flash memory are unpredictable until the @samp{vFlashDone}
23973 request is completed.
23974
23975 @item vRun;@var{filename}@r{[};@var{argument}@r{]}@dots{}
23976 @cindex @samp{vRun} packet
23977 Run the program @var{filename}, passing it each @var{argument} on its
23978 command line. The file and arguments are hex-encoded strings. If
23979 @var{filename} is an empty string, the stub may use a default program
23980 (e.g.@: the last program run). The program is created in the stopped
23981 state. If the stub is currently controlling a process, it is killed.
23982
23983 This packet is only available in extended mode (@pxref{extended mode}).
23984
23985 Reply:
23986 @table @samp
23987 @item E @var{nn}
23988 for an error
23989 @item @r{Any stop packet}
23990 for success (@pxref{Stop Reply Packets})
23991 @end table
23992
23993 @item X @var{addr},@var{length}:@var{XX@dots{}}
23994 @anchor{X packet}
23995 @cindex @samp{X} packet
23996 Write data to memory, where the data is transmitted in binary.
23997 @var{addr} is address, @var{length} is number of bytes,
23998 @samp{@var{XX}@dots{}} is binary data (@pxref{Binary Data}).
23999
24000 Reply:
24001 @table @samp
24002 @item OK
24003 for success
24004 @item E @var{NN}
24005 for an error
24006 @end table
24007
24008 @item z @var{type},@var{addr},@var{length}
24009 @itemx Z @var{type},@var{addr},@var{length}
24010 @anchor{insert breakpoint or watchpoint packet}
24011 @cindex @samp{z} packet
24012 @cindex @samp{Z} packets
24013 Insert (@samp{Z}) or remove (@samp{z}) a @var{type} breakpoint or
24014 watchpoint starting at address @var{address} and covering the next
24015 @var{length} bytes.
24016
24017 Each breakpoint and watchpoint packet @var{type} is documented
24018 separately.
24019
24020 @emph{Implementation notes: A remote target shall return an empty string
24021 for an unrecognized breakpoint or watchpoint packet @var{type}. A
24022 remote target shall support either both or neither of a given
24023 @samp{Z@var{type}@dots{}} and @samp{z@var{type}@dots{}} packet pair. To
24024 avoid potential problems with duplicate packets, the operations should
24025 be implemented in an idempotent way.}
24026
24027 @item z0,@var{addr},@var{length}
24028 @itemx Z0,@var{addr},@var{length}
24029 @cindex @samp{z0} packet
24030 @cindex @samp{Z0} packet
24031 Insert (@samp{Z0}) or remove (@samp{z0}) a memory breakpoint at address
24032 @var{addr} of size @var{length}.
24033
24034 A memory breakpoint is implemented by replacing the instruction at
24035 @var{addr} with a software breakpoint or trap instruction. The
24036 @var{length} is used by targets that indicates the size of the
24037 breakpoint (in bytes) that should be inserted (e.g., the @sc{arm} and
24038 @sc{mips} can insert either a 2 or 4 byte breakpoint).
24039
24040 @emph{Implementation note: It is possible for a target to copy or move
24041 code that contains memory breakpoints (e.g., when implementing
24042 overlays). The behavior of this packet, in the presence of such a
24043 target, is not defined.}
24044
24045 Reply:
24046 @table @samp
24047 @item OK
24048 success
24049 @item
24050 not supported
24051 @item E @var{NN}
24052 for an error
24053 @end table
24054
24055 @item z1,@var{addr},@var{length}
24056 @itemx Z1,@var{addr},@var{length}
24057 @cindex @samp{z1} packet
24058 @cindex @samp{Z1} packet
24059 Insert (@samp{Z1}) or remove (@samp{z1}) a hardware breakpoint at
24060 address @var{addr} of size @var{length}.
24061
24062 A hardware breakpoint is implemented using a mechanism that is not
24063 dependant on being able to modify the target's memory.
24064
24065 @emph{Implementation note: A hardware breakpoint is not affected by code
24066 movement.}
24067
24068 Reply:
24069 @table @samp
24070 @item OK
24071 success
24072 @item
24073 not supported
24074 @item E @var{NN}
24075 for an error
24076 @end table
24077
24078 @item z2,@var{addr},@var{length}
24079 @itemx Z2,@var{addr},@var{length}
24080 @cindex @samp{z2} packet
24081 @cindex @samp{Z2} packet
24082 Insert (@samp{Z2}) or remove (@samp{z2}) a write watchpoint.
24083
24084 Reply:
24085 @table @samp
24086 @item OK
24087 success
24088 @item
24089 not supported
24090 @item E @var{NN}
24091 for an error
24092 @end table
24093
24094 @item z3,@var{addr},@var{length}
24095 @itemx Z3,@var{addr},@var{length}
24096 @cindex @samp{z3} packet
24097 @cindex @samp{Z3} packet
24098 Insert (@samp{Z3}) or remove (@samp{z3}) a read watchpoint.
24099
24100 Reply:
24101 @table @samp
24102 @item OK
24103 success
24104 @item
24105 not supported
24106 @item E @var{NN}
24107 for an error
24108 @end table
24109
24110 @item z4,@var{addr},@var{length}
24111 @itemx Z4,@var{addr},@var{length}
24112 @cindex @samp{z4} packet
24113 @cindex @samp{Z4} packet
24114 Insert (@samp{Z4}) or remove (@samp{z4}) an access watchpoint.
24115
24116 Reply:
24117 @table @samp
24118 @item OK
24119 success
24120 @item
24121 not supported
24122 @item E @var{NN}
24123 for an error
24124 @end table
24125
24126 @end table
24127
24128 @node Stop Reply Packets
24129 @section Stop Reply Packets
24130 @cindex stop reply packets
24131
24132 The @samp{C}, @samp{c}, @samp{S}, @samp{s} and @samp{?} packets can
24133 receive any of the below as a reply. In the case of the @samp{C},
24134 @samp{c}, @samp{S} and @samp{s} packets, that reply is only returned
24135 when the target halts. In the below the exact meaning of @dfn{signal
24136 number} is defined by the header @file{include/gdb/signals.h} in the
24137 @value{GDBN} source code.
24138
24139 As in the description of request packets, we include spaces in the
24140 reply templates for clarity; these are not part of the reply packet's
24141 syntax. No @value{GDBN} stop reply packet uses spaces to separate its
24142 components.
24143
24144 @table @samp
24145
24146 @item S @var{AA}
24147 The program received signal number @var{AA} (a two-digit hexadecimal
24148 number). This is equivalent to a @samp{T} response with no
24149 @var{n}:@var{r} pairs.
24150
24151 @item T @var{AA} @var{n1}:@var{r1};@var{n2}:@var{r2};@dots{}
24152 @cindex @samp{T} packet reply
24153 The program received signal number @var{AA} (a two-digit hexadecimal
24154 number). This is equivalent to an @samp{S} response, except that the
24155 @samp{@var{n}:@var{r}} pairs can carry values of important registers
24156 and other information directly in the stop reply packet, reducing
24157 round-trip latency. Single-step and breakpoint traps are reported
24158 this way. Each @samp{@var{n}:@var{r}} pair is interpreted as follows:
24159
24160 @itemize @bullet
24161 @item
24162 If @var{n} is a hexadecimal number, it is a register number, and the
24163 corresponding @var{r} gives that register's value. @var{r} is a
24164 series of bytes in target byte order, with each byte given by a
24165 two-digit hex number.
24166
24167 @item
24168 If @var{n} is @samp{thread}, then @var{r} is the thread process ID, in
24169 hex.
24170
24171 @item
24172 If @var{n} is a recognized @dfn{stop reason}, it describes a more
24173 specific event that stopped the target. The currently defined stop
24174 reasons are listed below. @var{aa} should be @samp{05}, the trap
24175 signal. At most one stop reason should be present.
24176
24177 @item
24178 Otherwise, @value{GDBN} should ignore this @samp{@var{n}:@var{r}} pair
24179 and go on to the next; this allows us to extend the protocol in the
24180 future.
24181 @end itemize
24182
24183 The currently defined stop reasons are:
24184
24185 @table @samp
24186 @item watch
24187 @itemx rwatch
24188 @itemx awatch
24189 The packet indicates a watchpoint hit, and @var{r} is the data address, in
24190 hex.
24191
24192 @cindex shared library events, remote reply
24193 @item library
24194 The packet indicates that the loaded libraries have changed.
24195 @value{GDBN} should use @samp{qXfer:libraries:read} to fetch a new
24196 list of loaded libraries. @var{r} is ignored.
24197 @end table
24198
24199 @item W @var{AA}
24200 The process exited, and @var{AA} is the exit status. This is only
24201 applicable to certain targets.
24202
24203 @item X @var{AA}
24204 The process terminated with signal @var{AA}.
24205
24206 @item O @var{XX}@dots{}
24207 @samp{@var{XX}@dots{}} is hex encoding of @sc{ascii} data, to be
24208 written as the program's console output. This can happen at any time
24209 while the program is running and the debugger should continue to wait
24210 for @samp{W}, @samp{T}, etc.
24211
24212 @item F @var{call-id},@var{parameter}@dots{}
24213 @var{call-id} is the identifier which says which host system call should
24214 be called. This is just the name of the function. Translation into the
24215 correct system call is only applicable as it's defined in @value{GDBN}.
24216 @xref{File-I/O Remote Protocol Extension}, for a list of implemented
24217 system calls.
24218
24219 @samp{@var{parameter}@dots{}} is a list of parameters as defined for
24220 this very system call.
24221
24222 The target replies with this packet when it expects @value{GDBN} to
24223 call a host system call on behalf of the target. @value{GDBN} replies
24224 with an appropriate @samp{F} packet and keeps up waiting for the next
24225 reply packet from the target. The latest @samp{C}, @samp{c}, @samp{S}
24226 or @samp{s} action is expected to be continued. @xref{File-I/O Remote
24227 Protocol Extension}, for more details.
24228
24229 @end table
24230
24231 @node General Query Packets
24232 @section General Query Packets
24233 @cindex remote query requests
24234
24235 Packets starting with @samp{q} are @dfn{general query packets};
24236 packets starting with @samp{Q} are @dfn{general set packets}. General
24237 query and set packets are a semi-unified form for retrieving and
24238 sending information to and from the stub.
24239
24240 The initial letter of a query or set packet is followed by a name
24241 indicating what sort of thing the packet applies to. For example,
24242 @value{GDBN} may use a @samp{qSymbol} packet to exchange symbol
24243 definitions with the stub. These packet names follow some
24244 conventions:
24245
24246 @itemize @bullet
24247 @item
24248 The name must not contain commas, colons or semicolons.
24249 @item
24250 Most @value{GDBN} query and set packets have a leading upper case
24251 letter.
24252 @item
24253 The names of custom vendor packets should use a company prefix, in
24254 lower case, followed by a period. For example, packets designed at
24255 the Acme Corporation might begin with @samp{qacme.foo} (for querying
24256 foos) or @samp{Qacme.bar} (for setting bars).
24257 @end itemize
24258
24259 The name of a query or set packet should be separated from any
24260 parameters by a @samp{:}; the parameters themselves should be
24261 separated by @samp{,} or @samp{;}. Stubs must be careful to match the
24262 full packet name, and check for a separator or the end of the packet,
24263 in case two packet names share a common prefix. New packets should not begin
24264 with @samp{qC}, @samp{qP}, or @samp{qL}@footnote{The @samp{qP} and @samp{qL}
24265 packets predate these conventions, and have arguments without any terminator
24266 for the packet name; we suspect they are in widespread use in places that
24267 are difficult to upgrade. The @samp{qC} packet has no arguments, but some
24268 existing stubs (e.g.@: RedBoot) are known to not check for the end of the
24269 packet.}.
24270
24271 Like the descriptions of the other packets, each description here
24272 has a template showing the packet's overall syntax, followed by an
24273 explanation of the packet's meaning. We include spaces in some of the
24274 templates for clarity; these are not part of the packet's syntax. No
24275 @value{GDBN} packet uses spaces to separate its components.
24276
24277 Here are the currently defined query and set packets:
24278
24279 @table @samp
24280
24281 @item qC
24282 @cindex current thread, remote request
24283 @cindex @samp{qC} packet
24284 Return the current thread id.
24285
24286 Reply:
24287 @table @samp
24288 @item QC @var{pid}
24289 Where @var{pid} is an unsigned hexadecimal process id.
24290 @item @r{(anything else)}
24291 Any other reply implies the old pid.
24292 @end table
24293
24294 @item qCRC:@var{addr},@var{length}
24295 @cindex CRC of memory block, remote request
24296 @cindex @samp{qCRC} packet
24297 Compute the CRC checksum of a block of memory.
24298 Reply:
24299 @table @samp
24300 @item E @var{NN}
24301 An error (such as memory fault)
24302 @item C @var{crc32}
24303 The specified memory region's checksum is @var{crc32}.
24304 @end table
24305
24306 @item qfThreadInfo
24307 @itemx qsThreadInfo
24308 @cindex list active threads, remote request
24309 @cindex @samp{qfThreadInfo} packet
24310 @cindex @samp{qsThreadInfo} packet
24311 Obtain a list of all active thread ids from the target (OS). Since there
24312 may be too many active threads to fit into one reply packet, this query
24313 works iteratively: it may require more than one query/reply sequence to
24314 obtain the entire list of threads. The first query of the sequence will
24315 be the @samp{qfThreadInfo} query; subsequent queries in the
24316 sequence will be the @samp{qsThreadInfo} query.
24317
24318 NOTE: This packet replaces the @samp{qL} query (see below).
24319
24320 Reply:
24321 @table @samp
24322 @item m @var{id}
24323 A single thread id
24324 @item m @var{id},@var{id}@dots{}
24325 a comma-separated list of thread ids
24326 @item l
24327 (lower case letter @samp{L}) denotes end of list.
24328 @end table
24329
24330 In response to each query, the target will reply with a list of one or
24331 more thread ids, in big-endian unsigned hex, separated by commas.
24332 @value{GDBN} will respond to each reply with a request for more thread
24333 ids (using the @samp{qs} form of the query), until the target responds
24334 with @samp{l} (lower-case el, for @dfn{last}).
24335
24336 @item qGetTLSAddr:@var{thread-id},@var{offset},@var{lm}
24337 @cindex get thread-local storage address, remote request
24338 @cindex @samp{qGetTLSAddr} packet
24339 Fetch the address associated with thread local storage specified
24340 by @var{thread-id}, @var{offset}, and @var{lm}.
24341
24342 @var{thread-id} is the (big endian, hex encoded) thread id associated with the
24343 thread for which to fetch the TLS address.
24344
24345 @var{offset} is the (big endian, hex encoded) offset associated with the
24346 thread local variable. (This offset is obtained from the debug
24347 information associated with the variable.)
24348
24349 @var{lm} is the (big endian, hex encoded) OS/ABI-specific encoding of the
24350 the load module associated with the thread local storage. For example,
24351 a @sc{gnu}/Linux system will pass the link map address of the shared
24352 object associated with the thread local storage under consideration.
24353 Other operating environments may choose to represent the load module
24354 differently, so the precise meaning of this parameter will vary.
24355
24356 Reply:
24357 @table @samp
24358 @item @var{XX}@dots{}
24359 Hex encoded (big endian) bytes representing the address of the thread
24360 local storage requested.
24361
24362 @item E @var{nn}
24363 An error occurred. @var{nn} are hex digits.
24364
24365 @item
24366 An empty reply indicates that @samp{qGetTLSAddr} is not supported by the stub.
24367 @end table
24368
24369 @item qL @var{startflag} @var{threadcount} @var{nextthread}
24370 Obtain thread information from RTOS. Where: @var{startflag} (one hex
24371 digit) is one to indicate the first query and zero to indicate a
24372 subsequent query; @var{threadcount} (two hex digits) is the maximum
24373 number of threads the response packet can contain; and @var{nextthread}
24374 (eight hex digits), for subsequent queries (@var{startflag} is zero), is
24375 returned in the response as @var{argthread}.
24376
24377 Don't use this packet; use the @samp{qfThreadInfo} query instead (see above).
24378
24379 Reply:
24380 @table @samp
24381 @item qM @var{count} @var{done} @var{argthread} @var{thread}@dots{}
24382 Where: @var{count} (two hex digits) is the number of threads being
24383 returned; @var{done} (one hex digit) is zero to indicate more threads
24384 and one indicates no further threads; @var{argthreadid} (eight hex
24385 digits) is @var{nextthread} from the request packet; @var{thread}@dots{}
24386 is a sequence of thread IDs from the target. @var{threadid} (eight hex
24387 digits). See @code{remote.c:parse_threadlist_response()}.
24388 @end table
24389
24390 @item qOffsets
24391 @cindex section offsets, remote request
24392 @cindex @samp{qOffsets} packet
24393 Get section offsets that the target used when relocating the downloaded
24394 image.
24395
24396 Reply:
24397 @table @samp
24398 @item Text=@var{xxx};Data=@var{yyy}@r{[};Bss=@var{zzz}@r{]}
24399 Relocate the @code{Text} section by @var{xxx} from its original address.
24400 Relocate the @code{Data} section by @var{yyy} from its original address.
24401 If the object file format provides segment information (e.g.@: @sc{elf}
24402 @samp{PT_LOAD} program headers), @value{GDBN} will relocate entire
24403 segments by the supplied offsets.
24404
24405 @emph{Note: while a @code{Bss} offset may be included in the response,
24406 @value{GDBN} ignores this and instead applies the @code{Data} offset
24407 to the @code{Bss} section.}
24408
24409 @item TextSeg=@var{xxx}@r{[};DataSeg=@var{yyy}@r{]}
24410 Relocate the first segment of the object file, which conventionally
24411 contains program code, to a starting address of @var{xxx}. If
24412 @samp{DataSeg} is specified, relocate the second segment, which
24413 conventionally contains modifiable data, to a starting address of
24414 @var{yyy}. @value{GDBN} will report an error if the object file
24415 does not contain segment information, or does not contain at least
24416 as many segments as mentioned in the reply. Extra segments are
24417 kept at fixed offsets relative to the last relocated segment.
24418 @end table
24419
24420 @item qP @var{mode} @var{threadid}
24421 @cindex thread information, remote request
24422 @cindex @samp{qP} packet
24423 Returns information on @var{threadid}. Where: @var{mode} is a hex
24424 encoded 32 bit mode; @var{threadid} is a hex encoded 64 bit thread ID.
24425
24426 Don't use this packet; use the @samp{qThreadExtraInfo} query instead
24427 (see below).
24428
24429 Reply: see @code{remote.c:remote_unpack_thread_info_response()}.
24430
24431 @item QPassSignals: @var{signal} @r{[};@var{signal}@r{]}@dots{}
24432 @cindex pass signals to inferior, remote request
24433 @cindex @samp{QPassSignals} packet
24434 @anchor{QPassSignals}
24435 Each listed @var{signal} should be passed directly to the inferior process.
24436 Signals are numbered identically to continue packets and stop replies
24437 (@pxref{Stop Reply Packets}). Each @var{signal} list item should be
24438 strictly greater than the previous item. These signals do not need to stop
24439 the inferior, or be reported to @value{GDBN}. All other signals should be
24440 reported to @value{GDBN}. Multiple @samp{QPassSignals} packets do not
24441 combine; any earlier @samp{QPassSignals} list is completely replaced by the
24442 new list. This packet improves performance when using @samp{handle
24443 @var{signal} nostop noprint pass}.
24444
24445 Reply:
24446 @table @samp
24447 @item OK
24448 The request succeeded.
24449
24450 @item E @var{nn}
24451 An error occurred. @var{nn} are hex digits.
24452
24453 @item
24454 An empty reply indicates that @samp{QPassSignals} is not supported by
24455 the stub.
24456 @end table
24457
24458 Use of this packet is controlled by the @code{set remote pass-signals}
24459 command (@pxref{Remote Configuration, set remote pass-signals}).
24460 This packet is not probed by default; the remote stub must request it,
24461 by supplying an appropriate @samp{qSupported} response (@pxref{qSupported}).
24462
24463 @item qRcmd,@var{command}
24464 @cindex execute remote command, remote request
24465 @cindex @samp{qRcmd} packet
24466 @var{command} (hex encoded) is passed to the local interpreter for
24467 execution. Invalid commands should be reported using the output
24468 string. Before the final result packet, the target may also respond
24469 with a number of intermediate @samp{O@var{output}} console output
24470 packets. @emph{Implementors should note that providing access to a
24471 stubs's interpreter may have security implications}.
24472
24473 Reply:
24474 @table @samp
24475 @item OK
24476 A command response with no output.
24477 @item @var{OUTPUT}
24478 A command response with the hex encoded output string @var{OUTPUT}.
24479 @item E @var{NN}
24480 Indicate a badly formed request.
24481 @item
24482 An empty reply indicates that @samp{qRcmd} is not recognized.
24483 @end table
24484
24485 (Note that the @code{qRcmd} packet's name is separated from the
24486 command by a @samp{,}, not a @samp{:}, contrary to the naming
24487 conventions above. Please don't use this packet as a model for new
24488 packets.)
24489
24490 @item qSupported @r{[}:@var{gdbfeature} @r{[};@var{gdbfeature}@r{]}@dots{} @r{]}
24491 @cindex supported packets, remote query
24492 @cindex features of the remote protocol
24493 @cindex @samp{qSupported} packet
24494 @anchor{qSupported}
24495 Tell the remote stub about features supported by @value{GDBN}, and
24496 query the stub for features it supports. This packet allows
24497 @value{GDBN} and the remote stub to take advantage of each others'
24498 features. @samp{qSupported} also consolidates multiple feature probes
24499 at startup, to improve @value{GDBN} performance---a single larger
24500 packet performs better than multiple smaller probe packets on
24501 high-latency links. Some features may enable behavior which must not
24502 be on by default, e.g.@: because it would confuse older clients or
24503 stubs. Other features may describe packets which could be
24504 automatically probed for, but are not. These features must be
24505 reported before @value{GDBN} will use them. This ``default
24506 unsupported'' behavior is not appropriate for all packets, but it
24507 helps to keep the initial connection time under control with new
24508 versions of @value{GDBN} which support increasing numbers of packets.
24509
24510 Reply:
24511 @table @samp
24512 @item @var{stubfeature} @r{[};@var{stubfeature}@r{]}@dots{}
24513 The stub supports or does not support each returned @var{stubfeature},
24514 depending on the form of each @var{stubfeature} (see below for the
24515 possible forms).
24516 @item
24517 An empty reply indicates that @samp{qSupported} is not recognized,
24518 or that no features needed to be reported to @value{GDBN}.
24519 @end table
24520
24521 The allowed forms for each feature (either a @var{gdbfeature} in the
24522 @samp{qSupported} packet, or a @var{stubfeature} in the response)
24523 are:
24524
24525 @table @samp
24526 @item @var{name}=@var{value}
24527 The remote protocol feature @var{name} is supported, and associated
24528 with the specified @var{value}. The format of @var{value} depends
24529 on the feature, but it must not include a semicolon.
24530 @item @var{name}+
24531 The remote protocol feature @var{name} is supported, and does not
24532 need an associated value.
24533 @item @var{name}-
24534 The remote protocol feature @var{name} is not supported.
24535 @item @var{name}?
24536 The remote protocol feature @var{name} may be supported, and
24537 @value{GDBN} should auto-detect support in some other way when it is
24538 needed. This form will not be used for @var{gdbfeature} notifications,
24539 but may be used for @var{stubfeature} responses.
24540 @end table
24541
24542 Whenever the stub receives a @samp{qSupported} request, the
24543 supplied set of @value{GDBN} features should override any previous
24544 request. This allows @value{GDBN} to put the stub in a known
24545 state, even if the stub had previously been communicating with
24546 a different version of @value{GDBN}.
24547
24548 No values of @var{gdbfeature} (for the packet sent by @value{GDBN})
24549 are defined yet. Stubs should ignore any unknown values for
24550 @var{gdbfeature}. Any @value{GDBN} which sends a @samp{qSupported}
24551 packet supports receiving packets of unlimited length (earlier
24552 versions of @value{GDBN} may reject overly long responses). Values
24553 for @var{gdbfeature} may be defined in the future to let the stub take
24554 advantage of new features in @value{GDBN}, e.g.@: incompatible
24555 improvements in the remote protocol---support for unlimited length
24556 responses would be a @var{gdbfeature} example, if it were not implied by
24557 the @samp{qSupported} query. The stub's reply should be independent
24558 of the @var{gdbfeature} entries sent by @value{GDBN}; first @value{GDBN}
24559 describes all the features it supports, and then the stub replies with
24560 all the features it supports.
24561
24562 Similarly, @value{GDBN} will silently ignore unrecognized stub feature
24563 responses, as long as each response uses one of the standard forms.
24564
24565 Some features are flags. A stub which supports a flag feature
24566 should respond with a @samp{+} form response. Other features
24567 require values, and the stub should respond with an @samp{=}
24568 form response.
24569
24570 Each feature has a default value, which @value{GDBN} will use if
24571 @samp{qSupported} is not available or if the feature is not mentioned
24572 in the @samp{qSupported} response. The default values are fixed; a
24573 stub is free to omit any feature responses that match the defaults.
24574
24575 Not all features can be probed, but for those which can, the probing
24576 mechanism is useful: in some cases, a stub's internal
24577 architecture may not allow the protocol layer to know some information
24578 about the underlying target in advance. This is especially common in
24579 stubs which may be configured for multiple targets.
24580
24581 These are the currently defined stub features and their properties:
24582
24583 @multitable @columnfractions 0.35 0.2 0.12 0.2
24584 @c NOTE: The first row should be @headitem, but we do not yet require
24585 @c a new enough version of Texinfo (4.7) to use @headitem.
24586 @item Feature Name
24587 @tab Value Required
24588 @tab Default
24589 @tab Probe Allowed
24590
24591 @item @samp{PacketSize}
24592 @tab Yes
24593 @tab @samp{-}
24594 @tab No
24595
24596 @item @samp{qXfer:auxv:read}
24597 @tab No
24598 @tab @samp{-}
24599 @tab Yes
24600
24601 @item @samp{qXfer:features:read}
24602 @tab No
24603 @tab @samp{-}
24604 @tab Yes
24605
24606 @item @samp{qXfer:libraries:read}
24607 @tab No
24608 @tab @samp{-}
24609 @tab Yes
24610
24611 @item @samp{qXfer:memory-map:read}
24612 @tab No
24613 @tab @samp{-}
24614 @tab Yes
24615
24616 @item @samp{qXfer:spu:read}
24617 @tab No
24618 @tab @samp{-}
24619 @tab Yes
24620
24621 @item @samp{qXfer:spu:write}
24622 @tab No
24623 @tab @samp{-}
24624 @tab Yes
24625
24626 @item @samp{QPassSignals}
24627 @tab No
24628 @tab @samp{-}
24629 @tab Yes
24630
24631 @end multitable
24632
24633 These are the currently defined stub features, in more detail:
24634
24635 @table @samp
24636 @cindex packet size, remote protocol
24637 @item PacketSize=@var{bytes}
24638 The remote stub can accept packets up to at least @var{bytes} in
24639 length. @value{GDBN} will send packets up to this size for bulk
24640 transfers, and will never send larger packets. This is a limit on the
24641 data characters in the packet, including the frame and checksum.
24642 There is no trailing NUL byte in a remote protocol packet; if the stub
24643 stores packets in a NUL-terminated format, it should allow an extra
24644 byte in its buffer for the NUL. If this stub feature is not supported,
24645 @value{GDBN} guesses based on the size of the @samp{g} packet response.
24646
24647 @item qXfer:auxv:read
24648 The remote stub understands the @samp{qXfer:auxv:read} packet
24649 (@pxref{qXfer auxiliary vector read}).
24650
24651 @item qXfer:features:read
24652 The remote stub understands the @samp{qXfer:features:read} packet
24653 (@pxref{qXfer target description read}).
24654
24655 @item qXfer:libraries:read
24656 The remote stub understands the @samp{qXfer:libraries:read} packet
24657 (@pxref{qXfer library list read}).
24658
24659 @item qXfer:memory-map:read
24660 The remote stub understands the @samp{qXfer:memory-map:read} packet
24661 (@pxref{qXfer memory map read}).
24662
24663 @item qXfer:spu:read
24664 The remote stub understands the @samp{qXfer:spu:read} packet
24665 (@pxref{qXfer spu read}).
24666
24667 @item qXfer:spu:write
24668 The remote stub understands the @samp{qXfer:spu:write} packet
24669 (@pxref{qXfer spu write}).
24670
24671 @item QPassSignals
24672 The remote stub understands the @samp{QPassSignals} packet
24673 (@pxref{QPassSignals}).
24674
24675 @end table
24676
24677 @item qSymbol::
24678 @cindex symbol lookup, remote request
24679 @cindex @samp{qSymbol} packet
24680 Notify the target that @value{GDBN} is prepared to serve symbol lookup
24681 requests. Accept requests from the target for the values of symbols.
24682
24683 Reply:
24684 @table @samp
24685 @item OK
24686 The target does not need to look up any (more) symbols.
24687 @item qSymbol:@var{sym_name}
24688 The target requests the value of symbol @var{sym_name} (hex encoded).
24689 @value{GDBN} may provide the value by using the
24690 @samp{qSymbol:@var{sym_value}:@var{sym_name}} message, described
24691 below.
24692 @end table
24693
24694 @item qSymbol:@var{sym_value}:@var{sym_name}
24695 Set the value of @var{sym_name} to @var{sym_value}.
24696
24697 @var{sym_name} (hex encoded) is the name of a symbol whose value the
24698 target has previously requested.
24699
24700 @var{sym_value} (hex) is the value for symbol @var{sym_name}. If
24701 @value{GDBN} cannot supply a value for @var{sym_name}, then this field
24702 will be empty.
24703
24704 Reply:
24705 @table @samp
24706 @item OK
24707 The target does not need to look up any (more) symbols.
24708 @item qSymbol:@var{sym_name}
24709 The target requests the value of a new symbol @var{sym_name} (hex
24710 encoded). @value{GDBN} will continue to supply the values of symbols
24711 (if available), until the target ceases to request them.
24712 @end table
24713
24714 @item QTDP
24715 @itemx QTFrame
24716 @xref{Tracepoint Packets}.
24717
24718 @item qThreadExtraInfo,@var{id}
24719 @cindex thread attributes info, remote request
24720 @cindex @samp{qThreadExtraInfo} packet
24721 Obtain a printable string description of a thread's attributes from
24722 the target OS. @var{id} is a thread-id in big-endian hex. This
24723 string may contain anything that the target OS thinks is interesting
24724 for @value{GDBN} to tell the user about the thread. The string is
24725 displayed in @value{GDBN}'s @code{info threads} display. Some
24726 examples of possible thread extra info strings are @samp{Runnable}, or
24727 @samp{Blocked on Mutex}.
24728
24729 Reply:
24730 @table @samp
24731 @item @var{XX}@dots{}
24732 Where @samp{@var{XX}@dots{}} is a hex encoding of @sc{ascii} data,
24733 comprising the printable string containing the extra information about
24734 the thread's attributes.
24735 @end table
24736
24737 (Note that the @code{qThreadExtraInfo} packet's name is separated from
24738 the command by a @samp{,}, not a @samp{:}, contrary to the naming
24739 conventions above. Please don't use this packet as a model for new
24740 packets.)
24741
24742 @item QTStart
24743 @itemx QTStop
24744 @itemx QTinit
24745 @itemx QTro
24746 @itemx qTStatus
24747 @xref{Tracepoint Packets}.
24748
24749 @item qXfer:@var{object}:read:@var{annex}:@var{offset},@var{length}
24750 @cindex read special object, remote request
24751 @cindex @samp{qXfer} packet
24752 @anchor{qXfer read}
24753 Read uninterpreted bytes from the target's special data area
24754 identified by the keyword @var{object}. Request @var{length} bytes
24755 starting at @var{offset} bytes into the data. The content and
24756 encoding of @var{annex} is specific to @var{object}; it can supply
24757 additional details about what data to access.
24758
24759 Here are the specific requests of this form defined so far. All
24760 @samp{qXfer:@var{object}:read:@dots{}} requests use the same reply
24761 formats, listed below.
24762
24763 @table @samp
24764 @item qXfer:auxv:read::@var{offset},@var{length}
24765 @anchor{qXfer auxiliary vector read}
24766 Access the target's @dfn{auxiliary vector}. @xref{OS Information,
24767 auxiliary vector}. Note @var{annex} must be empty.
24768
24769 This packet is not probed by default; the remote stub must request it,
24770 by supplying an appropriate @samp{qSupported} response (@pxref{qSupported}).
24771
24772 @item qXfer:features:read:@var{annex}:@var{offset},@var{length}
24773 @anchor{qXfer target description read}
24774 Access the @dfn{target description}. @xref{Target Descriptions}. The
24775 annex specifies which XML document to access. The main description is
24776 always loaded from the @samp{target.xml} annex.
24777
24778 This packet is not probed by default; the remote stub must request it,
24779 by supplying an appropriate @samp{qSupported} response (@pxref{qSupported}).
24780
24781 @item qXfer:libraries:read:@var{annex}:@var{offset},@var{length}
24782 @anchor{qXfer library list read}
24783 Access the target's list of loaded libraries. @xref{Library List Format}.
24784 The annex part of the generic @samp{qXfer} packet must be empty
24785 (@pxref{qXfer read}).
24786
24787 Targets which maintain a list of libraries in the program's memory do
24788 not need to implement this packet; it is designed for platforms where
24789 the operating system manages the list of loaded libraries.
24790
24791 This packet is not probed by default; the remote stub must request it,
24792 by supplying an appropriate @samp{qSupported} response (@pxref{qSupported}).
24793
24794 @item qXfer:memory-map:read::@var{offset},@var{length}
24795 @anchor{qXfer memory map read}
24796 Access the target's @dfn{memory-map}. @xref{Memory Map Format}. The
24797 annex part of the generic @samp{qXfer} packet must be empty
24798 (@pxref{qXfer read}).
24799
24800 This packet is not probed by default; the remote stub must request it,
24801 by supplying an appropriate @samp{qSupported} response (@pxref{qSupported}).
24802
24803 @item qXfer:spu:read:@var{annex}:@var{offset},@var{length}
24804 @anchor{qXfer spu read}
24805 Read contents of an @code{spufs} file on the target system. The
24806 annex specifies which file to read; it must be of the form
24807 @file{@var{id}/@var{name}}, where @var{id} specifies an SPU context ID
24808 in the target process, and @var{name} identifes the @code{spufs} file
24809 in that context to be accessed.
24810
24811 This packet is not probed by default; the remote stub must request it,
24812 by supplying an appropriate @samp{qSupported} response (@pxref{qSupported}).
24813 @end table
24814
24815 Reply:
24816 @table @samp
24817 @item m @var{data}
24818 Data @var{data} (@pxref{Binary Data}) has been read from the
24819 target. There may be more data at a higher address (although
24820 it is permitted to return @samp{m} even for the last valid
24821 block of data, as long as at least one byte of data was read).
24822 @var{data} may have fewer bytes than the @var{length} in the
24823 request.
24824
24825 @item l @var{data}
24826 Data @var{data} (@pxref{Binary Data}) has been read from the target.
24827 There is no more data to be read. @var{data} may have fewer bytes
24828 than the @var{length} in the request.
24829
24830 @item l
24831 The @var{offset} in the request is at the end of the data.
24832 There is no more data to be read.
24833
24834 @item E00
24835 The request was malformed, or @var{annex} was invalid.
24836
24837 @item E @var{nn}
24838 The offset was invalid, or there was an error encountered reading the data.
24839 @var{nn} is a hex-encoded @code{errno} value.
24840
24841 @item
24842 An empty reply indicates the @var{object} string was not recognized by
24843 the stub, or that the object does not support reading.
24844 @end table
24845
24846 @item qXfer:@var{object}:write:@var{annex}:@var{offset}:@var{data}@dots{}
24847 @cindex write data into object, remote request
24848 Write uninterpreted bytes into the target's special data area
24849 identified by the keyword @var{object}, starting at @var{offset} bytes
24850 into the data. @var{data}@dots{} is the binary-encoded data
24851 (@pxref{Binary Data}) to be written. The content and encoding of @var{annex}
24852 is specific to @var{object}; it can supply additional details about what data
24853 to access.
24854
24855 Here are the specific requests of this form defined so far. All
24856 @samp{qXfer:@var{object}:write:@dots{}} requests use the same reply
24857 formats, listed below.
24858
24859 @table @samp
24860 @item qXfer:@var{spu}:write:@var{annex}:@var{offset}:@var{data}@dots{}
24861 @anchor{qXfer spu write}
24862 Write @var{data} to an @code{spufs} file on the target system. The
24863 annex specifies which file to write; it must be of the form
24864 @file{@var{id}/@var{name}}, where @var{id} specifies an SPU context ID
24865 in the target process, and @var{name} identifes the @code{spufs} file
24866 in that context to be accessed.
24867
24868 This packet is not probed by default; the remote stub must request it,
24869 by supplying an appropriate @samp{qSupported} response (@pxref{qSupported}).
24870 @end table
24871
24872 Reply:
24873 @table @samp
24874 @item @var{nn}
24875 @var{nn} (hex encoded) is the number of bytes written.
24876 This may be fewer bytes than supplied in the request.
24877
24878 @item E00
24879 The request was malformed, or @var{annex} was invalid.
24880
24881 @item E @var{nn}
24882 The offset was invalid, or there was an error encountered writing the data.
24883 @var{nn} is a hex-encoded @code{errno} value.
24884
24885 @item
24886 An empty reply indicates the @var{object} string was not
24887 recognized by the stub, or that the object does not support writing.
24888 @end table
24889
24890 @item qXfer:@var{object}:@var{operation}:@dots{}
24891 Requests of this form may be added in the future. When a stub does
24892 not recognize the @var{object} keyword, or its support for
24893 @var{object} does not recognize the @var{operation} keyword, the stub
24894 must respond with an empty packet.
24895
24896 @end table
24897
24898 @node Register Packet Format
24899 @section Register Packet Format
24900
24901 The following @code{g}/@code{G} packets have previously been defined.
24902 In the below, some thirty-two bit registers are transferred as
24903 sixty-four bits. Those registers should be zero/sign extended (which?)
24904 to fill the space allocated. Register bytes are transferred in target
24905 byte order. The two nibbles within a register byte are transferred
24906 most-significant - least-significant.
24907
24908 @table @r
24909
24910 @item MIPS32
24911
24912 All registers are transferred as thirty-two bit quantities in the order:
24913 32 general-purpose; sr; lo; hi; bad; cause; pc; 32 floating-point
24914 registers; fsr; fir; fp.
24915
24916 @item MIPS64
24917
24918 All registers are transferred as sixty-four bit quantities (including
24919 thirty-two bit registers such as @code{sr}). The ordering is the same
24920 as @code{MIPS32}.
24921
24922 @end table
24923
24924 @node Tracepoint Packets
24925 @section Tracepoint Packets
24926 @cindex tracepoint packets
24927 @cindex packets, tracepoint
24928
24929 Here we describe the packets @value{GDBN} uses to implement
24930 tracepoints (@pxref{Tracepoints}).
24931
24932 @table @samp
24933
24934 @item QTDP:@var{n}:@var{addr}:@var{ena}:@var{step}:@var{pass}@r{[}-@r{]}
24935 Create a new tracepoint, number @var{n}, at @var{addr}. If @var{ena}
24936 is @samp{E}, then the tracepoint is enabled; if it is @samp{D}, then
24937 the tracepoint is disabled. @var{step} is the tracepoint's step
24938 count, and @var{pass} is its pass count. If the trailing @samp{-} is
24939 present, further @samp{QTDP} packets will follow to specify this
24940 tracepoint's actions.
24941
24942 Replies:
24943 @table @samp
24944 @item OK
24945 The packet was understood and carried out.
24946 @item
24947 The packet was not recognized.
24948 @end table
24949
24950 @item QTDP:-@var{n}:@var{addr}:@r{[}S@r{]}@var{action}@dots{}@r{[}-@r{]}
24951 Define actions to be taken when a tracepoint is hit. @var{n} and
24952 @var{addr} must be the same as in the initial @samp{QTDP} packet for
24953 this tracepoint. This packet may only be sent immediately after
24954 another @samp{QTDP} packet that ended with a @samp{-}. If the
24955 trailing @samp{-} is present, further @samp{QTDP} packets will follow,
24956 specifying more actions for this tracepoint.
24957
24958 In the series of action packets for a given tracepoint, at most one
24959 can have an @samp{S} before its first @var{action}. If such a packet
24960 is sent, it and the following packets define ``while-stepping''
24961 actions. Any prior packets define ordinary actions --- that is, those
24962 taken when the tracepoint is first hit. If no action packet has an
24963 @samp{S}, then all the packets in the series specify ordinary
24964 tracepoint actions.
24965
24966 The @samp{@var{action}@dots{}} portion of the packet is a series of
24967 actions, concatenated without separators. Each action has one of the
24968 following forms:
24969
24970 @table @samp
24971
24972 @item R @var{mask}
24973 Collect the registers whose bits are set in @var{mask}. @var{mask} is
24974 a hexadecimal number whose @var{i}'th bit is set if register number
24975 @var{i} should be collected. (The least significant bit is numbered
24976 zero.) Note that @var{mask} may be any number of digits long; it may
24977 not fit in a 32-bit word.
24978
24979 @item M @var{basereg},@var{offset},@var{len}
24980 Collect @var{len} bytes of memory starting at the address in register
24981 number @var{basereg}, plus @var{offset}. If @var{basereg} is
24982 @samp{-1}, then the range has a fixed address: @var{offset} is the
24983 address of the lowest byte to collect. The @var{basereg},
24984 @var{offset}, and @var{len} parameters are all unsigned hexadecimal
24985 values (the @samp{-1} value for @var{basereg} is a special case).
24986
24987 @item X @var{len},@var{expr}
24988 Evaluate @var{expr}, whose length is @var{len}, and collect memory as
24989 it directs. @var{expr} is an agent expression, as described in
24990 @ref{Agent Expressions}. Each byte of the expression is encoded as a
24991 two-digit hex number in the packet; @var{len} is the number of bytes
24992 in the expression (and thus one-half the number of hex digits in the
24993 packet).
24994
24995 @end table
24996
24997 Any number of actions may be packed together in a single @samp{QTDP}
24998 packet, as long as the packet does not exceed the maximum packet
24999 length (400 bytes, for many stubs). There may be only one @samp{R}
25000 action per tracepoint, and it must precede any @samp{M} or @samp{X}
25001 actions. Any registers referred to by @samp{M} and @samp{X} actions
25002 must be collected by a preceding @samp{R} action. (The
25003 ``while-stepping'' actions are treated as if they were attached to a
25004 separate tracepoint, as far as these restrictions are concerned.)
25005
25006 Replies:
25007 @table @samp
25008 @item OK
25009 The packet was understood and carried out.
25010 @item
25011 The packet was not recognized.
25012 @end table
25013
25014 @item QTFrame:@var{n}
25015 Select the @var{n}'th tracepoint frame from the buffer, and use the
25016 register and memory contents recorded there to answer subsequent
25017 request packets from @value{GDBN}.
25018
25019 A successful reply from the stub indicates that the stub has found the
25020 requested frame. The response is a series of parts, concatenated
25021 without separators, describing the frame we selected. Each part has
25022 one of the following forms:
25023
25024 @table @samp
25025 @item F @var{f}
25026 The selected frame is number @var{n} in the trace frame buffer;
25027 @var{f} is a hexadecimal number. If @var{f} is @samp{-1}, then there
25028 was no frame matching the criteria in the request packet.
25029
25030 @item T @var{t}
25031 The selected trace frame records a hit of tracepoint number @var{t};
25032 @var{t} is a hexadecimal number.
25033
25034 @end table
25035
25036 @item QTFrame:pc:@var{addr}
25037 Like @samp{QTFrame:@var{n}}, but select the first tracepoint frame after the
25038 currently selected frame whose PC is @var{addr};
25039 @var{addr} is a hexadecimal number.
25040
25041 @item QTFrame:tdp:@var{t}
25042 Like @samp{QTFrame:@var{n}}, but select the first tracepoint frame after the
25043 currently selected frame that is a hit of tracepoint @var{t}; @var{t}
25044 is a hexadecimal number.
25045
25046 @item QTFrame:range:@var{start}:@var{end}
25047 Like @samp{QTFrame:@var{n}}, but select the first tracepoint frame after the
25048 currently selected frame whose PC is between @var{start} (inclusive)
25049 and @var{end} (exclusive); @var{start} and @var{end} are hexadecimal
25050 numbers.
25051
25052 @item QTFrame:outside:@var{start}:@var{end}
25053 Like @samp{QTFrame:range:@var{start}:@var{end}}, but select the first
25054 frame @emph{outside} the given range of addresses.
25055
25056 @item QTStart
25057 Begin the tracepoint experiment. Begin collecting data from tracepoint
25058 hits in the trace frame buffer.
25059
25060 @item QTStop
25061 End the tracepoint experiment. Stop collecting trace frames.
25062
25063 @item QTinit
25064 Clear the table of tracepoints, and empty the trace frame buffer.
25065
25066 @item QTro:@var{start1},@var{end1}:@var{start2},@var{end2}:@dots{}
25067 Establish the given ranges of memory as ``transparent''. The stub
25068 will answer requests for these ranges from memory's current contents,
25069 if they were not collected as part of the tracepoint hit.
25070
25071 @value{GDBN} uses this to mark read-only regions of memory, like those
25072 containing program code. Since these areas never change, they should
25073 still have the same contents they did when the tracepoint was hit, so
25074 there's no reason for the stub to refuse to provide their contents.
25075
25076 @item qTStatus
25077 Ask the stub if there is a trace experiment running right now.
25078
25079 Replies:
25080 @table @samp
25081 @item T0
25082 There is no trace experiment running.
25083 @item T1
25084 There is a trace experiment running.
25085 @end table
25086
25087 @end table
25088
25089
25090 @node Host I/O Packets
25091 @section Host I/O Packets
25092 @cindex Host I/O, remote protocol
25093 @cindex file transfer, remote protocol
25094
25095 The @dfn{Host I/O} packets allow @value{GDBN} to perform I/O
25096 operations on the far side of a remote link. For example, Host I/O is
25097 used to upload and download files to a remote target with its own
25098 filesystem. Host I/O uses the same constant values and data structure
25099 layout as the target-initiated File-I/O protocol. However, the
25100 Host I/O packets are structured differently. The target-initiated
25101 protocol relies on target memory to store parameters and buffers.
25102 Host I/O requests are initiated by @value{GDBN}, and the
25103 target's memory is not involved. @xref{File-I/O Remote Protocol
25104 Extension}, for more details on the target-initiated protocol.
25105
25106 The Host I/O request packets all encode a single operation along with
25107 its arguments. They have this format:
25108
25109 @table @samp
25110
25111 @item vFile:@var{operation}: @var{parameter}@dots{}
25112 @var{operation} is the name of the particular request; the target
25113 should compare the entire packet name up to the second colon when checking
25114 for a supported operation. The format of @var{parameter} depends on
25115 the operation. Numbers are always passed in hexadecimal. Negative
25116 numbers have an explicit minus sign (i.e.@: two's complement is not
25117 used). Strings (e.g.@: filenames) are encoded as a series of
25118 hexadecimal bytes. The last argument to a system call may be a
25119 buffer of escaped binary data (@pxref{Binary Data}).
25120
25121 @end table
25122
25123 The valid responses to Host I/O packets are:
25124
25125 @table @samp
25126
25127 @item F @var{result} [, @var{errno}] [; @var{attachment}]
25128 @var{result} is the integer value returned by this operation, usually
25129 non-negative for success and -1 for errors. If an error has occured,
25130 @var{errno} will be included in the result. @var{errno} will have a
25131 value defined by the File-I/O protocol (@pxref{Errno Values}). For
25132 operations which return data, @var{attachment} supplies the data as a
25133 binary buffer. Binary buffers in response packets are escaped in the
25134 normal way (@pxref{Binary Data}). See the individual packet
25135 documentation for the interpretation of @var{result} and
25136 @var{attachment}.
25137
25138 @item
25139 An empty response indicates that this operation is not recognized.
25140
25141 @end table
25142
25143 These are the supported Host I/O operations:
25144
25145 @table @samp
25146 @item vFile:open: @var{pathname}, @var{flags}, @var{mode}
25147 Open a file at @var{pathname} and return a file descriptor for it, or
25148 return -1 if an error occurs. @var{pathname} is a string,
25149 @var{flags} is an integer indicating a mask of open flags
25150 (@pxref{Open Flags}), and @var{mode} is an integer indicating a mask
25151 of mode bits to use if the file is created (@pxref{mode_t Values}).
25152 @xref{open}, for details of the open flags and mode values.
25153
25154 @item vFile:close: @var{fd}
25155 Close the open file corresponding to @var{fd} and return 0, or
25156 -1 if an error occurs.
25157
25158 @item vFile:pread: @var{fd}, @var{count}, @var{offset}
25159 Read data from the open file corresponding to @var{fd}. Up to
25160 @var{count} bytes will be read from the file, starting at @var{offset}
25161 relative to the start of the file. The target may read fewer bytes;
25162 common reasons include packet size limits and an end-of-file
25163 condition. The number of bytes read is returned. Zero should only be
25164 returned for a successful read at the end of the file, or if
25165 @var{count} was zero.
25166
25167 The data read should be returned as a binary attachment on success.
25168 If zero bytes were read, the response should include an empty binary
25169 attachment (i.e.@: a trailing semicolon). The return value is the
25170 number of target bytes read; the binary attachment may be longer if
25171 some characters were escaped.
25172
25173 @item vFile:pwrite: @var{fd}, @var{offset}, @var{data}
25174 Write @var{data} (a binary buffer) to the open file corresponding
25175 to @var{fd}. Start the write at @var{offset} from the start of the
25176 file. Unlike many @code{write} system calls, there is no
25177 separate @var{count} argument; the length of @var{data} in the
25178 packet is used. @samp{vFile:write} returns the number of bytes written,
25179 which may be shorter than the length of @var{data}, or -1 if an
25180 error occurred.
25181
25182 @item vFile:unlink: @var{pathname}
25183 Delete the file at @var{pathname} on the target. Return 0,
25184 or -1 if an error occurs. @var{pathname} is a string.
25185
25186 @end table
25187
25188 @node Interrupts
25189 @section Interrupts
25190 @cindex interrupts (remote protocol)
25191
25192 When a program on the remote target is running, @value{GDBN} may
25193 attempt to interrupt it by sending a @samp{Ctrl-C} or a @code{BREAK},
25194 control of which is specified via @value{GDBN}'s @samp{remotebreak}
25195 setting (@pxref{set remotebreak}).
25196
25197 The precise meaning of @code{BREAK} is defined by the transport
25198 mechanism and may, in fact, be undefined. @value{GDBN} does
25199 not currently define a @code{BREAK} mechanism for any of the network
25200 interfaces.
25201
25202 @samp{Ctrl-C}, on the other hand, is defined and implemented for all
25203 transport mechanisms. It is represented by sending the single byte
25204 @code{0x03} without any of the usual packet overhead described in
25205 the Overview section (@pxref{Overview}). When a @code{0x03} byte is
25206 transmitted as part of a packet, it is considered to be packet data
25207 and does @emph{not} represent an interrupt. E.g., an @samp{X} packet
25208 (@pxref{X packet}), used for binary downloads, may include an unescaped
25209 @code{0x03} as part of its packet.
25210
25211 Stubs are not required to recognize these interrupt mechanisms and the
25212 precise meaning associated with receipt of the interrupt is
25213 implementation defined. If the stub is successful at interrupting the
25214 running program, it is expected that it will send one of the Stop
25215 Reply Packets (@pxref{Stop Reply Packets}) to @value{GDBN} as a result
25216 of successfully stopping the program. Interrupts received while the
25217 program is stopped will be discarded.
25218
25219 @node Examples
25220 @section Examples
25221
25222 Example sequence of a target being re-started. Notice how the restart
25223 does not get any direct output:
25224
25225 @smallexample
25226 -> @code{R00}
25227 <- @code{+}
25228 @emph{target restarts}
25229 -> @code{?}
25230 <- @code{+}
25231 <- @code{T001:1234123412341234}
25232 -> @code{+}
25233 @end smallexample
25234
25235 Example sequence of a target being stepped by a single instruction:
25236
25237 @smallexample
25238 -> @code{G1445@dots{}}
25239 <- @code{+}
25240 -> @code{s}
25241 <- @code{+}
25242 @emph{time passes}
25243 <- @code{T001:1234123412341234}
25244 -> @code{+}
25245 -> @code{g}
25246 <- @code{+}
25247 <- @code{1455@dots{}}
25248 -> @code{+}
25249 @end smallexample
25250
25251 @node File-I/O Remote Protocol Extension
25252 @section File-I/O Remote Protocol Extension
25253 @cindex File-I/O remote protocol extension
25254
25255 @menu
25256 * File-I/O Overview::
25257 * Protocol Basics::
25258 * The F Request Packet::
25259 * The F Reply Packet::
25260 * The Ctrl-C Message::
25261 * Console I/O::
25262 * List of Supported Calls::
25263 * Protocol-specific Representation of Datatypes::
25264 * Constants::
25265 * File-I/O Examples::
25266 @end menu
25267
25268 @node File-I/O Overview
25269 @subsection File-I/O Overview
25270 @cindex file-i/o overview
25271
25272 The @dfn{File I/O remote protocol extension} (short: File-I/O) allows the
25273 target to use the host's file system and console I/O to perform various
25274 system calls. System calls on the target system are translated into a
25275 remote protocol packet to the host system, which then performs the needed
25276 actions and returns a response packet to the target system.
25277 This simulates file system operations even on targets that lack file systems.
25278
25279 The protocol is defined to be independent of both the host and target systems.
25280 It uses its own internal representation of datatypes and values. Both
25281 @value{GDBN} and the target's @value{GDBN} stub are responsible for
25282 translating the system-dependent value representations into the internal
25283 protocol representations when data is transmitted.
25284
25285 The communication is synchronous. A system call is possible only when
25286 @value{GDBN} is waiting for a response from the @samp{C}, @samp{c}, @samp{S}
25287 or @samp{s} packets. While @value{GDBN} handles the request for a system call,
25288 the target is stopped to allow deterministic access to the target's
25289 memory. Therefore File-I/O is not interruptible by target signals. On
25290 the other hand, it is possible to interrupt File-I/O by a user interrupt
25291 (@samp{Ctrl-C}) within @value{GDBN}.
25292
25293 The target's request to perform a host system call does not finish
25294 the latest @samp{C}, @samp{c}, @samp{S} or @samp{s} action. That means,
25295 after finishing the system call, the target returns to continuing the
25296 previous activity (continue, step). No additional continue or step
25297 request from @value{GDBN} is required.
25298
25299 @smallexample
25300 (@value{GDBP}) continue
25301 <- target requests 'system call X'
25302 target is stopped, @value{GDBN} executes system call
25303 -> @value{GDBN} returns result
25304 ... target continues, @value{GDBN} returns to wait for the target
25305 <- target hits breakpoint and sends a Txx packet
25306 @end smallexample
25307
25308 The protocol only supports I/O on the console and to regular files on
25309 the host file system. Character or block special devices, pipes,
25310 named pipes, sockets or any other communication method on the host
25311 system are not supported by this protocol.
25312
25313 @node Protocol Basics
25314 @subsection Protocol Basics
25315 @cindex protocol basics, file-i/o
25316
25317 The File-I/O protocol uses the @code{F} packet as the request as well
25318 as reply packet. Since a File-I/O system call can only occur when
25319 @value{GDBN} is waiting for a response from the continuing or stepping target,
25320 the File-I/O request is a reply that @value{GDBN} has to expect as a result
25321 of a previous @samp{C}, @samp{c}, @samp{S} or @samp{s} packet.
25322 This @code{F} packet contains all information needed to allow @value{GDBN}
25323 to call the appropriate host system call:
25324
25325 @itemize @bullet
25326 @item
25327 A unique identifier for the requested system call.
25328
25329 @item
25330 All parameters to the system call. Pointers are given as addresses
25331 in the target memory address space. Pointers to strings are given as
25332 pointer/length pair. Numerical values are given as they are.
25333 Numerical control flags are given in a protocol-specific representation.
25334
25335 @end itemize
25336
25337 At this point, @value{GDBN} has to perform the following actions.
25338
25339 @itemize @bullet
25340 @item
25341 If the parameters include pointer values to data needed as input to a
25342 system call, @value{GDBN} requests this data from the target with a
25343 standard @code{m} packet request. This additional communication has to be
25344 expected by the target implementation and is handled as any other @code{m}
25345 packet.
25346
25347 @item
25348 @value{GDBN} translates all value from protocol representation to host
25349 representation as needed. Datatypes are coerced into the host types.
25350
25351 @item
25352 @value{GDBN} calls the system call.
25353
25354 @item
25355 It then coerces datatypes back to protocol representation.
25356
25357 @item
25358 If the system call is expected to return data in buffer space specified
25359 by pointer parameters to the call, the data is transmitted to the
25360 target using a @code{M} or @code{X} packet. This packet has to be expected
25361 by the target implementation and is handled as any other @code{M} or @code{X}
25362 packet.
25363
25364 @end itemize
25365
25366 Eventually @value{GDBN} replies with another @code{F} packet which contains all
25367 necessary information for the target to continue. This at least contains
25368
25369 @itemize @bullet
25370 @item
25371 Return value.
25372
25373 @item
25374 @code{errno}, if has been changed by the system call.
25375
25376 @item
25377 ``Ctrl-C'' flag.
25378
25379 @end itemize
25380
25381 After having done the needed type and value coercion, the target continues
25382 the latest continue or step action.
25383
25384 @node The F Request Packet
25385 @subsection The @code{F} Request Packet
25386 @cindex file-i/o request packet
25387 @cindex @code{F} request packet
25388
25389 The @code{F} request packet has the following format:
25390
25391 @table @samp
25392 @item F@var{call-id},@var{parameter@dots{}}
25393
25394 @var{call-id} is the identifier to indicate the host system call to be called.
25395 This is just the name of the function.
25396
25397 @var{parameter@dots{}} are the parameters to the system call.
25398 Parameters are hexadecimal integer values, either the actual values in case
25399 of scalar datatypes, pointers to target buffer space in case of compound
25400 datatypes and unspecified memory areas, or pointer/length pairs in case
25401 of string parameters. These are appended to the @var{call-id} as a
25402 comma-delimited list. All values are transmitted in ASCII
25403 string representation, pointer/length pairs separated by a slash.
25404
25405 @end table
25406
25407
25408
25409 @node The F Reply Packet
25410 @subsection The @code{F} Reply Packet
25411 @cindex file-i/o reply packet
25412 @cindex @code{F} reply packet
25413
25414 The @code{F} reply packet has the following format:
25415
25416 @table @samp
25417
25418 @item F@var{retcode},@var{errno},@var{Ctrl-C flag};@var{call-specific attachment}
25419
25420 @var{retcode} is the return code of the system call as hexadecimal value.
25421
25422 @var{errno} is the @code{errno} set by the call, in protocol-specific
25423 representation.
25424 This parameter can be omitted if the call was successful.
25425
25426 @var{Ctrl-C flag} is only sent if the user requested a break. In this
25427 case, @var{errno} must be sent as well, even if the call was successful.
25428 The @var{Ctrl-C flag} itself consists of the character @samp{C}:
25429
25430 @smallexample
25431 F0,0,C
25432 @end smallexample
25433
25434 @noindent
25435 or, if the call was interrupted before the host call has been performed:
25436
25437 @smallexample
25438 F-1,4,C
25439 @end smallexample
25440
25441 @noindent
25442 assuming 4 is the protocol-specific representation of @code{EINTR}.
25443
25444 @end table
25445
25446
25447 @node The Ctrl-C Message
25448 @subsection The @samp{Ctrl-C} Message
25449 @cindex ctrl-c message, in file-i/o protocol
25450
25451 If the @samp{Ctrl-C} flag is set in the @value{GDBN}
25452 reply packet (@pxref{The F Reply Packet}),
25453 the target should behave as if it had
25454 gotten a break message. The meaning for the target is ``system call
25455 interrupted by @code{SIGINT}''. Consequentially, the target should actually stop
25456 (as with a break message) and return to @value{GDBN} with a @code{T02}
25457 packet.
25458
25459 It's important for the target to know in which
25460 state the system call was interrupted. There are two possible cases:
25461
25462 @itemize @bullet
25463 @item
25464 The system call hasn't been performed on the host yet.
25465
25466 @item
25467 The system call on the host has been finished.
25468
25469 @end itemize
25470
25471 These two states can be distinguished by the target by the value of the
25472 returned @code{errno}. If it's the protocol representation of @code{EINTR}, the system
25473 call hasn't been performed. This is equivalent to the @code{EINTR} handling
25474 on POSIX systems. In any other case, the target may presume that the
25475 system call has been finished --- successfully or not --- and should behave
25476 as if the break message arrived right after the system call.
25477
25478 @value{GDBN} must behave reliably. If the system call has not been called
25479 yet, @value{GDBN} may send the @code{F} reply immediately, setting @code{EINTR} as
25480 @code{errno} in the packet. If the system call on the host has been finished
25481 before the user requests a break, the full action must be finished by
25482 @value{GDBN}. This requires sending @code{M} or @code{X} packets as necessary.
25483 The @code{F} packet may only be sent when either nothing has happened
25484 or the full action has been completed.
25485
25486 @node Console I/O
25487 @subsection Console I/O
25488 @cindex console i/o as part of file-i/o
25489
25490 By default and if not explicitly closed by the target system, the file
25491 descriptors 0, 1 and 2 are connected to the @value{GDBN} console. Output
25492 on the @value{GDBN} console is handled as any other file output operation
25493 (@code{write(1, @dots{})} or @code{write(2, @dots{})}). Console input is handled
25494 by @value{GDBN} so that after the target read request from file descriptor
25495 0 all following typing is buffered until either one of the following
25496 conditions is met:
25497
25498 @itemize @bullet
25499 @item
25500 The user types @kbd{Ctrl-c}. The behaviour is as explained above, and the
25501 @code{read}
25502 system call is treated as finished.
25503
25504 @item
25505 The user presses @key{RET}. This is treated as end of input with a trailing
25506 newline.
25507
25508 @item
25509 The user types @kbd{Ctrl-d}. This is treated as end of input. No trailing
25510 character (neither newline nor @samp{Ctrl-D}) is appended to the input.
25511
25512 @end itemize
25513
25514 If the user has typed more characters than fit in the buffer given to
25515 the @code{read} call, the trailing characters are buffered in @value{GDBN} until
25516 either another @code{read(0, @dots{})} is requested by the target, or debugging
25517 is stopped at the user's request.
25518
25519
25520 @node List of Supported Calls
25521 @subsection List of Supported Calls
25522 @cindex list of supported file-i/o calls
25523
25524 @menu
25525 * open::
25526 * close::
25527 * read::
25528 * write::
25529 * lseek::
25530 * rename::
25531 * unlink::
25532 * stat/fstat::
25533 * gettimeofday::
25534 * isatty::
25535 * system::
25536 @end menu
25537
25538 @node open
25539 @unnumberedsubsubsec open
25540 @cindex open, file-i/o system call
25541
25542 @table @asis
25543 @item Synopsis:
25544 @smallexample
25545 int open(const char *pathname, int flags);
25546 int open(const char *pathname, int flags, mode_t mode);
25547 @end smallexample
25548
25549 @item Request:
25550 @samp{Fopen,@var{pathptr}/@var{len},@var{flags},@var{mode}}
25551
25552 @noindent
25553 @var{flags} is the bitwise @code{OR} of the following values:
25554
25555 @table @code
25556 @item O_CREAT
25557 If the file does not exist it will be created. The host
25558 rules apply as far as file ownership and time stamps
25559 are concerned.
25560
25561 @item O_EXCL
25562 When used with @code{O_CREAT}, if the file already exists it is
25563 an error and open() fails.
25564
25565 @item O_TRUNC
25566 If the file already exists and the open mode allows
25567 writing (@code{O_RDWR} or @code{O_WRONLY} is given) it will be
25568 truncated to zero length.
25569
25570 @item O_APPEND
25571 The file is opened in append mode.
25572
25573 @item O_RDONLY
25574 The file is opened for reading only.
25575
25576 @item O_WRONLY
25577 The file is opened for writing only.
25578
25579 @item O_RDWR
25580 The file is opened for reading and writing.
25581 @end table
25582
25583 @noindent
25584 Other bits are silently ignored.
25585
25586
25587 @noindent
25588 @var{mode} is the bitwise @code{OR} of the following values:
25589
25590 @table @code
25591 @item S_IRUSR
25592 User has read permission.
25593
25594 @item S_IWUSR
25595 User has write permission.
25596
25597 @item S_IRGRP
25598 Group has read permission.
25599
25600 @item S_IWGRP
25601 Group has write permission.
25602
25603 @item S_IROTH
25604 Others have read permission.
25605
25606 @item S_IWOTH
25607 Others have write permission.
25608 @end table
25609
25610 @noindent
25611 Other bits are silently ignored.
25612
25613
25614 @item Return value:
25615 @code{open} returns the new file descriptor or -1 if an error
25616 occurred.
25617
25618 @item Errors:
25619
25620 @table @code
25621 @item EEXIST
25622 @var{pathname} already exists and @code{O_CREAT} and @code{O_EXCL} were used.
25623
25624 @item EISDIR
25625 @var{pathname} refers to a directory.
25626
25627 @item EACCES
25628 The requested access is not allowed.
25629
25630 @item ENAMETOOLONG
25631 @var{pathname} was too long.
25632
25633 @item ENOENT
25634 A directory component in @var{pathname} does not exist.
25635
25636 @item ENODEV
25637 @var{pathname} refers to a device, pipe, named pipe or socket.
25638
25639 @item EROFS
25640 @var{pathname} refers to a file on a read-only filesystem and
25641 write access was requested.
25642
25643 @item EFAULT
25644 @var{pathname} is an invalid pointer value.
25645
25646 @item ENOSPC
25647 No space on device to create the file.
25648
25649 @item EMFILE
25650 The process already has the maximum number of files open.
25651
25652 @item ENFILE
25653 The limit on the total number of files open on the system
25654 has been reached.
25655
25656 @item EINTR
25657 The call was interrupted by the user.
25658 @end table
25659
25660 @end table
25661
25662 @node close
25663 @unnumberedsubsubsec close
25664 @cindex close, file-i/o system call
25665
25666 @table @asis
25667 @item Synopsis:
25668 @smallexample
25669 int close(int fd);
25670 @end smallexample
25671
25672 @item Request:
25673 @samp{Fclose,@var{fd}}
25674
25675 @item Return value:
25676 @code{close} returns zero on success, or -1 if an error occurred.
25677
25678 @item Errors:
25679
25680 @table @code
25681 @item EBADF
25682 @var{fd} isn't a valid open file descriptor.
25683
25684 @item EINTR
25685 The call was interrupted by the user.
25686 @end table
25687
25688 @end table
25689
25690 @node read
25691 @unnumberedsubsubsec read
25692 @cindex read, file-i/o system call
25693
25694 @table @asis
25695 @item Synopsis:
25696 @smallexample
25697 int read(int fd, void *buf, unsigned int count);
25698 @end smallexample
25699
25700 @item Request:
25701 @samp{Fread,@var{fd},@var{bufptr},@var{count}}
25702
25703 @item Return value:
25704 On success, the number of bytes read is returned.
25705 Zero indicates end of file. If count is zero, read
25706 returns zero as well. On error, -1 is returned.
25707
25708 @item Errors:
25709
25710 @table @code
25711 @item EBADF
25712 @var{fd} is not a valid file descriptor or is not open for
25713 reading.
25714
25715 @item EFAULT
25716 @var{bufptr} is an invalid pointer value.
25717
25718 @item EINTR
25719 The call was interrupted by the user.
25720 @end table
25721
25722 @end table
25723
25724 @node write
25725 @unnumberedsubsubsec write
25726 @cindex write, file-i/o system call
25727
25728 @table @asis
25729 @item Synopsis:
25730 @smallexample
25731 int write(int fd, const void *buf, unsigned int count);
25732 @end smallexample
25733
25734 @item Request:
25735 @samp{Fwrite,@var{fd},@var{bufptr},@var{count}}
25736
25737 @item Return value:
25738 On success, the number of bytes written are returned.
25739 Zero indicates nothing was written. On error, -1
25740 is returned.
25741
25742 @item Errors:
25743
25744 @table @code
25745 @item EBADF
25746 @var{fd} is not a valid file descriptor or is not open for
25747 writing.
25748
25749 @item EFAULT
25750 @var{bufptr} is an invalid pointer value.
25751
25752 @item EFBIG
25753 An attempt was made to write a file that exceeds the
25754 host-specific maximum file size allowed.
25755
25756 @item ENOSPC
25757 No space on device to write the data.
25758
25759 @item EINTR
25760 The call was interrupted by the user.
25761 @end table
25762
25763 @end table
25764
25765 @node lseek
25766 @unnumberedsubsubsec lseek
25767 @cindex lseek, file-i/o system call
25768
25769 @table @asis
25770 @item Synopsis:
25771 @smallexample
25772 long lseek (int fd, long offset, int flag);
25773 @end smallexample
25774
25775 @item Request:
25776 @samp{Flseek,@var{fd},@var{offset},@var{flag}}
25777
25778 @var{flag} is one of:
25779
25780 @table @code
25781 @item SEEK_SET
25782 The offset is set to @var{offset} bytes.
25783
25784 @item SEEK_CUR
25785 The offset is set to its current location plus @var{offset}
25786 bytes.
25787
25788 @item SEEK_END
25789 The offset is set to the size of the file plus @var{offset}
25790 bytes.
25791 @end table
25792
25793 @item Return value:
25794 On success, the resulting unsigned offset in bytes from
25795 the beginning of the file is returned. Otherwise, a
25796 value of -1 is returned.
25797
25798 @item Errors:
25799
25800 @table @code
25801 @item EBADF
25802 @var{fd} is not a valid open file descriptor.
25803
25804 @item ESPIPE
25805 @var{fd} is associated with the @value{GDBN} console.
25806
25807 @item EINVAL
25808 @var{flag} is not a proper value.
25809
25810 @item EINTR
25811 The call was interrupted by the user.
25812 @end table
25813
25814 @end table
25815
25816 @node rename
25817 @unnumberedsubsubsec rename
25818 @cindex rename, file-i/o system call
25819
25820 @table @asis
25821 @item Synopsis:
25822 @smallexample
25823 int rename(const char *oldpath, const char *newpath);
25824 @end smallexample
25825
25826 @item Request:
25827 @samp{Frename,@var{oldpathptr}/@var{len},@var{newpathptr}/@var{len}}
25828
25829 @item Return value:
25830 On success, zero is returned. On error, -1 is returned.
25831
25832 @item Errors:
25833
25834 @table @code
25835 @item EISDIR
25836 @var{newpath} is an existing directory, but @var{oldpath} is not a
25837 directory.
25838
25839 @item EEXIST
25840 @var{newpath} is a non-empty directory.
25841
25842 @item EBUSY
25843 @var{oldpath} or @var{newpath} is a directory that is in use by some
25844 process.
25845
25846 @item EINVAL
25847 An attempt was made to make a directory a subdirectory
25848 of itself.
25849
25850 @item ENOTDIR
25851 A component used as a directory in @var{oldpath} or new
25852 path is not a directory. Or @var{oldpath} is a directory
25853 and @var{newpath} exists but is not a directory.
25854
25855 @item EFAULT
25856 @var{oldpathptr} or @var{newpathptr} are invalid pointer values.
25857
25858 @item EACCES
25859 No access to the file or the path of the file.
25860
25861 @item ENAMETOOLONG
25862
25863 @var{oldpath} or @var{newpath} was too long.
25864
25865 @item ENOENT
25866 A directory component in @var{oldpath} or @var{newpath} does not exist.
25867
25868 @item EROFS
25869 The file is on a read-only filesystem.
25870
25871 @item ENOSPC
25872 The device containing the file has no room for the new
25873 directory entry.
25874
25875 @item EINTR
25876 The call was interrupted by the user.
25877 @end table
25878
25879 @end table
25880
25881 @node unlink
25882 @unnumberedsubsubsec unlink
25883 @cindex unlink, file-i/o system call
25884
25885 @table @asis
25886 @item Synopsis:
25887 @smallexample
25888 int unlink(const char *pathname);
25889 @end smallexample
25890
25891 @item Request:
25892 @samp{Funlink,@var{pathnameptr}/@var{len}}
25893
25894 @item Return value:
25895 On success, zero is returned. On error, -1 is returned.
25896
25897 @item Errors:
25898
25899 @table @code
25900 @item EACCES
25901 No access to the file or the path of the file.
25902
25903 @item EPERM
25904 The system does not allow unlinking of directories.
25905
25906 @item EBUSY
25907 The file @var{pathname} cannot be unlinked because it's
25908 being used by another process.
25909
25910 @item EFAULT
25911 @var{pathnameptr} is an invalid pointer value.
25912
25913 @item ENAMETOOLONG
25914 @var{pathname} was too long.
25915
25916 @item ENOENT
25917 A directory component in @var{pathname} does not exist.
25918
25919 @item ENOTDIR
25920 A component of the path is not a directory.
25921
25922 @item EROFS
25923 The file is on a read-only filesystem.
25924
25925 @item EINTR
25926 The call was interrupted by the user.
25927 @end table
25928
25929 @end table
25930
25931 @node stat/fstat
25932 @unnumberedsubsubsec stat/fstat
25933 @cindex fstat, file-i/o system call
25934 @cindex stat, file-i/o system call
25935
25936 @table @asis
25937 @item Synopsis:
25938 @smallexample
25939 int stat(const char *pathname, struct stat *buf);
25940 int fstat(int fd, struct stat *buf);
25941 @end smallexample
25942
25943 @item Request:
25944 @samp{Fstat,@var{pathnameptr}/@var{len},@var{bufptr}}@*
25945 @samp{Ffstat,@var{fd},@var{bufptr}}
25946
25947 @item Return value:
25948 On success, zero is returned. On error, -1 is returned.
25949
25950 @item Errors:
25951
25952 @table @code
25953 @item EBADF
25954 @var{fd} is not a valid open file.
25955
25956 @item ENOENT
25957 A directory component in @var{pathname} does not exist or the
25958 path is an empty string.
25959
25960 @item ENOTDIR
25961 A component of the path is not a directory.
25962
25963 @item EFAULT
25964 @var{pathnameptr} is an invalid pointer value.
25965
25966 @item EACCES
25967 No access to the file or the path of the file.
25968
25969 @item ENAMETOOLONG
25970 @var{pathname} was too long.
25971
25972 @item EINTR
25973 The call was interrupted by the user.
25974 @end table
25975
25976 @end table
25977
25978 @node gettimeofday
25979 @unnumberedsubsubsec gettimeofday
25980 @cindex gettimeofday, file-i/o system call
25981
25982 @table @asis
25983 @item Synopsis:
25984 @smallexample
25985 int gettimeofday(struct timeval *tv, void *tz);
25986 @end smallexample
25987
25988 @item Request:
25989 @samp{Fgettimeofday,@var{tvptr},@var{tzptr}}
25990
25991 @item Return value:
25992 On success, 0 is returned, -1 otherwise.
25993
25994 @item Errors:
25995
25996 @table @code
25997 @item EINVAL
25998 @var{tz} is a non-NULL pointer.
25999
26000 @item EFAULT
26001 @var{tvptr} and/or @var{tzptr} is an invalid pointer value.
26002 @end table
26003
26004 @end table
26005
26006 @node isatty
26007 @unnumberedsubsubsec isatty
26008 @cindex isatty, file-i/o system call
26009
26010 @table @asis
26011 @item Synopsis:
26012 @smallexample
26013 int isatty(int fd);
26014 @end smallexample
26015
26016 @item Request:
26017 @samp{Fisatty,@var{fd}}
26018
26019 @item Return value:
26020 Returns 1 if @var{fd} refers to the @value{GDBN} console, 0 otherwise.
26021
26022 @item Errors:
26023
26024 @table @code
26025 @item EINTR
26026 The call was interrupted by the user.
26027 @end table
26028
26029 @end table
26030
26031 Note that the @code{isatty} call is treated as a special case: it returns
26032 1 to the target if the file descriptor is attached
26033 to the @value{GDBN} console, 0 otherwise. Implementing through system calls
26034 would require implementing @code{ioctl} and would be more complex than
26035 needed.
26036
26037
26038 @node system
26039 @unnumberedsubsubsec system
26040 @cindex system, file-i/o system call
26041
26042 @table @asis
26043 @item Synopsis:
26044 @smallexample
26045 int system(const char *command);
26046 @end smallexample
26047
26048 @item Request:
26049 @samp{Fsystem,@var{commandptr}/@var{len}}
26050
26051 @item Return value:
26052 If @var{len} is zero, the return value indicates whether a shell is
26053 available. A zero return value indicates a shell is not available.
26054 For non-zero @var{len}, the value returned is -1 on error and the
26055 return status of the command otherwise. Only the exit status of the
26056 command is returned, which is extracted from the host's @code{system}
26057 return value by calling @code{WEXITSTATUS(retval)}. In case
26058 @file{/bin/sh} could not be executed, 127 is returned.
26059
26060 @item Errors:
26061
26062 @table @code
26063 @item EINTR
26064 The call was interrupted by the user.
26065 @end table
26066
26067 @end table
26068
26069 @value{GDBN} takes over the full task of calling the necessary host calls
26070 to perform the @code{system} call. The return value of @code{system} on
26071 the host is simplified before it's returned
26072 to the target. Any termination signal information from the child process
26073 is discarded, and the return value consists
26074 entirely of the exit status of the called command.
26075
26076 Due to security concerns, the @code{system} call is by default refused
26077 by @value{GDBN}. The user has to allow this call explicitly with the
26078 @code{set remote system-call-allowed 1} command.
26079
26080 @table @code
26081 @item set remote system-call-allowed
26082 @kindex set remote system-call-allowed
26083 Control whether to allow the @code{system} calls in the File I/O
26084 protocol for the remote target. The default is zero (disabled).
26085
26086 @item show remote system-call-allowed
26087 @kindex show remote system-call-allowed
26088 Show whether the @code{system} calls are allowed in the File I/O
26089 protocol.
26090 @end table
26091
26092 @node Protocol-specific Representation of Datatypes
26093 @subsection Protocol-specific Representation of Datatypes
26094 @cindex protocol-specific representation of datatypes, in file-i/o protocol
26095
26096 @menu
26097 * Integral Datatypes::
26098 * Pointer Values::
26099 * Memory Transfer::
26100 * struct stat::
26101 * struct timeval::
26102 @end menu
26103
26104 @node Integral Datatypes
26105 @unnumberedsubsubsec Integral Datatypes
26106 @cindex integral datatypes, in file-i/o protocol
26107
26108 The integral datatypes used in the system calls are @code{int},
26109 @code{unsigned int}, @code{long}, @code{unsigned long},
26110 @code{mode_t}, and @code{time_t}.
26111
26112 @code{int}, @code{unsigned int}, @code{mode_t} and @code{time_t} are
26113 implemented as 32 bit values in this protocol.
26114
26115 @code{long} and @code{unsigned long} are implemented as 64 bit types.
26116
26117 @xref{Limits}, for corresponding MIN and MAX values (similar to those
26118 in @file{limits.h}) to allow range checking on host and target.
26119
26120 @code{time_t} datatypes are defined as seconds since the Epoch.
26121
26122 All integral datatypes transferred as part of a memory read or write of a
26123 structured datatype e.g.@: a @code{struct stat} have to be given in big endian
26124 byte order.
26125
26126 @node Pointer Values
26127 @unnumberedsubsubsec Pointer Values
26128 @cindex pointer values, in file-i/o protocol
26129
26130 Pointers to target data are transmitted as they are. An exception
26131 is made for pointers to buffers for which the length isn't
26132 transmitted as part of the function call, namely strings. Strings
26133 are transmitted as a pointer/length pair, both as hex values, e.g.@:
26134
26135 @smallexample
26136 @code{1aaf/12}
26137 @end smallexample
26138
26139 @noindent
26140 which is a pointer to data of length 18 bytes at position 0x1aaf.
26141 The length is defined as the full string length in bytes, including
26142 the trailing null byte. For example, the string @code{"hello world"}
26143 at address 0x123456 is transmitted as
26144
26145 @smallexample
26146 @code{123456/d}
26147 @end smallexample
26148
26149 @node Memory Transfer
26150 @unnumberedsubsubsec Memory Transfer
26151 @cindex memory transfer, in file-i/o protocol
26152
26153 Structured data which is transferred using a memory read or write (for
26154 example, a @code{struct stat}) is expected to be in a protocol-specific format
26155 with all scalar multibyte datatypes being big endian. Translation to
26156 this representation needs to be done both by the target before the @code{F}
26157 packet is sent, and by @value{GDBN} before
26158 it transfers memory to the target. Transferred pointers to structured
26159 data should point to the already-coerced data at any time.
26160
26161
26162 @node struct stat
26163 @unnumberedsubsubsec struct stat
26164 @cindex struct stat, in file-i/o protocol
26165
26166 The buffer of type @code{struct stat} used by the target and @value{GDBN}
26167 is defined as follows:
26168
26169 @smallexample
26170 struct stat @{
26171 unsigned int st_dev; /* device */
26172 unsigned int st_ino; /* inode */
26173 mode_t st_mode; /* protection */
26174 unsigned int st_nlink; /* number of hard links */
26175 unsigned int st_uid; /* user ID of owner */
26176 unsigned int st_gid; /* group ID of owner */
26177 unsigned int st_rdev; /* device type (if inode device) */
26178 unsigned long st_size; /* total size, in bytes */
26179 unsigned long st_blksize; /* blocksize for filesystem I/O */
26180 unsigned long st_blocks; /* number of blocks allocated */
26181 time_t st_atime; /* time of last access */
26182 time_t st_mtime; /* time of last modification */
26183 time_t st_ctime; /* time of last change */
26184 @};
26185 @end smallexample
26186
26187 The integral datatypes conform to the definitions given in the
26188 appropriate section (see @ref{Integral Datatypes}, for details) so this
26189 structure is of size 64 bytes.
26190
26191 The values of several fields have a restricted meaning and/or
26192 range of values.
26193
26194 @table @code
26195
26196 @item st_dev
26197 A value of 0 represents a file, 1 the console.
26198
26199 @item st_ino
26200 No valid meaning for the target. Transmitted unchanged.
26201
26202 @item st_mode
26203 Valid mode bits are described in @ref{Constants}. Any other
26204 bits have currently no meaning for the target.
26205
26206 @item st_uid
26207 @itemx st_gid
26208 @itemx st_rdev
26209 No valid meaning for the target. Transmitted unchanged.
26210
26211 @item st_atime
26212 @itemx st_mtime
26213 @itemx st_ctime
26214 These values have a host and file system dependent
26215 accuracy. Especially on Windows hosts, the file system may not
26216 support exact timing values.
26217 @end table
26218
26219 The target gets a @code{struct stat} of the above representation and is
26220 responsible for coercing it to the target representation before
26221 continuing.
26222
26223 Note that due to size differences between the host, target, and protocol
26224 representations of @code{struct stat} members, these members could eventually
26225 get truncated on the target.
26226
26227 @node struct timeval
26228 @unnumberedsubsubsec struct timeval
26229 @cindex struct timeval, in file-i/o protocol
26230
26231 The buffer of type @code{struct timeval} used by the File-I/O protocol
26232 is defined as follows:
26233
26234 @smallexample
26235 struct timeval @{
26236 time_t tv_sec; /* second */
26237 long tv_usec; /* microsecond */
26238 @};
26239 @end smallexample
26240
26241 The integral datatypes conform to the definitions given in the
26242 appropriate section (see @ref{Integral Datatypes}, for details) so this
26243 structure is of size 8 bytes.
26244
26245 @node Constants
26246 @subsection Constants
26247 @cindex constants, in file-i/o protocol
26248
26249 The following values are used for the constants inside of the
26250 protocol. @value{GDBN} and target are responsible for translating these
26251 values before and after the call as needed.
26252
26253 @menu
26254 * Open Flags::
26255 * mode_t Values::
26256 * Errno Values::
26257 * Lseek Flags::
26258 * Limits::
26259 @end menu
26260
26261 @node Open Flags
26262 @unnumberedsubsubsec Open Flags
26263 @cindex open flags, in file-i/o protocol
26264
26265 All values are given in hexadecimal representation.
26266
26267 @smallexample
26268 O_RDONLY 0x0
26269 O_WRONLY 0x1
26270 O_RDWR 0x2
26271 O_APPEND 0x8
26272 O_CREAT 0x200
26273 O_TRUNC 0x400
26274 O_EXCL 0x800
26275 @end smallexample
26276
26277 @node mode_t Values
26278 @unnumberedsubsubsec mode_t Values
26279 @cindex mode_t values, in file-i/o protocol
26280
26281 All values are given in octal representation.
26282
26283 @smallexample
26284 S_IFREG 0100000
26285 S_IFDIR 040000
26286 S_IRUSR 0400
26287 S_IWUSR 0200
26288 S_IXUSR 0100
26289 S_IRGRP 040
26290 S_IWGRP 020
26291 S_IXGRP 010
26292 S_IROTH 04
26293 S_IWOTH 02
26294 S_IXOTH 01
26295 @end smallexample
26296
26297 @node Errno Values
26298 @unnumberedsubsubsec Errno Values
26299 @cindex errno values, in file-i/o protocol
26300
26301 All values are given in decimal representation.
26302
26303 @smallexample
26304 EPERM 1
26305 ENOENT 2
26306 EINTR 4
26307 EBADF 9
26308 EACCES 13
26309 EFAULT 14
26310 EBUSY 16
26311 EEXIST 17
26312 ENODEV 19
26313 ENOTDIR 20
26314 EISDIR 21
26315 EINVAL 22
26316 ENFILE 23
26317 EMFILE 24
26318 EFBIG 27
26319 ENOSPC 28
26320 ESPIPE 29
26321 EROFS 30
26322 ENAMETOOLONG 91
26323 EUNKNOWN 9999
26324 @end smallexample
26325
26326 @code{EUNKNOWN} is used as a fallback error value if a host system returns
26327 any error value not in the list of supported error numbers.
26328
26329 @node Lseek Flags
26330 @unnumberedsubsubsec Lseek Flags
26331 @cindex lseek flags, in file-i/o protocol
26332
26333 @smallexample
26334 SEEK_SET 0
26335 SEEK_CUR 1
26336 SEEK_END 2
26337 @end smallexample
26338
26339 @node Limits
26340 @unnumberedsubsubsec Limits
26341 @cindex limits, in file-i/o protocol
26342
26343 All values are given in decimal representation.
26344
26345 @smallexample
26346 INT_MIN -2147483648
26347 INT_MAX 2147483647
26348 UINT_MAX 4294967295
26349 LONG_MIN -9223372036854775808
26350 LONG_MAX 9223372036854775807
26351 ULONG_MAX 18446744073709551615
26352 @end smallexample
26353
26354 @node File-I/O Examples
26355 @subsection File-I/O Examples
26356 @cindex file-i/o examples
26357
26358 Example sequence of a write call, file descriptor 3, buffer is at target
26359 address 0x1234, 6 bytes should be written:
26360
26361 @smallexample
26362 <- @code{Fwrite,3,1234,6}
26363 @emph{request memory read from target}
26364 -> @code{m1234,6}
26365 <- XXXXXX
26366 @emph{return "6 bytes written"}
26367 -> @code{F6}
26368 @end smallexample
26369
26370 Example sequence of a read call, file descriptor 3, buffer is at target
26371 address 0x1234, 6 bytes should be read:
26372
26373 @smallexample
26374 <- @code{Fread,3,1234,6}
26375 @emph{request memory write to target}
26376 -> @code{X1234,6:XXXXXX}
26377 @emph{return "6 bytes read"}
26378 -> @code{F6}
26379 @end smallexample
26380
26381 Example sequence of a read call, call fails on the host due to invalid
26382 file descriptor (@code{EBADF}):
26383
26384 @smallexample
26385 <- @code{Fread,3,1234,6}
26386 -> @code{F-1,9}
26387 @end smallexample
26388
26389 Example sequence of a read call, user presses @kbd{Ctrl-c} before syscall on
26390 host is called:
26391
26392 @smallexample
26393 <- @code{Fread,3,1234,6}
26394 -> @code{F-1,4,C}
26395 <- @code{T02}
26396 @end smallexample
26397
26398 Example sequence of a read call, user presses @kbd{Ctrl-c} after syscall on
26399 host is called:
26400
26401 @smallexample
26402 <- @code{Fread,3,1234,6}
26403 -> @code{X1234,6:XXXXXX}
26404 <- @code{T02}
26405 @end smallexample
26406
26407 @node Library List Format
26408 @section Library List Format
26409 @cindex library list format, remote protocol
26410
26411 On some platforms, a dynamic loader (e.g.@: @file{ld.so}) runs in the
26412 same process as your application to manage libraries. In this case,
26413 @value{GDBN} can use the loader's symbol table and normal memory
26414 operations to maintain a list of shared libraries. On other
26415 platforms, the operating system manages loaded libraries.
26416 @value{GDBN} can not retrieve the list of currently loaded libraries
26417 through memory operations, so it uses the @samp{qXfer:libraries:read}
26418 packet (@pxref{qXfer library list read}) instead. The remote stub
26419 queries the target's operating system and reports which libraries
26420 are loaded.
26421
26422 The @samp{qXfer:libraries:read} packet returns an XML document which
26423 lists loaded libraries and their offsets. Each library has an
26424 associated name and one or more segment or section base addresses,
26425 which report where the library was loaded in memory.
26426
26427 For the common case of libraries that are fully linked binaries, the
26428 library should have a list of segments. If the target supports
26429 dynamic linking of a relocatable object file, its library XML element
26430 should instead include a list of allocated sections. The segment or
26431 section bases are start addresses, not relocation offsets; they do not
26432 depend on the library's link-time base addresses.
26433
26434 @value{GDBN} must be linked with the Expat library to support XML
26435 library lists. @xref{Expat}.
26436
26437 A simple memory map, with one loaded library relocated by a single
26438 offset, looks like this:
26439
26440 @smallexample
26441 <library-list>
26442 <library name="/lib/libc.so.6">
26443 <segment address="0x10000000"/>
26444 </library>
26445 </library-list>
26446 @end smallexample
26447
26448 Another simple memory map, with one loaded library with three
26449 allocated sections (.text, .data, .bss), looks like this:
26450
26451 @smallexample
26452 <library-list>
26453 <library name="sharedlib.o">
26454 <section address="0x10000000"/>
26455 <section address="0x20000000"/>
26456 <section address="0x30000000"/>
26457 </library>
26458 </library-list>
26459 @end smallexample
26460
26461 The format of a library list is described by this DTD:
26462
26463 @smallexample
26464 <!-- library-list: Root element with versioning -->
26465 <!ELEMENT library-list (library)*>
26466 <!ATTLIST library-list version CDATA #FIXED "1.0">
26467 <!ELEMENT library (segment*, section*)>
26468 <!ATTLIST library name CDATA #REQUIRED>
26469 <!ELEMENT segment EMPTY>
26470 <!ATTLIST segment address CDATA #REQUIRED>
26471 <!ELEMENT section EMPTY>
26472 <!ATTLIST section address CDATA #REQUIRED>
26473 @end smallexample
26474
26475 In addition, segments and section descriptors cannot be mixed within a
26476 single library element, and you must supply at least one segment or
26477 section for each library.
26478
26479 @node Memory Map Format
26480 @section Memory Map Format
26481 @cindex memory map format
26482
26483 To be able to write into flash memory, @value{GDBN} needs to obtain a
26484 memory map from the target. This section describes the format of the
26485 memory map.
26486
26487 The memory map is obtained using the @samp{qXfer:memory-map:read}
26488 (@pxref{qXfer memory map read}) packet and is an XML document that
26489 lists memory regions.
26490
26491 @value{GDBN} must be linked with the Expat library to support XML
26492 memory maps. @xref{Expat}.
26493
26494 The top-level structure of the document is shown below:
26495
26496 @smallexample
26497 <?xml version="1.0"?>
26498 <!DOCTYPE memory-map
26499 PUBLIC "+//IDN gnu.org//DTD GDB Memory Map V1.0//EN"
26500 "http://sourceware.org/gdb/gdb-memory-map.dtd">
26501 <memory-map>
26502 region...
26503 </memory-map>
26504 @end smallexample
26505
26506 Each region can be either:
26507
26508 @itemize
26509
26510 @item
26511 A region of RAM starting at @var{addr} and extending for @var{length}
26512 bytes from there:
26513
26514 @smallexample
26515 <memory type="ram" start="@var{addr}" length="@var{length}"/>
26516 @end smallexample
26517
26518
26519 @item
26520 A region of read-only memory:
26521
26522 @smallexample
26523 <memory type="rom" start="@var{addr}" length="@var{length}"/>
26524 @end smallexample
26525
26526
26527 @item
26528 A region of flash memory, with erasure blocks @var{blocksize}
26529 bytes in length:
26530
26531 @smallexample
26532 <memory type="flash" start="@var{addr}" length="@var{length}">
26533 <property name="blocksize">@var{blocksize}</property>
26534 </memory>
26535 @end smallexample
26536
26537 @end itemize
26538
26539 Regions must not overlap. @value{GDBN} assumes that areas of memory not covered
26540 by the memory map are RAM, and uses the ordinary @samp{M} and @samp{X}
26541 packets to write to addresses in such ranges.
26542
26543 The formal DTD for memory map format is given below:
26544
26545 @smallexample
26546 <!-- ................................................... -->
26547 <!-- Memory Map XML DTD ................................ -->
26548 <!-- File: memory-map.dtd .............................. -->
26549 <!-- .................................... .............. -->
26550 <!-- memory-map.dtd -->
26551 <!-- memory-map: Root element with versioning -->
26552 <!ELEMENT memory-map (memory | property)>
26553 <!ATTLIST memory-map version CDATA #FIXED "1.0.0">
26554 <!ELEMENT memory (property)>
26555 <!-- memory: Specifies a memory region,
26556 and its type, or device. -->
26557 <!ATTLIST memory type CDATA #REQUIRED
26558 start CDATA #REQUIRED
26559 length CDATA #REQUIRED
26560 device CDATA #IMPLIED>
26561 <!-- property: Generic attribute tag -->
26562 <!ELEMENT property (#PCDATA | property)*>
26563 <!ATTLIST property name CDATA #REQUIRED>
26564 @end smallexample
26565
26566 @include agentexpr.texi
26567
26568 @node Target Descriptions
26569 @appendix Target Descriptions
26570 @cindex target descriptions
26571
26572 @strong{Warning:} target descriptions are still under active development,
26573 and the contents and format may change between @value{GDBN} releases.
26574 The format is expected to stabilize in the future.
26575
26576 One of the challenges of using @value{GDBN} to debug embedded systems
26577 is that there are so many minor variants of each processor
26578 architecture in use. It is common practice for vendors to start with
26579 a standard processor core --- ARM, PowerPC, or MIPS, for example ---
26580 and then make changes to adapt it to a particular market niche. Some
26581 architectures have hundreds of variants, available from dozens of
26582 vendors. This leads to a number of problems:
26583
26584 @itemize @bullet
26585 @item
26586 With so many different customized processors, it is difficult for
26587 the @value{GDBN} maintainers to keep up with the changes.
26588 @item
26589 Since individual variants may have short lifetimes or limited
26590 audiences, it may not be worthwhile to carry information about every
26591 variant in the @value{GDBN} source tree.
26592 @item
26593 When @value{GDBN} does support the architecture of the embedded system
26594 at hand, the task of finding the correct architecture name to give the
26595 @command{set architecture} command can be error-prone.
26596 @end itemize
26597
26598 To address these problems, the @value{GDBN} remote protocol allows a
26599 target system to not only identify itself to @value{GDBN}, but to
26600 actually describe its own features. This lets @value{GDBN} support
26601 processor variants it has never seen before --- to the extent that the
26602 descriptions are accurate, and that @value{GDBN} understands them.
26603
26604 @value{GDBN} must be linked with the Expat library to support XML
26605 target descriptions. @xref{Expat}.
26606
26607 @menu
26608 * Retrieving Descriptions:: How descriptions are fetched from a target.
26609 * Target Description Format:: The contents of a target description.
26610 * Predefined Target Types:: Standard types available for target
26611 descriptions.
26612 * Standard Target Features:: Features @value{GDBN} knows about.
26613 @end menu
26614
26615 @node Retrieving Descriptions
26616 @section Retrieving Descriptions
26617
26618 Target descriptions can be read from the target automatically, or
26619 specified by the user manually. The default behavior is to read the
26620 description from the target. @value{GDBN} retrieves it via the remote
26621 protocol using @samp{qXfer} requests (@pxref{General Query Packets,
26622 qXfer}). The @var{annex} in the @samp{qXfer} packet will be
26623 @samp{target.xml}. The contents of the @samp{target.xml} annex are an
26624 XML document, of the form described in @ref{Target Description
26625 Format}.
26626
26627 Alternatively, you can specify a file to read for the target description.
26628 If a file is set, the target will not be queried. The commands to
26629 specify a file are:
26630
26631 @table @code
26632 @cindex set tdesc filename
26633 @item set tdesc filename @var{path}
26634 Read the target description from @var{path}.
26635
26636 @cindex unset tdesc filename
26637 @item unset tdesc filename
26638 Do not read the XML target description from a file. @value{GDBN}
26639 will use the description supplied by the current target.
26640
26641 @cindex show tdesc filename
26642 @item show tdesc filename
26643 Show the filename to read for a target description, if any.
26644 @end table
26645
26646
26647 @node Target Description Format
26648 @section Target Description Format
26649 @cindex target descriptions, XML format
26650
26651 A target description annex is an @uref{http://www.w3.org/XML/, XML}
26652 document which complies with the Document Type Definition provided in
26653 the @value{GDBN} sources in @file{gdb/features/gdb-target.dtd}. This
26654 means you can use generally available tools like @command{xmllint} to
26655 check that your feature descriptions are well-formed and valid.
26656 However, to help people unfamiliar with XML write descriptions for
26657 their targets, we also describe the grammar here.
26658
26659 Target descriptions can identify the architecture of the remote target
26660 and (for some architectures) provide information about custom register
26661 sets. @value{GDBN} can use this information to autoconfigure for your
26662 target, or to warn you if you connect to an unsupported target.
26663
26664 Here is a simple target description:
26665
26666 @smallexample
26667 <target version="1.0">
26668 <architecture>i386:x86-64</architecture>
26669 </target>
26670 @end smallexample
26671
26672 @noindent
26673 This minimal description only says that the target uses
26674 the x86-64 architecture.
26675
26676 A target description has the following overall form, with [ ] marking
26677 optional elements and @dots{} marking repeatable elements. The elements
26678 are explained further below.
26679
26680 @smallexample
26681 <?xml version="1.0"?>
26682 <!DOCTYPE target SYSTEM "gdb-target.dtd">
26683 <target version="1.0">
26684 @r{[}@var{architecture}@r{]}
26685 @r{[}@var{feature}@dots{}@r{]}
26686 </target>
26687 @end smallexample
26688
26689 @noindent
26690 The description is generally insensitive to whitespace and line
26691 breaks, under the usual common-sense rules. The XML version
26692 declaration and document type declaration can generally be omitted
26693 (@value{GDBN} does not require them), but specifying them may be
26694 useful for XML validation tools. The @samp{version} attribute for
26695 @samp{<target>} may also be omitted, but we recommend
26696 including it; if future versions of @value{GDBN} use an incompatible
26697 revision of @file{gdb-target.dtd}, they will detect and report
26698 the version mismatch.
26699
26700 @subsection Inclusion
26701 @cindex target descriptions, inclusion
26702 @cindex XInclude
26703 @ifnotinfo
26704 @cindex <xi:include>
26705 @end ifnotinfo
26706
26707 It can sometimes be valuable to split a target description up into
26708 several different annexes, either for organizational purposes, or to
26709 share files between different possible target descriptions. You can
26710 divide a description into multiple files by replacing any element of
26711 the target description with an inclusion directive of the form:
26712
26713 @smallexample
26714 <xi:include href="@var{document}"/>
26715 @end smallexample
26716
26717 @noindent
26718 When @value{GDBN} encounters an element of this form, it will retrieve
26719 the named XML @var{document}, and replace the inclusion directive with
26720 the contents of that document. If the current description was read
26721 using @samp{qXfer}, then so will be the included document;
26722 @var{document} will be interpreted as the name of an annex. If the
26723 current description was read from a file, @value{GDBN} will look for
26724 @var{document} as a file in the same directory where it found the
26725 original description.
26726
26727 @subsection Architecture
26728 @cindex <architecture>
26729
26730 An @samp{<architecture>} element has this form:
26731
26732 @smallexample
26733 <architecture>@var{arch}</architecture>
26734 @end smallexample
26735
26736 @var{arch} is an architecture name from the same selection
26737 accepted by @code{set architecture} (@pxref{Targets, ,Specifying a
26738 Debugging Target}).
26739
26740 @subsection Features
26741 @cindex <feature>
26742
26743 Each @samp{<feature>} describes some logical portion of the target
26744 system. Features are currently used to describe available CPU
26745 registers and the types of their contents. A @samp{<feature>} element
26746 has this form:
26747
26748 @smallexample
26749 <feature name="@var{name}">
26750 @r{[}@var{type}@dots{}@r{]}
26751 @var{reg}@dots{}
26752 </feature>
26753 @end smallexample
26754
26755 @noindent
26756 Each feature's name should be unique within the description. The name
26757 of a feature does not matter unless @value{GDBN} has some special
26758 knowledge of the contents of that feature; if it does, the feature
26759 should have its standard name. @xref{Standard Target Features}.
26760
26761 @subsection Types
26762
26763 Any register's value is a collection of bits which @value{GDBN} must
26764 interpret. The default interpretation is a two's complement integer,
26765 but other types can be requested by name in the register description.
26766 Some predefined types are provided by @value{GDBN} (@pxref{Predefined
26767 Target Types}), and the description can define additional composite types.
26768
26769 Each type element must have an @samp{id} attribute, which gives
26770 a unique (within the containing @samp{<feature>}) name to the type.
26771 Types must be defined before they are used.
26772
26773 @cindex <vector>
26774 Some targets offer vector registers, which can be treated as arrays
26775 of scalar elements. These types are written as @samp{<vector>} elements,
26776 specifying the array element type, @var{type}, and the number of elements,
26777 @var{count}:
26778
26779 @smallexample
26780 <vector id="@var{id}" type="@var{type}" count="@var{count}"/>
26781 @end smallexample
26782
26783 @cindex <union>
26784 If a register's value is usefully viewed in multiple ways, define it
26785 with a union type containing the useful representations. The
26786 @samp{<union>} element contains one or more @samp{<field>} elements,
26787 each of which has a @var{name} and a @var{type}:
26788
26789 @smallexample
26790 <union id="@var{id}">
26791 <field name="@var{name}" type="@var{type}"/>
26792 @dots{}
26793 </union>
26794 @end smallexample
26795
26796 @subsection Registers
26797 @cindex <reg>
26798
26799 Each register is represented as an element with this form:
26800
26801 @smallexample
26802 <reg name="@var{name}"
26803 bitsize="@var{size}"
26804 @r{[}regnum="@var{num}"@r{]}
26805 @r{[}save-restore="@var{save-restore}"@r{]}
26806 @r{[}type="@var{type}"@r{]}
26807 @r{[}group="@var{group}"@r{]}/>
26808 @end smallexample
26809
26810 @noindent
26811 The components are as follows:
26812
26813 @table @var
26814
26815 @item name
26816 The register's name; it must be unique within the target description.
26817
26818 @item bitsize
26819 The register's size, in bits.
26820
26821 @item regnum
26822 The register's number. If omitted, a register's number is one greater
26823 than that of the previous register (either in the current feature or in
26824 a preceeding feature); the first register in the target description
26825 defaults to zero. This register number is used to read or write
26826 the register; e.g.@: it is used in the remote @code{p} and @code{P}
26827 packets, and registers appear in the @code{g} and @code{G} packets
26828 in order of increasing register number.
26829
26830 @item save-restore
26831 Whether the register should be preserved across inferior function
26832 calls; this must be either @code{yes} or @code{no}. The default is
26833 @code{yes}, which is appropriate for most registers except for
26834 some system control registers; this is not related to the target's
26835 ABI.
26836
26837 @item type
26838 The type of the register. @var{type} may be a predefined type, a type
26839 defined in the current feature, or one of the special types @code{int}
26840 and @code{float}. @code{int} is an integer type of the correct size
26841 for @var{bitsize}, and @code{float} is a floating point type (in the
26842 architecture's normal floating point format) of the correct size for
26843 @var{bitsize}. The default is @code{int}.
26844
26845 @item group
26846 The register group to which this register belongs. @var{group} must
26847 be either @code{general}, @code{float}, or @code{vector}. If no
26848 @var{group} is specified, @value{GDBN} will not display the register
26849 in @code{info registers}.
26850
26851 @end table
26852
26853 @node Predefined Target Types
26854 @section Predefined Target Types
26855 @cindex target descriptions, predefined types
26856
26857 Type definitions in the self-description can build up composite types
26858 from basic building blocks, but can not define fundamental types. Instead,
26859 standard identifiers are provided by @value{GDBN} for the fundamental
26860 types. The currently supported types are:
26861
26862 @table @code
26863
26864 @item int8
26865 @itemx int16
26866 @itemx int32
26867 @itemx int64
26868 @itemx int128
26869 Signed integer types holding the specified number of bits.
26870
26871 @item uint8
26872 @itemx uint16
26873 @itemx uint32
26874 @itemx uint64
26875 @itemx uint128
26876 Unsigned integer types holding the specified number of bits.
26877
26878 @item code_ptr
26879 @itemx data_ptr
26880 Pointers to unspecified code and data. The program counter and
26881 any dedicated return address register may be marked as code
26882 pointers; printing a code pointer converts it into a symbolic
26883 address. The stack pointer and any dedicated address registers
26884 may be marked as data pointers.
26885
26886 @item ieee_single
26887 Single precision IEEE floating point.
26888
26889 @item ieee_double
26890 Double precision IEEE floating point.
26891
26892 @item arm_fpa_ext
26893 The 12-byte extended precision format used by ARM FPA registers.
26894
26895 @end table
26896
26897 @node Standard Target Features
26898 @section Standard Target Features
26899 @cindex target descriptions, standard features
26900
26901 A target description must contain either no registers or all the
26902 target's registers. If the description contains no registers, then
26903 @value{GDBN} will assume a default register layout, selected based on
26904 the architecture. If the description contains any registers, the
26905 default layout will not be used; the standard registers must be
26906 described in the target description, in such a way that @value{GDBN}
26907 can recognize them.
26908
26909 This is accomplished by giving specific names to feature elements
26910 which contain standard registers. @value{GDBN} will look for features
26911 with those names and verify that they contain the expected registers;
26912 if any known feature is missing required registers, or if any required
26913 feature is missing, @value{GDBN} will reject the target
26914 description. You can add additional registers to any of the
26915 standard features --- @value{GDBN} will display them just as if
26916 they were added to an unrecognized feature.
26917
26918 This section lists the known features and their expected contents.
26919 Sample XML documents for these features are included in the
26920 @value{GDBN} source tree, in the directory @file{gdb/features}.
26921
26922 Names recognized by @value{GDBN} should include the name of the
26923 company or organization which selected the name, and the overall
26924 architecture to which the feature applies; so e.g.@: the feature
26925 containing ARM core registers is named @samp{org.gnu.gdb.arm.core}.
26926
26927 The names of registers are not case sensitive for the purpose
26928 of recognizing standard features, but @value{GDBN} will only display
26929 registers using the capitalization used in the description.
26930
26931 @menu
26932 * ARM Features::
26933 * MIPS Features::
26934 * M68K Features::
26935 * PowerPC Features::
26936 @end menu
26937
26938
26939 @node ARM Features
26940 @subsection ARM Features
26941 @cindex target descriptions, ARM features
26942
26943 The @samp{org.gnu.gdb.arm.core} feature is required for ARM targets.
26944 It should contain registers @samp{r0} through @samp{r13}, @samp{sp},
26945 @samp{lr}, @samp{pc}, and @samp{cpsr}.
26946
26947 The @samp{org.gnu.gdb.arm.fpa} feature is optional. If present, it
26948 should contain registers @samp{f0} through @samp{f7} and @samp{fps}.
26949
26950 The @samp{org.gnu.gdb.xscale.iwmmxt} feature is optional. If present,
26951 it should contain at least registers @samp{wR0} through @samp{wR15} and
26952 @samp{wCGR0} through @samp{wCGR3}. The @samp{wCID}, @samp{wCon},
26953 @samp{wCSSF}, and @samp{wCASF} registers are optional.
26954
26955 @node MIPS Features
26956 @subsection MIPS Features
26957 @cindex target descriptions, MIPS features
26958
26959 The @samp{org.gnu.gdb.mips.cpu} feature is required for MIPS targets.
26960 It should contain registers @samp{r0} through @samp{r31}, @samp{lo},
26961 @samp{hi}, and @samp{pc}. They may be 32-bit or 64-bit depending
26962 on the target.
26963
26964 The @samp{org.gnu.gdb.mips.cp0} feature is also required. It should
26965 contain at least the @samp{status}, @samp{badvaddr}, and @samp{cause}
26966 registers. They may be 32-bit or 64-bit depending on the target.
26967
26968 The @samp{org.gnu.gdb.mips.fpu} feature is currently required, though
26969 it may be optional in a future version of @value{GDBN}. It should
26970 contain registers @samp{f0} through @samp{f31}, @samp{fcsr}, and
26971 @samp{fir}. They may be 32-bit or 64-bit depending on the target.
26972
26973 The @samp{org.gnu.gdb.mips.linux} feature is optional. It should
26974 contain a single register, @samp{restart}, which is used by the
26975 Linux kernel to control restartable syscalls.
26976
26977 @node M68K Features
26978 @subsection M68K Features
26979 @cindex target descriptions, M68K features
26980
26981 @table @code
26982 @item @samp{org.gnu.gdb.m68k.core}
26983 @itemx @samp{org.gnu.gdb.coldfire.core}
26984 @itemx @samp{org.gnu.gdb.fido.core}
26985 One of those features must be always present.
26986 The feature that is present determines which flavor of m86k is
26987 used. The feature that is present should contain registers
26988 @samp{d0} through @samp{d7}, @samp{a0} through @samp{a5}, @samp{fp},
26989 @samp{sp}, @samp{ps} and @samp{pc}.
26990
26991 @item @samp{org.gnu.gdb.coldfire.fp}
26992 This feature is optional. If present, it should contain registers
26993 @samp{fp0} through @samp{fp7}, @samp{fpcontrol}, @samp{fpstatus} and
26994 @samp{fpiaddr}.
26995 @end table
26996
26997 @node PowerPC Features
26998 @subsection PowerPC Features
26999 @cindex target descriptions, PowerPC features
27000
27001 The @samp{org.gnu.gdb.power.core} feature is required for PowerPC
27002 targets. It should contain registers @samp{r0} through @samp{r31},
27003 @samp{pc}, @samp{msr}, @samp{cr}, @samp{lr}, @samp{ctr}, and
27004 @samp{xer}. They may be 32-bit or 64-bit depending on the target.
27005
27006 The @samp{org.gnu.gdb.power.fpu} feature is optional. It should
27007 contain registers @samp{f0} through @samp{f31} and @samp{fpscr}.
27008
27009 The @samp{org.gnu.gdb.power.altivec} feature is optional. It should
27010 contain registers @samp{vr0} through @samp{vr31}, @samp{vscr},
27011 and @samp{vrsave}.
27012
27013 The @samp{org.gnu.gdb.power.spe} feature is optional. It should
27014 contain registers @samp{ev0h} through @samp{ev31h}, @samp{acc}, and
27015 @samp{spefscr}. SPE targets should provide 32-bit registers in
27016 @samp{org.gnu.gdb.power.core} and provide the upper halves in
27017 @samp{ev0h} through @samp{ev31h}. @value{GDBN} will combine
27018 these to present registers @samp{ev0} through @samp{ev31} to the
27019 user.
27020
27021 @include gpl.texi
27022
27023 @raisesections
27024 @include fdl.texi
27025 @lowersections
27026
27027 @node Index
27028 @unnumbered Index
27029
27030 @printindex cp
27031
27032 @tex
27033 % I think something like @colophon should be in texinfo. In the
27034 % meantime:
27035 \long\def\colophon{\hbox to0pt{}\vfill
27036 \centerline{The body of this manual is set in}
27037 \centerline{\fontname\tenrm,}
27038 \centerline{with headings in {\bf\fontname\tenbf}}
27039 \centerline{and examples in {\tt\fontname\tentt}.}
27040 \centerline{{\it\fontname\tenit\/},}
27041 \centerline{{\bf\fontname\tenbf}, and}
27042 \centerline{{\sl\fontname\tensl\/}}
27043 \centerline{are used for emphasis.}\vfill}
27044 \page\colophon
27045 % Blame: doc@cygnus.com, 1991.
27046 @end tex
27047
27048 @bye
This page took 1.038518 seconds and 5 git commands to generate.